Defend against bad data from gethostbyaddr(). Fixes bug #619
[exim.git] / doc / doc-src / spec.src
1 . $Cambridge: exim/doc/doc-src/spec.src,v 1.8 2005/02/17 11:58:25 ph10 Exp $
2 .
3 .set version "4.50"
4 .set previousversion "4.40"
5 .set versionmonth "February"
6 .set versionyear "2005"
7 .set ACL "ACL"
8
9 . The last of those is to make ACL index entries easier to type. It is put
10 . up here so that it gets picked up by the HTML converter, which otherwise
11 . skips to the first chapter. A longer version is set below for use in the
12 . printed index.
13
14 .set sgcal true
15 .set html false
16 .set texinfo false
17
18 .if !set style
19 .library "a4ps"
20 .linelength ~~sys.linelength + 0.2in
21 .set newlinelength ~~sys.linelength
22 .emphasis ~~sys.linelength + 0.1in
23 .pagedepth ~~sys.pagedepth - 0.2in
24 .bindfont 51 "atl/Times-Bold" 9
25 .bindfont 52 "atl/Times-Roman" 9
26 .bindfont 53 "atl/Times-Roman" 7
27 .bindfont 54 "atl/Courier" 9
28 .bindfont 55 "atl/Courier-Bold" ~~maintypesize
29 .bindfont 56 "atl/Times-Italic" 7
30 .bindfont 57 "atl/Times-Bold" 7
31 .bindfont 58 "atl/Symbol" 7
32 .set ssspaceb 1.50
33
34 .if ~~sgcal
35 . Used for the "small print" incorporated code stuff. Only rm, it, bf, sp are
36 . actually used at present.
37 . rm it sl bf bi ss tt sp sc
38 .fontgroup 9 = 53 56 0 57 0 0 0 58 0
39 .fi
40 .fi
41
42 .if !~~sys.fancy
43 .fontgroup 9 = 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
44 .fi
45
46 .include "markup.sg"
47
48 .if ~~sys.fancy
49 .flag $smc{ "$push$g0$f54"
50 .flag $sm{ "$push$g0$f53"
51 .flag $smi{ "$push$g0$f56"
52 .flag $as{ "$push$g0$f52"
53 .flag $ab{ "$push$g0$f51"
54 .flag $cb{ "$push$g0$f55"
55 .
56 .else
57 .flag $smc{ "$push"
58 .flag $sm{ "$push"
59 .flag $smi{ "$push"
60 .flag $cb{ "$push"
61 .fi
62
63 .macro isunderscore "string"
64 .set string "~~1"
65 .set length length "~~1"
66 .undrec 1
67 .endm
68
69 .macro undrec "offset"
70 .if ~~1 > ~~length
71 .set underscore false
72 .else
73 .set sub "~~string"(1,~~1)
74 .if "~~sub" == "_"
75 .set underscore true
76 .else
77 .set next ~~1 + 1
78 .undrec ~~next
79 .fi
80 .fi
81 .endm
82
83 .macro testunderscore "string"
84 .isunderscore "~~1"
85 .newline
86 .endm
87
88 .macro tabs 6
89 .if ~~sys.fancy
90 .tabset ~~1em
91 .else
92 .set temp (~~1 * 5)/4
93 .tabset ~~temp em
94 .fi
95 .endm
96
97 .macro startoptions
98 .newline
99 .push
100 .if ~~sys.fancy
101 .indent 6em
102 .else
103 .indent 7em
104 .fi
105 .endm
106
107 .macro endoptions
108 .newline
109 .pop
110 .endm
111
112 .macro option "option" ""
113 .newpar
114 .index \-~~1-\ option
115 .tempindent 0
116 \-~~1-\~~2#$i
117 .nosep
118 .endm
119
120 .macro startitems
121 .newline
122 .push
123 .indent 3em
124 .endm
125
126 .macro enditems
127 .newline
128 .pop
129 .endm
130
131 .macro item "item" "6"
132 .newpar
133 .if ~~sys.leftonpage < ~~2ld
134 .newpage
135 .fi
136 .tempindent 0
137 \**~~1**\
138 .blank
139 .endm
140
141 .macro startconf ""
142 .set confsection "~~1"
143 .newline
144 .push
145 .if ~~sys.fancy
146 .indent 2em
147 .tabset 9em
148 .else
149 .indent 4em
150 .tabset 13em
151 .fi
152 .endm
153
154 .macro endconf
155 .newline
156 .pop
157 .endm
158
159 .macro conf "option" "type" "default" "6"
160 .newpar
161 .if ~~sys.leftonpage < ~~4ld
162 .newpage
163 .fi
164 .testunderscore "~~1"
165 .if ~~underscore
166 .index \~~1\
167 .else
168 .index \~~1\ option
169 .fi
170 .if "~~confsection" == ""
171 .set inssect ""
172 .else
173 .set inssect "$rm{Use:} $it{~~confsection}###"
174 .fi
175 .tempindent 0
176 \**~~1**\ $c ~~inssect$rm{Type:} $it{~~2} $e $rm{Default:} $it{~~3}
177 .blank
178 .endm
179
180 .set contents true
181 .set figurenumber -1
182 .set displayindent 2em
183
184 .index @$1, @$2, etc. $it{see numerical variables}
185 .index address||rewriting $it{see rewriting}
186 .index CR character $it{see carriage return}
187 .index CRL $it{see certificate revocation list}
188 .index delivery||failure report $it{see bounce message}
189 .index dialup $it{see intermittently connected hosts}
190 .index exiscan $it{see content scanning}
191 .index failover $it{see fallback}
192 .index fallover $it{see fallback}
193 .index filter||Sieve $it{see Sieve filter}
194 .index ident $it{see RFC 1413}
195 .index LF character $it{see linefeed}
196 .index maximum $it{see limit}
197 .index NUL $it{see binary zero}
198 .index passwd file $it{see \(/etc/passwd)\}
199 .index process id $it{see pid}
200 .index RBL $it{see DNS list}
201 .index redirection $it{see address redirection}
202 .index return path||$it{see also envelope sender}
203 .index scanning $it{see content scanning}
204 .index SSL $it{see TLS}
205 .index string||expansion $it{see expansion}
206 .index top bit $it{see 8-bit characters}
207 .index variables $it{see expansion, variables}
208 .index zero, binary $it{see binary zero}
209
210 . This is used for the printed index. See setting above for
211 . the HTML index value.
212
213 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
214
215 . ======================================================
216
217 .push
218 .disable filling
219 .justify centre
220 .nofoot
221 .space 8ld
222 $chead{University of Cambridge Computing Service}
223 .space 2ld
224 $chead{Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent}
225 .space 3ld
226 by
227 .space 1ld
228 Philip Hazel
229 .space ~~sys.leftonpage - 15*~~sys.linedepth
230 .justify left
231 University Computing Service
232 New Museums Site
233 Pembroke Street
234 Cambridge CB2 3QH
235 United Kingdom
236 .blank
237 .tabs 6
238 $it{phone:} $t +44 1223 334600
239 $it{fax:} $t +44 1223 334679
240 $it{email:} $t ph10 $it{at} cus.cam.ac.uk
241 .blank
242 Edition for Exim ~~version, ~~versionmonth ~~versionyear
243 .space 2ld
244 .if ~~sgcal
245 .fontgroup 1
246 .fi
247 $c$rm{Copyright (c) University of Cambridge ~~versionyear}
248
249
250 .if ~~sgcal
251 .fontgroup 0
252 .font 0
253 .fi
254
255 .pop
256 .newpage
257
258 . Blank verso for title page
259 .space 1ld
260 .newpage
261
262
263 . Set up for actual text pages
264 .page 1
265 . The first one to prevent a warning from sgfr
266 . set runningfoot "~~chapter"
267 .set runningfoot ""
268
269 .if ~~sys.fancy
270 .footdepth 2ld
271 .foot
272 .if "~~runningfoot" == ""
273 .set rhs ""
274 .else
275 .set rhs "~~runningfoot (~~chapter)"
276 .fi
277 .set lhs "Exim ~~version"
278 .linelength ~~newlinelength
279 $it{~~lhs}$c[~~sys.pagenumber]$e$it{~~rhs}
280 .endfoot
281 .fi
282
283
284
285
286 .
287 .
288 .
289 .
290 . ============================================================================
291 .chapter Introduction
292 .set runningfoot "introduction"
293
294 .if ~~sys.fancy
295 $c$bi{If I have seen further it is by standing on the shoulders of giants.}##(Isaac Newton)
296 .elif !~~html
297 $c"If I have seen further it is by standing on the shoulders of giants."
298 .newline
299 $e (Isaac Newton)
300 .else
301 \*If I have seen further it is by standing on the shoulders of giants.*\
302 (Isaac Newton).
303 .fi
304 .blank 4
305
306 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
307 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
308 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
309 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
310
311 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
312 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd, GNU/Linux,
313 HI-OSF (Hitachi), HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD, QNX, SCO, SCO
314 SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4, Tru64-Unix (formerly
315 Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware. Some of these operating
316 systems are no longer current and cannot easily be tested, so the configuration
317 files may no longer work in practice.
318
319 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
320 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
321 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
322
323 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
324 the file \(NOTICE)\. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
325 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file \(LICENCE)\.
326
327 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
328 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
329 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
330 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
331 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
332
333 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
334 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
335 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
336 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
337 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
338
339 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
340 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
341 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
342 \(ACKNOWLEDGMENTS)\, in which I have started recording the names of
343 contributors.
344
345
346 .section Exim documentation
347 .index documentation
348 .em
349 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version ~~version of Exim.
350 Substantive changes from the ~~previousversion edition are marked by bars in
351 the right-hand margin in the PostScript, PDF, and plain text versions of the
352 document, and by green text in the HTML version, as shown by this paragraph.
353 Changes are not marked in the Texinfo version, because Texinfo doesn't support
354 change bars. Minor corrections and rewordings are not marked.
355 .nem
356
357 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
358 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
359 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
360 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
361 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
362 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
363 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
364 very wide interest.
365
366 .index books about Exim
367 An `easier' discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
368 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled
369 .if ~~html
370 [(A HREF="http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/")]
371 $it{The Exim SMTP Mail Server},
372 [(/A)]
373 published by UIT Cambridge.
374 .else
375 $it{The Exim SMTP Mail Server}, published by UIT Cambridge
376 (\?http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/?\).
377 .fi
378
379 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
380 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
381 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
382 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
383
384 .index \(doc/NewStuff)\
385 .index \(doc/ChangeLog)\
386 .index change log
387 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
388 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
389 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
390 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
391 \(doc/NewStuff)\ in the Exim distribution.
392
393 .em
394 Some features may be classified as `experimental'. These may change
395 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
396 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
397 can be found in the file \(doc/experimental.txt)\.
398 .nem
399
400 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
401 change) are noted briefly in the file called \(doc/ChangeLog)\.
402
403 .index \(doc/spec.txt)\
404 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in \(doc/spec.txt)\ so
405 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the \(doc)\
406 directory are:
407 .display rm
408 .tabs 18
409 \(OptionLists.txt)\ $t $rm{list of all options in alphabetical order}
410 \(dbm.discuss.txt)\ $t $rm{discussion about DBM libraries}
411 \(exim.8)\ $t $rm{a man page of Exim's command line options}
412 .newline
413 .em
414 \(experimental.txt)\ $t $rm{documentation of experimental features}
415 .nem
416 .newline
417 \(filter.txt)\ $t $rm{specification of the filter language}
418 \(pcrepattern.txt)\ $t $rm{specification of PCRE regular expressions}
419 \(pcretest.txt)\ $t $rm{specification of the PCRE testing program}
420 \(Exim3.upgrade)\ $t $rm{upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3}
421 \(Exim4.upgrade)\ $t $rm{upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4}
422 .endd
423 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
424 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
425 ~~SECTavail below tells you how to get hold of these.
426
427
428 .section FTP and web sites
429 .index web site
430 .index FTP site
431 .em
432 The primary distribution site for Exim is currently the University of
433 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in \*Where to find the Exim
434 distribution*\ below. In addition, there is a
435 .if ~~html
436 [(A HREF="http://www.exim.org/")]
437 .fi
438 web site
439 .if ~~html
440 [(/A)]
441 .fi
442 and an
443 .if ~~html
444 [(A HREF="ftp://ftp.exim.org/")]
445 .fi
446 FTP site
447 .if ~~html
448 [(/A)]
449 .fi
450 at \exim.org\. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge.
451 The \exim.org\ site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
452 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
453
454 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
455 differently formatted versions of the documentation, including the
456 .index FAQ
457 .if ~~html
458 [(A HREF="FAQ.html")]
459 .fi
460 FAQ
461 .if ~~html
462 [(/A)]
463 .fi
464 in both text and HTML formats. The HTML version comes with a keyword-in-context
465 index. A recent addition to the online information is the
466 .index wiki
467 .if ~~html
468 [(A HREF="http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/")]
469 Exim wiki.
470 [(/A)]
471 .else
472 Exim wiki (\?http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/?\).
473 .fi
474 We hope that this will make it easier for Exim users to contribute examples,
475 tips, and know-how for the benefit of others.
476 .nem
477
478 .section Mailing lists
479 .index mailing lists||for Exim users
480 .em
481 The following are the three main Exim mailing lists:
482 .display rm
483 .tabs 28
484 $it{exim-users@@exim.org} $t general discussion list
485 $it{exim-dev@@exim.org} $t discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc.
486 $it{exim-announce@@exim.org} $t moderated, low volume announcements list
487 .endd
488 .nem
489 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
490 or search the archives via the
491 .if ~~html
492 [(A HREF="http://www.exim.org/maillist.html")]
493 .fi
494 mailing lists
495 .if ~~html
496 [(/A)]
497 .fi
498 link on the Exim home page. The $it{exim-users} mailing list is also forwarded
499 to \?http://www.egroups.com/list/exim-users?\, an archiving system with
500 searching capabilities.
501
502 .section Exim training
503 .index training courses
504 From time to time (approximately annually at the time of writing),
505 lecture-based training courses are run by the author of Exim in Cambridge, UK.
506 Details can be found on the web site
507 .if ~~html
508 [(A HREF="http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/")]
509 .fi
510 \?http://www-tus@.csx@.cam@.ac.uk/courses/exim/?\.
511 .if ~~html
512 [(/A)]
513 .fi
514
515 .section Bug reports
516 .index bug reports
517 .index reporting bugs
518 Reports of obvious bugs should be emailed to \*bugs@@exim.org*\. However, if
519 you are unsure whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is
520 to post a message to the $it{exim-users} mailing list and have it discussed.
521
522
523 .em
524 .section Where to find the Exim distribution
525 .rset SECTavail "~~chapter.~~section"
526 .index FTP site
527 .index distribution||ftp site
528 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
529 .display rm
530 .if ! ~~sys.fancy
531 .indent 0
532 .fi
533 \?ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim?\
534 .endd
535 This is mirrored by
536 .display rm
537 .if ! ~~sys.fancy
538 .indent 0
539 .fi
540 \?ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim?\
541 .endd
542 The file references that follow are relative to the \(exim)\ directories at
543 these sites.
544
545 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around the world.
546 Those that I know about are listed in the file called \(Mirrors)\.
547
548 Within the \(exim)\ directory there are subdirectories called \(exim3)\ (for
549 previous Exim 3 distributions), \(exim4)\ (for the latest Exim 4
550 distributions), and \(Testing)\ for testing versions. In the \(exim4)\
551 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
552 .display rm
553 \(exim-$it{n.nn}.tar.gz)\
554 \(exim-$it{n.nn}.tar.bz2)\
555 .endd
556 where $it{n.nn} is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
557 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
558 The \(.bz2)\ file is usually a lot smaller than the \(.gz)\ file.
559 .index distribution||signing details
560 .index distribution||public key
561 .index public key for signed distribution
562 The distributions are currently signed with Philip Hazel's GPG key. The
563 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
564 also a copy in the file \(Public-Key)\. The signatures for the tar bundles are
565 in:
566 .display rm
567 \(exim-$it{n.nn}.tar.gz.sig)\
568 \(exim-$it{n.nn}.tar.bz2.sig)\
569 .endd
570 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
571 separate file in the directory \(ChangeLogs)\ so that it is possible to
572 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
573
574 .index documentation||available formats
575 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
576 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
577 inside the \(exim4)\ directory of the FTP site:
578 .display rm
579 \(exim-html-$it{n.nn}.tar.gz)\
580 \(exim-pdf-$it{n.nn}.tar.gz)\
581 \(exim-postscript-$it{n.nn}.tar.gz)\
582 \(exim-texinfo-$it{n.nn}.tar.gz)\
583 .endd
584 These tar files contain only the \(doc)\ directory, not the complete
585 distribution, and are also available in \(.bz2)\ as well as \(.gz)\ forms.
586
587 .index FAQ
588 The FAQ is available for downloading in two different formats in these files:
589 .display rm
590 \(exim4/FAQ.txt.gz)\
591 \(exim4/FAQ.html.tar.gz)\
592 .endd
593 The first of these is a single ASCII file that can be searched with a text
594 editor. The second is a directory of HTML files, normally accessed by starting
595 at \(index.html)\. The HTML version of the FAQ (which is also included in the
596 HTML documentation tarbundle) includes a keyword-in-context index, which is
597 often the most convenient way of finding your way around.
598
599 .section Wish list
600 .index wish list
601 A wish list is maintained, containing ideas for new features that have been
602 submitted. From time to time the file is exported to the ftp site into the file
603 \(exim4/WishList)\. Items are removed from the list if they get implemented.
604
605
606 .section Contributed material
607 .index contributed material
608 At the ftp site, there is a directory called \(Contrib)\ that contains
609 miscellaneous files contributed to the Exim community by Exim users. There is
610 also a collection of contributed configuration examples in
611 \(exim4/config.samples.tar.gz)\. These samples are referenced from the FAQ.
612 .nem
613
614 .section Limitations
615 .index limitations of Exim
616 .numberpars $.
617 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses
618 in RFC 2822 domain format only.
619 .index bang paths||not handled by Exim
620 It cannot handle UUCP `bang paths', though simple two-component bang paths can
621 be converted by a straightforward rewriting configuration. This restriction
622 does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to UUCP as a transport mechanism,
623 provided that domain addresses are used.
624 .nextp
625 .index domainless addresses
626 .index address||without domain
627 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
628 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
629 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
630 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
631 arrival.
632 .nextp
633 .index transport||external
634 .index external transports
635 The only external transport currently implemented is an SMTP transport over a
636 TCP/IP network (using sockets, including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
637 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
638 and pipes, optionally in \*batched SMTP*\ format; these facilities can be used
639 to send messages to some other transport mechanism such as UUCP, provided it
640 can handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
641 .nextp
642 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
643 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages `delivered' into files
644 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
645 other means.
646 .nextp
647 .em
648 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
649 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
650 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
651 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
652 a number of common scanners are provided.
653 .nem
654 .endp
655
656
657
658 .section Run time configuration
659 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
660 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
661 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
662 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
663 distribution, and is described in chapter ~~CHAPdefconfil below.
664
665
666 .section Calling interface
667 .index Sendmail compatibility||command line interface
668 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
669 can be a straight replacement for \(/usr/lib/sendmail)\ or
670 \(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\ when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
671 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
672 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
673 example, \-bp-\, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
674 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
675 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter ~~CHAPcommandline
676 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
677 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
678
679 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
680 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called \*eximon*\, which
681 displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
682 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
683
684
685 .section Terminology
686 .index terminology definitions
687 .index body of message||definition of
688 The \*body*\ of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
689 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the \*header*\ (see
690 below) by a blank line.
691
692 .index bounce message||definition of
693 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
694 delivery failure message or a `non-delivery report' (NDR). The term \*bounce*\
695 is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often called
696 \*bounce messages*\. This is a convenient shorthand for `delivery failure error
697 report'. Such messages have an empty sender address in the message's
698 \*envelope*\ (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give rise to
699 further bounce messages.
700
701 The term \*default*\ appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
702 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
703 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
704 otherwise.
705
706 The term \*defer*\ is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
707 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
708 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are \*deferred*\
709 until a later time.
710
711 The word \*domain*\ is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
712 host's name. It is $it{not} used in that sense here, where it normally
713 refers to the part of an email address following the @@ sign.
714
715 .index envelope, definition of
716 .index sender||definition of
717 A message in transit has an associated \*envelope*\, as well as a header and a
718 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
719 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
720 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
721 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
722 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
723
724 .index message||header, definition of
725 .index header section||definition of
726 The \*header*\ of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
727 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as ::From::, ::To::,
728 ::Subject::, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
729 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
730 line.
731
732 .index local part||definition of
733 .index domain||definition of
734 The term \*local part*\, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
735 part of an email address that precedes the @@ sign. The part that follows the
736 @@ sign is called the \*domain*\ or \*mail domain*\.
737
738 .index local delivery||definition of
739 .index remote delivery, definition of
740 The terms \*local delivery*\ and \*remote delivery*\ are used to distinguish
741 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
742 TCP/IP to a remote host.
743
744 .index return path||definition of
745 \*Return path*\ is another name that is used for the sender address in a
746 message's envelope.
747
748 .index queue||definition of
749 The term \*queue*\ is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
750 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
751 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
752 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
753
754 .index queue runner||definition of
755 The term \*queue runner*\ is used to describe a process that scans the queue
756 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
757 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command \runq\, but in Exim
758 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
759
760 .index spool directory||definition of
761 The term \*spool directory*\ is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
762 messages on its queue -- that is, those that it is in the process of
763 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
764 mailboxes are stored, which is called a `spool directory' by some people. In
765 the Exim documentation, `spool' is always used in the first sense.
766
767
768
769 .
770 .
771 .
772 .
773 . ============================================================================
774 .chapter Incorporated code
775 .set runningfoot "incorporated code"
776 .index incorporated code
777 .index regular expressions||library
778 .index PCRE
779 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
780 .numberpars $.
781 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the Exim
782 monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright (c) University
783 of Cambridge. The source is distributed in the directory \(src/pcre)\. However,
784 this is a cut-down version of PCRE. If you want to use the PCRE library in
785 other programs, you should obtain and install the full version from
786 \?ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre?\.
787
788 .space 1ld
789 .nextp
790 .index cdb||acknowledgement
791 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
792 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
793 Online Ltd. which contains the following statements:
794 .rule
795 .push
796 .if ~~sgcal
797 .fontgroup 9
798 .font 0
799 .fi
800 Copyright (c) 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
801
802 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
803 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
804 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
805 version.
806
807 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
808 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
809 \?http://www.pobox.com/@~djb/cdb.html?\. This implementation borrows some code
810 from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license restrictions applied
811 to it).
812 .newline
813 .pop
814 .rule
815 The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
816 It does not link against an external cdb library.
817 .space 1ld
818 .nextp
819 .index SPA authentication
820 .index Samba project
821 .index Microsoft Secure Password Authentication
822 Client support for Microsoft's \*Secure Password Authentication*\ is provided
823 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
824 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
825 under the Gnu GPL.
826
827 .space 1ld
828 .nextp
829 .index Cyrus
830 .index \*pwcheck*\ daemon
831 .index \*pwauthd*\ daemon
832 Support for calling the Cyrus \*pwcheck*\ and \*saslauthd*\ daemons is provided
833 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
834 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
835 conditions expressed therein.
836
837 .rule
838 .push
839 .if ~~sgcal
840 .fontgroup 9
841 .font 0
842 .fi
843 Copyright (c) 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
844
845 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
846 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
847 are met:
848
849 .if ~~sgcal
850 .cancelflag $npbracket
851 .flag $npbracket "" "."
852 .fi
853 .numberpars
854 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
855 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
856 .nextp
857 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
858 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
859 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
860 distribution.
861 .nextp
862 The name `Carnegie Mellon University' must not be used to
863 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
864 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
865 details, please contact
866 .display rm
867 Office of Technology Transfer
868 Carnegie Mellon University
869 5000 Forbes Avenue
870 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
871 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
872 tech-transfer@@andrew.cmu.edu
873 .endd
874 .nextp
875 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
876 acknowledgment:
877 .newline
878 .push
879 .indent ~~sys.indent + 3em
880 .justify left
881 $it{This product includes software developed by Computing Services
882 at Carnegie Mellon University (\?http://www.cmu.edu/computing/?\).}
883 .newline
884 .pop
885 .endp
886 .if ~~sgcal
887 .cancelflag $npbracket
888 .flag $npbracket "(" ")"
889 .fi
890
891 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
892 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
893 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
894 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
895 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
896 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
897 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
898 .newline
899 .pop
900 .rule
901
902 .space 1ld
903 .nextp
904 .index monitor
905 .index X-windows
906 .index Athena
907 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
908 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
909 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
910 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
911
912 .rule
913 .push
914 .if ~~sgcal
915 .fontgroup 9
916 .font 0
917 .fi
918 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
919 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
920 .blank
921 $c All Rights Reserved
922 .blank
923 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
924 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
925 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
926 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
927 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
928 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
929 software without specific, written prior permission.
930
931 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
932 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
933 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
934 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
935 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
936 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
937 SOFTWARE.
938 .newline
939 .pop
940 .rule
941 .space 1ld
942 .nextp
943 .em
944 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
945 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
946 contributors are happy to see their code incoporated into Exim under the GPL.
947 .nem
948 .endp
949
950
951
952 .
953 .
954 .
955 .
956 . ============================================================================
957 .chapter How Exim receives and delivers mail
958 .set runningfoot "receiving & delivering mail"
959
960 .section Overall philosophy
961 .index design philosophy
962 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
963 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
964 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
965 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
966 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
967 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
968
969
970 .section Policy control
971 .index policy control||overview
972 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
973 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
974 `open relays' by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of unsolicited
975 junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible facilities for
976 specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
977 .numberpars $.
978 .index ~~ACL||introduction
979 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
980 incoming mail by means of \*Access Control Lists*\ (ACLs). Each list is a
981 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
982 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
983 host. However, the most common places are after each \\RCPT\\ command, and at
984 the very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting
985 or rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at
986 these two points (see chapter ~~CHAPACL). Denial of access results in an SMTP
987 error code.
988 .nextp
989 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
990 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
991 .nextp
992 .em
993 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
994 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
995 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
996 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
997 .nem
998 .nextp
999 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
1000 host, but before the final acknowledgement has been sent, a locally supplied C
1001 function called \*local@_scan()*\ can be run to inspect the message and decide
1002 whether to accept it or not (see chapter ~~CHAPlocalscan). If the message is
1003 accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
1004 .nextp
1005 .em
1006 Using the \*local@_scan()*\ mechanism is another way of calling external
1007 scanner software. The \SA-Exim\ add-on package works this way. It does not
1008 require Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
1009 .nem
1010 .nextp
1011 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
1012 the form of the $it{system filter} (see chapter ~~CHAPsystemfilter). This runs
1013 at the start of every delivery process.
1014 .endp
1015
1016 .section User filters
1017 .index filter||introduction
1018 .index Sieve filter
1019 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
1020 setting up appropriate \(.forward)\ files in their home directories. See
1021 chapter ~~CHAPredirect (about the \%redirect%\ router) for the configuration
1022 needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
1023 .if ~~html
1024 [(A HREF="filter_toc.html")]
1025 .fi
1026 \*Exim's interfaces to mail filtering*\
1027 .if ~~html
1028 [(/A)]
1029 .fi
1030 for user details. Two different kinds of filtering are available:
1031 .numberpars $.
1032 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined by
1033 RFC 3028.
1034 .nextp
1035 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
1036 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
1037 .endp
1038 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
1039
1040
1041 .section Message identification
1042 .rset SECTmessiden "~~chapter.~~section"
1043 .index message||ids, details of format
1044 .index format||of message id
1045 .index id of message
1046 .index base62
1047 .index base36
1048 .index Darwin
1049 .index Cygwin
1050 Every message handled by Exim is given a \*message id*\ which is sixteen
1051 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
1052 example \"16VDhn-0001bo-D3"\. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
1053 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
1054 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
1055 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
1056 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
1057 not case-sensitive.
1058
1059 .index pid (process id)||re-use of
1060 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
1061 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
1062 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
1063 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
1064 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
1065 somewhat eccentric:
1066 .numberpars $.
1067 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1068 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1069 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1070 way of representing the date and time of day).
1071 .nextp
1072 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1073 received the message.
1074 .nextp
1075 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1076 .numberpars alpha
1077 .index \localhost@_number\
1078 If \localhost@_number\ is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1079 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1080 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1081 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1082 .nextp
1083 If \localhost@_number\ is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1084 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1085 (1/100) of a second.
1086 .endp
1087 .endp
1088 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1089 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1090 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1091 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1092 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1093
1094 .section Receiving mail
1095 .index receiving mail
1096 .index message||reception
1097 The only way Exim can receive mail from a remote host is using SMTP over
1098 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are tranferred using
1099 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1100 there are several possibilities:
1101 .numberpars $.
1102 If the process runs Exim with the \-bm-\ option, the message is read
1103 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1104 command line, or from the body of the message if \-t-\ is also used.
1105 .nextp
1106 If the process runs Exim with the \-bS-\ option, the message is also read
1107 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1108 the message in a series of SMTP \\RCPT\\ commands, terminated by a \\DATA\\
1109 command. This is so-called `batch SMTP' format,
1110 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1111 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1112 .nextp
1113 If the process runs Exim with the \-bs-\ option, the message is read
1114 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1115 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1116 This is `real' SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1117 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1118 .nextp
1119 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1120 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1121 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1122 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1123 .endp
1124
1125 .index message||sender, constructed by Exim
1126 .index sender||constructed by Exim
1127 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1128 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1129 qualification domain (which can be set by the \qualify@_domain\ configuration
1130 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1131 SMTP \\MAIL\\ command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1132 certain users (`trusted users') to specify a different sender address
1133 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1134 address. The \-f-\ option or the SMTP \\MAIL\\ command is used to specify these
1135 different addresses. See section ~~SECTtrustedadmin for details of trusted
1136 users, and the \untrusted@_set@_sender\ option for a way of allowing untrusted
1137 users to change sender addresses.
1138
1139 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1140 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1141 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1142 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1143 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1144 requirements are not met. The \*local@_scan()*\ function (see chapter
1145 ~~CHAPlocalscan) is run for all incoming messages.
1146
1147 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1148 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1149 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1150 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1151 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1152 message is received.
1153
1154
1155
1156
1157 .section Handling an incoming message
1158 .index spool directory||files that hold a message
1159 .index file||how a message is held
1160 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1161 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message,
1162 and the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The
1163 names of the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by $tt{-H} for
1164 the file containing the envelope and header, and $tt{-D} for the data file.
1165
1166 .index spool directory||\(input)\ sub-directory
1167 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1168 \(input)\ inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1169 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets very large; to
1170 improve performance in such cases, the \split@_spool@_directory\ option can be
1171 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1172 whose names are single letters or digits.
1173
1174 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1175 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1176 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1177 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1178 first spool file is described in chapter ~~CHAPspool.
1179
1180 .index rewriting||addresses
1181 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1182 (see chapter ~~CHAPrewrite) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1183 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1184 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1185 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1186 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1187 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1188 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1189 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1190 delivered (see chapters ~~CHAProutergeneric and ~~CHAPtransportgeneric).
1191
1192
1193 .section Life of a message
1194 .index message||life of
1195 .index message||frozen
1196 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1197 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1198 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1199 cannot proceed -- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1200 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked `frozen' on the
1201 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1202
1203 .index frozen messages||thawing
1204 .index message||thawing frozen
1205 An administrator can `thaw' such messages when the problem has been corrected,
1206 and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In addition, an
1207 administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message to be sent.
1208
1209 .index \auto@_thaw\
1210 There is an option called \auto@_thaw\, which can be used to cause Exim to
1211 retry frozen messages after a certain time. When this is set, no message will
1212 remain on the queue for ever, because the delivery timeout will eventually be
1213 reached. Delivery failure reports (bounce messages) that reach this timeout are
1214 discarded.
1215 .index \timeout@_frozen@_after\
1216 There is also an option called \timeout@_frozen@_after\, which discards frozen
1217 messages after a certain time.
1218
1219 .index message||log file for
1220 .index log||file for each message
1221 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1222 attempt to the main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1223 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter ~~CHAPlog). The log lines
1224 are also written to a separate $it{message log} file for each message. These
1225 logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally deleted
1226 along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1227 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1228 \no@_message@_logs\; this might give an improvement in performance on very
1229 busy systems.
1230
1231 .index journal file
1232 .index file||journal
1233 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1234 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1235 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1236 message id followed by $tt{-J}. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1237 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the $tt{-H} file)
1238 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1239 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1240 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1241
1242 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1243 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1244 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1245 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1246 deliveries caused by crashes.
1247
1248
1249 .section Processing an address for delivery
1250 .rset SECTprocaddress "~~chapter.~~section"
1251 .index drivers||definition of
1252 .index router||definition of
1253 .index transport||definition of
1254 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called $it{routers} and
1255 $it{transports}, and collectively these are known as $it{drivers}. Code for a
1256 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1257 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1258 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1259
1260 .index drivers||instance definition
1261 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an \*instance*\
1262 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1263 you can set up several different \%smtp%\ transports, each with different
1264 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1265 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1266 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1267 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1268 the driver's features in general.
1269
1270 A $it{router} is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1271 its delivery should happen, by routing it to a specific transport, or
1272 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1273 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1274 to be bounced.
1275
1276 A $it{transport} is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1277 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a $it{local}
1278 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1279 $it{remote} transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1280 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1281 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1282
1283 .index preconditions||definition of
1284 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1285 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1286 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1287 detail shortly. As a simple example, the diagram below illustrates how each
1288 recipient address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three
1289 routers that are configured in various ways.
1290
1291 .if ~~sys.fancy
1292 .figure "Routing an address" rm
1293 .indent 0
1294 .call aspic -sgcal -nv
1295 centre ~~sys.linelength;
1296 magnify 0.8;
1297 boundingbox 30;
1298 ibox depth 14 "address";
1299 B: arrow down 44;
1300 textdepth 14;
1301 A: box width 100 "first router" "conditions ok?";
1302 arrow right "yes";
1303 C: box width 100 "run" "first router";
1304 arrow down "fail";
1305 D: ibox depth 20 "address bounces";
1306
1307 arc clockwise from right of C "accept";
1308 arrow down 10;
1309 ibox "queue for" "transport";
1310
1311 arrow down from A align bottom of D plus (0,-20) "no"(-6,20)/r;
1312 E: box width 100 "second router" "conditions ok?";
1313 arrow right "yes";
1314 F: box width 100 "run" "second router";
1315 line right 100 "redirect";
1316 line up align middle of B;
1317 arrow left to middle of B "new addresses";
1318
1319 line down 20 from bottom left of F plus (30,0);
1320 arrow left align centre of E "decline";
1321
1322 line down 20 from bottom right of F plus (-30,0);
1323 arrow right "fail";
1324 ibox width 64 "address" "bounces";
1325
1326 arrow down 64 from E "no"(-6,20)/r;
1327 G: box width 100 "third router" "conditions ok?";
1328 arrow right "yes";
1329 H: box width 100 "run" "third router";
1330 arc clockwise from right of H "accept";
1331 arrow down 10;
1332 ibox "queue for" "transport";
1333
1334 line down 20 from bottom of H;
1335 arrow left align centre of G "decline";
1336 arrow down 64 from G "no"(-6,20)/r;
1337
1338 ibox "no more routers" "address bounces";
1339 .endcall
1340 .endfigure
1341 .elif !~~html
1342 .display asis
1343
1344 address
1345 |
1346 |<------------- new addresses -----------------------------
1347 V |
1348 ----------------- ----------------- |
1349 | first router |----- yes ----->| run |--- accept |
1350 | conditions ok?| | first router | | |
1351 ----------------- ----------------- | |
1352 | | V |
1353 no | fail | queue for |
1354 | V transport |
1355 | address bounces |
1356 | |
1357 V |
1358 ----------------- ----------------- |
1359 | second router |----- yes ----->| run |----redirect ----
1360 | conditions ok?| | second router |
1361 ----------------- -----------------
1362 | | |
1363 no | | |
1364 |<-------- decline ----------- --- fail ---> address
1365 | bounces
1366 V
1367 ----------------- -----------------
1368 | third router |----- yes ----->| run |--- accept
1369 | conditions ok?| | third router | |
1370 ----------------- ----------------- |
1371 | | V
1372 no | | queue for
1373 |<-------- decline --------------- transport
1374 |
1375 V
1376 no more routers
1377 address bounces
1378 .endd
1379 .else
1380 [(img src="routing.gif" alt="Routing an address")][(br)]
1381 .fi
1382 To make this a more concrete example, we'll describe it in terms of some actual
1383 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1384 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1385 configuration.
1386
1387 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1388 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1389 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1390 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1391 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do $it{not}
1392 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1393 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1394 queued for a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1395 configured to fail the address.
1396
1397 The example pictured could be a configuration of this type. The second and
1398 third routers can only be run for addresses for which the preconditions for
1399 the first router are not met. If one of these preconditions checks the
1400 domain, the second and third routers are run only for domains that are somehow
1401 special to the local host.
1402
1403 The second router does redirection -- also known as aliasing and forwarding.
1404 When it generates one or more new addresses from the original, each of them is
1405 routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the router may cause an address
1406 to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the address, in which case the
1407 address is passed to the next router.
1408
1409 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1410 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1411 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1412 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1413 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1414 the address is bounced.
1415
1416
1417 .section Processing an address for verification
1418 .index router||for verification
1419 .index verifying||address, overview
1420 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1421 are also used for \*address verification*\. Verification can be requested as
1422 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1423 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the \-bv-\ and
1424 \-bvs-\ command line options.
1425
1426 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in `verify mode'. This
1427 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1428 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1429 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1430 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1431 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1432 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the \no@_verify\ option
1433 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1434
1435
1436
1437 .section Running an individual router
1438 .rset SECTrunindrou "~~chapter.~~section"
1439 .index router||running details
1440 .index preconditions||checking
1441 .index router||result of running
1442 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1443 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1444 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router $it{are} met,
1445 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1446 the following:
1447 .numberpars $.
1448 \*accept*\: The router accepts the address, and either queues it for a
1449 transport, or generates one or more `child' addresses. Processing the original
1450 address ceases,
1451 .index \unseen\ option
1452 unless the \unseen\ option is set on the router. This option
1453 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1454 for keeping archive copies of messages). When \unseen\ is set, the address is
1455 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an \*accept*\ return marks the
1456 end of routing.
1457
1458 .index case of local parts
1459 .index address||duplicate, discarding
1460 If child addresses are generated, Exim checks to see whether they are
1461 duplicates of any existing recipient addresses. During this check, local parts
1462 are treated as case-sensitive. Duplicate addresses are discarded. Each of the
1463 remaining child addresses is then processed independently, starting with the
1464 first router by default. It is possible to change this by setting the
1465 \redirect@_router\ option to specify which router to start at for child
1466 addresses. Unlike \pass@_router\ (see below) the router specified by
1467 \redirect@_router\ may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1468 .nextp
1469 \*pass*\: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1470 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1471 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1472 \pass@_router\ option. However, (unlike \redirect@_router\) the named router
1473 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1474 .nextp
1475 \*decline*\: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1476 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1477 this can be prevented by setting the \no@_more\ option. When \no@_more\ is set,
1478 all the remaining routers are skipped.
1479 .nextp
1480 \*fail*\: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1481 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1482 original address unless \unseen\ is set on the router.
1483 .nextp
1484 \*defer*\: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A database
1485 may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further processing of
1486 the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again next time the
1487 message is considered for delivery.
1488 .nextp
1489 \*error*\: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1490 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1491 .endp
1492 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1493 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable.
1494 The default error message in this situation is `unrouteable address', but you
1495 can set your own message by making use of the \cannot@_route@_message\ option.
1496 This can be set for any router; the value from the last router that `saw'
1497 the address is used.
1498
1499 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1500 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1501 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1502 when the relevant conditions are met. The \%redirect%\ router has a `fail'
1503 facility for this purpose.
1504
1505
1506
1507 .section Router preconditions
1508 .rset SECTrouprecon "~~chapter.~~section"
1509 .index router||preconditions, order of processing
1510 .index preconditions||order of processing
1511 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1512 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1513 described in more detail in chapter ~~CHAProutergeneric.
1514 .numberpars $.
1515 The \local@_part@_prefix\ and \local@_part@_suffix\ options can specify that
1516 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1517 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1518 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1519 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1520 of any other conditions.
1521 .nextp
1522 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1523 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1524 \verify\ option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1525 address.
1526 Setting the \verify\ option actually sets two options, \verify@_sender\ and
1527 \verify@_recipient\, which independently control the use of the router for
1528 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1529 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1530 .nextp
1531 If the \address@_test\ option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1532 run with the \-bt-\ option to test an address routing. This can be helpful when
1533 the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it makes it
1534 possible to use \-bt-\ to test subsequent delivery routing without having to
1535 simulate the effect of the scanner.
1536 .nextp
1537 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1538 opposed to routing it for delivery. The \verify@_only\ option controls this.
1539 .nextp
1540 Certain routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to check an
1541 address given in the SMTP \\EXPN\\ command (see the \expn\ option).
1542 .nextp
1543 If the \domains\ option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set of
1544 domains that it defines.
1545 .nextp
1546 If the \local@_parts\ option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1547 the set of local parts that it defines. If \local@_part@_prefix\ or
1548 \local@_part@_suffix\ is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1549 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1550 that include affixes, you can do so by using a \condition\ option (see below)
1551 that uses the variables \$local@_part$\, \$local@_part@_prefix$\, and
1552 \$local@_part@_suffix$\ as necessary.
1553 .nextp
1554 If the \check@_local@_user\ option is set, the local part must be the name of
1555 an account on the local host.
1556 If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the local user are placed in
1557 \$local@_user@_uid$\ and \$local@_user@_gid$\; these values can be used in the
1558 remaining preconditions.
1559 .nextp
1560 If the \router@_home@_directory\ option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1561 because it overrides the value of \$home$\. If this expansion were left till
1562 later, the value of \$home$\ as set by \check@_local@_user\ would be used in
1563 subsequent tests. Having two different values of \$home$\ in the same router
1564 could lead to confusion.
1565 .nextp
1566 If the \senders\ option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the set
1567 of addresses that it defines.
1568 .nextp
1569 If the \require@_files\ option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1570 specified files is tested.
1571 .nextp
1572 .index customizing||precondition
1573 If the \condition\ option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option uses
1574 an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1575 Expanded strings are described in chapter ~~CHAPexpand.
1576 .endp
1577
1578 Note that \require@_files\ comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use it
1579 to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1580 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1581 \exists\ expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1582 \require@_files\ option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1583 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1584 example, \(.procmailrc)\).
1585
1586
1587 .section Delivery in detail
1588 .index delivery||in detail
1589 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1590 .numberpars $.
1591 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1592 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1593 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1594 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1595 files, described in the separate document entitled
1596 .if ~~html
1597 [(A HREF="filter.html")]
1598 .fi
1599 \*Exim's interfaces to mail filtering*\.
1600 .if ~~html
1601 [(/A)]
1602 .fi
1603 .index Sieve filter||not available for system filter
1604 (\**Note**\: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1605 Some additional features are available in system filters -- see chapter
1606 ~~CHAPsystemfilter for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1607 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1608 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1609 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1610 condition \first@_delivery\ can be used to detect the first run of the system
1611 filter.
1612 .nextp
1613 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1614 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle
1615 the address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because
1616 routers can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains
1617 can be processed entirely independently of each other.
1618 .nextp
1619 .index routing||loops in
1620 .index loop||while routing
1621 A router that accepts an address may set up a local or a remote transport for
1622 it. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address is
1623 placed on a list for the particular transport, to be run later. Alternatively,
1624 the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically from alias,
1625 forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this process from
1626 the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address which has an
1627 identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1628 .nextp
1629 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1630 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1631 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1632 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1633 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1634 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1635 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1636 addresses to the same domain.
1637 .nextp
1638 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1639 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1640 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1641 to Exim (`the Exim user'), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1642 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1643 one message is set by the \remote@_max@_parallel\ option.
1644 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1645 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1646 .nextp
1647 .index queue runner
1648 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1649 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1650 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1651 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1652 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1653 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1654 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1655 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1656 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1657 .nextp
1658 .index delivery||retry in remote transports
1659 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1660 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1661 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1662 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1663 not. See chapter ~~CHAPretry for details of retry strategies.
1664 .nextp
1665 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1666 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1667 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1668 messages to other addresses.
1669 .nextp
1670 .index delivery||deferral
1671 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1672 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1673 \*deferred*\.
1674 .nextp
1675 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1676 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1677 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1678 .endp
1679
1680
1681 .section Retry mechanism
1682 .index delivery||retry mechanism
1683 .index retry||description of mechanism
1684 .index queue runner
1685 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1686 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1687 uses the \-q-\ option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1688 intervals, or use some other means (such as \*cron*\) to start them. If you do
1689 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1690 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1691 it way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1692 passed its retry time.
1693 You can run several queue runners at once.
1694
1695 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1696 address (see chapter ~~CHAPretry). These rules also specify when Exim should
1697 give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a bounce
1698 message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and error
1699 combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated as
1700 permanent.
1701
1702
1703 .section Temporary delivery failure
1704 .index delivery||temporary failure
1705 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1706 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1707 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1708 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1709 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1710 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1711 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1712 also apply.
1713
1714 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1715 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1716 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1717 deferred,
1718 .index hints database
1719 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1720 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1721 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1722 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1723 one connection.
1724
1725
1726
1727 .section Permanent delivery failure
1728 .index delivery||permanent failure
1729 .index bounce message||when generated
1730 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1731 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1732 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1733 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1734 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1735 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1736 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1737 See chapter ~~CHAPemsgcust for details.
1738
1739 .index ::X-Failed-Recipients:: header line
1740 Bounce messages contain an ::X-Failed-Recipients:: header line that lists the
1741 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1742 automatically.
1743
1744 .index bounce message||recipient of
1745 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1746 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1747 address given in the \\MAIL\\ command. However, when an address is
1748 expanded via a forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified
1749 for delivery failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion
1750 (see section ~~SECTmailinglists) it is common to direct bounce messages to the
1751 manager of the list.
1752
1753
1754
1755 .section Failures to deliver bounce messages
1756 .index bounce message||failure to deliver
1757 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1758 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1759 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1760 which can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1761 for only a short time (see \timeout@_frozen@_after\ and
1762 \ignore@_bounce@_errors@_after\).
1763
1764
1765
1766 .
1767 .
1768 .
1769 .
1770 . ============================================================================
1771 .chapter Building and installing Exim
1772 .set runningfoot "building/installing"
1773
1774 .index building Exim
1775 .section Unpacking
1776 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when upacked,
1777 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1778 \(exim-~~version)\) into which the following files are placed:
1779 .display rm
1780 .if !~~sys.fancy && ~~sgcal
1781 .tabs 16
1782 .else
1783 .tabs 22
1784 .fi
1785 \(ACKNOWLEDGMENTS)\ $t contains some acknowledgments
1786 .newline
1787 \(CHANGES)\ $t contains a reference to where changes are documented
1788 \(LICENCE)\ $t the GNU General Public Licence
1789 \(Makefile)\ $t top-level make file
1790 \(NOTICE)\ $t conditions for the use of Exim
1791 \(README)\ $t list of files, directories and simple build instructions
1792 .endd
1793 Other files whose names begin with \(README)\ may also be present. The
1794 following subdirectories are created:
1795 .display rm
1796 .if !~~sys.fancy && ~~sgcal
1797 .tabs 16
1798 .else
1799 .tabs 22
1800 .fi
1801 \(Local)\ $t an empty directory for local configuration files
1802 \(OS)\ $t OS-specific files
1803 \(doc)\ $t documentation files
1804 \(exim@_monitor)\$t source files for the Exim monitor
1805 \(scripts)\ $t scripts used in the build process
1806 \(src)\ $t remaining source files
1807 \(util)\ $t independent utilities
1808 .endd
1809 The main utility programs are contained in the \(src)\ directory, and are built
1810 with the Exim binary. The \(util)\ directory contains a few optional scripts
1811 that may be useful to some sites.
1812
1813 .section Multiple machine architectures and operating systems
1814 .index building Exim||multiple OS/architectures
1815 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1816 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1817 source files. Compilation does not take place in the \(src)\ directory. Instead,
1818 a \*build directory*\ is created for each architecture and operating system.
1819 .index symbolic link||to build directory
1820 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1821 the actual building takes place.
1822
1823 In most cases, Exim can discover the machine architecture and operating system
1824 for itself, but the defaults can be overridden if necessary.
1825
1826 .section DBM libraries
1827 .rset SECTdb "~~chapter.~~section"
1828 .index DBM||libraries, discussion of
1829 .index hints database||DBM files used for
1830 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1831 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1832 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1833 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1834
1835 .index Solaris||DBM library for
1836 .index IRIX, DBM library for
1837 .index BSD, DBM library for
1838 .index Linux, DBM library for
1839 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1840 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1841 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1842 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1843
1844 .index \*ndbm*\ DBM library
1845 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1846 via the \*ndbm*\ interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1847 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1848 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1849 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1850 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardised on the
1851 Berkeley DB library.
1852
1853 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1854 use. When a program opens a file called \(dbmfile)\, there are four
1855 possibilities:
1856 .numberpars
1857 A traditional \*ndbm*\ implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1858 Solaris, operates on two files called \(dbmfile.dir)\ and \(dbmfile.pag)\.
1859 .nextp
1860 .index \*gdbm*\ DBM library
1861 The GNU library, \*gdbm*\, operates on a single file. If used via its \*ndbm*\
1862 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1863 \(dbmfile.dir)\ and \(dbmfile.pag)\, but if used via its native interface, the
1864 file name is used unmodified.
1865 .nextp
1866 .index Berkeley DB library
1867 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its \*ndbm*\ compatibility interface,
1868 operates on a single file called \(dbmfile.db)\, but otherwise looks to the
1869 programmer exactly the same as the traditional \*ndbm*\ implementation.
1870 .nextp
1871 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1872 file called \(dbmfile)\; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1873 the traditional \*ndbm*\ interface.
1874 .nextp
1875 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1876 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1877 2.$it{x} and 3.$it{x} were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1878 numbered 4.$it{x}. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1879 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1880 .display rm
1881 \?http://www.sleepycat.com/?\
1882 .endd
1883 .nextp
1884 .index \*tdb*\ DBM library
1885 Yet another DBM library, called \*tdb*\, has become available from
1886 .display rm
1887 \?http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb?\
1888 .endd
1889 It has its own interface, and also operates on a single file.
1890 .endp
1891 .index \\USE@_DB\\
1892 .index DBM||libraries, configuration for building
1893 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1894 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1895 \\USE@_DB\\ in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1896 \(Local/Makefile)\). For example:
1897 .display asis
1898 USE_DB=yes
1899 .endd
1900 Similarly, for gdbm you set \\USE@_GDBM\\, and for tdb you set \\USE@_TDB\\. An
1901 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1902
1903 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1904 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1905 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1906 Linux) assume type (4) by setting \\USE@_DB\\ as their default, and the
1907 configuration files for Cygwin set \\USE@_GDBM\\. Anything you set in
1908 \(Local/Makefile)\, however, overrides these system defaults.
1909
1910 As well as setting \\USE@_DB\\, \\USE@_GDBM\\, or \\USE@_TDB\\, it may also be
1911 necessary to set \\DBMLIB\\, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1912 in one of these lines:
1913 .display asis
1914 DBMLIB = -ldb
1915 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1916 .endd
1917 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1918 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1919 the default path. You may need to set \\INCLUDE\\ to specify where the header
1920 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in \\DBMLIB\\, as in
1921 this example:
1922 .display asis
1923 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1924 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1925 .endd
1926
1927 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1928 file \(doc/dbm.discuss.txt)\ in the Exim distribution.
1929
1930
1931 .section Pre-building configuration
1932 .index building Exim||pre-building configuration
1933 .index configuration for building Exim
1934 .index \(Local/Makefile)\
1935 .index \(src/EDITME)\
1936 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1937 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1938 \(Local/Makefile)\. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1939 \(src/EDITME)\, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1940 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1941 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1942 \(src/EDITME)\ to \(Local/Makefile)\, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1943
1944 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1945 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1946 (\\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1947 (\\BIN@_DIRECTORY\\), and the identity of the Exim user (\\EXIM@_USER\\ and
1948 maybe \\EXIM@_GROUP\\ as well). The value of \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ can in fact be
1949 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1950
1951 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1952 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1953 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1954 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1955 you specify them in \(Local/Makefile)\ instead of at run time, so that errors
1956 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1957 be logged.
1958
1959 .index content scanning||specifying at build time
1960 .em
1961 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning sofware directly from
1962 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1963 facilities, you need to set
1964 .display asis
1965 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1966 .endd
1967 in your \(Local/Makefile)\. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1968 chapter ~~CHAPexiscan.
1969 .nem
1970
1971 .index \(Local/eximon.conf)\
1972 .index \(exim@_monitor/EDITME)\
1973 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1974 required. The file \(exim@_monitor/EDITME)\ must be edited appropriately for
1975 your installation and saved under the name \(Local/eximon.conf)\. If you are
1976 happy with the default settings described in \(exim@_monitor/EDITME)\,
1977 \(Local/eximon.conf)\ can be empty, but it must exist.
1978
1979 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1980 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1981 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1982 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1983 defaults to \gcc\. See section ~~SECToverride below for details of how to do
1984 this.
1985
1986
1987 .section Support for iconv()
1988 .index \*iconv()*\ support
1989 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1990 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1991 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1992 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the \@$h@_\
1993 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1994 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1995 supports the \*iconv()*\ function.
1996
1997 However, some of the operating systems that supply \*iconv()*\ do not support
1998 very many conversions. The GNU \libiconv\ library (available from
1999 \?http:/@/www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/?\) can be installed on such systems to
2000 remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply \*iconv()*\ at
2001 all. After installing \libiconv\, you should add
2002 .display asis
2003 HAVE_ICONV=yes
2004 .endd
2005 to your \(Local/Makefile)\ and rebuild Exim.
2006
2007
2008 .section Including TLS/SSL encryption support
2009 .rset SECTinctlsssl "~~chapter.~~section"
2010 .index TLS||including support for TLS
2011 .index encryption||including support for
2012 .index \\SUPPORT@_TLS\\
2013 .index OpenSSL||building Exim with
2014 .index GnuTLS||building Exim with
2015 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the \\STARTTLS\\
2016 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
2017 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
2018 \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ runtime option and the \-tls-on-connect-\ command
2019 line option).
2020
2021 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
2022 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
2023 implementing SSL.
2024
2025 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
2026 .display asis
2027 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
2028 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
2029 .endd
2030 in \(Local/Makefile)\. You may also need to specify the locations of the
2031 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
2032 .display asis
2033 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
2034 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
2035 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
2036 .endd
2037
2038 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
2039 .index \\USE@_GNUTLS\\
2040 .display asis
2041 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
2042 USE_GNUTLS=yes
2043 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
2044 .endd
2045 in \(Local/Makefile)\, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
2046 library and include files. For example:
2047 .display asis
2048 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
2049 USE_GNUTLS=yes
2050 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
2051 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
2052 .endd
2053 You do not need to set \\TLS@_INCLUDE\\ if the relevant directory is already
2054 specified in \\INCLUDE\\. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS
2055 are given in chapter ~~CHAPTLS.
2056
2057
2058
2059 .section Use of tcpwrappers
2060 .index tcpwrappers, building Exim to support
2061 .index \\USE@_TCP@_WRAPPERS\\
2062 Exim can be linked with the \*tcpwrappers*\ library in order to check incoming
2063 SMTP calls using the \*tcpwrappers*\ control files. This may be a convenient
2064 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
2065 already making use of \*tcpwrappers*\ for other purposes. To do this, you should
2066 set \\USE@_TCP@_WRAPPERS\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\, arrange for the file
2067 \(tcpd.h)\ to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
2068 \(libwrap.a)\ is available at link time, typically by including \-lwrap-\ in
2069 \\EXTRALIBS@_EXIM\\. For example, if \*tcpwrappers*\ is installed in
2070 \(/usr/local)\, you might have
2071 .display
2072 USE@_TCP@_WRAPPERS=yes
2073 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
2074 .newline
2075 EXTRALIBS@_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
2076 .endd
2077 in \(Local/Makefile)\. The name to use in the \*tcpwrappers*\ control files is
2078 `exim'. For example, the line
2079 .display
2080 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
2081 .endd
2082 in your \(/etc/hosts.allow)\ file allows connections from the local host, from
2083 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in \*friendly.domain.example*\.
2084 All other connections are denied. Consult the \*tcpwrappers*\ documentation for
2085 further details.
2086
2087
2088 .section Including support for IPv6
2089 .index IPv6||including support for
2090 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
2091 \\HAVE@_IPV6=YES\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ causes the IPv6 code to be included;
2092 it may also be necessary to set \\IPV6@_INCLUDE\\ and \\IPV6@_LIBS\\ on systems
2093 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
2094 library files.
2095
2096 .em
2097 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2098 defined. AAAA records (analagous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2099 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2100 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to
2101 be over-complex, and its status was reduced to `experimental'. It is not known
2102 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
2103 this is included only if you set \\SUPPORT@_A6=YES\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\. The
2104 support has not been tested for some time.
2105 .nem
2106
2107 .section The building process
2108 .index build directory
2109 Once \(Local/Makefile)\ (and \(Local/eximon.conf)\, if required) have been
2110 created, run \*make*\ at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2111 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2112 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2113 \(build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc)\ is created.
2114 .index symbolic link||to source files
2115 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2116
2117 \**Warning**\: The \-j-\ (parallel) flag must not be used with \*make*\; the
2118 building process fails if it is set.
2119
2120 If this is the first time \*make*\ has been run, it calls a script that builds
2121 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2122 \(Local)\ directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2123 \*make*\. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2124 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2125 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command \*make
2126 makefile*\ can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2127 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2128
2129 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2130 \(README)\ file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2131 .if ~~html
2132 [(A HREF="FAQ.html")]
2133 .fi
2134 FAQ,
2135 .if ~~html
2136 [(/A)]
2137 .fi
2138 where some common problems are covered.
2139
2140
2141
2142 .section Overriding build-time options for Exim
2143 .index build-time options, overriding
2144 .rset SECToverride "~~chapter.~~section"
2145 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2146 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2147 values, followed by a fixed set of \*make*\ instructions. If a value is set
2148 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2149 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2150 order:
2151 .display rm
2152 \(OS/Makefile-Default)\
2153 \(OS/Makefile-)\<<ostype>>
2154 \(Local/Makefile)\
2155 \(Local/Makefile-)\<<ostype>>
2156 \(Local/Makefile-)\<<archtype>>
2157 \(Local/Makefile-)\<<ostype>>-<<archtype>>
2158 \(OS/Makefile-Base)\
2159 .endd
2160 .index \(Local/Makefile)\
2161 where <<ostype>> is the operating system type and <<archtype>> is the
2162 .index building Exim||operating system type
2163 .index building Exim||architecture type
2164 architecture type. \(Local/Makefile)\ is required to exist, and the building
2165 process fails if it is absent. The other three \(Local)\ files are optional,
2166 and are often not needed.
2167
2168 The values used for <<ostype>> and <<archtype>> are obtained from scripts
2169 called \(scripts/os-type)\ and \(scripts/arch-type)\ respectively. If either of
2170 the environment variables \\EXIM@_OSTYPE\\ or \\EXIM@_ARCHTYPE\\ is set, their
2171 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2172 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the \uname\ command. If this
2173 fails, the shell variables \\OSTYPE\\ and \\ARCHTYPE\\ are inspected. A number
2174 of $it{ad hoc} transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2175 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2176 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2177
2178
2179 \(OS/Makefile-Default)\ contains comments about the variables that are set
2180 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2181 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2182 file for your operating system (\(OS/Makefile-<<ostype>>)\) to see what the
2183 default values are.
2184
2185
2186 .index building Exim||overriding default settings
2187 If you need to change any of the values that are set in \(OS/Makefile-Default)\
2188 or in \(OS/Makefile-<<ostype>>)\, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2189 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2190 putting the new values in an appropriate \(Local)\ file. For example,
2191 .index Tru64-Unix build-time settings
2192 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2193 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2194 compiler is called \*cc*\ rather than \*gcc*\. Also, the compiler must be
2195 called with the option \-std1-\, to make it recognize some of the features of
2196 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2197 default.) To do this, you should create a file called \(Local/Makefile-OSF1)\
2198 containing the lines
2199 .display
2200 CC=cc
2201 CFLAGS=-std1
2202 .endd
2203 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2204 these lines directly into \(Local/Makefile)\.
2205
2206 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2207 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2208 the contents of the \(Local)\ directory.
2209
2210
2211 .index NIS lookup type||including support for
2212 .index NIS@+ lookup type||including support for
2213 .index LDAP||including support for
2214 .index lookup||inclusion in binary
2215 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2216 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2217 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2218 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2219 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2220 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for \(Local/Makefile)\ are:
2221 .display asis
2222 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2223 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2224 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2225 .endd
2226 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2227 \(src/EDITME)\. In most cases the relevant include files and interface
2228 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2229 .index cdb||including support for
2230 However, in the case of cdb, which is included in the binary only if
2231 .display asis
2232 LOOKUP_CDB=yes
2233 .endd
2234 is set, the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2235 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2236 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2237 errors.
2238
2239 .index Perl||including support for
2240 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2241 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2242 .display asis
2243 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2244 .endd
2245 must be defined in \(Local/Makefile)\. Details of this facility are given in
2246 chapter ~~CHAPperl.
2247
2248 .index X11 libraries, location of
2249 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2250 operating systems, and of course there are different versions of X11 to cope
2251 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2252 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2253 The following three variables are set in \(OS/Makefile-Default)\:
2254 .display asis
2255 X11=/usr/X11R6
2256 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2257 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2258 .endd
2259 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2260 example, in \(OS/Makefile-SunOS5)\ there is
2261 .display asis
2262 X11=/usr/openwin
2263 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2264 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2265 .endd
2266 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2267 definition of all three of these variables into your
2268 \(Local/Makefile-<<ostype>>)\ file.
2269
2270 .index \\EXTRALIBS\\
2271 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2272 variable called \\EXTRALIBS\\, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2273 default is not defined. In contrast, \\EXTRALIBS@_EXIM\\ is used only on the
2274 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2275 .index DBM||libraries, configuration for building
2276 There is also \\DBMLIB\\, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2277 use DBM functions (see also section ~~SECTdb). Finally, there is
2278 \\EXTRALIBS@_EXIMON\\, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2279 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2280 libraries.
2281
2282 .index configuration file||editing
2283 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2284 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2285 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is, \(Local/Makefile)\
2286 or \(Local/eximon.conf)\) before rebuilding.
2287
2288 .section OS-specific header files
2289 .index \(os.h)\
2290 .index building Exim||OS-specific C header files
2291 The \(OS)\ directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2292 \(os.h-<<ostype>>)\. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2293 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2294 recognized in the file \(OS/os.configuring)\, which should be consulted if you
2295 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2296
2297
2298 .section Overriding build-time options for the monitor
2299 .index building Eximon||overriding default options
2300 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2301 where the files that are involved are
2302 .display rm
2303 \(OS/eximon.conf-Default)\
2304 \(OS/eximon.conf-)\<<ostype>>
2305 \(Local/eximon.conf)\
2306 \(Local/eximon.conf-)\<<ostype>>
2307 \(Local/eximon.conf-)\<<archtype>>
2308 \(Local/eximon.conf-)\<<ostype>>-<<archtype>>
2309 .endd
2310 .index \(Local/eximon.conf)\
2311 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2312 \(OS/eximon.conf-<<ostype>>)\ file is also optional. The default values in
2313 \(OS/eximon.conf-Default)\ can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2314 variables of the same name, preceded by \\EXIMON@_\\. For example, setting
2315 \\EXIMON@_LOG@_DEPTH\\ in the environment overrides the value of
2316 \\LOG@_DEPTH\\ at run time.
2317
2318
2319
2320 .section Installing Exim binaries and scripts
2321 .index installing Exim
2322 .index \\BIN@_DIRECTORY\\
2323 The command \*make install*\ runs the \*exim@_install*\ script with no
2324 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2325 whose name is specified by the \\BIN@_DIRECTORY\\ setting in
2326 \(Local/Makefile)\.
2327
2328 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ setting
2329 .index \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\
2330 in \(Local/Makefile)\. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2331 exist, the default configuration file \(src/configure.default)\ is copied there
2332 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2333 is left alone. If \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ is a colon-separated list, naming several
2334 alternative files, no default is installed.
2335
2336 .index system aliases file
2337 .index \(/etc/aliases)\
2338 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2339 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2340 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2341 \\SYSTEM@_ALIASES@_FILE\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ (\(/etc/aliases)\ by default).
2342 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2343 and outputs a comment to the user.
2344
2345 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2346 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2347 kept in \(/etc/aliases)\. However, some operating systems are now using
2348 \(/etc/mail/aliases)\. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2349 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2350
2351 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2352 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory \(/var/mail)\,
2353 running as the local user. System aliases and \(.forward)\ files in users' home
2354 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2355 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2356 over SMTP.
2357
2358 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2359 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2360 \*setuid*\ bit set,
2361 .index setuid||installing Exim with
2362 for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run \*make install*\ as root so
2363 that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in some special
2364 situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries) it may be
2365 possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see chapter
2366 ~~CHAPsecurity for details).
2367
2368 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2369 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2370 command such as
2371 .display asis
2372 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2373 .endd
2374 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2375 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2376 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name \*is*\ modified.)
2377 For backwards compatibility, \\ROOT\\ is used if \\DESTDIR\\ is not set,
2378 but this usage is deprecated.
2379
2380 .index installing Exim||what is not installed
2381 Running \*make install*\ does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2382 \*convert4r4*\, or the \*pcretest*\ test program. You will probably run the
2383 first of these only once (if you are upgrading from Exim 3), and the second
2384 isn't really part of Exim. None of the documentation files in the \(doc)\
2385 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2386 \\INFO@_DIRECTORY\\, as described in section ~~SECTinsinfdoc below.
2387
2388 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix \(.O)\
2389 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2390 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2391 for example \(exim-~~version-1)\. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2392 called \(exim)\ to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2393 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name \(exim)\ is never absent
2394 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2395
2396 .index installing Exim||testing the script
2397 If you want to see what the \*make install*\ will do before running it for
2398 real, you can pass the \-n-\ option to the installation script by this command:
2399 .display asis
2400 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2401 .endd
2402 The contents of the variable \\INSTALL@_ARG\\ are passed to the installation
2403 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2404 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2405 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2406 command:
2407 .display
2408 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim@_install -n)
2409 .endd
2410
2411 .index installing Exim||install script options
2412 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2413 .numberpars $.
2414 \-no@_chown-\ bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2415 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2416 .nextp
2417 \-no@_symlink-\ bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link \(exim)\ to the
2418 installed binary.
2419 .endp
2420 \\INSTALL@_ARG\\ can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2421 .display asis
2422 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2423 .endd
2424
2425 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2426 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2427 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2428 .display asis
2429 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2430 .endd
2431
2432
2433 .section Installing info documentation
2434 .rset SECTinsinfdoc "~~chapter.~~section"
2435 .index installing Exim||\*info*\ documentation
2436 Not all systems use the GNU \*info*\ system for documentation, and for this
2437 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2438 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2439 ~~SECTavail).
2440
2441 If you have defined \\INFO@_DIRECTORY\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ and the Texinfo
2442 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running \*make
2443 install*\ automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2444
2445
2446 .section Setting up the spool directory
2447 .index spool directory||creating
2448 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2449 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2450 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2451 necessary.
2452
2453
2454
2455 .section Testing
2456 .index testing||installation
2457 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2458 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2459 Exim binary directory is within your \\PATH\\ environment variable:
2460 .display
2461 exim -bV
2462 .endd
2463 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2464 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2465 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2466 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2467 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2468 example,
2469 .display
2470 exim -bt <<local username>>
2471 .endd
2472 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2473 .display
2474 exim -bt <<remote address>>
2475 .endd
2476 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2477 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2478 user agent. For example:
2479 .display
2480 exim -v postmaster@@your.domain.example
2481 From: user@@your.domain.example
2482 To: postmaster@@your.domain.example
2483 Subject: Testing Exim
2484
2485 This is a test message.
2486 ^D
2487 .endd
2488 The \-v-\ option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2489 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2490 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing `Completed'.
2491
2492 .index delivery||problems with
2493 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (\*mainlog*\ and
2494 \*paniclog*\) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2495 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2496 \-d-\ option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2497 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2498 .display
2499 exim -d -M <<message-id>>
2500 .endd
2501 You must be root or an `admin user' in order to do this. The \-d-\ option
2502 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2503 For example, if you use \-d-all+route-\ only the debugging information relevant
2504 to routing is included. (See the \-d-\ option in chapter ~~CHAPcommandline for
2505 more details.)
2506
2507 .index `sticky' bit
2508 .index lock files
2509 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2510 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2511 `sticky bit' set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2512 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2513 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the `sticky bit' on the
2514 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2515 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2516 \%local@_delivery%\ transport in the default configuration file). Another
2517 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2518 \*fcntl()*\ locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2519 agents also use \*fcntl()*\ locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2520 see chapter ~~CHAPappendfile.
2521
2522 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2523 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2524 \-oX-\ option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2525 port, or \*inetd*\ can be used to do this. The \-bh-\ option and the
2526 \*exim@_checkaccess*\ utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2527 incoming SMTP mail.
2528
2529 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2530 be done by building a binary with a different \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ setting. From
2531 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2532 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2533 production version.
2534
2535 .section Replacing another MTA with Exim
2536 .index replacing another MTA
2537 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2538 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2539 is either \(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\, or \(/usr/lib/sendmail)\ (depending on the
2540 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the \*exim*\
2541 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2542 normally done by renaming any existing file and making \(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\
2543 or \(/usr/lib/sendmail)\
2544 .index symbolic link||to \*exim*\ binary
2545 a symbolic link to the \*exim*\ binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2546 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2547 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2548
2549 .index FreeBSD, MTA indirection
2550 .index \(/etc/mail/mailer.conf)\
2551 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2552 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2553 \(/etc/mail/mailer.conf)\ instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2554 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2555 as follows:
2556 .display asis
2557 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2558 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2559 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2560 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2561 .endd
2562
2563 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited \(/etc/mail/mailer.conf)\,
2564 your Exim installation is `live'. Check it by sending a message from your
2565 favourite user agent.
2566
2567 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2568 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2569 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2570 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2571 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2572 .if ~~html
2573 [(A HREF="filter.html")]
2574 .fi
2575 \*Exim's interface to mail filtering*\
2576 .if ~~html
2577 [(/A)]
2578 .fi
2579 available to them.
2580
2581
2582 .section Upgrading Exim
2583 .index upgrading Exim
2584 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2585 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2586 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2587 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-exec itself, and thereby pick up the new
2588 binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2589 version of Exim.
2590
2591
2592 .section Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris
2593 .index Solaris||stopping Exim on
2594 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2595 .display
2596 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2597 .endd
2598 If \(/usr/lib/sendmail)\ has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2599 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command \*ps -e*\ and greps the output
2600 for the text `sendmail'; this is not present because the actual program name
2601 (that is, `exim') is given by the \*ps*\ command with these options. A solution
2602 is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2603 .display asis
2604 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2605 .endd
2606 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2607
2608 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not `stop Exim'. Messages can
2609 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2610 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2611
2612
2613 .
2614 .
2615 .
2616 .
2617 . ============================================================================
2618 .chapter The Exim command line
2619 .set runningfoot "command line"
2620 .rset CHAPcommandline ~~chapter
2621 .index command line||options
2622 .index options||command line
2623
2624 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2625 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2626 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2627 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2628 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2629 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2630
2631 .section Setting options by program name
2632 .index \*mailq*\
2633 If Exim is called under the name \*mailq*\, it behaves as if the option \-bp-\
2634 were present before any other options.
2635 The \-bp-\ option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2636 standard output.
2637 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2638 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2639 \(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\ or \(/usr/lib/sendmail)\.
2640
2641 .index \*rsmtp*\
2642 If Exim is called under the name \*rsmtp*\ it behaves as if the option \-bS-\
2643 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The \-bS-\
2644 option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP format.
2645
2646 .index \*rmail*\
2647 If Exim is called under the name \*rmail*\ it behaves as if the \-i-\ and
2648 \-oee-\ options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2649 Smail. The name \*rmail*\ is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2650
2651 .index \*runq*\
2652 .index queue runner
2653 If Exim is called under the name \*runq*\ it behaves as if the option \-q-\ were
2654 present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The \-q-\
2655 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2656
2657 .index \*newaliases*\
2658 .index alias file||building
2659 .index Sendmail compatibility||calling Exim as \*newaliases*\
2660 If Exim is called under the name \*newaliases*\ it behaves as if the option
2661 \-bi-\ were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2662 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2663 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2664 command if called with the \-bi-\ option.
2665
2666 .section Trusted and admin users
2667 .rset SECTtrustedadmin "~~chapter.~~section"
2668 Some Exim options are available only to \*trusted users*\ and others are
2669 available only to \*admin users*\. In the description below, the phrases `Exim
2670 user' and `Exim group' mean the user and group defined by \\EXIM@_USER\\ and
2671 \\EXIM@_GROUP\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ or set by the \exim@_user\ and
2672 \exim@_group\ options. These do not necessarily have to use the name `exim'.
2673
2674 .numberpars $.
2675 .index trusted user||definition of
2676 .index user||trusted, definition of
2677 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2678 \trusted@_users\ configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2679 supplementary group is one of those listed in the \trusted@_groups\
2680 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2681
2682 .index `From' line
2683 .index envelope sender
2684 Trusted users are always permitted to use the \-f-\ option or a leading `From '
2685 line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to Exim through
2686 the local interface (see the \-bm-\ and \-f-\ options below). See the
2687 \untrusted@_set@_sender\ option for a way of permitting non-trusted users to
2688 set envelope senders.
2689 .index ::From:: header line
2690 .index ::Sender:: header line
2691 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the ::From::
2692 header line, and a ::Sender:: line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2693 ::Sender:: line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2694
2695 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2696 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2697 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2698 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2699 users may in some circumstances use \-f-\, but can never set the other values
2700 that are available to trusted users.
2701 .nextp
2702 .index user||admin, definition of
2703 .index admin user||definition of
2704 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2705 Exim group or of any group listed in the \admin@_groups\ configuration option.
2706 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2707
2708 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2709 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2710 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2711 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2712
2713 By default, the use of the \-M-\, \-q-\, \-R-\, and \-S-\ options to cause Exim
2714 to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2715 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the \prod@_requires@_admin\
2716 option false (that is, specifying \no@_prod@_requires@_admin\).
2717
2718 Similarly, the use of the \-bp-\ option to list all the messages in the queue
2719 is restricted to admin users unless \queue@_list@_requires@_admin\ is set
2720 false.
2721 .endp
2722
2723 \**Warning**\: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2724 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2725 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2726 ~~CHAPconf.
2727
2728
2729
2730 .section Command line options
2731 The command options are described in alphabetical order below.
2732
2733 .startoptions
2734
2735 .option @-
2736 .index options||command line, terminating
2737 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2738 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2739 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2740
2741 .option -help
2742 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2743 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2744 no arguments.
2745
2746 .option B <<type>>
2747 .index 8-bit characters
2748 .index Sendmail compatibility||8-bit characters
2749 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2750 clean; it ignores this option.
2751
2752 .option bd
2753 .index daemon
2754 .index SMTP listener
2755 .index queue runner
2756 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2757 the \-bd-\ option is combined with the \-q-\<<time>> option, to specify that
2758 the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2759
2760 The \-bd-\ option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the \-d-\
2761 (debugging) or \-v-\ (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2762 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2763 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2764
2765 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2766 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2767 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2768 ~~CHAPinterfaces contains a description of the options that control this.
2769
2770 .index daemon||process id (pid)
2771 .index pid (process id)||of daemon
2772 When a listening daemon is started without the use of \-oX-\ (that is, without
2773 overriding the normal configuration), it writes its process id to a file called
2774 \(exim-daemon.pid)\ in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden
2775 by setting \\PID@_FILE@_PATH\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\. The file is written while
2776 Exim is still running as root.
2777
2778 When \-oX-\ is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2779 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, \-oP-\ can be
2780 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2781
2782 .index \\SIGHUP\\
2783 The \\SIGHUP\\ signal can be used to cause the daemon to re-exec itself. This
2784 should be done whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is
2785 incorporated into it by means of the \.include\ facility, is changed, and also
2786 whenever a new version of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this
2787 when other files that are referenced from the configuration (for example, alias
2788 files) are changed, because these are reread each time they are used.
2789
2790 .option bdf
2791 This option has the same effect as \-bd-\ except that it never disconnects from
2792 the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2793
2794 .option be
2795 .index testing||string expansion
2796 .index expansion||testing
2797 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2798 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2799 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2800 of data.
2801 .em
2802 If Exim was built with \\USE@_READLINE\\=yes in \(Local/Makefile)\, it tries
2803 to load the \libreadline\ library dynamically whenever the \-be-\ option is
2804 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the \*readline()*\
2805 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2806 test data. A line history is supported.
2807 .nem
2808
2809 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2810 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, whitespace at the start of
2811 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2812 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2813 configuration file (for example, \$qualify@_domain$\) are available, but no
2814 message-specific values (such as \$domain$\) are set, because no message is
2815 being processed.
2816
2817 .option bF #<<filename>>
2818 .index system filter||testing
2819 .index testing||system filter
2820 This option is the same as \-bf-\ except that it assumes that the filter being
2821 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2822 system filters are recognized.
2823
2824 .option bf #<<filename>>
2825 .index filter||testing
2826 .index testing||filter file
2827 .index forward file||testing
2828 .index testing||forward file
2829 .index Sieve filter||testing
2830 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2831 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2832 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2833 supplied.
2834 .em
2835 If you want to test a system filter file, use \-bF-\ instead of \-bf-\. You can
2836 use both \-bF-\ and \-bf-\ on the same command, in order to
2837 test a system filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2838 .display asis
2839 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2840 .endd
2841 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2842 variables that are used by the user filter.
2843 .nem
2844
2845 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2846 .display asis
2847 # Exim filter
2848 # Sieve filter
2849 .endd
2850 it is taken to be a normal \(.forward)\ file, and is tested for validity under
2851 that interpretation. See sections ~~SECTitenonfilred to ~~SECTspecitredli for a
2852 description of the possible contents of non-filter redirection lists.
2853
2854 The result of an Exim command that uses \-bf-\, provided no errors are
2855 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2856 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2857 separate document entitled \*Exim's interfaces to mail filtering*\.
2858
2859 .index `From' line
2860 .index envelope sender
2861 .index \-f-\ option||for filter testing
2862 When testing a filter file, the envelope sender can be set by the \-f-\ option,
2863 or by a `From ' line at the start of the test message. Various parameters that
2864 would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message can
2865 be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four options).
2866
2867 .em
2868 .option bfd #<<domain>>
2869 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2870 tested by means of the \-bf-\ option. The default is the value of
2871 \$qualify@_domain$\.
2872
2873 .option bfl #<<local part>>
2874 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the \-bf-\ option. The default is the username of the
2876 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2877 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2878 actually being delivered.
2879
2880 .option bfp #<<prefix>>
2881 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2882 file is being tested by means of the \-bf-\ option. The default is an empty
2883 prefix.
2884
2885 .option bfp #<<suffix>>
2886 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2887 file is being tested by means of the \-bf-\ option. The default is an empty
2888 suffix.
2889 .em
2890
2891
2892 .option bh #<<IP address>>
2893 .index testing||incoming SMTP
2894 .index SMTP||testing incoming
2895 .index testing||relay control
2896 .index relaying||testing configuration
2897 .index policy control||testing
2898 .index debugging||\-bh-\ option
2899 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2900 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2901 after a full stop. For example:
2902 .display asis
2903 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2904 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2905 .endd
2906 .em
2907 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2908 of the second example above, the value of \$sender@_host@_address$\ after
2909 conversion to the canonical form is \"fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678"\.
2910 .nem
2911
2912 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2913 include lines beginning with `LOG' for anything that would have been logged.
2914 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2915 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2916 test your relay controls using \-bh-\.
2917
2918 .index RFC 1413
2919 \**Warning 1**\: You cannot test features of the configuration that rely on
2920 ident (RFC 1413) callouts. These cannot be done when testing using
2921 \-bh-\ because there is no incoming SMTP connection.
2922
2923 \**Warning 2**\: Address verification callouts (see section ~~SECTcallver) are
2924 also skipped when testing using \-bh-\. If you want these callouts to occur,
2925 use \-bhc-\ instead.
2926
2927 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2928 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2929 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The \-oMi-\ option
2930 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important.
2931
2932 The \*exim@_checkaccess*\ utility is a `packaged' version of \-bh-\ whose
2933 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2934 acceptable or not. See section ~~SECTcheckaccess.
2935
2936 .option bhc #<<IP address>>
2937 This option operates in the same way as \-bh-\, except that address
2938 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2939 updating the callout cache database.
2940
2941 .option bi
2942 .index alias file||building
2943 .index building alias file
2944 .index Sendmail compatibility||\-bi-\ option
2945 Sendmail interprets the \-bi-\ option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2946 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2947 this behaviour. However, calls to \(/usr/lib/sendmail)\ with the \-bi-\ option
2948 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2949 recognized.
2950
2951 If \-bi-\ is encountered, the command specified by the \bi@_command\
2952 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2953 the \-oA-\ option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2954 The command set by \bi@_command\ may not contain arguments. The command can use
2955 the \*exim@_dbmbuild*\ utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files if
2956 this is required. If the \bi@_command\ option is not set, calling Exim with
2957 \-bi-\ is a no-op.
2958
2959 .option bm
2960 .index local message reception
2961 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2962 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2963 command arguments (except when \-t-\ is also present -- see below). Each
2964 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2965 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2966 if no other conflicting option is present.
2967
2968 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2969 qualified by the values of the \qualify@_domain\ or \qualify@_recipient\
2970 options, as appropriate. The \-bnq-\ option (see below) provides a way of
2971 suppressing this for special cases.
2972
2973 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of the
2974 non-SMTP ACL. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for details.
2975 .index return code||for \-bm-\
2976 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2977 action is controlled by the \-oe$it{x}-\ option setting -- see below.
2978
2979 .index message||format
2980 .index format||message
2981 .index `From' line
2982 .index UUCP||`From' line
2983 .index Sendmail compatibility||`From' line
2984 The format of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2985 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2986 .display
2987 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2988 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2989 .endd
2990 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2991 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2992 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2993 matching against the regular expression defined by the \uucp@_from@_pattern\
2994 option, which can be changed if necessary.
2995 .index \-f-\ option||overriding `From' line
2996 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2997 \-f-\ option, but if a \-f-\ option is also present, its argument is used in
2998 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2999 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3000
3001 .option bnq
3002 .index address||qualification, suppressing
3003 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3004 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3005 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3006 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3007 \qualify@_domain\, and recipient addresses using \qualify@_recipient\ (which
3008 defaults to the value of \qualify@_domain\).
3009
3010 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if \-bS-\ (batch SMTP) is
3011 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3012 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3013 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3014 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3015
3016 The \-bnq-\ option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3017 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3018 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3019 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3020
3021
3022 .option bP
3023 .index configuration options, extracting
3024 .index options||configuration, extracting
3025 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3026 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3027 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3028 arguments, for example:
3029 .display
3030 exim -bP qualify@_domain hold@_domains
3031 .endd
3032 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word `hide' in the
3033 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3034 users, the output is as in this example:
3035 .display asis
3036 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3037 .endd
3038 If \configure@_file\ is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3039 configuration file is output.
3040 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3041 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3042
3043 .index daemon||process id (pid)
3044 .index pid (process id)||of daemon
3045 If \log__file__path\ or \pid@_file@_path\ are given, the names of the
3046 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3047 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3048 sub-directory of the spool directory called \log\, and the pid file is written
3049 directly into the spool directory.
3050
3051 If \-bP-\ is followed by a name preceded by \"+"\, for example,
3052 .display asis
3053 exim -bP +local_domains
3054 .endd
3055 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3056 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3057
3058 .index options||router, extracting
3059 .index options||transport, extracting
3060 If one of the words \router\, \transport\, or \authenticator\ is given,
3061 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3062 that driver are output. For example:
3063 .display
3064 exim -bP transport local@_delivery
3065 .endd
3066 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3067 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3068 using one of the words \router@_list\, \transport@_list\, or
3069 \authenticator@_list\, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3070 settings can be obtained by using \routers\, \transports\, or \authenticators\.
3071
3072
3073 .option bp
3074 .index queue||listing messages on
3075 .index listing||messages on the queue
3076 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3077 standard output. If the \-bp-\ option is followed by a list of message ids,
3078 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3079 admin user. However, the \queue__list__requires__admin\ option can be set false
3080 to allow any user to see the queue.
3081
3082 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3083 .display
3084 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@@wonderland.fict.example>
3085 red.king@@looking-glass.fict.example
3086 <<other addresses>>
3087 .endd
3088 .index message||size in queue listing
3089 .index size||of message
3090 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3091 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3092 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3093 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3094 `<>'. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3095 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3096 before the sender address.
3097 .index frozen messages||in queue listing
3098 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3099 `$*$$*$$*$ frozen $*$$*$$*$' is displayed at the end of this line.
3100
3101 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3102 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3103 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3104 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3105 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3106 complete.
3107
3108
3109 .option bpa
3110 This option operates like \-bp-\, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3111 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3112 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with `+D' instead
3113 of just `D'.
3114
3115
3116 .option bpc
3117 .index queue||count of messages on
3118 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3119 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3120 \queue__list__requires__admin\ is set false.
3121
3122
3123 .option bpr
3124 This option operates like \-bp-\, but the output is not sorted into
3125 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3126 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3127 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3128
3129 .option bpra
3130 This option is a combination of \-bpr-\ and \-bpa-\.
3131
3132 .option bpru
3133 This option is a combination of \-bpr-\ and \-bpu-\.
3134
3135
3136 .option bpu
3137 This option operates like \-bp-\ but shows only undelivered top-level addresses
3138 for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or forwarding are
3139 not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a router with
3140 the \one@_time\ option set.
3141
3142
3143 .option brt
3144 .index testing||retry configuration
3145 .index retry||configuration testing
3146 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3147 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3148 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3149 .display asis
3150 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3151 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3152 .endd
3153 See chapter ~~CHAPretry for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3154 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3155 \*local@_part@@domain*\, or it can be just a domain name. The second argument is
3156 an optional second domain name; if no retry rule is found for the first
3157 argument, the second is tried. This ties in with Exim's behaviour when looking
3158 for retry rules for remote hosts -- if no rule is found that matches the host,
3159 one that matches the mail domain is sought. The final argument is the name of a
3160 specific delivery error, as used in setting up retry rules, for example
3161 `quota@_3d'.
3162
3163 .option brw
3164 .index testing||rewriting
3165 .index rewriting||testing
3166 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3167 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3168 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3169 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3170 ~~CHAPrewrite for further details.
3171
3172 .option bS
3173 .index SMTP||batched incoming
3174 .index batched SMTP input
3175 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3176 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3177 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3178 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3179 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3180 \untrusted@_set@_sender\ is set, the senders in the SMTP \\MAIL\\ commands are
3181 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3182
3183 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3184 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3185 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3186
3187 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3188 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter ~~CHAPACL).
3189 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using \qualify@_domain\ and
3190 \qualify@_recipient\, as appropriate, unless the \-bnq-\ option is used.
3191
3192 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. \\HELO\\ and \\EHLO\\ act
3193 as \\RSET\\; \\VRFY\\, \\EXPN\\, \\ETRN\\, and \\HELP\\ act as \\NOOP\\;
3194 \\QUIT\\ quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3195
3196 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3197 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately.
3198 .index return code||for \-bS-\
3199 The return code is 0 if no error was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages
3200 were accepted before the error was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3201
3202 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3203 ~~SECTincomingbatchedSMTP.
3204
3205 .option bs
3206 .index SMTP||local input
3207 .index local SMTP input
3208 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3209 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3210 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter ~~CHAPACL) are applied.
3211
3212 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3213 messages to the MTA.
3214 .index sender||source of
3215 In this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or \untrusted@_set@_sender\ is
3216 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP \\MAIL\\ commands.
3217 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3218 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3219 \qualify@_domain\ and \qualify@_recipient\, as appropriate, unless the \-bnq-\
3220 option is used.
3221
3222 .index inetd
3223 The \-bs-\ option is also used to run Exim from \*inetd*\, as an alternative to
3224 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3225 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3226 \*inetd*\, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3227 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3228 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3229 the listening daemon.
3230
3231 .option bt
3232 .index testing||addresses
3233 .index address||testing
3234 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3235 as an address to be tested for deliverability. The results are written to the
3236 standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no
3237 details of the failure are output, because these might contain sensitive
3238 information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3239
3240 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3241 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3242 .em
3243 Unlike the \-be-\ test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3244 \*readline()*\ function, because it is running as \*root*\ and there are
3245 security issues.
3246 .nem
3247
3248 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3249 (compare the \-bv-\ option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3250 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3251 \no@_address@_test\ set is bypassed. This can make \-bt-\ easier to use for
3252 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3253 program.
3254
3255 .index return code||for \-bt-\
3256 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3257 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3258 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3259
3260 \**Warning**\: \-bt-\ can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3261 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3262 message,
3263 .index \-f-\ option||for address testing
3264 you can use the \-f-\ option to set an appropriate sender when running
3265 \-bt-\ tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3266 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3267 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3268 those conditions using \-bt-\. The \-N-\ option provides a possible way of
3269 doing such tests.
3270
3271 .option bV
3272 .index version number of Exim, verifying
3273 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3274 number, and compilation date of the \*exim*\ binary to the standard output.
3275 It also lists the DBM library this is being used, the optional modules (such as
3276 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3277 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3278
3279 .em
3280 As part of its operation, \-bV-\ causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3281 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3282 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3283 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on \-bV-\
3284 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3285 realistic testing is needed. The \-bh-\ and \-N-\ options provide more dynamic
3286 testing facilities.
3287 .nem
3288
3289
3290 .option bv
3291 .index verifying||address, using \-bv-\
3292 .index address||verification
3293 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3294 taken as an address to be verified. During normal operation, verification
3295 happens mostly as a consequence processing a \verify\ condition in an ACL (see
3296 chapter ~~CHAPACL). If you want to test an entire ACL, see the \-bh-\ option.
3297
3298 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3299 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3300 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3301
3302 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3303 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3304 .em
3305 Unlike the \-be-\ test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3306 \*readline()*\ function, because it is running as \*exim*\ and there are
3307 security issues.
3308 .nem
3309
3310 Verification differs from address testing (the \-bt-\ option) in that routers
3311 that have \no@_verify\ set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3312 router that has \fail@_verify\ set, verification fails. The address is verified
3313 as a recipient if \-bv-\ is used; to test verification for a sender address,
3314 \-bvs-\ should be used.
3315
3316 If the \-v-\ option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3317 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3318 latter case. Otherwise, more details are given of how the address has been
3319 handled, and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses
3320 are also considered. Without \-v-\, generating more than one address by
3321 redirection causes verification to end sucessfully.
3322
3323 .index return code||for \-bv-\
3324 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3325 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3326 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3327
3328 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3329 address of a message, you should use the \-f-\ option to set an appropriate
3330 sender when running \-bv-\ tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3331 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3332
3333 .option bvs
3334 This option acts like \-bv-\, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3335 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3336 might happen.
3337
3338 .option C #<<filelist>>
3339 .index configuration file||alternate
3340 .index \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\
3341 .index alternate configuration file
3342 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3343 list instead of from the list specified by the \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\
3344 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3345 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3346 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3347 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3348
3349 When this option is used by a caller other than root or the Exim user, and the
3350 list is different from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege
3351 immediately, and runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of
3352 the caller. However, if \\ALT@_CONFIG@_ROOT@_ONLY\\ is defined in
3353 \(Local/Makefile)\, root privilege is retained for \-C-\ only if the caller of
3354 Exim is root.
3355 .em
3356 That is, the Exim user is no longer privileged in this regard. This build-time
3357 option is not set by default in the Exim source distribution tarbundle.
3358 However, if you are using a `packaged' version of Exim (source or binary), the
3359 packagers might have enabled it.
3360 .nem
3361
3362 Setting \\ALT@_CONFIG@_ROOT@_ONLY\\ locks out the possibility of testing a
3363 configuration using \-C-\ right through message reception and delivery, even if
3364 the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as
3365 the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
3366 use of \-C-\ causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
3367 delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
3368 \-odq-\, and another to do the delivery, using \-M-\).
3369
3370 If \\ALT@_CONFIG@_PREFIX\\ is defined \(in Local/Makefile)\, it specifies a
3371 prefix string with which any file named in a \-C-\ command line option
3372 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence \"/../"\.
3373 However, if the value of the \-C-\ option is identical to the value of
3374 \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\, Exim ignores \-C-\ and proceeds as
3375 usual. There is no default setting for \\ALT@_CONFIG@_PREFIX\\; when it is
3376 unset, any file name can be used with \-C-\.
3377
3378 \\ALT@_CONFIG@_PREFIX\\ can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3379 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3380 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3381 configuration file.
3382
3383 The \-C-\ facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3384 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3385 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3386 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3387 specified by this option.
3388
3389 .option D <<macro>>=<<value>>
3390 .index macro||setting on command line
3391 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3392 (see section ~~SECTmacrodefs). However, like \-C-\, if it is used by an
3393 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3394 If \\DISABLE@_D@_OPTION\\ is defined in \(Local/Makefile)\, the use of \-D-\ is
3395 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3396
3397 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3398 command line item. \-D-\ can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3399 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3400 synonymous:
3401 .display asis
3402 exim -DABC ...
3403 exim -DABC= ...
3404 .endd
3405 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3406 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3407 example:
3408 .display asis
3409 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3410 .endd
3411 \-D-\ may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3412
3413 .option d <<debug options>>
3414 .index debugging||list of selectors
3415 .index debugging||\-d-\ option
3416 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3417 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3418 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3419 filter files should be protected. When \-d-\ is used, \-v-\ is assumed. If
3420 \-d-\ is given on its own, a lot of standard debugging data is output. This can
3421 be reduced, or increased to include some more rarely needed information, by
3422 following \-d-\ with a string made up of names preceded by plus or minus
3423 characters. These add or remove sets of debugging data, respectively. For
3424 example, \-d+filter-\ adds filter debugging, whereas \-d-all+filter-\ selects
3425 only filter debugging. The available debugging categories are:
3426 .display flow
3427 .tabs 21
3428 .
3429 . The odd formatting of the lines below is deliberate. It does not affect the
3430 . SGCAL output, but by putting in the space it keeps things aligned in the man
3431 . page that is automatically generated from this text.
3432 .
3433 acl $t $rm{ACL interpretation}
3434 auth $t $rm{authenticators}
3435 deliver $t $rm{general delivery logic}
3436 dns $t $rm{DNS lookups (see also resolver)}
3437 dnsbl $t $rm{DNS black list (aka RBL) code}
3438 exec $t $rm{arguments for \execv@(@)\ calls}
3439 expand $t $rm{detailed debugging for string expansions}
3440 filter $t $rm{filter handling}
3441 hints@_lookup $t $rm{hints data lookups}
3442 host@_lookup $t $rm{all types of name-to-IP address handling}
3443 ident $t $rm{ident lookup}
3444 interface $t $rm{lists of local interfaces}
3445 lists $t $rm{matching things in lists}
3446 load $t $rm{system load checks}
3447 local@_scan $t $rm{can be used by \*local@_scan()*\ (see chapter ~~CHAPlocalscan)}
3448 lookup $t $rm{general lookup code and all lookups}
3449 memory $t $rm{memory handling}
3450 pid $t $rm{add pid to debug output lines}
3451 process@_info $t $rm{setting info for the process log}
3452 queue@_run $t $rm{queue runs}
3453 receive $t $rm{general message reception logic}
3454 resolver $t $rm{turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output}
3455 retry $t $rm{retry handling}
3456 rewrite $t $rm{address rewriting}
3457 route $t $rm{address routing}
3458 timestamp $t $rm{add timestamp to debug output lines}
3459 tls $t $rm{TLS logic}
3460 transport $t $rm{transports}
3461 uid $t $rm{changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid}
3462 verify $t $rm{address verification logic}
3463
3464 all $t $rm{all of the above, and also \-v-\}
3465 .endd
3466 .index resolver, debugging output
3467 .index DNS||resolver, debugging output
3468 The \"resolver"\ option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3469 with \\DEBUG\\ enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3470 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3471 rather than stderr.
3472
3473 The default (\-d-\ with no argument) omits \"expand"\, \"filter"\,
3474 \"interface"\, \"load"\, \"memory"\, \"pid"\, \"resolver"\, and \"timestamp"\.
3475 However, the \"pid"\ selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3476 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3477 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3478 run in parallel.
3479
3480 The \"timestamp"\ selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3481 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3482 in processing.
3483
3484 If the \debug@_print\ option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3485 any debugging is selected, or if \-v-\ is used.
3486
3487 .em
3488 .option dd <<debug options>>
3489 This option behaves exactly like \-d-\ except when used on a command that
3490 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3491 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3492 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3493 .nem
3494
3495 .option dropcr
3496 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3497 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3498 described in section ~~SECTlineendings.
3499
3500
3501 .option E
3502 .index bounce message||generating
3503 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3504 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3505 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3506 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3507 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3508 follow the characters \-E-\. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3509 new message contains the id, following `R=', as a cross-reference.
3510
3511 .option e$it{x}
3512 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with \-oe-\ which seem to be
3513 called by various programs without the leading \o\ in the option. For example,
3514 the \vacation\ program uses \-eq-\. Exim treats all options of the form
3515 \-e$it{x}-\ as synonymous with the corresponding \-oe$it{x}-\ options.
3516
3517 .option F #<<string>>
3518 .index sender||name
3519 .index name||of sender
3520 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3521 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's \*gecos*\
3522 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3523 their \*gecos*\ entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3524 between \-F-\ and the <<string>> is optional.
3525
3526 .option f #<<address>>
3527 .index sender||address
3528 .index address||sender
3529 .index trusted user
3530 .index envelope sender
3531 .index user||trusted
3532 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3533 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3534 by a trusted user, but \untrusted@_set@_sender\ can be set to allow untrusted
3535 users to use it.
3536 .em
3537 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3538 trusted users are defined by the \trusted@_users\ or \trusted@_groups\ options.
3539
3540 In the absence of \-f-\, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender of a local
3541 message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify domain.
3542
3543 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of \-f-\: an empty sender
3544 can be specified by any user, trusted or not,
3545 .nem
3546 to create a message that can never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be
3547 specified either as an empty string, or as a pair of angle brackets with
3548 nothing between them, as in these examples of shell commands:
3549 .display asis
3550 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3551 exim -f "" user@domain
3552 .endd
3553 In addition, the use of \-f-\ is not restricted when testing a filter file with
3554 \-bf-\ or when testing or verifying addresses using the \-bt-\ or \-bv-\
3555 options.
3556
3557 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3558 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the ::From:: header
3559 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a ::Sender:: header,
3560 though this can be overridden by setting \no@_local@_from@_check\.
3561
3562 .index `From' line
3563 White space between \-f-\ and the <<address>> is optional
3564 (that is, they can be given as two arguments or one combined argument).
3565 The sender of a locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by
3566 an initial `From ' line in the message -- see the description of \-bm-\ above
3567 -- but if \-f-\ is also present, it overrides `From'.
3568
3569 .option G
3570 .index Sendmail compatibility||\-G-\ option ignored
3571 This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3572
3573 .option h #<<number>>
3574 .index Sendmail compatibility||\-h-\ option ignored
3575 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3576 Sendmail it overrides the `hop count' obtained by counting ::Received::
3577 headers.)
3578
3579 .option i
3580 .index Solaris||\*mail*\ command
3581 .index dot||in incoming, non-SMTP message
3582 This option, which has the same effect as \-oi-\, specifies that a dot on a
3583 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3584 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the \*mailx*\
3585 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also \-ti-\.
3586
3587 .option M #<<message id>>#<<message id>> ...
3588 .index forcing delivery
3589 .index delivery||forcing attempt
3590 .index frozen messages||forcing delivery
3591 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3592 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3593 delivery attempt. The settings of \queue@_domains\, \queue@_smtp@_domains\, and
3594 \hold@_domains\ are ignored.
3595 .index hints database||overriding retry hints
3596 Retry hints for any of the addresses are
3597 overridden -- Exim tries to deliver even if the normal retry time has not yet
3598 been reached. This option requires the caller to be an admin user. However,
3599 there is an option called \prod@_requires@_admin\ which can be set false to
3600 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the \-q-\, \-R-\, and
3601 \-S-\ options).
3602
3603
3604 .option Mar #<<message id>>#<<address>>#<<address>> ...
3605 .index message||adding recipients
3606 .index recipient||adding
3607 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3608 message (`ar' for `add recipients'). The first argument must be a message id,
3609 and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3610 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3611 can be used only by an admin user.
3612
3613 .index SMTP||passed connection
3614 .index SMTP||multiple deliveries
3615 .index multiple SMTP deliveries
3616 .option MC #<<transport>>#<<hostname>>#<<sequence number>>#<<message id>>
3617 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3618 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3619 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3620 given in chapter ~~CHAPSMTP. This must be the final option, and the caller must
3621 be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3622
3623 .option MCA
3624 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3625 by Exim in conjunction with the \-MC-\ option. It signifies that the connection
3626 to the remote host has been authenticated.
3627
3628 .option MCP
3629 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3630 by Exim in conjunction with the \-MC-\ option. It signifies that the server to
3631 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3632
3633 .option MCQ #<<process id>> <<pipe fd>>
3634 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3635 by Exim in conjunction with the \-MC-\ option when the original delivery was
3636 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3637 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3638 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3639 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3640
3641 .option MCS
3642 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3643 by Exim in conjunction with the \-MC-\ option, and passes on the fact that the
3644 SMTP \\SIZE\\ option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3645 connection.
3646
3647 .option MCT
3648 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3649 by Exim in conjunction with the \-MC-\ option, and passes on the fact that the
3650 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3651
3652 .option Mc #<<message id>>#<<message id>> ...
3653 .index hints database||not overridden by \-Mc-\
3654 .index delivery||manually started, not forced
3655 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3656 but unlike the \-M-\ option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3657 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3658 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3659 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter ~~CHAPsecurity).
3660 However, \-Mc-\ can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3661 respects retry times and other options such as \hold@_domains\ that are
3662 overridden when \-M-\ is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3663 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3664 \-q-\ with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3665 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3666
3667 .option Mes #<<message id>>#<<address>>
3668 .index message||changing sender
3669 .index sender||changing
3670 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3671 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or `<>' (`es' for `edit
3672 sender'). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must be a
3673 message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message is
3674 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This
3675 option can be used only by an admin user.
3676
3677 .option Mf #<<message id>>#<<message id>> ...
3678 .index freezing messages
3679 .index message||manually freezing
3680 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as `frozen'. This
3681 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is `thawed',
3682 either manually or as a result of the \auto@_thaw\ configuration option.
3683 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3684 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3685 user.
3686
3687 .option Mg #<<message id>>#<<message id>> ...
3688 .index giving up on messages
3689 .index message||abandoning delivery attempts
3690 .index delivery||abandoning further attempts
3691 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3692 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3693 their status is not altered.
3694 For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message is sent to the sender,
3695 containing the text `cancelled by administrator'. Bounce messages are just
3696 discarded.
3697 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3698
3699 .option Mmad #<<message id>>#<<message id>> ...
3700 .index delivery||cancelling all
3701 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3702 as already delivered (`mad' for `mark all delivered'). However, if any message
3703 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3704 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3705
3706 .option Mmd #<<message id>>#<<address>>#<<address>> ...
3707 .index delivery||cancelling by address
3708 .index recipient||removing
3709 .index removing recipients
3710 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3711 (`md' for `mark delivered'). The first argument must be a message id, and the
3712 remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3713 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3714 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3715 can be used only by an admin user.
3716
3717 .option Mrm #<<message id>>#<<message id>> ...
3718 .index removing messages
3719 .index abandoning mail
3720 .index message||manually discarding
3721 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3722 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3723 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3724 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3725 placed on the queue.
3726
3727 .option Mt #<<message id>>#<<message id>> ...
3728 .index thawing messages
3729 .index unfreezing messages
3730 .index frozen messages||thawing
3731 .index message||thawing frozen
3732 This option requests Exim to `thaw' any of the listed messages that are
3733 `frozen', so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the messages
3734 are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an
3735 admin user.
3736
3737 .option Mvb #<<message id>>
3738 .index listing||message body
3739 .index message||listing body of
3740 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3741 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3742
3743 .option Mvh #<<message id>>
3744 .index listing||message headers
3745 .index header lines||listing
3746 .index message||listing header lines
3747 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3748 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3749
3750 .option Mvl #<<message id>>
3751 .index listing||message log
3752 .index message||listing message log
3753 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3754 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3755
3756 .option m
3757 This is apparently a synonym for \-om-\ that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3758 treats it that way too.
3759
3760 .option N
3761 .index debugging||\-N-\ option
3762 .index debugging||suppressing delivery
3763 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3764 level. It implies \-v-\. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery --
3765 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3766 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3767 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with `$*$>' rather
3768 than `=>'.
3769
3770 Because \-N-\ discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3771 user are allowed to use it with \-bd-\, \-q-\, \-R-\ or \-M-\. In other words,
3772 an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to which it
3773 will apply. Although transportation never fails when \-N-\ is set, an address
3774 may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a routing
3775 problem. Once \-N-\ has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to the
3776 message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen for
3777 that message.
3778
3779 .option n
3780 .index Sendmail compatibility||\-n-\ option ignored
3781 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean `no aliasing'. It is ignored by
3782 Exim.
3783
3784 .option O #<<data>>
3785 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean `set option`. It is ignored by
3786 Exim.
3787
3788 .option oA #<<file name>>
3789 .index Sendmail compatibility||\-oA-\ option
3790 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with \-bi-\ to specify an
3791 alternative alias file name. Exim handles \-bi-\ differently; see the
3792 description above.
3793
3794 .index SMTP||passed connection
3795 .option oB #<<n>>
3796 .index SMTP||multiple deliveries
3797 .index multiple SMTP deliveries
3798 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3799 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any \%smtp%\
3800 transport. If <<n>> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3801
3802 .option odb
3803 .index background delivery
3804 .index delivery||in the background
3805 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3806 including the listening daemon. It requests `background' delivery of such
3807 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3808 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3809 processes to finish.
3810 .em
3811 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits, leaving
3812 the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output and
3813 error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3814 .nem
3815 This is the default action if none of the \-od-\ options are present.
3816
3817 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3818 (\queue@_only\ or \queue@_only@_file\, for example) is in effect, \-odb-\
3819 overrides it if \queue@_only@_override\ is set true, which is the default
3820 setting. If \queue@_only@_override\ is set false, \-odb-\ has no effect.
3821
3822 .option odf
3823 .index foreground delivery
3824 .index delivery||in the foreground
3825 This option requests `foreground' (synchronous) delivery when Exim has accepted
3826 a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3827 \-odb-\.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the
3828 message, and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3829 .em
3830 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3831 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3832 during deliveries.
3833 .nem
3834 However, like \-odb-\, this option has no effect if \queue@_only@_override\ is
3835 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3836
3837 .em
3838 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the message
3839 is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception process
3840 exists. See chapter ~~CHAPnonqueueing for a way of setting up a restricted
3841 configuration that never queues messages.
3842 .nem
3843
3844 .option odi
3845 This option is synonymous with \-odf-\. It is provided for compatibility with
3846 Sendmail.
3847
3848 .option odq
3849 .index non-immediate delivery
3850 .index delivery||suppressing immediate
3851 .index queueing incoming messages
3852 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3853 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
3854 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
3855 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
3856 process encounters them.
3857 There are several configuration options (such as \queue@_only\) that can be
3858 used to queue incoming messages under certain conditions. This option overrides
3859 all of them and also \-odqs-\. It always forces queueing.
3860
3861 .option odqs
3862 .index SMTP||delaying delivery
3863 This option is a hybrid between \-odb-\/\-odi-\ and \-odq-\.
3864 However, like \-odb-\ and \-odi-\, this option has no effect if
3865 \queue@_only@_override\ is false and one of the queueing options in the
3866 configuration file is in effect.
3867
3868 When \-odqs-\ does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
3869 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if \-odi-\ is also
3870 present.
3871 The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done in the normal
3872 way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not done at this
3873 time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue runner
3874 process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which messages are
3875 waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same host can be
3876 sent in a single SMTP connection. The \queue@_smtp@_domains\ configuration
3877 option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the \-qq-\ option.
3878
3879 .option oee
3880 .index error||reporting
3881 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
3882 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
3883 message.
3884 .index return code||for \-oee-\
3885 Provided this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
3886 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
3887 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
3888 the default \-oe$it{x}-\ option if Exim is called as \*rmail*\.
3889
3890 .option oem
3891 .index error||reporting
3892 .index return code||for \-oem-\
3893 This is the same as \-oee-\, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
3894 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
3895 This is the default \-oe$it{x}-\ option, unless Exim is called as \*rmail*\.
3896
3897 .option oep
3898 .index error||reporting
3899 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
3900 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
3901 .index return code||for \-oep-\
3902 The return code is 1 for all errors.
3903
3904 .option oeq
3905 .index error||reporting
3906 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3907 effect as \-oep-\.
3908
3909 .option oew
3910 .index error||reporting
3911 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3912 effect as \-oem-\.
3913
3914 .option oi
3915 .index dot||in incoming, non-SMTP message
3916 This option, which has the same effect as \-i-\, specifies that a dot on a line
3917 by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message.
3918 Otherwise, a single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing
3919 for other lines that start with a dot.
3920 This option is set by default if Exim is called as \*rmail*\. See also \-ti-\.
3921
3922 .option oitrue
3923 This option is treated as synonymous with \-oi-\.
3924
3925 .option oMa #<<host address>>
3926 .index sender||host address, specifying for local message
3927 A number of options starting with \-oM-\ can be used to set values associated
3928 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
3929 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
3930 \-bh-\,
3931 \-be-\,
3932 \-bf-\, \-bF-\, \-bt-\, or \-bv-\ testing options. In other circumstances, they
3933 are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
3934
3935 The \-oMa-\ option sets the sender host address. This may include a port number
3936 at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
3937 .display asis
3938 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
3939 .endd
3940 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets, followed
3941 by a colon and the port number:
3942 .display asis
3943 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
3944 .endd
3945 The IP address is placed in the \$sender@_host@_address$\ variable, and the
3946 port, if present, in \$sender@_host@_port$\.
3947
3948 .option oMaa #<<name>>
3949 .index authentication||name, specifying for local message
3950 See \-oMa-\ above for general remarks about the \-oM-\ options. The \-oMaa-\
3951 option sets the value of \$sender@_host@_authenticated$\ (the authenticator
3952 name). See chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
3953
3954 .option oMai #<<string>>
3955 .index authentication||id, specifying for local message
3956 See \-oMa-\ above for general remarks about the \-oM-\ options. The \-oMai-\
3957 option sets the
3958 value of \$authenticated@_id$\ (the id that was authenticated).
3959 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id) for messages from
3960 local sources. See chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH for a discussion of authenticated
3961 ids.
3962
3963 .option oMas #<<address>>
3964 .index authentication||sender, specifying for local message
3965 See \-oMa-\ above for general remarks about the \-oM-\ options. The \-oMas-\
3966 option sets the authenticated sender value
3967 in \$authenticated@_sender$\.
3968 It overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
3969 messages from local sources. See chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH for a discussion of
3970 authenticated senders.
3971
3972 .option oMi #<<interface address>>
3973 .index interface||address, specifying for local message
3974 See \-oMa-\ above for general remarks about the \-oM-\ options. The \-oMi-\
3975 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
3976 using the same syntax as for \-oMa-\.
3977 The interface address is placed in \$interface@_address$\ and the port number,
3978 if present, in \$interface@_port$\.
3979
3980 .option oMr #<<protocol name>>
3981 .index protocol||incoming, specifying for local message
3982 See \-oMa-\ above for general remarks about the \-oM-\ options. The \-oMr-\
3983 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
3984 \$received@_protocol$\. However, this applies only when \-bs-\ is not used. For
3985 interactive SMTP input (\-bs-\), the protocol is always
3986 .em
3987 `local-' followed by one of the standard SMTP protocol names (see the
3988 description of \$received@_protocol$\ in section ~~SECTexpvar).
3989 .nem
3990 For \-bS-\ (batch SMTP) however, the protocol can be set by \-oMr-\.
3991
3992 .option oMs #<<host name>>
3993 .index sender||host name, specifying for local message
3994 See \-oMa-\ above for general remarks about the \-oM-\ options. The \-oMs-\
3995 option sets the sender host name
3996 in \$sender@_host@_name$\. When this option is present, Exim does not attempt
3997 to look up a host name from an IP address; it uses the name it is given.
3998
3999 .option oMt #<<ident string>>
4000 .index sender||ident string, specifying for local message
4001 See \-oMa-\ above for general remarks about the \-oM-\ options. The \-oMt-\
4002 option sets the sender ident value
4003 in \$sender@_ident$\.
4004 The default setting for local callers is the login id of the calling process.
4005
4006 .option om
4007 .index Sendmail compatibility||\-om-\ option ignored
4008 In Sendmail, this option means `me too', indicating that the sender of a
4009 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4010 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4011
4012 .option oo
4013 .index Sendmail compatibility||\-oo-\ option ignored
4014 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies `old style headers', whatever
4015 that means.
4016
4017 .option oP #<<path>>
4018 .index pid (process id)||of daemon
4019 .index daemon||process id (pid)
4020 This option is useful only in conjunction with \-bd-\ or \-q-\ with a time
4021 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4022 written. When \-oX-\ is used with \-bd-\, or when \-q-\ with a time is used
4023 without \-bd-\, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4024 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4025
4026 .option or #<<time>>
4027 .index timeout||for non-SMTP input
4028 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4029 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4030 by the \receive@_timeout\ option. The format used for specifying times is
4031 described in section ~~SECTtimeformat.
4032
4033 .option os #<<time>>
4034 .index timeout||for SMTP input
4035 .index SMTP||timeout, input
4036 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4037 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4038 the \smtp@_receive@_timeout\ option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4039 for specifying times is described in section ~~SECTtimeformat.
4040
4041 .option ov
4042 This option has exactly the same effect as \-v-\.
4043
4044 .option oX #<<number or string>>
4045 .index TCP/IP||setting listening ports
4046 .index TCP/IP||setting listening interfaces
4047 .index port||receiving TCP/IP
4048 This option is relevant only when the \-bd-\ (start listening daemon) option is
4049 also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details of
4050 the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given in
4051 chapter ~~CHAPinterfaces. When \-oX-\ is used to start a daemon, no pid file is
4052 written unless \-oP-\ is also present to specify a pid file name.
4053
4054 .option pd
4055 .index Perl||starting the interpreter
4056 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4057 chapter ~~CHAPperl). It overrides the setting of the \perl@_at@_start\ option,
4058 forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is needed.
4059
4060 .option ps
4061 .index Perl||starting the interpreter
4062 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4063 chapter ~~CHAPperl). It overrides the setting of the \perl@_at@_start\ option,
4064 forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is started.
4065
4066 .option p<<rval>>:<<sval>>
4067 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option
4068 is equivalent to
4069 .display
4070 -oMr <<rval>> -oMs <<sval>>
4071 .endd
4072 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4073 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4074 Note the Exim already has two private options, \-pd-\ and \-ps-\, that refer to
4075 embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of \"p"\ or
4076 \"s"\ using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4077
4078 .option q
4079 .index queue runner||starting manually
4080 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4081 configuration option called \prod@_requires@_admin\ which can be set false to
4082 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the \-M-\, \-R-\, and
4083 \-S-\ options).
4084
4085 .index queue runner||description of operation
4086 The \-q-\ option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4087 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4088 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4089 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4090 have not been reached. Use \-qf-\ (see below) if you want to override this.
4091 .index SMTP||passed connection
4092 .index SMTP||multiple deliveries
4093 .index multiple SMTP deliveries
4094 If the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4095 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4096 proceeding.
4097
4098 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4099 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4100 mail, one message at a time. Use \-q-\ with a time (see below) if you want this
4101 to be repeated periodically.
4102
4103 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4104 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4105 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4106 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4107
4108 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4109 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4110 \queue@_run@_in@_order\ option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4111
4112 .option q <<qflags>>
4113 The \-q-\ option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4114 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4115 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4116
4117 .option qq...
4118 .index queue||double scanning
4119 .index queue||routing
4120 .index routing||whole queue before delivery
4121 An option starting with \-qq-\ requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4122 stage, the queue is scanned as if the \queue@_smtp@_domains\ option matched
4123 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4124 transports are run.
4125 .index hints database||remembering routing
4126 The hints database that remembers which messages are
4127 waiting for specific hosts is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been
4128 deferred. After this is complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with
4129 routing and delivery taking place as normal. Messages that are routed to the
4130 same host should mostly be delivered down a single SMTP
4131 .index SMTP||passed connection
4132 .index SMTP||multiple deliveries
4133 .index multiple SMTP deliveries
4134 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4135 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4136 intermittently.
4137
4138 .option q[q]i...
4139 .index queue||initial delivery
4140 If the \*i*\ flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4141 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (\*i*\ stands for `initial
4142 delivery'.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4143 \-odq-\ and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4144
4145 .option q[q][i]f...
4146 .index queue||forcing delivery
4147 .index delivery||forcing in queue run
4148 If one \*f*\ flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4149 message, whereas without \f\ only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4150 their retry times are tried.
4151
4152 .option q[q][i]ff...
4153 .index frozen messages||forcing delivery
4154 If \*ff*\ is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4155 frozen or not.
4156
4157 .option q[q][i][f[f]]l
4158 .index queue||local deliveries only
4159 The \*l*\ (the letter `ell') flag specifies that only local deliveries are to be
4160 done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue for
4161 later delivery.
4162
4163 .option q <<qflags>>#<<start id>>#<<end id>>
4164 .index queue||delivering specific messages
4165 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4166 lexically less than a given value by following the \-q-\ option with a starting
4167 message id. For example:
4168 .display
4169 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4170 .endd
4171 Messages that arrived earlier than \"0t5C6f-0000c8-00"\ are not inspected. If a
4172 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4173 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4174 .display
4175 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4176 .endd
4177 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from \-M-\
4178 in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from \-Mc-\ in that it
4179 counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection mechanism does
4180 not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There are also other
4181 ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a queue run -- see
4182 \-R-\ and \-S-\.
4183
4184 .option q <<qflags>><<time>>
4185 .index queue runner||starting periodically
4186 .index periodic queue running
4187 When a time value is present, the \-q-\ option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4188 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4189 (whose format is described in section ~~SECTtimeformat). This form of the \-q-\
4190 option is commonly combined with the \-bd-\ option, in which case a single
4191 daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a combined
4192 daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4193 .display
4194 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4195 .endd
4196 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4197 process every 30 minutes.
4198
4199 When a daemon is started by \-q-\ with a time value, but without \-bd-\, no pid
4200 file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the \-oP-\ option.
4201
4202 .option qR <<rsflags>>#<<string>>
4203 This option is synonymous with \-R-\. It is provided for Sendmail
4204 compatibility.
4205
4206 .option qS <<rsflags>>#<<string>>
4207 This option is synonymous with \-S-\.
4208
4209 .option R <<rsflags>>#<<string>>
4210 .index queue runner||for specific recipients
4211 .index delivery||to given domain
4212 .index domain||delivery to
4213 The <<rsflags>> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4214 is optional, unless the string is \*f*\, \*ff*\, \*r*\, \*rf*\, or \*rff*\,
4215 which are the possible values for <<rsflags>>. White space is required if
4216 <<rsflags>> is not empty.
4217
4218 This option is similar to \-q-\ with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4219 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4220 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4221 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4222 way. If the <<rsflags>> start with \*r*\, <<string>> is interpreted as a regular
4223 expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4224
4225 Once a message is selected, all its addresses are processed. For the first
4226 selected message, Exim overrides any retry information and forces a delivery
4227 attempt for each undelivered address. This means that if delivery of any
4228 address in the first message is successful, any existing retry information is
4229 deleted, and so delivery attempts for that address in subsequently selected
4230 messages (which are processed without forcing) will run. However, if delivery
4231 of any address does not succeed, the retry information is updated, and in
4232 subsequently selected messages, the failing address will be skipped.
4233
4234 If the <<rsflags>> contain \*f*\ or \*ff*\, the delivery forcing applies to all
4235 selected messages, not just the first;
4236 .index frozen messages||forcing delivery
4237 frozen messages are included when \*ff*\ is present.
4238
4239 The \-R-\ option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4240 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4241 command \\ETRN\\ is accepted by its ACL (see chapter ~~CHAPACL), its default
4242 effect is to run Exim with the \-R-\ option, but it can be configured to run an
4243 arbitrary command instead.
4244
4245 .option r
4246 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for \-f-\.
4247
4248 .index delivery||from given sender
4249 .option S <<rsflags>>#<<string>>
4250 .index queue runner||for specific senders
4251 This option acts like \-R-\ except that it checks the string against each
4252 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If \-R-\ is also set, both
4253 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4254 has \*f*\ or \*ff*\ in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4255
4256 .option Tqt#<<times>>
4257 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite.
4258 It is not recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up
4259 of explicit `queue times' so that various warning/retry features can be
4260 tested.
4261
4262 .option t
4263 .index recipient||extracting from header lines
4264 .index ::Bcc:: header line
4265 .index ::Cc:: header line
4266 .index ::To:: header line
4267 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4268 input, the \-t-\ option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4269 from the ::To::, ::Cc::, and ::Bcc:: header lines in the message instead of from
4270 the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting takes
4271 place.
4272
4273 .index Sendmail compatibility||\-t-\ option
4274 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4275 is $it{not} to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4276 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4277 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4278 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4279 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail $it{add}
4280 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4281 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4282 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4283 \extract__addresses__remove__arguments\ false.
4284
4285 If a ::Bcc:: header line is present, it is removed from the message unless
4286 there is no ::To:: or ::Cc::, in which case a ::Bcc:: line with no data is
4287 created. This is necessary for conformity with the original RFC 822 standard;
4288 the requirement has been removed in RFC 2822, but that is still very new.
4289
4290 .index \Resent@-\ header lines||with \-t-\
4291 If there are any \Resent@-\ header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4292 recipients from all ::Resent-To::, ::Resent-Cc::, and ::Resent-Bcc:: header
4293 lines instead of from ::To::, ::Cc::, and ::Bcc::. This is for compatibility
4294 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4295 \-t-\ was used in conjunction with \Resent@-\ header lines.)
4296
4297 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of \Resent@-\ header lines (for when a
4298 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4299 added at the front of the message, and separated by ::Received:: lines. It is
4300 not at all clear how \-t-\ should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4301 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a `set'.
4302 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The \Resent@-\ lines are
4303 often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4304 once, it is common for the original set of \Resent@-\ headers to be renamed as
4305 \X-Resent@-\ when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4306
4307 .option ti
4308 This option is exactly equivalent to \-t-\ \-i-\. It is provided for
4309 compatibility with Sendmail.
4310
4311 .option tls-on-connect
4312 .index TLS||use without STARTTLS
4313 .index TLS||automatic start
4314 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support.
4315 .em
4316 It forces all incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is
4317 listed in the \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ option. See section ~~SECTsupobssmt and
4318 chapter ~~CHAPTLS for further details.
4319 .nem
4320
4321 .option U
4322 .index Sendmail compatibility||\-U-\ option ignored
4323 Sendmail uses this option for `initial message submission', and its
4324 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4325 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4326 set. Exim ignores this option.
4327
4328 .option v
4329 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4330 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4331 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4332 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4333 the log if the setting of \log@_selector\ discards them. Any relevant selectors
4334 are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is unconditional.
4335
4336 .option x
4337 AIX uses \-x-\ for a private purpose (`mail from a local mail program has
4338 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item').
4339 It sets \-x-\ when calling the MTA from its \mail\ command. Exim ignores this
4340 option.
4341
4342 .endoptions
4343
4344
4345
4346 .
4347 .
4348 .
4349 .
4350 . ============================================================================
4351 .chapter The Exim run time configuration file
4352 .set runningfoot "configuration file"
4353 .rset CHAPconf ~~chapter
4354
4355 .index run time configuration
4356 .index configuration file||general description
4357 .index \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\
4358 .index configuration file||errors in
4359 .index error||in configuration file
4360 .index return code||for bad configuration
4361 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4362 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4363 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4364 control.
4365
4366 .em
4367 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4368 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4369 The message is also written to the panic log. \**Note**\: only simple syntax
4370 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4371 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4372 actually alter the string.
4373 .nem
4374
4375
4376 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4377 reasons, and is specified by the \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ compilation option. In
4378 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4379 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4380 existing file in the list.
4381
4382 .index \\EXIM@_USER\\
4383 .index \\EXIM@_GROUP\\
4384 .index \\CONFIGURE@_OWNER\\
4385 .index \\CONFIGURE@_GROUP\\
4386 .index configuration file||ownership
4387 .index ownership||configuration file
4388 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4389 specified at compile time by the \\EXIM@_USER\\ option, or by the user that is
4390 specified at compile time by the \\CONFIGURE@_OWNER\\ option (if set). The
4391 configuration file must not be world-writeable or group-writeable, unless its
4392 group is the one specified at compile time by the \\EXIM@_GROUP\\ option
4393 .em
4394 or by the \\CONFIGURE@_GROUP\\ option.
4395 .nem
4396
4397 \**Warning**\: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4398 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4399 easy way to run commands as root. If you make your mail administrators members
4400 of the Exim group, but do not trust them with root, make sure that the run time
4401 configuration is not group writeable.
4402
4403 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4404 is provided in the file \(src/configure.default)\. If \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\
4405 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4406 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4407 \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4408 ~~CHAPdefconfil is a `walk-through' discussion of the default configuration.
4409
4410
4411 .section Using a different configuration file
4412 .index configuration file||alternate
4413 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the \-C-\ command line
4414 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when \-C-\
4415 is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root or the Exim
4416 user (or unless the argument for \-C-\ is identical to the built-in value from
4417 \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\). \-C-\ is useful mainly for checking the syntax of
4418 configuration files before installing them. No owner or group checks are done
4419 on a configuration file specified by \-C-\.
4420
4421 The privileged use of \-C-\ by the Exim user can be locked out by setting
4422 \\ALT@_CONFIG@_ROOT@_ONLY\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ when building Exim. However,
4423 if you do this, you also lock out the possibility of testing a
4424 configuration using \-C-\ right through message reception and delivery, even if
4425 the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as
4426 the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
4427 use of \-C-\ causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
4428 delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
4429 \-odq-\, and another to do the delivery, using \-M-\).
4430
4431 If \\ALT@_CONFIG@_PREFIX\\ is defined \(in Local/Makefile)\, it specifies a
4432 prefix string with which any file named in a \-C-\ command line option must
4433 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence \"/../"\. There
4434 is no default setting for \\ALT@_CONFIG@_PREFIX\\; when it is unset, any file
4435 name can be used with \-C-\.
4436
4437 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the \-D-\ command line
4438 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4439 configuration file. However, like \-C-\, the use of this option by a
4440 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4441 If \\DISABLE@_D@_OPTION\\ is defined in \(Local/Makefile)\, the use of \-D-\ is
4442 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4443
4444 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4445 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4446 If \\CONFIGURE@_FILE@_USE@_NODE\\ is defined in \(Local/Makefile)\, Exim first
4447 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4448 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the \*uname()*\ function. If this
4449 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4450 each file name in the list given by \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ or \-C-\.
4451
4452 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4453 different effective uids and the \\CONFIGURE@_FILE@_USE@_EUID\\ is defined to
4454 help with this. See the comments in \(src/EDITME)\ for details.
4455
4456
4457 .section Configuration file format
4458 .rset SECTconffilfor "~~chapter.~~section"
4459 .index configuration file||format of
4460 .index format||configuration file
4461 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4462 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4463 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4464 is introduced by the word `begin' followed by the name of the part. The
4465 optional parts are:
4466
4467 .numberpars $.
4468 \*ACL*\: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail.
4469 .nextp
4470 .index \\AUTH\\||configuration
4471 \*authenticators*\: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4472 are concerned with the SMTP \\AUTH\\ command (see chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH).
4473 .nextp
4474 \*routers*\: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4475 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered.
4476 .nextp
4477 \*transports*\: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4478 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations.
4479 .nextp
4480 \*retry*\: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be immediately delivered.
4481 .nextp
4482 \*rewrite*\: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4483 when new addresses are generated during delivery.
4484 .nextp
4485 \*local@_scan*\: Private options for the \*local@_scan()*\ function. If you
4486 want to use this feature, you must set
4487 .display asis
4488 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4489 .endd
4490 in \(Local/Makefile)\ before building Exim. Full details of the
4491 \*local@_scan()*\ facility are given in chapter ~~CHAPlocalscan.
4492 .endp
4493 .index configuration file||leading whitespace in
4494 .index configuration file||trailing whitespace in
4495 .index whitespace||in configuration file
4496 .em
4497 Leading and trailing whitespace in configuration lines is always ignored.
4498 .nem
4499 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a @# character (ignoring
4500 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. \**Note**\: a
4501 @# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4502 and does not introduce a comment.
4503
4504 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash.
4505 .em
4506 Note that the general rule for whitespace means that trailing white space after
4507 the backslash is ignored, and leading white space at the start of continuation
4508 lines is also ignored.
4509 .nem
4510 Comment lines beginning with @# (but not empty lines) may appear in the middle
4511 of a sequence of continuation lines.
4512
4513 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4514 default, which is supplied in \(src/configure.default)\, and add, delete, or
4515 change settings as required.
4516
4517 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4518 described in chapters ~~CHAPACL, ~~CHAPretry, and ~~CHAPrewrite, respectively.
4519 The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic items in common,
4520 and these are described below, from section ~~SECTcos onwards. Before that, the
4521 inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are described.
4522
4523
4524 .section File inclusions in the configuration file
4525 .index inclusions in configuration file
4526 .index configuration file||including other files
4527 .index .include in configuration file
4528 .index .include@_if@_exists in configuration file
4529 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4530 using this syntax:
4531 .display
4532 @.include <<file name>>
4533 .endd
4534 or
4535 .display
4536 @.include@_if@_exists <<file name>>
4537 .endd
4538 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4539 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4540 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4541
4542 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4543 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4544 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4545 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4546
4547 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4548 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4549 for example:
4550 .display asis
4551 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4552 .include /some/file
4553 .endd
4554 Include processing happens
4555 after
4556 macro processing (see below). Its effect is to process the lines of the file as
4557 if they occurred inline where the inclusion appears.
4558
4559
4560 .section Macros in the configuration file
4561 .rset SECTmacrodefs "~~chapter.~~section"
4562 .index macro||description of
4563 .index configuration file||macros
4564 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4565 `begin' line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4566 definition, and must be of the form
4567 .display
4568 <<name>> = <<rest of line>>
4569 .endd
4570 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4571 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4572 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4573 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4574 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4575
4576 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4577 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4578 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which they are defined. The
4579 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4580 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4581 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4582 define
4583 .display asis
4584 ABCD_XYZ = <<something>>
4585 ABCD = <<something else>>
4586 .endd
4587 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4588 error.
4589
4590 Macro expansion is applied to individual lines from the file, before checking
4591 for line continuation or file inclusion (see below). If a line consists solely
4592 of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the line is ignored.
4593 A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a comment line or a
4594 \".include"\ line.
4595
4596 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4597 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4598 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4599 .display asis
4600 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4601 login=${quote_mysql:$local_part};
4602 .endd
4603 This can then be used in a \%redirect%\ router setting like this:
4604 .display asis
4605 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4606 .endd
4607 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4608 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists -- see section
4609 ~~SECTnamedlists.
4610
4611 Macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the \-D-\ command line
4612 option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when \-D-\ is used, unless called
4613 by root or the Exim user.
4614
4615
4616 .section Conditional skips in the configuration file
4617 .index configuration file||conditional skips
4618 .index .ifdef
4619 You can use the directives \".ifdef"\, \".ifndef"\, \".elifdef"\,
4620 \".elifndef"\, \".else"\, and \".endif"\ to dynamically include or exclude
4621 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4622 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4623
4624 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4625 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4626 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4627 line. Thus:
4628 .display
4629 @.ifdef AAA
4630 message@_size@_limit = 50M
4631 @.else
4632 message@_size@_limit = 100M
4633 @.endif
4634 .endd
4635 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro \"AAA"\ is defined, and 100M
4636 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4637 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an `or' condition. To
4638 obtain an `and' condition, you need to use nested \".ifdef"\s.
4639
4640 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4641 it is not very useful, because the condition `there was a macro substitution
4642 in this line' will always be true.
4643
4644 Text following \".else"\ and \".endif"\ is ignored, and can be used as comment
4645 to clarify complicated nestings.
4646
4647
4648 .section Common option syntax
4649 .rset SECTcos "~~chapter.~~section"
4650 .index common option syntax
4651 .index syntax of common options
4652 .index configuration file||common option syntax
4653 For the main set of options, driver options, and \*local@_scan()*\ options,
4654 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4655 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4656 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4657 space) and then the value. For example:
4658 .display asis
4659 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4660 .endd
4661 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4662 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the \-bP-\ command line
4663 option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the word
4664 `hide'. For example:
4665 .display asis
4666 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4667 .endd
4668 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4669 .display asis
4670 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4671 .endd
4672 If `hide' is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on all
4673 instances of the same driver.
4674
4675 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4676 that are found in option settings.
4677
4678 .section Boolean options
4679 .index format||boolean
4680 .index boolean configuration values
4681 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4682 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4683 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4684 if it is preceded by `no@_' or `not@_' the switch is turned off. However,
4685 boolean options may optionally be followed by an equals sign and one of the
4686 words `true', `false', `yes', or `no', as an alternative syntax. For example,
4687 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4688 .display asis
4689 queue_only
4690 queue_only = true
4691 .endd
4692 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4693 .display asis
4694 no_queue_only
4695 queue_only = false
4696 .endd
4697 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4698
4699
4700
4701 .section Integer values
4702 .index integer configuration values
4703 .index format||integer
4704 If an integer data item starts with the characters `0x', the remainder of it
4705 is interpreted as a hexadecimal number. Otherwise, it is treated as octal if it
4706 starts with the digit 0, and decimal if not. If an integer value is followed by
4707 the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if it is followed by the letter M, it
4708 is multiplied by 1024x1024.
4709
4710 When the values of integer option settings are output, values which are an
4711 exact multiple of 1024 or 1024x1024 are
4712 sometimes, but not always,
4713 printed using the letters K and M. The printing style is independent of the
4714 actual input format that was used.
4715
4716 .section Octal integer values
4717 .index integer format
4718 .index format||octal integer
4719 The value of an option specified as an octal integer is always interpreted in
4720 octal, whether or not it starts with the digit zero. Such options are always
4721 output in octal.
4722
4723
4724 .section Fixed point number values
4725 .index fixed point configuration values
4726 .index format||fixed point
4727 A fixed point number consists of a decimal integer, optionally followed by a
4728 decimal point and up to three further digits.
4729
4730
4731 .section Time interval values
4732 .index time interval||specifying in configuration
4733 .index format||time interval
4734 .rset SECTtimeformat "~~chapter.~~section"
4735 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
4736 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
4737 .display rm
4738 .tabs 5
4739 \s\ $t seconds
4740 \m\ $t minutes
4741 \h\ $t hours
4742 \d\ $t days
4743 \w\ $t weeks
4744 .endd
4745 For example, `3h50m' specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
4746 intervals are output in the same format.
4747 Exim does not restrict the values; it is perfectly acceptable, for example, to
4748 specify `90m' instead of `1h30m'.
4749
4750
4751 .section String values
4752 .index string||format of configuration values
4753 .index format||string
4754 .rset SECTstrings "~~chapter.~~section"
4755 If a string data item does not start with a double-quote character, it is taken
4756 as consisting of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines,
4757 starting at the first character after any leading white space, with trailing
4758 white space characters removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in
4759 the string. Because Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with @#) at an
4760 early stage, they can appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The
4761 following settings are therefore equivalent:
4762 .display asis
4763 trusted_users = uucp:mail
4764
4765 trusted_users = uucp:\
4766 # This comment line is ignored
4767 mail
4768 .endd
4769 .index string||quoted
4770 .index escape characters in quoted strings
4771 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
4772 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
4773 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
4774 .display
4775 .tabs 15
4776 @\@\ $t $rm{single backslash}
4777 @\n $t $rm{newline}
4778 @\r $t $rm{carriage return}
4779 @\t $t $rm{tab}
4780 @\<<octal digits>> $t $rm{up to 3 octal digits specify one character}
4781 @\x<<hex digits>> $t $rm{up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one character}
4782 .endd
4783 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
4784 character, that character replaces the pair.
4785
4786 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
4787 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
4788 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
4789 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
4790 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
4791 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
4792
4793 .section Expanded strings
4794 .index string||expansion, definition of
4795 .index expansion||definition of
4796 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to \*string expansion*\,
4797 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
4798 circumstances (see chapter ~~CHAPexpand). The input syntax for such strings is
4799 as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted strings
4800 is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place. However,
4801 backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any backslashes that
4802 are required for that reason must be doubled if they are within a quoted
4803 configuration string.
4804
4805 .section User and group names
4806 .index user name||format of
4807 .index format||user name
4808 .index group||name format
4809 .index format||group name
4810 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
4811 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
4812 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
4813 \*getpwnam()*\ or \*getgrnam()*\ function, as appropriate.
4814
4815 .section List construction
4816 .index list||syntax of in configuration
4817 .index format||list item in configuration
4818 .index string list, definition
4819 .rset SECTlistconstruct "~~chapter.~~section"
4820 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
4821 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type `string list' in
4822 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as `domain list',
4823 `host list', `address list', or `local part list'. Syntactically, they are all
4824 the same; however, those other than `string list' are subject to particular
4825 kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter ~~CHAPdomhosaddlists.
4826
4827 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
4828 input syntax is concerned. The \trusted@_users\ setting in section
4829 ~~SECTstrings above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item in
4830 a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space on
4831 each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
4832 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
4833 example, the list
4834 .display asis
4835 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
4836 .endd
4837 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address
4838 @:@:1.
4839 .index list||separator, changing
4840 .index IPv6||addresses in lists
4841 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
4842 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
4843 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
4844 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
4845 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
4846 .display asis
4847 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
4848 .endd
4849 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
4850 \log@_file@_path\. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
4851 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
4852
4853
4854 .em
4855 .section Empty items in lists
4856 .rset SECTempitelis "~~chapter.~~section"
4857 .index list||empty item in
4858 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
4859 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
4860 .display asis
4861 senders = user@domain :
4862 .endd
4863 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
4864 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
4865 items, the second of which is empty:
4866 .display asis
4867 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
4868 .endd
4869 \**Note**\: there must be whitespace between the two colons, as otherwise they
4870 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
4871 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
4872 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
4873 .display asis
4874 senders = :
4875 .endd
4876 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
4877 is at the end of the list.
4878 .nem
4879
4880
4881 .section Format of driver configurations
4882 .rset SECTfordricon "~~chapter.~~section"
4883 .index drivers||configuration format
4884 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
4885 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
4886 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
4887 a sequence of lines like this:
4888 .display
4889 <<instance name>>:
4890 <<option>>
4891 ...
4892 <<option>>
4893 .endd
4894 In the following example, the instance name is \%localuser%\, and it is
4895 followed by three options settings:
4896 .display asis
4897 localuser:
4898 driver = accept
4899 check_local_user
4900 transport = local_delivery
4901 .endd
4902 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses -- by the
4903 setting of the \driver\ option -- and (optionally) some configuration settings.
4904 For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to deliver with
4905 SMTP you would use the \%smtp%\ driver; if you want to deliver to a local file
4906 you would use the \%appendfile%\ driver. Each of the drivers is described in
4907 detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
4908
4909 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
4910 the same underlying driver (each must have a different name).
4911
4912 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
4913 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
4914 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
4915 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
4916 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
4917 server.
4918
4919 .index generic options
4920 .index options||generic, definition of
4921 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option:
4922 $it{generic} and $it{private}. The generic options are those that apply to all
4923 drivers of the same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all
4924 authenticators).
4925 The \driver\ option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
4926 .index private options
4927 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
4928 they all have default values.
4929
4930 The options may appear in any order, except that the \driver\ option must
4931 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
4932 this reason, it is recommended that \driver\ always be the first option.
4933
4934 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
4935 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
4936 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
4937 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
4938 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
4939 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
4940 configuration lines:
4941 .display asis
4942 remote_smtp:
4943 driver = smtp
4944 .endd
4945 create an instance of the \%smtp%\ transport driver whose name is
4946 \%remote@_smtp%\. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
4947 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
4948 instance of the \%smtp%\ transport, with different options, might be defined
4949 thus:
4950 .display asis
4951 special_smtp:
4952 driver = smtp
4953 port = 1234
4954 command_timeout = 10s
4955 .endd
4956 The names \%remote@_smtp%\ and \%special@_smtp%\ would be used to reference
4957 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
4958 lines.
4959
4960 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
4961 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
4962 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the \-bP-\ command line
4963 option.
4964
4965
4966
4967
4968
4969
4970 .
4971 .
4972 .
4973 .
4974 . ============================================================================
4975 .chapter The default configuration file
4976 .set runningfoot "default configuration"
4977 .rset CHAPdefconfil "~~chapter"
4978 .index configuration file||default, `walk through'
4979 .index default||configuration file `walk through'
4980 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as \(src/configure.default)\
4981 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
4982 the way Exim is configured, this chapter `walks through' the default
4983 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
4984 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
4985 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
4986 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
4987 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
4988
4989
4990 .section Main configuration settings
4991 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
4992 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
4993 the line
4994 .display asis
4995 # primary_hostname =
4996 .endd
4997 This is a commented-out setting of the \primary@_hostname\ option. Exim needs
4998 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
4999 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5000 it is unset, Exim uses the \*uname()*\ system function to obtain the host name.
5001
5002 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5003 .display asis
5004 domainlist local_domains = @
5005 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5006 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5007 .endd
5008 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5009 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5010 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5011 configuration file (see section ~~SECTnamedlists).
5012
5013 The first line defines a domain list called \*local@_domains*\; this is used
5014 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5015 on the local host.
5016 .index @@ in a domain list
5017 There is just one item in this list, the string `@@'. This is a special form of
5018 entry which means `the name of the local host'. Thus, if the local host is
5019 called \*a.host.example*\, mail to \*any.user@@a.host.example*\ is expected to
5020 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5021 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5022
5023 The second line defines a domain list called \*relay@_to@_domains*\, but the
5024 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5025 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5026 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5027 domain is permitted.
5028
5029 The third line defines a host list called \*relay@_from@_hosts*\. This list is
5030 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5031 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5032 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5033 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5034 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5035
5036 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5037 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5038 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5039
5040 The next configuration line is a genuine option setting:
5041 .display asis
5042 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5043 .endd
5044 This option specifies an \*Access Control List*\ (ACL) which is to be used
5045 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every
5046 \\RCPT\\ command). The name of the list is \*acl@_check@_rcpt*\, and we will
5047 come to its definition below, in the ACL section of the configuration. ACLs
5048 control which recipients are accepted for an incoming message -- if a
5049 configuration does not provide an ACL to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be
5050 accepted.
5051
5052 Two commented-out options settings are next:
5053 .display asis
5054 # qualify_domain =
5055 # qualify_recipient =
5056 .endd
5057 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5058 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5059 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set \qualify@_domain\,
5060 the value of \primary@_hostname\ is used. If you set both of these options, you
5061 can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient addresses. If
5062 you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5063
5064 .index domain literal||recognizing format
5065 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5066 addresses of the form \*user@@[10.11.12.13]*\ that is, with a `domain literal'
5067 (an IP address) instead of a named domain.
5068 .display asis
5069 # allow_domain_literals
5070 .endd
5071 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5072 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5073 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5074 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5075 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5076 \*postmaster*\) where domain literals are still useful.
5077
5078 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5079 .display asis
5080 never_users = root
5081 .endd
5082 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5083 convention is to set up \*root*\ as an alias for the system administrator. This
5084 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5085 The list of users specified by \never@_users\ is not, however, the complete
5086 list; the build-time configuration in \(Local/Makefile)\ has an option called
5087 \\FIXED@_NEVER@_USERS\\ specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5088 contents of \never@_users\ are added to this list. By default
5089 \\FIXED@_NEVER@_USERS\\ also specifies root.
5090
5091 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5092 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5093 line,
5094 .display asis
5095 host_lookup = *
5096 .endd
5097 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5098 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5099 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5100 or restrict the lookup to hosts on `nearby' networks.
5101 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5102 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5103 unreachable.
5104
5105 The next two lines are concerned with \*ident*\ callbacks, as defined by RFC
5106 1413 (hence their names):
5107 .display asis
5108 rfc1413_hosts = *
5109 rfc1413_query_timeout = 30s
5110 .endd
5111 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5112 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5113 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5114 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5115 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5116 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5117 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5118
5119 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5120 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5121 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5122 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5123 .display asis
5124 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5125 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5126 .endd
5127 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5128 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5129
5130 The \percent@_hack@_domains\ option is also commented out:
5131 .display asis
5132 # percent_hack_domains =
5133 .endd
5134 It provides a list of domains for which the `percent hack' is to operate. This
5135 is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5136 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5137
5138 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5139 concerned with messages that have been `frozen' on Exim's queue. When a message
5140 is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing occurs when
5141 a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender address of
5142 the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the bounce cannot be
5143 delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there are also other
5144 conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not always bounce
5145 messages.
5146 .display asis
5147 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5148 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5149 .endd
5150 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5151 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5152 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5153 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5154 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5155
5156
5157 .section ACL configuration
5158 .index default||ACLs
5159 .index ~~ACL||default configuration
5160 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5161 It starts with the line
5162 .display asis
5163 begin acl
5164 .endd
5165 and it contains the definition of one ACL called \*acl@_check@_rcpt*\ that was
5166 referenced in the setting of \acl@_smtp@_rcpt\ above.
5167 .index \\RCPT\\||ACL for
5168 This ACL is used for every \\RCPT\\ command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5169 \\RCPT\\ command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5170 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5171 rejected. The \\RCPT\\ command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5172 result of the ACL processing.
5173 .display asis
5174 acl_check_rcpt:
5175 .endd
5176 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5177 ACL, and names it.
5178 .display asis
5179 accept hosts = :
5180 .endd
5181 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5182 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5183 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5184 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message didn't come from a remote
5185 host. The colon is important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can
5186 never match anything.
5187
5188 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5189 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5190 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5191 manner.
5192 .display asis
5193 deny domains = +local_domains
5194 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5195
5196 deny domains = !+local_domains
5197 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5198 .endd
5199 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5200 characters `@@', `%', `!', `/', `|', or dots in unusual places. Although these
5201 characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of `@@' and leading
5202 dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur in Internet mail
5203 addresses.
5204
5205 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5206 addresses (percent is still sometimes used -- see the \percent@_hack@_domains\
5207 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5208 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5209 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5210 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5211 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5212 policy of being as safe as possible.
5213
5214 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5215 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5216 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5217 \*local@_domains*\ domain list. The `+' character is used to indicate a
5218 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5219 \*local@_domains*\, but in general there may be many.
5220
5221 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5222 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain `@@', `%', `!', `/', or `|'.
5223 If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will have to
5224 modify this rule.
5225
5226 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5227 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider local
5228 parts constructed as `first-initial.second-initial.family-name' when applied to
5229 someone like the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local
5230 part starting with a dot or containing `/../' can cause trouble if it is used
5231 as part of a file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for
5232 local parts that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the
5233 local part is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5234
5235 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5236 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5237 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5238 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5239 local part. However, the sequence `/../' is barred. The use of `@@', `%', and
5240 `!' is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users (or
5241 your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5242
5243 .display asis
5244 accept local_parts = postmaster
5245 domains = +local_domains
5246 .endd
5247 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5248 local part is \*postmaster*\ and the domain is one of those listed in the
5249 \*local@_domains*\ domain list. The `+' character is used to indicate a
5250 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5251 \*local@_domains*\, but in general there may be many.
5252
5253 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5254 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5255 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5256 .display asis
5257 require verify = sender
5258 .endd
5259 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5260 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5261 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5262 see if a
5263 bounce
5264 message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote addresses, basic
5265 verification checks only the domain, but \*callouts*\ can be used for more
5266 verification if required. Section ~~SECTaddressverification discusses the
5267 details of address verification.
5268
5269 .display asis
5270 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address is \
5271 # in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5272 # $dnslist_text
5273 # dnslists = black.list.example
5274 #
5275 # warn message = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is \
5276 # in a black list at $dnslist_domain
5277 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5278 # dnslists = black.list.example
5279 .endd
5280 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5281 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5282 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second merely inserts a warning header
5283 line.
5284
5285 .display asis
5286 accept domains = +local_domains
5287 endpass
5288 message = unknown user
5289 verify = recipient
5290 .endd
5291 This statement accepts the incoming recipient address if its domain is one of
5292 the local domains, but only if the address can be verified. Verification of
5293 local addresses normally checks both the local part and the domain. The
5294 \endpass\ line needs some explanation: if the condition above \endpass\ fails,
5295 that is, if the address is not in a local domain, control is passed to the next
5296 ACL statement. However, if the condition below \endpass\ fails, that is, if a
5297 recipient in a local domain cannot be verified, access is denied and the
5298 recipient is rejected.
5299 .index customizing||ACL failure message
5300 The \message\ modifier provides a customized error message for the failure.
5301 .display asis
5302 accept domains = +relay_to_domains
5303 endpass
5304 message = unrouteable address
5305 verify = recipient
5306 .endd
5307 This statement accepts the incoming recipient address if its domain is one of
5308 the domains for which this host is a relay, but again, only if the address can
5309 be verified.
5310 .display asis
5311 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5312 .endd
5313 Control reaches this statement only if the recipient's domain is neither a
5314 local domain, nor a relay domain. The statement accepts the address if the
5315 message is coming from one of the hosts that are defined as being allowed to
5316 relay through this host. Recipient verification is omitted here, because in
5317 many cases the clients are dumb MUAs that do not cope well with SMTP error
5318 responses. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should probably add
5319 recipient verification here.
5320 .display asis
5321 accept authenticated = *
5322 .endd
5323 Control reaches here for attempts to relay to arbitrary domains from arbitrary
5324 hosts. The statement accepts the address only if the client host has
5325 authenticated itself. The default configuration does not define any
5326 authenticators, which means that no client can in fact authenticate. You will
5327 need to add authenticator definitions if you want to make use of this ACL
5328 statement.
5329 .display asis
5330 deny message = relay not permitted
5331 .endd
5332 The final statement denies access, giving a specific error message. Reaching
5333 the end of the ACL also causes access to be denied, but with the generic
5334 message `administrative prohibition'.
5335
5336
5337 .section Router configuration
5338 .index default||routers
5339 .index routers||default
5340 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5341 by the line
5342 .display asis
5343 begin routers
5344 .endd
5345 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5346 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5347 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5348 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5349 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5350
5351 .index domain literal||default router
5352 .display asis
5353 # domain_literal:
5354 # driver = ipliteral
5355 # domains = !+local_domains
5356 # transport = remote_smtp
5357 .endd
5358 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5359 support domain literal addresses (those of the form \*user@@[10.9.8.7]*\). If
5360 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5361 \allow@_domain@_literals\ in the main part of the configuration.
5362
5363 .display asis
5364 dnslookup:
5365 driver = dnslookup
5366 domains = ! +local_domains
5367 transport = remote_smtp
5368 .newline
5369 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5370 .newline
5371 no_more
5372 .endd
5373 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5374 domains. This is specified by the line
5375 .display asis
5376 domains = ! +local_domains
5377 .endd
5378 The \domains\ option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5379 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5380 that are not in the domain list called \*local@_domains*\ (which was defined at
5381 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before \*local@_domains*\
5382 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5383 passed on to the following routers.
5384
5385 The name of the router driver is \%dnslookup%\,
5386 and is specified by the \driver\ option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5387 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5388 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the \driver\ option must be one
5389 of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5390
5391 The \%dnslookup%\ router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5392 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5393 router succeeds, the address is queued for the \%remote@_smtp%\ transport, as
5394 specified by the \transport\ option. If the router does not find the domain in
5395 the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the \no@_more\ setting, so the
5396 address fails and is bounced.
5397
5398 The \ignore@_target@_hosts\ option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5399 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5400 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5401 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5402 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5403 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5404 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5405 out.
5406 .display asis
5407 system_aliases:
5408 driver = redirect
5409 allow_fail
5410 allow_defer
5411 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5412 # user = exim
5413 file_transport = address_file
5414 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5415 .endd
5416 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5417 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5418 alias in the \(/etc/aliases)\ file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5419 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5420 the value of the \data\ option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5421 the next router.
5422
5423 \(/etc/aliases)\ is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5424 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5425 file. However, you can change this by setting \\SYSTEM@_ALIASES@_FILE\\ in
5426 \(Local/Makefile)\ before building Exim.
5427
5428 .display asis
5429 userforward:
5430 driver = redirect
5431 check_local_user
5432 file = $home/.forward
5433 no_verify
5434 no_expn
5435 check_ancestor
5436 # allow_filter
5437 file_transport = address_file
5438 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5439 reply_transport = address_reply
5440 .endd
5441 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5442 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5443 individual users. The \check@_local@_user\ setting means that the first thing it
5444 does is to check that the local part of the address is the login name of a
5445 local user. If it is not, the router is skipped. When a local user is found,
5446 the file called \(.forward)\ in the user's home directory is consulted. If it
5447 does not exist, or is empty, the router declines. Otherwise, the contents of
5448 \(.forward)\ are interpreted as redirection data (see chapter ~~CHAPredirect
5449 for more details).
5450
5451 .index Sieve filter||enabling in default router
5452 Traditional \(.forward)\ files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5453 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if \allow@_filter\ is set (it is
5454 commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set of
5455 Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with `@#Exim
5456 filter' or `@#Sieve filter', respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5457 separate document entitled \*Exim's interfaces to mail filtering*\.
5458
5459 The \no@_verify\ and \no@_expn\ options mean that this router is skipped when
5460 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP \\EXPN\\
5461 command.
5462 There are two reasons for doing this:
5463 .numberpars
5464 Whether or not a local user has a \(.forward)\ file is not really relevant when
5465 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5466 unnecessary work.
5467 .nextp
5468 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an \\EXPN\\
5469 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5470 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5471 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' \(.forward)\ files at
5472 this time.
5473 .endp
5474
5475 The setting of \check@_ancestor\ prevents the router from generating a new
5476 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5477 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5478 forwarding -- see section ~~SECTredlocmai).
5479
5480 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5481 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5482 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a \(.forward)\ file contains
5483 .display asis
5484 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5485 .endd
5486 the delivery to \(/home/spqr/archive)\ is done by running the \address@_file\
5487 transport.
5488 .display asis
5489 localuser:
5490 driver = accept
5491 check_local_user
5492 transport = local_delivery
5493 .endd
5494 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5495 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and queuing it for
5496 the \%local@_delivery%\ transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5497 routers, so the address is bounced.
5498
5499
5500 .section Transport configuration
5501 .index default||transports
5502 .index transports||default
5503 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5504 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5505 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5506 .display asis
5507 begin transports
5508 .endd
5509 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5510 .display asis
5511 remote_smtp:
5512 driver = smtp
5513 .endd
5514 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5515 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5516 .display asis
5517 local_delivery:
5518 driver = appendfile
5519 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5520 delivery_date_add
5521 envelope_to_add
5522 return_path_add
5523 # group = mail
5524 # mode = 0660
5525 .endd
5526 This \%appendfile%\ transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5527 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5528 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the \(/var/mail)\
5529 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5530 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5531 show how this can be done.
5532
5533 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: ::Delivery-date::,
5534 ::Envelope-to:: and ::Return-path::. This action is requested by the three
5535 similarly-named options above.
5536 .display asis
5537 address_pipe:
5538 driver = pipe
5539 return_output
5540 .endd
5541 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5542 redirection (aliasing or users' \(.forward)\ files). The \return@_output\
5543 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5544 sender.
5545 .display asis
5546 address_file:
5547 driver = appendfile
5548 delivery_date_add
5549 envelope_to_add
5550 return_path_add
5551 .endd
5552 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5553 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5554 \%appendfile%\, because it comes from the \%redirect%\ router.
5555 .display asis
5556 address_reply:
5557 driver = autoreply
5558 .endd
5559 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5560 filter files.
5561
5562
5563 .section Default retry rule
5564 .index retry||default rule
5565 .index default||retry rule
5566 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5567 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5568 introduced by the line
5569 .display asis
5570 begin retry
5571 .endd
5572 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5573 errors:
5574 .display asis
5575 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5576 .endd
5577 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
5578 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
5579 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5580 is not delivered after 4 days of failure, it is bounced.
5581
5582
5583 .section Rewriting configuration
5584 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5585 .display asis
5586 begin rewrite
5587 .endd
5588 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5589 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5590
5591
5592 .section Authenticators configuration
5593 .index \\AUTH\\||configuration
5594 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5595 .display asis
5596 begin authenticators
5597 .endd
5598 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP \\AUTH\\ command. No authenticators
5599 are specified in the default configuration file.
5600
5601
5602
5603 .
5604 .
5605 .
5606 .
5607 . ============================================================================
5608 .chapter Regular expressions
5609 .set runningfoot "regular expressions"
5610 .rset CHAPregexp ~~chapter
5611
5612 .index regular expressions||library
5613 .index PCRE
5614 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
5615 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
5616 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
5617 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
5618 Jeffrey Friedl's
5619 .if ~~html
5620 [(A HREF="http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex/")]
5621 .fi
5622 $it{Mastering Regular Expressions}
5623 .if ~~html
5624 [(/A)]
5625 .fi
5626 (O'Reilly, ISBN 0-596-00289-0).
5627
5628 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
5629 are supported by PCRE is included in plain text in the file
5630 \(doc/pcrepattern.txt)\ in the Exim distribution, and also in the HTML
5631 tarbundle of Exim documentation, and as an appendix to the
5632 .if ~~html
5633 [(A HREF="http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/")]
5634 .fi
5635 Exim book.
5636 .if ~~html
5637 [(/A)]
5638 .fi
5639 It describes in detail the features of the regular expressions that PCRE
5640 supports, so no further description is included here. The PCRE functions are
5641 called from Exim using the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE
5642 options set), except that the \\PCRE@_CASELESS\\ option is set when the
5643 matching is required to be case-insensitive.
5644
5645 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
5646 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
5647 or an `ends with' wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
5648 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
5649 .display asis
5650 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
5651 .endd
5652 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
5653 precedes interpretation -- see section ~~SECTlittext for more discussion of
5654 this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
5655 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
5656 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
5657 normal effect of `anchoring' it to the start of the string that is being
5658 matched.
5659
5660 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
5661 recognition of a regular expression: these are the \match\ condition in a
5662 string expansion, and the \matches\ condition in an Exim filter file. In these
5663 cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if it
5664 does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can match
5665 anywhere in the subject string.
5666
5667 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
5668 you must code the @$ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
5669 .display asis
5670 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
5671 .endd
5672 matches the domain \*123.example*\, but it also matches \*123.example.com*\.
5673 You need to use:
5674 .display asis
5675 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
5676 .endd
5677 if you want \*example*\ to be the top-level domain. (The backslash before the
5678 @$ is another artefact of string expansion.)
5679
5680
5681 .section Testing regular expressions
5682 .index testing||regular expressions
5683 .index regular expressions||testing
5684 .index \*pcretest*\
5685 A program called \*pcretest*\ forms part of the PCRE distribution and is built
5686 with PCRE during the process of building Exim. It is primarily intended for
5687 testing PCRE itself, but it can also be used for experimenting with regular
5688 expressions. After building Exim, the binary can be found in the build
5689 directory (it is not installed anywhere automatically). There is documentation
5690 of various options in \(doc/pcretest.txt)\, but for simple testing, none are
5691 needed. This is the output of a sample run of \*pcretest*\:
5692 .display
5693 re> $cb{/^([^@@]+)@@.+@\.(ac|edu)@\.(?!kr)[a-z]@{2@}@$/}
5694 data> $cb{x@@y.ac.uk}
5695 0: x@@y.ac.uk
5696 1: x
5697 2: ac
5698 data> $cb{x@@y.ac.kr}
5699 No match
5700 data> $cb{x@@y.edu.com}
5701 No match
5702 data> $cb{x@@y.edu.co}
5703 0: x@@y.edu.co
5704 1: x
5705 2: edu
5706 .endd
5707 .if ~~sys.fancy
5708 Input typed by the user is shown in bold face.
5709 .fi
5710 After the `re>' prompt, a regular expression enclosed in delimiters is
5711 expected. If this compiles without error, `data>' prompts are given for strings
5712 against which the expression is matched. An empty data line causes a new
5713 regular expression to be read. If the match is successful, the captured
5714 substring values (that is, what would be in the variables \$0$\, \$1$\, \$2$\,
5715 etc.) are shown. The above example tests for an email address whose domain ends
5716 with either `ac' or `edu' followed by a two-character top-level domain that is
5717 not `kr'. The local part is captured in \$1$\ and the `ac' or `edu' in \$2$\.
5718
5719
5720
5721
5722
5723
5724 .
5725 .
5726 .
5727 .
5728 . ============================================================================
5729 .chapter File and database lookups
5730 .set runningfoot "file/database lookups"
5731 .rset CHAPfdlookup "~~chapter"
5732 .index file||lookup
5733 .index database lookups
5734 .index lookup||description of
5735 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
5736 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
5737 .numberpars
5738 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
5739 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
5740 lookup.
5741 .nextp
5742 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
5743 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
5744 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
5745 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
5746 chapter ~~CHAPdomhosaddlists.
5747 .endp
5748 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
5749 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
5750 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
5751 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
5752 .display asis
5753 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
5754 domains = lsearch;/some/file
5755 .endd
5756 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
5757 String expansions are described in detail in chapter ~~CHAPexpand. The
5758 expansion takes place first, and the file that is searched could contain lines
5759 like this:
5760 .display asis
5761 192.168.3.4: domain1 : domain2 : ...
5762 192.168.1.9: domain3 : domain4 : ...
5763 .endd
5764 Thus, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and possibly other
5765 types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
5766
5767 In the second case, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
5768 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
5769 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
5770 .display asis
5771 domain1:
5772 domain2:
5773 .endd
5774 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
5775 matches the list item.
5776
5777 It is possible to use both kinds of lookup at once. Consider a file containing
5778 lines like this:
5779 .display asis
5780 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
5781 .endd
5782 If the value of \$sender@_host@_address$\ is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
5783 first \domains\ setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
5784 causes a second lookup to occur.
5785
5786 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
5787 available. Any of them can be used in either of the circumstances described
5788 above. The syntax requirements for the two cases are described in chapters
5789 ~~CHAPexpand and ~~CHAPdomhosaddlists, respectively.
5790
5791 .section Lookup types
5792 .index lookup||types of
5793 .index single-key lookup||definition of
5794 Two different styles of data lookup are implemented:
5795 .numberpars $.
5796 The \*single-key*\ style requires the specification of a file in which to look,
5797 and a single key to search for.
5798 .em
5799 The key must be a non-empty string for the lookup to succeed.
5800 .nem
5801 The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
5802 .nextp
5803 .index query-style lookup||definition of
5804 The \*query*\ style accepts a generalized database query.
5805 No particular key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can
5806 use whichever Exim variable(s) you need to construct the database query.
5807 .endp
5808 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
5809 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
5810 default settings in \(src/EDITME)\ are:
5811 .display asis
5812 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
5813 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
5814 .endd
5815 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
5816 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
5817 libraries and header files before building Exim.
5818
5819
5820
5821 .section Single-key lookup types
5822 .rset SECTsinglekeylookups "~~chapter.~~section"
5823 .index lookup||single-key types
5824 .index single-key lookup||list of types
5825 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
5826 .numberpars $.
5827 .index cdb||description of
5828 .index lookup||cdb
5829 .index binary zero||in lookup key
5830 \%cdb%\: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
5831 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
5832 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
5833 re-creation. As such, it is particulary suitable for large files containing
5834 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
5835 be found in several places:
5836 .display rm
5837 \?http://www.pobox.com/@~djb/cdb.html?\
5838 \?ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/?\
5839 \?http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html?\
5840 .endd
5841 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
5842 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
5843 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
5844 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
5845 .nextp
5846 .index DBM||lookup type
5847 .index lookup||dbm
5848 .index binary zero||in lookup key
5849 \%dbm%\: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
5850 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
5851 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
5852 ~~SECTdb for a discussion of DBM libraries.
5853 .index Berkeley DB library||file format
5854 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the \\DB@_HASH\\ style of database
5855 when building DBM files using the \exim@_dbmbuild\ utility. However, when using
5856 Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with the
5857 \\DB@_UNKNOWN\\ option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
5858 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
5859 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, \\DB@_HASH\\ is always used.)
5860
5861 .nextp
5862 .index lookup||dbmnz
5863 .index lookup||dbm, terminating zero
5864 .index binary zero||in lookup key
5865 .index Courier
5866 .index \(/etc/userdbshadow.dat)\
5867 .index dmbnz lookup type
5868 \%dbmnz%\: This is the same as \%dbm%\, except that a terminating binary zero
5869 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
5870 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
5871 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
5872 use \%dbmnz%\ rather than \%dbm%\ if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
5873 calls using the passwords from Courier's \(/etc/userdbshadow.dat)\ file. Exim's
5874 utility program for creating DBM files (\*exim@_dbmbuild*\) includes the zeros
5875 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section ~~SECTdbmbuild).
5876 .nextp
5877 .index lookup||dsearch
5878 .index dsearch lookup type
5879 \%dsearch%\: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for a file
5880 whose name is the key. The key may not contain any forward slash characters.
5881 The result of a successful lookup is the name of the file. An example of how
5882 this lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
5883 ~~SECTvirtualdomains.
5884 .nextp
5885 .index lookup||iplsearch
5886 .index iplsearch lookup type
5887 \%iplsearch%\: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
5888 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
5889 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
5890 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
5891 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
5892 .display asis
5893 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
5894 192.168.0.0/16 data for 192.168.0.0/16
5895 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
5896 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
5897 .endd
5898 The key for an \%iplsearch%\ lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
5899 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
5900 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
5901 `best' match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
5902 \%iplsearch%\ is the same as for \%lsearch%\.
5903
5904 \**Warning 1**\: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
5905 \%iplsearch%\ can \*not*\ be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
5906 lookup types support only literal keys.
5907
5908 \**Warning 2**\: In a host list, you must always use \%net-iplsearch%\ so that
5909 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
5910 ~~SECThoslispatsikey).
5911
5912 .nextp
5913 .index linear search
5914 .index lookup||lsearch
5915 .index lsearch lookup type
5916 \%lsearch%\: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
5917 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
5918 end of the line. The first occurrence that is found in the file is used. White
5919 space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the line,
5920 with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
5921 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
5922 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
5923 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
5924 colon, for example:
5925 .display
5926 baduser: :fail:
5927 .endd
5928 Empty lines and lines beginning with @# are ignored, even if they occur in the
5929 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
5930 that the keys in an \%lsearch%\ file are literal strings. There is no
5931 wildcarding of any kind.
5932
5933 .index lookup||lsearch, colons in keys
5934 .index whitespace||in lsearch key
5935 In most \%lsearch%\ files, keys are not required to contain colons or @#
5936 characters, or whitespace. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
5937 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
5938 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
5939 contents (see section ~~SECTstrings). An optional colon is permitted after
5940 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
5941 quotes for the data part of an \%lsearch%\ line.
5942 .nextp
5943 .index NIS lookup type
5944 .index lookup||NIS
5945 .index binary zero||in lookup key
5946 \%nis%\: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
5947 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
5948 \%nis0%\ which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
5949 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
5950 aliases; the full map names must be used.
5951 .nextp
5952 .index wildlsearch lookup type
5953 .index lookup||wildlsearch
5954 .index nwildlsearch lookup type
5955 .index lookup||nwildlsearch
5956 \%wildlsearch%\ or \%nwildlsearch%\: These search a file linearly, like
5957 \%lsearch%\, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key may
5958 be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is that for
5959 \%wildlsearch%\, each key in the file is string-expanded before being used,
5960 whereas for \%nwildlsearch%\, no expansion takes place.
5961
5962 Like \%lsearch%\, the testing is done case-insensitively. The following forms
5963 of wildcard are recognized:
5964 .numberpars "$*$"
5965 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean `ends with'. For example:
5966 .display asis
5967 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
5968 *fish data for anythingfish
5969 .endd
5970 .nextp
5971 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
5972 example, for \%wildlsearch%\:
5973 .display asis
5974 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
5975 .endd
5976 Note the use of \"@\N"\ to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
5977 expression. If you are using \%nwildlsearch%\, where the keys are not
5978 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
5979 .display asis
5980 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
5981 .endd
5982
5983 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
5984 either quote it (see \%lsearch%\ above), or represent these characters in other
5985 ways. For example, \"@\s"\ can be used for white space and \"@\x3A"\ for a
5986 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
5987 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
5988 .nextp
5989 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function
5990 that is used to implement
5991 \%(n)wildlsearch%\
5992 means that the string may begin with a lookup name terminated by a semicolon,
5993 and followed by lookup data. For example:
5994 .display asis
5995 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
5996 .endd
5997 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
5998 .endp
5999 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6000 continuation rules for the data are the same as for \%lsearch%\, and keys may
6001 be followed by optional colons.
6002
6003 \**Warning**\: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6004 \%(n)wildlsearch%\ can \*not*\ be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6005 lookup types support only literal keys.
6006 .endp
6007
6008 .section Query-style lookup types
6009 .index lookup||query-style types
6010 .index query-style lookup||list of types
6011 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6012 many of them are given in later sections.
6013 .numberpars $.
6014 .index DNS||as a lookup type
6015 .index lookup||DNS
6016 \%dnsdb%\: This does a DNS search for
6017 .em
6018 one or more records whose domain names are given in the supplied query. The
6019 resulting data is the contents of the records.
6020 .nem
6021 See section ~~SECTdnsdb.
6022 .nextp
6023 .index Interbase lookup type
6024 .index lookup||Interbase
6025 \%ibase%\: This does a lookup in an Interbase database.
6026 .nextp
6027 .index LDAP||lookup type
6028 .index lookup||LDAP
6029 \%ldap%\: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6030 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called \%ldapm%\
6031 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6032 called \%ldapdn%\ returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6033 any attribute values. See section ~~SECTldap.
6034 .nextp
6035 .index MySQL||lookup type
6036 .index lookup||MySQL
6037 \%mysql%\: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a MySQL
6038 database. See section ~~SECTsql.
6039 .nextp
6040 .index NIS@+ lookup type
6041 .index lookup||NIS+
6042 \%nisplus%\: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6043 the field to be returned. See section ~~SECTnisplus.
6044 .nextp
6045 .index Oracle||lookup type
6046 .index lookup||Oracle
6047 \%oracle%\: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6048 Oracle database. See section ~~SECTsql.
6049 .nextp
6050 .index lookup||passwd
6051 .index passwd lookup type
6052 .index \(/etc/passwd)\
6053 \%passwd%\ is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6054 lookup calls \*getpwnam()*\ to interrogate the system password data, and on
6055 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an \%lsearch%\
6056 lookup on a traditional \(/etc/passwd file)\, though with \"*"\ for the
6057 password value. For example:
6058 .display asis
6059 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6060 .endd
6061 .nextp
6062 .index PostgreSQL lookup type
6063 .index lookup||PostgreSQL
6064 \%pgsql%\: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6065 PostgreSQL database. See section ~~SECTsql.
6066 .nextp
6067 \%testdb%\: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6068 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6069 .nextp
6070 .index whoson lookup type
6071 .index lookup||whoson
6072 \%whoson%\: \*Whoson*\ (\?http://whoson.sourceforge.net?\) is a proposed
6073 Internet protocol that allows Internet server programs to check whether a
6074 particular (dynamically allocated) IP address is currently allocated to a known
6075 (trusted) user and, optionally, to obtain the identity of the said user. In
6076 Exim, this can be used to implement `POP before SMTP' checking using ACL
6077 statements such as
6078 .display asis
6079 require condition = \
6080 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6081 .endd
6082 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6083 the authenticated user.
6084 .endp
6085
6086 .section Temporary errors in lookups
6087 .index lookup||temporary error in
6088 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6089 completed. For example, a NIS or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6090 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6091 options such as a list of local domains.
6092
6093 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6094 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6095 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6096 or may give up altogether.
6097
6098
6099 .section Default values in single-key lookups
6100 .rset SECTdefaultvaluelookups "~~chapter.~~section"
6101 .index wildcard lookups
6102 .index lookup||default values
6103 .index lookup||wildcard
6104 .index lookup||$*$ added to type
6105 .index default||in single-key lookups
6106 In this context, a `default value' is a value specified by the administrator
6107 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6108
6109 If `$*$' is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, \lsearch$*$\) and
6110 the initial lookup fails, the key `$*$' is looked up in the file to provide
6111 a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6112
6113 .index @*@@ with single-key lookup
6114 .index lookup||$*$@@ added to type
6115 .index alias file||per-domain default
6116 Alternatively, if `$*$@@' is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6117 \dbm$*$@@\) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @@
6118 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @@ replaced
6119 by $*$. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6120 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6121 take place because there is no @@ in the key), `$*$' is looked up.
6122 For example, a \%redirect%\ router might contain:
6123 .display asis
6124 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mixed-aliases}}
6125 .endd
6126 Suppose the address that is being processed is \*jane@@eyre.example*\. Exim
6127 looks up these keys, in this order:
6128 .display asis
6129 jane@eyre.example
6130 *@eyre.example
6131 *
6132 .endd
6133 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. \**Note**\: in an
6134 \%lsearch%\ file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6135 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6136 Exim move on to try the next key.
6137
6138
6139 .section Partial matching in single-key lookups
6140 .rset SECTpartiallookup "~~chapter.~~section"
6141 .index partial matching
6142 .index wildcard lookups
6143 .index lookup||partial matching
6144 .index lookup||wildcard
6145 .index asterisk||in search type
6146 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6147 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6148 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6149 information in the file that has a key starting with `$*$.' is matched by any
6150 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6151 a key in a DBM file is
6152 .display
6153 *.dates.fict.example
6154 .endd
6155 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6156 \*2001.dates.fict.example*\ and \*1984.dates.fict.example*\. It is also matched
6157 by \*dates.fict.example*\, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6158 file.
6159
6160 \**Note**\: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6161 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6162 ~~SECTaddresslist).
6163
6164 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6165 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6166 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6167 partial matching keys
6168 beginning with a special prefix (default `$*$.') are included in the data file.
6169 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6170 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6171
6172 Partial matching is requested by adding the string `partial-' to the front of
6173 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, \partial-dbm\. When this is
6174 done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, `$*$.'
6175 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6176 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed
6177 from the start of the subject key, one-by-one, and `$*$.' added on the front of
6178 what remains.
6179
6180 A minimum number of two non-$*$ components are required. This can be adjusted
6181 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6182 \partial3-lsearch\ specifies a minimum of three non-$*$ components in the
6183 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to `partial2-'. If the subject
6184 key is \*2250.dates.fict.example*\ then the following keys are looked up when
6185 the minimum number of non-$*$ components is two:
6186 .display asis
6187 2250.dates.fict.example
6188 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6189 *.dates.fict.example
6190 *.fict.example
6191 .endd
6192 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6193 finishes.
6194
6195 .index lookup||partial matching, changing prefix
6196 .index prefix||for partial matching
6197 The use of `$*$.' as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6198 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6199 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6200 parentheses instead of the hyphen after `partial'. For example:
6201 .display asis
6202 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6203 .endd
6204 In this example, if the domain is \*a.b.c*\, the sequence of lookups is
6205 \"a.b.c"\, \".a.b.c"\, and \".b.c"\ (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6206 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6207 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6208 .display asis
6209 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6210 .endd
6211 For this example, if the domain is \*a.b.c*\, the sequence of lookups is
6212 \"a.b.c"\, \"b.c"\, and \"c"\.
6213
6214 If `partial0' is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with just
6215 one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right down
6216 to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6217 .numberpars $.
6218 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6219 .nextp
6220 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6221 example, the final lookup for `partial0(.)' is for \"."\ alone.
6222 .nextp
6223 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6224 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6225 for `$*$' on its own.
6226 .nextp
6227 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6228 .endp
6229
6230 If the search type ends in `$*$' or `$*$@@' (see section
6231 ~~SECTdefaultvaluelookups above), the search for an ultimate default that this
6232 implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If `partial0' is
6233 specified, adding `$*$' to the search type has no effect with the default
6234 prefix, because the `$*$' key is already included in the sequence of partial
6235 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6236 `partial0(.)lsearch$*$'.
6237
6238 The use of `$*$' in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6239 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6240 dot-separated components; a key such as \"*fict.example"\
6241 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6242 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6243
6244
6245
6246 .section Lookup caching
6247 .index lookup||caching
6248 .index caching||lookup data
6249 .em
6250 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6251 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6252 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6253 single Exim process. There is no inter-process caching facility.
6254
6255 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6256 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6257 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6258 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6259 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6260 own internal limit, which can be changed via the \lookup@_open@_max\ option.
6261
6262 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6263 strategic points during delivery -- for example, after all routing is complete.
6264 .nem
6265
6266
6267 .section Quoting lookup data
6268 .index lookup||quoting
6269 .index quoting||in lookups
6270 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6271 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6272 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6273 .display asis
6274 [name=$local_part]
6275 .endd
6276 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6277 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6278 .display asis
6279 [name="$local_part"]
6280 .endd
6281 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6282 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6283 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6284 of the following form is provided:
6285 .display
6286 @$@{quote@_<<lookup-type>>:<<string>>@}
6287 .endd
6288 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6289 .display asis
6290 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6291 .endd
6292 See chapter ~~CHAPexpand for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6293 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6294 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6295
6296
6297
6298 .section More about dnsdb
6299 .rset SECTdnsdb "~~chapter.~~section"
6300 .index dnsdb lookup
6301 .index lookup||dnsdb
6302 .index DNS||as a lookup type
6303 The \%dnsdb%\ lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6304 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6305 an expansion string could contain:
6306 .display asis
6307 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6308 .endd
6309 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6310 when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6311 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6312 .em
6313 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6314 \in-addr.arpa\ or \ip6.arpa\ happens automatically. For example:
6315 .display asis
6316 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6317 .endd
6318 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6319 altered and nothing is added.
6320
6321 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6322 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6323 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6324 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6325 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6326 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6327 .display asis
6328 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6329 .endd
6330 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6331 whitespace is ignored.
6332
6333 .index SRV record||in \%dnsdb%\ lookup
6334 For SRV records, the priority, weight, port, and host name are returned for
6335 each record, separated by spaces.
6336
6337 .index MX record||in \%dnsdb%\ lookup
6338 For MX records, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6339 each record, separated by a space. However, if you want only host names, you
6340 can use the pseudo-type MXH:
6341 .display asis
6342 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6343 .endd
6344 In this case, the preference values are omitted.
6345
6346 .index name server||for enclosing domain
6347 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for `zone NS'). It performs a lookup for NS
6348 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6349 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6350 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6351 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6352 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6353 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6354 .display asis
6355 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6356 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6357 .endd
6358 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6359 the first returns the name servers for \quercite.com\, and the second returns
6360 the name servers for \edu\.
6361
6362 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6363 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6364 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6365 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6366 for the high-level domains such as \com\ or \co.uk\ are not going to be on such
6367 a list.
6368
6369 .nem
6370
6371 .em
6372 .section Multiple dnsdb lookups
6373 In the previous section, \%dnsdb%\ lookups for a single domain are described.
6374 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6375 \%dnsdb%\ lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6376 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6377 .display asis
6378 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6379 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6380 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6381 .endd
6382 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6383 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6384 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6385 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6386
6387 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6388 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6389 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6390
6391 The \%dnsdb%\ lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6392 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6393 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6394 type. The possible keywords are `defer@_strict', `defer@_never', and
6395 `defer@_lax'. With `strict' behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6396 whole lookup to defer. With `never' behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6397 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6398 With `lax' behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6399 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6400 succeed. The default is `lax', so the following lookups are equivalent:
6401 .display asis
6402 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6403 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6404 .endd
6405 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6406 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6407 .nem
6408
6409
6410 .section More about LDAP
6411 .rset SECTldap "~~chapter.~~section"
6412 .index LDAP lookup
6413 .index lookup||LDAP
6414 .index Solaris||LDAP
6415 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6416 become `Open LDAP', and there are now two different releases. Another
6417 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6418 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6419 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6420 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6421 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6422 your \(Local/Makefile)\:
6423 .display asis
6424 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6425 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6426 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6427 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6428 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6429 .endd
6430 If \\LDAP@_LIB@_TYPE\\ is not set, Exim assumes \"OPENLDAP1"\, which has the
6431 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6432
6433 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6434 the way they handle the results of a query:
6435 .numberpars $.
6436 \%ldap%\ requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6437 gives an error.
6438 .nextp
6439 \%ldapdn%\ also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6440 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6441 .nextp
6442 \%ldapm%\ permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes from
6443 all of them are returned.
6444 .endp
6445
6446 For \%ldap%\ and \%ldapm%\, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6447 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6448 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6449 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6450
6451 .section Format of LDAP queries
6452 .rset SECTforldaque "~~chapter.~~section"
6453 .index LDAP||query format
6454 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6455 the configuration of a \%redirect%\ router one might have this setting:
6456 .display asis
6457 data = ${lookup ldap \
6458 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6459 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6460 .endd
6461 .index LDAP||with TLS
6462 The URL may begin with \"ldap"\ or \"ldaps"\ if your LDAP library supports
6463 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6464 encrypted TLS connection is used.
6465
6466 .section LDAP quoting
6467 .index LDAP||quoting
6468 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6469 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6470 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6471 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6472
6473 The \quote@_ldap\ operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6474 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6475 the string:
6476 .display asis
6477 * => \2A
6478 ( => \28
6479 ) => \29
6480 \ => \5C
6481 .endd
6482 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6483 to the rules for URLs, that is, all characters except
6484 .display asis
6485 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
6486 .endd
6487 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6488 .display asis
6489 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6490 .endd
6491 yields
6492 .display asis
6493 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6494 .endd
6495 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6496 .display asis
6497 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6498 .endd
6499
6500 The \quote@_ldap@_dn\ operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6501 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6502 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6503 .display asis
6504 , + " \ < > ;
6505 .endd
6506 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or @# characters, and
6507 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6508 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6509 .display asis
6510 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6511 .endd
6512 yields
6513 .display asis
6514 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6515 .endd
6516 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6517 .display asis
6518 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
6519 .endd
6520 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
6521 authentication below.
6522
6523 .section LDAP connections
6524 .index LDAP||connections
6525 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
6526 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
6527 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
6528 by starting it with
6529 .display
6530 ldap://<<hostname>>:<<port>>/...
6531 .endd
6532 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
6533 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
6534 taken from the \ldap@_default@_servers\ configuration option. This supplies a
6535 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
6536 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
6537 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
6538 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
6539 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
6540 failures, and timeouts.
6541
6542 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
6543 of specifing a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
6544 \ldap@_default@_servers\ is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
6545 doubled. For example
6546 .display asis
6547 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
6548 .endd
6549 If \ldap@_default@_servers\ is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
6550 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
6551 the local host) is used.
6552
6553 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
6554 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
6555 \"ldapi"\ instead of \"ldap"\ in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
6556 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
6557 not available.
6558
6559 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
6560 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
6561 can be specified either as an item in \ldap@_default@_servers\, or inline in
6562 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
6563 .display asis
6564 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
6565 .endd
6566 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
6567 \"%2F"\ to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
6568 .display asis
6569 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
6570 .endd
6571 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the `hostname' is really
6572 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
6573 specifies \"ldap"\ or \"ldaps"\. In particular, no encryption is used for a
6574 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
6575 \ldap@_default@_servers\ such as in the example above with traditional \"ldap"\
6576 or \"ldaps"\ queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
6577 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
6578 backup host.
6579
6580 If an explicit \"ldapi"\ type is given in a query when a host name is
6581 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
6582 \ldap@_default@_servers\, they are tried. In other words:
6583 .numberpars $.
6584 Using a pathname with \"ldap"\ or \"ldaps"\ forces the use of the Unix domain
6585 interface.
6586 .nextp
6587 Using \"ldapi"\ with a host name causes an error.
6588 .endp
6589
6590 Using \"ldapi"\ with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
6591 \ldap@_default@_servers\, does whatever the library does by default.
6592
6593
6594 .section LDAP authentication and control information
6595 .index LDAP||authentication
6596 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
6597 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
6598 be preceded by any number of `<<name>>=<<value>>' settings, separated by
6599 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
6600 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
6601 them. The following names are recognized:
6602 .display
6603 DEREFERENCE $rm{set the dereferencing parameter}
6604 .newline
6605 .em
6606 NETTIME $rm{set a timeout for a network operation}
6607 .nem
6608 .newline
6609 USER $rm{set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind}
6610 PASS $rm{set the password, likewise}
6611 SIZE $rm{set the limit for the number of entries returned}
6612 TIME $rm{set the maximum waiting time for a query}
6613 .endd
6614 The value of the \\DEREFERENCE\\ parameter must be one of the words `never',
6615 `searching', `finding', or `always'.
6616
6617 .em
6618 The name \\CONNECT\\ is an obsolete name for \\NETTIME\\, retained for
6619 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
6620 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
6621 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
6622 \*ldap@_result()*\ function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
6623 \\LDAP@_OPT@_NETWORK@_TIMEOUT\\ is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
6624 if \\LDAP@_X@_OPT@_CONNECT@_TIMEOUT\\ is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
6625 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of `no timeout' for
6626 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
6627
6628 The \\TIME\\ parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
6629 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
6630 .nem
6631
6632 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
6633 values. This is a single line, folded for ease of reading:
6634 .display asis
6635 .indent 0
6636 ${lookup ldap
6637 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
6638 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
6639 {$value}fail}
6640 .endd
6641 The encoding of spaces as %20 is a URL thing which should not be done for any
6642 of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups which
6643 contain password information should be preceded by `hide' to prevent non-admin
6644 users from using the \-bP-\ option to see their values.
6645
6646 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
6647 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
6648 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
6649
6650 When a DN is quoted in the \\USER=\\ setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
6651 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
6652 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
6653 quoting has two advantages:
6654 .numberpars $.
6655 It makes it possible to use the same \quote@_ldap@_dn\ expansion for \\USER=\\
6656 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
6657 .nextp
6658 It permits spaces inside \\USER=\\ DNs.
6659 .endp
6660 For example, a setting such as
6661 .display asis
6662 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
6663 .endd
6664 should work even if \$1$\ contains spaces.
6665
6666 Expanded data for the \\PASS=\\ value should be quoted using the \quote\
6667 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
6668 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
6669 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
6670 .display asis
6671 PASS=${quote:$3}
6672 .endd
6673
6674 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
6675 SMTP authentication. See the \ldapauth\ expansion string condition in chapter
6676 ~~CHAPexpand.
6677
6678
6679 .section Format of data returned by LDAP
6680 .index LDAP||returned data formats
6681 The \%ldapdn%\ lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry as
6682 a sequence of values, for example
6683 .display asis
6684 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
6685 .endd
6686
6687 The \%ldap%\ lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
6688 search filter, whereas \%ldapm%\ permits this case, and inserts a newline in
6689 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
6690 values to be returned for both \%ldap%\ and \%ldapm%\, but in the former case
6691 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
6692 directory.
6693
6694 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
6695 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
6696 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
6697
6698 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
6699 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
6700 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
6701 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
6702 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
6703 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
6704 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
6705
6706 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
6707 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
6708 \attr1\ has two values, whereas \attr2\ has only one value:
6709 .display asis
6710 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
6711 value1.1, value1.2
6712
6713 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
6714 value two
6715
6716 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
6717 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
6718
6719 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
6720 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
6721 .endd
6722 The \extract\ operator in string expansions can be used to pick out individual
6723 fields from data that consists of $it{key}=$it{value} pairs. You can make use
6724 of Exim's \-be-\ option to run expansion tests and thereby check the results of
6725 LDAP lookups.
6726
6727
6728
6729 .section More about NIS+
6730 .rset SECTnisplus "~~chapter.~~section"
6731 .index NIS@+ lookup type
6732 .index lookup||NIS+
6733 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ \*indexed name*\ followed by an optional colon
6734 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
6735 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
6736 of \*field-name=field-value*\ pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
6737 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
6738 .display asis
6739 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
6740 .endd
6741 might return the string
6742 .display asis
6743 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
6744 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
6745 .endd
6746 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
6747 .display asis
6748 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
6749 .endd
6750 would just return
6751 .display asis
6752 Martin Guerre
6753 .endd
6754 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
6755 for the given indexed key. The effect of the \quote@_nisplus\ expansion
6756 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
6757
6758
6759 .section More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and Interbase
6760 .rset SECTsql "~~chapter.~~section"
6761 .index MySQL||lookup type
6762 .index PostgreSQL lookup type
6763 .index lookup||MySQL
6764 .index lookup||PostgreSQL
6765 .index Oracle||lookup type
6766 .index lookup||Oracle
6767 .index Interbase lookup type
6768 .index lookup||Interbase
6769 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or Interbase lookups are used, the
6770 \mysql@_servers\, \pgsql@_servers\, \oracle@_servers\, or \ibase@_servers\
6771 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
6772 information. Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four items:
6773 host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of Oracle, the
6774 host name field is used for the `service name', and the database name field is
6775 not used and should be empty. For example:
6776 .display asis
6777 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//ph10/abcdwxyz
6778 .endd
6779 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
6780 `hide', to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the \-bP-\
6781 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
6782 .display asis
6783 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
6784 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
6785 .endd
6786 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <<name>>:<<port>> but
6787 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled.
6788
6789 For each query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection
6790 and a query succeeds. Queries for these databases are SQL statements, so an
6791 example might be
6792 .display asis
6793 .indent 0
6794 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='ph10'}{$value}fail}
6795 .endd
6796 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for
6797 each field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result
6798 of
6799 .display asis
6800 .indent 0
6801 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='ph10'}{$value}}
6802 .endd
6803 might be
6804 .display asis
6805 home=/home/ph10 name="Philip Hazel"
6806 .endd
6807 Values containing spaces and empty values are double quoted, with embedded
6808 quotes escaped by a backslash.
6809
6810 If the result of the query contains just one field, the value is passed back
6811 verbatim, without a field name, for example:
6812 .display asis
6813 Philip Hazel
6814 .endd
6815 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
6816 with a newline between the data for each row.
6817
6818 The \quote@_mysql\, \quote@_pgsql\, and \quote@_oracle\ expansion operators
6819 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to @\n, @\t, @\r, and @\b
6820 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
6821 itself are escaped with backslashes. The \quote@_pgsql\ expansion operator, in
6822 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
6823 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
6824 characters are not special.
6825
6826
6827 .section Special MySQL features
6828 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of `localhost' in \mysql@_servers\
6829 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
6830 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
6831 each item in \mysql@_servers\ is:
6832 .display
6833 <<hostname>>@:@:<<port>>(<<socket name>>)/<<database>>/<<user>>/<<password>>
6834 .endd
6835 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
6836 the local host it can be left blank or set to just `localhost'.
6837
6838 No database need be supplied -- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
6839 the queries.
6840
6841 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
6842 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
6843 .em
6844 \**Warning**\: this can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
6845 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
6846 is zero because no rows are affected.
6847 .nem
6848
6849
6850 .section Special PostgreSQL features
6851 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
6852 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
6853 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
6854 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
6855 looks like this:
6856 .display asis
6857 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
6858 .endd
6859 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
6860 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
6861 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
6862
6863 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
6864 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
6865 affected.
6866
6867
6868
6869
6870 .
6871 .
6872 .
6873 .
6874 . ============================================================================
6875 .chapter Domain, host, address, and local part lists
6876 .set runningfoot "domain, host, and address lists"
6877 .rset CHAPdomhosaddlists "~~chapter"
6878 .index list||of domains, hosts, etc.
6879 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
6880 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the \hold@_domains\ option
6881 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
6882 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter ~~CHAPACL).
6883
6884 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
6885 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
6886 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
6887 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
6888
6889
6890 .section Expansion of lists
6891 .index expansion||of lists
6892 .em
6893 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
6894 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
6895 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
6896 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections ~~SECTlistconstruct and
6897 ~~SECTempitelis for details of the list syntax; the second of these discusses
6898 the way you specify empty list items.
6899 .nem
6900
6901 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
6902 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
6903 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
6904
6905 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
6906 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
6907 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
6908 the \"@\N"\ expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
6909 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
6910 .display asis
6911 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N :
6912 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
6913 .endd
6914 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
6915 \"@\N"\, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
6916 senders based on the receiving domain.
6917
6918
6919
6920 .section Negated items in lists
6921 .index list||negation
6922 .index negation in lists
6923 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
6924 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
6925 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
6926 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
6927 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
6928
6929 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
6930 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
6931 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
6932 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
6933 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
6934 .display asis
6935 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
6936 .endd
6937 matches any domain ending in \*.b.c*\ except for \*a.b.c*\. Domains that match
6938 neither \*a.b.c*\ nor \*@*.b.c*\ do not match, because the last item in the
6939 list is positive. However, if the setting were
6940 .display asis
6941 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
6942 .endd
6943 then all domains other than \*a.b.c*\ would match because the last item in the
6944 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
6945 as if it had an extra item \":*"\ on the end.
6946
6947 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
6948 the connector as `or' after a positive item and as `and' after a negative
6949 item.
6950
6951
6952 .section File names in lists
6953 .rset SECTfilnamlis "~~chapter.~~section"
6954 .index list||file name in
6955 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
6956 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
6957 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
6958 file names are not allowed,
6959 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
6960 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
6961 lines:
6962 .numberpars $.
6963 For domain and host lists, if a @# character appears anywhere in a line of the
6964 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
6965 .nextp
6966 Because local parts may legitimately contain @# characters, a comment in an
6967 address list or local part list file is recognized only if @# is preceded by
6968 white space or the start of the line. For example:
6969 .display asis
6970 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
6971 .endd
6972 .endp
6973 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
6974 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
6975 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
6976 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
6977
6978 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
6979 within the file is inverted. For example, if
6980 .display asis
6981 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
6982 .endd
6983 and the file contains the lines
6984 .display asis
6985 !a.b.c
6986 *.b.c
6987 .endd
6988 then \*a.b.c*\ is in the set of domains defined by \hold@_domains\, whereas any
6989 domain matching \"*.b.c"\ is not.
6990
6991
6992 .section An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list
6993 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
6994 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
6995 confusion about the way \%lsearch%\ lookups work in lists. Because
6996 an \%lsearch%\ file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
6997 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
6998 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an \%lsearch%\ file are
6999 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7000
7001 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7002 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7003 in the previous section.
7004
7005
7006
7007 .section Named lists
7008 .rset SECTnamedlists "~~chapter.~~section"
7009 .index named lists
7010 .index list||named
7011 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7012 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7013 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7014 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7015 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7016 a domain list called \*local@_domains*\ for all the domains that are handled
7017 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7018 .display asis
7019 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7020 .endd
7021 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7022 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7023 configured with the line
7024 .display asis
7025 domains = +local_domains
7026 .endd
7027 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7028 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7029 .display asis
7030 dnslookup:
7031 driver = dnslookup
7032 domains = ! +local_domains
7033 transport = remote_smtp
7034 no_more
7035 .endd
7036 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7037 the words \domainlist\, \hostlist\, \addresslist\, or \localpartlist\,
7038 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7039 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7040 .display asis
7041 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7042 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7043 .endd
7044 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7045 .display asis
7046 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7047 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7048 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7049 .endd
7050
7051 \**Warning**\: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7052 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7053 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7054 .display asis
7055 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7056 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7057 .endd
7058 The second list specifies `either in the \dom1\ list or \*@*.b*\'. The first
7059 list specifies just `not \*a.b*\', so the domain \*x.y*\ matches it. That means
7060 it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7061 .display asis
7062 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7063 .endd
7064 where \*x.y*\ does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7065 referenced lists if you can.
7066
7067 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7068 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7069 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7070 .display asis
7071 domains = +local_domains
7072 .endd
7073 on several of your routers
7074 or in several ACL statements,
7075 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7076 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7077 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7078 the same each time they are referenced.
7079
7080 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7081 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7082 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7083 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7084
7085
7086 .section Named lists compared with macros
7087 .index list||named compared with macro
7088 .index macro||compared with named list
7089 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7090 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7091 write
7092 .display asis
7093 ALIST = host1 : host2
7094 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7095 .endd
7096 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7097 .display asis
7098 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7099 .endd
7100 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7101 list, and write
7102 .display asis
7103 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7104 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7105 .endd
7106 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7107 .display asis
7108 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7109 .endd
7110
7111
7112 .section Named list caching
7113 .index list||caching of named
7114 .index caching||named lists
7115 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7116 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7117 the cache operates only if the list contains no @$ characters, which guarantees
7118 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7119 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7120 message. For example:
7121 .display asis
7122 domainlist special_domains = \
7123 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7124 .endd
7125 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7126 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7127 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7128 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7129 same list each time.
7130
7131 By appending \"@_cache"\ to \"domainlist"\ you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7132 cache the result anyway. For example:
7133 .display asis
7134 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7135 .endd
7136 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7137 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7138
7139
7140 .section Domain lists
7141 .rset SECTdomainlist "~~chapter.~~section"
7142 .index domain list||patterns for
7143 .index list||domain list
7144 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7145 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7146 .numberpars $.
7147 .index primary host name
7148 .index host||name, matched in domain list
7149 .index \primary@_hostname\
7150 .index domain list||matching primary host name
7151 .index @@ in a domain list
7152 If a pattern consists of a single @@ character, it matches the local host name,
7153 as set by the \primary@_hostname\ option (or defaulted). This makes it possible
7154 to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that differ only
7155 in their names.
7156 .nextp
7157 .index @@[] in a domain list
7158 .index domain list||matching local IP interfaces
7159 .index domain literal
7160 If a pattern consists of the string \"@@[]"\ it matches any local IP interface
7161 address, enclosed in square brackets, as in an email address that contains a
7162 domain literal.
7163 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7164 .nextp
7165 .index @@mx@_any
7166 .index @@mx@_primary
7167 .index @@mx@_secondary
7168 .index domain list||matching MX pointers to local host
7169 If a pattern consists of the string \"@@mx@_any"\ it matches any domain that
7170 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7171 .index \hosts@_treat@_as@_local\
7172 \hosts@_treat@_as@_local\. The items \"@@mx@_primary"\ and \"@@mx@_secondary"\
7173 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7174 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7175 but a secondary MX target is. `Primary' means an MX record with the lowest
7176 preference value -- there may of course be more than one of them.
7177
7178 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7179 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7180 example, a single-component domain will \*not*\ be expanded by adding the
7181 resolver's default domain. See the \qualify@_single\ and \search@_parents\
7182 options of the \%dnslookup%\ router for a discussion of domain widening.
7183
7184 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7185 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with \"/ignore=<<ip
7186 list>>"\, where <<ip list>> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7187 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the \ignore@_target@_hosts\ option
7188 on a router). For example:
7189 .display asis
7190 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7191 .endd
7192 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7193 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7194
7195 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7196 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7197 contain negative items.
7198
7199 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7200 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7201 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7202 .display asis
7203 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7204 an.other.domain : ...
7205 .endd
7206 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7207 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7208 .display asis
7209 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7210 an.other.domain ? ...
7211 .endd
7212
7213 .nextp
7214 .index asterisk||in domain list
7215 .index domain list||asterisk in
7216 .index domain list||matching `ends with'
7217 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7218 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of `$*$' in
7219 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7220 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7221 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7222 list item such as \"*key.ex"\ matches \*donkey.ex*\ as well as
7223 \*cipher.key.ex*\.
7224 .nextp
7225 .index regular expressions||in domain list
7226 .index domain list||matching regular expression
7227 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7228 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7229 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7230 References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions are given in
7231 chapter ~~CHAPregexp.
7232
7233 \**Warning**\: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7234 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7235 use the special \"@\N"\ sequence (see chapter ~~CHAPexpand) to specify that it
7236 is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular expression
7237 by expansion, of course).
7238 .nextp
7239 .index lookup||in domain list
7240 .index domain list||matching by lookup
7241 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7242 semicolon (for example, `dbm;' or `lsearch;'), the remainder of the pattern
7243 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7244 `cdb;' it must be an absolute path:
7245 .display asis
7246 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7247 .endd
7248 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7249 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7250 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7251 is used for the \domains\ option on a router
7252 or a \domains\ condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7253 \$domain@_data$\ variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7254 other statements in the same ACL.
7255 .nextp
7256 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by `partial<<n>>-',
7257 where the <<n>> is optional, for example,
7258 .display asis
7259 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7260 .endd
7261 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7262 works is given in section ~~SECTpartiallookup.
7263 .nextp
7264 .index asterisk||in lookup type
7265 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7266 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7267 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7268 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7269 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the \$domain@_data$\
7270 expansion variable.
7271 .nextp
7272 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7273 semicolon (for example, `nisplus;' or `ldap;'), the remainder of the pattern
7274 must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in chapter
7275 ~~CHAPfdlookup. For example:
7276 .display asis
7277 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7278 where domain = '$domain';
7279 .endd
7280 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7281 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7282 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7283 \domains\ option on a router, the data is preserved in the \$domain@_data$\
7284 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7285 .nextp
7286 .index domain list||matching literal domain name
7287 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made between
7288 the pattern and the domain.
7289 .endp
7290
7291 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7292 .display asis
7293 domainlist funny_domains = \
7294 @ : \
7295 lib.unseen.edu : \
7296 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7297 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7298 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7299 nis;domains.byname : \
7300 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7301 .endd
7302 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7303 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7304 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7305 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7306 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7307 patterns earlier.
7308
7309
7310 .section Host lists
7311 .rset SECThostlist "~~chapter.~~section"
7312 .index host list||patterns in
7313 .index list||host list
7314 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7315 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7316 may be permitted to use the SMTP \\ETRN\\ command. Hosts can be identified in
7317 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7318 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7319 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7320 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7321
7322 .section Special host list patterns
7323 .index empty item in hosts list
7324 .index host list||empty string in
7325 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7326 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7327 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7328 not used.
7329
7330 .index asterisk||in host list
7331 The special pattern `$*$' in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7332 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7333
7334
7335 .section Host list patterns that match by IP address
7336 .rset SECThoslispatip "~~chapter.~~section"
7337 .index host list||matching IP addresses
7338 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7339 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7340 `@:@:$tt{ffff}:<<v4address>>'. When such an address is tested against a host
7341 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7342 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7343 concerns.)
7344
7345 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7346 inspecting its IP address:
7347 .numberpars $.
7348 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7349 with $*$, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7350 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7351 \*getipnodebyname()*\ function when available, otherwise \*gethostbyname()*\.
7352 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7353 with the IP address of the subject host.
7354
7355 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7356 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7357 ACL condition, the ACL gives a `defer' response, usually leading to a temporary
7358 SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name, what happens
7359 is described in section ~~SECTbehipnot below.
7360
7361 .nextp
7362 .index @@ in a host list
7363 If the pattern is `@@', the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7364 domain name, as just described.
7365 .nextp
7366 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7367 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal `dotted-quad' notation.
7368 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7369 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7370 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7371 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7372 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7373 that can never match a client host.
7374 .nextp
7375 .index @@[] in a host list
7376 If the pattern is `@@[]', it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7377 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7378 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7379 .display asis
7380 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7381 accept hosts = @[]
7382 .endd
7383 .nextp
7384 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7385 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7386 host under the given mask.
7387 This allows, an entire network of hosts to be included (or excluded) by a
7388 single item.
7389 .index CIDR notation
7390 The mask uses CIDR notation; it specifies the number of address bits that must
7391 match, starting from the most significant end of the address.
7392
7393 \**Note**\: the mask is \*not*\ a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7394 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7395 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7396 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7397 .display asis
7398 192.168.23.236/31
7399 .endd
7400 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
7401 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7402 matches.
7403
7404 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7405 .display asis
7406 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7407 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7408 .endd
7409 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7410 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7411 For example,
7412 .display asis
7413 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7414 .endd
7415 could make use of a file containing
7416 .display asis
7417 172.16.0.0/12
7418 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
7419 .endd
7420 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
7421 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
7422 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
7423 .display asis
7424 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
7425 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
7426 .endd
7427 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading `<;' at the start of the
7428 list.
7429 .endp
7430
7431
7432 .section Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address
7433 .rset SECThoslispatsikey "~~chapter.~~section"
7434 .index host list||lookup of IP address
7435 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
7436 address, the pattern takes this form:
7437 .display
7438 net-<<single-key-search-type>>;<<search-data>>
7439 .endd
7440 For example:
7441 .display asis
7442 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
7443 .endd
7444 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
7445 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
7446 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
7447 \%lsearch%\ files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in \%lsearch%\ files by
7448 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
7449 returned by the lookup is not used.
7450
7451 .index IP address||masking
7452 .index host list||masked IP address
7453 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
7454 patterns of this form:
7455 .display
7456 net<<number>>-<<single-key-search-type>>;<<search-data>>
7457 .endd
7458 For example:
7459 .display asis
7460 net24-dbm;/networks.db
7461 .endd
7462 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <<number>> as the mask
7463 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
7464 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
7465 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
7466 `192.168.34.0/24'. IPv6 addresses are converted to a text value using lower
7467 case letters and dots as separators instead of the more usual colon, because
7468 colon is the key terminator in \%lsearch%\ files. Full, unabbreviated IPv6
7469 addresses are always used.
7470
7471 \**Warning**\: Specifing \net32@-\ (for an IPv4 address) or \net128@-\ (for an
7472 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifing just \net@-\ without a number. In
7473 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
7474 case the IP address is used on its own.
7475
7476
7477 .section Host list patterns that match by host name
7478 .rset SECThoslispatnam "~~chapter.~~section"
7479 .index host||lookup failures
7480 .index unknown host name
7481 .index host list||matching host name
7482 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
7483 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
7484 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
7485 address to match against, as described in the section ~~SECThoslispatip above.)
7486
7487 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
7488 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
7489 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
7490 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
7491 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
7492 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
7493 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
7494
7495 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
7496 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
7497
7498 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
7499 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (\*gethostbyaddr()*\ or
7500 \*getipnodebyaddr()*\ if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
7501 are done can be changed by setting the \host@_lookup@_order\ option.
7502
7503 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
7504 found. These are described in section ~~SECTbehipnot below.
7505
7506
7507 .index host||alias for
7508 .index alias for host
7509 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
7510 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
7511 .numberpars $.
7512 .index asterisk||in host list
7513 If a pattern starts with `$*$' the remainder of the item must match the end of
7514 the host name. For example, \"*.b.c"\ matches all hosts whose names end in
7515 \*.b.c*\. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
7516 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
7517 expression.
7518 .nextp
7519 .index regular expressions||in host list
7520 .index host list||regular expression in
7521 If the item starts with `@^' it is taken to be a regular expression which is
7522 matched against the host name. For example,
7523 .display asis
7524 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
7525 .endd
7526 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts \*a.c.d*\ or
7527 \*b.c.d*\. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
7528 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
7529 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use \"@\N"\ to mark that
7530 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
7531 .display asis
7532 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
7533 .endd
7534 \**Warning**\: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
7535 \"@$"\ terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
7536 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
7537 required.
7538 .endp
7539
7540
7541 .section Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found
7542 .rset SECTbehipnot "~~chapter.~~section"
7543 .index host||lookup failures
7544 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
7545 name (see section ~~SECThoslispatip), or it may need to look up a host name
7546 from an IP address (see section ~~SECThoslispatnam). In either case, the
7547 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
7548
7549 .index \"+include@_unknown"\
7550 .index \"+ignore@_unknown"\
7551 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
7552 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
7553 items \"+include@_unknown"\ or \"+ignore@_unknown"\ may appear in the list (at
7554 top level -- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
7555 .numberpars $.
7556 If any item that follows \"+include@_unknown"\ requires information that
7557 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
7558 .display asis
7559 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
7560 .endd
7561 rejects connections from any host whose name matches \"*.enemy.ex"\, and also
7562 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
7563 .nextp
7564 If any item that follows \"+ignore@_unknown"\ requires information that cannot
7565 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
7566 example:
7567 .display asis
7568 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
7569 192.168.4.5
7570 .endd
7571 accepts from any host whose name is \*friend.example*\ and from 192.168.4.5,
7572 whether or not its host name can be found. Without \"+ignore@_unknown"\, if no
7573 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
7574 .endp
7575 Both \"+include@_unknown"\ and \"+ignore@_unknown"\ may appear in the same
7576 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
7577 list.
7578
7579 \**Note**\: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does \*not*\
7580 apply to temporary DNS errors. They always cause a defer action.
7581
7582
7583 .section Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name
7584 .rset SECThoslispatnamsk "~~chapter.~~section"
7585 .index host||lookup failures
7586 .index unknown host name
7587 .index host list||matching host name
7588 If a pattern is of the form
7589 .display
7590 <<single-key-search-type>>;<<search-data>>
7591 .endd
7592 for example
7593 .display asis
7594 dbm;/host/accept/list
7595 .endd
7596 a single-key lookup is performend, using the host name as its key. If the
7597 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
7598 is not used.
7599
7600 \**Reminder**\: With this kind of pattern, you must have host $it{names} as
7601 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
7602 addresses, you must precede the search type with `net-' (see section
7603 ~~SECThoslispatsikey). There is, however, no reason why you could not use two
7604 items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
7605 lookup, both using the same file.
7606
7607
7608 .section Host list patterns for query-style lookups
7609 If a pattern is of the form
7610 .display
7611 <<query-style-search-type>>;<<query>>
7612 .endd
7613 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
7614 data that is looked up is not used. The variables \$sender@_host@_address$\ and
7615 \$sender@_host@_name$\ can be used in the query. For example:
7616 .display asis
7617 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
7618 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
7619 .endd
7620 The value of \$sender@_host@_address$\ for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
7621 can use the \sg\ expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
7622 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the \mask\ expansion
7623 operator.
7624
7625 If the query contains a reference to \$sender@_host@_name$\, Exim automatically
7626 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
7627 ~~SECThoslispatnam for comments on finding host names.)
7628
7629 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
7630 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
7631 \"net-"\. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, \"net-"\ is
7632 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
7633 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, \"net-"\ $it{is} important.
7634 See section ~~SECThoslispatsikey.)
7635
7636
7637 .section Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists
7638 .rset SECTmixwilhos "~~chapter.~~section"
7639 .index host list||mixing names and addresses in
7640 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
7641 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
7642 ACL you could have:
7643 .display asis
7644 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
7645 .endd
7646 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
7647 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
7648 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
7649 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
7650 \accept\ statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
7651 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
7652
7653 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
7654 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
7655 .display asis
7656 accept hosts = *.friend.example
7657 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
7658 .endd
7659 If the first \accept\ fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
7660 ~~CHAPACL for details of ACLs.
7661
7662
7663
7664
7665 .section Address lists
7666 .index list||address list
7667 .index address list||empty item
7668 .index address list||patterns
7669 .rset SECTaddresslist "~~chapter.~~section"
7670 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
7671 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
7672 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
7673 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
7674 using this option setting:
7675 .display asis
7676 senders = :
7677 .endd
7678 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
7679 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
7680 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
7681 .em
7682 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when \$sender@_address$\ is empty.
7683
7684 The following kinds of address list pattern can match any address, including
7685 the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message senders:
7686 .nem
7687 .numberpars $.
7688 .em
7689 As explained above, if a pattern item is empty, it matches the empty address
7690 (and no others).
7691 .nem
7692 .nextp
7693 .index regular expressions||in address list
7694 .index address list||regular expression in
7695 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with `@^', a regular expression match is
7696 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
7697 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
7698 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use \"@\N"\
7699 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
7700 .display asis
7701 deny senders = \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
7702 .endd
7703 The \"@\N"\ sequences are removed by the expansion, so the item does start
7704 with `@^' by the time it is being interpreted as an address pattern.
7705 .nextp
7706 .index address list||lookup for complete address
7707 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
7708 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
7709 example:
7710 .display asis
7711 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
7712 mysql;select address from blocked where \
7713 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
7714 .endd
7715 .em
7716 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
7717 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
7718 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
7719 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
7720
7721 .nem
7722 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section ~~SECTpartiallookup) cannot be
7723 used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the panic
7724 log.
7725 .index @*@@ with single-key lookup
7726 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
7727 ~~SECTdefaultvaluelookups, but this is useful only for the `$*$@@' type of
7728 default. For example, with this lookup:
7729 .display asis
7730 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
7731 .endd
7732 the file could contains lines like this:
7733 .display asis
7734 user1@domain1.example
7735 *@domain2.example
7736 .endd
7737 and for the sender address \*nimrod@@jaeger.example*\, the sequence of keys
7738 that are tried is:
7739 .display asis
7740 nimrod@jaeger.example
7741 *@jaeger.example
7742 *
7743 .endd
7744 \**Warning 1**\: Do not include a line keyed by `$*$' in the file, because that
7745 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
7746
7747 \**Warning 2**\: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
7748 .display asis
7749 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
7750 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
7751 .endd
7752 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
7753 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
7754 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
7755 .endp
7756
7757
7758 .em
7759 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
7760 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
7761 always fails.
7762 .nem
7763
7764 .numberpars $.
7765 .index @@@@ with single-key lookup
7766 .index address list||@@@@ lookup type
7767 .index address list||split local part and domain
7768 If a pattern starts with `@@@@' followed by a single-key lookup item
7769 (for example, \"@@@@lsearch;/some/file"\), the address that is being checked is
7770 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
7771 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
7772 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
7773 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
7774
7775 .index asterisk||in address list
7776 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
7777 keyed by `$*$' (see section ~~SECTdefaultvaluelookups). The local part patterns
7778 that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with `$*$', or even be
7779 further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example, with
7780 .display asis
7781 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
7782 .endd
7783 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
7784 .display asis
7785 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
7786 .endd
7787 to reject all senders except \postmaster\ from that domain.
7788 .index local part||starting with !
7789 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
7790 has to be specified using a regular expression. In \%lsearch%\ files, an entry
7791 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
7792 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
7793 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
7794 .display asis
7795 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
7796 spammer3 : spammer4
7797 .endd
7798 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
7799 doubling.
7800
7801 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
7802 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
7803 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
7804 might have entries like
7805 .display asis
7806 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
7807 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
7808 *: ^\d{8}$
7809 .endd
7810 in a file that was searched with \@@@@dbm$*$\, to specify a match for 8-digit
7811 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
7812 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
7813 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
7814 .index loop||in lookups
7815 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
7816 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
7817 .nextp
7818 The @@@@<<lookup>> style of item can also be used with a query-style
7819 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
7820 can only return a single list of local parts.
7821 .nextp
7822 If a pattern contains an @@ character, but is not a regular expression and does
7823 not begin with a lookup type as described above, the local part of the subject
7824 address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start with an
7825 asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly the same
7826 way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
7827 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
7828 .display asis
7829 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
7830 *@+hostile_domains:\
7831 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
7832 .newline
7833 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
7834 .endd
7835 .index local part||starting with !
7836 .index address list||local part starting with !
7837 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
7838 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
7839 treated as a sign of negation.
7840 .nextp
7841 If a pattern is not one of the above syntax forms, that is, if a
7842 .em
7843 non-empty
7844 .nem
7845 pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not contain an @@
7846 character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject address. The
7847 only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal domain, or a domain
7848 pattern that starts with $*$. In both these cases, the effect is the same as if
7849 \"*@@"\ preceded the pattern.
7850 .endp
7851
7852 \**Warning**\: there is an important difference between the address list items
7853 in these two examples:
7854 .display asis
7855 senders = +my_list
7856 senders = *@+my_list
7857 .endd
7858 In the first one, \"my@_list"\ is a named address list, whereas in the second
7859 example it is a named domain list.
7860
7861
7862
7863 .section Case of letters in address lists
7864 .rset SECTcasletadd "~~chapter.~~section"
7865 .index case of local parts
7866 .index address list||case forcing
7867 .index case forcing in address lists
7868 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
7869 case may be significant on some systems (see \caseful@_local@_part\ for how
7870 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 ($it{Anti-Spam
7871 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs}) suggests that matching of addresses to blocking
7872 lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address lists in
7873 Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by default.
7874
7875 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
7876 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
7877 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
7878 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
7879 that is looked up using the `@@@@' mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
7880 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than \%lsearch%\ (which
7881 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
7882 case-independent.
7883
7884 .index \"+caseful"\
7885 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
7886 an address list is the string `+caseful', the original case of the local
7887 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
7888 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
7889 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
7890 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
7891 become case-sensitive after `+caseful' has been seen.
7892
7893
7894 .section Local part lists
7895 .rset SECTlocparlis "~~chapter.~~section"
7896 .index list||local part list
7897 .index local part||list
7898 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
7899 lists, as just described. The `+caseful' item can be used if required. In a
7900 setting of the \local@_parts\ option in a router with \caseful@_local@_part\
7901 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
7902 case-insensitive. In this case, `+caseful' will restore case-sensitive matching
7903 in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
7904 \caseful@_local@_part\ is set true in a router, matching in the \local@_parts\
7905 option is case-sensitive from the start.
7906
7907 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section ~~SECTfilnamlis),
7908 comments are handled in the same way as address lists -- they are recognized
7909 only if the @# is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
7910 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
7911 that the special items that refer to the local host (\"@@"\, \"@@[]"\,
7912 \"@@mx@_any"\, \"@@mx@_primary"\, and \"@@mx@_secondary"\) are not recognized.
7913 Refer to section ~~SECTdomainlist for details of the other available item
7914 types.
7915
7916
7917
7918 .
7919 .
7920 .
7921 .
7922 . ============================================================================
7923 .chapter String expansions
7924 .set runningfoot "string expansions"
7925 .rset CHAPexpand ~~chapter
7926 .index expansion||of strings
7927 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
7928 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
7929
7930 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
7931 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
7932 start of a portion of the string which is interpreted and replaced as described
7933 below in section ~~SECTexpansionitems onwards. Backslash is used as an escape
7934 character, as described in the following section.
7935
7936
7937 .section Literal text in expanded strings
7938 .rset SECTlittext "~~chapter.~~section"
7939 .index expansion||including literal text
7940 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
7941 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
7942 character being treated specially in an expansion, including itself. If the
7943 string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
7944 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
7945 the string is read in (see section ~~SECTstrings).
7946
7947 .index expansion||non-expandable substrings
7948 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
7949 two occurrences of \"@\N"\. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
7950 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
7951 .display asis
7952 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
7953 .endd
7954 On encountering the first \"@\N"\, the expander copies subsequent characters
7955 without interpretation until it reaches the next \"@\N"\ or the end of the
7956 string.
7957
7958
7959 .section Character escape sequences in expanded strings
7960 .index expansion||escape sequences
7961 A backslash followed by one of the letters `n', `r', or `t' in an expanded
7962 string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline, carriage
7963 return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three octal digits
7964 is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a backslash
7965 followed by `x' and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal encoding.
7966
7967 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
7968 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
7969 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
7970
7971 .section Testing string expansions
7972 .index expansion||testing
7973 .index testing||string expansion
7974 .index \-be-\ option
7975 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the \-be-\ option. This takes
7976 the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
7977 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
7978 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
7979 since no message is being processed, variables such as \$local@_part$\ have no
7980 value. Nevertheless the \-be-\ option can be useful for checking out file and
7981 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as \sg\, \substr\ and
7982 \nhash\.
7983
7984 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the \-be-\ option, and
7985 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
7986 using \-be-\ for reading files to which they do not have access.
7987
7988
7989 .em
7990 .section Forced expansion failure
7991 .rset SECTforexpfai "~~chapter.~~section"
7992 .index expansion||forced failure
7993 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
7994 alternative `true' and `false' substrings, enclosed in curly brackets. Which
7995 one is used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the
7996 expansion. If, instead of a `false' substring, the word `fail' is used (not in
7997 curly brackets), the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be
7998 detected by the code that requested the expansion. This is called `forced
7999 expansion failure', and its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some
8000 cases it is no different from any other expansion failure, but in others a
8001 different action may be taken. Such variations are mentioned in the
8002 documentation of the option that is being expanded.
8003 .nem
8004
8005
8006 .section Expansion items
8007 .rset SECTexpansionitems "~~chapter.~~section"
8008 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8009 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8010 outer set of braces, to improve readability. \**Warning**\: Within braces,
8011 white space is significant.
8012
8013 .startitems
8014
8015 .item "@$<<variable name>>#$rm{or}#@$@{<<variable name>>@}"
8016 .index expansion||variables
8017 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example
8018 .display asis
8019 $local_part
8020 ${domain}
8021 .endd
8022 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8023 characters. This form (using curly brackets) is available only for variables;
8024 it does $it{not} apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given
8025 in section ~~SECTexpvar below. If the name of a non-existent variable is given,
8026 the expansion fails.
8027
8028 .item "@$@{<<op>>:<<string>>@}"
8029 .index expansion||operators
8030 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by <<op>>
8031 is applied to it. For example,
8032 .display asis
8033 ${lc:$local_part}
8034 .endd
8035 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8036 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section ~~SECTexpop below.
8037 The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just one
8038 argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8039 string easier to understand.
8040
8041 .item "@$@{extract@{<<key>>@}@{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@{<<string3>>@}@}"
8042 .index expansion||extracting substrings by key
8043 The key and <<string1>> are first expanded separately.
8044 Leading and trailing whitespace is removed from the key (but not from any of
8045 the strings).
8046 The key must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <<string1>> must be
8047 of the form:
8048 .display
8049 <<key1>> = <<value1>> <<key2>> = <<value2>> ...
8050 .endd
8051 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8052 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8053 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8054 described in section ~~SECTstrings. The expanded <<string1>> is searched for
8055 the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If the
8056 key is found, <<string2>> is expanded, and replaces the whole item; otherwise
8057 <<string3>> is used. During the expansion of <<string2>> the variable \$value$\
8058 contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it is restored to any
8059 previous value it might have had.
8060
8061 If @{<<string3>>@} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8062 key is not found. If @{<<string2>>@} is also omitted, the value that was
8063 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8064 yield `2001':
8065 .display
8066 @$@{extract@{gid@}{uid=1984 gid=2001@}@}
8067 @$@{extract@{gid@}{uid=1984 gid=2001@}@{@$value@}@}
8068 .endd
8069 Instead of @{<<string3>>@} the word `fail' (not in curly brackets) can appear,
8070 for example:
8071 .display
8072 @$@{extract@{Z@}@{A=... B=...@}@{@$value@} fail @}
8073 .endd
8074 This forces an expansion failure (see section ~~SECTforexpfai); @{<<string2>>@}
8075 must be present for `fail' to be recognized.
8076
8077
8078 .item "@$@{extract@{<<number>>@}@{<<separators>>@}@{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@{<<string3>>@}@}"
8079 .index expansion||extracting substrings by number
8080 The <<number>> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8081 apart from leading and trailing whitespace, which is ignored.
8082 This is what distinguishes this form of \extract\ from the previous kind. It
8083 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8084 extracts from <<string1>> the field whose number is given as the first
8085 argument. You can use \$value$\ in <<string2>> or \"fail"\ instead of
8086 <<string3>> as before.
8087
8088 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8089 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8090 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8091 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8092 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8093 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8094 expansion of <<string3>>, or the empty string if <<string3>> is not provided.
8095 For example:
8096 .display asis
8097 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8098 .endd
8099 yields `42', and
8100 .display asis
8101 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8102 .endd
8103 yields `99'. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8104 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8105
8106
8107 .item "@$@{hash@{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@{<<string3>>@}@}"
8108 .index hash function||textual
8109 .index expansion||textual hash
8110 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8111 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8112 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8113
8114 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <<m>> and
8115 <<n>>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if <<string1>>
8116 and <<string2>> do not change when they are expanded, you can use the
8117 simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8118 .display
8119 @$@{hash@_<<n>>@_<<m>>:<<string>>@}
8120 .endd
8121 The second number is optional (in both notations).
8122
8123 If <<n>> is greater than or equal to the length of the string, the expansion
8124 item returns the string. Otherwise it computes a new string of length <<n>> by
8125 applying a hashing function to the string. The new string consists of
8126 characters taken from the first <<m>> characters of the string
8127 .display asis
8128 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8129 .endd
8130 If <<m>> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8131 letters appear. For example:
8132 .display
8133 @$@{hash@{3@}@{monty@}@} $rm{yields} \"jmg"\
8134 @$@{hash@{5@}@{monty@}@} $rm{yields} \"monty"\
8135 @$@{hash@{4@}@{62@}@{monty python@}@} $rm{yields} \"fbWx"\
8136 .endd
8137
8138
8139 .item "@$header@_<<header name>>:#$rm{or}#@$h@_<<header name>>:"
8140 .item "@$bheader@_<<header name>>:#$rm{or}#@$bh@_<<header name>>:"
8141 .item "@$rheader@_<<header name>>:#$rm{or}#@$rh@_<<header name>>:"
8142 .index expansion||header insertion
8143 .index \$header@_$\
8144 .index \$bheader@_$\
8145 .index \$rheader@_$\
8146 .index header lines||in expansion strings
8147 .index header lines||character sets
8148 .index header lines||decoding
8149 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8150 .display asis
8151 $header_reply-to:
8152 .endd
8153 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8154 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8155 lines) may be present.
8156
8157 The difference between \rheader\, \bheader\, and \header\ is in the way the
8158 data in the header line is interpreted.
8159 .numberpars $.
8160 .index whitespace||in header lines
8161 \rheader\ gives the original `raw' content of the header line, with no
8162 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing whitespace.
8163 .nextp
8164 .index base64 encoding||in header lines
8165 \bheader\ removes leading and trailing whitespace, and then decodes base64 or
8166 quoted-printable MIME `words' within the header text, but does no character
8167 set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME `word'
8168 fails, the raw string is returned.
8169 .index binary zero||in header line
8170 If decoding produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark
8171 -- this is what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header
8172 lines.
8173 .nextp
8174 \header\ tries to translate the string as decoded by \bheader\ to a standard
8175 character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would be
8176 displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the \bheader\ string is
8177 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8178 \*iconv()*\ function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro
8179 \\HAVE@_ICONV\\ in a system Makefile or in \(Local/Makefile)\.
8180 .endp
8181
8182 In a filter file, the target character set for \header\ can be specified by a
8183 command of the following form:
8184 .display asis
8185 headers charset "UTF-8"
8186 .endd
8187 This command affects all references to \$h@_$\ (or \$header@_$\) expansions in
8188 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8189 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the \headers@_charset\
8190 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8191 value of \\HEADERS@_CHARSET\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\. The ultimate default is
8192 ISO-8859-1.
8193
8194 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8195 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8196 $it{do not} terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8197 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8198
8199 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8200 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8201 message, and any that are added by
8202 an ACL \warn\ statement or by
8203 a system filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message
8204 by a router or transport are not accessible.
8205
8206 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8207 before the \\DATA\\ ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8208 message is received. Header lines that are added by \warn\ statements in a
8209 \\RCPT\\ ACL (for example) are saved until the message's incoming header lines
8210 are available, at which point they are added. When a \\DATA\\ ACL is running,
8211 however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
8212
8213 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8214 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8215 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8216 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8217 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8218 replaced by an empty string. (See the \def\ condition in section ~~SECTexpcond
8219 for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8220
8221 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8222 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. A newline
8223 character is inserted between each line.
8224 For the \header\ expansion, for those headers that contain lists of addresses,
8225 a comma is also inserted at the junctions between lines. This does not happen
8226 for the \rheader\ expansion.
8227
8228
8229
8230 .item "@$@{hmac@{<<hashname>>@}@{<<secret>>@}@{<<string>>@}@}"
8231 .index expansion||hmac hashing
8232 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8233 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8234 RFC 2104.
8235 This differs from \"@$@{md5:secret@_text...@}"\ or
8236 \"@$@{sha1:secret@_text...@}"\ in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8237 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8238 or SHA-1 alone.
8239 The hash name must expand to either \"md5"\ or \"sha1"\ at present. For
8240 example:
8241 .display asis
8242 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8243 .endd
8244 For the hostname \*mail.example.com*\ and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8245 produces:
8246 .display asis
8247 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8248 .endd
8249 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8250 an Exim configuration:
8251 .display asis
8252 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8253 .endd
8254 In a router or a transport you could then have:
8255 .display asis
8256 headers_add = \
8257 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_id} \
8258 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8259 {${primary_hostname},${message_id},$h_message-id:}}
8260 .endd
8261 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8262 ::X-Spam-Scanned:: header line. If you know the secret, you can check that this
8263 header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the host
8264 name, message ID and the ::Message-id:: header line. This can be done using
8265 Exim's \-be-\ option, or by other means, for example by using the
8266 \*hmac@_md5@_hex()*\ function in Perl.
8267
8268
8269 .item "@${if <<condition>> @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@}"
8270 .index expansion||conditional
8271 If <<condition>> is true, <<string1>> is expanded and replaces the whole item;
8272 otherwise <<string2>> is used. The available conditions are described in
8273 section ~~SECTexpcond below. For example:
8274 .display asis
8275 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8276 .endd
8277 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8278 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word `fail' may be
8279 present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
8280 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8281 ~~SECTforexpfai).
8282
8283 .em
8284 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string \"true"\ if the condition
8285 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
8286 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
8287 .display asis
8288 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
8289 .endd
8290 you can use
8291 .display asis
8292 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
8293 .endd
8294 .nem
8295
8296
8297 .item "@$@{length@{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@}"
8298 .index expansion||string truncation
8299 The \length\ item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
8300 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <<n>>, say. If you
8301 are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <<string1>> does not change
8302 when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of
8303 the braces:
8304 .display
8305 @$@{length@_<<n>>:<<string>>@}
8306 .endd
8307 The result of this item is either the first <<n>> characters or the whole
8308 of <<string2>>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse \length\ with
8309 \strlen\, which gives the length of a string.
8310
8311
8312 .item "@${lookup@{<<key>>@} <<search type>> @{<<file>>@} @{<<string1>>@} @{<<string2>>@}@}"
8313 .item "@${lookup <<search type>> @{<<query>>@} @{<<string1>>@} @{<<string2>>@}@}"
8314 .index expansion||lookup in
8315 .index file||lookup
8316 .index lookup||in expanded string
8317 These items specify data lookups in files and databases, as discussed in
8318 chapter ~~CHAPfdlookup. The first form is used for single-key lookups, and the
8319 second is used for query-style lookups. The <<key>>, <<file>>, and <<query>>
8320 strings are expanded before use.
8321
8322 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
8323 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the \%manualroute%\ router, or any
8324 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
8325 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
8326 out by the system administrator.
8327
8328 .index \$value$\
8329 If the lookup succeeds, <<string1>> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
8330 During its expansion, the variable \$value$\ contains the data returned by the
8331 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
8332 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <<string2>> is expanded and replaces
8333 the entire item. If @{<<string2>>@} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
8334 string on failure. If <<string2>> is provided, it can itself be a nested
8335 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
8336 original lookup fails.
8337
8338 If a nested lookup is used as part of <<string1>>, \$value$\ contains the data
8339 for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are expanded,
8340 and also while <<string2>> of the second lookup is expanded, should the second
8341 lookup fail.
8342
8343 Instead of @{<<string2>>@} the word `fail' can appear, and in this case, if the
8344 lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced to fail (see section
8345 ~~SECTforexpfai). If both @{<<string1>>@} and @{<<string2>>@} are omitted, the
8346 result is the looked up value in the case of a successful lookup, and nothing
8347 in the case of failure.
8348
8349 For single-key lookups, the string `partial' is permitted to precede the
8350 search type in order to do partial matching, and $*$ or $*$@@ may follow a
8351 search type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
8352 ~~SECTdefaultvaluelookups and ~~SECTpartiallookup for details).
8353
8354 .index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in lookup expansion
8355 If a partial search is used, the variables \$1$\ and \$2$\ contain the wild
8356 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
8357 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
8358
8359 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
8360 .display asis
8361 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
8362 .endd
8363 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
8364 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
8365 .display asis
8366 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
8367 {$value}fail}
8368 .endd
8369
8370
8371 .item "@$@{nhash@{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@{<<string3>>@}@}"
8372 .index expansion||numeric hash
8373 .index hash function||numeric
8374 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8375 <<n>> and <<m>>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8376 <<string1>> and <<string2>> do not change when they are expanded, you can use
8377 the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8378 .display
8379 @$@{nhash@_<<n>>@_<<m>>:<<string>>@}
8380 .endd
8381 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
8382 the result is a number in the range 0--<<n>>-1. Otherwise, the string is
8383 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
8384 slash, in the ranges 0 to <<n>>-1 and 0 to <<m>>-1, respectively. For example,
8385 .display asis
8386 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
8387 .endd
8388 returns the string `6/33'.
8389
8390
8391
8392 .item "@$@{perl@{<<subroutine>>@}@{<<arg>>@}@{<<arg>>@}...@}"
8393 .index Perl||use in expanded string
8394 .index expansion||calling Perl from
8395 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
8396 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
8397 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
8398 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
8399 name of the subroutine, is nine.
8400
8401 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
8402 the return value is \undef\. In that case, the expansion fails in the same way
8403 as an explicit `fail' on a lookup item.
8404 The return value is a scalar. Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar
8405 context. For example, if you return the name of a Perl vector, the
8406 return value is the size of the vector, not its contents.
8407
8408 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's \die\ function, the expansion fails
8409 with the error message that was passed to \die\. More details of the embedded
8410 Perl facility are given in chapter ~~CHAPperl.
8411
8412 The \%redirect%\ router has an option called \forbid@_filter@_perl\ which locks
8413 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8414
8415
8416 .item "@$@{readfile@{<<file name>>@}@{<<eol string>>@}@}"
8417 .index expansion||inserting an entire file
8418 .index file||inserting into expansion
8419 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
8420 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
8421 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
8422 newlines are left in the string.
8423 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
8424 you must wrap the item in an \expand\ operator. If the file cannot be read, the
8425 string expansion fails.
8426
8427 The \%redirect%\ router has an option called \forbid@_filter@_readfile\ which
8428 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8429
8430
8431
8432 .item "@$@{readsocket@{<<name>>@}@{<<request>>@}@{<<timeout>>@}@{<<eol string>>@}@{<<fail string>>@}@}"
8433 .index expansion||inserting from a socket
8434 .index socket, use of in expansion
8435 This item inserts data that is read from a Unix domain socket into the expanded
8436 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments:
8437 .display asis
8438 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
8439 .endd
8440 Exim connects to the socket, writes the request string (unless it is an
8441 empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file is read. A timeout
8442 of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments extend what can be
8443 done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
8444 .display asis
8445 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request-string}{3s}}
8446 .endd
8447 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
8448 that is read, in the same way as for \readfile\ (see above). This example turns
8449 them into spaces:
8450 .display asis
8451 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request-string}{3s}{ }}
8452 .endd
8453 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
8454 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
8455 addition, the following errors can occur:
8456 .numberpars $.
8457 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
8458 .nextp
8459 Failure to connect the socket;
8460 .nextp
8461 Failure to write the request-string;
8462 .nextp
8463 Timeout on reading from the socket.
8464 .endp
8465 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
8466 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
8467 errors occurs. For example:
8468 .display asis
8469 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request-string}{3s}{\n}\
8470 {socket failure}}
8471 .endd
8472 You can test for the existence of the socket by wrapping this expansion in
8473 \"@$@{if exists"\, but there is a race condition between that test and the
8474 actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument if you
8475 want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a non-existent
8476 socket.
8477
8478 The \%redirect%\ router has an option called \forbid@_filter@_readsocket\ which
8479 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8480
8481 .item "@$rheader@_<<header name>>:#$rm{or}#@$rh@_<<header name>>:"
8482 This item inserts `raw' header lines. It is described with the \header\
8483 expansion item above.
8484
8485
8486
8487 .item "@$@{run@{<<command>> <<args>>@}@{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@}"
8488 .index expansion||running a command
8489 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
8490 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
8491 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
8492 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
8493 .index return code||from \run\ expansion
8494 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <<string1>> is expanded and
8495 replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output from the
8496 command is in the variable \$value$\. If the command fails, <<string2>>, if
8497 present, is expanded. If it is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively,
8498 <<string2>> can be the word `fail' (not in braces) to force expansion failure
8499 if the command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is the
8500 standard output on success, and nothing on failure.
8501
8502 The return code from the command is put in the variable \$runrc$\, and this
8503 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
8504 .display asis
8505 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
8506 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
8507 ...
8508 endif
8509 .endd
8510 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
8511 the return code is 127 -- the same code that shells use for non-existent
8512 commands.
8513
8514 \**Warning**\: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
8515 option values are expanded, except for those pre-conditions whose order of
8516 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set \$runrc$\
8517 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
8518
8519 The \%redirect%\ router has an option called \forbid@_filter@_run\ which locks
8520 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8521
8522
8523 .item "@$@{sg@{<<subject>>@}@{<<regex>>@}@{<<replacement>>@}@}"
8524 .index expansion||string substitution
8525 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
8526 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
8527 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
8528 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
8529 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example
8530 .display asis
8531 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
8532 .endd
8533 yields `xyzdefxyzdef'. Because all three arguments are expanded before use, if
8534 any @$ or @\ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
8535 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example
8536 .display asis
8537 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
8538 .endd
8539 yields `defabc', and
8540 .display asis
8541 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
8542 .endd
8543 yields `K1=A K4=D K3=C'.
8544 Note the use of \"@\N"\ to protect the contents of the regular expression from
8545 string expansion.
8546
8547
8548
8549 .item "@$@{substr@{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@{<<string3>>@}@}"
8550 .index \substr\
8551 .index substring extraction
8552 .index expansion||substring extraction
8553 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8554 <<n>> and <<m>>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8555 <<string1>> and <<string2>> do not change when they are expanded, you can use
8556 the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8557 .display
8558 @$@{substr@_<<n>>@_<<m>>:<<string>>@}
8559 .endd
8560 The second number is optional (in both notations).
8561 .em
8562 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
8563 omitted.
8564 .nem
8565
8566 The \substr\ item can be used to extract more general substrings than \length\.
8567 The first number, <<n>>, is a starting offset, and <<m>> is the length
8568 required. For example
8569 .display asis
8570 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
8571 .endd
8572 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the null
8573 string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string length,
8574 the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the given
8575 offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
8576
8577 The \substr\ expansion item can take negative offset values to count
8578 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
8579 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
8580 .display asis
8581 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
8582 .endd
8583 yields `34'. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
8584 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
8585 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
8586 .display asis
8587 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
8588 .endd
8589 yields an empty string, but
8590 .display asis
8591 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
8592 .endd
8593 yields `1'.
8594
8595 When the second number is omitted from \substr\, the remainder of the string is
8596 taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
8597 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
8598 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
8599 .display asis
8600 ${substr_-1:abcde}
8601 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
8602 .endd
8603 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, `abcd'.
8604
8605
8606
8607 .item "@$@{tr@{<<subject>>@}@{<<characters>>@}@{<<replacements>>@}@}"
8608 .index expansion||character translation
8609 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
8610 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
8611 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
8612 replacement list. For example
8613 .display asis
8614 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
8615 .endd
8616 yields `1b3de1'. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
8617 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
8618 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
8619 place.
8620
8621 .enditems
8622
8623
8624 .section Expansion operators
8625 .rset SECTexpop "~~chapter.~~section"
8626 .index expansion||operators
8627 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
8628 the `operator' notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
8629 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
8630 following operations can be performed:
8631
8632 .startitems
8633
8634 .item "@$@{address:<<string>>@}"
8635 .index expansion||RFC 2822 address handling
8636 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
8637 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
8638 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
8639
8640
8641 .item "@$@{base62:<<digits>>@}"
8642 .index base62
8643 .index expansion||conversion to base 62
8644 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
8645 base 62 (sic) and output as a string of six characters, including leading
8646 zeros. \**Note**\: Just to be absolutely clear: this is \*not*\ base64
8647 encoding.
8648
8649 .item "@$@{base62d:<<base-62 digits>>@}"
8650 .index base62
8651 .index expansion||conversion to base 62
8652 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits. The number is converted to
8653 decimal and output as a string.
8654
8655
8656 .item "@$@{domain:<<string>>@}"
8657 .index domain||extraction
8658 .index expansion||domain extraction
8659 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
8660 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
8661
8662
8663 .item "@$@{escape:<<string>>@}"
8664 .index expansion||escaping non-printing characters
8665 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
8666 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
8667 significant bit set (so-called `8-bit characters') count as printing or not is
8668 controlled by the \print@_topbitchars\ option.
8669
8670
8671 .item "@$@{eval:<<string>>@}"
8672 .item "@$@{eval10:<<string>>@}"
8673 .index expansion||expression evaluation
8674 .index expansion||arithmetic expression
8675 These items supports simple arithmetic in expansion strings. The string (after
8676 expansion) must be a conventional arithmetic expression, but it is limited to
8677 the four basic operators (plus, minus, times, divide) and parentheses. All
8678 operations are carried out using integer arithmetic. Plus and minus have a
8679 lower priority than times and divide; operators with the same priority are
8680 evaluated from left to right.
8681
8682 For \eval\, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with `0') or hexadecimal
8683 (starting with `0x'). For \eval10\, all numbers are taken as decimal, even if
8684 they start with a leading zero. This can be useful when processing numbers
8685 extracted from dates or times, which often do have leading zeros.
8686
8687 A number may be followed by `K' or `M' to multiply it by 1024 or 1024$*$1024,
8688 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
8689 a decimal representation of the answer (without `K' or `M'). For example:
8690 .display
8691 @$@{eval:1+1@} $rm{yields} 2
8692 @$@{eval:1+2*3@} $rm{yields} 7
8693 @$@{eval:(1+2)*3@} $rm{yields} 9
8694 .endd
8695 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
8696 .display asis
8697 deny message = Too many bad recipients
8698 condition = \
8699 ${if and { \
8700 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
8701 { \
8702 < \
8703 {$recipients_count} \
8704 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
8705 } \
8706 }{yes}{no}}
8707 .endd
8708 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 \\RCPT\\ commands and
8709 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
8710
8711
8712 .item "@$@{expand:<<string>>@}"
8713 .index expansion||re-expansion of substring
8714 The \expand\ operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
8715 example,
8716 .display asis
8717 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
8718 .endd
8719 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for \expand\, and
8720 then re-expands what it has found.
8721
8722
8723 .item "@$@{from@_utf8:<<string>>@}"
8724 .index Unicode
8725 .index UTF-8||conversion from
8726 .index expansion||UTF-8 conversion
8727 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
8728 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
8729 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
8730 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
8731 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
8732 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
8733
8734 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
8735 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
8736 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
8737 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
8738 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
8739 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
8740 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
8741
8742
8743 .item "@$@{hash@_<<n>>@_<<m>>:<<string>>@}"
8744 .index hash function||textual
8745 .index expansion||textual hash
8746 The \hash\ operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can be
8747 used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
8748 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
8749 .display
8750 @$@{hash@{<<n>>@}@{<<m>>@}@{<<string>>@}@}
8751 .endd
8752 See the description of the general \hash\ item above for details. The
8753 abbreviation \h\ can be used when \hash\ is used as an operator.
8754
8755
8756
8757 .item "@$@{hex2b64:<<hexstring>>@}"
8758 .index base64 encoding||conversion from hex
8759 .index expansion||hex to base64
8760 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
8761 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
8762
8763
8764 .item "@$@{lc:<<string>>@}"
8765 .index case forcing in strings
8766 .index string||case forcing
8767 .index lower casing
8768 .index expansion||case forcing
8769 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
8770 .display asis
8771 ${lc:$local_part}
8772 .endd
8773
8774
8775 .item "@$@{length@_<<number>>:<<string>>@}"
8776 .index expansion||string truncation
8777 The \length\ operator is a simpler interface to the \length\ function that can
8778 be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
8779 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
8780 .display
8781 @$@{length@{<<number>>@}@{<<string>>@}@}
8782 .endd
8783 See the description of the general \length\ item above for details. Note that
8784 \length\ is not the same as \strlen\. The abbreviation \l\ can be used when
8785 \length\ is used as an operator.
8786
8787
8788 .item "@$@{local@_part:<<string>>@}"
8789 .index expansion||local part extraction
8790 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
8791 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
8792 empty.
8793
8794
8795 .item "@$@{mask:<<IP address>>/<<bit count>>@}"
8796 .index masked IP address
8797 .index IP address||masking
8798 .index CIDR notation
8799 .index expansion||IP address masking
8800 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
8801 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
8802 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
8803 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
8804 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
8805 .display asis
8806 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
8807 .endd
8808 returns the string `10.111.131.192/28'. Since this operation is expected to be
8809 mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
8810 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
8811 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
8812 .display asis
8813 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
8814 .endd
8815 returns the string
8816 .display asis
8817 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
8818 .endd
8819 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
8820
8821
8822 .item "@$@{md5:<<string>>@}"
8823 .index MD5 hash
8824 .index expansion||MD5 hash
8825 The \md5\ operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it as
8826 a 32-digit hexadecimal number,
8827 in which any letters are in lower case.
8828
8829
8830 .item "@$@{nhash@_<<n>>@_<<m>>:<<string>>@}"
8831 .index expansion||numeric hash
8832 .index hash function||numeric
8833 The \nhash\ operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
8834 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
8835 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
8836 .display
8837 @$@{nhash@{<<n>>@}@{<<m>>@}@{<<string>>@}@}
8838 .endd
8839 See the description of the general \nhash\ item above for details.
8840
8841
8842 .item "@$@{quote:<<string>>@}"
8843 .index quoting||in string expansions
8844 .index expansion||quoting
8845 The \quote\ operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
8846 is an empty string or
8847 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
8848 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
8849 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to \"@\n"\ and \"@\r"\,
8850 respectively For example,
8851 .display asis
8852 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
8853 .endd
8854 becomes
8855 .display asis
8856 "ab\"*\"cd"
8857 .endd
8858 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
8859 variable or a message header.
8860
8861 .item "@$@{quote@_local@_part:<<string>>@}"
8862 This operator is like \quote\, except that it quotes the string only if
8863 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
8864 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for \quote\).
8865 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of \$local@_part$\
8866 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
8867
8868
8869 .item "@$@{quote@_<<lookup-type>>:<<string>>@}"
8870 .index quoting||lookup-specific
8871 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
8872 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
8873 the lookups in chapter ~~CHAPfdlookup. For example,
8874 .display asis
8875 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
8876 .endd
8877 returns
8878 .display asis
8879 two%20%5C2A%20two
8880 .endd
8881 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
8882 yields an unchanged string.
8883
8884
8885 .item "@$@{rxquote:<<string>>@}"
8886 .index quoting||in regular expressions
8887 .index regular expressions||quoting
8888 The \rxquote\ operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
8889 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
8890 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
8891
8892
8893 .item "@$@{rfc2047:<<string>>@}"
8894 .index expansion||RFC 2047
8895 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
8896 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
8897 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
8898 \headers@_charset\ option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string contains
8899 only characters in the range 33--126, and no instances of the characters
8900 .display asis
8901 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
8902 .endd
8903 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
8904 string,
8905 .em
8906 using as many `coded words' as necessary to encode all the characters.
8907 .nem
8908
8909
8910 .item "@$@{sha1:<<string>>@}"
8911 .index SHA-1 hash
8912 .index expansion||SHA-1 hashing
8913 The \sha1\ operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns it
8914 as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
8915
8916
8917 .item "@$@{stat:<<string>>@}"
8918 .index expansion||statting a file
8919 .index file||extracting characteristics
8920 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the \*stat()*\
8921 function is made for this path. If \*stat()*\ fails, an error occurs and the
8922 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
8923 series of <<name>>=<<value>> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
8924 except for the value of `smode'. The names are: `mode' (giving the mode as a
8925 4-digit octal number), `smode' (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
8926 10-character string, as for the \*ls*\ command), `inode', `device', `links',
8927 `uid', `gid', `size', `atime', `mtime', and `ctime'. You can extract individual
8928 fields using the \extract\ expansion item. \**Warning**\: The file size may be
8929 incorrect on 32-bit systems for files larger than 2GB.
8930
8931
8932 .em
8933 .item "@$@{str2b64:<<string>>@}"
8934 .index expansion||base64 encoding
8935 .index base64 encoding||in string expansion
8936 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
8937 .nem
8938
8939
8940 .item "@$@{strlen:<<string>>@}"
8941 .index expansion||string length
8942 .index string||length in expansion
8943 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
8944 decimal number. \**Note**\: Do not confuse \strlen\ with \length\.
8945
8946
8947 .item "@$@{substr@_<<start>>@_<<length>>:<<string>>@}"
8948 .index \substr\
8949 .index substring extraction
8950 .index expansion||substring expansion
8951 The \substr\ operator is a simpler interface to the \substr\ function that can
8952 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
8953 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
8954 .display
8955 @$@{substr@{<<start>>@}@{<<length>>@}@{<<string>>@}@}
8956 .endd
8957 See the description of the general \substr\ item above for details. The
8958 abbreviation \s\ can be used when \substr\ is used as an operator.
8959
8960 .item "@$@{time@_interval:<<string>>@}"
8961 .index \time@_interval\
8962 .index time interval||formatting
8963 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
8964 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
8965 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
8966 \"1w3d4h2m6s"\.
8967
8968 .item "@$@{uc:<<string>>@}"
8969 .index case forcing in strings
8970 .index string||case forcing
8971 .index upper casing
8972 .index expansion||case forcing
8973 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
8974
8975 .enditems
8976
8977
8978
8979 .section Expansion conditions
8980 .rset SECTexpcond "~~chapter.~~section"
8981 .index expansion||conditions
8982 The following conditions are available for testing by the \@$@{if\ construct
8983 while expanding strings:
8984
8985 .startitems
8986
8987 .item "!<<condition>>"
8988 .index expansion||negating a condition
8989 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
8990 condition.
8991
8992 .item "<<symbolic operator>> @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
8993 .index numeric comparison
8994 .index expansion||numeric comparison
8995 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
8996 are:
8997 .display
8998 .tabs 8
8999 = $t $rm{equal}
9000 == $t $rm{equal}
9001 > $t $rm{greater}
9002 >= $t $rm{greater or equal}
9003 < $t $rm{less}
9004 <= $t $rm{less or equal}
9005 .endd
9006 For example,
9007 .display asis
9008 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9009 .endd
9010 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9011 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9012 optionally followed by one of the letters `K' or `M' (in either upper or lower
9013 case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024$*$1024, respectively.
9014
9015 .item "crypteq @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9016 .index expansion||encrypted comparison
9017 .index encrypted strings, comparing
9018 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9019 authentication mechanisms (see chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH). Otherwise, it is
9020 necessary to define \\SUPPORT@_CRYPTEQ\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ to get \crypteq\
9021 included in the binary.
9022
9023 The \crypteq\ condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and compared
9024 against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may be in the
9025 LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the encryption type
9026 in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string does not begin
9027 with `{' it is assumed to be encrypted with \*crypt()*\
9028 or \*crypt16()*\ (see below),
9029 since such strings cannot begin with `{'. Typically this will be a field from a
9030 password file.
9031
9032 An example of an encrypted string in LDAP form is:
9033 .display asis
9034 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
9035 .endd
9036 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
9037 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
9038 .display asis
9039 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
9040 .endd
9041 The following encryption types
9042 (whose names are matched case-independently)
9043 are supported:
9044 .numberpars $.
9045 .index MD5 hash
9046 .index base64 encoding||in encrypted password
9047 \@{md5@}\ computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9048 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9049 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
9050 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
9051 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
9052 comparison fails.
9053 .nextp
9054 .index SHA-1 hash
9055 \@{sha1@}\ computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9056 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9057 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
9058 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
9059 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
9060 .nextp
9061 .index \*crypt()*\
9062 \@{crypt@}\ calls the \*crypt()*\ function,
9063 .em
9064 which traditionally used to use only the first eight characters of the
9065 password. However, in modern operating systems this is no longer true, and in
9066 many cases the entire password is used, whatever its length.
9067 .nem
9068 .nextp
9069 .index \*crypt16()*\
9070 \@{crypt16@}\ calls the \*crypt16()*\ function (also known as \*bigcrypt()*\),
9071 which
9072 .em
9073 was orginally created to use up to 16 characters of the password. Again, in
9074 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
9075 .nem
9076 .endp
9077 Exim has its own version of \*crypt16()*\ (which is just a double call to
9078 \*crypt()*\). For operating systems that have their own version, setting
9079 \\HAVE@_CRYPT16\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ when building Exim causes it to use the
9080 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
9081 the OS-dependent \(Makefile)\ for those operating systems that are known to
9082 support \*crypt16()*\.
9083
9084 If you do not put any curly bracket encryption type in a \crypteq\ comparison,
9085 the default is either \"@{crypt@}"\ or \"@{crypt16@}"\, as determined by the
9086 setting of \\DEFAULT@_CRYPT\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\. The default default is
9087 \"@{crypt@}"\. Whatever the default, you can always use either function by
9088 specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
9089
9090 Note that if a password is no longer than 8 characters, the results of
9091 encrypting it with \*crypt()*\ and \*crypt16()*\ are identical. That means that
9092 \*crypt16()*\ is backwards compatible, as long as nobody feeds it a password
9093 longer than 8 characters.
9094
9095
9096 .item "def:<<variable name>>"
9097 .index expansion||checking for empty variable
9098 The \def\ condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
9099 variables defined in section ~~SECTexpvar. The condition is true if the named
9100 expansion variable does not contain the empty string, for example
9101 .display asis
9102 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
9103 .endd
9104 Note that the variable name is given without a leading \@$\ character. If the
9105 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
9106
9107 .item "def:header@_<<header name>>:##or##def:h@_<<header name>>:"
9108 .index expansion||checking header line existence
9109 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
9110 exists in the message. For example,
9111 .display asis
9112 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
9113 .endd
9114 Note that no \@$\ appears before \header@_\ or \h@_\ in the condition,
9115 and that header names must be terminated by colons if white space does not
9116 follow.
9117
9118 .item "eq @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9119 .item "eqi @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9120 .index string||comparison
9121 .index expansion||string comparison
9122 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
9123 resulting strings are identical: for \eq\ the comparison includes the case of
9124 letters, whereas for \eqi\ the comparison is case-independent.
9125
9126 .item "exists @{<<file name>>@}"
9127 .index expansion||file existence test
9128 .index file||existence test
9129 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
9130 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
9131 is done by calling the \*stat()*\ function. The use of the \exists\ test in
9132 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
9133
9134 .item "first@_delivery"
9135 .index delivery||first
9136 .index first delivery
9137 .index expansion||first delivery test
9138 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
9139 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
9140
9141 .item "ge @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9142 .item "gei @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9143 .index string||comparison
9144 .index expansion||string comparison
9145 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9146 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string: for \ge\ the
9147 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for \gei\ the comparison is
9148 case-independent.
9149
9150 .item "gt @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9151 .item "gti @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9152 .index string||comparison
9153 .index expansion||string comparison
9154 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9155 string is lexically greater than the second string: for \gt\ the comparison
9156 includes the case of letters, whereas for \gti\ the comparison is
9157 case-independent.
9158
9159 .item "isip @{<<string>>@}" 8
9160 .item "isip4 @{<<string>>@}"
9161 .item "isip6 @{<<string>>@}"
9162 .index IP address||testing string format
9163 .index string||testing for IP address
9164 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
9165 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for \isip\, whereas
9166 \isip4\ and \isip6\ test just for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses, respectively. For
9167 example, you could use
9168 .display asis
9169 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
9170 .endd
9171 to test which version of IP an incoming SMTP connection is using.
9172
9173
9174 .item "ldapauth @{<<ldap query>>@}"
9175 .index LDAP||use for authentication
9176 .index expansion||LDAP authentication test
9177 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section ~~SECTldap
9178 for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of queries. For this
9179 use, the query must contain a user name and password. The query itself is not
9180 used, and can be empty. The condition is true if
9181 the password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the
9182 LDAP server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP
9183 binds with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of
9184 the username, and will succeed in most configurations.
9185 See chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH for details of SMTP authentication, and chapter
9186 ~~CHAPplaintext for an example of how this can be used.
9187
9188
9189 .item "le @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9190 .item "lei @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9191 .index string||comparison
9192 .index expansion||string comparison
9193 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9194 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string: for \le\ the
9195 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for \lei\ the comparison is
9196 case-independent.
9197
9198 .item "lt @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9199 .item "lti @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9200 .index string||comparison
9201 .index expansion||string comparison
9202 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9203 string is lexically less than the second string: for \lt\ the comparison
9204 includes the case of letters, whereas for \lti\ the comparison is
9205 case-independent.
9206
9207
9208 .item "match @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9209 .index expansion||regular expression comparison
9210 .index regular expressions||match in expanded string
9211 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
9212 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
9213 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
9214 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
9215 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
9216 premature termination of <<string2>>. The easiest approach is to use the
9217 \"@\N"\ feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
9218 For example,
9219 .display asis
9220 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
9221 .endd
9222 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
9223 backslashes is also required.
9224
9225 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
9226 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
9227 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
9228 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
9229 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the \"@$"\
9230 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
9231
9232 .index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in \if\ expansion
9233 At the start of an \if\ expansion the values of the numeric variable
9234 substitutions \$1$\ etc. are remembered. Obeying a \match\ condition that
9235 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
9236 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
9237 of the \if\ expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
9238 combination of conditions using \or\, the subsequent values of the numeric
9239 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
9240
9241 .item "match@_domain @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9242 .item "match@_address @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9243 .item "match@_local@_part @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9244 .index domain list||in expansion condition
9245 .index address list||in expansion condition
9246 .index local part list||in expansion condition
9247 These conditions make it possible to test domain, address, and local
9248 part lists within expansions. Each condition requires two arguments: an item
9249 and a list to match. A trivial example is:
9250 .display asis
9251 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
9252 .endd
9253 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
9254 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
9255 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
9256 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
9257 .display asis
9258 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
9259 .endd
9260 .index \"+caseful"\
9261 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the \"+caseful"\
9262 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
9263 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
9264 caselessly.
9265
9266 \**Note**\: Host lists are \*not*\ supported in this way. This is because
9267 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
9268 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. At least, I haven't come
9269 up with anything yet.
9270
9271 .item "pam {<<string1>>:<<string2>>:...@}"
9272 .index PAM authentication
9273 .index \\AUTH\\||with PAM
9274 .index Solaris||PAM support
9275 .index expansion||PAM authentication test
9276 \*Pluggable Authentication Modules*\
9277 (\?http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/?\)
9278 are a facility which is available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some
9279 GNU/Linux distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in
9280 conjunction with the SMTP \\AUTH\\ command, is available only if Exim is
9281 compiled with
9282 .display asis
9283 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
9284 .endd
9285 in \(Local/Makefile)\. You probably need to add \-lpam-\ to \\EXTRALIBS\\, and
9286 in some releases of GNU/Linux \-ldl-\ is also needed.
9287
9288 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a colon-separated
9289 list of strings.
9290 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
9291 The PAM module is initialized with the service name `exim' and the user name
9292 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<<string1>>). The
9293 remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests from
9294 the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one request,
9295 for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
9296
9297 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
9298 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
9299 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the \sg\ expansion
9300 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
9301 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
9302 .display asis
9303 server_condition = ${if pam{$1:${sg{$2}{:}{::}}}{yes}{no}}
9304 .endd
9305 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
9306 .display asis
9307 server_condition = ${if pam{$2:${sg{$3}{:}{::}}}{yes}{no}}
9308 .endd
9309 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
9310 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
9311 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
9312 A patched version of the \*pam@_unix*\ module that comes with the
9313 Linux PAM package is available from \?http:@/@/www.e-admin.de/pam@_exim/?\.
9314 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
9315 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
9316 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
9317
9318
9319 .item "pwcheck {<<string1>>:<<string2>>@}"
9320 .index \*pwcheck*\ daemon
9321 .index Cyrus
9322 .index expansion||\*pwcheck*\ authentication test
9323 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus \*pwcheck*\ daemon.
9324 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
9325 that is not running as root.
9326 \**Note:**\ The use of \*pwcheck*\ is now deprecated. Its replacement is
9327 \*saslauthd*\ (see below).
9328
9329 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
9330 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in \(Local/Makefile)\ before
9331 building Exim. For example:
9332 .display asis
9333 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
9334 .endd
9335 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
9336 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
9337 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that \*exim*\ is the only user that has
9338 access to the \(/var/pwcheck)\ directory.
9339
9340 The \pwcheck\ condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
9341 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
9342 configuration, you might have this:
9343 .display asis
9344 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$1:$2}{1}{0}}
9345 .endd
9346
9347 .item "queue@_running"
9348 .index queue runner||detecting when delivering from
9349 .index expansion||queue runner test
9350 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
9351 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
9352
9353
9354 .item "radius {<<authentication string>>@}"
9355 .index Radius
9356 .index expansion||Radius authentication
9357 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
9358 set \\RADIUS@_CONFIG@_FILE\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ to specify the location of
9359 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
9360 support.
9361 .em
9362 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the \radiusclient\
9363 library. You can also link Exim with the \libradius\ library that comes with
9364 FreeBSD. To do this, set
9365 .display asis
9366 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
9367 .endd
9368 in \(Local/Makefile)\, in addition to setting \\RADIUS@_CONFIGURE@_FILE\\.
9369 .nem
9370 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in \\EXTRALIBS\\ so that the
9371 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
9372
9373 The string specified by \\RADIUS@_CONFIG@_FILE\\ is expanded and passed to the
9374 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
9375 the authentication is successful. For example
9376 .display
9377 server@_condition = @$@{if radius@{<<arguments>>@}@{yes@}@{no@}@}
9378 .endd
9379
9380
9381
9382 .item "saslauthd @{@{<<user>>@}@{<<password>>@}@{<<service>>@}@{<<realm>>@}@}"
9383 .index \*saslauthd*\ daemon
9384 .index Cyrus
9385 .index expansion||\*saslauthd*\ authentication test
9386 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus \*saslauthd*\
9387 daemon. This replaces the older \*pwcheck*\ daemon, which is now deprecated.
9388 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
9389 by a process that is not running as root.
9390
9391 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
9392 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in \(Local/Makefile)\ before
9393 building Exim. For example:
9394 .display asis
9395 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
9396 .endd
9397 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
9398 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
9399 from the Cyrus SASL library.
9400
9401 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the \saslauthd\ condition, but only two
9402 are mandatory. For example:
9403 .display asis
9404 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$1}{$2}}{1}{0}}
9405 .endd
9406 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
9407 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
9408 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
9409
9410 .enditems
9411
9412
9413
9414 .section Combining expansion conditions
9415 .index expansion||combining conditions
9416 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the \and\ and
9417 \or\ combination conditions. Note that \and\ and \or\ are complete conditions
9418 on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each sub-condition
9419 must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain the list. No
9420 repetition of \if\ is used.
9421
9422 .startitems
9423
9424 .item "or @{@{<<cond1>>@}@{<<cond2>>@}...@}"
9425 .index `or' expansion condition
9426 .index expansion||`or' of conditions
9427 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
9428 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
9429 For example,
9430 .display asis
9431 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
9432 .endd
9433 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
9434 evaluated. If there are several `match' sub-conditions the values of the
9435 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
9436
9437 .item "and @{@{<<cond1>>@}@{<<cond2>>@}...@}"
9438 .index `and' expansion condition
9439 .index expansion||`and' of conditions
9440 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
9441 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several `match'
9442 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
9443 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
9444 parsed but not evaluated.
9445
9446 .enditems
9447
9448
9449
9450 .section Expansion variables
9451 .rset SECTexpvar "~~chapter.~~section"
9452 .index expansion||variables, list of
9453
9454 .em
9455 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
9456 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
9457 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
9458 .nem
9459
9460 .push
9461 .indent 2em
9462 .index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)
9463 .tempindent 0
9464 \$0$\, \$1$\, etc: When a \match\ expansion condition succeeds, these
9465 variables contain the captured substrings identified by the regular expression
9466 during subsequent processing of the success string of the containing \if\
9467 expansion item. They may also be set externally by some other matching process
9468 which precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available
9469 in Exim filter files include an \if\ command with its own regular expression
9470 matching condition.
9471
9472 .tempindent 0
9473 \$acl@_c0$\ -- \$acl@_c9$\: Values can be placed in these variables by the
9474 \set\ modifier in an ACL. The values persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP
9475 connection. They can be used to pass information between ACLs and different
9476 invocations of the same ACL.
9477 When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the
9478 message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during
9479 subsequent delivery.
9480
9481 .tempindent 0
9482 \$acl@_m0$\ -- \$acl@_m9$\: Values can be placed in these variables by the
9483 \set\ modifier in an ACL. They retain their values while a message is being
9484 received, but are reset afterwards. They are also reset by \\MAIL\\, \\RSET\\,
9485 \\EHLO\\, \\HELO\\, and after starting a TLS session.
9486 When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the
9487 message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during
9488 subsequent delivery.
9489
9490
9491 .tempindent 0
9492 \$acl@_verify@_message$\: During the expansion of the \message\ and
9493 \log@_message\ modifiers in an ACL statement after an address verification has
9494 failed, this variable contains the original failure message that will be
9495 overridden by the expanded string.
9496
9497 .tempindent 0
9498 \$address@_data$\: This variable is set by means of the \address@_data\
9499 option in routers. The value then remains with the address while it is
9500 processed by subsequent routers and eventually a transport. If the transport is
9501 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used. See
9502 chapter ~~CHAProutergeneric for more details. \**Note**\: the contents of
9503 \$address@_data$\ are visible in user filter files.
9504
9505 .em
9506 If \$address@_data$\ is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
9507 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
9508 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
9509 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
9510 of the verification, and in this case the final value of \$address@_data$\ is
9511 from the child's routing.
9512
9513 If \$address@_data$\ is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
9514 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
9515 \$sender@_address@_data$\, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
9516 address.
9517
9518 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
9519 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
9520 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
9521 .nem
9522
9523 .tempindent 0
9524 \$address@_file$\: When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a
9525 message is directed to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the
9526 file when the transport is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For
9527 example, using the default configuration, if user \r2d2\ has a \(.forward)\
9528 file containing
9529 .display asis
9530 /home/r2d2/savemail
9531 .endd
9532 then when the \%address@_file%\ transport is running, \$address@_file$\
9533 contains `/home/r2d2/savemail'.
9534 .index Sieve filter||value of \$address@_file$\
9535 For Sieve filters, the value may be `inbox' or a relative folder name. It is
9536 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
9537 to the relevant file.
9538
9539
9540 .tempindent 0
9541 \$address@_pipe$\: When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is
9542 directed to a pipe, this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is
9543 running.
9544
9545 .index authentication||id
9546 .tempindent 0
9547 \$authenticated@_id$\: When a server successfully authenticates a client it may
9548 be configured to preserve some of the authentication information in the
9549 variable \$authenticated@_id$\ (see chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH). For example, a
9550 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
9551 in the routers. When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP
9552 connection), the value of \$authenticated@_id$\ is the login name of the
9553 calling process.
9554
9555 .index sender||authenticated
9556 .index authentication||sender
9557 .index \\AUTH\\||on \\MAIL\\ command
9558 .tempindent 0
9559 \$authenticated@_sender$\:
9560 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the \\AUTH=\\ parameter on an
9561 incoming SMTP \\MAIL\\ command
9562 if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as described in section
9563 ~~SECTauthparamail. Unless the data is the string `@<@>', it is set as the
9564 authenticated sender of the message, and the value is available during delivery
9565 in the \$authenticated@_sender$\ variable. If the sender is not trusted, Exim
9566 accepts the syntax of \\AUTH=\\, but ignores the data.
9567
9568 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
9569 value of \$authenticated@_sender$\ is an address constructed from the login
9570 name of the calling process and \$qualify@_domain$\.
9571
9572
9573 .index authentication||failure
9574 .tempindent 0
9575 \$authentication@_failed$\:
9576 This variable is set to `1' in an Exim server if a client issues an \\AUTH\\
9577 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to `0'. This makes it
9578 possible to distinguish between `did not try to authenticate'
9579 (\$sender@_host@_authenticated$\ is empty and \$authentication__failed$\ is set
9580 to `0') and `tried to authenticate but failed' (\$sender@_host@_authenticated$\
9581 is empty and \$authentication@_failed$\ is set to `1'). Failure includes any
9582 negative response to an \\AUTH\\ command, including (for example) an attempt to
9583 use an undefined mechanism.
9584
9585
9586 .index message||body, line count
9587 .index body of message||line count
9588 .tempindent 0
9589 \$body@_linecount$\:
9590 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
9591 number of lines in the message's body.
9592
9593 .index message||body, binary zero count
9594 .index body of message||binary zero count
9595 .index binary zero||in message body
9596 .tempindent 0
9597 \$body@_zerocount$\:
9598 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
9599 number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
9600
9601 .tempindent 0
9602 \$bounce@_recipient$\:
9603 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
9604 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
9605 chapter ~~CHAPemsgcust).
9606
9607 .tempindent 0
9608 \$bounce@_return@_size@_limit$\: This contains the value set in the
9609 \bounce@_return@_size@_limit\ option, rounded up to a multiple of 1000. It is
9610 useful when a customized error message text file is in use (see chapter
9611 ~~CHAPemsgcust).
9612
9613 .index gid (group id)||caller
9614 .tempindent 0
9615 \$caller@_gid$\: The
9616 real
9617 group id under which the process that called Exim was
9618 running. This is not the same as the group id of the originator of a message
9619 (see \$originator@_gid$\). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
9620 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
9621
9622 .index uid (user id)||caller
9623 .tempindent 0
9624 \$caller@_uid$\: The
9625 real
9626 user id under which the process that called Exim was
9627 running. This is not the same as the user id of the originator of a message
9628 (see \$originator@_uid$\). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
9629 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
9630
9631 .tempindent 0
9632 \$compile@_date$\: The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
9633
9634 .tempindent 0
9635 \$compile@_number$\: The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
9636 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
9637 compilations of the same version of the program.
9638
9639 .em
9640 .tempindent 0
9641 \$demime@_errorlevel$\: This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
9642 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete \demime\ condition. For
9643 details, see section ~~SECTdemimecond.
9644
9645 .tempindent 0
9646 \$demime@_reason$\: This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
9647 content-scanning extension and the obsolete \demime\ condition. For details,
9648 see section ~~SECTdemimecond.
9649 .nem
9650
9651 .index black list (DNS)
9652 .tempindent 0
9653 \$dnslist@_domain$\: When a client host is found to be on a DNS (black) list,
9654 the list's domain name is put into this variable so that it can be included in
9655 the rejection message.
9656
9657 .tempindent 0
9658 \$dnslist@_text$\: When a client host is found to be on a DNS (black) list, the
9659 contents of any associated TXT record are placed in this variable.
9660
9661 .tempindent 0
9662 \$dnslist@_value$\: When a client host is found to be on a DNS (black) list,
9663 the IP address from the resource record is placed in this variable.
9664 If there are multiple records, all the addresses are included, comma-space
9665 separated.
9666
9667 .tempindent 0
9668 \$domain$\: When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
9669 variable contains the domain. Global address rewriting happens when a message
9670 is received, so the value of \$domain$\ during routing and delivery is the
9671 value after rewriting. \$domain$\ is set during user filtering, but not during
9672 system filtering, because a message may have many recipients and the system
9673 filter is called just once.
9674
9675 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
9676 \\RCPT\\ commands in one SMTP delivery), \$domain$\ is set only if they all
9677 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
9678 at a time if the value of \$domain$\ is required at transport time -- this is
9679 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
9680 which local transports are run, see chapter ~~CHAPenvironment.
9681
9682 .index \delay@_warning@_condition\
9683 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
9684 set in \$domain$\ during the expansion of \delay@_warning@_condition\.
9685
9686 The \$domain$\ variable is also used in some other circumstances:
9687 .numberpars $.
9688 When an ACL is running for a \\RCPT\\ command, \$domain$\ contains the domain
9689 of the recipient address.
9690 \**Note:**\ the domain of the sender address is in \$sender@_address@_domain$\
9691 at \\MAIL\\ time and at \\RCPT\\ time. \$domain$\ is not set for the \\MAIL\\
9692 ACL.
9693 .nextp
9694 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter ~~CHAPrewrite), \$domain$\
9695 contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten; it can be
9696 used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to rewrite
9697 domains by file lookup.
9698 .nextp
9699 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
9700 \$domain$\ contains the subject domain. \**Exception**\: When a domain list in
9701 a \sender@_domains\ condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
9702 is in \$sender@_address@_domain$\ and not in \$domain$\. It works this way so
9703 that, in a \\RCPT\\ ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
9704 recipient domain (which is what is in \$domain$\ at this time).
9705 .nextp
9706 .index \\ETRN\\||value of \$domain$\
9707 .index \smtp@_etrn@_command\
9708 When the \smtp@_etrn@_command\ option is being expanded, \$domain$\ contains
9709 the complete argument of the \\ETRN\\ command (see section ~~SECTETRN).
9710 .endp
9711
9712 .tempindent 0
9713 \$domain@_data$\: When the \domains\ option on a router matches a domain by
9714 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
9715 of the router as \$domain@_data$\. In addition, if the driver routes the
9716 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
9717 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
9718 used.
9719
9720 \$domain@_data$\ is also set when the \domains\ condition in an ACL matches a
9721 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
9722 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
9723 to nothing.
9724
9725 .tempindent 0
9726 \$exim@_gid$\: This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
9727
9728 .tempindent 0
9729 \$exim@_path$\: This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
9730
9731 .tempindent 0
9732 \$exim@_uid$\: This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
9733
9734 .em
9735 .tempindent 0
9736 \$found@_extension$\: This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
9737 content-scanning extension and the obsolete \demime\ condition. For details,
9738 see section ~~SECTdemimecond.
9739 .nem
9740
9741 .tempindent 0
9742 \$header@_<<name>>$\: This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is
9743 expansion syntax for inserting the message header line with the given name.
9744 Note that the name must be terminated by colon or white space, because it may
9745 contain a wide variety of characters.
9746 Note also that braces must \*not*\ be used.
9747
9748 .tempindent 0
9749 \$home$\:
9750 When the \check@_local@_user\ option is set for a router, the user's home
9751 directory is placed in \$home$\ when the check succeeds. In particular, this
9752 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
9753 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
9754 by a setting on the transport itself.
9755
9756 When running a filter test via the \-bf-\ option, \$home$\ is set to the value
9757 of the environment variable \\HOME\\.
9758
9759 .tempindent 0
9760 \$host$\:
9761 When the \%smtp%\ transport is expanding its options for encryption using TLS,
9762 \$host$\ contains the name of the host to which it is connected. Likewise, when
9763 used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
9764 ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH), \$host$\ contains the name of the server to which the client
9765 is connected.
9766 .index transport||filter
9767 .index filter||transport filter
9768 When used in a transport filter (see chapter ~~CHAPtransportgeneric) \$host$\
9769 refers to the host involved in the current connection. When a local transport
9770 is run as a result of a router that sets up a host list, \$host$\ contains the
9771 name of the first host.
9772
9773 .tempindent 0
9774 \$host@_address$\:
9775 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever \$host$\ is set
9776 for a remote connection.
9777 .em
9778 It is also set to the IP address that is being checked when the
9779 \ignore@_target@_hosts\ option is being processed.
9780 .nem
9781
9782 .tempindent 0
9783 \$host@_data$\:
9784 If a \hosts\ condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
9785 of the lookup is made available in the \$host@_data$\ variable. This
9786 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
9787 .display asis
9788 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
9789 message = $host_data
9790 .endd
9791
9792 .em
9793 .index host||name lookup, failure of
9794 .tempindent 0
9795 \$host@_lookup@_deferred$\:
9796 This variable normally contains `0', as does \$host@_lookup@_failed$\. When a
9797 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
9798 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
9799 variables is set to `1'.
9800 .numberpars $.
9801 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
9802 succeeded, but no records were found), \$host@_lookup@_failed$\ is set to `1'.
9803 .nextp
9804 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
9805 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
9806 lookup), \$host@_lookup@_deferred$\ is set to `1'.
9807 .endp
9808 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
9809 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
9810 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
9811 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
9812 \$host@_lookup@_failed$\ is set to `1'. Thus, being able to find a name from an
9813 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
9814 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
9815 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
9816 the result, the name is not accepted, and \$host@_lookup@_deferred$\ is set to
9817 `1'. See also \$sender@_host@_name$\.
9818
9819 .tempindent 0
9820 \$host@_lookup@_failed$\: See \$host@_lookup@_deferred$\.
9821 .nem
9822
9823 .tempindent 0
9824 \$inode$\:
9825 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the \directory@_file\
9826 option in the \%appendfile%\ transport. The variable contains the inode number
9827 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
9828 a unique name for the file.
9829
9830 .tempindent 0
9831 \$interface@_address$\:
9832 When a message is received over a TCP/IP connection, this variable contains the
9833 address of the local IP interface. See also the \-oMi-\ command line option.
9834 This variable can be used in ACLs and also, for example, to make the file name
9835 for a TLS certificate depend on which interface is being used.
9836
9837 .tempindent 0
9838 \$interface@_port$\:
9839 When a message is received over a TCP/IP connection, this variable contains the
9840 local port number. See also the \-oMi-\ command line option.
9841 This variable can be used in ACLs and also, for example, to make the file name
9842 for a TLS certificate depend on which port is being used.
9843
9844 .tempindent 0
9845 \$ldap@_dn$\:
9846 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
9847 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
9848 lookup.
9849
9850 .tempindent 0
9851 \$load@_average$\:
9852 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 to that it
9853 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
9854 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
9855
9856 .tempindent 0
9857 \$local@_part$\: When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
9858 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
9859 delivered together (for example, multiple \\RCPT\\ commands in an SMTP
9860 session), \$local@_part$\ is not set.
9861
9862 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
9863 \$local@_part$\ during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
9864 \$local@_part$\ is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
9865 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
9866 once.
9867
9868 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
9869 value of \$local@_part$\ during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
9870 any prefix or suffix are in \$local@_part@_prefix$\ and
9871 \$local@_part@_suffix$\, respectively.
9872
9873 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
9874 result of aliasing or forwarding, \$local@_part$\ is set to the local part of
9875 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see \$address@_file$\ and
9876 \$address@_pipe$\).
9877
9878 When an ACL is running for a \\RCPT\\ command, \$local@_part$\ contains the
9879 local part of the recipient address.
9880
9881 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter ~~CHAPrewrite),
9882 \$local@_part$\ contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
9883 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
9884
9885 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
9886 the addresses
9887 .display asis
9888 "abc:xyz"@test.example
9889 abc\:xyz@test.example
9890 .endd
9891 the value of \$local@_part$\ is
9892 .display asis
9893 abc:xyz
9894 .endd
9895 If you use \$local@_part$\ to create another address, you should always wrap it
9896 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a \%redirect%\ router you could have:
9897 .display asis
9898 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
9899 .endd
9900 \**Note**\: The value of \$local@_part$\ is normally lower cased. If you want
9901 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
9902 \caseful@_local@_part\ option (see chapter ~~CHAProutergeneric).
9903
9904 .tempindent 0
9905 \$local@_part@_data$\:
9906 When the \local@_parts\ option on a router matches a local part by means of a
9907 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
9908 router as \$local@_part@_data$\. In addition, if the driver routes the address
9909 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
9910 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
9911
9912 \$local@_part@_data$\ is also set when the \local@_parts\ condition in an ACL
9913 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
9914 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
9915 variable expands to nothing.
9916
9917 .tempindent 0
9918 \$local@_part@_prefix$\: When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
9919 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
9920 variable, having been removed from \$local@_part$\.
9921
9922 .tempindent 0
9923 \$local@_part@_suffix$\: When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
9924 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
9925 variable, having been removed from \$local@_part$\.
9926
9927 .tempindent 0
9928 \$local@_scan@_data$\: This variable contains the text returned by the
9929 \*local@_scan()*\ function when a message is received. See chapter
9930 ~~CHAPlocalscan for more details.
9931
9932 .tempindent 0
9933 \$local@_user@_gid$\: See \$local@_user@_uid$\.
9934
9935 .tempindent 0
9936 \$local@_user@_uid$\: This variable and \$local@_user@_gid$\ are set to
9937 the uid and gid after the \check__local__user\ router precondition succeeds.
9938 This means that their values are available for the remaining preconditions
9939 (\senders\, \require@_files\, and \condition\), for the \address@_data\
9940 expansion, and for any router-specific expansions. At all other times, the
9941 values in these variables are \"(uid@_t)(-1)"\ and \"(gid@_t)(-1)"\,
9942 respectively.
9943
9944 .tempindent 0
9945 \$localhost@_number$\: This contains the expanded value of the
9946 \localhost@_number\ option. The expansion happens after the main options have
9947 been read.
9948
9949 .em
9950 .tempindent 0
9951 \$log@_inodes$\: The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
9952 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
9953 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
9954 the value of is -1. See also the \check@_log@_inodes\ option.
9955
9956 .tempindent 0
9957 \$log@_space$\: The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
9958 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
9959 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
9960 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
9961 the space value is -1. See also the \check@_log@_space\ option.
9962 .nem
9963
9964 .tempindent 0
9965 \$mailstore@_basename$\: This variable is set only when doing deliveries in
9966 `mailstore' format in the \%appendfile%\ transport. During the expansion of the
9967 \mailstore@_prefix\, \mailstore@_suffix\, \message__prefix\, and
9968 \message@_suffix\ options, it contains the basename of the files that are being
9969 written, that is, the name without the `.tmp', `.env', or `.msg' suffix. At all
9970 other times, this variable is empty.
9971
9972 .em
9973 .tempindent 0
9974 \$malware@_name$\: This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
9975 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
9976 when the ACL \malware\ condition is true (see section ~~SECTscanvirus).
9977 .nem
9978
9979 .index message||age of
9980 .tempindent 0
9981 \$message@_age$\: This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to
9982 contain the number of seconds since the message was received. It does not
9983 change during a single delivery attempt.
9984
9985 .index body of message||expansion variable
9986 .index message||body, in expansion
9987 .index binary zero||in message body
9988 .tempindent 0
9989 \$message@_body$\: This variable contains the initial portion of a message's
9990 body while it is being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter
9991 files. The maximum number of characters of the body that are put into the
9992 variable is set by the \message@_body@_visible\ configuration option; the
9993 default is 500. Newlines are converted into spaces to make it easier to search
9994 for phrases that might be split over a line break.
9995 Binary zeros are also converted into spaces.
9996
9997 .index body of message||expansion variable
9998 .index message||body, in expansion
9999 .tempindent 0
10000 \$message@_body@_end$\: This variable contains the final portion of a message's
10001 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
10002 \$message@_body$\.
10003
10004 .index body of message||size
10005 .index message||body, size
10006 .tempindent 0
10007 \$message@_body@_size$\: When a message is being delivered, this variable
10008 contains the size of the body in bytes. The count starts from the character
10009 after the blank line that separates the body from the header. Newlines are
10010 included in the count. See also \$message@_size$\, \$body@_linecount$\, and
10011 \$body@_zerocount$\.
10012
10013 .tempindent 0
10014 \$message@_headers$\:
10015 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
10016 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
10017 lines are separated by newline characters.
10018
10019 .tempindent 0
10020 \$message@_id$\:
10021 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10022 unique message id that is used by Exim to identify the message.
10023 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been
10024 successfully received.
10025 \**Note**\: This is \*not*\ the contents of the ::Message-ID:: header line; it
10026 is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
10027 \"1BXTIK-0001yO-VA"\.
10028
10029 .index size||of message
10030 .index message||size
10031 .tempindent 0
10032 \$message@_size$\:
10033 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
10034 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
10035 message, but not those (such as ::Envelope-to::) that are added to individual
10036 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
10037 expansion of the \maildir@_tag\ option in the \%appendfile%\ transport while
10038 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of \$message@_size$\ is the
10039 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
10040 \$message@_body@_size$\, \$body@_linecount$\, and \$body@_zerocount$\.
10041
10042 .index \\RCPT\\||value of \$message@_size$\
10043 While running an ACL at the time of an SMTP \\RCPT\\ command, \$message@_size$\
10044 contains the size supplied on the \\MAIL\\ command, or
10045 -1
10046 if no size was given. The value may not, of course, be truthful.
10047
10048 .em
10049 .tempindent 0
10050 \$mime@_$\\*xxx*\: A number of variables whose names start with \$mime$\ are
10051 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
10052 details, see section ~~SECTscanmimepart.
10053 .nem
10054
10055 .tempindent 0
10056 \$n0$\ -- \$n9$\: These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
10057 of the \add\ command in filter files.
10058
10059 .tempindent 0
10060 \$original@_domain$\: When a top-level address is being processed for delivery,
10061 this contains the same value as \$domain$\. However, if a `child' address (for
10062 example, generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed,
10063 this variable contains the domain of the original address. This differs from
10064 \$parent@_domain$\ only when there is more than one level of aliasing or
10065 forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a single transport
10066 run, \$original@_domain$\ is not set.
10067
10068 If new an address is created by means of a \deliver\ command in a system
10069 filter, it is set up with an artificial `parent' address. This has the local
10070 part \*system-filter*\ and the default qualify domain.
10071
10072 .tempindent 0
10073 \$original@_local@_part$\: When a top-level address is being processed for
10074 delivery, this contains the same value as \$local@_part$\, unless a prefix or
10075 suffix was removed from the local part, because \$original@_local@_part$\
10076 always contains the full local part. When a `child' address (for example,
10077 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
10078 variable contains the full local part of the original address.
10079
10080 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
10081 case-insensitively, the value in \$original@_local@_part$\ is in lower case.
10082 This variable differs from \$parent@_local@_part$\ only when there is more than
10083 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
10084 delivered in a single transport run, \$original@_local@_part$\ is not set.
10085
10086 If new an address is created by means of a \deliver\ command in a system
10087 filter, it is set up with an artificial `parent' address. This has the local
10088 part \*system-filter*\ and the default qualify domain.
10089
10090
10091 .index gid (group id)||of originating user
10092 .index sender||gid
10093 .tempindent 0
10094 \$originator@_gid$\: The value of \$caller@_gid$\ that was set when the message
10095 was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the gid of
10096 the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally
10097 the gid of the Exim user.
10098
10099 .index uid (user id)||of originating user
10100 .index sender||uid
10101 .tempindent 0
10102 \$originator@_uid$\: The value of \$caller@_uid$\ that was set when the message
10103 was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the uid of
10104 the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally
10105 the uid of the Exim user.
10106
10107 .tempindent 0
10108 \$parent@_domain$\: This variable is similar to \$original@_domain$\ (see
10109 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
10110
10111 .tempindent 0
10112 \$parent@_local@_part$\: This variable is similar to \$original@_local@_part$\
10113 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
10114
10115 .index pid (process id)||of current process
10116 .tempindent 0
10117 \$pid$\: This variable contains the current process id.
10118
10119 .index filter||transport filter
10120 .index transport||filter
10121 .tempindent 0
10122 \$pipe@_addresses$\: This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here
10123 because the string `@$pipe@_addresses' is handled specially in the command
10124 specification for the \%pipe%\ transport (chapter ~~CHAPpipetransport) and in
10125 transport filters (described under \transport@_filter\ in chapter
10126 ~~CHAPtransportgeneric). It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and
10127 provokes an `unknown variable' error if encountered.
10128
10129 .tempindent 0
10130 \$primary@_hostname$\: The value set in the configuration file, or read by the
10131 \*uname()*\ function. If \*uname()*\ returns a single-component name, Exim
10132 calls \*gethostbyname()*\ (or \*getipnodebyname()*\ where available) in an
10133 attempt to acquire a fully qualified host name.
10134 See also \$smtp@_active@_hostname$\.
10135
10136 .tempindent 0
10137 \$qualify@_domain$\: The value set for this option in the configuration file.
10138
10139 .tempindent 0
10140 \$qualify@_recipient$\: The value set for this option in the configuration file,
10141 or if not set, the value of \$qualify@_domain$\.
10142
10143 .tempindent 0
10144 \$rcpt@_count$\: When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable
10145 contains the number of \\RCPT\\ commands received for the current message. If
10146 this variable is used in a \\RCPT\\ ACL, its value includes the current
10147 command.
10148
10149 .tempindent 0
10150 \$rcpt@_defer@_count$\: When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable
10151 contains the number of \\RCPT\\ commands in the current message that have
10152 previously been rejected with a temporary (4\*xx*\) response.
10153
10154 .tempindent 0
10155 \$rcpt@_fail@_count$\: When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable
10156 contains the number of \\RCPT\\ commands in the current message that have
10157 previously been rejected with a permanent (5\*xx*\) response.
10158
10159 .tempindent 0
10160 \$received@_count$\: This variable contains the number of ::Received:: header
10161 lines in the message, including the one added by Exim (so its value is always
10162 greater than zero). It is available in the \\DATA\\ ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and
10163 while routing and delivering.
10164
10165 .tempindent 0
10166 \$received@_for$\: If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming
10167 message, this variable contains that address when the ::Received:: header line
10168 is being built.
10169 The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before the
10170 \*local@_scan()*\ function is run.
10171
10172 .tempindent 0
10173 \$received@_protocol$\: When a message is being processed, this variable
10174 contains the name of the protocol by which it was received.
10175 .em
10176 Most of the names used by Exim are defined by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They
10177 start with `smtp' (the client used \\HELO\\) or `esmtp' (the client used
10178 \\EHLO\\). This can be followed by `s' for secure (encrypted) and/or `a' for
10179 authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol is set to `esmtpsa', the
10180 message was received over an encrypted SMTP connection and the client was
10181 successfully authenticated.
10182
10183 Exim uses the protocol name `smtps' for the case when encryption is
10184 automatically set up on connection without the use of \\STARTTLS\\ (see
10185 \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\), and the client uses \\HELO\\ to initiate the
10186 encrypted SMTP session. The name `smtps' is also used for the rare situation
10187 where the client initially uses \\EHLO\\, sets up an encrypted connection using
10188 \\STARTTLS\\, and then uses \\HELO\\ afterwards.
10189
10190 The \-oMr-\ option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
10191 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
10192 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
10193 .nem
10194
10195 .tempindent 0
10196 \$recipient@_data$\: This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in
10197 an ACL \recipients\ condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
10198 value remains set until the next \recipients\ test. Thus, you can do things
10199 like this:
10200 .display
10201 require recipients = cdb*@@;/some/file
10202 deny \*some further test involving*\ @$recipient@_data
10203 .endd
10204 \**Warning**\: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
10205 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
10206 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
10207 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
10208
10209 .em
10210 .tempindent 0
10211 \$recipient@_verify@_failure$\: In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails,
10212 this variable contains information about the failure. It is set to one of the
10213 following words:
10214 .numberpars " "
10215 `qualify': The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
10216 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
10217 .nextp
10218 `route': Routing failed.
10219 .nextp
10220 `mail': Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
10221 or before the \\MAIL\\ command (that is, on initial connection, \\HELO\\, or
10222 \\MAIL\\).
10223 .nextp
10224 `recipient': The \\RCPT\\ command in a callout was rejected.
10225 .nextp
10226 `postmaster': The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
10227 .endp
10228 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
10229 rejections of \\MAIL\\ and rejections of \\RCPT\\.
10230 .nem
10231
10232 .tempindent 0
10233 \$recipients$\: This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a
10234 message. A comma and a space separate the addresses in the replacement text.
10235 However, the variable is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc
10236 recipients in unprivileged users' filter files. You can use \$recipients$\ only
10237 in these two cases:
10238 .numberpars
10239 In a system filter file.
10240 .nextp
10241 .em
10242 In the ACLs associated with the \\DATA\\ command, that is, the ACLs defined by
10243 \acl@_smtp@_predata\ and \acl@_smtp@_data\.
10244 .nem
10245 .endp
10246
10247 .tempindent 0
10248 \$recipients@_count$\: When a message is being processed, this variable
10249 contains the number of envelope recipients that came with the message.
10250 Duplicates are not excluded from the count. While a message is being received
10251 over SMTP, the number increases for each accepted recipient. It can be
10252 referenced in an ACL.
10253
10254 .tempindent 0
10255 \$reply@_address$\: When a message is being processed, this variable contains
10256 the contents of the ::Reply-To:: header line if one exists
10257 and it is not empty,
10258 or otherwise the contents of the ::From:: header line.
10259
10260 .tempindent 0
10261 \$return@_path$\: When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the
10262 return path -- the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It
10263 is not enclosed in @<@> characters.
10264 At the start of routing an address,
10265 \$return@_path$\ has the same value as \$sender@_address$\, but if, for
10266 example, an incoming message to a mailing list has been expanded by a router
10267 which specifies a different address for bounce messages, \$return@_path$\
10268 subsequently contains the new bounce address, whereas \$sender@_address$\
10269 always contains the original sender address that was received with the message.
10270 In other words, \$sender@_address$\ contains the incoming envelope sender, and
10271 \$return@_path$\ contains the outgoing envelope sender.
10272
10273 .tempindent 0
10274 \$return@_size@_limit$\: This is an obsolete name for
10275 \$bounce@_return@_size@_limit$\.
10276
10277 .index return code||from \run\ expansion
10278 .tempindent 0
10279 \$runrc$\: This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by
10280 the \@$@{run...@}\ expansion item.
10281 \**Warning**\: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10282 option values are expanded, except for those pre-conditions whose order of
10283 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set \$runrc$\
10284 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10285
10286 .tempindent 0
10287 \$self@_hostname$\: When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that
10288 turns out to be the local host, what happens is controlled by the
10289 .index \self\ option||value of host name
10290 \self\ generic router option. One of its values causes the address to be passed
10291 to another router. When this happens, \$self@_hostname$\ is set to the name of
10292 the local host that the original router encountered. In other circumstances its
10293 contents are null.
10294
10295 .tempindent 0
10296 \$sender@_address$\: When a message is being processed, this variable contains
10297 the sender's address that was received in the message's envelope. For bounce
10298 messages, the value of this variable is the empty string.
10299 See also \$return@_path$\.
10300
10301 .em
10302 .tempindent 0
10303 \$sender@_address@_data$\: If \$address@_data$\ is set when the routers are
10304 called from an ACL to verify a sender address, the final value is preserved in
10305 \$sender@_address@_data$\, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10306 address. The value does not persist after the end of the current ACL statement.
10307 If you want to preserve it for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
10308 .nem
10309
10310 .tempindent 0
10311 \$sender@_address@_domain$\: The domain portion of \$sender@_address$\.
10312
10313 .tempindent 0
10314 \$sender@_address@_local@_part$\: The local part portion of \$sender@_address$\.
10315
10316 .tempindent 0
10317 \$sender@_data$\: This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL
10318 \senders\ condition or in a router \senders\ option. It contains the data from
10319 the lookup, and the value remains set until the next \senders\ test. Thus, you
10320 can do things like this:
10321 .display
10322 require senders = cdb*@@;/some/file
10323 deny \*some further test involving*\ @$sender@_data
10324 .endd
10325 \**Warning**\: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
10326 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
10327 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
10328 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
10329
10330 .tempindent 0
10331 \$sender@_fullhost$\: When a message is received from a remote host, this
10332 variable contains the host name and IP address in a single string. It ends
10333 with the IP address in square brackets, followed by a colon and a port number
10334 if the logging of ports is enabled. The format of the rest of the string
10335 depends on whether the host issued a \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ SMTP command, and
10336 whether the host name was verified by looking up its IP address. (Looking up
10337 the IP address can be forced by the \host@_lookup\ option, independent of
10338 verification.) A plain host name at the start of the string is a verified host
10339 name; if this is not present, verification either failed or was not requested.
10340 A host name in parentheses is the argument of a \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command.
10341 This is omitted if it is identical to the verified host name or to the host's
10342 IP address in square brackets.
10343
10344 .tempindent 0
10345 \$sender@_helo@_name$\: When a message is received from a remote host that has
10346 issued a \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command, the argument of that command is placed
10347 in this variable. It is also set if \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ is used when a message
10348 is received using SMTP locally via the \-bs-\ or \-bS-\ options.
10349
10350 .tempindent 0
10351 \$sender@_host@_address$\: When a message is received from a remote host, this
10352 variable contains that host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is
10353 empty.
10354
10355 .tempindent 0
10356 \$sender@_host@_authenticated$\: This variable contains the name (not the
10357 public name) of the authenticator driver which successfully authenticated the
10358 client from which the message was received. It is empty if there was no
10359 successful authentication.
10360
10361 .tempindent 0
10362 \$sender@_host@_name$\: When a message is received from a remote host, this
10363 variable contains the host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address.
10364 For messages received by other means, this variable is empty.
10365
10366 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
10367 \$sender@_host@_name$\ triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
10368 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
10369 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails
10370 .em
10371 to find any data,
10372 .nem
10373 or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
10374 \$sender@_host@_name$\ remains empty, and \$host@_lookup@_failed$\ is set to
10375 `1'.
10376 .em
10377 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
10378 DNS timeout), \$host@_lookup@_deferred$\ is set to `1', and
10379 \$host@_lookup@_failed$\ remains set to `0'.
10380
10381 Once \$host@_lookup@_failed$\ is set to `1', Exim does not try to look up the
10382 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to \$sender@_host@_name$\
10383 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if \$sender@_host@_deferred$\
10384 is set to `1'.
10385 .nem
10386
10387 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
10388 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
10389 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
10390 following are true:
10391 .numberpars
10392 A string containing \$sender@_host@_name$\ is expanded.
10393 .nextp
10394 The calling host matches the list in \host@_lookup\. In the default
10395 configuration, this option is set to $*$, so it must be changed if lookups are
10396 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for \host@_lookup\ is unset.)
10397 .nextp
10398 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
10399 that require this are described in sections ~~SECThoslispatnam and
10400 ~~SECThoslispatnamsk.
10401 .nextp
10402 The calling host matches \helo@_try@_verify@_hosts\ or \helo@_verify@_hosts\.
10403 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
10404 \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\ commands that the client issues.
10405 .nextp
10406 The remote host issues a \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\ command that quotes one of the
10407 domains in \helo@_lookup@_domains\. The default value of this option is
10408 .display asis
10409 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
10410 .endd
10411 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
10412 IP address in an \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\ command.
10413 .endp
10414
10415 .tempindent 0
10416 \$sender@_host@_port$\: When a message is received from a remote host, this
10417 variable contains the port number that was used on the remote host.
10418
10419 .tempindent 0
10420 \$sender@_ident$\: When a message is received from a remote host, this variable
10421 contains the identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a
10422 message has been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the
10423 user that called Exim.
10424
10425 .tempindent 0
10426 \$sender@_rcvhost$\: This is provided specifically for use in ::Received::
10427 headers. It starts with either the verified host name (as obtained from a
10428 .index DNS||reverse lookup
10429 .index reverse DNS lookup
10430 reverse DNS lookup) or, if there is no verified host name, the IP address in
10431 square brackets. After that there may be text in parentheses. When the first
10432 item is a verified host name, the first thing in the parentheses is the IP
10433 address in square brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if port
10434 logging is enabled. When the first item is an IP address, the port is recorded
10435 as `port=$it{xxxx}' inside the parentheses.
10436
10437 There may also be items of the form `helo=$it{xxxx}' if \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\
10438 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
10439 address, and `ident=$it{xxxx}' if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If all
10440 three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted into
10441 the string, to improve the formatting of the ::Received:: header.
10442
10443 .em
10444 .tempindent 0
10445 \$sender@_verify@_failure$\: In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this
10446 variable contains information about the failure. The details are the same as
10447 for \$recipient@_verify@_failure$\.
10448
10449 .tempindent 0
10450 \$smtp@_active@_hostname$\: During an SMTP session, this variable contains the
10451 value of the active host name, as specified by the \smtp@_active@_hostname\
10452 option. The value of \$smtp@_active@_hostname$\ is saved with any message that
10453 is received, so its value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
10454 .nem
10455
10456 .index \\AUTH\\||argument
10457 .index \\EXPN\\||argument
10458 .index \\ETRN\\||argument
10459 .index \\VRFY\\||argument
10460 .tempindent 0
10461 \$smtp@_command@_argument$\: While an ACL is running to check an \\AUTH\\,
10462 \\EHLO\\, \\EXPN\\, \\ETRN\\, \\HELO\\, or \\VRFY\\ command, this variable
10463 contains the argument for the SMTP command.
10464
10465 .tempindent 0
10466 \$sn0$\ -- \$sn9$\: These variables are copies of the values of the \$n0$\
10467 -- \$n9$\ accumulators that were current at the end of the system filter file.
10468 This allows a system filter file to set values that can be tested in users'
10469 filter files. For example, a system filter could set a value indicating how
10470 likely it is that a message is junk mail.
10471
10472 .em
10473 .tempindent 0
10474 \$spam@_$\\*xxx*\: A number of variables whose names start with \$spam$\ are
10475 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
10476 details, see section ~~SECTscanspamass.
10477 .nem
10478
10479 .tempindent 0
10480 \$spool@_directory$\: The name of Exim's spool directory.
10481
10482 .em
10483 .tempindent 0
10484 \$spool@_inodes$\: The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
10485 spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable
10486 is referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
10487 the value of is -1.
10488 See also the \check@_spool@_inodes\ option.
10489
10490 .tempindent 0
10491 \$spool@_space$\: The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the
10492 disk partition where Exim's spool files are being written. The value is
10493 recalculated whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does
10494 not have the ability to find the amount of free space (only true for
10495 experimental systems), the space value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL
10496 that there is at least 50 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
10497 .display asis
10498 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
10499 .endd
10500 See also the \check@_spool@_space\ option.
10501 .nem
10502
10503 .tempindent 0
10504 \$thisaddress$\: This variable is set only during the processing of the
10505 \foranyaddress\ command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the
10506 description of that command.
10507
10508 .tempindent 0
10509 \$tls@_certificate@_verified$\:
10510 This variable is set to `1' if a TLS certificate was verified when the message
10511 was received, and `0' otherwise.
10512
10513 .tempindent 0
10514 \$tls@_cipher$\: When a message is received from a remote host over an
10515 encrypted SMTP connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was
10516 negotiated, for example DES-CBC3-SHA.
10517 In other circumstances, in particular, for message received over unencrypted
10518 connections, the variable is empty.
10519 See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for details of TLS support.
10520
10521 .tempindent 0
10522 \$tls@_peerdn$\: When a message is received from a remote host over an
10523 encrypted SMTP connection,
10524 and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
10525 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
10526 \$tls@_peerdn$\ during subsequent processing.
10527
10528 .tempindent 0
10529 \$tod@_bsdinbox$\: The time of day and date, in the format required for
10530 BSD-style mailbox files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
10531
10532 .tempindent 0
10533 \$tod@_epoch$\: The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the
10534 Unix epoch.
10535
10536 .tempindent 0
10537 \$tod@_full$\: A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct
10538 1995 09:51:40 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from
10539 UTC, with positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and
10540 negative values for those that are behind (west).
10541
10542 .tempindent 0
10543 \$tod@_log$\: The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log
10544 files, for example: 1995-10-12 15:32:29,
10545 but without a timezone.
10546
10547 .tempindent 0
10548 \$tod@_logfile$\:
10549 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
10550 is used for datestamping log files when \log@_file@_path\ contains the \"%D"\
10551 flag.
10552
10553 .tempindent 0
10554 \$tod@_zone$\: This variable contains the numerical value of the local
10555 timezone, for example: -0500.
10556
10557 .tempindent 0
10558 \$tod@_zulu$\:
10559 This variable contains the UTC date and time in `Zulu' format, as specified by
10560 ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
10561
10562 .index \$value$\
10563 .tempindent 0
10564 \$value$\: This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction
10565 operation, or external command, as described above.
10566
10567 .tempindent 0
10568 \$version@_number$\: The version number of Exim.
10569
10570 .tempindent 0
10571 \$warn@_message@_delay$\: This variable is set only during the creation of a
10572 message warning about a delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in
10573 section ~~SECTcustwarn.
10574
10575 .tempindent 0
10576 \$warn@_message@_recipients$\: This variable is set only during the creation of
10577 a message warning about a delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in
10578 section ~~SECTcustwarn.
10579 .pop
10580
10581
10582
10583 .
10584 .
10585 . ============================================================================
10586 .chapter Embedded Perl
10587 .set runningfoot "embedded Perl"
10588 .rset CHAPperl "~~chapter"
10589 .index Perl||calling from Exim
10590
10591 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
10592 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
10593 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
10594 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
10595 the line
10596 .display asis
10597 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
10598 .endd
10599 in your \(Local/Makefile)\ and then build Exim in the normal way.
10600
10601 .section Setting up so Perl can be used
10602 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
10603 .index \perl@_startup\
10604 \perl@_startup\ and an expansion string operator \@$@{perl ...@}\. If there is
10605 no \perl@_startup\ option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
10606 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
10607 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a \perl@_startup\
10608 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
10609 a newly created Perl interpreter.
10610
10611 The value of \perl@_startup\ is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
10612 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
10613 should usually be something like
10614 .display asis
10615 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
10616 .endd
10617 where \(/etc/exim.pl)\ is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
10618 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
10619 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
10620 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
10621 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
10622 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
10623 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
10624 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
10625 two ways:
10626 .numberpars $.
10627 .index \perl@_at@_start\
10628 Setting \perl@_at@_start\ (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
10629 a startup when Exim is entered.
10630 .nextp
10631 The command line option \-ps-\ also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
10632 overriding the setting of \perl@_at@_start\.
10633 .endp
10634 There is also a command line option \-pd-\ (for delay) which suppresses the
10635 initial startup, even if \perl@_at@_start\ is set.
10636
10637 .section Calling Perl subroutines
10638 When the configuration file includes a \perl@_startup\ option you can make use
10639 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
10640 by the \perl@_startup\ code. The operator is used in any of the following
10641 forms:
10642 .display asis
10643 ${perl{foo}}
10644 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
10645 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
10646 .endd
10647 which calls the subroutine \foo\ with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
10648 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
10649 with an error message of the form
10650 .display asis
10651 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
10652 .endd
10653 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
10654 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
10655 return value is \*undef*\, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
10656 an explicit `fail' on an \@$@{if ...@}\ or \@$@{lookup...@}\ item. If the
10657 subroutine aborts by obeying Perl's \die\ function, the expansion fails with
10658 the error message that was passed to \die\.
10659
10660 .section Calling Exim functions from Perl
10661 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function \*Exim@:@:expand@_string*\
10662 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
10663 the Perl code
10664 .display asis
10665 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
10666 .endd
10667 makes the current Exim \$local@_part$\ available in the Perl variable \$lp$\.
10668 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
10669 \$local@_part$\ being interpolated as a Perl variable.
10670
10671 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a `fail' item, the result of
10672 \*Exim@:@:expand@_string*\ is \undef\. If there is a syntax error in the
10673 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
10674 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if \die\ were used.
10675
10676 .index debugging||from embedded Perl
10677 .index log||writing from embedded Perl
10678 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
10679 \*Exim@:@:debug@_write(<<string>>)*\ writes the string to the standard error
10680 stream if Exim's debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you
10681 must supply it. \*Exim@:@:log@_write(<<string>>)*\ writes the string to Exim's
10682 main log, adding a leading timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a
10683 terminating newline.
10684
10685 .em
10686 .section Use of standard output and error by Perl
10687 .index Perl||standard output and error
10688 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
10689 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
10690 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
10691 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
10692 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
10693 error streams are connected to \(/dev/null)\ in the daemon. The chaos is
10694 avoided, but the output is lost.
10695
10696 .index Perl||\warn\, use of
10697 The Perl \warn\ statement writes to the standard error stream by default. Calls
10698 to \warn\ may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which you have
10699 no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for output
10700 from the \warn\ statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can change
10701 this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code. For
10702 example, to discard \warn\ output completely, you need this:
10703 .display asis
10704 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
10705 .endd
10706 Whenever a \warn\ is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
10707 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
10708 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the \warn\ message is passed
10709 as the first subroutine argument.
10710 .nem
10711
10712
10713 .
10714 .
10715 .
10716 .
10717 . ============================================================================
10718 .chapter Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces
10719 .set runningfoot "starting the daemon"
10720 .rset CHAPinterfaces "~~chapter"
10721 .index daemon||starting
10722 .index interface||listening
10723 .index network interface
10724 .index interface||network
10725 .index IP address||for listening
10726 .index daemon||listening IP addresses
10727 .index TCP/IP||setting listening interfaces
10728 .index TCP/IP||setting listening ports
10729
10730 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
10731 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
10732 or more `logical' interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
10733 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
10734 In addition, TCP/IP software supports `loopback' interfaces (127.0.0.1 in IPv4
10735 and @:@:1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
10736 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
10737 .numberpars
10738 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
10739 and ports to listen on.
10740 .nextp
10741 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
10742 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
10743 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
10744 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
10745 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
10746 local host. Unless the \self\ router option or the \allow@_localhost\
10747 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
10748 as an error situation.
10749 .nextp
10750 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
10751 for the outgoing connection.
10752 .endp
10753
10754 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
10755 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
10756 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
10757 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
10758 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
10759
10760 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
10761 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
10762 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
10763 chapter describes how they operate.
10764
10765 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
10766 actually used are set in \$interface@_address$\ and \$interface@_port$\.
10767
10768
10769 .section Starting a listening daemon
10770 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the \-bd-\ command line
10771 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
10772 following options:
10773 .numberpars $.
10774 \daemon@_smtp@_ports\ contains a list of default ports. (For backward
10775 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
10776 .nextp
10777 \local@_interfaces\ contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
10778 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
10779 .endp
10780 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
10781 described in section ~~SECTlistconstruct. When IPv6 addresses are involved, it
10782 is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
10783 colons. For example:
10784 .display asis
10785 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
10786 192.168.23.65 ; \
10787 ::1 ; \
10788 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
10789 .endd
10790 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
10791 in \local@_interfaces\:
10792 .numberpars
10793 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
10794 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
10795 .display asis
10796 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
10797 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
10798 .endd
10799 .nextp
10800 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
10801 with a colon separator, for example:
10802 .display asis
10803 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
10804 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
10805 .endd
10806 .endp
10807 When a port is not specified, the value of \daemon@_smtp@_ports\ is used. The
10808 default setting contains just one port:
10809 .display asis
10810 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
10811 .endd
10812 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
10813 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
10814 \daemon@_smtp@_ports\ can be identified either by name (defined in
10815 \(/etc/services)\) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
10816 IP addresses in \local@_interfaces\, only numbers (not names) can be used.
10817
10818
10819 .section Special IP listening addresses
10820 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and @:@:0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
10821 as `all IPv4 interfaces' and `all IPv6 interfaces', respectively. In each
10822 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to `listen on all IPv\*x*\ interfaces'
10823 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
10824 default value of \local@_interfaces\ is
10825 .display asis
10826 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
10827 .endd
10828 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
10829 .display asis
10830 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
10831 .endd
10832 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
10833
10834
10835 .section Overriding local@_interfaces and daemon@_smtp@_ports
10836 The \-oX-\ command line option can be used to override the values of
10837 \daemon@_smtp@_ports\ and/or \local@_interfaces\ for a particular daemon
10838 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the \-D-\
10839 option. However, \-oX-\ can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
10840 the runtime configuration by \-D-\ is allowed only when the caller is root or
10841 exim.
10842
10843 The value of \-oX-\ is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
10844 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
10845 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
10846 \daemon@_smtp@_ports\ is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
10847 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of \local@_interfaces\ is
10848 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
10849 .display asis
10850 -oX 1225
10851 .endd
10852 overrides \daemon@_smtp@_ports\, but leaves \local@_interfaces\ unchanged,
10853 whereas
10854 .display asis
10855 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
10856 .endd
10857 overrides \local@_interfaces\, leaving \daemon@_smtp@_ports\ unchanged.
10858 (However, since \local@_interfaces\ now contains no items without ports, the
10859 value of \daemon@_smtp@_ports\ is no longer relevant in this example.)
10860
10861
10862 .em
10863 .section Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol
10864 .rset SECTsupobssmt "~~chapter.~~section"
10865 .index ssmtp protocol
10866 .index smtps protocol
10867 .index SMTP||ssmtp protocol
10868 .index SMTP||smtps protocol
10869 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
10870 before the \\STARTTLS\\ command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
10871 still use this protocol. If the \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ option is set to a
10872 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
10873 common use of this option is expected to be
10874 .display asis
10875 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
10876 .endd
10877 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
10878 a command line option \-tls-on-connect-\, which forces all ports to behave in
10879 this way when a daemon is started.
10880
10881 \**Warning**\: Setting \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ does not of itself cause the
10882 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
10883 \daemon@_smtp@_ports\, \local@_interfaces\, or the \-oX-\ option. (This is
10884 because \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ applies to \inetd\ connections as well as to
10885 connections via the daemon.)
10886 .nem
10887
10888
10889 .section IPv6 address scopes
10890 IPv6 addresses have `scopes', and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
10891 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
10892 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
10893 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
10894 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
10895 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
10896 .display asis
10897 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
10898 .endd
10899 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
10900 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls \*getaddrinfo()*\
10901 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
10902 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
10903 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
10904 \*getaddrinfo()*\. If
10905 .display asis
10906 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
10907 .endd
10908 is set in \(Local/Makefile)\ (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
10909 Exim uses \*inet@_pton()*\ to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
10910 instead of \*getaddrinfo()*\. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
10911 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
10912 \*getaddrinfo()*\ -- recognizing scoped addresses -- is lost.
10913
10914
10915 .section Examples of starting a listening daemon
10916 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
10917 .display asis
10918 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
10919 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
10920 .endd
10921 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
10922 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
10923 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
10924 read the comments in the \(daemon.c)\ source file.)
10925
10926 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
10927 .display asis
10928 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
10929 .endd
10930 (leaving \local@_interfaces\ at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
10931 .display asis
10932 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
10933 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
10934 .endd
10935 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
10936 IPv4 loopback address only:
10937 .display asis
10938 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
10939 .endd
10940 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
10941 .display asis
10942 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
10943 .endd
10944 \**Warning**\: such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
10945
10946
10947 .section Recognising the local host
10948 .rset SECTreclocipadd "~~chapter.~~section"
10949 The \local@_interfaces\ option is also used when Exim needs to determine
10950 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
10951 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
10952 treated as local.
10953
10954 For this usage, port numbers in \local@_interfaces\ are ignored. If either of
10955 the items 0.0.0.0 or @:@:0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
10956 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
10957 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
10958
10959 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
10960 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
10961 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
10962 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
10963 \extra@_local@_interfaces\ to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
10964 `all' wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
10965 used for listening. Consider this example:
10966 .display asis
10967 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
10968 192.168.53.235 ; \
10969 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
10970
10971 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
10972 .endd
10973 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
10974 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
10975 Exim is routing.
10976
10977 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
10978 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
10979 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
10980 these cases can be handled by setting the \hosts@_treat@_as@_local\ option.
10981 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
10982 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
10983 host if its name matches \hosts@_treat@_as@_local\, or if any of its IP
10984 addresses match \local@_interfaces\ or \extra@_local@_interfaces\.
10985
10986
10987 .section Delivering to a remote host
10988 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
10989 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
10990 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
10991 \interface\ option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
10992 description of the smtp transport in chapter ~~CHAPsmtptrans for more details.
10993
10994
10995
10996
10997 .
10998 .
10999 .
11000 .
11001 . ============================================================================
11002 .chapter Main configuration
11003 .set runningfoot "main configuration"
11004 .rset CHAPmainconfig "~~chapter"
11005 .index configuration file||main section
11006 .index main configuration
11007 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
11008 .numberpars $.
11009 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
11010 ~~SECTmacrodefs for details of macro processing.
11011 .nextp
11012 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words `domainlist',
11013 `hostlist', `addresslist', or `localpartlist'. Their use is described in
11014 section ~~SECTnamedlists.
11015 .nextp
11016 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
11017 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
11018 `hide', the \-bP-\ command line option displays its value to admin users only.
11019 See section ~~SECTcos for a description of the syntax of these option settings.
11020 .endp
11021 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
11022 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
11023 in alphabetical order in section ~~SECTalomo below. However, because there are
11024 now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as an
11025 aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
11026 listed in more than one group.
11027
11028 .set savedisplayflowcheck ~~displayflowcheck
11029 .set displayflowcheck 0
11030
11031 .section Miscellaneous
11032 .display flow rm
11033 .tabs 31
11034 \bi@_command\ $t$rm{to run for \-bi-\ command line option}
11035 \keep@_malformed\ $t$rm{for broken files -- should not happen}
11036 \localhost@_number\ $t$rm{for unique message ids in clusters}
11037 \message@_body@_visible\ $t$rm{how much to show in \$message@_body$\}
11038 .newline
11039 .em
11040 \mua@_wrapper\ $t$rm{run in `MUA wrapper' mode}
11041 .nem
11042 .newline
11043 \print@_topbitchars\ $t$rm{top-bit characters are printing}
11044 \timezone\ $t$rm{force time zone}
11045 .endd
11046
11047 .section Exim parameters
11048 .display flow rm
11049 .tabs 31
11050 \exim@_group\ $t$rm{override compiled-in value}
11051 \exim@_path\ $t$rm{override compiled-in value}
11052 \exim@_user\ $t$rm{override compiled-in value}
11053 \primary@_hostname\ $t$rm{default from \*uname()*\}
11054 \split@_spool@_directory\ $t$rm{use multiple directories}
11055 \spool@_directory\ $t$rm{override compiled-in value}
11056 .endd
11057
11058 .section Privilege controls
11059 .display flow rm
11060 .tabs 31
11061 \admin@_groups\ $t$rm{groups that are Exim admin users}
11062 \deliver@_drop@_privilege\ $t$rm{drop root for delivery processes}
11063 \local@_from@_check\ $t$rm{insert ::Sender:: if necessary}
11064 \local@_from@_prefix\ $t$rm{for testing ::From:: for local sender}
11065 \local@_from@_suffix\ $t$rm{for testing ::From:: for local sender}
11066 \local@_sender@_retain\ $t$rm{keep ::Sender:: from untrusted user}
11067 \never@_users\ $t$rm{do not run deliveries as these}
11068 \prod@_requires@_admin\ $t$rm{forced delivery requires admin user}
11069 \queue@_list@_requires@_admin\ $t$rm{queue listing requires admin user}
11070 \trusted@_groups\ $t$rm{groups that are trusted}
11071 \trusted@_users\ $t$rm{users that are trusted}
11072 .endd
11073
11074 .section Logging
11075 .display flow rm
11076 .tabs 31
11077 .em
11078 \hosts@_connection@_nolog\ $t$rm{exemption from connect logging}
11079 .nem
11080 .newline
11081 \log@_file@_path\ $t$rm{override compiled-in value}
11082 \log@_selector\ $t$rm{set/unset optional logging}
11083 \log@_timezone\ $t$rm{add timezone to log lines}
11084 \message@_logs\ $t$rm{create per-message logs}
11085 \preserve@_message@_logs\ $t$rm{after message completion}
11086 \process@_log@_path\ $t$rm{for SIGUSR1 and \*exiwhat*\}
11087 \syslog@_duplication\ $t$rm{controls duplicate log lines on syslog }
11088 \syslog@_facility\ $t$rm{set syslog `facility' field}
11089 \syslog@_processname\ $t$rm{set syslog `ident' field}
11090 \syslog@_timestamp\ $t$rm{timestamp syslog lines}
11091 .newline
11092 \write@_rejectlog\ $t$rm{control use of message log}
11093 .newline
11094 .endd
11095
11096 .section Frozen messages
11097 .display flow rm
11098 .tabs 31
11099 \auto@_thaw\ $t$rm{sets time for retrying frozen messages}
11100 \freeze@_tell\ $t$rm{send message when freezing}
11101 \move@_frozen@_messages\ $t$rm{to another directory}
11102 \timeout@_frozen@_after\ $t$rm{keep frozen messages only so long}
11103 .endd
11104
11105 .section Data lookups
11106 .display flow rm
11107 .tabs 31
11108 \ldap@_default@_servers\ $t$rm{used if no server in query}
11109 \ldap@_version\ $t$rm{set protocol version}
11110 \lookup@_open@_max\ $t$rm{lookup files held open}
11111 \mysql@_servers\ $t$rm{as it says}
11112 \oracle@_servers\ $t$rm{as it says}
11113 \pgsql@_servers\ $t$rm{as it says}
11114 .endd
11115
11116 .section Message ids
11117 .display flow rm
11118 .tabs 31
11119 \message@_id@_header@_domain\ $t$rm{used to build ::Message-ID:: header}
11120 \message@_id@_header@_text\ $t$rm{ditto}
11121 .endd
11122
11123 .section Embedded Perl Startup
11124 .display flow rm
11125 .tabs 31
11126 \perl@_at@_start\ $t$rm{always start the interpreter}
11127 \perl@_startup\ $t$rm{code to obey when starting Perl}
11128 .endd
11129
11130 .section Daemon
11131 .display flow rm
11132 .tabs 31
11133 \daemon@_smtp@_ports\ $t$rm{default ports}
11134 \extra@_local@_interfaces\ $t$rm{not necessarily listened on}
11135 \local@_interfaces\ $t$rm{on which to listen, with optional ports}
11136 \pid@_file@_path\ $t$rm{override compiled-in value}
11137 \queue@_run@_max\ $t$rm{maximum simultaneous queue runners}
11138 .endd
11139
11140 .section Resource control
11141 .display flow rm
11142 .tabs 31
11143 \check@_log@_inodes\ $t$rm{before accepting a message}
11144 \check@_log@_space\ $t$rm{before accepting a message}
11145 \check@_spool@_inodes\ $t$rm{before accepting a message}
11146 \check@_spool@_space\ $t$rm{before accepting a message}
11147 \deliver@_queue@_load@_max\ $t$rm{no queue deliveries if load high}
11148 \queue@_only@_load\ $t$rm{queue incoming if load high}
11149 \queue@_run@_max\ $t$rm{maximum simultaneous queue runners}
11150 \remote@_max@_parallel\ $t$rm{parallel SMTP delivery per message}
11151 \smtp@_accept@_max\ $t$rm{simultaneous incoming connections}
11152 \smtp@_accept@_max@_nommail\ $t$rm{non-mail commands}
11153 \smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail@_hosts\ $t$rm{hosts to which the limit applies}
11154 \smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_connection\ $t$rm{messages per connection}
11155 \smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_host\ $t$rm{connections from one host}
11156 \smtp@_accept@_queue\ $t$rm{queue mail if more connections}
11157 \smtp@_accept@_queue@_per@_connection\ $t$rm{queue if more messages per connection}
11158 \smtp@_accept@_reserve\ $t$rm{only reserve hosts if more connections}
11159 \smtp@_check@_spool@_space\ $t$rm{from \\SIZE\\ on \\MAIL\\ command}
11160 \smtp@_connect@_backlog\ $t$rm{passed to TCP/IP stack}
11161 \smtp@_load@_reserve\ $t$rm{SMTP from reserved hosts if load high}
11162 \smtp@_reserve@_hosts\ $t$rm{these are the reserve hosts}
11163 .endd
11164
11165 .section Policy controls
11166 .display flow rm
11167 .tabs 31
11168 \acl@_not@_smtp\ $t$rm{set ACL for non-SMTP messages}
11169 \acl@_smtp@_auth\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\AUTH\\}
11170 \acl@_smtp@_connect\ $t$rm{set ACL for connection}
11171 \acl@_smtp@_data\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\DATA\\}
11172 \acl@_smtp@_etrn\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\ETRN\\}
11173 \acl@_smtp@_expn\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\EXPN\\}
11174 \acl@_smtp@_helo\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\}
11175 \acl@_smtp@_mail\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\MAIL\\}
11176 \acl@_smtp@_mailauth\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\AUTH\\ on \\MAIL\\ command}
11177 .newline
11178 .em
11179 \acl@_smtp@_mime\ $t$rm{set ACL for MIME parts}
11180 \acl@_smtp@_predata\ $t$rm{set ACL for start of data}
11181 \acl@_smtp@_quit\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\QUIT\\}
11182 .nem
11183 .newline
11184 \acl@_smtp@_rcpt\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\RCPT\\}
11185 \acl@_smtp@_starttls\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\STARTTLS\\}
11186 \acl@_smtp@_vrfy\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\VRFY\\}
11187 .newline
11188 .em
11189 \av@_scanner\ $t$rm{specify virus scanner}
11190 .nem
11191 .newline
11192 \header@_maxsize\ $t$rm{total size of message header}
11193 \header@_line@_maxsize\ $t$rm{individual header line limit}
11194 \helo@_accept@_junk@_hosts\ $t$rm{allow syntactic junk from these hosts}
11195 \helo@_allow@_chars\ $t$rm{allow illegal chars in \\HELO\\ names}
11196 \helo@_lookup@_domains\ $t$rm{lookup hostname for these \\HELO\\ names}
11197 \helo@_try@_verify@_hosts\ $t$rm{\\HELO\\ soft-checked for these hosts}
11198 \helo@_verify@_hosts\ $t$rm{\\HELO\\ hard-checked for these hosts}
11199 \host@_lookup\ $t$rm{host name looked up for these hosts}
11200 \host@_lookup@_order\ $t$rm{order of DNS and local name lookups}
11201 \host@_reject@_connection\ $t$rm{reject connection from these hosts}
11202 \hosts@_treat@_as@_local\ $t$rm{useful in some cluster configurations}
11203 \local@_scan@_timeout\ $t$rm{timeout for \*local@_scan()*\}
11204 \message@_size@_limit\ $t$rm{for all messages}
11205 \percent@_hack@_domains\ $t$rm{recognize %-hack for these domains}
11206 .newline
11207 .em
11208 \spamd@_address\ $t$rm{set interface to SpamAssassin}
11209 .nem
11210 .newline
11211 .endd
11212
11213 .section Callout cache
11214 .display flow rm
11215 .tabs 31
11216 \callout@_domain@_negative@_expire\ $t$rm{timeout for negative domain cache item}
11217 \callout@_domain@_positive@_expire\ $t$rm{timeout for positive domain cache item}
11218 \callout@_negative@_expire\ $t$rm{timeout for negative address cache item}
11219 \callout@_positive@_expire\ $t$rm{timeout for positive address cache item}
11220 \callout@_random@_local@_part\ $t$rm{string to use for `random' testing}
11221 .endd
11222
11223 .section TLS
11224 .display flow rm
11225 .tabs 31
11226 \tls@_advertise@_hosts\ $t$rm{advertise TLS to these hosts}
11227 \tls@_certificate\ $t$rm{location of server certificate}
11228 \tls@_crl\ $t$rm{certificate revocation list}
11229 \tls@_dhparam\ $t$rm{DH parameters for server}
11230 .newline
11231 .em
11232 \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ $t$rm{specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports}
11233 .nem
11234 .newline
11235 \tls@_privatekey\ $t$rm{location of server private key}
11236 \tls@_remember@_esmtp\ $t$rm{don't reset after starting TLS}
11237 \tls@_require@_ciphers\ $t$rm{specify acceptable cipers}
11238 \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\ $t$rm{try to verify client certificate}
11239 \tls@_verify@_certificates\ $t$rm{expected client certificates}
11240 \tls@_verify@_hosts\ $t$rm{insist on client certificate verify}
11241 .endd
11242
11243 .section Local user handling
11244 .display flow rm
11245 .tabs 31
11246 \finduser@_retries\ $t$rm{useful in NIS environments}
11247 \gecos@_name\ $t$rm{used when creating ::Sender::}
11248 \gecos@_pattern\ $t$rm{ditto}
11249 \max@_username@_length\ $t$rm{for systems that truncate}
11250 \unknown@_login\ $t$rm{used when no login name found}
11251 \unknown@_username\ $t$rm{ditto}
11252 \uucp@_from@_pattern\ $t$rm{for recognizing `From ' lines}
11253 \uucp@_from@_sender\ $t$rm{ditto}
11254 .endd
11255
11256 .section All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)
11257 .display flow rm
11258 .tabs 31
11259 \header@_maxsize\ $t$rm{total size of message header}
11260 \header@_line@_maxsize\ $t$rm{individual header line limit}
11261 \message@_size@_limit\ $t$rm{applies to all messages}
11262 \percent@_hack@_domains\ $t$rm{recognize %-hack for these domains}
11263 \received@_header@_text\ $t$rm{expanded to make ::Received::}
11264 \received@_headers@_max\ $t$rm{for mail loop detection}
11265 \recipients@_max\ $t$rm{limit per message}
11266 \recipients@_max@_reject\ $t$rm{permanently reject excess}
11267 .endd
11268
11269
11270 .section Non-SMTP incoming messages
11271 .display rm
11272 .tabs 31
11273 \receive@_timeout\ $t$rm{for non-SMTP messages}
11274 .endd
11275
11276
11277
11278 .section Incoming SMTP messages
11279 See also the \*Policy controls*\ section above.
11280 .display flow rm
11281 .tabs 31
11282 \host@_lookup\ $t$rm{host name looked up for these hosts}
11283 \host@_lookup@_order\ $t$rm{order of DNS and local name lookups}
11284 \recipient@_unqualified@_hosts\ $t$rm{may send unqualified recipients}
11285 \rfc1413@_hosts\ $t$rm{make ident calls to these hosts}
11286 \rfc1413@_query@_timeout\ $t$rm{zero disables ident calls}
11287 \sender@_unqualified@_hosts\ $t$rm{may send unqualified senders}
11288 \smtp@_accept@_keepalive\ $t$rm{some TCP/IP magic}
11289 \smtp@_accept@_max\ $t$rm{simultaneous incoming connections}
11290 \smtp@_accept@_max@_nommail\ $t$rm{non-mail commands}
11291 \smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail@_hosts\ $t$rm{hosts to which the limit applies}
11292 \smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_connection\ $t$rm{messages per connection}
11293 \smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_host\ $t$rm{connections from one host}
11294 \smtp@_accept@_queue\ $t$rm{queue mail if more connections}
11295 \smtp@_accept@_queue@_per@_connection\ $t$rm{queue if more messages per connection}
11296 \smtp@_accept@_reserve\ $t$rm{only reserve hosts if more connections}
11297 .newline
11298 \smtp@_active@_hostname\ $t$rm{host name to use in messages}
11299 .newline
11300 \smtp@_banner\ $t$rm{text for welcome banner}
11301 \smtp@_check@_spool@_space\ $t$rm{from \\SIZE\\ on \\MAIL\\ command}
11302 \smtp@_connect@_backlog\ $t$rm{passed to TCP/IP stack}
11303 \smtp@_enforce@_sync\ $t$rm{of SMTP command/responses}
11304 \smtp@_etrn@_command\ $t$rm{what to run for \\ETRN\\}
11305 \smtp@_etrn@_serialize\ $t$rm{only one at once}
11306 \smtp@_load@_reserve\ $t$rm{only reserve hosts if this load}
11307 \smtp@_max@_unknown@_commands\ $t$rm{before dropping connection}
11308 \smtp@_ratelimit@_hosts\ $t$rm{apply ratelimiting to these hosts}
11309 \smtp@_ratelimit@_mail\ $t$rm{ratelimit for \\MAIL\\ commands}
11310 \smtp@_ratelimit@_rcpt\ $t$rm{ratelimit for \\RCPT\\ commands}
11311 \smtp@_receive@_timeout\ $t$rm{per command or data line}
11312 \smtp@_reserve@_hosts\ $t$rm{these are the reserve hosts}
11313 \smtp@_return@_error@_details\ $t$rm{give detail on rejections}
11314 .endd
11315
11316 .section SMTP extensions
11317 .display flow rm
11318 .tabs 31
11319 \accept@_8bitmime\ $t$rm{advertise \\8BITMIME\\}
11320 \auth@_advertise@_hosts\ $t$rm{advertise \\AUTH\\ to these hosts}
11321 \ignore@_fromline@_hosts\ $t$rm{allow `From ' from these hosts}
11322 \ignore@_fromline@_local\ $t$rm{allow `From ' from local SMTP}
11323 \pipelining@_advertise@_hosts\ $t$rm{advertise pipelining to these hosts}
11324 \tls@_advertise@_hosts\ $t$rm{advertise TLS to these hosts}
11325 .endd
11326
11327 .section Processing messages
11328 .display flow rm
11329 .tabs 31
11330 \allow@_domain@_literals\ $t$rm{recognize domain literal syntax}
11331 \allow@_mx@_to@_ip\ $t$rm{allow MX to point to IP address}
11332 \allow@_utf8@_domains\ $t$rm{in addresses}
11333 \delivery@_date@_remove\ $t$rm{from incoming messages}
11334 \envelope@_to@_remote\ $t$rm{from incoming messages}
11335 \extract@_addresses@_remove@_arguments\ $t$rm{affects \-t-\ processing}
11336 \headers@_charset\ $t$rm{default for translations}
11337 \qualify@_domain\ $t$rm{default for senders}
11338 \qualify@_recipient\ $t$rm{default for recipients}
11339 \return@_path@_remove\ $t$rm{from incoming messages}
11340 \strip@_excess@_angle@_brackets\ $t$rm{in addresses}
11341 \strip@_trailing@_dot\ $t$rm{at end of addresses}
11342 \untrusted@_set@_sender\ $t$rm{untrusted can set envelope sender}
11343 .endd
11344
11345 .section System filter
11346 .display flow rm
11347 .tabs 31
11348 \system@_filter\ $t$rm{locate system filter}
11349 \system@_filter@_directory@_transport\ $t$rm{transport for delivery to a directory}
11350 \system@_filter@_file@_transport\ $t$rm{transport for delivery to a file}
11351 \system@_filter@_group\ $t$rm{group for filter running}
11352 \system@_filter@_pipe@_transport\ $t$rm{transport for delivery to a pipe}
11353 \system@_filter@_reply@_transport\ $t$rm{transport for autoreply delivery}
11354 \system@_filter@_user\ $t$rm{user for filter running}
11355 .endd
11356
11357 .section Routing and delivery
11358 .display flow rm
11359 .tabs 31
11360 \dns@_again@_means@_nonexist\ $t$rm{for broken domains}
11361 \dns@_check@_names@_pattern\ $t$rm{pre-DNS syntax check}
11362 \dns@_ipv4@_lookup\ $t$rm{only v4 lookup for these domains}
11363 \dns@_retrans\ $t$rm{parameter for resolver}
11364 \dns@_retry\ $t$rm{parameter for resolver}
11365 \hold@_domains\ $t$rm{hold delivery for these domains}
11366 \local@_interfaces\ $t$rm{for routing checks}
11367 \queue@_domains\ $t$rm{no immediate delivery for these}
11368 \queue@_only\ $t$rm{no immediate delivery at all}
11369 \queue@_only@_file\ $t$rm{no immediate deliveryif file exists}
11370 \queue@_only@_load\ $t$rm{no immediate delivery if load is high}
11371 \queue@_only@_override\ $t$rm{allow command line to override}
11372 \queue@_run@_in@_order\ $t$rm{order of arrival}
11373 \queue@_run@_max\ $t$rm{of simultaneous queue runners}
11374 \queue@_smtp@_domains\ $t$rm{no immediate SMTP delivery for these}
11375 \remote@_max@_parallel\ $t$rm{parallel SMTP delivery per message}
11376 \remote@_sort@_domains\ $t$rm{order of remote deliveries}
11377 \retry@_data@_expire\ $t$rm{timeout for retry data}
11378 \retry@_interval@_max\ $t$rm{safety net for retry rules}
11379 .endd
11380
11381 .section Bounce and warning messages
11382 .display flow rm
11383 .tabs 31
11384 \bounce@_message@_file\ $t$rm{content of bounce}
11385 \bounce@_message@_text\ $t$rm{content of bounce}
11386 \bounce@_return@_body\ $t$rm{include body if returning message}
11387 \bounce@_return@_message\ $t$rm{include original message in bounce}
11388 \bounce@_return@_size@_limit\ $t$rm{limit on returned message}
11389 \bounce@_sender@_authentication\ $t$rm{send authenticated sender with bounce}
11390 \errors@_copy\ $t$rm{copy bounce messages}
11391 \errors@_reply@_to\ $t$rm{::Reply-to:: in bounces}
11392 \delay@_warning\ $t$rm{time schedule}
11393 \delay@_warning@_condition\ $t$rm{condition for warning messages}
11394 \ignore@_bounce@_errors@_after\ $t$rm{discard undeliverable bounces}
11395 \warn@_message@_file\ $t$rm{content of warning message}
11396 .endd
11397
11398 .set displayflowcheck ~~savedisplayflowcheck
11399
11400 .section Alphabetical list of main options
11401 .rset SECTalomo "~~chapter.~~section"
11402 .if ~~sgcal
11403 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with $**$.
11404 .fi
11405
11406 .startconf main
11407
11408 .index \\8BITMIME\\
11409 .index 8-bit characters
11410 .conf accept@_8bitmime boolean false
11411 This option causes Exim to send \\8BITMIME\\ in its response to an SMTP
11412 \\EHLO\\ command, and to accept the \\BODY=\\ parameter on \\MAIL\\ commands.
11413 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
11414 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
11415 Consequently, this option is turned off by default.
11416
11417 .index ~~ACL||for non-SMTP messages
11418 .index non-SMTP messages, ACL for
11419 .conf acl@_not@_smtp string$**$ unset
11420 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message is on the point
11421 of being accepted. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11422
11423 .index ~~ACL||setting up for SMTP commands
11424 .index \\AUTH\\||ACL for
11425 .conf acl@_smtp@_auth string$**$ unset
11426 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\AUTH\\ command is
11427 received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11428
11429 .index ~~ACL||on SMTP connection
11430 .conf acl@_smtp@_connect string$**$ unset
11431 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
11432 See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11433
11434 .index \\DATA\\, ACL for
11435 .conf acl@_smtp@_data string$**$ unset
11436 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP \\DATA\\ command has been
11437 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
11438 acknowledgement is sent. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11439
11440 .index \\ETRN\\||ACL for
11441 .conf acl@_smtp@_etrn string$**$ unset
11442 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\ETRN\\ command is
11443 received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11444
11445 .index \\EXPN\\||ACL for
11446 .conf acl@_smtp@_expn string$**$ unset
11447 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\EXPN\\ command is
11448 received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11449
11450 .index \\EHLO\\||ACL for
11451 .index \\HELO\\||ACL for
11452 .conf acl@_smtp@_helo string$**$ unset
11453 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\
11454 command is received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11455
11456 .index \\MAIL\\||ACL for
11457 .conf acl@_smtp@_mail string$**$ unset
11458 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\MAIL\\ command is
11459 received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11460
11461 .index \\AUTH\\||on \\MAIL\\ command
11462 .conf acl@_smtp@_mailauth string$**$ unset
11463 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an \\AUTH\\ parameter on
11464 a \\MAIL\\ command. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for details of ACLs, and chapter
11465 ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH for details of authentication.
11466
11467 .em
11468 .index MIME content scanning||ACL for
11469 .conf acl@_smtp@_mime string$**$ unset
11470 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
11471 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
11472 section ~~SECTscanmimepart for details.
11473
11474 .conf acl@_smtp@_predata string$**$ unset
11475 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\DATA\\ command is
11476 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for
11477 further details.
11478
11479 .index \\QUIT\\||ACL for
11480 .conf acl@_smtp@_quit string$**$ unset
11481 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\QUIT\\ command is
11482 received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11483 .nem
11484
11485 .index \\RCPT\\||ACL for
11486 .conf acl@_smtp@_rcpt string$**$ unset
11487 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\RCPT\\ command is
11488 received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11489
11490 .index \\STARTTLS\\, ACL for
11491 .conf acl@_smtp@_starttls string$**$ unset
11492 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\STARTTLS\\ command is
11493 received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11494
11495 .index \\VRFY\\||ACL for
11496 .conf acl@_smtp@_vrfy string$**$ unset
11497 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\VRFY\\ command is
11498 received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11499
11500 .conf admin@_groups "string list" unset
11501 .index admin user
11502 If the current group or any of the supplementary groups of the caller is in
11503 this colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
11504 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
11505 admin privileges by putting that group in \admin@_groups\. However, this does
11506 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
11507 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
11508
11509 .conf allow@_domain@_literals boolean false
11510 .index domain literal
11511 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
11512 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
11513 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
11514 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
11515
11516 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
11517 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
11518 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
11519 \allow@_domain@_literals\ true, and also to add \"@@[]"\ to the list of local
11520 domains (defined in the named domain list \local@_domains\ in the default
11521 configuration). This `magic string' matches the domain literal form of all the
11522 local host's IP addresses.
11523
11524 .conf allow@_mx@_to@_ip boolean false
11525 .index MX record||pointing to IP address
11526 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
11527 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
11528 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
11529 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
11530 practice, so to avoid `Why can't Exim do this?' complaints, \allow@_mx@_to@_ip\
11531 exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not recommended, except
11532 when you have no other choice.
11533
11534 .index domain||UTF-8 characters in
11535 .index UTF-8||in domain name
11536 .conf allow@_utf8@_domains boolean false
11537 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
11538 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
11539 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
11540 experiment if they wish.
11541
11542 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
11543 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
11544 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
11545 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
11546 adjust the value of \dns@_check@_names@_pattern\ to match the extended form. A
11547 suitable setting is:
11548 .display asis
11549 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
11550 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
11551 .endd
11552 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
11553 .display asis
11554 dns_check_names_pattern =
11555 .endd
11556 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
11557
11558 .conf auth@_advertise@_hosts "host list$**$" $*$
11559 .index authentication||advertising
11560 .index \\AUTH\\||advertising
11561 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
11562 response to an \\EHLO\\ command only if the calling host matches this list.
11563 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise \\AUTH\\.
11564 Exim does not accept \\AUTH\\ commands from clients to which it has not
11565 advertised the availability of \\AUTH\\. The advertising of individual
11566 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
11567 \server@_advertise@_condition\ generic authenticator option on the individual
11568 authenticators. See chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH for further details.
11569
11570 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
11571 and password for authentication if \\AUTH\\ is advertised, even though it may
11572 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
11573 authentication, for example). The \auth@_advertise@_hosts\ option can be used
11574 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
11575 which Exim advertises \\AUTH\\.
11576
11577 .index \\AUTH\\||advertising when encrypted
11578 If you want to advertise the availability of \\AUTH\\ only when the connection
11579 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
11580 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
11581 .display asis
11582 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
11583 .endd
11584 If \$tls@_cipher$\ is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
11585 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
11586 expansion is $*$, which matches all hosts.
11587
11588 .conf auto@_thaw time 0s
11589 .index thawing messages
11590 .index unfreezing messages
11591 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
11592 new delivery attempt on any frozen message if this much time has passed since
11593 it was frozen. This may result in the message being re-frozen if nothing has
11594 changed since the last attempt. It is a way of saying `keep on trying, even
11595 though there are big problems'. See also \timeout@_frozen@_after\ and
11596 \ignore@_bounce@_errors@_after\.
11597
11598 .em
11599 .conf av@_scanner string "see below"
11600 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
11601 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
11602 .display asis
11603 sophie:/var/run/sophie
11604 .endd
11605 If the value of \av@_scanner\ starts with dollar character, it is expanded
11606 before use. See section ~~SECTscanvirus for further details.
11607 .nem
11608
11609 .conf bi@_command string unset
11610 .index \-bi-\ option
11611 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
11612 the \-bi-\ option (see chapter ~~CHAPcommandline). The string value is just the
11613 command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is required, it
11614 must come from the \-oA-\ command line option.
11615
11616 .conf bounce@_message@_file string unset
11617 .index bounce message||customizing
11618 .index customizing||bounce message
11619 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
11620 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
11621 chapter ~~CHAPemsgcust. See also \warn@_message@_file\.
11622
11623 .conf bounce@_message@_text string unset
11624 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
11625 message immediately after `This message was created automatically by mail
11626 delivery software.' It is not used if \bounce@_message@_file\ is set.
11627
11628 .index bounce message||including body
11629 .conf bounce@_return@_body boolean true
11630 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
11631 bounce message when \bounce@_return@_message\ is true. If it is not set, only
11632 the message header is included.
11633
11634 .index bounce message||including original
11635 .conf bounce@_return@_message boolean true
11636 If this option is set false, the original message is not included in bounce
11637 messages generated by Exim. See also \bounce@_return@_size@_limit\.
11638
11639 .conf bounce@_return@_size@_limit integer 100K
11640 .index size||of bounce, limit
11641 .index bounce message||size limit
11642 .index limit||bounce message size
11643 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
11644 senders as part of bounce messages when \bounce@_return@_message\ is true. The
11645 limit should be less than the value of the global \message@_size@_limit\ and of
11646 any \message@_size@_limit\ settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
11647 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
11648
11649 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
11650 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
11651 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
11652 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
11653 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
11654 messages.
11655
11656 .index bounce message||sender authentication
11657 .index authentication||bounce message
11658 .index \\AUTH\\||on bounce message
11659 .conf bounce@_sender@_authentication string unset
11660 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
11661 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
11662 connection. A typical setting might be:
11663 .display asis
11664 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
11665 .endd
11666 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
11667 .display asis
11668 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
11669 .endd
11670 The value of \bounce@_sender@_authentication\ must always be a complete email
11671 address.
11672
11673 .index caching||callout, timeouts
11674 .index callout||caching timeouts
11675 .conf callout@_domain@_negative@_expire time 3h
11676 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
11677 domain. See section ~~SECTcallver for details of callout verification, and
11678 section ~~SECTcallvercache for details of the caching.
11679
11680 .conf callout@_domain@_positive@_expire time 7d
11681 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
11682 domain. See section ~~SECTcallver for details of callout verification, and
11683 section ~~SECTcallvercache for details of the caching.
11684
11685 .conf callout@_negative@_expire time 2h
11686 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
11687 address. See section ~~SECTcallver for details of callout verification, and
11688 section ~~SECTcallvercache for details of the caching.
11689
11690 .conf callout@_positive@_expire time 24h
11691 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
11692 address. See section ~~SECTcallver for details of callout verification, and
11693 section ~~SECTcallvercache for details of the caching.
11694
11695 .conf callout@_random@_local@_part string$**$ "see below"
11696 This option defines the `random' local part that can be used as part of callout
11697 verification. The default value is
11698 .display asis
11699 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
11700 .endd
11701 See section ~~CALLaddparcall for details of how this value is used.
11702
11703 .conf check@_log@_inodes integer 0
11704 See \check@_spool@_space\ below.
11705
11706 .conf check@_log@_space integer 0
11707 See \check@_spool@_space\ below.
11708
11709 .conf check@_spool@_inodes integer 0
11710 See \check@_spool@_space\ below.
11711
11712 .conf check@_spool@_space integer 0
11713 .index checking disk space
11714 .index disk space, checking
11715 .index spool directory||checking space
11716 The four \check@_...\ options allow for checking of disk resources before a
11717 message is accepted.
11718 .em
11719 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
11720 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so
11721 by testing the the variables \$log@_inodes$\, \$log@_space$\,
11722 \$spool@_inodes$\, and \$spool@_space$\ in an ACL with appropriate additional
11723 conditions.
11724 .nem
11725
11726 \check@_spool@_space\ and \check@_spool@_inodes\ check the spool partition if
11727 either value is greater than zero, for example:
11728 .display asis
11729 check_spool_space = 10M
11730 check_spool_inodes = 100
11731 .endd
11732 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
11733 \\SPOOL@_DIRECTORY\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\. It is used for holding messages in
11734 transit.
11735
11736 \check@_log@_space\ and \check@_log@_inodes\ check the partition in which log
11737 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
11738 \log@_file@_path\ and \spool@_directory\ refer to different partitions.
11739
11740 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
11741 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
11742 error response to the \\MAIL\\ command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
11743 \\SIZE\\ parameter on the \\MAIL\\ command, its value is added to the
11744 \check@_spool@_space\ value, and the check is performed even if
11745 \check@_spool@_space\ is zero, unless \no@_smtp@_check@_spool@_space\ is set.
11746
11747 The values for \check@_spool@_space\ and \check@_log@_space\ are held as a
11748 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
11749
11750 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
11751 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
11752 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
11753
11754 .index port||for daemon
11755 .index TCP/IP||setting listening ports
11756 .conf daemon@_smtp@_ports string "$tt{smtp}"
11757 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
11758 listens. See chapter ~~CHAPinterfaces for details of how it is used. For
11759 backward compatibility, \daemon@_smtp@_port\ (singular) is a synonym.
11760
11761 .conf delay@_warning "time list" 24h
11762 .index warning of delay
11763 .index delay warning, specifying
11764 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
11765 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
11766 after which to send warning messages.
11767 .em
11768 If the value of the option is an empty string or a zero time, no warnings are
11769 sent.
11770 .nem
11771 Up to 10 times may be given. If a message has been on the queue for longer than
11772 the last time, the last interval between the times is used to compute
11773 subsequent warning times. For example, with
11774 .display asis
11775 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
11776 .endd
11777 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
11778 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
11779 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
11780 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
11781 .display asis
11782 delay_warning = 6h
11783 .endd
11784 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
11785 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
11786 .display asis
11787 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
11788 .endd
11789
11790 .conf delay@_warning@_condition string$**$ "see below"
11791 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
11792 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in \$domain$\ during the
11793 expansion. Otherwise \$domain$\ is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
11794 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of `0', `no' or
11795 `false' (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is not
11796 sent. The default is
11797 .display asis
11798 delay_warning_condition = \
11799 ${if match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk}{no}{yes}}
11800 .endd
11801 which suppresses the sending of warnings about messages that have `bulk',
11802 `list' or `junk' in a ::Precedence:: header.
11803
11804 .index unprivileged delivery
11805 .index delivery||unprivileged
11806 .conf deliver@_drop@_privilege boolean false
11807 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
11808 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
11809 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
11810 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
11811 chapter ~~CHAPsecurity.
11812
11813 .index load average
11814 .index queue runner||abandoning
11815 .conf deliver@_queue@_load@_max fixed-point unset
11816 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
11817 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
11818 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
11819 See also \queue@_only@_load\ and \smtp@_load@_reserve\.
11820
11821 .conf delivery@_date@_remove boolean true
11822 .index ::Delivery-date:: header line
11823 Exim's transports have an option for adding a ::Delivery-date:: header to a
11824 message when it is delivered -- in exactly the same way as ::Return-path:: is
11825 handled. ::Delivery-date:: records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
11826 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
11827 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
11828 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
11829
11830 .index DNS||`try again' response, overriding
11831 .conf dns@_again@_means@_nonexist "domain list$**$" unset
11832 DNS lookups give a `try again' response for the DNS errors `non-authoritative
11833 host not found' and `\\SERVERFAIL\\'. This can cause Exim to keep trying to
11834 deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to incoming mail.
11835 Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and may persist
11836 for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches anything in
11837 \dns__again__means__nonexist\, it is treated as if it did not exist. This
11838 option should be used with care.
11839 You can make it apply to reverse lookups by a setting such as this:
11840 .display asis
11841 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
11842 .endd
11843 .em
11844 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. The \%dnslookup%\ router
11845 has some options of its own for controlling what happens when lookups for MX or
11846 SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific options are applied
11847 after the global option.
11848 .nem
11849
11850 .index DNS||pre-check of name syntax
11851 .conf dns@_check@_names@_pattern string "see below"
11852 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
11853 names for illegal characters before handing them to the DNS resolver, because
11854 some resolvers give temporary errors for malformed names. If a domain name
11855 contains any illegal characters, a `not found' result is forced, and the
11856 resolver is not called. The check is done by matching the domain name against a
11857 regular expression, which is the value of this option. The default pattern is
11858 .display asis
11859 dns_check_names_pattern = \
11860 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9-]*[^\W_])?)+$
11861 .endd
11862 which permits only letters, digits, and hyphens in components, but they may not
11863 start or end with a hyphen.
11864 If you set \allow@_utf8@_domains\, you must modify this pattern, or set the
11865 option to an empty string.
11866
11867 .conf dns@_ipv4@_lookup "domain list$**$" unset
11868 .index IPv6||DNS lookup for AAAA records
11869 .index DNS||IPv6 lookup for AAAA records
11870 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, it looks for IPv6 address records
11871 (AAAA and, if configured, A6) as well as IPv4 address records when trying to
11872 find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's domain matches this list.
11873
11874 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
11875 not work for the new IPv6 record types. If Exim is handed an IPv6 address
11876 record as a result of an MX lookup, it always recognizes it, and may as a
11877 result make an outgoing IPv6 connection. All this option does is to make Exim
11878 look only for IPv4-style A records when it needs to find an IP address for a
11879 host name. In due course, when the world's name servers have all been upgraded,
11880 there should be no need for this option.
11881
11882 .conf dns@_retrans time 0s
11883 .index DNS||resolver options
11884 The options \dns@_retrans\ and \dns@_retry\ can be used to set the
11885 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
11886 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
11887 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
11888 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
11889 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
11890 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
11891 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
11892 to set in them.
11893
11894 .conf dns@_retry integer 0
11895 See \dns@_retrans\ above.
11896
11897 .conf drop@_cr boolean false
11898 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
11899 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
11900 described in section ~~SECTlineendings.
11901
11902 .conf envelope@_to@_remove boolean true
11903 .index ::Envelope-to:: header line
11904 Exim's transports have an option for adding an ::Envelope-to:: header to a
11905 message when it is delivered -- in exactly the same way as ::Return-path:: is
11906 handled. ::Envelope-to:: records the original recipient address from the
11907 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
11908 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
11909 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
11910 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
11911
11912 .conf errors@_copy "string list$**$" unset
11913 .index bounce message||copy to other address
11914 .index copy of bounce message
11915 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
11916 generates to other addresses. \**Note**\: this does not apply to bounce messages
11917 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
11918 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
11919 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
11920 must be enclosed in double quotes.
11921
11922 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
11923 (see section ~~SECTaddresslist). When a pattern matches the recipient of the
11924 bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The items
11925 are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items are
11926 examined. For example:
11927 .display asis
11928 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
11929 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
11930 postmaster@mydomain.example
11931 .endd
11932 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables
11933 \$local@_part$\ and \$domain$\ are set from the original recipient of the error
11934 message, and if there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
11935 .index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in \errors@_copy\
11936 variables \$0$\, \$1$\, etc. are set in the normal way.
11937
11938 .conf errors@_reply@_to string unset
11939 .index bounce message||::Reply-to:: in
11940 Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
11941 .display
11942 From: Mail Delivery System @<Mailer-Daemon@@<<qualify-domain>>@>
11943 .endd
11944 where <<qualify-domain>> is the value of the \qualify@_domain\ option.
11945 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
11946 \errors@_reply@_to\ option is set, a ::Reply-To:: header is added to bounce and
11947 warning messages. For example:
11948 .display asis
11949 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
11950 .endd
11951 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
11952 address.
11953
11954 .conf exim@_group string "compile-time configured"
11955 .index gid (group id)||Exim's own
11956 .index Exim group
11957 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
11958 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
11959 option is used only when \exim@_user\ is also set. Unless it consists entirely
11960 of digits, the string is looked up using \*getgrnam()*\, and failure causes a
11961 configuration error. See chapter ~~CHAPsecurity for a discussion of security
11962 issues.
11963
11964 .conf exim@_path string "see below"
11965 .index Exim binary, path name
11966 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
11967 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file \*exim*\ in
11968 the directory configured at compile time by the \\BIN@_DIRECTORY\\ setting. It
11969 is necessary to change \exim@_path\ if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
11970 other place.
11971 \**Warning**\: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
11972 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
11973 where the binary is. (They then use the \-bP-\ option to extract option
11974 settings such as the value of \spool@_directory\.)
11975
11976 .conf exim@_user string "compile-time configured"
11977 .index uid (user id)||Exim's own
11978 .index Exim user
11979 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
11980 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
11981 time configuration file and the use of the \-C-\ and \-D-\ command line options
11982 is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
11983
11984 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
11985 \*getpwnam()*\, and failure causes a configuration error. If \exim@_group\ is
11986 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of \*getpwnam()*\ if it is
11987 used. See chapter ~~CHAPsecurity for a discussion of security issues.
11988
11989 .conf extra@_local@_interfaces "string list" unset
11990 .index
11991 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
11992 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
11993 ~~SECTreclocipadd for details.
11994
11995 .conf extract@_addresses@_remove@_arguments boolean true
11996 .index \-t-\ option
11997 .index command line||addresses with \-t-\
11998 .index Sendmail compatibility||\-t-\ option
11999 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
12000 are present on the command line when the \-t-\ option is used to build an
12001 envelope from a message's ::To::, ::Cc:: and ::Bcc:: headers, the command line
12002 addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail behaves.
12003 However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that command
12004 line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
12005 \extract__addresses__remove__arguments\ is true (the default), Exim subtracts
12006 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
12007 addresses.
12008
12009 .conf finduser@_retries integer 0
12010 .index NIS, looking up users, retrying
12011 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
12012 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when \*getpwnam()*\ and
12013 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
12014 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine `not found'
12015 errors. If \finduser@_retries\ is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
12016 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
12017 retries.
12018
12019 .index \(/etc/passwd)\, multiple reading of
12020 .em
12021 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
12022 a traditional \(/etc/passwd)\ file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
12023 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
12024 .nem
12025
12026 .conf freeze@_tell "string list, comma separated" unset
12027 .index freezing messages||sending a message when freezing
12028 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
12029 or in an ACL,
12030 Exim freezes a message. This means that no further delivery attempts take place
12031 until an administrator (or the \auto@_thaw\ feature) thaws the message. If
12032 \freeze@_tell\ is set, Exim generates a warning message whenever it freezes
12033 something, unless the message it is freezing is a
12034 locally-generated
12035 bounce message. (Without this exception there is the possibility of looping.)
12036 The warning message is sent to the addresses supplied as the comma-separated
12037 value of this option. If several of the message's addresses cause freezing,
12038 only a single message is sent.
12039 If the freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the
12040 message log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for
12041 any logging that you require.
12042
12043 .conf gecos@_name string$**$ unset
12044 .index HP-UX
12045 .index `gecos' field, parsing
12046 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the `gecos' field in the system
12047 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
12048 looks up this field for use when it is creating ::Sender:: or ::From:: headers.
12049 If either \gecos@_pattern\ or \gecos@_name\ are unset, the contents of the
12050 field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered, it is
12051 replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
12052 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
12053
12054 When these options are set, \gecos@_pattern\ is treated as a regular expression
12055 that is to be applied to the field (again with & replaced by the login name),
12056 and if it matches, \gecos@_name\ is expanded and used as the user's name.
12057 .index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in \gecos@_name\
12058 Numeric variables such as \$1$\, \$2$\, etc. can be used in the expansion to
12059 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
12060 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
12061 .display asis
12062 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
12063 gecos_name = $1
12064 .endd
12065
12066 .conf gecos@_pattern string unset
12067 See \gecos@_name\ above.
12068
12069 .conf headers@_charset string "see below"
12070 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
12071 `words' in header lines, when referenced by an \$h@_xxx$\ expansion item. The
12072 default is the value of \\HEADERS@_CHARSET\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\. The
12073 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
12074 insertions in section ~~SECTexpansionitems.
12075
12076
12077 .conf header@_maxsize integer "see below"
12078 .index header section||maximum size of
12079 .index limit||size of message header section
12080 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
12081 section. The default is the value of \\HEADER@_MAXSIZE\\ in
12082 \(Local/Makefile)\; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
12083 sections are rejected.
12084
12085 .conf header@_line@_maxsize integer 0
12086 .index header lines||maximum size of
12087 .index limit||size of one header line
12088 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
12089 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
12090 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
12091 zero means `no limit'.
12092
12093
12094
12095 .conf helo@_accept@_junk@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
12096 .index \\HELO\\||accepting junk data
12097 .index \\EHLO\\||accepting junk data
12098 Exim checks the syntax of \\HELO\\ and \\EHLO\\ commands for incoming SMTP
12099 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
12100 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
12101 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See \helo@_verify@_hosts\
12102 if you want to do semantic checking.
12103 See also \helo@_allow@_chars\ for a way of extending the permitted character
12104 set.
12105
12106 .conf helo@_allow@_chars string unset
12107 .index \\HELO\\||underscores in
12108 .index \\EHLO\\||underscores in
12109 .index underscore in \\EHLO\\/\\HELO\\
12110 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
12111 all \\EHLO\\ and \\HELO\\ names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
12112 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
12113 .display asis
12114 helo_allow_chars = _
12115 .endd
12116 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
12117
12118 .conf helo@_lookup@_domains "domain list$**$" "$tt{@@:@@[]}"
12119 .index \\HELO\\||forcing reverse lookup
12120 .index \\EHLO\\||forcing reverse lookup
12121 If the domain given by a client in a \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command matches this
12122 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
12123 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
12124 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
12125 do.
12126
12127 .conf helo@_try@_verify@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
12128 .index \\HELO\\||verifying, optional
12129 .index \\EHLO\\||verifying, optional
12130 The RFCs mandate that a server must not reject a message because it doesn't
12131 like the \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command. By default, Exim just checks the syntax
12132 of these commands (see \helo__accept__junk__hosts\ and \helo@_allow@_chars\
12133 above). However, some sites like to be stricter. If the calling host matches
12134 \helo@_try@_verify@_hosts\, Exim checks that the host name given in the \\HELO\\
12135 or \\EHLO\\ command either:
12136 .numberpars $.
12137 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host (the RFCs
12138 specifically allow this), or
12139 .nextp
12140 .index DNS||reverse lookup
12141 .index reverse DNS lookup
12142 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
12143 calling host address, or
12144 .nextp
12145 when looked up using \*gethostbyname()*\ (or \*getipnodebyname()*\ when
12146 available) yields the calling host address.
12147 .endp
12148 However, the \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\ command is not rejected if any of the checks
12149 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
12150 be detected later in an ACL by the \"verify = helo"\ condition. If you want
12151 verification failure to cause rejection of \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\, use
12152 \helo@_verify@_hosts\ instead.
12153
12154
12155 .conf helo@_verify@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
12156 .index \\HELO\\||verifying, mandatory
12157 .index \\EHLO\\||verifying, mandatory
12158 For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host name given in the
12159 \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ in the same way as for \helo@_try@_verify@_hosts\. If the
12160 check fails, the \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command is rejected with a 550 error, and
12161 entries are written to the main and reject logs. If a \\MAIL\\ command is
12162 received before \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\, it is rejected with a
12163 503
12164 error.
12165
12166 .conf hold@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
12167 .index domain||delaying delivery
12168 .index delivery||delaying certain domains
12169 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
12170 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
12171 \-M-\, \-qf-\, \-Rf-\ or \-Sf-\ options, and also while testing or verifying
12172 addresses using \-bt-\ or \-bv-\. Otherwise, if a domain matches an item in
12173 \hold@_domains\, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and it is
12174 deferred every time the message is looked at.
12175
12176 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
12177 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
12178 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
12179 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use \queue@_domains\ or
12180 \queue@_smtp@_domains\, not \hold@_domains\.
12181
12182 A setting of \hold@_domains\ does not override Exim's code for removing
12183 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
12184 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
12185 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
12186
12187 .conf host@_lookup "host list$**$" unset
12188 .index host||name lookup, forcing
12189 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
12190 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
12191 \helo@_try@_verify@_hosts\ or \helo@_verify@_hosts\, or the host matches this
12192 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
12193 default configuration file contains
12194 .display asis
12195 host_lookup = *
12196 .endd
12197 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
12198 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
12199
12200 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
12201 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
12202 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
12203
12204 After any kind of failure, the host name (in \$sender@_host@_name$\) remains
12205 unset, and \$host@_lookup@_failed$\ is set to the string `1'. See also
12206 \dns@_again@_means@_nonexist\, \helo__lookup__domains\, and \"verify =
12207 reverse@_host@_lookup"\ in ACLs.
12208
12209 .conf host@_lookup@_order "string list" $tt{bydns:byaddr}
12210 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
12211 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
12212 first, and then to try a local lookup (using \*gethostbyaddr()*\ or equivalent)
12213 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
12214 if you want.
12215
12216 \**Warning**\: the `byaddr' method does not always yield aliases when there are
12217 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
12218 \(/etc/hosts)\. Different operating systems give different results in this
12219 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
12220
12221
12222 .conf host@_reject@_connection "host list$**$" unset
12223 .index host||rejecting connections from
12224 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
12225 as soon as the connection is made.
12226 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
12227 nowadays the ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_connect\ can also reject incoming
12228 connections immediately.
12229
12230 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
12231 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
12232 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
12233 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after \\RCPT\\ commands. See
12234 chapter ~~CHAPACL.
12235
12236 .em
12237 .conf hosts@_connection@_nolog "host list$**$" unset
12238 .index host||not logging connections from
12239 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
12240 happen, even though the \smtp@_connection\ log selector is set. For example,
12241 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
12242 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
12243 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
12244 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
12245 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
12246 .display asis
12247 hosts_connection_nolog = :
12248 .endd
12249 If the \smtp@_connection\ log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
12250 .nem
12251
12252 .conf hosts@_treat@_as@_local "domain list$**$" unset
12253 .index local host||domains treated as
12254 .index host||treated as local
12255 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
12256 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
12257 records
12258 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
12259 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
12260
12261 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
12262 \"@@mx@_any"\, \"@@mx@_primary"\, and \"@@mx@_secondary"\ in a domain list (see
12263 section ~~SECTdomainlist), and when checking the \hosts\ option in the \%smtp%\
12264 transport for the local host (see the \allow@_localhost\ option in that
12265 transport).
12266 See also \local@_interfaces\, \extra@_local@_interfaces\, and chapter
12267 ~~CHAPinterfaces, which contains a discussion about local network interfaces
12268 and recognising the local host.
12269
12270 .conf ignore@_bounce@_errors@_after time 10w
12271 .index bounce message||discarding
12272 .index discarding bounce message
12273 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
12274 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
12275 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
12276
12277 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
12278 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
12279 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
12280 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
12281 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
12282 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
12283 for frozen messages. For example,
12284 .display asis
12285 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
12286 .endd
12287 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
12288 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
12289 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
12290 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
12291 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see \auto@_thaw\ and
12292 \timeout@_frozen@_after\.
12293
12294 .conf ignore@_fromline@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
12295 .index `From' line
12296 .index UUCP||`From' line
12297 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like `From' line before the
12298 headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the message's
12299 body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as such. Exim
12300 can be made to ignore it by setting \ignore@_fromline@_hosts\ to match those
12301 hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local process
12302 rather than a remote host, and is using \-bs-\ to inject the messages,
12303 \ignore__fromline__local\ must be set to achieve this effect.
12304
12305 .conf ignore@_fromline@_local boolean false
12306 See \ignore@_fromline@_hosts\ above.
12307
12308 .conf keep@_malformed time 4d
12309 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
12310 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
12311 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
12312 logged.
12313
12314 .conf ldap@_default@_servers "string list" unset
12315 .index LDAP||default servers
12316 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
12317 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section ~~SECTforldaque for details
12318 of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built with
12319 LDAP support.
12320
12321 .conf ldap@_version integer unset
12322 .index LDAP||protocol version, forcing
12323 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
12324 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the \-bP-\ command line option as
12325 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if \\LDAP@_VERSION3\\ is defined in
12326 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
12327 has been built with LDAP support.
12328
12329
12330 .conf local@_from@_check boolean true
12331 .index ::Sender:: header line||disabling addition of
12332 .index ::From:: header line||disabling checking of
12333 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
12334 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing ::Sender:: header line, and checks
12335 that the ::From:: header line matches
12336 .em
12337 the login of the calling user and the domain specified by \qualify@_domain\.
12338
12339 \**Note**\: An unqualified address (no domain) in the ::From:: header in a
12340 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
12341 \-bnq-\ command line option is used.
12342 .nem
12343
12344 You can use \local@_from@_prefix\ and \local@_from@_suffix\ to permit affixes
12345 on the local part. If the ::From:: header line does not match, Exim adds a
12346 ::Sender:: header with an address constructed from the calling user's login and
12347 the default qualify domain.
12348
12349 If \local@_from@_check\ is set false, the ::From:: header check is disabled,
12350 and no ::Sender:: header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
12351 ::Sender:: header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
12352 \local@_sender@_retain\ to be true.
12353
12354 .index envelope sender
12355 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
12356 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
12357 \untrusted@_set@_sender\ permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
12358
12359 .em
12360 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify `submission mode' to
12361 request similar header line checking. See section ~~SECTthesenhea, which has
12362 more details about ::Sender:: processing.
12363 .nem
12364
12365
12366 .conf local@_from@_prefix string unset
12367 When Exim checks the ::From:: header line of locally submitted messages for
12368 matching the login id (see \local@_from@_check\ above), it can be configured to
12369 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
12370 done by setting \local@_from@_prefix\ and/or \local@_from@_suffix\ to
12371 appropriate lists, in the same form as the \local@_part@_prefix\ and
12372 \local@_part@_suffix\ router options (see chapter ~~CHAProutergeneric). For
12373 example, if
12374 .display asis
12375 local_from_prefix = *-
12376 .endd
12377 is set, a ::From:: line containing
12378 .display asis
12379 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
12380 .endd
12381 will not cause a ::Sender:: header to be added if \*user@@your.domain.example*\
12382 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
12383 qualify domain.
12384
12385 .conf local@_from@_suffix string unset
12386 See \local@_from@_prefix\ above.
12387
12388 .conf local@_interfaces "string list" "see below"
12389 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
12390 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
12391 ~~CHAPinterfaces contains a full description of this option and the related
12392 options
12393 .em
12394 \daemon@_smtp@_ports\, \extra@_local@_interfaces\, \hosts@_treat@_as@_local\,
12395 and \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\.
12396 .nem
12397 The default value for \local@_interfaces\ is
12398 .display asis
12399 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12400 .endd
12401 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
12402 .display asis
12403 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12404 .endd
12405
12406 .conf local@_scan@_timeout time 5m
12407 .index timeout||for \*local@_scan()*\ function
12408 .index \*local@_scan()*\ function||timeout
12409 This timeout applies to the \*local@_scan()*\ function (see chapter
12410 ~~CHAPlocalscan). Zero means `no timeout'. If the timeout is exceeded, the
12411 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
12412 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
12413 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
12414
12415
12416 .conf local@_sender@_retain boolean false
12417 .index ::Sender:: header line||retaining from local submission
12418 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
12419 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing ::Sender:: header line. If you
12420 do not want this to happen, you must set \local@_sender@_retain\, and you must
12421 also set \local@_from@_check\ to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
12422 Section ~~SECTthesenhea has more details about ::Sender:: processing.
12423
12424
12425
12426 .conf localhost@_number string$**$ unset
12427 .index host||locally unique number for
12428 .index message||ids, with multiple hosts
12429 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
12430 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
12431 value for the \localhost@_number\ option. The string is expanded immediately
12432 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
12433 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
12434 range 0--16 (or 0--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file systems).
12435 This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
12436 \$localhost@_number$\. When \localhost@_number is set\, the final two
12437 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
12438 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
12439 section ~~SECTmessiden.
12440
12441
12442 .conf log@_file@_path "string list$**$" "set at compile time"
12443 .index log||file path for
12444 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
12445 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
12446 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
12447 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
12448 are written in a sub-directory called \(log)\ in Exim's spool directory.
12449 Chapter ~~CHAPlog contains further details about Exim's logging, and section
12450 ~~SECTwhelogwri describes how the contents of \log@_file@_path\ are used. If
12451 this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion variables) it
12452 is recommended that you do not set this option in the configuration file, but
12453 instead supply the path using \\LOG@_FILE@_PATH\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ so that
12454 it is available to Exim for logging errors detected early on -- in particular,
12455 failure to read the configuration file.
12456
12457 .conf log@_selector string unset
12458 .index log||selectors
12459 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
12460 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
12461 minus characters. For example:
12462 .display asis
12463 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
12464 .endd
12465 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
12466 logging, in section ~~SECTlogselector.
12467
12468 .conf log@_timezone boolean false
12469 .index log||timezone for entries
12470 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
12471 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
12472 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
12473 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
12474 \log@_timezone\ true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
12475 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
12476 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
12477 \$tod@_log$\ variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
12478 another variable called \$tod@_zone$\ that contains just the timezone offset.
12479
12480 .conf lookup@_open@_max integer 25
12481 .index too many open files
12482 .index open files, too many
12483 .index file||too many open
12484 .index lookup||maximum open files
12485 .index limit||open files for lookups
12486 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
12487 lookups that use regular files (that is, \%lsearch%\, \%dbm%\, and \%cdb%\). Exim
12488 normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same file is
12489 required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least recently
12490 used file. Note that if you are using the \*ndbm*\ library, it actually opens
12491 two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts as one for the
12492 purposes of \lookup@_open@_max\. If you are getting `too many open files'
12493 errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of \lookup@_open@_max\.
12494
12495 .conf max@_username@_length integer 0
12496 .index length of login name
12497 .index user name||maximum length
12498 .index limit||user name length
12499 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
12500 \*getpwnam()*\ to eight characters, instead of returning `no such user'. If
12501 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call \*getpwnam()*\ with
12502 an argument that is longer behaves as if \*getpwnam()*\ failed.
12503
12504
12505 .conf message@_body@_visible integer 500
12506 .index body of message||visible size
12507 .index message||body, visible size
12508 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
12509 \$message@_body$\ and \$message@_body@_end$\ expansion variables.
12510
12511 .conf message@_id@_header@_domain string$**$ unset
12512 .index ::Message-ID:: header line
12513 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
12514 (domain) of the ::Message-ID:: header that Exim creates if a
12515 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. `Locally-originated'
12516 means `not received over TCP/IP.'
12517 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
12518 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
12519 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
12520 empty string, the option is ignored.
12521
12522 .conf message@_id@_header@_text string$**$ unset
12523 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
12524 the ::Message-id:: header that Exim creates if a
12525 locally-originated
12526 incoming message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC
12527 2822 to take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message
12528 id as the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option
12529 is set, it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and
12530 does not yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header
12531 immediately before the @@, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any
12532 characters that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into
12533 hyphens. This means that variables such as \$tod@_log$\ can be used, because
12534 the spaces and colons will become hyphens.
12535
12536 .conf message@_logs boolean true
12537 .index message||log, disabling
12538 .index log||message log, disabling
12539 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
12540 \(msglog)\ spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
12541 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
12542 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
12543 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
12544 which is not affected by this option.
12545
12546 .conf message@_size@_limit string$**$ 50M
12547 .index message||size limit
12548 .index limit||message size
12549 .index size||of message, limit
12550 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
12551 value is expanded for each incoming
12552 connection so, for example, it can be made to depend on the IP address of the
12553 remote host for messages arriving via TCP/IP. \**Note**\: This limit cannot be
12554 made to depend on a message's sender or any other properties of an individual
12555 message, because it has to be advertised in the server's response to \\EHLO\\.
12556 String expansion failure causes a temporary error. A value of zero means no
12557 limit, but its use is not recommended. See also \bounce@_return@_size@_limit\.
12558
12559 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
12560 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
12561 failure message to the sender, depending on the \-oe-\ setting. Rejection of an
12562 oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also the
12563 generic transport option \message@_size@_limit\, which limits the size of
12564 message that an individual transport can process.
12565
12566 .conf move@_frozen@_messages boolean false
12567 .index frozen messages||moving
12568 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
12569 .display asis
12570 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
12571 .endd
12572 in \(Local/Makefile)\, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
12573 moved from the \(input)\ and \(msglog)\ directories on the spool to \(Finput)\
12574 and \(Fmsglog)\, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
12575 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
12576 lists generated by \-bp-\ or by the Exim monitor.
12577
12578 .em
12579 .conf mua@_wrapper boolean false
12580 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
12581 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter ~~CHAPnonqueueing
12582 contains a full description of this facility.
12583 .nem
12584
12585 .conf mysql@_servers "string list" unset
12586 .index MySQL||server list
12587 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
12588 be used in conjunction with \%mysql%\ lookups (see section ~~SECTsql). The
12589 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
12590
12591 .conf never@_users "string list" unset
12592 Local message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
12593 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
12594 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
12595 safety precaution.
12596
12597 When Exim is built, an option called \\FIXED@_NEVER@_USERS\\ can be set to a
12598 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
12599 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
12600 contains just the single user name `root'. The \never@_users\ runtime option
12601 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
12602
12603 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
12604 \never@_users\ list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
12605 example is
12606 .display
12607 never@_users = root:daemon:bin
12608 .endd
12609 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
12610 harm.
12611 This option overrides the \pipe@_as@_creator\ option of the \%pipe%\ transport
12612 driver.
12613
12614 .conf oracle@_servers "string list" unset
12615 .index Oracle||server list
12616 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
12617 to be used in conjunction with \%oracle%\ lookups (see section ~~SECTsql). The
12618 option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
12619
12620 .conf percent@_hack@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
12621 .index `percent hack'
12622 .index source routing||in email address
12623 .index address||source-routed
12624 The `percent hack' is the convention whereby a local part containing a percent
12625 sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent replaced by @@.
12626 This is sometimes called `source routing', though that term is also applied to
12627 RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @@ character. If this option is set, Exim
12628 implements the percent facility for those domains listed, but no others. This
12629 happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against an ACL.
12630
12631 \**Warning**\: The `percent hack' has often been abused by people who are
12632 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
12633 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
12634 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
12635 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
12636 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
12637 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
12638
12639 .conf perl@_at@_start boolean false
12640 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
12641 interpreter. See chapter ~~CHAPperl for details of its use.
12642
12643 .conf perl@_startup string unset
12644 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
12645 interpreter. See chapter ~~CHAPperl for details of its use.
12646
12647 .conf pgsql@_servers "string list" unset
12648 .index PostgreSQL lookup type||server list
12649 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
12650 data, to be used in conjunction with \%pgsql%\ lookups (see section ~~SECTsql).
12651 The option is available only if Exim has been built with PostgreSQL support.
12652
12653 .conf pid@_file@_path string$**$ "set at compile time"
12654 .index daemon||pid file path
12655 .index pid file, path for
12656 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
12657 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
12658 to the host name:
12659 .display asis
12660 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
12661 .endd
12662 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file \(exim-daemon.pid)\ in Exim's
12663 spool directory.
12664 The value set by the option can be overridden by the \-oP-\ command line
12665 option. A pid file is not written if a `non-standard' daemon is run by means of
12666 the \-oX-\ option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by \-oP-\.
12667
12668 .conf pipelining@_advertise@_hosts "host list$**$" $*$
12669 .index \\PIPELINING\\||advertising, suppressing
12670 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
12671 \\PIPELINING\\ extension to specific hosts. When \\PIPELINING\\ is not
12672 advertised and \smtp@_enforce@_sync\ is true, an Exim server enforces strict
12673 synchronization for each SMTP command and response.
12674 When \\PIPELINING\\ is advertised, Exim assumes that clients will use it; `out
12675 of order' commands that are `expected' do not count as protocol errors (see
12676 \smtp@_max@_synprot@_errors\).
12677
12678 .conf preserve@_message@_logs boolean false
12679 .index message logs, preserving
12680 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
12681 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
12682 called \(msglog.OLD)\, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
12683 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
12684 volume of mail. Use with care!
12685
12686 .conf primary@_hostname string "see below"
12687 .index name||of local host
12688 .index host||name of local
12689 .index local host||name of
12690 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default \\EHLO\\
12691 or \\HELO\\ command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the \helo@_data\
12692 option in the \%smtp%\ transport),
12693 and as the default for \qualify@_domain\. If it is not set, Exim calls
12694 \*uname()*\ to find it. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name
12695 returned by \*uname()*\ contains only one component, Exim passes it to
12696 \*gethostbyname()*\ (or \*getipnodebyname()*\ when available) in order to
12697 obtain the fully qualified version.
12698
12699 The value of \$primary@_hostname$\ is also used by default in some SMTP
12700 response messages from an Exim server. This can be changed dynamically by
12701 setting \smtp@_active@_hostname\.
12702
12703 .conf print@_topbitchars boolean false
12704 .index printing characters
12705 .index 8-bit characters
12706 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
12707 32--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
12708 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
12709 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If \print@_topbitchars\ is
12710 set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
12711 characters.
12712
12713 .conf process@_log@_path string unset
12714 .index process log path
12715 .index log||process log
12716 .index \*exiwhat*\
12717 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
12718 `process log' when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the \*exiwhat*\ utility
12719 script. If this option is unset, the file called \(exim-process.info)\ in
12720 Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly can
12721 be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
12722 different spool directories.
12723
12724 .conf prod@_requires@_admin boolean true
12725 .index \-M-\ option
12726 .index \-R-\ option
12727 .index \-q-\ option
12728 The \-M-\, \-R-\, and \-q-\ command-line options require the caller to be an
12729 admin user unless \prod@_requires@_admin\ is set false. See also
12730 \queue@_list@_requires@_admin\.
12731
12732 .conf qualify@_domain string "see below"
12733 .index domain||for qualifying addresses
12734 .index address||qualification
12735 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
12736 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
12737 recipient addresses if \qualify@_recipient\ is not set.
12738 .em
12739 Unqualified addresses are accepted by default only for locally-generated
12740 messages.
12741
12742 Qualification is also applied to addresses in header lines such as ::From:: and
12743 ::To:: for locally-generated messages, unless the \-bnq-\ command line option
12744 is used.
12745 .nem
12746
12747 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
12748 unless the sending host matches \sender@_unqualified@_hosts\ or
12749 \recipient@_unqualified@_hosts\ (as appropriate), in which case incoming
12750 addresses are qualified with \qualify@_domain\ or \qualify@_recipient\ as
12751 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
12752 addresses. If \qualify@_domain\ is not set, it defaults to the
12753 \primary@_hostname\ value.
12754
12755 .conf qualify@_recipient string "see below"
12756 .em
12757 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
12758 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See \qualify@_domain\ above.
12759 .nem
12760
12761 .conf queue@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
12762 .index domain||specifying non-immediate delivery
12763 .index queueing incoming messages
12764 .index message||queueing certain domains
12765 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
12766 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
12767 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
12768 next queue run. See also \hold@_domains\ and \queue@_smtp@_domains\.
12769
12770 .conf queue@_list@_requires@_admin boolean true
12771 .index \-bp-\ option
12772 The \-bp-\ command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the queue,
12773 requires the caller to be an admin user unless \queue__list__requires__admin\
12774 is set false. See also \prod@_requires@_admin\.
12775
12776 .conf queue@_only boolean false
12777 .index queueing incoming messages
12778 .index message||queueing unconditionally
12779 If \queue@_only\ is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
12780 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
12781 next queue run. Even if \queue@_only\ is false, incoming messages may not get
12782 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
12783
12784 The \-odq-\ command line has the same effect as \queue@_only\. The \-odb-\ and
12785 \-odi-\ command line options override \queue@_only\ unless
12786 \queue@_only@_override\ is set false. See also \queue@_only@_file\,
12787 \queue@_only@_load\, and \smtp@_accept@_queue\.
12788
12789 .conf queue@_only@_file string unset
12790 .index queueing incoming messages
12791 .index message||queueing by file existence
12792 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
12793 one optionally preceded by `smtp'. When Exim is receiving a message,
12794 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to \*stat()*\. For
12795 each path that exists, the corresponding queuing option is set.
12796 For paths with no prefix, \queue@_only\ is set; for paths prefixed by `smtp',
12797 \queue@_smtp@_domains\ is set to match all domains. So, for example,
12798 .display asis
12799 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
12800 .endd
12801 causes Exim to behave as if \queue@_smtp@_domains\ were set to `$*$' whenever
12802 \(/some/file)\ exists.
12803
12804 .conf queue@_only@_load fixed-point unset
12805 .index load average
12806 .index queueing incoming messages
12807 .index message||queueing by load
12808 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
12809 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
12810 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages on the same
12811 connection are queued. Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue
12812 runner processes. This option has no effect on ancient operating systems on
12813 which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
12814 \deliver@_queue@_load@_max\ and \smtp@_load@_reserve\.
12815
12816 .conf queue@_only@_override boolean true
12817 .index queueing incoming messages
12818 When this option is true, the \-od\*x*\-\ command line options override the
12819 setting of \queue@_only\ or \queue@_only@_file\ in the configuration file. If
12820 \queue@_only@_override\ is set false, the \-od\*x*\-\ options cannot be used to
12821 override; they are accepted, but ignored.
12822
12823 .conf queue@_run@_in@_order boolean false
12824 .index queue runner||processing messages in order
12825 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
12826 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
12827 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
12828 single directory (the default),
12829 .em
12830 a single list is created for both the ordered and the non-ordered cases.
12831 However, if \split@_spool@_directory\ is set, a single list is not created when
12832 \queue@_run@_in@_order\ is false. In this case, the sub-directories are
12833 processed one at a time (in a random order), and this avoids setting up one
12834 huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting \queue@_run@_in@_order\ with
12835 \split@_spool@_directory\ may degrade performance when the queue is large,
12836 because of the extra work in setting up the single, large list. In most
12837 situations, \queue@_run@_in@_order\ should not be set.
12838 .nem
12839
12840 .conf queue@_run@_max integer 5
12841 .index queue runner||maximum number of
12842 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
12843 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
12844 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
12845 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
12846 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
12847 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
12848 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
12849
12850 .conf queue@_smtp@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
12851 .index queueing incoming messages
12852 .index message||queueing remote deliveries
12853 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
12854 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
12855 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
12856 \queue@_smtp@_domains\, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
12857 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
12858 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
12859 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
12860 over a single SMTP connection. The \-odqs-\ command line option causes all SMTP
12861 deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
12862 \queue@_smtp@_domains\ to `$*$'. See also \hold@_domains\ and \queue@_domains\.
12863
12864 .conf receive@_timeout time 0s
12865 .index timeout||for non-SMTP input
12866 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
12867 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
12868 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
12869 \-or-\ command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
12870 controlled by \smtp@_receive@_timeout\.
12871
12872 .index customizing|| ::Received:: header
12873 .index ::Received:: header line||customizing
12874 .conf received@_header@_text string$**$ "see below"
12875 This string defines the contents of the ::Received:: message header that is
12876 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
12877 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
12878 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no ::Received:: header line is
12879 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
12880 `Received:' and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for ::Received:: header
12881 lines. The default setting is:
12882 .display asis
12883 received_header_text = Received: \
12884 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
12885 {${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident }}\
12886 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
12887 by $primary_hostname \
12888 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
12889 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
12890 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
12891 id $message_id\
12892 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
12893 .endd
12894 Note the use of quotes, to allow the sequences \"@\n"\ and \"@\t"\ to be used
12895 for newlines and tabs, respectively. The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted
12896 when Exim is built without TLS support. The use of conditional expansions
12897 ensures that this works for both locally generated messages and messages
12898 received from remote hosts, giving header lines such as the following:
12899 .display asis
12900 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
12901 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
12902 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
12903 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
12904 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
12905 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
12906 .endd
12907 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
12908 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
12909 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
12910 message was accepted.
12911
12912 .conf received@_headers@_max integer 30
12913 .index loop||prevention
12914 .index mail loop prevention
12915 .index ::Received:: header line||counting
12916 When a message is to be delivered, the number of ::Received:: headers is
12917 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
12918 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
12919 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
12920
12921 .conf recipient@_unqualified@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
12922 .index unqualified addresses
12923 .index host||unqualified addresses from
12924 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
12925 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
12926 qualified by the addition of the \qualify@_recipient\ value. This option also
12927 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
12928 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
12929 host that matches \recipient@_unqualified@_hosts\,
12930 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the \-bnq-\
12931 option was not set.
12932
12933 .conf recipients@_max integer 0
12934 .index limit||number of recipients
12935 .index recipient||maximum number
12936 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
12937 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
12938 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
12939 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
12940 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
12941 done.
12942 .index \\RCPT\\||maximum number of incoming
12943 Note that the RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
12944 \\RCPT\\ commands in a single message.
12945
12946 .conf recipients@_max@_reject boolean false
12947 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
12948 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus \\RCPT\\ commands, and a 554
12949 error to the eventual \\DATA\\ command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
12950 error to the surplus \\RCPT\\ commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
12951 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
12952 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
12953
12954 .conf remote@_max@_parallel integer 2
12955 .index delivery||parallelism for remote
12956 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
12957 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
12958 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
12959 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
12960 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to \remote@_max@_parallel\
12961 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than \remote@_max@_parallel\
12962 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
12963 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
12964 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
12965 \remote@_sort@_domains\ option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
12966 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
12967 tagged with its process id.
12968
12969 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
12970 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
12971 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
12972 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
12973 is received.
12974 .index number of deliveries
12975 .index delivery||maximum number of
12976 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
12977 need to set the \queue@_only\ option. This ensures that all incoming messages
12978 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
12979 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
12980 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
12981 runners by setting the \queue__run__max\ parameter. Because each queue runner
12982 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
12983 then take place at once is \queue@_run@_max\ multiplied by
12984 \remote@_max@_parallel\.
12985
12986 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
12987 \queue@_smtp@_domains\ instead of \queue@_only\. This has the added benefit of
12988 doing the SMTP routing before queuing, so that several messages for the same
12989 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
12990
12991 .conf remote@_sort@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
12992 .index sorting remote deliveries
12993 .index delivery||sorting remote
12994 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
12995 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
12996 .display asis
12997 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
12998 .endd
12999 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the \*cam.ac.uk*\ domain first, then
13000 to those in the \uk\ domain, then to any others.
13001
13002 .conf retry@_data@_expire time 7d
13003 .index hints database||data expiry
13004 This option sets a `use before' time on retry information in Exim's hints
13005 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
13006 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
13007 past failures.
13008
13009 .conf retry@_interval@_max time 24h
13010 .index retry||limit on interval
13011 .index limit||on retry interval
13012 Chapter ~~CHAPretry describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the intervals
13013 between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered straight away.
13014 This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between retries.
13015
13016 .conf return@_path@_remove boolean true
13017 .index ::Return-path:: header line||removing
13018 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a ::Return-path::
13019 header line into a message when it makes a `final delivery'. The ::Return-path::
13020 header preserves the sender address as received in the \\MAIL\\ command. This
13021 description implies that this header should not be present in an incoming
13022 message. If \return@_path@_remove\ is true, any existing ::Return-path::
13023 headers are removed from messages at the time they are received. Exim's
13024 transports have options for adding ::Return-path:: headers at the time of
13025 delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
13026
13027 .conf return@_size@_limit integer 100K
13028 This option is an obsolete synonym for \bounce@_return@_size@_limit\.
13029
13030 .conf rfc1413@_hosts "host list$**$" $*$
13031 .index RFC 1413
13032 .index host||for RFC 1413 calls
13033 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
13034 in the list.
13035
13036 .conf rfc1413@_query@_timeout time 30s
13037 .index RFC 1413||query timeout
13038 .index timeout||for RFC 1413 call
13039 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
13040 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
13041
13042 .conf sender@_unqualified@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
13043 .index unqualified addresses
13044 .index host||unqualified addresses from
13045 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
13046 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
13047 \qualify@_domain\. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does not
13048 reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but it
13049 qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
13050 \sender@_unqualified@_hosts\,
13051 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the \-bnq-\
13052 option was not set.
13053
13054 .conf smtp@_accept@_keepalive boolean true
13055 .index keepalive||on incoming connection
13056 This option controls the setting of the \\SO@_KEEPALIVE\\ option on incoming
13057 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
13058 connections periodically, by sending packets with `old' sequence numbers. The
13059 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgement if the connection is
13060 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
13061 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
13062 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
13063 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
13064 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
13065
13066
13067 .conf smtp@_accept@_max integer 20
13068 .index limit||incoming SMTP connections
13069 .index SMTP||incoming connection count
13070 .index inetd
13071 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
13072 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
13073 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by \*inetd*\. If the value
13074 is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be non-zero if
13075 either \smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_host\ or \smtp@_accept@_queue\ is set. See also
13076 \smtp@_accept@_reserve\.
13077
13078
13079 .conf smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail integer 10
13080 .index limit||non-mail SMTP commands
13081 .index SMTP||limiting non-mail commands
13082 Exim counts the number of `non-mail' commands in an SMTP session, and drops the
13083 connection if there are too many. This option defines `too many'. The check
13084 catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing \\AUTH\\s, or a mad
13085 client looping sending \\EHLO\\, for example. The check is applied only if the
13086 client host matches \smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail@_hosts\.
13087
13088 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of \\RSET\\ is not counted. This
13089 allows a client to send one \\RSET\\ between messages (this is not necessary,
13090 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurence of \\HELO\\
13091 or \\EHLO\\, and one occurrence of \\STARTTLS\\ between messages. After
13092 starting up a TLS session, another \\EHLO\\ is expected, and so it too is not
13093 counted. The first occurrence of \\AUTH\\ in a connection, or immediately
13094 following \\STARTTLS\\ is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
13095 \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, \\DATA\\, and \\QUIT\\ are counted.
13096
13097 .conf smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail@_hosts "host list$**$" $*$
13098 You can control which hosts are subject to the \smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail\
13099 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
13100 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
13101 live with.
13102
13103
13104 .conf smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_connection integer 1000
13105 .index SMTP||incoming message count, limiting
13106 .index limit||messages per SMTP connection
13107 The value of this option limits the number of \\MAIL\\ commands that Exim is
13108 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
13109 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
13110 response is given to subsequent \\MAIL\\ commands. This limit is a safety
13111 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
13112 seen).
13113
13114 .conf smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_host string$**$ unset
13115 .index limit||SMTP connections from one host
13116 .index host||limiting SMTP connections from
13117 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
13118 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
13119 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
13120 reference to \$sender@_host@_address$\. Once the limit is reached, additional
13121 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. The
13122 default value of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set, it is required
13123 that \smtp@_accept@_max\ be non-zero.
13124
13125 \**Warning**\: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
13126 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
13127 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
13128 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
13129 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
13130 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
13131
13132
13133 .conf smtp@_accept@_queue integer 0
13134 .index SMTP||incoming connection count
13135 .index queueing incoming messages
13136 .index message||queueing by SMTP connection count
13137 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls handled via the listening
13138 daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed on the
13139 queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. A value of zero implies
13140 no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only if it is less than the
13141 \smtp@_accept@_max\ value (unless that is zero). See also \queue@_only\,
13142 \queue@_only@_load\, \queue@_smtp@_domains\, and the various \-od-\ command
13143 line options.
13144
13145 .conf smtp@_accept@_queue@_per@_connection integer 10
13146 .index queueing incoming messages
13147 .index message||queueing by message count
13148 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
13149 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
13150 the use of \-bs-\ or \-bS-\. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
13151 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
13152 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
13153 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
13154 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
13155 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
13156 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
13157
13158 .conf smtp@_accept@_reserve integer 0
13159 .index SMTP||incoming call count
13160 .index host||reserved
13161 When \smtp@_accept@_max\ is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
13162 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
13163 that are specified in \smtp@_reserve@_hosts\. The value set in
13164 \smtp@_accept@_max\ includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
13165 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
13166 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that that group
13167 of hosts can always get at least \smtp@_accept@_reserve\ connections.
13168
13169 For example, if \smtp@_accept@_max\ is set to 50 and \smtp@_accept@_reserve\ is
13170 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
13171 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in \smtp@_reserve@_hosts\.
13172 See also \smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_host\.
13173
13174 .conf smtp@_active@_hostname string$**$ unset
13175 .index host||name in SMTP responses
13176 .index SMTP||host name in responses
13177 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
13178 several different hosts. At the start of an SMTP connection, its value is
13179 expanded and used instead of the value of \$primary@_hostname$\ in SMTP
13180 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
13181 incoming \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command.
13182 .em
13183 It is also used in \\HELO\\ commands for callout verification.
13184 The active hostname is placed in the \$smtp__active__hostname$\ variable, which
13185 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
13186 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
13187 .nem
13188
13189 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
13190 expansion results in an empty string, the value of \$primary@_hostname$\ is
13191 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
13192 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
13193 value of \smtp@_active@_hostname\ depends on the incoming interface address.
13194 For example:
13195 .display asis
13196 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$interface_address}{10.0.0.1}\
13197 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
13198 .endd
13199
13200 .conf smtp@_banner string$**$ "see below"
13201 .index SMTP||welcome banner
13202 .index banner for SMTP
13203 .index welcome banner for SMTP
13204 .index customizing||SMTP banner
13205 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
13206 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
13207 .display asis
13208 .em
13209 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
13210 $version_number $tod_full
13211 .nem
13212 .endd
13213 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
13214 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use `@\n' in the string at
13215 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
13216 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
13217 multiline response).
13218
13219 .conf smtp@_check@_spool@_space boolean true
13220 .index checking disk space
13221 .index disk space, checking
13222 .index spool directory||checking space
13223 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the \\SIZE\\
13224 option on a \\MAIL\\ command, it checks that there is enough space in the
13225 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
13226 leaving free the amount specified by \check@_spool@_space\ (even if that value
13227 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
13228
13229 .conf smtp@_connect@_backlog integer 20
13230 .index connection backlog
13231 .index SMTP||connection backlog
13232 .index backlog of connections
13233 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
13234 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
13235 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
13236 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
13237 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
13238 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
13239 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
13240 attacks by SYN flooding.
13241
13242 .conf smtp@_enforce@_sync boolean true
13243 .index SMTP||synchronization checking
13244 .index synchronization checking in SMTP
13245 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
13246 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without \\PIPELINING\\ these
13247 synchronization points are after every command; with \\PIPELINING\\ they are
13248 fewer, but they still exist.
13249
13250 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
13251 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
13252 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response `554
13253 SMTP synchronization error' is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing for
13254 this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected input
13255 may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it does
13256 detect many instances.
13257
13258 .em
13259 The check can be globally disabled by setting \smtp@_enforce@_sync\ false.
13260 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
13261 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a \control\ modifier in an ACL
13262 (see section ~~SECTcontrols). See also \pipelining@_advertise@_hosts\.
13263 .nem
13264
13265 .conf smtp@_etrn@_command string$**$ unset
13266 .index \\ETRN\\||command to be run
13267 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP \\ETRN\\
13268 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
13269 chapter ~~CHAPACL). The string is split up into separate arguments which are
13270 independently expanded. The expansion variable \$domain$\ is set to the
13271 argument of the \\ETRN\\ command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
13272 example:
13273 .display asis
13274 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain $sender_host_address
13275 .endd
13276 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
13277 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
13278 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the \\ETRN\\ caller still receives
13279 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
13280 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
13281 the command.
13282
13283 .conf smtp@_etrn@_serialize boolean true
13284 .index \\ETRN\\||serializing
13285 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
13286 one identical command as a result of \\ETRN\\ in an SMTP connection. See
13287 section ~~SECTETRN for details.
13288
13289 .conf smtp@_load@_reserve fixed-point unset
13290 .index load average
13291 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
13292 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in \smtp@_reserve@_hosts\.
13293 If \smtp@_reserve@_hosts\ is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
13294 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
13295 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
13296 \deliver@_queue@_load@_max\ and \queue@_only@_load\.
13297
13298
13299 .conf smtp@_max@_synprot@_errors integer 3
13300 .index SMTP||limiting syntax and protocol errors
13301 .index limit||SMTP syntax and protocol errors
13302 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
13303 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
13304 .display asis
13305 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
13306 .endd
13307 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
13308 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
13309 example of a protocol error is receiving \\RCPT\\ before \\MAIL\\. If there are
13310 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
13311 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
13312
13313 .index \\PIPELINING\\||expected errors
13314 When the \\PIPELINING\\ extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
13315 `expected', for instance, a \\RCPT\\ command after a rejected \\MAIL\\ command.
13316 Exim assumes that \\PIPELINING\\ will be used if it advertises it (see
13317 \pipelining@_advertise@_hosts\), and in this situation, `expected' errors do
13318 not count towards the limit.
13319
13320
13321 .conf smtp@_max@_unknown@_commands integer 3
13322 .index SMTP||limiting unknown commands
13323 .index limit||unknown SMTP commands
13324 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
13325 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
13326 that subvert web
13327 clients
13328 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
13329 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
13330
13331
13332 .conf smtp@_ratelimit@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
13333 .index SMTP||rate limiting
13334 .index limit||rate of message arrival
13335 .index \\RCPT\\||rate limiting
13336 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
13337 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
13338 recipients. When a host matches \smtp@_ratelimit@_hosts\, the values of
13339 \smtp@_ratelimit@_mail\ and \smtp@_ratelimit@_rcpt\ are used to control the
13340 rate of acceptance of \\MAIL\\ and \\RCPT\\ commands in a single SMTP session,
13341 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
13342 values:
13343 .numberpars $.
13344 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
13345 .nextp
13346 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
13347 fractional parts are allowed here.
13348 .nextp
13349 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
13350 .nextp
13351 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
13352 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
13353 .endp
13354 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
13355 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
13356 .display asis
13357 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
13358 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
13359 .endd
13360 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to \\MAIL\\ commands after
13361 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
13362 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
13363 delays to \\RCPT\\ commands when more than four occur in a single message.
13364
13365 It is also possible to configure delays explicitly in ACLs. See section
13366 ~~SECTACLmodi for details.
13367
13368
13369 .conf smtp@_ratelimit@_mail string unset
13370 See \smtp@_ratelimit@_hosts\ above.
13371
13372 .conf smtp@_ratelimit@_rcpt string unset
13373 See \smtp@_ratelimit@_hosts\ above.
13374
13375 .conf smtp@_receive@_timeout time 5m
13376 .index timeout||for SMTP input
13377 .index SMTP||timeout, input
13378 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
13379 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
13380 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
13381 the message is abandoned.
13382 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
13383 .display asis
13384 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
13385 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
13386 .endd
13387 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
13388 means that it was in the \\DATA\\ phase, reading the contents of a message.
13389
13390
13391 .index \-os-\ option
13392 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
13393 \-os-\ command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
13394 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
13395 of local input using \-bs-\ or \-bS-\.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
13396 timeout is controlled by \receive@_timeout\ and \-or-\.
13397
13398 .conf smtp@_reserve@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
13399 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
13400 \smtp@_accept@_reserve\ and \smtp@_load@_reserve\ above.
13401
13402 .conf smtp@_return@_error@_details boolean false
13403 .index SMTP||details policy failures
13404 .index policy control||rejection, returning details
13405 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
13406 `Administrative prohibition' when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
13407 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
13408 to spammers. However, some other syadmins who are applying strict checking
13409 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
13410 \smtp@_return@_error@_details\ true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
13411 example, instead of `Administrative prohibition', it might give:
13412 .display asis
13413 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
13414 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
13415 .endd
13416
13417 .em
13418 .conf spamd@_address string "$tt{127.0.0.1 783}"
13419 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
13420 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's \spamd\ daemon. See
13421 section ~~SECTscanspamass for more details.
13422 .nem
13423
13424 .conf split@_spool@_directory boolean false
13425 .index multiple spool directories
13426 .index spool directory||split
13427 .index directories, multiple
13428 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
13429 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
13430 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
13431 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
13432 arrival of the message.
13433
13434 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
13435 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
13436 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
13437 directory; however, if \preserve@_message@_logs\ is set, all old msglog files
13438 are still placed in the single directory \(msglog.OLD)\.
13439
13440 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
13441 changing \split@_spool@_directory\. Exim notices messages that are in the
13442 `wrong' place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off after
13443 a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
13444 automatically deleted.
13445
13446 When \split@_spool@_directory\ is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
13447 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
13448 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
13449 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
13450 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
13451 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
13452 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
13453 if \queue@_run@_in@_order\ is set, none of this new processing happens. The
13454 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
13455
13456 .conf spool@_directory string$**$ "set at compile time"
13457 .index spool directory||path to
13458 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
13459 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
13460 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
13461 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
13462 \$primary@_hostname$\.
13463
13464 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
13465 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
13466 log files are being written to the spool directory (see \log@_file@_path\).
13467 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
13468 as failures in the configuration file.
13469
13470 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
13471 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
13472
13473 .conf strip@_excess@_angle@_brackets boolean false
13474 .index angle brackets, excess
13475 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round `route-addr'
13476 items in addresses are stripped. For example, \*@<@<xxx@@a.b.c.d@>@>*\ is treated
13477 as \*@<xxx@@a.b.c.d@>*\. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on
13478 to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this option is
13479 not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
13480
13481 .conf strip@_trailing@_dot boolean false
13482 .index trailing dot on domain
13483 .index dot||trailing on domain
13484 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
13485 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
13486 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
13487 domain causes a syntax error.
13488 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
13489 syntax checking.
13490
13491 .conf syslog@_duplication boolean true
13492 .index syslog||duplicate log lines, suppressing
13493 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
13494 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
13495 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
13496 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
13497 nuisance. If \syslog@_duplication\ is set false, only one copy of any
13498 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
13499 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
13500 containing message header lines) is written, at \\LOG@_NOTICE\\ priority.
13501 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
13502 the \\LOG@_ALERT\\ priority.
13503
13504 .conf syslog@_facility string unset
13505 .index syslog||facility, setting
13506 This option sets the syslog `facility' name, used when Exim is logging to
13507 syslog. The value must be one of the strings `mail', `user', `news', `uucp',
13508 `daemon', or `local\*x*\' where \*x*\ is a digit between 0 and 7. If this
13509 option is unset, `mail' is used. See chapter ~~CHAPlog for details of Exim's
13510 logging.
13511
13512
13513 .conf syslog@_processname string "$tt{exim}"
13514 .index syslog||process name, setting
13515 This option sets the syslog `ident' name, used when Exim is logging to syslog.
13516 The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter ~~CHAPlog for
13517 details of Exim's logging.
13518
13519
13520 .conf syslog@_timestamp boolean true
13521 .index syslog||timestamps
13522 If \syslog@_timestamp\ is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
13523 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter ~~CHAPlog for
13524 details of Exim's logging.
13525
13526 .conf system@_filter string$**$ unset
13527 .index filter||system filter
13528 .index system filter||specifying
13529 .index Sieve filter||not available for system filter
13530 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
13531 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
13532 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
13533 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
13534 appropriate \system@_filter@_...@_transport\ option(s) must be set, to define
13535 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
13536 ~~CHAPsystemfilter.
13537
13538 .conf system@_filter@_directory@_transport string$**$ unset
13539 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
13540 \save\ command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in `/',
13541 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
13542 During the delivery, the variable \$address@_file$\ contains the path name.
13543
13544 .conf system@_filter@_file@_transport string$**$ unset
13545 .index file||transport for system filter
13546 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the \save\
13547 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in `/'. During
13548 the delivery, the variable \$address@_file$\ contains the path name.
13549
13550 .index gid (group id)||system filter
13551 .conf system@_filter@_group string unset
13552 This option is used only when \system@_filter@_user\ is also set. It sets the
13553 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
13554 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
13555
13556 .conf system@_filter@_pipe@_transport string$**$ unset 7
13557 .index \%pipe%\ transport||for system filter
13558 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a \pipe\ command is
13559 used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable \$address@_pipe$\
13560 contains the pipe command.
13561
13562 .conf system@_filter@_reply@_transport string$**$ unset
13563 .index \%autoreply%\ transport||for system filter
13564 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a \mail\ command is
13565 used in a system filter.
13566
13567 .index uid (user id)||system filter
13568 .conf system@_filter@_user string unset
13569 If this option is not set, the system filter is run in the main Exim delivery
13570 process, as root. When the option is set, the system filter runs in a separate
13571 process, as the given user. Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
13572 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
13573 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
13574 specified by \system@_filter@_group\. When the uid is specified numerically,
13575 \system@_filter@_group\ is required to be set.
13576
13577 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
13578 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
13579 transport option overrides.
13580 Normally you should set \system@_filter@_user\ if your system filter generates
13581 these kinds of delivery.
13582
13583 .conf tcp@_nodelay boolean true
13584 .index daemon||\\TCP@_NODELAY\\ on sockets
13585 .index Nagle algorithm
13586 .index \\TCP@_NODELAY\\ on listening sockets
13587 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
13588 \\TCP@_NODELAY\\ option on its listening sockets. Setting \\TCP@_NODELAY\\
13589 turns off the `Nagle algorithm', which is a way of improving network
13590 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
13591 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
13592 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
13593 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
13594 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
13595 \\TCP@_NODELAY\\.
13596
13597 .conf timeout@_frozen@_after time 0s
13598 .index frozen messages||timing out
13599 .index timeout||frozen messages
13600 If \timeout@_frozen@_after\ is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
13601 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given
13602 time is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If it is a bounce
13603 message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the sender, in a
13604 similar manner to cancellation by the \-Mg-\ command line option. If you want
13605 to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of frozen message,
13606 see \ignore@_bounce@_errors@_after\.
13607
13608 .conf timezone string unset
13609 .index timezone, setting
13610 The value of \timezone\ is used to set the environment variable \\TZ\\ while
13611 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
13612 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
13613 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
13614 .display asis
13615 timezone = UTC
13616 .endd
13617 The default value is taken from \\TIMEZONE@_DEFAULT\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\,
13618 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
13619 is built. If \timezone\ is set to the empty string, either at build or run
13620 time, any existing \\TZ\\ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
13621 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
13622 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
13623
13624 .conf tls@_advertise@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
13625 .index TLS||advertising
13626 .index encryption||on SMTP connection
13627 .index SMTP||encrypted connection
13628 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
13629 of the \\STARTTLS\\ command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
13630 response to \\EHLO\\ only to those client hosts that match this option. See
13631 chapter ~~CHAPTLS for details of Exim's support for TLS.
13632
13633 .conf tls@_certificate string$**$ unset
13634 .index TLS||server certificate, location of
13635 .index certificate||for server, location of
13636 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
13637 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
13638 assumed to be in this file if \tls@_privatekey\ is unset. See chapter ~~CHAPTLS
13639 for further details.
13640
13641 \**Note**\: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
13642 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
13643 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the \tls@_certificate\
13644 option in the relevant \%smtp%\ transport.
13645
13646 .conf tls@_crl string$**$ unset
13647 .index TLS||server certificate revocation list
13648 .index certificate||revocation list for server
13649 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
13650 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
13651
13652 .conf tls@_dhparam string$**$ unset
13653 .index TLS||D-H parameters for server
13654 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
13655 a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
13656 This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
13657 ignored. See section ~~SECTopenvsgnu for further details.
13658
13659 .em
13660 .conf tls@_on@_connect@_ports "string list" unset
13661 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
13662 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
13663 set up without waiting for the client to issue a \\STARTTLS\\ command. For
13664 further details, see section ~~SECTsupobssmt.
13665 .nem
13666
13667 .conf tls@_privatekey string$**$ unset
13668 .index TLS||server private key, location of
13669 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
13670 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, the
13671 private key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See
13672 chapter ~~CHAPTLS for further details.
13673
13674 .conf tls@_remember@_esmtp boolean false
13675 .index TLS||esmtp state, remembering
13676 .index TLS||broken clients
13677 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
13678 `esmtp' state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
13679 support for broken clients that fail to send a new \\EHLO\\ after starting a
13680 TLS session.
13681
13682 .conf tls@_require@_ciphers string$**$ unset
13683 .index TLS||requiring specific ciphers
13684 .index cipher||requiring specific
13685 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
13686 The \%smtp%\ transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
13687 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
13688 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
13689 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
13690 in somewhat different ways.
13691 .em
13692 If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the preference order of the
13693 available ciphers.
13694 .nem
13695 Details are given in sections ~~SECTreqciphssl and ~~SECTreqciphgnu.
13696
13697 .conf tls@_try@_verify@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
13698 .index TLS||client certificate verification
13699 .index certificate||verification of client
13700 See \tls@_verify@_hosts\ below.
13701
13702 .conf tls@_verify@_certificates string$**$ unset
13703 .index TLS||client certificate verification
13704 .index certificate||verification of client
13705 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
13706 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
13707 match \tls@_verify@_hosts\ or \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\. Alternatively, if you
13708 are using OpenSSL, you can set \tls@_verify@_certificates\ to the name of a
13709 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
13710 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
13711
13712 .conf tls@_verify@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
13713 .index TLS||client certificate verification
13714 .index certificate||verification of client
13715 This option, along with \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\, controls the checking of
13716 certificates from clients.
13717 The expected certificates are defined by \tls@_verify@_certificates\, which
13718 must be set. A configuration error occurs if either \tls@_verify@_hosts\ or
13719 \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\ is set and \tls@_verify@_certificates\ is not set.
13720
13721 Any client that matches \tls@_verify@_hosts\ is constrained by
13722 \tls@_verify@_certificates\. The client must present one of the listed
13723 certificates. If it does not, the connection is aborted.
13724
13725 A weaker form of checking is provided by \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\. If a client
13726 matches this option (but not \tls@_verify@_hosts\), Exim requests a
13727 certificate and checks it against \tls@_verify@_certificates\, but does not
13728 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
13729 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
13730 such as `accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received, but
13731 accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified certificate'.
13732
13733 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
13734 certificates.
13735
13736 .conf trusted@_groups "string list" unset
13737 .index trusted group
13738 .index group||trusted
13739 If this option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups,
13740 or which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted.
13741 The groups can be specified numerically or by name.
13742 See section ~~SECTtrustedadmin for details of what trusted callers are
13743 permitted to do. If neither \trusted@_groups\ nor \trusted@_users\ is set, only
13744 root and the Exim user are trusted.
13745
13746 .conf trusted@_users "string list" unset
13747 .index trusted user
13748 .index user||trusted
13749 If this option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users
13750 is trusted.
13751 The users can be specified numerically or by name.
13752 See section ~~SECTtrustedadmin for details of what trusted callers are
13753 permitted to do. If neither \trusted@_groups\ nor \trusted@_users\ is set, only
13754 root and the Exim user are trusted.
13755
13756 .index uid (user id)||unknown caller
13757 .conf unknown@_login string$**$ unset
13758 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
13759 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using \*getpwuid()*\, Exim
13760 gives up. The \unknown@_login\ option can be used to set a login name to be
13761 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like \user@$caller@_uid\
13762 can be set. When \unknown@_login\ is used, the value of \unknown@_username\ is
13763 used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
13764 \-F-\ option.
13765
13766 .conf unknown@_username string unset
13767 See \unknown@_login\.
13768
13769 .conf untrusted@_set@_sender "address list$**$" unset
13770 .index trusted user
13771 .index sender||setting by untrusted user
13772 .index untrusted user, setting sender
13773 .index user||untrusted setting sender
13774 .index envelope sender
13775 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
13776 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
13777 default qualification domain. Data from the \-f-\ option (for setting envelope
13778 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP \\MAIL\\ command (if \-bs-\ or \-bS-\
13779 is used) is ignored.
13780
13781 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
13782 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
13783 .display asis
13784 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
13785 .endd
13786 The \untrusted@_set@_sender\ option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
13787 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
13788 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
13789 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
13790 identity of the user is in \$sender@_ident$\, so you can, for example, restrict
13791 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
13792 followed by a hyphen
13793 by a setting like this:
13794 .display asis
13795 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
13796 .endd
13797 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
13798 restriction, you can use
13799 .display asis
13800 untrusted_set_sender = *
13801 .endd
13802 The \untrusted@_set@_sender\ option applies to all forms of local input, but
13803 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
13804 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
13805 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
13806 ::Sender:: header in the message, or from adding a ::Sender:: header if
13807 necessary. See \local__sender__retain\ and \local@_from@_check\ for ways of
13808 overriding these actions. The handling of the ::Sender:: header is also
13809 described in section ~~SECTthesenhea.
13810
13811 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following `<='.
13812 For local messages, the user's login always follows, after `U='. In \-bp-\
13813 displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an envelope sender
13814 address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the sender address.
13815
13816 .conf uucp@_from@_pattern string "see below"
13817 .index `From' line
13818 .index UUCP||`From' line
13819 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
13820 an initial line starting with `From' to pass the envelope sender. In
13821 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
13822 of a regular expression that is set in \uucp@_from@_pattern\. When the pattern
13823 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
13824 \uucp@_from@_sender\, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
13825 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
13826 .display asis
13827 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
13828 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
13829 .endd
13830 The pattern can be seen by running
13831 .display asis
13832 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
13833 .endd
13834 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
13835 year in the second case. The first word after `From' is matched in the regular
13836 expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
13837 \uucp@_from@_sender\ is `$1', which therefore just uses this first word (`ph10'
13838 in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
13839 \ignore@_fromline@_hosts\.
13840
13841 .conf uucp@_from@_sender string$**$ "$tt{@$1}"
13842 See \uucp@_from@_pattern\ above.
13843
13844 .conf warn@_message@_file string unset
13845 .index warning of delay||customizing the message
13846 .index customizing||warning message
13847 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13848 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
13849 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
13850 \delay@_warning\. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
13851 ~~CHAPemsgcust. See also \bounce@_message@_file\.
13852
13853 .conf write@_rejectlog boolean true
13854 .index reject log||disabling
13855 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
13856 See chapter ~~CHAPlog for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
13857
13858 .endconf
13859
13860
13861
13862 .
13863 .
13864 .
13865 .
13866 . ============================================================================
13867 .chapter Generic options for routers
13868 .rset CHAProutergeneric "~~chapter"
13869 .set runningfoot "generic router options"
13870 .index options||generic, for routers
13871 .index generic options||router
13872
13873 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers,
13874 identifying those that are preconditions. For a general description of how a
13875 router operates, see sections ~~SECTrunindrou and ~~SECTrouprecon. The latter
13876 specifies the order in which the preconditions are tested. The order of
13877 expansion of the options that provide data for a transport is: \errors@_to\,
13878 \headers@_add\, \headers@_remove\, \transport\.
13879
13880 .startconf routers
13881
13882 .conf address@_data string$**$ unset
13883 .index router||data attached to address
13884 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
13885 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
13886 router declines. Other expansion failures cause delivery of the address to be
13887 deferred.
13888
13889 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
13890 accessed using the variable \$address@_data$\ in the current router, subsequent
13891 routers, and the eventual transport.
13892
13893 \**Warning**\: if the current or any subsequent router is a \%redirect%\ router
13894 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of \$address@_data$\ are
13895 accessible in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is
13896 usually either not confidential or it `belongs' to the current user, but if you
13897 do put confidential data into \$address@_data$\ you need to remember this
13898 point.
13899
13900 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of \$address@_data$\ remains
13901 with the address, though it can be changed by another \address@_data\ setting
13902 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
13903 \$address@_data$\ propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
13904 `child' that is generated by a router with the \unseen\ option.
13905
13906 The idea of \address@_data\ is that you can use it to look up a lot of data for
13907 the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example, you
13908 could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
13909 .display asis
13910 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
13911 .endd
13912 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
13913 .display asis
13914 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
13915 .endd
13916 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
13917 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
13918
13919 The \address@_data\ facility is also useful as a means of passing information
13920 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
13921 .em
13922 \$address@_data$\ is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
13923 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
13924 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to \$sender@_address@_data$\.
13925 .nem
13926
13927
13928 .conf address@_test "boolean (precondition)" true
13929 .index \-bt-\ option
13930 .index router||skipping when address testing
13931 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
13932 by means of the \-bt-\ command line option. This can be a convenience when your
13933 first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
13934 having to set the `already scanned' indicator when testing real address
13935 routing.
13936
13937
13938 .conf cannot@_route@_message string$**$ unset
13939 .index router||customizing `cannot route' message
13940 .index customizing||`cannot route' message
13941 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
13942 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is `Unrouteable
13943 address'. This option is useful only on routers that have \more\ set false, or
13944 on the very last router in a configuration, because the value that is used is
13945 taken from the last router that inspects an address. For example, using the
13946 default configuration, you could put:
13947 .display asis
13948 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
13949 .endd
13950 on the first (\%dnslookup%\) router, and
13951 .display asis
13952 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
13953 .endd
13954 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails, the
13955 default message is used.
13956 Unless the expansion failure was explicitly forced, a message about the failure
13957 is written to the main and panic logs, in addition to the normal message about
13958 the routing failure.
13959
13960 .conf caseful@_local@_part boolean false
13961 .index case of local parts
13962 .index router||case of local parts
13963 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
13964 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
13965 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
13966 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
13967 part lists (for example, \local@_parts\), case-sensitive matching can be turned
13968 on by `+caseful' as a list item. See section ~~SECTcasletadd for more details.
13969
13970 .em
13971 The value of the \$local@_part$\ variable is forced to lower case while a
13972 router is running unless \caseful@_local@_part\ is set. When a router assigns
13973 an address to a transport, the value of \$local@_part$\ when the transport runs
13974 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
13975 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of \$original@_local@_part$\
13976 and \$parent@_local@_part$\ are those that were used by the redirecting router.
13977
13978 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
13979 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate \control\
13980 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
13981 (see section ~~SECTcontrols).
13982 .nem
13983
13984 .conf check@_local@_user "boolean (precondition)" false
13985 .index local user, checking in router
13986 .index router||checking for local user
13987 .index \(/etc/passwd)\
13988 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
13989 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
13990 local system. The check is done by calling the \*getpwnam()*\ function rather
13991 than trying to read \(/etc/passwd)\ directly. This means that other methods of
13992 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
13993 user, \$home$\ is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
13994 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
13995 given in section ~~SECTrouprecon). However, the value of \$home$\ can be
13996 overridden by \router@_home@_directory\. If the local part is not a local user,
13997 the router is skipped.
13998
13999 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
14000 or matches something else, you cannot combine \check@_local@_user\ with a
14001 setting of \local@_parts\, because that specifies the logical \*and*\ of the
14002 two conditions. However, you can use a \%passwd%\ lookup in a \local@_parts\
14003 setting to achieve this. For example:
14004 .display asis
14005 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
14006 .endd
14007 Note, however, that the side effects of \check@_local@_user\ (such as setting
14008 up a home directory) do not occur when a \%passwd%\ lookup is used in a
14009 \local@_parts\ (or any other) precondition.
14010
14011
14012 .conf condition "string$**$ (precondition)" unset
14013 .index router||customized precondition
14014 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
14015 router to be called. The \condition\ option is the last precondition to be
14016 evaluated (see section ~~SECTrouprecon). The string is expanded, and if the
14017 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings `0' or
14018 `no' or `false' (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the router
14019 is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
14020 .em
14021 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
14022 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
14023
14024 The \condition\ option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
14025 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
14026 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
14027 .display asis
14028 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
14029 .endd
14030 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
14031 .display asis
14032 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
14033 .endd
14034 .nem
14035
14036 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
14037 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
14038 be specified using \condition\.
14039
14040
14041 .conf debug@_print string$**$ unset
14042 .index testing||variables in drivers
14043 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the \-d-\ command line
14044 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
14045 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
14046 output, and Exim carries on processing.
14047 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
14048 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a \condition\
14049 option appears not to be working, \debug@_print\ can be used to output the
14050 variables it references. The output happens after checks for \domains\,
14051 \local@_parts\, and \check@_local@_user\ but before any other preconditions are
14052 tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
14053
14054
14055 .conf disable@_logging boolean false
14056 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
14057 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
14058 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
14059 transport option of the same name.
14060
14061 .conf domains "domain list$**$ (precondition)" unset
14062 .index router||restricting to specific domains
14063 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
14064 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
14065 lookup returned for the domain is placed in \$domain@_data$\ for use in string
14066 expansions of the driver's private options.
14067 See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
14068 are evaluated.
14069
14070
14071 .conf driver string unset
14072 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
14073 to be used.
14074
14075
14076 .conf errors@_to string$**$ unset
14077 .index envelope sender
14078 .index router||changing address for errors
14079 If a router successfully handles an address, it may queue the address for
14080 delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if there is a
14081 delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce message is sent
14082 to the address that results from expanding this string, provided that the
14083 address verifies successfully.
14084 \errors@_to\ is expanded before \headers@_add\, \headers@_remove\, and
14085 \transport\.
14086
14087 If the option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
14088 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
14089 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
14090 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
14091
14092 If an address for which \errors@_to\ has been set ends up being delivered over
14093 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the \errors@_to\ value, so that
14094 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
14095 sent there. The most common use of \errors@_to\ is probably to direct mailing
14096 list bounces to the manager of the list, as described in section
14097 ~~SECTmailinglists.
14098
14099 The \errors@_to\ setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
14100 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own \errors@_to\
14101 settings,
14102 or if it is delivered by a transport with a \return@_path\ setting.
14103
14104 You can set \errors@_to\ to the empty string by either of these settings:
14105 .display asis
14106 errors_to =
14107 errors_to = ""
14108 .endd
14109 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
14110 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
14111 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
14112 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to \"<>"\, unless
14113 overridden by the \return@_path\ option on the transport.
14114
14115 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
14116 \\MAIL\\ command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
14117 path in \$address@_data$\ in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
14118 setting \return@_path\.
14119
14120
14121 .conf expn "boolean (precondition)" true
14122 .index address||testing
14123 .index testing||addresses
14124 .index \\EXPN\\||router skipping
14125 .index router||skipping for \\EXPN\\
14126 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
14127 as a result of processing an SMTP \\EXPN\\ command. You might, for example,
14128 want to turn it off on a router for users' \(.forward)\ files, while leaving it
14129 on for the system alias file.
14130 See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
14131 are evaluated.
14132
14133 The use of the SMTP \\EXPN\\ command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
14134 ~~CHAPACL). When Exim is running an \\EXPN\\ command, it is similar to testing
14135 an address with \-bt-\. Compare \\VRFY\\, whose counterpart is \-bv-\.
14136
14137
14138 .conf fail@_verify boolean false
14139 .index router||forcing verification failure
14140 Setting this option has the effect of setting both \fail@_verify@_sender\ and
14141 \fail@_verify@_recipient\ to the same value.
14142
14143
14144 .conf fail@_verify@_recipient boolean false
14145 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
14146 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
14147
14148
14149 .conf fail@_verify@_sender boolean false
14150 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
14151 verifying a sender, verification fails.
14152
14153
14154 .conf fallback@_hosts "string list" unset
14155 .index router||fallback hosts
14156 .index fallback||hosts specified on router
14157 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
14158 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. If a router queues an
14159 address for a remote transport, this host list is associated with the address,
14160 and used instead of the transport's fallback host list. If \hosts@_randomize\
14161 is set on the transport, the order of the list is randomized for each use. See
14162 the \fallback@_hosts\ option of the \%smtp%\ transport for further details.
14163
14164 .conf group string$**$ "see below"
14165 .index gid (group id)||local delivery
14166 .index local transports||uid and gid
14167 .index transport||local
14168 .index router||setting group
14169 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
14170 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
14171 process.
14172 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
14173 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
14174 The default is unset, unless \check@_local@_user\ is set, when the default
14175 is taken from the password information. See also \initgroups\ and \user\ and
14176 the discussion in chapter ~~CHAPenvironment.
14177
14178
14179 .conf headers@_add string$**$ unset
14180 .index header lines||adding
14181 .index router||adding header lines
14182 .em
14183 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
14184 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
14185 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
14186 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
14187 ~~SECTheadersaddrem.
14188
14189 The \headers@_add\ option is expanded after \errors@_to\, but before
14190 \headers@_remove\ and \transport\. If the expanded string is empty, or if the
14191 expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion failures
14192 are treated as configuration errors.
14193
14194 \**Warning**\: The \headers@_add\ option cannot be used for a \%redirect%\
14195 router that has the \one@_time\ option set.
14196 .nem
14197
14198
14199 .conf headers@_remove string$**$ unset
14200 .index header lines||removing
14201 .index router||removing header lines
14202 .em
14203 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
14204 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
14205 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
14206 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
14207 section ~~SECTheadersaddrem.
14208
14209 The \headers@_remove\ option is expanded after \errors@_to\ and \headers@_add\,
14210 but before \transport\. If the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no
14211 effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration errors.
14212
14213 \**Warning**\: The \headers@_remove\ option cannot be used for a \%redirect%\
14214 router that has the \one@_time\ option set.
14215 .nem
14216
14217
14218 .conf ignore@_target@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
14219 .index IP address||discarding
14220 .index router||discarding IP addresses
14221 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
14222 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
14223 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
14224 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
14225 like
14226 .display asis
14227 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
14228 .endd
14229 by setting
14230 .display asis
14231 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
14232 .endd
14233 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a \%dnslookup%\ router are
14234 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
14235 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the `unrouteable
14236 domain' error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
14237
14238 Similarly, if \ignore@_target@_hosts\ is set on an \%ipliteral%\ router, the
14239 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
14240
14241 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
14242 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of \ignore@_target@_hosts\
14243 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
14244 domain that is being routed.
14245 .em
14246 During its expansion, \$host@_address$\ is set to the IP address that is being
14247 checked.
14248 .nem
14249
14250
14251
14252 .index additional groups
14253 .index groups, additional
14254 .index local transports||uid and gid
14255 .index transport||local
14256 .conf initgroups boolean false
14257 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
14258 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
14259 \*initgroups()*\ function is called when running the transport to ensure that
14260 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also \group\ and
14261 \user\ and the discussion in chapter ~~CHAPenvironment.
14262
14263
14264 .conf local@_part@_prefix "string list (precondition)" unset
14265 .index router||prefix for local part
14266 .index prefix||for local part, used in router
14267 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part
14268 starts with one of the given strings, or \local@_part@_prefix@_optional\ is
14269 true.
14270 See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
14271 are evaluated.
14272
14273 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
14274 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
14275 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
14276 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
14277 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
14278 .index multiple mailboxes
14279 .index mailbox||multiple
14280 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
14281 section ~~SECTmulbox.
14282
14283 During the testing of the \local@_parts\ option, and while the router is
14284 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
14285 expansion variable \$local@_part@_prefix$\. If the router accepts the address,
14286 this remains true during subsequent delivery.
14287 In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the \\RCPT\\ command
14288 for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default. This
14289 behaviour can be overridden by setting \rcpt@_include@_affixes\ true on the
14290 relevant transport.
14291
14292 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
14293 \owner-something\. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
14294 \real-username\ to bypass a user's \(.forward)\ file -- helpful when trying to
14295 tell a user their forwarding is broken -- by placing a router like this one
14296 immediately before the router that handles \(.forward)\ files:
14297 .display asis
14298 real_localuser:
14299 driver = accept
14300 local_part_prefix = real-
14301 check_local_user
14302 transport = local_delivery
14303 .endd
14304 If both \local@_part@_prefix\ and \local@_part@_suffix\ are set for a router,
14305 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
14306 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
14307 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
14308
14309 .conf local@_part@_prefix@_optional boolean false
14310 See \local@_part@_prefix\ above.
14311
14312
14313 .conf local@_part@_suffix "string list (precondition)" unset
14314 .index router||suffix for local part
14315 .index suffix for local part, used in router
14316 This option operates in the same way as \local@_part@_prefix\, except that the
14317 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
14318 \local@_part@_suffix@_optional\ option determines whether the suffix is
14319 mandatory, and the wildcard $*$ character, if present, must be the last
14320 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
14321 parts of the form \something-request\ and multiple user mailboxes of the form
14322 \username-foo\.
14323
14324 .conf local@_part@_suffix@_optional boolean false
14325 See \local@_part@_suffix\ above.
14326
14327
14328 .conf local@_parts "local part list$**$ (precondition)" unset
14329 .index router||restricting to specific local parts
14330 .index local part||checking in router
14331 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
14332 See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
14333 are evaluated, and
14334 section ~~SECTlocparlis for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
14335 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
14336 example:
14337 .display asis
14338 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
14339 .endd
14340 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
14341 for the local part is placed in the variable \$local@_part@_data$\ for use in
14342 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
14343 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
14344 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
14345 each virtual domain:
14346 .display asis
14347 postmaster:
14348 driver = redirect
14349 local_parts = postmaster
14350 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
14351 .endd
14352
14353
14354 .conf log@_as@_local boolean "see below"
14355 .index log||delivery line
14356 .index delivery||log line format
14357 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
14358 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the `local' style, the
14359 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
14360 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the \%accept%\
14361 router, and false for all the others.
14362
14363
14364 .conf more boolean$**$ true
14365 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
14366 that is, one of the strings `yes', `no', `true', or `false'. Any other result
14367 causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to fail,
14368 the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause delivery
14369 to be deferred.
14370
14371 If this option is set false, and the router is run, but declines to handle the
14372 address, no further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is
14373 bounced.
14374 .index \self\ option
14375 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
14376 means of the setting
14377 .display asis
14378 self = pass
14379 .endd
14380 or otherwise, the setting of \more\ is ignored. Also, the setting of \more\
14381 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
14382 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
14383
14384
14385 .conf pass@_on@_timeout boolean false
14386 .index timeout||of router
14387 .index router||timeout
14388 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
14389 address. If \pass@_on@_timeout\ is set, the address is passed on to the next
14390 router, overriding \no@_more\. This may be helpful for systems that are
14391 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
14392 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
14393
14394 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
14395 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
14396 applies to all of them.
14397
14398
14399 .conf pass@_router string unset
14400 .index router||go to after `pass'
14401 When a router returns `pass', the address is normally handed on to the next
14402 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting \pass@_router\ to the name
14403 of another router. However (unlike \redirect@_router\) the named router must be
14404 below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only to
14405 the special case of `pass'. It does not apply when a router returns `decline'.
14406
14407
14408 .conf redirect@_router string unset
14409 .index router||start at after redirection
14410 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
14411 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
14412 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
14413 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
14414
14415 The \redirect@_router\ option can be set to the name of any router instance. It
14416 causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
14417 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
14418 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
14419
14420
14421 .conf require@_files "string list$**$ (precondition)" unset
14422 .index file||requiring for router
14423 .index router||requiring file existence
14424 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
14425 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
14426 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
14427 through the \require@_files\ list, expanding each item separately.
14428
14429 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
14430 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
14431 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
14432 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
14433
14434 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
14435 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
14436 `!'. The paths are passed to the \*stat()*\ function to test for the existence
14437 of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not preceded by
14438 `!' do not exist, or if any paths preceded by `!' do exist.
14439
14440 .index NFS
14441 If \*stat()*\ cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
14442 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
14443 unavailable.
14444
14445 This option is checked after the \domains\, \local@_parts\, and \senders\
14446 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
14447 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a
14448 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
14449 these options are all expanded, you can use the \exists\ expansion condition to
14450 make such tests. The \require@_files\ option is intended for checking files
14451 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
14452 transport (for example \(.procmailrc)\).
14453
14454 During delivery, the \*stat()*\ function is run as root, but there is a
14455 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
14456 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a `rough' check that
14457 operates as follows:
14458
14459 If an item in a \require@_files\ list does not contain any forward slash
14460 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
14461 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
14462 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
14463 used. For example:
14464 .display asis
14465 require_files = mail:/some/file
14466 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
14467 .endd
14468 If a user or group name in a \require@_files\ list does not exist, the
14469 \require@_files\ condition fails.
14470
14471 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
14472 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for `x' access on
14473 directories, and `r' access on the final file. Note that this means that file
14474 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
14475
14476 \**Warning 1**\: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
14477 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
14478 may affect the result of a \require@_files\ check. In particular, \*stat()*\
14479 may yield the error \\EACCES\\ (`Permission denied'). This means that the Exim
14480 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
14481
14482 \**Warning 2**\: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
14483 \*stat()*\ can yield \\EACCES\\ for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
14484 without root access.
14485 .em
14486 In this case, if a check for access by a particular user is requested, Exim
14487 creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the check again in that
14488 process.
14489
14490 The default action for handling an unresolved \\EACCES\\ is to consider it to
14491 be caused by a configuration error,
14492 .nem
14493 and routing is deferred because the existence or non-existence of the file
14494 cannot be determined. However, in some circumstances it may be desirable to
14495 treat this condition as if the file did not exist. If the file name (or the
14496 exclamation mark that precedes the file name for non-existence) is preceded by
14497 a plus sign, the \\EACCES\\ error is treated as if the file did not exist. For
14498 example:
14499 .display asis
14500 require_files = +/some/file
14501 .endd
14502 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
14503 handles users' \(.forward)\ files), another solution is to set the \verify\
14504 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
14505
14506
14507 .conf retry@_use@_local@_part boolean "see below"
14508 .index hints database||retry keys
14509 .index local part||in retry keys
14510 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
14511 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
14512 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
14513 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
14514 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
14515 latter kind.
14516
14517 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
14518 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
14519 router. The default value is true for any router that has \check@_local@_user\
14520 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
14521 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
14522 same name.
14523
14524 The setting of \retry@_use@_local@_part\ applies only to the router on which it
14525 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
14526 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
14527
14528
14529 .conf router@_home@_directory string$**$ unset
14530 .index router||home directory for
14531 .index home directory||for router
14532 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
14533 \transport__home@_directory\, which sets a home directory for later
14534 transporting.) In particular, if used on a \%redirect%\ router, this option
14535 sets a value for \$home$\ while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
14536 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored -- other failures
14537 cause the router to defer.
14538
14539 Expansion of \router@_home@_directory\ happens immediately after the
14540 \check@_local@_user\ test (if configured), before any further expansions take
14541 place.
14542 (See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
14543 are evaluated.)
14544 While the router is running, \router__home@_directory\ overrides the value of
14545 \$home$\ that came from \check@_local@_user\.
14546
14547 When a router accepts an address and routes it to a transport (including the
14548 cases when a redirect router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply delivery),
14549 the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first of these
14550 values that is set:
14551 .numberpars $.
14552 The \home@_directory\ option on the transport;
14553 .nextp
14554 The \transport@_home@_directory\ option on the router;
14555 .nextp
14556 The password data if \check@_local@_user\ is set on the router;
14557 .nextp
14558 The \router@_home@_directory\ option on the router.
14559 .endp
14560 In other words, \router@_home@_directory\ overrides the password data for the
14561 router, but not for the transport.
14562
14563
14564 .conf self string "freeze"
14565 .index MX record||pointing to local host
14566 .index local host||MX pointing to
14567 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
14568 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the \%dnslookup%\, \%ipliteral%\,
14569 and \%manualroute%\ routers.
14570 Certain configurations of the \%queryprogram%\ router can also specify a list
14571 of remote hosts.
14572 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
14573 \%smtp%\ transport. The \self\ option specifies what happens when the first
14574 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
14575 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
14576 ~~SECTreclocipadd.
14577
14578 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
14579 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
14580 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
14581 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
14582 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
14583 cases:
14584 .numberpars $.
14585 \defer\
14586 .newline
14587 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
14588 .nextp
14589 \reroute: <<domain>>\
14590 .newline
14591 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
14592 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
14593 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
14594 .nextp
14595 \reroute: rewrite: <<domain>>\
14596 .newline
14597 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
14598 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
14599 rewritten.
14600 .nextp
14601 \pass\
14602 .newline
14603 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
14604 \pass@_router\ option if it is set.
14605 .index \more\ option
14606 This overrides \no@_more\.
14607
14608 During subsequent routing and delivery, the variable
14609 \$self@_hostname$\ contains the name of the local host that the router
14610 encountered. This can be used to distinguish between different cases for hosts
14611 with multiple names. The combination
14612 .display asis
14613 self = pass
14614 no_more
14615 .endd
14616 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
14617 Without \no@_more\, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
14618 be passed to the next router.
14619 .nextp
14620 \fail\
14621 .newline
14622 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
14623 .nextp
14624 \send\
14625 .newline
14626 .index local host||sending to
14627 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
14628 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an \%smtp%\ transport, it makes
14629 sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port is not
14630 this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
14631 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
14632 .endp
14633
14634 .conf senders "address list$**$ (precondition)" unset
14635 .index router||checking senders
14636 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
14637 address matches something on the list.
14638 See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
14639 are evaluated.
14640
14641 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
14642 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an \errors@_to\
14643 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the \-bt-\ option to
14644 check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the \-f-\ option to set
14645 an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when verifying
14646 the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the SMTP
14647 \\VRFY\\ command is enabled, it must be used after \\MAIL\\ if the sender
14648 address matters.
14649
14650 .conf translate@_ip@_address string$**$ unset
14651 .index IP address||translating
14652 .index packet radio
14653 .index router||IP address translation
14654 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
14655 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
14656 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
14657 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
14658 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
14659 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
14660 \\SUPPORT__TRANSLATE__IP__ADDRESS\\=yes is set in \(Local/Makefile)\.
14661
14662 The \translate@_ip@_address\ string is expanded for every IP address generated
14663 by the router, with the generated address set in \$host@_address$\. If the
14664 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
14665 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
14666 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
14667 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name -- this is looked up
14668 using \*gethostbyname()*\ (or \*getipnodebyname()*\ when available) to produce
14669 one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP addresses
14670 in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
14671 .display
14672 $smc{translate@_ip@_address = @\
14673 @$@{lookup@{@$@{mask:@$host@_address/26@}@}lsearch@{/some/file@}@{@$value@}fail@}}
14674 .endd
14675 The file would contain lines like
14676 .display asis
14677 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
14678 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
14679 .endd
14680 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
14681 are doing.
14682
14683
14684 .conf transport string$**$ unset
14685 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
14686 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
14687 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
14688 after the expansion of \errors@_to\, \headers@_add\, and \headers@_remove\, and
14689 result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
14690 delivery is deferred.
14691
14692 The \transport\ option is not used by the \%redirect%\ router, but it does have
14693 some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries (see
14694 chapter ~~CHAPredirect).
14695
14696
14697 .conf transport@_current@_directory string$**$ unset
14698 .index current directory for local transport
14699 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
14700 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
14701 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
14702 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
14703 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
14704 overridden by a setting on the transport.
14705 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
14706 logged, and delivery is deferred.
14707 See chapter ~~CHAPenvironment for details of the local delivery environment.
14708
14709
14710
14711 .conf transport@_home@_directory string$**$ "see below"
14712 .index home directory||for local transport
14713 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
14714 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
14715 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
14716 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
14717 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
14718 setting of \home@_directory\ on the transport.
14719 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
14720 logged, and delivery is deferred.
14721
14722 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
14723 \transport@_home@_directory\ is not set for the router, the home directory for
14724 the tranport is taken from the password data if \check@_local@_user\ is set for
14725 the router. Otherwise it is taken from \router@_home@_directory\ if that option
14726 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
14727
14728 See chapter ~~CHAPenvironment for further details of the local delivery
14729 environment.
14730
14731
14732
14733 .conf unseen boolean$**$ false
14734 .index router||carrying on after success
14735 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
14736 that is, one of the strings `yes', `no', `true', or `false'. Any other result
14737 causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to fail,
14738 the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause delivery
14739 to be deferred.
14740
14741 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
14742 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
14743 overriding a false setting of \more\. There is little point in setting \more\
14744 false if \unseen\ is always true, but it may be useful in cases when the value
14745 of \unseen\ contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is sometimes
14746 true and sometimes false).
14747
14748 The \unseen\ option can be used to cause
14749 .index copy of message (\unseen\ option)
14750 copies of messages to be delivered to some other destination, while also
14751 carrying out a normal delivery. In effect, the current address is made into a
14752 `parent' that has two children -- one that is delivered as specified by this
14753 router, and a clone that goes on to be routed further.
14754
14755 Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by this router or
14756 by previous routers affect the `unseen' copy of the message only. The clone
14757 that continues to be processed by further routers starts with no added headers
14758 and none specified for removal.
14759
14760 However, any data that was set by the \address@_data\ option in the current or
14761 previous routers is passed on. Setting this option has a similar effect to the
14762 \unseen\ command qualifier in filter files.
14763
14764
14765 .conf user string$**$ "see below"
14766 .index uid (user id)||local delivery
14767 .index local transports||uid and gid
14768 .index transport||local
14769 .index router||user for filter processing
14770 .index filter||user for processing
14771 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
14772 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
14773 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
14774 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
14775 This user is also used by the \%redirect%\ router when running a filter file.
14776 The default is unset, except when \check@_local@_user\ is set. In this case,
14777 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
14778 a name, and \group\ is not set, the group associated with the user is used. See
14779 also \initgroups\ and \group\ and the discussion in chapter ~~CHAPenvironment.
14780
14781
14782 .conf verify "boolean (precondition)" true
14783 Setting this option has the effect of setting \verify@_sender\ and
14784 \verify@_recipient\ to the same value.
14785
14786 .conf verify@_only "boolean (precondition)" false
14787 .index \\EXPN\\||with \verify@_only\
14788 .index \-bv-\ option
14789 .index router||used only when verifying
14790 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
14791 testing with the \-bv-\ option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
14792 with the \-bt-\ option, or running the SMTP \\EXPN\\ command. It can be further
14793 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of \verify@_sender\
14794 and \verify@_recipient\.
14795
14796 \**Warning**\: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
14797 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
14798 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
14799 user or group.
14800
14801 .conf verify@_recipient "boolean (precondition)" true
14802 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
14803 addresses
14804 or testing recipient verification using \-bv-\.
14805 See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
14806 are evaluated.
14807
14808 .conf verify@_sender "boolean (precondition)" true
14809 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
14810 or testing sender verification using \-bvs-\.
14811 See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
14812 are evaluated.
14813
14814 .endconf
14815
14816
14817
14818
14819
14820 .
14821 .
14822 .
14823 .
14824 . ============================================================================
14825 .chapter The accept router
14826 .set runningfoot "accept router"
14827 .index \%accept%\ router
14828 .index routers||\%accept%\
14829 The \%accept%\ router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being used
14830 purely for verification (see \verify@_only\) a transport is required to be
14831 defined by the generic \transport\ option. If the preconditions that are
14832 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
14833 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
14834 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
14835 .display asis
14836 localusers:
14837 driver = accept
14838 domains = mydomain.example
14839 check_local_user
14840 transport = local_delivery
14841 .endd
14842 The \domains\ condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
14843 \check@_local@_user\ checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
14844 When both preconditions are met, the \%accept%\ router runs, and queues the
14845 address for the \%local@_delivery%\ transport.
14846
14847
14848
14849
14850
14851
14852 .
14853 .
14854 .
14855 .
14856 . ============================================================================
14857 .chapter The dnslookup router
14858 .rset CHAPdnslookup "~~chapter"
14859 .set runningfoot "dnslookup router"
14860 .index \%dnslookup%\ router
14861 .index routers||\%dnslookup%\
14862 The \%dnslookup%\ router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
14863 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
14864 unless \verify@_only\ is set.
14865
14866 If SRV support is configured (see \check@_srv\ below), Exim first searches for
14867 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
14868 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
14869 However, \mx@_domains\ can be set to disable the direct use of address records.
14870
14871 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
14872 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
14873 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
14874 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
14875 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the \ignore@_target@_hosts\
14876 generic option, the router declines.
14877
14878 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
14879 to the local host, or to any host name that matches \hosts__treat__as__local\,
14880 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
14881
14882 .index MX record||pointing to local host
14883 .index local host||MX pointing to
14884 .index \self\ option||in \%dnslookup%\ router
14885 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
14886 address record, is the local host, or matches \hosts__treat__as__local\, what
14887 happens is controlled by the generic \self\ option.
14888
14889 .em
14890 .section Problems with DNS lookups
14891 .rset SECTprowitdnsloo "~~chapter.~~section"
14892 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
14893 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
14894 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
14895 MX records. The global \dns@_again@_means@_nonexist\ option can help with this
14896 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
14897
14898 For this reason, there are two options, \srv@_fail@_domains\ and
14899 \mx@_fail@_domains\, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
14900 \%dnslookup%\ router results in a DNS failure or a `try again' response. If an
14901 attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
14902 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded `no
14903 such record'. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router proceeds
14904 to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to look for A
14905 or AAAA records, unless the domain matches \mx@_domains\, in which case routing
14906 fails.
14907 .nem
14908
14909
14910 .section Private options for dnslookup
14911 The private options for the \%dnslookup%\ router are as follows:
14912
14913
14914 .startconf dnslookup
14915
14916 .index options||\%dnslookup%\ router
14917 .conf check@_secondary@_mx boolean false
14918 .index MX record||checking for secondary
14919 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
14920 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
14921 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
14922 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
14923 the local host is described in section ~~SECTreclocipadd.
14924
14925 .conf check@_srv string$**$ unset
14926 .index SRV record||enabling use of
14927 The \%dnslookup%\ router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
14928 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
14929 enable SRV support, set the \check@_srv\ option to the name of the service
14930 required. For example,
14931 .display asis
14932 check_srv = smtp
14933 .endd
14934 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
14935 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
14936 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
14937 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the \check@_srv\
14938 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
14939 normal way.
14940
14941 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
14942 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
14943 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates `no such service for
14944 this domain'; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
14945 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
14946 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
14947
14948 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
14949 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
14950 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
14951 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
14952 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
14953 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
14954 have an additional `weight' feature which some people might find useful when
14955 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
14956
14957 .em
14958 See section ~~SECTprowitdnsloo above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour when
14959 there is a DNS lookup error.
14960 .nem
14961
14962 .conf mx@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
14963 .index MX record||required to exist
14964 .index SRV record||required to exist
14965 A domain that matches \mx@_domains\ is required to have either an MX or an SRV
14966 record in order to be recognised. (The name of this option could be improved.)
14967 For example, if all the mail hosts in \*fict.example*\ are known to have MX
14968 records, except for those in \*discworld.fict.example*\, you could use this
14969 setting:
14970 .display asis
14971 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
14972 .endd
14973 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
14974 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
14975 the address record.
14976
14977 .em
14978 .conf mx@_fail@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
14979 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
14980 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
14981 ~~SECTprowitdnsloo for more discussion.
14982 .nem
14983
14984
14985 .conf qualify@_single boolean true
14986 .index DNS||resolver options
14987 .index DNS||qualifying single-component names
14988 When this option is true, the resolver option \\RES@_DEFNAMES\\ is set for DNS
14989 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
14990 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
14991 called \*dictionary.ref.example*\, the domain \*thesaurus*\ would be changed to
14992 \*thesaurus.ref.example*\ inside the resolver. For details of what your resolver
14993 actually does, consult your man pages for \*resolver*\ and \*resolv.conf*\.
14994
14995
14996 .conf rewrite@_headers boolean true
14997 .index rewriting||header lines
14998 .index header lines||rewriting
14999 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
15000 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
15001 an address is specified as \*dormouse@@teaparty*\, the domain might be
15002 expanded to \*teaparty.wonderland.fict.example*\. Domain expansion can also
15003 occur as a result of setting the \widen@_domains\ option. If \rewrite@_headers\
15004 is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in any ::Bcc::, ::Cc::,
15005 ::From::, ::Reply-to::, ::Sender::, and ::To:: header lines of the message are
15006 rewritten with the full domain name.
15007
15008 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
15009 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
15010 sense.
15011
15012 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
15013 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
15014 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
15015 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
15016 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
15017 header rewriting.
15018
15019 .conf same@_domain@_copy@_routing boolean false
15020 .index address||copying routing
15021 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the \%dnslookup%\ router
15022 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
15023 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
15024 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
15025 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
15026 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
15027
15028 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
15029 domain, and you are using a \%dnslookup%\ router which is independent of the
15030 local part, you can set \same__domain__copy@_routing\ to bypass repeated DNS
15031 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when \%dnslookup%\
15032 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
15033 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
15034 without processing them independently,
15035 provided the following conditions are met:
15036 .numberpars $.
15037 No router that processed the address specified \headers@_add\ or
15038 \headers@_remove\.
15039 .nextp
15040 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by `widening'
15041 the domain.
15042 .endp
15043
15044
15045 .conf search@_parents boolean false
15046 .index DNS||resolver options
15047 When this option is true, the resolver option \\RES@_DNSRCH\\ is set for DNS
15048 lookups. This is different from the \qualify@_single\ option in that it applies
15049 to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes the
15050 resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent domains.
15051 For example, on a machine in the \*fict.example*\ domain, if looking up
15052 \*teaparty.wonderland*\ failed, the resolver would try
15053 \*teaparty.wonderland.fict.example*\. For details of what your resolver
15054 actually does, consult your man pages for \*resolver*\ and \*resolv.conf*\.
15055
15056 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
15057 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
15058 local wildcard.
15059
15060
15061 .em
15062 .conf srv@_fail@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
15063 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
15064 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
15065 ~~SECTprowitdnsloo for more discussion.
15066 .nem
15067
15068
15069 .conf widen@_domains "string list" unset
15070 .index domain||partial, widening
15071 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
15072 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
15073 if
15074 .display asis
15075 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
15076 .endd
15077 is set and a lookup of \*klingon.dictionary*\ fails,
15078 \*klingon.dictionary.fict.example*\ is looked up, and if this fails,
15079 \*klingon.dictionary.ref.example*\ is tried. Note that the \qualify@_single\
15080 and \search@_parents\ options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
15081 the DNS resolver.
15082
15083 .endconf
15084
15085 .section Effect of qualify@_single and search@_parents
15086 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
15087 of the \qualify@_single\ or \search@_parents\ options, Exim rewrites the
15088 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless \rewrite@_headers\
15089 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
15090
15091 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
15092 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
15093 such as that implied by
15094 .display asis
15095 domains = @mx_any
15096 .endd
15097 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
15098 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
15099
15100
15101
15102
15103
15104
15105
15106
15107
15108 .
15109 .
15110 .
15111 .
15112 . ============================================================================
15113 .chapter The ipliteral router
15114 .set runningfoot "ipliteral router"
15115 .index \%ipliteral%\ router
15116 .index domain literal||routing
15117 .index routers||\%ipliteral%\
15118 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
15119 verification (see \verify@_only\) a transport is required to be defined by the
15120 generic \transport\ option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
15121 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal, that is, an IP address enclosed
15122 in square brackets. For example, this router handles the address
15123 .display asis
15124 root@[192.168.1.1]
15125 .endd
15126 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address.
15127
15128 If the IP address matches something in \ignore@_target@_hosts\, the router
15129 declines.
15130 .index \self\ option||in \%ipliteral%\ router
15131 If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic \self\
15132 option determines what happens.
15133
15134 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
15135 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
15136 also set the main configuration option \allow@_domain@_literals\. Otherwise,
15137 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
15138
15139
15140
15141 .
15142 .
15143 .
15144 .
15145 . ============================================================================
15146 .chapter The iplookup router
15147 .set runningfoot "iplookup router"
15148 .index \%iplookup%\ router
15149 .index routers||\%iplookup%\
15150 The \%iplookup%\ router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
15151 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
15152 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
15153 must set
15154 .display asis
15155 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
15156 .endd
15157 in your \(Local/Makefile)\ configuration file.
15158
15159 The \%iplookup%\ router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
15160 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
15161 a different address -- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
15162 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers.
15163
15164
15165 If this process fails, the address can be passed on to
15166 other routers, or delivery can be deferred.
15167
15168 Background, for those that are interested: We have an Oracle database of all
15169 Cambridge users, and one of the items of data it maintains for each user is
15170 where to send mail addressed to \*user@@cam.ac.uk*\. The MX records for
15171 \*cam.ac.uk*\ point to a central machine that has a large alias list that is
15172 abstracted from the database. Mail from outside is switched by this system, and
15173 originally internal mail was also done this way. However, this resulted in a
15174 fair number of messages travelling from some of our larger systems to the
15175 switch and back again. The Oracle machine now runs a UDP service that can be
15176 called by the \%iplookup%\ router in Exim to find out where \*user@@cam.ac.uk*\
15177 addresses really have to go; this saves passing through the central switch, and
15178 in many cases saves doing any remote delivery at all.
15179
15180 Since \%iplookup%\ is just a rewriting router, a transport must not be
15181 specified for it.
15182
15183 .startconf iplookup
15184 .index options||\%iplookup%\ router
15185
15186 .conf hosts string unset
15187 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
15188 names. The hosts are looked up using \*gethostbyname()*\
15189 (or \*getipnodebyname()*\ when available)
15190 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
15191 happens is controlled by \optional\.
15192
15193 .conf optional boolean false
15194 If \optional\ is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address is
15195 passed to the next router, overriding \no@_more\. If \optional\ is false,
15196 delivery to the address is deferred.
15197
15198 .conf port integer 0
15199 .index port||\%iplookup%\ router
15200 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
15201 call.
15202
15203 .conf protocol string "udp"
15204 This option can be set to `udp' or `tcp' to specify which of the two protocols
15205 is to be used.
15206
15207 .conf query string$**$ "$tt{@$local@_part@@@$domain @$local@_part@@@$domain}"
15208 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
15209 repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct query
15210 in the default case (see \response@_pattern\ below).
15211
15212 .conf reroute string$**$ unset
15213 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
15214 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
15215 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
15216 in the response by \response@_pattern\ by means of numeric variables such as
15217 \$1$\, \$2$\, etc. The variable \$0$\ refers to the entire input string,
15218 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
15219 up in the form \*local@_part@@domain*\.
15220
15221 .conf response@_pattern string unset
15222 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
15223 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
15224 router declines. If \response@_pattern\ is not set, no checking of the response
15225 is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a check that
15226 the text returned after the first white space is the original address. This
15227 checks that the answer that has been received is in response to the correct
15228 question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the following
15229 could be used:
15230 .display asis
15231 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
15232 reroute = $local_part@$1
15233 .endd
15234
15235 .conf timeout time 5s
15236 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
15237 machine. The same timeout is used for the \*connect()*\ function for a TCP
15238 call. It does not apply to UDP.
15239
15240 .endconf
15241
15242
15243
15244
15245 .
15246 .
15247 .
15248 .
15249 . ============================================================================
15250 .chapter The manualroute router
15251 .set runningfoot "manualroute router"
15252 .index \%manualroute%\ router
15253 .index routers||\%manualroute%\
15254 .index domain||manually routing
15255 The \%manualroute%\ router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
15256 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
15257 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
15258 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, \%manualroute%\ can also
15259 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
15260 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
15261
15262 The \%manualroute%\ router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain it
15263 is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern has
15264 associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
15265 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
15266 `routing rule'. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
15267 generic \transport\ option must specify a transport, unless the router is being
15268 used purely for verification (see \verify@_only\).
15269
15270 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
15271 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
15272 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
15273 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
15274 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
15275 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
15276 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in \$host$\ as a single
15277 text string.
15278
15279 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in \route@_list\,
15280 or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file or database by
15281 setting \route@_data\. Only one of these settings may appear in any one
15282 instance of \%manualroute%\. The format of routing rules is described below,
15283 following the list of private options.
15284
15285 .section Private options for manualroute
15286 .rset SECTprioptman "~~chapter.~~section"
15287
15288 The private options for the \%manualroute%\ router are as follows:
15289
15290 .startconf manualroute
15291 .index options||\%manualroute%\ router
15292
15293 .conf host@_find@_failed string "freeze"
15294 This option controls what happens when \%manualroute%\ tries to find an IP
15295 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
15296 of
15297 .display asis
15298 decline
15299 defer
15300 fail
15301 freeze
15302 pass
15303 .endd
15304 The default assumes that this state is a serious configuration error. The
15305 difference between `pass' and `decline' is that the former forces the address
15306 to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by \pass@_router\),
15307 .index \more\ option
15308 overriding \no@_more\, whereas the latter passes the address to the next router
15309 only if \more\ is true.
15310
15311 This option applies only to a definite `does not exist' state; if a host lookup
15312 gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the generic
15313 \pass@_on@_timeout\ option is set.
15314
15315 .conf hosts@_randomize boolean false
15316 .index randomized host list
15317 .index host||list of, randomized
15318 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
15319 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
15320 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
15321 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
15322 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
15323 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
15324 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
15325
15326 When \hosts@_randomize\ is true, a host list may be split
15327 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
15328 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
15329 item that is just \"+"\ in the host list. For example:
15330 .display asis
15331 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
15332 .endd
15333 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
15334 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
15335 If \hosts@_randomize\ is not set, a \"+"\ item in the list is ignored. If a
15336 randomized host list is passed to an \%smtp%\ transport that also has
15337 \hosts@_randomize set\, the list is not re-randomized.
15338
15339 .conf route@_data string$**$ unset
15340 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
15341 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
15342 example:
15343 .display asis
15344 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
15345 .endd
15346 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
15347 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
15348 deferred.
15349
15350 .conf route@_list "string list, semicolon-separated" unset
15351 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
15352 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
15353 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
15354
15355 .conf same@_domain@_copy@_routing boolean false
15356 .index address||copying routing
15357 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the \%manualroute%\ router
15358 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
15359 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
15360 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
15361 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
15362 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
15363
15364 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
15365 domain, and you are using a \%manualroute%\ router which is independent of the
15366 local part, you can set \same@_domain@_copy@_routing\ to bypass repeated DNS
15367 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when \%manualroute%\
15368 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
15369 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
15370 without processing them independently. However, this is only done if
15371 \headers@_add\ and \headers@_remove\ are unset.
15372
15373 .endconf
15374
15375
15376 .section Routing rules in route@_list
15377 The value of \route@_list\ is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
15378 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
15379 entered as two semicolons. Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
15380 .display
15381 <<domain pattern>> <<list of hosts>> <<options>>
15382 .endd
15383 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
15384 no options:
15385 .display asis
15386 route_list = \
15387 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
15388 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
15389 .endd
15390 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
15391 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
15392 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a \route@_list\ must start with a
15393 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
15394 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
15395 ~~SECTdomainlist),
15396 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
15397 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
15398 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
15399 in a \route@_list\).
15400
15401 The rules in \route@_list\ are searched in order until one of the patterns
15402 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
15403 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
15404 \route@_list\ is set, \route@_data\ must not be set.
15405
15406
15407 .section Routing rules in route@_data
15408 The use of \route@_list\ is convenient when there are only a small number of
15409 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
15410 hold the routing information, and use the \route@_data\ option instead.
15411 The value of \route@_data\ is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
15412 Most commonly, \route@_data\ is set as a string that contains an
15413 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
15414 like this:
15415 .display asis
15416 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
15417 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
15418 .endd
15419 This data can be accessed by setting
15420 .display asis
15421 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
15422 .endd
15423 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
15424 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in \route@_data\. The only
15425 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
15426 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
15427 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
15428
15429
15430
15431 .section Format of the list of hosts
15432 A list of hosts, whether obtained via \route@_data\ or \route@_list\, is always
15433 separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router declines.
15434 The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names and/or
15435 IP addresses. IP addresses are not enclosed in brackets.
15436
15437 If the list of hosts was obtained from a \route@_list\ item, the following
15438 variables are set during its expansion:
15439 .index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in \%manualroute%\ router
15440 .numberpars $.
15441 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
15442 \$1$\, \$2$\, etc. may be set.
15443 .nextp
15444 \$0$\ is always set to the entire domain.
15445 .nextp
15446 \$1$\ is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
15447 .nextp
15448 .index \$value$\
15449 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
15450 looked up is available in the expansion variable \$value$\.
15451 .endp
15452
15453
15454 .section How the list of hosts is used
15455 When an address is routed to an \%smtp%\ transport by \%manualroute%\, each of
15456 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
15457 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the \hosts@_randomize\
15458 option, either on the router (see section ~~SECTprioptman above), or on the
15459 transport.
15460
15461 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
15462 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by \"/MX"\ is
15463 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
15464 records in the DNS. For example:
15465 .display asis
15466 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
15467 .endd
15468 If the \hosts@_randomize\ option is set, the order of the items in the list is
15469 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
15470 that is not followed by \"/MX"\ it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
15471 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
15472 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
15473 happens is controlled by the
15474 .index \self\ option||in \%manualroute%\ router
15475 \self\ option of the router.
15476
15477 A name on the list that is followed by \"/MX"\ is replaced with the list of
15478 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
15479 lookup; the \bydns\ and \byname\ options (see section ~~SECThowoptused below)
15480 are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the preference
15481 values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because randomizing
15482 happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is defined by
15483 MX preferences.
15484
15485 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
15486 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
15487 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
15488
15489 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
15490 depends on where in the original list of hosts the \"/MX"\ item appears. If it
15491 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
15492 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
15493
15494 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
15495 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the \self\ option of the
15496 router.
15497
15498 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
15499 failures when looking up IP addresses: \pass@_on@_timeout\ and
15500 \host@_find@_failed\ are used when relevant.
15501
15502 The generic \ignore@_target@_hosts\ option applies to all hosts in the list,
15503 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
15504
15505
15506 .section How the options are used
15507 .rset SECThowoptused "~~chapter.~~section"
15508 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
15509 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
15510 \transport\ option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
15511 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
15512 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
15513 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
15514 .numberpars $.
15515 \randomize\: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
15516 setting of \hosts@_randomize\ for this routing rule only.
15517 .nextp
15518 \no@_randomize\: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
15519 overriding the setting of \hosts@_randomize\ for this routing rule only.
15520 .nextp
15521 \byname\: use \*getipnodebyname()*\ (\*gethostbyname()*\ on older systems) to
15522 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
15523 also look in \(/etc/hosts)\ or other sources of information.
15524 .nextp
15525 \bydns\: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
15526 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
15527 timeout), delivery is deferred.
15528 .endp
15529 For example:
15530 .display asis
15531 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
15532 domain2 host4:host5
15533 .endd
15534 If neither \byname\ nor \bydns\ is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a DNS
15535 lookup is done. If this yields anything other than \\HOST@_NOT@_FOUND\\, that
15536 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to \*getipnodebyname()*\
15537 or \*gethostbyname()*\, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
15538 call.
15539
15540 \**Warning**\: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
15541 called via \*getipnodebyname()*\ times out, \\HOST@_NOT@_FOUND\\ is returned
15542 instead of \\TRY@_AGAIN\\. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
15543 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite `no such host' is the local
15544 function called.
15545
15546
15547
15548 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
15549 \host@_find@_failed\ option.
15550
15551 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
15552 The host list is passed to the transport in the \$host$\ variable.
15553
15554
15555 .section Manualroute examples
15556 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the \remote@_smtp\
15557 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
15558
15559 .numberpars $.
15560 .index smart host||example router
15561 The \%manualroute%\ router can be used to forward all external mail to a
15562 \*smart host*\. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
15563 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example,
15564 .display asis
15565 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
15566 .endd
15567 you can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
15568 your first router something like this:
15569 .display asis
15570 smart_route:
15571 driver = manualroute
15572 domains = !+local_domains
15573 transport = remote_smtp
15574 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
15575 .endd
15576 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
15577 \*smarthost.ref.example*\. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
15578 they are tried in order
15579 (but you can use \hosts@_randomize\ to vary the order each time).
15580 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
15581 .display asis
15582 smart_route:
15583 driver = manualroute
15584 transport = remote_smtp
15585 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
15586 .endd
15587 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
15588 However, they behave differently if \no@_more\ is added to them. In the first
15589 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the \domains\
15590 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
15591 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, \no@_more\ would
15592 have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it always
15593 runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
15594 \no@_more\ would prevent subsequent routers from running.
15595
15596 .nextp
15597 .index mail hub example
15598 A \*mail hub*\ is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
15599 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
15600 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
15601 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
15602 \%manualroute%\ router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
15603 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
15604 using the \route@_list\ option, but for a larger number a file or database
15605 lookup is easier to manage.
15606
15607 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
15608 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
15609 example,
15610 .display asis
15611 hub_route:
15612 driver = manualroute
15613 transport = remote_smtp
15614 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
15615 .endd
15616 This configuration routes domains that match \"*.rhodes.tvs.example"\ to hosts
15617 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
15618 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
15619 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
15620 domain can be used to find the host:
15621 .display asis
15622 through_firewall:
15623 driver = manualroute
15624 transport = remote_smtp
15625 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
15626 .endd
15627 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
15628 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
15629 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
15630 next router.
15631
15632 .nextp
15633 .index batched SMTP output example
15634 .index SMTP||batched outgoing, example
15635 You can use \%manualroute%\ to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
15636 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
15637 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
15638 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
15639 .display asis
15640 save_in_file:
15641 driver = manualroute
15642 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
15643 route_list = saved.domain.example
15644 .endd
15645 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
15646 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
15647 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
15648 .display asis
15649 save_in_file:
15650 driver = manualroute
15651 route_list = \
15652 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
15653 *.saved.domain2.example \
15654 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
15655 batch_pipe
15656 .endd
15657 The first of these just passes the domain in the \$host$\ variable, which
15658 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in \$domain$\), but the second does a
15659 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
15660 the address if the lookup fails.
15661 .nextp
15662 .index UUCP||example of router for
15663 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
15664 \%manualroute%\ in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
15665 one way it can be done:
15666 .display asis
15667 # Transport
15668 uucp:
15669 driver = pipe
15670 user = nobody
15671 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
15672 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
15673 return_fail_output = true
15674 .endd
15675 .display asis
15676 # Router
15677 uucphost:
15678 transport = uucp
15679 driver = manualroute
15680 route_data = \
15681 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
15682 .endd
15683 The file \(/usr/local/exim/uucphosts)\ contains entries like
15684 .display asis
15685 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
15686 .endd
15687 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing `.UUCP' but this way
15688 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
15689 \*darksite.ethereal.example*\ and the UUCP host name \*darksite*\.
15690 .endp
15691
15692
15693
15694
15695
15696
15697 .
15698 .
15699 .
15700 .
15701 . ============================================================================
15702 .chapter The queryprogram router
15703 .set runningfoot "queryprogram router"
15704 .rset CHAPdriverlast "~~chapter"
15705 .index \%queryprogram%\ router
15706 .index routers||\%queryprogram%\
15707 .index routing||by external program
15708 The \%queryprogram%\ router routes an address by running an external command and
15709 acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended mainly
15710 for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments. However, if
15711 it is possible to use the precondition options (\domains\, \local@_parts\,
15712 etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly be used in
15713 special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private options:
15714
15715 .startconf queryprogram
15716 .index options||\%queryprogram%\ router
15717 .conf command string$**$ unset
15718 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
15719 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
15720 expanded separately (exactly as for a \%pipe%\ transport, described in chapter
15721 ~~CHAPpipetransport).
15722
15723 .conf command@_group string unset
15724 .index gid (group id)||in \%queryprogram%\ router
15725 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command. It must be set
15726 if \command@_user\ specifies a numerical uid. If it begins with a digit, it is
15727 interpreted as the numerical value of the gid. Otherwise it is looked up using
15728 \*getgrnam()*\.
15729
15730 .conf command@_user string unset
15731 .index uid (user id)||for \%queryprogram%\
15732 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
15733 command. If it begins with a digit it is interpreted as the numerical value of
15734 the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up using \*getpwnam()*\ to obtain a value for
15735 the uid and, if \command@_group\ is not set, a value for the gid also.
15736
15737 .conf current@_directory string /
15738 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
15739 before running the command.
15740
15741 .conf timeout time 1h
15742 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
15743 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
15744 timeout.
15745
15746 .endconf
15747
15748 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
15749 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
15750 containing up to five fields, separated by white space.
15751 .em
15752 The maximum length of the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently
15753 truncated.
15754 .nem
15755 The first field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
15756 .numberpars $.
15757 \*Accept*\: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
15758 below).
15759 .nextp
15760 \*Decline*\: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
15761 \no@_more\ is set.
15762 .nextp
15763 \*Fail*\: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
15764 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
15765 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
15766 included in the SMTP response.
15767 .nextp
15768 \*Defer*\: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
15769 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
15770 included in any SMTP response.
15771 .nextp
15772 \*Freeze*\: the same as \*defer*\, except that the message is frozen.
15773 .nextp
15774 \*Pass*\: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
15775 \pass@_router\), overriding \no@_more\.
15776 .nextp
15777 \*Redirect*\: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
15778 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
15779 or the router specified by \redirect@_router\, if set.
15780 .endp
15781 When the first word is \*accept*\, the remainder of the line consists of a
15782 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
15783 the page):
15784 .display
15785 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<<transport>> HOSTS=<<list of hosts>>
15786 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<<text>>
15787 .endd
15788 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
15789 is included, the transport specified by the generic \transport\ option is used.
15790 The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is an
15791 \%smtp%\ transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
15792
15793 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the \%manualroute%\ router.
15794 As well as host names and IP addresses, it may contain names followed by
15795 \"/MX"\ to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX
15796 records.
15797
15798 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
15799 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
15800 anything other than \\HOST@_NOT@_FOUND\\, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
15801 goes on to try a call to \*getipnodebyname()*\ or \*gethostbyname()*\, and the
15802 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
15803
15804 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the \$address@_data$\
15805 variable. For example, this return line
15806 .display asis
15807 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
15808 .endd
15809 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
15810 the transport runs, the string `rule1' is in \$address@_data$\.
15811
15812
15813
15814 .
15815 .
15816 .
15817 .
15818 . ============================================================================
15819 .chapter The redirect router
15820 .set runningfoot "redirect router"
15821 .rset CHAPredirect "~~chapter"
15822 .index \%redirect%\ router
15823 .index routers||\%redirect%\
15824 .index alias file||in a \%redirect%\ router
15825 .index address redirection||\%redirect%\ router
15826 The \%redirect%\ router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
15827 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
15828 (usually called \(/etc/aliases)\) and for handling users' personal \(.forward)\
15829 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
15830 redirected in several different ways:
15831 .numberpars $.
15832 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
15833 independently.
15834 .nextp
15835 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
15836 .nextp
15837 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
15838 .nextp
15839 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
15840 .nextp
15841 It can be forced to fail, with a custom error message.
15842 .nextp
15843 It can be temporarily deferred.
15844 .nextp
15845 It can be discarded.
15846 .endp
15847 The generic \transport\ option must not be set for \%redirect%\ routers.
15848 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
15849 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the \file@_transport\,
15850 \pipe@_transport\ and \reply@_transport\ descriptions below.
15851
15852
15853 .section Redirection data
15854 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
15855 expanding the contents of the \data\ option, or by reading the entire contents
15856 of a file whose name is given in the \file\ option. These two options are
15857 mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system aliases, in
15858 a configuration like this:
15859 .display asis
15860 system_aliases:
15861 driver = redirect
15862 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
15863 .endd
15864 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
15865 expansion of \data\ results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
15866 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
15867 cause delivery to be deferred.
15868
15869 A configuration using \file\ is commonly used for handling users' \(.forward)\
15870 files, like this:
15871 .display asis
15872 userforward:
15873 driver = redirect
15874 check_local_user
15875 file = $home/.forward
15876 no_verify
15877 .endd
15878 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
15879 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. \**Warning**\: This
15880 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
15881 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
15882 comments.
15883
15884
15885 .section Forward files and address verification
15886 .index address redirection||while verifying
15887 It is usual to set \no@_verify\ on \%redirect%\ routers which handle users'
15888 \(.forward)\ files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
15889 .numberpars $.
15890 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
15891 running under the Exim uid, not as root.
15892 No additional groups are set up, even if the Exim uid is a member of other
15893 groups (that is, the \*initgroups()*\ function is not run).
15894 Exim is unable to change uid to read the file as the user, and it may not be
15895 able to read it as the Exim user. So in practice the router may not be able to
15896 operate.
15897 .nextp
15898 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a \(.forward)\ file
15899 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
15900 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
15901 saves some resources.
15902 .endp
15903
15904
15905
15906
15907 .section Interpreting redirection data
15908 .index Sieve filter||specifying in redirection data
15909 .index filter||specifying in redirection data
15910 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from \data\ or \file\, can be
15911 interpreted in two different ways:
15912 .numberpars $.
15913 If the \allow@_filter\ option is set true, and the data begins with the text
15914 `@#Exim filter' or `@#Sieve filter', it is interpreted as a list of
15915 \*filtering*\ instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
15916 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
15917 in a separate document entitled \*Exim's interfaces to mail filtering*\; this
15918 document is intended for use by end users.
15919 .nextp
15920 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
15921 described in the next section.
15922 .endp
15923 When a message is redirected to a file (a `mail folder'), the file name given
15924 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
15925 generate a relative path -- how this is handled depends on the transport's
15926 configuration. See section ~~SECTfildiropt for a discussion of this issue for
15927 the \%appendfile%\ transport.
15928
15929
15930 .section Items in a non-filter redirection list
15931 .rset SECTitenonfilred "~~chapter.~~section"
15932 .index address redirection||non-filter list items
15933 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
15934 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
15935 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
15936 ~~SECTspecitredli below). The special items can be individually enabled or
15937 disabled by means of options whose names begin with \allow@_\ or \forbid@_\,
15938 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
15939 commas or newlines.
15940 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
15941 quotes.
15942
15943 Lines starting with a @# character are comments, and are ignored, and @# may
15944 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the @# and the
15945 next newline character is ignored.
15946
15947 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
15948 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
15949 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description, `item'
15950 refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been removed.
15951
15952 \**Warning**\: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
15953 and the expansion contains a reference to \$local@_part$\, you should make use
15954 of the \quote\ expansion operator, in case the local part contains special
15955 characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
15956 \*obsolete.example*\, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
15957 setting:
15958 .display asis
15959 data = ${quote:$local_part}@newdomain.example
15960 .endd
15961
15962
15963 .section Redirecting to a local mailbox
15964 .rset SECTredlocmai "~~chapter.~~section"
15965 .index routing||loops in
15966 .index loop||while routing, avoidance of
15967 .index address redirection||to local mailbox
15968 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
15969 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
15970 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
15971 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
15972 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
15973 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
15974 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
15975
15976 .index address redirection||local part without domain
15977 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
15978 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
15979 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
15980 \*cleo*\ might have a \(.forward)\ file containing this:
15981 .display asis
15982 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
15983 .endd
15984 .index backslash in alias file
15985 .index alias file||backslash in
15986 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
15987 preceeded by `@\', but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
15988 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
15989 synonymously.
15990
15991 If an item begins with `@\' and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC 2822
15992 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the domain
15993 of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading `@\', unqualified
15994 addresses are qualified using the value in \qualify@_recipient\, but you can
15995 force the incoming domain to be used by setting \qualify__preserve@_domain\.
15996
15997 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
15998 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
15999 contains:
16000 .display asis
16001 Sam.Reman: spqr
16002 .endd
16003 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is \*spqr*\) wants to save copies of
16004 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
16005 this forward file:
16006 .display asis
16007 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
16008 .endd
16009 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to \*Sam.Reman*\ fails. The
16010 \%redirect%\ router for system aliases does not process \*Sam.Reman*\ the
16011 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
16012 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
16013 should really contain
16014 .display asis
16015 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
16016 .endd
16017 but because this is such a common error, the \check@_ancestor\ option (see
16018 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
16019 \%redirect%\ router that is handling users' \(.forward)\ files.
16020
16021
16022 .section Special items in redirection lists
16023 .rset SECTspecitredli "~~chapter.~~section"
16024 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
16025 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
16026
16027 .numberpars $.
16028 .index pipe||in redirection list
16029 .index address redirection||to pipe
16030 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with `|' and does not parse
16031 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
16032 command must be specified by the \pipe@_transport\ option.
16033 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
16034 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
16035
16036 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
16037 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
16038 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
16039 in double quotes, for example:
16040 .display asis
16041 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
16042 .endd
16043 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
16044 quote just the command. An item such as
16045 .display asis
16046 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
16047 .endd
16048 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
16049 .nextp
16050 .index file||in redirection list
16051 .index address redirection||to file
16052 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with `/' and does not parse
16053 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
16054 .display asis
16055 /home/world/minbari
16056 .endd
16057 is treated as a file name, but
16058 .display asis
16059 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
16060 .endd
16061 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
16062 the \file@_transport\ option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
16063 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
16064 file name, and \directory@_transport\ is used instead.
16065
16066 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
16067 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
16068 .index \(/dev/null)\
16069 However, if a redirection item is the path \(/dev/null)\, delivery to it is
16070 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows `$*$$*$bypassed$*$$*$'
16071 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
16072 .nextp
16073 .index included address list
16074 .index address redirection||included external list
16075 If an item is of the form
16076 .display
16077 :include:<<path name>>
16078 .endd
16079 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
16080 point.
16081 \**Note**\: such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an out-of-line
16082 addition to the list.
16083 The items in the included list are separated by commas or newlines and are not
16084 subject to expansion. If this is the first item in an alias list in an
16085 \%lsearch%\ file, a colon must be used to terminate the alias name. This
16086 example is incorrect:
16087 .display asis
16088 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
16089 .endd
16090 It must be given as
16091 .display asis
16092 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
16093 .endd
16094 .nextp
16095 .index address redirection||to black hole
16096 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
16097 \data\ option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes the
16098 router to decline. Instead, the alias item
16099 .index black hole
16100 .index abandoning mail
16101 .display
16102 :blackhole:
16103 .endd
16104 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is done, and no error
16105 message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing \(/dev/null)\, but
16106 can be independently disabled.
16107
16108 \**Warning**\: If \":blackhole:"\ appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
16109 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
16110 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
16111 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
16112 \(/dev/null)\.
16113
16114 .nextp
16115 .index delivery||forcing failure
16116 .index delivery||forcing deferral
16117 .index failing delivery||forcing
16118 .index deferred delivery, forcing
16119 .index customizing||failure message
16120 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
16121 redirection items of the form
16122 .display
16123 :defer:
16124 $rm{or}
16125 :fail:
16126 .endd
16127 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies to the
16128 entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored (:::blackhole:: is
16129 different). Any text following :::fail:: or :::defer:: is placed in the error
16130 text associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
16131 .display asis
16132 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
16133 .endd
16134 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
16135 of a
16136 .index \\VRFY\\||error text, display of
16137 \\VRFY\\ command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
16138 default.
16139 .em
16140 .index \\EXPN\\||error text, display of
16141 The text is not included in the response to an \\EXPN\\ command.
16142 .nem
16143
16144 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
16145 default message is available in the variable \$acl@_verify@_message$\ and can
16146 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired. Exim sends a 451
16147 SMTP code for a :::defer::, and 550 for :::fail::. In non-SMTP cases the text
16148 is included in the error message that Exim generates.
16149
16150
16151
16152 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list -- a comma does not
16153 terminate it -- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
16154 normally present in alias expansions. In \%lsearch%\ lookups they are removed as
16155 part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of lookup
16156 and in :::include:: files.
16157
16158 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
16159 containing :::fail:: causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
16160 whereas :::defer:: causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
16161 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
16162 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
16163 rules still apply.
16164 .nextp
16165 .index alias file||exception to default
16166 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
16167 chapter ~~CHAPfdlookup) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need for
16168 exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
16169 .display asis
16170 :unknown:
16171 .endd
16172 This differs from :::fail:: in that it causes the \%redirect%\ router to decline,
16173 whereas :::fail:: forces routing to fail. A lookup which results in an empty
16174 redirection list has the same effect.
16175 .endp
16176
16177 .section Duplicate addresses
16178 .index duplicate addresses
16179 .index address||duplicate, discarding
16180 .index pipe||duplicated
16181 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
16182 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
16183 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
16184 aliasing scheme of the type
16185 .display asis
16186 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
16187 localpart1: pipe
16188 localpart2: pipe
16189 .endd
16190 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
16191 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part `pipe' it gets
16192 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
16193 such as
16194 .display asis
16195 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
16196 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
16197 .endd
16198 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
16199 the pipes are distinct.
16200
16201
16202 .section Repeated redirection expansion
16203 .index repeated redirection expansion
16204 .index address redirection||repeated for each delivery attempt
16205 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
16206 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
16207 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
16208 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
16209 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The \one@_time\ option
16210 can be used to avoid this.
16211
16212 .section Errors in redirection lists
16213 .index address redirection||errors
16214 If \skip@_syntax@_errors\ is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
16215 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
16216 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
16217 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
16218 deferred. See also \syntax@_errors@_to\.
16219
16220
16221 .section Private options for the redirect router
16222
16223 The private options for the \%redirect%\ router are as follows:
16224
16225 .startconf redirect
16226 .index options||\%redirect%\ router
16227
16228 .conf allow@_defer boolean false
16229 Setting this option allows the use of :::defer:: in non-filter redirection
16230 data,
16231 or the \defer\ command in an Exim filter file.
16232
16233 .conf allow@_fail boolean false
16234 .index failing delivery||from filter
16235 If this option is true, the :::fail:: item can be used in a redirection list,
16236 and the \fail\ command may be used in a filter file.
16237
16238 .conf allow@_filter boolean false
16239 .index filter||enabling use of
16240 .index Sieve filter||enabling use of
16241 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
16242 `@#Exim filter' or `@#Sieve filter' as a set of filtering instructions. There
16243 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
16244 lock out; see the \forbid@_filter@_xxx\ options below.
16245 .em
16246 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
16247 the other type; see \forbid@_exim@_filter\ and \forbid@_sieve@_filter\.
16248 .nem
16249
16250 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic \user\ and \group\
16251 options. These take their defaults from the password data if
16252 \check@_local@_user\ is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
16253 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When \allow@_filter\ is set
16254 true, Exim insists that either \check@_local@_user\ or \user\ is set.
16255
16256
16257 .conf allow@_freeze boolean false
16258 .index freezing messages||allowing in filter
16259 Setting this option allows the use of the \freeze\ command in an Exim filter.
16260 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
16261 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
16262 let ordinary users do.
16263
16264
16265 .conf check@_ancestor boolean false
16266 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
16267 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
16268 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
16269 configuration file for handling users' \(.forward)\ files. It is recommended
16270 for this use of the \%redirect%\ router.
16271
16272 When \check@_ancestor\ is set, if a generated address (including the domain) is
16273 the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
16274 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
16275 and B has a \(.forward)\ file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
16276 domain, the local part `Joe.Bloggs' is aliased to `jb' and \(@~jb/.forward)\
16277 contains:
16278 .display
16279 @\Joe.Bloggs, <<other item(s)>>
16280 .endd
16281 Without the \check@_ancestor\ setting, either local part (`jb' or `joe.bloggs')
16282 gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was originally. If `jb'
16283 is the real mailbox name, mail to `jb' gets delivered (having been turned into
16284 `joe.bloggs' by the \(.forward)\ file and back to `jb' by the alias), but mail
16285 to `joe.bloggs' fails. Setting \check@_ancestor\ on the \%redirect%\ router that
16286 handles the \(.forward)\ file prevents it from turning `jb' back into
16287 `joe.bloggs' when that was the original address. See also the \repeat@_use\
16288 option below.
16289
16290 .conf check@_group boolean "see below"
16291 When the \file\ option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
16292 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
16293 \owngroups\ option, together with the user's default group if
16294 \check@_local@_user\ is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
16295 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if \check@_local@_user\
16296 is set and the \modemask\ option permits the group write bit, or if the
16297 \owngroups\ option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
16298
16299
16300 .conf check@_owner boolean "see below"
16301 When the \file\ option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when this
16302 option is set. If \check@_local@_user\ is set, the local user is permitted;
16303 otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the \owners\ option. The
16304 default value for this option is true if \check@_local@_user\ or \owners\ is
16305 set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
16306
16307 .conf data string$**$ unset
16308 This option is mutually exclusive with \file\. One or other of them must be
16309 set, but not both. The contents of \data\ are expanded, and then used as the
16310 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
16311 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
16312 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
16313
16314 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with `@#Exim
16315 filter', and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
16316 terminated with newline characters. For example:
16317 .display asis
16318 data = #Exim filter\n\
16319 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
16320 .endd
16321 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
16322 you can use the \$@{sg@}$\ expansion item to turn the escape string of your
16323 choice into a newline.
16324
16325 .conf directory@_transport string$**$ unset
16326 A \%redirect%\ router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
16327 ending with a slash is specified as a new `address'. The transport used is
16328 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
16329 configured transport. This should normally be an \%appendfile%\ transport.
16330
16331 .conf file string$**$ unset
16332 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
16333 is mutually exclusive with the \data\ option. The string is expanded before
16334 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
16335 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
16336 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
16337 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
16338 entirely of comments), the router declines.
16339
16340 .index NFS||checking for file existence
16341 If the attempt to open the file fails with a `does not exist' error, Exim
16342 runs a check on the containing directory,
16343 unless \ignore@_enotdir\ is true (see below).
16344 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
16345 happen when users' \(.forward)\ files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
16346 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
16347 not, the router declines.
16348
16349 .conf file@_transport string$**$ unset
16350 A \%redirect%\ router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
16351 ending in a slash is specified as a new `address'. The transport used is
16352 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
16353 configured transport.
16354 This should normally be an \%appendfile%\ transport.
16355 When it is running, the file name is in \$address@_file$\.
16356
16357 .conf forbid@_blackhole boolean false
16358 If this option is true, the :::blackhole:: item may not appear in a redirection
16359 list.
16360
16361 .em
16362 .conf forbid@_exim@_filter boolean false
16363 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
16364 \allow@_filter\ is true.
16365 .nem
16366
16367
16368 .conf forbid@_file boolean false
16369 .index delivery||to file, forbidding
16370 .index Sieve filter||forbidding delivery to a file
16371 .index Sieve filter||`keep' facility, disabling
16372 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
16373 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
16374 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if \one@_time\ is
16375 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
16376 locks out the Sieve's `keep' facility.
16377
16378 .conf forbid@_filter@_existstest boolean false
16379 .index filter||locking out certain features
16380 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
16381 make use of the \exists\ condition.
16382
16383 .conf forbid@_filter@_logwrite boolean false
16384 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
16385 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
16386 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
16387 \(.forward)\ files).
16388
16389 .conf forbid@_filter@_lookup boolean false
16390 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
16391 to make use of \lookup\ items.
16392
16393 .conf forbid@_filter@_perl boolean false
16394 This option is available only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
16395 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
16396 of the embedded Perl support.
16397
16398 .conf forbid@_filter@_readfile boolean false
16399 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
16400 to make use of \readfile\ items.
16401
16402 .conf forbid@_filter@_readsocket boolean false
16403 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
16404 to make use of \readsocket\ items.
16405
16406 .conf forbid@_filter@_reply boolean false
16407 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
16408 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim
16409 .em
16410 or Sieve filter files, not from traditional forward files.
16411 .nem
16412 This option is forced to be true if \one@_time\ is set.
16413
16414 .conf forbid@_filter@_run boolean false
16415 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
16416 to make use of \run\ items.
16417
16418 .conf forbid@_include boolean false
16419 If this option is true, items of the form
16420 .display
16421 :include:<<path name>>
16422 .endd
16423 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
16424
16425 .conf forbid@_pipe boolean false
16426 .index delivery||to pipe, forbidding
16427 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
16428 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
16429 forward file. This option is forced to be true if \one@_time\ is set.
16430
16431 .em
16432 .conf forbid@_sieve@_filter boolean false
16433 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
16434 \allow@_filter\ is true.
16435 .nem
16436
16437
16438 .conf hide@_child@_in@_errmsg boolean false
16439 .index bounce message||redirection details, suppressing
16440 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
16441 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says `an address
16442 generated from <<the top level address>>'. Of course, this applies only to
16443 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, $it{its}
16444 bounce may well quote the generated address.
16445
16446 .conf ignore@_eacces boolean false
16447 .index \\EACCES\\
16448 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
16449 \\EACCES\\ error (permission denied), the \%redirect%\ router behaves as if the
16450 file did not exist.
16451
16452 .conf ignore@_enotdir boolean false
16453 .index \\ENOTDIR\\
16454 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
16455 \\ENOTDIR\\ error (something on the path is not a directory), the \%redirect%\
16456 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
16457
16458 Setting \ignore@_enotdir\ has another effect as well: When a \%redirect%\
16459 router that has the \file\ option set discovers that the file does not exist
16460 (the \\ENOENT\\ error), it tries to \*stat()*\ the parent directory, as a check
16461 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
16462 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when \ignore@_enotdir\ is
16463 set, because that option tells Exim to ignore `something on the path is not a
16464 directory' (the \\ENOTDIR\\ error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
16465 that some operating systems give \\ENOENT\\ where others give \\ENOTDIR\\.
16466
16467
16468 .conf include@_directory string unset
16469 If this option is set, the path names of any :::include:: items in a redirection
16470 list must start with this directory.
16471
16472 .conf modemask "octal integer" 022
16473 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
16474 \file\ option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
16475
16476 .conf one@_time boolean false
16477 .index one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion
16478 .index alias file||one-time expansion
16479 .index forward file||one-time expansion
16480 .index mailing lists||one-time expansion
16481 .index address redirection||one-time expansion
16482 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
16483 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem
16484 when one or more of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first
16485 attempt. The problem is not one of duplicate delivery -- Exim is clever enough
16486 to handle that -- but of what happens when the redirection list changes during
16487 the time that the message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the
16488 case of mailing lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages
16489 that were posted before they subscribed.
16490
16491 If \one@_time\ is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
16492 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
16493 `top level' addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
16494 `delivered'. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next
16495 delivery attempt.
16496
16497 \**Warning 1**\: This means that any header line addition or removal that is
16498 specified by this router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the
16499 first attempt. For this reason, the \headers@_add\ and \headers@_remove\
16500 generic options are not permitted when \one@_time\ is set.
16501
16502 \**Warning 2**\: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
16503 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) \forbid@_file\, \forbid@_pipe\,
16504 and \forbid@_filter@_reply\ are forced to be true when \one@_time\ is set.
16505
16506 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
16507 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
16508 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
16509 \all__parents\ log selector is set. It is expected that \one@_time\ will
16510 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
16511 expansion.
16512
16513 .conf owners "string list" unset
16514 .index ownership||alias file
16515 .index ownership||forward file
16516 .index alias file||ownership
16517 .index forward file||ownership
16518 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by \file\.
16519 This list is in addition to the local user when \check@_local@_user\ is set.
16520 See \check@_owner\ above.
16521
16522 .conf owngroups "string list" unset
16523 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by \file\. The
16524 list is in addition to the local user's primary group when \check@_local@_user\
16525 is set. See \check@_group\ above.
16526
16527 .conf pipe@_transport string$**$ unset
16528 A \%redirect%\ router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string starting
16529 with a vertical bar character is specified as a new `address'. The transport
16530 used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
16531 configured transport.
16532 This should normally be a \%pipe%\ transport.
16533 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in \$address@_pipe$\.
16534
16535 .conf qualify@_domain string$**$ unset
16536 If this option is set and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
16537 generated, it is qualified with the domain specified by expanding this string,
16538 instead of the global setting in \qualify@_recipient\. If the expansion fails,
16539 the router declines. If you want to revert to the default, you can have the
16540 expansion generate \$qualify@_recipient$\.
16541
16542 .conf qualify@_preserve@_domain boolean false
16543 .index domain||in redirection, preserving
16544 .index preserving domain in redirection
16545 .index address redirection||domain, preserving
16546 If this is set and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is generated,
16547 it is qualified with the domain of the
16548 parent address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the local
16549 \qualify@_domain\ or global \qualify@_recipient\ value.
16550
16551 .conf repeat@_use boolean true
16552 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
16553 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
16554 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
16555 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
16556 \check@_ancestor\ above and the generic \redirect@_router\ option.
16557
16558 .conf reply@_transport string$**$ unset
16559 A \%redirect%\ router sets up an automatic reply when a \mail\ or \vacation\
16560 command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified by this
16561 option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured transport.
16562 This should normally be an \%autoreply%\ transport. Other transports are
16563 unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
16564
16565 .conf rewrite boolean true
16566 .index address redirection||disabling rewriting
16567 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
16568 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
16569 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
16570
16571
16572 .em
16573 .conf sieve@_vacation@_directory string$**$ unset
16574 .index Sieve filter||vacation directory
16575 To enable the `vacation' extension for Sieve filters, you must set
16576 \sieve@_vacation@_directory\ to the directory where vacation databases are held
16577 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
16578 \reply@_transport\ option refers to an \%autoreply%\ transport.
16579 .nem
16580
16581
16582 .conf skip@_syntax@_errors boolean false
16583 .index forward file||broken
16584 .index address redirection||broken files
16585 .index alias file||broken
16586 .index broken alias or forward files
16587 .index ignoring faulty addresses
16588 .index skipping faulty addresses
16589 .index error||skipping bad syntax
16590 If \skip@_syntax@_errors\ is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
16591 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
16592 \syntax@_errors@_to\ is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
16593 giving details of the failures. If \syntax@_errors@_text\ is set, its contents
16594 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
16595 \syntax@_errors@_to\. Usually it is appropriate to set \syntax@_errors@_to\ to
16596 be the same address as the generic \errors@_to\ option. The
16597 \skip@_syntax@_errors\ option is often used when handling mailing lists.
16598
16599 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
16600 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
16601 the following routers.
16602
16603 If \skip@_syntax@_errors\ is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
16604 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
16605 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
16606 so it is passed to the following routers.
16607
16608 .index Sieve filter||syntax errors in
16609 .em
16610 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the `keep' action to
16611 occur. This action is specified by RFC 3028.
16612 .nem
16613 The values of \skip@_syntax@_errors\, \syntax@_errors@_to\, and
16614 \syntax@_errors@_text\ are not used.
16615
16616 \skip@_syntax@_errors\ can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
16617 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The \syntax@_errors@_to\
16618 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
16619 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
16620 .display flow asis
16621 userforward:
16622 driver = redirect
16623 allow_filter
16624 check_local_user
16625 file = $home/.forward
16626 file_transport = address_file
16627 pipe_transport = address_pipe
16628 reply_transport = address_reply
16629 no_verify
16630 skip_syntax_errors
16631 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
16632 syntax_errors_text = \
16633 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
16634 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
16635 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
16636 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
16637 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
16638 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
16639 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
16640 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
16641 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
16642 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
16643 .endd
16644 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
16645 \"real-"\ are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
16646 put this immediately before the \%userforward%\ router:
16647 .display asis
16648 real_localuser:
16649 driver = accept
16650 check_local_user
16651 local_part_prefix = real-
16652 transport = local_delivery
16653 .endd
16654
16655 .conf syntax@_errors@_text string$**$ unset
16656 See \skip@_syntax@_errors\ above.
16657
16658 .conf syntax@_errors@_to string unset
16659 See \skip@_syntax@_errors\ above.
16660
16661 .endconf
16662
16663
16664
16665
16666
16667 .
16668 .
16669 .
16670 . ============================================================================
16671 .chapter Environment for running local transports
16672 .rset CHAPenvironment "~~chapter"
16673 .set runningfoot "local transport environment"
16674 .index local transports||environment for
16675 .index environment for local transports
16676 .index transport||local, environment for
16677 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The \%autoreply%\
16678 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
16679 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
16680 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
16681
16682 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
16683 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The \%pipe%\
16684 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
16685 ~~SECTpipeenv for details.
16686
16687 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
16688 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
16689 settings with that address as a result of its \check@_local@_user\, \group\, or
16690 \user\ options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
16691 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
16692
16693
16694 .em
16695 .section Concurrent deliveries
16696 .index concurrent deliveries
16697 .index simultaneous deliveries
16698 If two different messages for the same local recpient arrive more or less
16699 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
16700 the \%appendfile%\ transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
16701 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
16702 time.
16703
16704 However, when you use a \%pipe%\ transport, it is up to you to arrange any
16705 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
16706 .display asis
16707 my_transport:
16708 driver = pipe
16709 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
16710 .endd
16711 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
16712 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
16713 \exim@_lock\ utility program (see section ~~SECTmailboxmaint) to lock a file
16714 using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
16715 .nem
16716
16717
16718 .section Uids and gids
16719 .rset SECTenvuidgid "~~chapter.~~section"
16720 .index local transports||uid and gid
16721 .index transport||local, uid and gid
16722 All transports have the options \group\ and \user\. If \group\ is set, it
16723 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if \user\ is not
16724 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
16725 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
16726 group (set by the transport). For example:
16727 .display asis
16728 # Routers ...
16729 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
16730 local_users:
16731 driver = accept
16732 check_local_user
16733 transport = group_delivery
16734
16735 # Transports ...
16736 # This transport overrides the group
16737 group_delivery:
16738 driver = appendfile
16739 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
16740 group = mail
16741 .endd
16742 If \user\ is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
16743 address. If \user\ is non-numeric and \group\ is not set, the gid associated
16744 with the user is used. If \user\ is numeric, \group\ must be set.
16745
16746 .index \initgroups\ option
16747 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the \*initgroups()*\
16748 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the \initgroups\
16749 option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified by the
16750 transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option for
16751 calling \*initgroups()*\ is taken from the router configuration.
16752
16753 .index \%pipe%\ transport||uid for
16754 The \%pipe%\ transport contains the special option \pipe@_as@_creator\. If this
16755 is set and \user\ is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
16756 receive the message is used, and if \group\ is not set, the corresponding
16757 original gid is also used.
16758
16759
16760 .section Current and home directories
16761 .index current directory for local transport
16762 .index home directory||for local transport
16763 .index transport||local, home directory for
16764 .index transport||local, current directory for
16765 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
16766 the \transport__current@_directory\ and \transport@_home@_directory\ options.
16767 However, if the transport's \current__directory\ or \home@_directory\ options
16768 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
16769 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
16770 .numberpars $.
16771 The \home@_directory\ option on the transport;
16772 .nextp
16773 The \transport@_home@_directory\ option on the router;
16774 .nextp
16775 The password data if \check@_local@_user\ is set on the router;
16776 .nextp
16777 The \router@_home@_directory\ option on the router.
16778 .endp
16779 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
16780 .numberpars $.
16781 The \current@_directory\ option on the transport;
16782 .nextp
16783 The \transport@_current@_directory\ option on the router.
16784 .endp
16785
16786 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
16787 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
16788 directory to \(/)\ before running a local transport.
16789
16790
16791 .section Expansion variables derived from the address
16792 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
16793 variables such as \$domain$\ and \$local@_part$\ are set during local
16794 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
16795 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
16796 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
16797 never set, \$domain$\ is set only if all the addresses have the same
16798 domain, and \$original@_domain$\ is never set.
16799
16800
16801
16802
16803
16804
16805
16806 .
16807 .
16808 .
16809 . ============================================================================
16810 .chapter Generic options for transports
16811 .rset CHAPtransportgeneric "~~chapter"
16812 .set runningfoot "generic transport options"
16813
16814 .index generic options||transport
16815 .index options||generic, for transports
16816 .index transport||generic options for
16817 The following generic options apply to all transports:
16818
16819 .startconf transports
16820 .conf body@_only boolean false
16821 .index transport||body only
16822 .index message||transporting body only
16823 .index body of message||transporting
16824 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
16825 mutually exclusive with \headers@_only\. If it is used with the \%appendfile%\ or
16826 \%pipe%\ transports, the settings of \message@_prefix\ and \message@_suffix\
16827 should be checked, because this option does not automatically suppress them.
16828
16829 .conf current@_directory string$**$ unset
16830 .index transport||current directory for
16831 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
16832 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
16833 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16834 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16835
16836 .conf disable@_logging boolean false
16837 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
16838 deliveries by the transport or for any
16839 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
16840 what you are doing.
16841
16842 .conf debug@_print string$**$ unset
16843 .index testing||variables in drivers
16844 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the \-d-\ command line
16845 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
16846 transport is run.
16847 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16848 output, and Exim carries on processing.
16849 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16850 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a \headers@_add\
16851 option is not working properly, \debug@_print\ could be used to output the
16852 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
16853 one.
16854
16855 .conf delivery@_date@_add boolean false
16856 .index ::Delivery-date:: header line
16857 If this option is true, a ::Delivery-date:: header is added to the message. This
16858 gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard header,
16859 Exim has a configuration option (\delivery@_date@_remove\) which requests its
16860 removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent
16861 to other recipients.
16862
16863 .conf driver string unset
16864 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
16865 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
16866
16867 .conf envelope@_to@_add boolean false
16868 .index ::Envelope-to:: header line
16869 If this option is true, an ::Envelope-to:: header is added to the message. This
16870 gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
16871 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
16872 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
16873 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
16874 header, Exim has a configuration option (\envelope@_to@_remove\) which requests
16875 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
16876 resent to other recipients.
16877
16878 .conf group string$**$ "Exim group"
16879 .index transport||group, specifying
16880 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
16881 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
16882 \user\ (see below).
16883
16884 .conf headers@_add string$**$ unset
16885 .index header lines||adding in transport
16886 .index transport||header lines, adding
16887 .em
16888 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
16889 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
16890 ~~SECTheadersaddrem. Additional header lines can also be specified by routers.
16891 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion is
16892 forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
16893 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
16894 .nem
16895
16896 .conf headers@_only boolean false
16897 .index transport||header lines only
16898 .index message||transporting headers only
16899 .index header lines||transporting
16900 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
16901 exclusive with \body@_only\. If it is used with the \%appendfile%\ or \%pipe%\
16902 transports, the settings of \message@_prefix\ and \message__suffix\ should be
16903 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
16904
16905 .conf headers@_remove string$**$ unset
16906 .index header lines||removing
16907 .index transport||header lines, removing
16908 .em
16909 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
16910 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
16911 in section ~~SECTheadersaddrem. Header removal can also be specified by
16912 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
16913 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
16914 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
16915 .nem
16916
16917 .conf headers@_rewrite string unset
16918 .index transport||header lines, rewriting
16919 .index rewriting||at transport time
16920 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
16921 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
16922 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
16923 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
16924 message is received. These are described in chapter ~~CHAPrewrite. For example,
16925 .display asis
16926 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
16927 x@y w@z
16928 .endd
16929 changes \a@@b\ into \c@@d\ in ::From:: header lines, and \x@@y\ into \w@@z\ in
16930 all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the header lines
16931 just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect only those
16932 copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only the
16933 message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system filter,
16934 are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are
16935 not affected by this option. These rewriting rules are $it{not} applied to the
16936 envelope. You can change the return path using \return@_path\, but you cannot
16937 change envelope recipients at this time.
16938
16939 .conf home@_directory string$**$ unset
16940 .index transport||home directory for
16941 This option specifies a home directory setting for the transport, overriding
16942 any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is placed in
16943 \$home$\ while expanding the transport's private options. It is also used as
16944 the current directory if no current directory is set by the
16945 \current__directory\ option on the transport or the
16946 \transport__current__directory\ option on the router.
16947 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16948 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16949
16950
16951 .index additional groups
16952 .index groups, additional
16953 .index transport||group, additional
16954 .conf initgroups boolean false
16955 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
16956 transport, the \*initgroups()*\ function is called when running the transport
16957 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
16958
16959 .conf message@_size@_limit string$**$ 0
16960 .index limit||message size per transport
16961 .index size||of message, limit
16962 .index transport||message size, limiting
16963 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
16964 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of digits,
16965 optionally followed by K or M.
16966 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, or if the
16967 result is not of the required form, delivery is deferred.
16968 If the value is greater than zero and the size of a message exceeds this
16969 limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that the resulting bounce
16970 message could be routed to the same transport, you should ensure that
16971 \return@_size@_limit\ is less than the transport's \message@_size@_limit\, as
16972 otherwise the bounce message will fail to get delivered.
16973
16974
16975 .conf rcpt@_include@_affixes boolean false
16976 .index prefix||for local part, including in envelope
16977 .index suffix||for local part, including in envelope
16978 .index local part||prefix
16979 .index local part||suffix
16980 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
16981 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
16982 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
16983 that contains
16984 .display asis
16985 local_part_prefix = *-
16986 .endd
16987 routes the address \*abc-xyz@@some.domain*\ to an SMTP transport, the envelope
16988 is delivered with
16989 .display asis
16990 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
16991 .endd
16992 If \rcpt@_include@_affixes\ is set true, the whole local part is included in
16993 the \\RCPT\\ command. This option applies to BSMTP deliveries by the
16994 \%appendfile%\ and \%pipe%\ transports as well as to the \%lmtp%\ and \%smtp%\
16995 transports.
16996
16997 .conf retry@_use@_local@_part boolean "see below"
16998 .index hints database||retry keys
16999 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
17000 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
17001 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
17002 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
17003 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
17004 temporary failure -- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
17005 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
17006
17007 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
17008 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
17009 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
17010 this by setting \retry@_use@_local@_part\ false.
17011
17012 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
17013 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
17014 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
17015
17016 .conf return@_path string$**$ unset
17017 .index envelope sender
17018 .index transport||return path, changing
17019 .index return path||changing in transport
17020 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
17021 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
17022 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
17023 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
17024 SMTP \\MAIL\\ command. If you set \return@_path\ for a local transport, the
17025 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the ::Return-path::
17026 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
17027
17028 The expansion can refer to the existing value via \$return@_path$\. This is
17029 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
17030 \errors@_to\ option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
17031 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
17032 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) -- see
17033 chapter ~~CHAPSMTP.
17034
17035 \**Note**\: If a delivery error is detected locally,
17036 including the case when a remote server rejects a message at SMTP time,
17037 the bounce message is not sent to the value of this option, but to the
17038 previously set errors address (which defaults to the incoming sender address).
17039
17040
17041 .conf return@_path@_add boolean false
17042 .index ::Return-path:: header line
17043 If this option is true, a ::Return-path:: header is added to the message.
17044 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
17045 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
17046 have easy access to it.
17047
17048 RFC 2821 states that the ::Return-path:: header is added to a message `when the
17049 delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery'. This implies that this header
17050 should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration option,
17051 \return@_path@_remove\, which requests removal of this header from incoming
17052 messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other recipients.
17053
17054 .conf shadow@_condition string$**$ unset
17055 See \shadow@_transport\ below.
17056
17057 .conf shadow@_transport string unset
17058 .index shadow transport
17059 .index transport||shadow
17060 A local transport may set the \shadow@_transport\ option to the name of another
17061 local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
17062
17063 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
17064 \shadow@_condition\ is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
17065 string or one of the strings `0' or `no' or `false', the message is also passed
17066 to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses.
17067 If expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion
17068 failures cause a log line to be written.
17069
17070 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
17071 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
17072 provided; the \shadow@_transport\ option is ignored on any transport when it is
17073 running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also ignored.
17074
17075 The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the
17076 form
17077 .display
17078 ST=<<shadow transport name>>
17079 .endd
17080 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
17081 parentheses afterwards.
17082
17083 Shadow transports can be used for a number of different purposes, including
17084 keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally provides, and
17085 implementing automatic acknowledgement policies based on message headers that
17086 some sites insist on.
17087
17088 .conf transport@_filter string$**$ unset
17089 .index transport||filter
17090 .index filter||transport filter
17091 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
17092 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
17093 individual users or via a system filter.
17094
17095 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
17096 \transport@_filter\ is started up in a separate process, and the entire
17097 message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard input
17098 (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock).
17099 The command must be specified as an absolute path.
17100
17101 .em
17102 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
17103 terminated by newline (`@\n').
17104 .nem
17105 The message is passed to the filter before any SMTP-specific processing, such
17106 as turning `@\n' into `@\r@\n' and escaping lines beginning with a dot, and
17107 also before any processing implied by the settings of \check@_string\ and
17108 \escape@_string\ in the \%appendfile%\ or \%pipe%\ transports.
17109
17110 .em
17111 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
17112 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
17113 destination.
17114 .nem
17115 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
17116 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. A demonstration Perl script is provided in
17117 \(util/transport-filter.pl)\; this makes a few arbitrary modifications just to
17118 show the possibilities. Exim does not check the result, except to test for a
17119 final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over SMTP must end
17120 with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
17121
17122 .index SMTP||\\SIZE\\
17123 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
17124 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
17125 support for the \\SIZE\\ parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
17126 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
17127 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
17128 the \size@_addition\ option on the \%smtp%\ transport, either to allow for
17129 additions to the message, or to disable the use of \\SIZE\\ altogether.
17130
17131 The value of the \transport@_filter\ option is the command string for starting
17132 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
17133 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the \%pipe%\ transport:
17134 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately. The
17135 special argument \$pipe@_addresses$\ is replaced by a number of arguments, one
17136 for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't an ideal name for
17137 this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the \%pipe%\
17138 transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
17139
17140 .index \$host$\
17141 .index \$host@_address$\
17142 The expansion variables \$host$\ and \$host@_address$\ are available when the
17143 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
17144 which the message is being sent. For example:
17145 .display asis
17146 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
17147 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
17148 .endd
17149 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
17150 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default.
17151 .em
17152 The command should normally yield a zero return code. A non-zero code is taken
17153 to mean that the transport filter failed in some way. Delivery of the message
17154 is deferred. It is not possible to cause a message to be bounced from a
17155 transport filter.
17156 .nem
17157
17158 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
17159 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
17160 message, which happens if the \return@_message\ option is set.
17161
17162 .conf transport@_filter@_timeout time 5m
17163 .index transport||filter, timeout
17164 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
17165 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is treated as a
17166 temporary delivery failure.
17167
17168
17169 .conf user string$**$ "Exim user"
17170 .index uid (user id)||local delivery
17171 .index transport||user, specifying
17172 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
17173 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
17174 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
17175 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the \group\
17176 option is not set.
17177
17178 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
17179 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
17180 \check@_local@_user\) by the router or transport.
17181
17182 .index hints database||access by remote transport
17183 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
17184 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
17185 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
17186 retry data.
17187
17188 .endconf
17189
17190
17191
17192
17193
17194 .
17195 .
17196 .
17197 . ============================================================================
17198 .chapter Address batching in local transports
17199 .set runningfoot "address batching"
17200 .rset CHAPbatching ~~chapter
17201 .index transport||local, address batching in
17202 The only remote transport (\%smtp%\) is normally configured to handle more than
17203 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
17204 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
17205 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
17206 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
17207 copy of the message is delivered each time.
17208
17209 .index batched local delivery
17210 .index \batch@_max\
17211 .index \batch@_id\
17212 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
17213 local transport, for example:
17214 .numberpars $.
17215 In an \%appendfile%\ transport, when storing messages in files for later
17216 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
17217 recipients saves space.
17218 .nextp
17219 In an \%lmtp%\ transport, when delivering over `local SMTP' to some process,
17220 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
17221 .nextp
17222 In a \%pipe%\ transport, when passing the message
17223 to a scanner program or
17224 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
17225 acceptable.
17226 .endp
17227 The three local transports (\%appendfile%\, \%lmtp%\, and \%pipe%\) all have
17228 the same options for controlling multiple (`batched') deliveries, namely
17229 \batch@_max\ and \batch@_id\. To save repeating the information for each
17230 transport, these options are described here.
17231
17232 The \batch@_max\ option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
17233 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one.
17234 When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a \batch@_max\
17235 value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch (that is, in a
17236 single run of the transport), subject to certain conditions:
17237 .numberpars $.
17238 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to \$local@_part$\, no
17239 batching is possible.
17240 .nextp
17241 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to \$domain$\, only
17242 addresses with the same domain are batched.
17243 .nextp
17244 .index customizing||batching condition
17245 If \batch@_id\ is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
17246 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
17247 customized batching conditions.
17248 Failure of the expansion for any reason, including forced failure, disables
17249 batching, but it does not stop the delivery from taking place.
17250 .nextp
17251 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
17252 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
17253 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
17254 be the same.
17255 .endp
17256 .index ::Envelope-to:: header line
17257 If the generic \envelope@_to@_add\ option is set for the transport, the
17258 ::Envelope-to:: header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
17259 that are batched together.
17260
17261 The \%appendfile%\ and \%pipe%\ transports have an option called \use@_bsmtp\,
17262 which causes them to deliver the message in `batched SMTP' format, with the
17263 envelope represented as SMTP commands. The \check@_string\ and \escape@_string\
17264 options are forced to the values
17265 .display asis
17266 check_string = "."
17267 escape_string = ".."
17268 .endd
17269 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
17270 given in section ~~SECTbatchSMTP. The \%lmtp%\ transport does not have a
17271 \use@_bsmtp\ option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
17272
17273 .index \%pipe%\ transport||with multiple addresses
17274 If you are not using BSMTP, but are using a \%pipe%\ transport, you can include
17275 \$pipe@_addresses$\ as part of the command. This is not a true variable; it is
17276 a bit of magic that causes each of the recipient addresses to be inserted into
17277 the command as a separate argument. This provides a way of accessing all the
17278 addresses that are being delivered in the batch.
17279
17280 If you are using a batching \%appendfile%\ transport without \use@_bsmtp\, the
17281 only way to preserve the recipient addresses is to set the \envelope@_to@_add\
17282 option. This causes an ::Envelope-to:: header line to be added to the message,
17283 containing all the recipients.
17284
17285
17286
17287 .
17288 .
17289 .
17290 . ============================================================================
17291 .chapter The appendfile transport
17292 .set runningfoot "appendfile transport"
17293 .rset CHAPappendfile ~~chapter
17294 .index \%appendfile%\ transport
17295 .index transports||\%appendfile%\
17296 .index directory creation
17297 .index creating directories
17298 The \%appendfile%\ transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
17299 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
17300 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
17301 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
17302 University of Washington IMAP daemon, $it{inter alia}. When each message is
17303 being delivered as a separate file, `maildir' format can optionally be used to
17304 give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
17305 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as `mailstore' is also
17306 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
17307 directory as necessary, provided that \create@_directory\ is set.
17308
17309 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
17310 default. It is necessary to set \\SUPPORT@_MBX\\, \\SUPPORT@_MAILDIR\\ and/or
17311 \\SUPPORT@_MAILSTORE\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ to have the appropriate code
17312 included.
17313
17314 .index quota||system
17315 Exim recognises system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
17316 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
17317 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
17318
17319 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
17320 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
17321 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
17322 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
17323
17324 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
17325 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
17326 private options.
17327
17328 \%appendfile%\ is most commonly used for local deliveries to users' mailboxes.
17329 However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for putting messages
17330 into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim. `Batch SMTP'
17331 format is often used in this case (see the \use@_bsmtp\ option).
17332
17333
17334 .section The file and directory options
17335 .rset SECTfildiropt "~~chapter.~~section"
17336 The \file\ option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
17337 the \directory\ option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
17338 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
17339 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them \*must*\ be set.
17340
17341 However, \%appendfile%\ is also used for delivering messages to files or
17342 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
17343 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a \save\ command in a user's
17344 Exim filter). When such a transport is running, \$local@_part$\ contains the
17345 local part that was aliased or forwarded, and \$address@_file$\ contains the
17346 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
17347 operation. There are two cases:
17348 .numberpars $.
17349 If neither \file\ nor \directory\ is set, the redirection operation
17350 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with \"/"\). This is the most
17351 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
17352 different folders. See for example, the \%address@_file%\ transport in the
17353 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
17354 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
17355 \maildir@_format\ or \mailstore@_format\.
17356 .nextp
17357 If \file\ or \directory\ is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is used
17358 to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
17359 contents of \$address@_file$\ are used in some way in the string expansion.
17360 .endp
17361
17362 .index Sieve filter||configuring \%appendfile%\
17363 .index Sieve filter||relative mailbox path handling
17364 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
17365 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
17366 form:
17367 .display asis
17368 save folder23
17369 .endd
17370 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
17371 .display asis
17372 require "fileinto";
17373 fileinto "folder23";
17374 .endd
17375 In this situation, the expansion of \file\ or \directory\ in the transport must
17376 transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the case
17377 of Sieve filters, the name \*inbox*\ must be handled. It is the name that is
17378 used as a result of a `keep' action in the filter. This example shows one way
17379 of handling this requirement:
17380 .display asis
17381 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
17382 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
17383 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
17384 {$address_file} \
17385 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
17386 }} \
17387 }
17388 .endd
17389 With this setting of \file\, \*inbox*\ refers to the standard mailbox location,
17390 absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the \(mail)\
17391 directory within the home directory.
17392
17393 \**Note 1**\: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
17394 \(folder23)\ is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
17395 the router. In particular, this is the case if \check@_local@_user\ is set. If
17396 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
17397 \router@_home@_directory\ empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
17398 path to the transport.
17399
17400 \**Note 2**\: An absolute path in \$address@_file$\ is not treated specially;
17401 the \file\ or \directory\ option is still used if it is set.
17402
17403
17404
17405 .section Private options for appendfile
17406 .index options||\%appendfile%\ transport
17407
17408 .startconf appendfile
17409
17410 .conf allow@_fifo boolean false
17411 .index fifo (named pipe)
17412 .index named pipe (fifo)
17413 .index pipe||named (fifo)
17414 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
17415 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
17416 delivery is deferred.
17417
17418 .conf allow@_symlink boolean false
17419 .index symbolic link||to mailbox
17420 .index mailbox||symbolic link
17421 By default, \%appendfile%\ will not deliver if the path name for the file is
17422 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
17423 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
17424 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
17425 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
17426
17427 .conf batch@_id string$**$ unset
17428 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter ~~CHAPbatching.
17429 However, batching is automatically disabled for \%appendfile%\ deliveries that
17430 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
17431 file.
17432
17433 .conf batch@_max integer 1
17434 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter ~~CHAPbatching.
17435
17436 .conf check@_group boolean false
17437 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the \file\
17438 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
17439 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
17440 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
17441
17442 .conf check@_owner boolean true
17443 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the \file\ option is
17444 checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
17445 process is running.
17446
17447 .conf check@_string string "see below"
17448 .index `From' line
17449 As \%appendfile%\ writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
17450 matching \check@_string\, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
17451 replaced by the contents of \escape@_string\. The value of \check@_string\ is a
17452 literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
17453 contains is significant.
17454
17455 If \use@_bsmtp\ is set the values of \check@_string\ and \escape@_string\ are
17456 forced to `.' and `..' respectively, and any settings in the configuration are
17457 ignored. Otherwise, they default to `From ' and `>From ' when the \file\ option
17458 is set, and unset when
17459 any of the \directory\, \maildir\, or \mailstore\ options are set.
17460
17461 The default settings, along with \message@_prefix\ and \message@_suffix\, are
17462 suitable for traditional `BSD' mailboxes, where a line beginning with `From '
17463 indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing if another
17464 format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
17465 .index MMDF format mailbox
17466 .index mailbox||MMDF format
17467 .display asis
17468 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
17469 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
17470 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
17471 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
17472 .endd
17473
17474 .index directory creation
17475 .conf create@_directory boolean true
17476 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
17477 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
17478 is given by the \directory@_mode\ option.
17479 .em
17480 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
17481 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
17482 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
17483 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
17484 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
17485 .nem
17486
17487 .conf create@_file string "anywhere"
17488 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
17489 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the \file\ option and
17490 directories defined by the \directory\ option. In the case of maildir delivery,
17491 it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories beneath.
17492
17493 The option must be set to one of the words `anywhere', `inhome', or
17494 `belowhome'. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been set
17495 for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
17496 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
17497 names are generated from users' \(.forward)\ files. These are usually handled
17498 by an \%appendfile%\ transport called \address@_file\. See also
17499 \file@_must@_exist\.
17500
17501 .conf directory string$**$ unset
17502 This option is mutually exclusive with the \file\ option, but one of \file\ or
17503 \directory\ must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
17504 redirection (see section ~~SECTfildiropt).
17505
17506 When \directory\ is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
17507 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
17508 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
17509 (see \maildir@_format\ and \mailstore@_format\), and see section ~~SECTopdir
17510 for further details of this form of delivery.
17511
17512 .conf directory@_file string$**$ "$tt{q@$@{base62:@$tod@_epoch@}-@$inode}"
17513 .index base62
17514 When \directory\ is set, but neither \maildir@_format\ nor \mailstore@_format\
17515 is set, \%appendfile%\ delivers each message into a file whose name is obtained
17516 by expanding this string. The default value generates a unique name from the
17517 current time, in base 62 form, and the inode of the file. The variable
17518 \$inode$\ is available only when expanding this option.
17519
17520 .conf directory@_mode "octal integer" 0700
17521 If \%appendfile%\ creates any directories as a result of the \create@_directory\
17522 option, their mode is specified by this option.
17523
17524 .conf escape@_string string "see description"
17525 See \check@_string\ above.
17526
17527 .conf file string$**$ unset
17528 This option is mutually exclusive with the \directory\ option, but one of
17529 \file\ or \directory\ must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of
17530 a redirection (see section ~~SECTfildiropt). The \file\ option specifies a
17531 single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
17532 \use@_fcntl@_lock\, \use@_flock@_lock\, or \use@_lockfile\ must be set with
17533 \file\.
17534 .index NFS||lock file
17535 .index locking files
17536 .index lock files
17537 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
17538 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
17539
17540 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
17541 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
17542 examples:
17543 .display asis
17544 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
17545 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
17546 file = $home/inbox
17547 .endd
17548 .index `sticky' bit
17549 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
17550 is configured to use lock files (see \use@_lockfile\ below) it must be able to
17551 create a file in the directory, so the `sticky' bit must be turned on for
17552 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the \group\ option can be used to
17553 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
17554
17555
17556 .conf file@_format string unset
17557 .index file||mailbox, checking existing format
17558 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
17559 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
17560 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
17561 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
17562 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
17563 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
17564 transport. For example, suppose the standard \%local@_delivery%\ transport has
17565 this added to it:
17566 .display asis
17567 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
17568 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
17569 .endd
17570 Mailboxes that begin with `From' are still handled by this transport, but if a
17571 mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
17572 to a transport called \local__mmdf__delivery\, which presumably is configured
17573 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
17574 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
17575 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
17576 delivery is deferred.
17577
17578 .conf file@_must@_exist boolean false
17579 If this option is true, the file specified by the \file\ option must exist, and
17580 an error occurs if it does not. Otherwise, it is created if it does not exist.
17581
17582 .conf lock@_fcntl@_timeout time 0s
17583 .index timeout||mailbox locking
17584 .index mailbox locking||blocking and non-blocking
17585 .index locking files
17586 By default, the \%appendfile%\ transport uses non-blocking calls to \*fcntl()*\
17587 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
17588 sleeps for \lock@_interval\ and tries again, up to \lock@_retries\ times.
17589 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
17590 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
17591 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
17592 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
17593 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
17594
17595 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
17596 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
17597 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
17598 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
17599
17600 If \lock@_fcntl@_timeout\ is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
17601 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
17602 retries is
17603 .display asis
17604 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
17605 .endd
17606 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
17607 which \%appendfile%\ is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
17608 \lock@_fcntl@_timeout\ is set very large.
17609
17610 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
17611 local deliveries because of errors of the form
17612 .display asis
17613 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
17614 .endd
17615
17616 .conf lock@_flock@_timeout time 0s
17617 This timeout applies to file locking when using \*flock()*\ (see \use@_flock\);
17618 the timeout operates in a similar manner to \lock@_fcntl@_timeout\.
17619
17620 .conf lock@_interval time 3s
17621 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
17622 for details of locking.
17623
17624 .conf lock@_retries integer 10
17625 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
17626 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
17627
17628 .conf lockfile@_mode "octal integer" 0600
17629 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
17630 used (see \use@_lockfile\).
17631
17632 .conf lockfile@_timeout time 30m
17633 .index timeout||mailbox locking
17634 When a lock file is being used (see \use@_lockfile\), if a lock file already
17635 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
17636 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
17637
17638 .em
17639 .conf mailbox@_filecount string$**$ unset
17640 .index mailbox||specifying size of
17641 .index size||of mailbox
17642 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
17643 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
17644 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
17645 external source that maintains the data.
17646
17647 .conf mailbox@_size string$**$ unset
17648 .index mailbox||specifying size of
17649 .index size||of mailbox
17650 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
17651 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
17652 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
17653 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
17654 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
17655 .nem
17656
17657 .conf maildir@_format boolean false
17658 .index maildir format||specifying
17659 If this option is set with the \directory\ option, the delivery is into a new
17660 file, in the `maildir' format that is used by other mail software. When the
17661 transport is activated directly from a \%redirect%\ router (for example, the
17662 \%address@_file%\ transport in the default configuration), setting
17663 \maildir@_format\ causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
17664 directory, whether or not it ends with \"/"\. This option is available only if
17665 \\SUPPORT@_MAILDIR\\ is present in \(Local/Makefile)\. See section
17666 ~~SECTmaildirdelivery below for further details.
17667
17668 .conf maildir@_quota@_directory@_regex string "See below"
17669 .index maildir format||quota, directories included in
17670 .index quota||maildir, directories included in
17671 This option is relevant only when \maildir@_use@_size@_file\ is set. It defines
17672 a regular expression for specifying directories that should be included in the
17673 quota calculation. The default value is
17674 .display asis
17675 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
17676 .endd
17677 which includes the \(cur)\ and \(new)\ directories, and any maildir++ folders
17678 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
17679 \(Trash)\
17680 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
17681 .display asis
17682 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
17683 .endd
17684 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
17685 directory whose name is \(.Trash)\.
17686
17687 .conf maildir@_retries integer 10
17688 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
17689 `maildir' format. See section ~~SECTmaildirdelivery below.
17690
17691 .conf maildir@_tag string$**$ unset
17692 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
17693 section ~~SECTmaildirdelivery below.
17694
17695 .conf maildir@_use@_size@_file boolean false
17696 .index maildir format||\(maildirsize)\ file
17697 Setting this option true enables support for \(maildirsize)\ files. Exim
17698 creates a \(maildirsize)\ file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
17699 quota from the \quota\ option of the transport. If \quota\ is unset, the value
17700 is zero. See section ~~SECTmaildirdelivery below for further details.
17701
17702 .conf mailstore@_format boolean false
17703 .index mailstore format||specifying
17704 If this option is set with the \directory\ option, the delivery is into two new
17705 files in `mailstore' format. The option is available only if
17706 \\SUPPORT@_MAILSTORE\\ is present in \(Local/Makefile)\. See section
17707 ~~SECTopdir below for further details.
17708
17709 .conf mailstore@_prefix string$**$ unset
17710 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
17711 section ~~SECTopdir below.
17712
17713 .conf mailstore@_suffix string$**$ unset
17714 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
17715 section ~~SECTopdir below.
17716
17717 .conf mbx@_format boolean false
17718 .index locking files
17719 .index file||locking
17720 .index file||MBX format
17721 .index MBX format, specifying
17722 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with \\SUPPORT@_MBX\\
17723 set in \(Local/Makefile)\. If \mbx@_format\ is set with the \file\ option,
17724 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
17725 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
17726 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the \*c-client*\ library that they all use.
17727
17728 \**Note**\: The \message@_prefix\ and \message@_suffix\ options are not
17729 automatically changed by the use of \mbx@_format\. They should normally be set
17730 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
17731 combination:
17732 .display asis
17733 mbx_format = true
17734 message_prefix =
17735 message_suffix =
17736 .endd
17737
17738 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
17739 \use@_mbx@_lock\ is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
17740 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with \mbx@_format\, but
17741 \use@_fcntl@_lock\ and \use@_mbx@_lock\ are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
17742 interworks with \*c-client*\, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
17743 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
17744 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
17745 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
17746
17747 If you set \use@_fcntl@_lock\ with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
17748 the standard version of \*c-client*\, because as long as it has a mailbox open
17749 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
17750 append messages to it.
17751
17752 .conf message@_prefix string$**$ "see below"
17753 .index `From' line
17754 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
17755 The default is unset unless \file\ is specified and \use@_bsmtp\ is not set, in
17756 which case it is:
17757 .display asis
17758 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
17759 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
17760 .endd
17761
17762 .conf message@_suffix string$**$ "see below"
17763 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
17764 The default is unset unless \file\ is specified and \use@_bsmtp\ is not set, in
17765 which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
17766 setting
17767 .display asis
17768 message_suffix =
17769 .endd
17770
17771 .conf mode "octal integer" 0600
17772 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
17773 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
17774 permissions, an error occurs unless \mode__fail__narrower\ is false. However,
17775 if the delivery is the result of a \save\ command in a filter file specifing a
17776 particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
17777 value, and this option is ignored.
17778
17779 .conf mode@_fail@_narrower boolean true
17780 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
17781 mode than that specified by the \mode\ option. If \mode@_fail@_narrower\ is
17782 true, the delivery is deferred (`mailbox has the wrong mode'); otherwise Exim
17783 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
17784
17785 .conf notify@_comsat boolean false
17786 If this option is true, the \*comsat*\ daemon is notified after every successful
17787 delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged on users
17788 about incoming mail.
17789
17790 .conf quota string$**$ unset
17791 .index quota||imposed by Exim
17792 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
17793 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the \directory\ option is
17794 set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
17795 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
17796 individually inspected and their sizes summed.
17797 (See \quota@_size@_regex\ and \maildir@_use@_size@_file\ for ways to avoid this
17798 in environments where users have no shell access to their mailboxes).
17799
17800 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
17801 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
17802 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
17803
17804 A file's size is taken as its \*used*\ value. Because of blocking effects, this
17805 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
17806 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
17807 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
17808 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the \*used*\ figure, because this is
17809 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
17810
17811 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
17812 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K or M. The
17813 expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for the
17814 delivery. This means that files which are inaccessible to the end user can be
17815 used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
17816 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
17817 system quota failures.
17818
17819 \**Note**\: A value of zero is interpreted as `no quota'.
17820
17821 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
17822 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
17823 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
17824 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
17825 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
17826 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
17827 changed by setting \quota@_is@_inclusive\ false. When this is done, the check
17828 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
17829 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
17830 delivered. See also \quota@_warn@_threshold\.
17831
17832 .conf quota@_directory string$**$ unset
17833 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
17834 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
17835 called \(maildirfolder)\ exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
17836 delivery directory.
17837
17838 .conf quota@_filecount string$**$ 0
17839 This option applies when the \directory\ option is set. It limits the total
17840 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
17841 can only be used if \quota\ is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
17842 failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17843
17844 .conf quota@_is@_inclusive boolean true
17845 See \quota\ above.
17846
17847 .conf quota@_size@_regex string unset
17848 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
17849 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
17850 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks \quota@_size@_regex\.
17851 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
17852 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
17853 file's size. The value of \quota@_size@_regex\ is not expanded.
17854
17855 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
17856 -- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
17857 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting \maildir@_tag\ to add
17858 the file length to the file name. For example:
17859 .display asis
17860 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
17861 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
17862 .endd
17863 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
17864 file name (even though \maildir@_tag\ puts it there) because maildir MUAs
17865 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
17866
17867 .conf quota@_warn@_message string$**$ "see below"
17868 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
17869 \quota@_warn@_threshold\ is set, it defaults to
17870 .display asis
17871 quota_warn_message = "\
17872 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
17873 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
17874 This message is automatically created \
17875 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
17876 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
17877 a warning threshold that is\n\
17878 set by the system administrator.\n"
17879 .endd
17880
17881 .conf quota@_warn@_threshold string$**$ 0
17882 .index quota||warning threshold
17883 .index mailbox||size warning
17884 .index size||of mailbox
17885 This option is expanded in the same way as \quota\ (see above). If the
17886 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
17887 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
17888 threshold, a warning message is sent. If \quota\ is also set, the threshold may
17889 be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent sign.
17890 For example:
17891 .display asis
17892 quota = 10M
17893 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
17894 .endd
17895 If \quota\ is not set, a setting of \quota@_warn@_threshold\ that ends with a
17896 percent sign is ignored.
17897
17898 The warning message itself is specified by the \quota@_warn@_message\ option,
17899 and it must start with a ::To:: header line containing the recipient(s). A
17900 ::Subject:: line should also normally be supplied. The \quota\ option does not
17901 have to be set in order to use this option; they are independent of one
17902 another except when the threshold is specified as a percentage.
17903
17904 .conf use@_bsmtp boolean false
17905 .index envelope sender
17906 If this option is set true, \%appendfile%\ writes messages in `batch SMTP'
17907 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
17908 you want to include a leading \\HELO\\ command with such messages, you can do
17909 so by setting the \message@_prefix\ option. See section ~~SECTbatchSMTP for
17910 details of batch SMTP.
17911
17912 .conf use@_crlf boolean false
17913 .index carriage return
17914 .index linefeed
17915 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
17916 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
17917 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
17918 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
17919
17920 The contents of the \message@_prefix\ and \message@_suffix\ options are written
17921 verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these are
17922 needed. In cases where these options have non-empty defaults, the values end
17923 with a single linefeed, so they
17924 must
17925 be changed to end with \"@\r@\n"\ if \use@_crlf\ is set.
17926
17927 .conf use@_fcntl@_lock boolean "see below"
17928 This option controls the use of the \*fcntl()*\ function to lock a file for
17929 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
17930 \use@_flock@_lock\ is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
17931 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both \use@_fcntl@_lock\ and
17932 \use@_flock@_lock\ are unset, \use@_lockfile\ must be set.
17933
17934 .conf use@_flock@_lock boolean false
17935 This option is provided to support the use of \*flock()*\ for file locking, for
17936 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
17937 \*fcntl()*\ and \*lockf()*\ locking, and these two functions interwork with
17938 each other. Exim uses \*fcntl()*\ locking by default.
17939
17940 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
17941 \*flock()*\ is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
17942 where \*flock()*\ does not correctly interwork with \*fcntl()*\. You can use
17943 both \*fcntl()*\ and \*flock()*\ locking simultaneously if you want.
17944
17945 .index Solaris||\*flock()*\ support
17946 Not all operating systems provide \*flock()*\. Some versions of Solaris do not
17947 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
17948 \*lockf()*\). If the OS does not have \*flock()*\, Exim will be built without
17949 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
17950 error.
17951
17952 \**Warning**\: \*flock()*\ locks do not work on NFS files (unless \*flock()*\
17953 is just being mapped onto \*fcntl()*\ by the OS).
17954
17955 .conf use@_lockfile boolean "see below"
17956 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
17957 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
17958 \*fcntl()*\. You should only turn \use@_lockfile\ off if you are absolutely
17959 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
17960 \*fcntl()*\ rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
17961 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
17962
17963 .index NFS||lock file
17964 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
17965 necessary to take out a lock $it{before} opening the file, and the lock file
17966 achieves this. Otherwise, even with \*fcntl()*\ locking, there is a risk of
17967 file corruption.
17968
17969 The \use@_lockfile\ option is set by default unless \use@_mbx@_lock\ is set. It
17970 is not possible to turn both \use@_lockfile\ and \use@_fcntl@_lock\ off, except
17971 when \mbx@_format\ is set.
17972
17973 .conf use@_mbx@_lock boolean "see below"
17974 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with \\SUPPORT@_MBX\\
17975 set in \(Local/Makefile)\. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
17976 locking rules be used. It is set by default if \mbx@_format\ is set and none of
17977 the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules are
17978 the same as are used by the \*c-client*\ library that underlies Pine and the
17979 IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The rules
17980 allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking does not
17981 work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
17982
17983 You can set \use@_mbx@_lock\ with either (or both) of \use@_fcntl@_lock\ and
17984 \use@_flock@_lock\ to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
17985 MBX locking rules. The default is to use \*fcntl()*\ if \use@_mbx@_lock\ is set
17986 without \use@_fcntl@_lock\ or \use@_flock@_lock\.
17987 .endconf
17988
17989
17990 .section Operational details for appending
17991 .rset SECTopappend "~~chapter.~~section"
17992 .index appending to a file
17993 .index file||appending
17994 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
17995 .numberpars $.
17996 If the name of the file is \(/dev/null)\, no action is taken, and a success
17997 return is given.
17998 .nextp
17999 .index directory creation
18000 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
18001 \create@_directory\ option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
18002 \directory@_mode\ option.
18003 .nextp
18004 If \file@_format\ is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
18005 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
18006 transport.
18007 .nextp
18008 .index file||locking
18009 .index locking files
18010 .index NFS||lock file
18011 If \use@_lockfile\ is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
18012 reliably over NFS, as follows:
18013 .numberpars $.
18014 Create a `hitching post' file whose name is that of the lock file with the
18015 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
18016 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
18017 .nextp
18018 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
18019 .nextp
18020 If the call to \*link()*\ succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
18021 Unlink the hitching post name.
18022 .nextp
18023 Otherwise, use \*stat()*\ to get information about the hitching post file, and
18024 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
18025 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
18026 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the \*link()*\ call.
18027 .nextp
18028 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for \lock@_interval\ and try again,
18029 up to \lock@_retries\ times. However, since any program that writes to a
18030 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
18031 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
18032 existing lock file is older than \lockfile@_timeout\ Exim attempts to unlink it
18033 before trying again.
18034 .endp
18035 .nextp
18036 A call is made to \*lstat()*\ to discover whether the main file exists, and if
18037 so, what its characteristics are. If \*lstat()*\ fails for any reason other
18038 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
18039 .nextp
18040 .index symbolic link||to mailbox
18041 .index mailbox||symbolic link
18042 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
18043 \allow@_symlink\ option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
18044 checked, and then \*stat()*\ is called to find out about the real file, which
18045 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
18046 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
18047 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
18048 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
18049 checked.
18050 .nextp
18051 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
18052 and group (if the group is being checked -- see \check@_group\ above) are
18053 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
18054 delivery is deferred.
18055 .nextp
18056 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
18057 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless \mode@_fail@_narrower\
18058 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
18059 permissions.
18060 .nextp
18061 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending. If
18062 this fails because the file has vanished, \%appendfile%\ behaves as if it hadn't
18063 existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
18064 .nextp
18065 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
18066 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
18067 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
18068 .nextp
18069 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the \file@_must@_exist\
18070 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
18071 directory if the \create@_file\ option is set (deferring on failure), and then
18072 open for writing as a new file, with the \\O@_EXCL\\ and \\O@_CREAT\\ options,
18073 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the \allow@_symlink\ option must be
18074 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
18075 the file is opened for writing using \\O@_CREAT\\ but not \\O@_EXCL\\, because
18076 that prevents link following.
18077 .nextp
18078 .index loop||while file testing
18079 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
18080 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
18081 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
18082 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
18083 .nextp
18084 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
18085 .nextp
18086 .index file||locking
18087 .index locking files
18088 Once the file is open, unless both \use@_fcntl@_lock\ and \use@_flock@_lock\
18089 are false, it is locked using \*fcntl()*\ or \*flock()*\ or both. If
18090 \use@_mbx@_lock\ is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
18091 However, if \use@_mbx@_lock\ is true,
18092 Exim takes out a shared lock on the open file,
18093 and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
18094 .display
18095 /tmp/.<<device-number>>.<<inode-number>>
18096 .endd
18097 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
18098 the MBX locking rules.
18099
18100 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
18101 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
18102 \lock@_fcntl@_timeout\ or \lock@_flock@_timeout\, as appropriate.
18103
18104 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
18105 \lock@_interval\, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
18106 to lock it again. This happens up to \lock@_retries\ times, after which the
18107 delivery is deferred.
18108
18109 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to \*fcntl()*\ or
18110 \*flock()*\ are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
18111 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
18112 immediately. It retries up to
18113 .display
18114 (lock@_retries * lock@_interval) / <<timeout>>
18115 .endd
18116 times (rounded up).
18117 .endp
18118
18119 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the \*fcntl()*\
18120 and/or \*flock()*\ locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
18121
18122 .section Operational details for delivery to a new file
18123 .rset SECTopdir "~~chapter.~~section"
18124 .index delivery||to single file
18125 .index `From' line
18126 When the \directory\ option is set instead of \file\, each message is delivered
18127 into a newly-created file or set of files. When \%appendfile%\ is activated
18128 directly from a \%redirect%\ router, neither \file\ nor \directory\ is normally
18129 set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the router. (See for example,
18130 the \%address@_file%\ transport in the default configuration.) In this case,
18131 delivery is to a new file if either the path name ends in \"/"\, or the
18132 \maildir@_format\ or \mailstore@_format\ option is set.
18133
18134 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
18135 locking options of the transport are ignored. The `From' line that by default
18136 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
18137 of message lines that start with `From', and there is no need to ensure a
18138 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
18139 \check@_string\, \message@_prefix\, and \message@_suffix\ are all unset when
18140 any of \directory\, \maildir@_format\, or \mailstore@_format\ is set.
18141
18142 If Exim is required to check a \quota\ setting, it adds up the sizes of all the
18143 files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
18144 different directory by setting \quota@_directory\. Also, for maildir deliveries
18145 (see below) the \(maildirfolder)\ convention is honoured.
18146
18147
18148 .index maildir format
18149 .index mailstore format
18150 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
18151 done, controlled by the settings of the \maildir@_format\ and
18152 \mailstore@_format\ options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
18153 formats is not included in the binary unless \\SUPPORT@_MAILDIR\\ or
18154 \\SUPPORT@_MAILSTORE\\, respectively, is set in \(Local/Makefile)\.
18155
18156 .index directory creation
18157 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
18158 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the \create@_directory\
18159 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
18160 constrained by setting \create@_file\. A created directory's mode is given by
18161 the \directory@_mode\ option. If creation fails, or if the \create@_directory\
18162 option is not set when creation is required, delivery is deferred.
18163
18164
18165 .section Maildir delivery
18166 .rset SECTmaildirdelivery "~~chapter.~~section"
18167 .index maildir format||description of
18168 If the \maildir@_format\ option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
18169 it to a file whose name is \(tmp/<<stime>>.H<<mtime>>P<<pid>>.<<host>>)\ in the
18170 given directory. If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
18171 \(new)\ subdirectory.
18172
18173 In the file name, <<stime>> is the current time of day in seconds, and
18174 <<mtime>> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
18175 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
18176 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
18177 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls \*stat()*\ for the file before
18178 opening it. If any response other than \\ENOENT\\ (does not exist) is given,
18179 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to \maildir@_retries\ times.
18180
18181 .index quota||in maildir delivery
18182 .index maildir++
18183 If Exim is required to check a \quota\ setting before a maildir delivery, and
18184 \quota@_directory\ is not set, it looks for a file called \(maildirfolder)\ in
18185 the maildir directory (alongside \(new)\, \(cur)\, \(tmp)\). If this exists,
18186 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
18187 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
18188 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
18189 amount of space used.
18190
18191 .em
18192 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
18193 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
18194 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
18195 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
18196 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
18197 of the \mailbox@_size\ option as a way of importing it into Exim.
18198 .nem
18199
18200
18201 .section Using tags to record message sizes
18202 If \maildir@_tag\ is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
18203 When the maildir file is renamed into the \(new)\ sub-directory, the
18204 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
18205 name to the point where the test \*stat()*\ call fails with \\ENAMETOOLONG\\,
18206 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
18207
18208 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
18209 \quota@_size@_regex\ above for an example. The expansion of \maildir@_tag\
18210 happens after the message has been written. The value of the \$message@_size$\
18211 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
18212 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
18213 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except `/'.
18214 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
18215 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
18216 colon is inserted.
18217
18218
18219 .section Using a maildirsize file
18220 .index quota||in maildir delivery
18221 .index maildir format||\(maildirsize)\ file
18222 If \maildir@_use@_size@_file\ is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
18223 storing quota and message size information in a file called \(maildirsize)\
18224 within the maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim creates it,
18225 setting the quota from the \quota\ option of the transport. If the maildir
18226 directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt to write a
18227 \(maildirsize)\ file.
18228
18229 The \(maildirsize)\ file is used to hold information about the sizes of
18230 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
18231 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
18232 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
18233 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
18234 need to know the quota.
18235
18236 If the \quota\ option in the transport is unset or zero, the \(maildirsize)\
18237 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
18238
18239 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
18240 maildir participate in quota calculations. See the description of the
18241 \maildir@_quota@_directory@_regex\ option above for details.
18242
18243
18244 .section Mailstore delivery
18245 .index mailstore format||description of
18246 If the \mailstore@_format\ option is true, each message is written as two files
18247 in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the message id
18248 and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use this base
18249 name plus the suffixes \(.env)\ and \(.msg)\. The \(.env)\ file contains the
18250 message's envelope, and the \(.msg)\ file contains the message itself.
18251
18252 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
18253 \(.tmp)\. The \(.msg)\ file is then written, and when it is complete, the
18254 \(.tmp)\ file is renamed as the \(.env)\ file. Programs that access messages in
18255 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a \(.msg)\ and a \(.env)\
18256 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
18257 the absence of a \(.tmp)\ file.
18258
18259 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the \mailstore@_prefix\
18260 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
18261 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
18262 There can be more than one recipient only if the \batch@_max\ option is set
18263 greater than one. Finally, \mailstore@_suffix\ is expanded and the result
18264 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
18265
18266 If expansion of \mailstore@_prefix\ or \mailstore@_suffix\ ends with a forced
18267 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
18268 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred.
18269
18270
18271 .section Non-special new file delivery
18272 If neither \maildir@_format\ nor \mailstore@_format\ is set, a single new file
18273 is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
18274 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
18275 section ~~SECTbatchSMTP), a setting such as
18276 .display asis
18277 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
18278 .endd
18279 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
18280 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
18281 expanding the contents of the \directory@_file\ option.
18282
18283
18284
18285
18286
18287 .
18288 .
18289 .
18290 .
18291 . ============================================================================
18292 .chapter The autoreply transport
18293 .set runningfoot "autoreply transport"
18294 .index transports||\%autoreply%\
18295 .index \%autoreply%\ transport
18296 The \%autoreply%\ transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
18297 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message.
18298 .em
18299 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
18300 \unseen\ option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
18301 delivered anywhere. However, when the \unseen\ option is set on the router that
18302 passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
18303 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
18304 .nem
18305
18306 The \%autoreply%\ transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
18307 `vacation' message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
18308 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
18309 message cascades, messages created by the \%autoreply%\ transport always have
18310 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
18311
18312 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
18313 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
18314 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
18315 transport is run as a consequence of a
18316 \mail\
18317 or \vacation\ command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
18318 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
18319 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
18320 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
18321 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the \file@_optional\,
18322 \mode\, and \return@_message\ options apply in all cases.
18323
18324 \%Autoreply%\ is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
18325 command in a user's filter file, \%autoreply%\ normally runs under the uid and
18326 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
18327 ~~CHAPenvironment).
18328
18329 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a \%pipe%\ transport
18330 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
18331 \%autoreply%\ transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
18332 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
18333 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
18334 the sender in a single message, whereas if \%autoreply%\ is used, a separate
18335 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
18336
18337 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
18338 message that \%autoreply%\ creates, with the exception of newlines that are
18339 immediately followed by whitespace. If any non-printing characters are found,
18340 the transport defers.
18341 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
18342 controlled by the \print@_topbitchars\ global option.
18343
18344 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
18345 \headers@_add\) are set on an \%autoreply%\ transport, they apply to the copy of
18346 the original message that is included in the generated message when
18347 \return@_message\ is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
18348
18349 If the \%autoreply%\ transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
18350 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
18351 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to \$sender@_address$\ when this
18352 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
18353 problems. They are just discarded.
18354
18355
18356 .section Private options for autoreply
18357
18358 .startconf autoreply
18359 .index options||\%autoreply%\ transport
18360 .conf bcc string$**$ unset
18361 This specifies the addresses that are to receive `blind carbon copies' of the
18362 message when the message is specified by the transport.
18363
18364 .conf cc string$**$ unset
18365 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the ::Cc:: header
18366 when the message is specified by the transport.
18367
18368 .conf file string$**$ unset
18369 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
18370 is specified by the transport. If both \file\ and \text\ are set, the text
18371 string comes first.
18372
18373 .conf file@_expand boolean false
18374 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the \file\ option are
18375 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
18376
18377 .conf file@_optional boolean false
18378 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the \file\
18379 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
18380
18381 .conf from string$**$ unset
18382 This specifies the contents of the ::From:: header when the message is specified
18383 by the transport.
18384
18385 .conf headers string$**$ unset
18386 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message when
18387 the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using `@\n'
18388 to separate them. There is no check on the format.
18389
18390 .conf log string$**$ unset
18391 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
18392 the message is specified by the transport.
18393
18394 .conf mode "octal integer" 0600
18395 If either the log file or the `once' file has to be created, this mode is used.
18396
18397 .em
18398 .conf never@_mail "address list$**$" unset
18399 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
18400 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
18401 discarded, no message is created.
18402 .nem
18403
18404 .conf once string$**$ unset
18405 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each
18406 ::To:: recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport.
18407 \**Note**\: This does not apply to ::Cc:: or ::Bcc:: recipients.
18408 If \once@_file@_size\ is not set, a DBM database is used, and it is allowed to
18409 grow as large as necessary. If a potential recipient is already in the
18410 database, no message is sent by default. However, if \once@_repeat\ specifies a
18411 time greater than zero, the message is sent if that much time has elapsed since
18412 a message was last sent to this recipient. If \once\ is unset, the message is
18413 always sent.
18414
18415 If \once@_file@_size\ is set greater than zero, it changes the way Exim
18416 implements the \once\ option. Instead of using a DBM file to record every
18417 recipient it sends to, it uses a regular file, whose size will never get larger
18418 than the given value. In the file, it keeps a linear list of recipient
18419 addresses and times at which they were sent messages. If the file is full when
18420 a new address needs to be added, the oldest address is dropped. If
18421 \once@_repeat\ is not set, this means that a given recipient may receive
18422 multiple messages, but at unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of
18423 turnover of addresses in the file. If \once@_repeat\ is set, it specifies a
18424 maximum time between repeats.
18425
18426 .conf once@_file@_size integer 0
18427 See \once\ above.
18428
18429 .conf once@_repeat time$**$ 0s
18430 See \once\ above.
18431 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
18432
18433 .conf reply@_to string$**$ unset
18434 This specifies the contents of the ::Reply-To:: header when the message is
18435 specified by the transport.
18436
18437 .conf return@_message boolean false
18438 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
18439 message, subject to the maximum size set in the \return@_size@_limit\ global
18440 configuration option.
18441
18442 .conf subject string$**$ unset
18443 This specifies the contents of the ::Subject:: header when the message is
18444 specified by the transport.
18445 .em
18446 It is tempting to quote the original subject in automatic responses. For
18447 example:
18448 .display asis
18449 subject = Re: $h_subject:
18450 .endd
18451 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
18452 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
18453 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
18454 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
18455 small.
18456 .nem
18457
18458 .conf text string$**$ unset
18459 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
18460 message is specified by the transport. If both \text\ and \file\ are set, the
18461 text comes first.
18462
18463 .conf to string$**$ unset
18464 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the ::To:: header
18465 when the message is specified by the transport.
18466
18467 .endconf
18468
18469
18470
18471 .
18472 .
18473 .
18474 .
18475 . ============================================================================
18476 .chapter The lmtp transport
18477 .set runningfoot "lmtp transport"
18478 .index transports||\%lmtp%\
18479 .index \%lmtp%\ transport
18480 .index LMTP||over a pipe
18481 .index LMTP||over a socket
18482 .rset CHAPLMTP "~~chapter"
18483 The \%lmtp%\ transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
18484 specified command
18485 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
18486 This transport is something of a cross between the \%pipe%\ and \%smtp%\
18487 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
18488 implemented as an option for the \%smtp%\ transport. Because LMTP is expected
18489 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in \(src/EDITME)\
18490 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
18491 .display asis
18492 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
18493 .endd
18494 is present in your \(Local/Makefile)\ in order to have the \%lmtp%\ transport
18495 included in the Exim binary.
18496
18497 The private options of the \%lmtp%\ transport are as follows:
18498
18499 .startconf lmtp
18500 .index options||\%lmtp%\ transport
18501
18502 .conf batch@_id string$**$ unset
18503 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter ~~CHAPbatching.
18504
18505 .conf batch@_max integer 1
18506 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
18507 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
18508 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
18509 batching in chapter ~~CHAPbatching.
18510
18511 .conf command string$**$ unset
18512 This option must be set if \socket\ is not set.
18513 The string is a command which is run in a separate process. It is split up into
18514 a command name and list of arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so
18515 expansion cannot change the number of arguments). The command is run directly,
18516 not via a shell. The message is passed to the new process using the standard
18517 input and output to operate the LMTP protocol.
18518
18519 .conf socket string$**$ unset
18520 This option must be set if \command\ is not set. The result of expansion must
18521 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
18522 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
18523
18524 .conf timeout time 5m
18525 The transport is aborted if the created process
18526 or Unix domain socket
18527 does not respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout.
18528
18529 .endconf
18530
18531 Here is an example of a typical LMTP transport:
18532 .display asis
18533 lmtp:
18534 driver = lmtp
18535 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
18536 batch_max = 20
18537 user = exim
18538 .endd
18539 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
18540 necessary, running as the user \*exim*\.
18541
18542
18543
18544 .
18545 .
18546 .
18547 .
18548 . ============================================================================
18549 .chapter The pipe transport
18550 .rset CHAPpipetransport "~~chapter"
18551 .set runningfoot "pipe transport"
18552 .index transports||\%pipe%\
18553 .index \%pipe%\ transport
18554 The \%pipe%\ transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
18555 running in another process.
18556 .em
18557 One example is the
18558 use of \%pipe%\ as a pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other
18559 delivery mechanism (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to
18560 automatically process their incoming messages. The \%pipe%\ transport can be
18561 used in one of the following ways:
18562 .nem
18563 .numberpars $.
18564 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the transport
18565 is configured as a \%pipe%\ transport. In this case, \$local@_part$\ contains
18566 the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run is
18567 specified by the \command\ option on the transport.
18568 .nextp
18569 .em
18570 If the \batch@_max\ option is set greater than 1 (the default), the transport
18571 can be called upon to handle more than one address in a single run. In this
18572 case, \$local@_part$\ is not set (because it is not unique). However, the
18573 pseudo-variable \$pipe@_addresses$\ (described in section ~~SECThowcommandrun
18574 below) contains all the addresses that are being handled.
18575 .nem
18576 .nextp
18577 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
18578 alias or forward file). In this case, \$local@_part$\ contains the local part
18579 that was redirected, and \$address@_pipe$\ contains the text of the pipe
18580 command itself. The \command\ option on the transport is ignored.
18581 .endp
18582
18583 The \%pipe%\ transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
18584 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
18585 implemented by the \%lmtp%\ transport.
18586
18587 In the case when \%pipe%\ is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
18588 \(.forward)\ file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
18589 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
18590 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and `home'
18591 directories are also controllable. See chapter ~~CHAPenvironment for details of
18592 the local delivery environment.
18593
18594
18595 .em
18596 .section Concurrent delivery
18597 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
18598 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
18599 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
18600 write to a file, the \exim@_lock\ utility might be of use.
18601 .nem
18602
18603
18604 .section Returned status and data
18605 .index \%pipe%\ transport||returned data
18606 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
18607 have failed, unless either the \ignore@_status\ option is set (in which case
18608 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
18609 in the \temp@_errors\ option, which are interpreted as meaning `try again
18610 later'. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
18611 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
18612 `local delivery failed'.
18613
18614 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
18615 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
18616 value is the return code minus 128.
18617
18618 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if \*execve()*\ fails), the
18619 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
18620 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
18621 a non-existent command may be the problem.
18622
18623 The \return@_output\ option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
18624 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
18625 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
18626 return code or if \ignore@_status\ is set. The output from the command is
18627 included as part of the bounce message. The \return@_fail@_output\ option is
18628 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
18629 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
18630 \temp@_errors\.
18631
18632
18633 .section How the command is run
18634 .rset SECThowcommandrun "~~chapter.~~section"
18635 .index \%pipe%\ transport||path for command
18636 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
18637 by the \%pipe%\ transport itself. The \allow@_commands\ and \restrict@_to@_path\
18638 options can be used to restrict the commands that may be run.
18639 .index quoting||in pipe command
18640 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
18641 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
18642 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
18643
18644 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
18645 traditional \(.forward)\ file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
18646 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
18647 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
18648 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
18649 .display asis
18650 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xxx}{yyy}}
18651 .endd
18652 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
18653 arguments. You have to write
18654 .display asis
18655 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xxx}{yyy}}"
18656 .endd
18657 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
18658 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
18659 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
18660 interact with external quoting.
18661
18662 .index transport||filter
18663 .index filter||transport filter
18664 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
18665 `$tt{@$pipe@_addresses}'. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
18666 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
18667 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
18668 inserted in the argument list at that point $it{as a separate argument}. This
18669 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
18670 \%pipe%\ transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
18671
18672 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
18673 in a subprocess directly from the transport, $it{not} under a shell. The
18674 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
18675 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
18676 read by Exim. The \max@_output\ option controls how much output the command may
18677 produce, and the \return@_output\ and \return@_fail@_output\ options control
18678 what is done with it.
18679
18680 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
18681 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
18682 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
18683 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
18684 where existing commands (for example, in \(.forward)\ files) expect to be run
18685 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
18686 an option called \use@_shell\, which changes the way the \%pipe%\ transport
18687 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
18688 as a single string and passes the result to \(/bin/sh)\. The
18689 \restrict@_to@_path\ option and the \$pipe@_addresses$\ facility cannot be used
18690 with \use@_shell\, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
18691
18692
18693 .section Environment variables
18694 .rset SECTpipeenv "~~chapter.~~section"
18695 .index \%pipe%\ transport||environment for command
18696 .index environment for pipe transport
18697 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
18698 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
18699 the \environment\ option can be used to add additional variables to this
18700 environment.
18701 .display flow
18702 .tabs 20
18703 DOMAIN $t $rm{the domain of the address}
18704 HOME $t $rm{the home directory, if set}
18705 HOST $t $rm{the host name when called from a router (see below)}
18706 LOCAL@_PART $t $rm{see below}
18707 LOCAL@_PART@_PREFIX $t $rm{see below}
18708 LOCAL@_PART@_SUFFIX $t $rm{see below}
18709 LOGNAME $t $rm{see below}
18710 MESSAGE@_ID $t $rm{the message's id}
18711 PATH $t $rm{as specified by the \path\ option below}
18712 QUALIFY@_DOMAIN $t $rm{the sender qualification domain}
18713 RECIPIENT $t $rm{the complete recipient address}
18714 SENDER $t $rm{the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)}
18715 SHELL $t `$tt{/bin/sh}'
18716 TZ $t $rm{the value of the \timezone\ option, if set}
18717 USER $t $rm{see below}
18718 .endd
18719
18720 When a \%pipe%\ transport is called directly from (for example) an \%accept%\
18721 router, \\LOCAL@_PART\\ is set to the local part of the address. When it is
18722 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, \\LOCAL@_PART\\ is set to
18723 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
18724 removed from the local part, and made available in \\LOCAL@_PART@_PREFIX\\ and
18725 \\LOCAL@_PART@_SUFFIX\\, respectively. \\LOGNAME\\ and \\USER\\ are set to the
18726 same value as \\LOCAL@_PART\\ for compatibility with other MTAs.
18727
18728 .index \\HOST\\
18729 \\HOST\\ is set only when a \%pipe%\ transport is called from a router that
18730 associates hosts with an address, typically when using \%pipe%\ as a
18731 pseudo-remote transport. \\HOST\\ is set to the first host name specified by
18732 the router.
18733
18734 .index \\HOME\\
18735 If the transport's generic \home@_directory\ option is set, its value is used
18736 for the \\HOME\\ environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
18737 by the router's \transport@_home@_directory\ option, which defaults to the
18738 user's home directory if \check@_local@_user\ is set.
18739
18740 .section Private options for pipe
18741 .index options||\%pipe%\ transport
18742
18743 .startconf pipe
18744
18745 .conf allow@_commands "string list$**$" unset
18746 .index \%pipe%\ transport||permitted commands
18747 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
18748 permitted commands. If \restrict@_to@_path\ is not set, the only commands
18749 permitted are those in the \allow@_commands\ list. They need not be absolute
18750 paths; the \path\ option is still used for relative paths. If
18751 \restrict@_to@_path\ is set with \allow@_commands\, the command must either be
18752 in the \allow@_commands\ list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
18753 the path. In other words, if neither \allow@_commands\ nor \restrict@_to@_path\
18754 is set, there is no restriction on the command, but otherwise only commands
18755 that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For example, if
18756 .display asis
18757 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
18758 .endd
18759 and \restrict@_to@_path\ is not set, the only permitted command is
18760 \(/usr/bin/vacation)\. The \allow@_commands\ option may not be set if
18761 \use@_shell\ is set.
18762
18763 .conf batch@_id string$**$ unset
18764 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter ~~CHAPbatching.
18765
18766 .conf batch@_max integer 1
18767 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
18768 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter ~~CHAPbatching.
18769
18770 .conf check@_string string unset
18771 As \%pipe%\ writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
18772 \check@_string\, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
18773 by the contents of \escape@_string\, provided both are set. The value of
18774 \check@_string\ is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
18775 any letters it contains is significant. When \use@_bsmtp\ is set, the contents
18776 of \check@_string\ and \escape@_string\ are forced to values that implement the
18777 SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
18778 ignored.
18779
18780 .conf command string$**$ unset
18781 This option need not be set when \%pipe%\ is being used to deliver to pipes
18782 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
18783 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
18784 the \path\ option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
18785 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
18786 ~~SECThowcommandrun above.
18787
18788 .conf environment string$**$ unset
18789 .index \%pipe%\ transport||environment for command
18790 .index environment for \%pipe%\ transport
18791 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
18792 command runs (see section ~~SECTpipeenv for the default list). Its value is a
18793 string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
18794 environment settings of the form `<<name>>=<<value>>'.
18795
18796 .conf escape@_string string unset
18797 See \check@_string\ above.
18798
18799 .conf freeze@_exec@_fail boolean false
18800 .index exec failure
18801 .index failure of exec
18802 .index \%pipe%\ transport||failure of exec
18803 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
18804 any other failure while running the command. However, if \freeze@_exec@_fail\
18805 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
18806 frozen, whatever the setting of \ignore@_status\.
18807
18808 .conf ignore@_status boolean false
18809 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
18810 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
18811 Otherwise, a non-zero status
18812 or termination by signal
18813 causes an error return from the transport unless the status value is one of
18814 those listed in \temp@_errors\; these cause the delivery to be deferred and
18815 tried again later.
18816
18817 .conf log@_defer@_output boolean false
18818 .index \%pipe%\ transport||logging output
18819 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
18820 one of the codes listed in \temp@_errors\ (that is, delivery was deferred),
18821 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
18822
18823 .conf log@_fail@_output boolean false
18824 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
18825 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
18826 \temp@_errors\ (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
18827 written to the main log.
18828 .em
18829 This option and \log@_output\ are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be
18830 set.
18831 .nem
18832
18833 .conf log@_output boolean false
18834 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
18835 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code.
18836 .em
18837 This option and \log@_fail@_output\ are mutually exclusive. Only one of them
18838 may be set.
18839 .nem
18840
18841 .conf max@_output integer 20K
18842 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
18843 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
18844 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
18845 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
18846 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
18847 \return@_output\). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
18848 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
18849
18850 .conf message@_prefix string$**$ "see below"
18851 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
18852 The default is unset if \use@_bsmtp\ is set. Otherwise it is
18853 .display asis
18854 message_prefix = \
18855 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
18856 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
18857 .endd
18858 .index Cyrus
18859 .index \tmail\
18860 .index `From' line
18861 This is required by the commonly used \(/usr/bin/vacation)\ program.
18862 However, it must $it{not} be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
18863 or to the \tmail\ local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by setting
18864 .display asis
18865 message_prefix =
18866 .endd
18867
18868 .conf message@_suffix string$**$ "see below"
18869 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
18870 The default is unset if \use@_bsmtp\ is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
18871 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
18872 .display asis
18873 message_suffix =
18874 .endd
18875
18876 .conf path string $tt{/usr/bin}
18877 This option specifies the string that is set up in the \\PATH\\ environment
18878 variable of the subprocess. If the \command\ option does not yield an absolute
18879 path name, the command is sought in the \\PATH\\ directories, in the usual way.
18880 \**Warning**\: This does not apply to a command specified as a transport
18881 filter.
18882
18883 .conf pipe@_as@_creator boolean false
18884 .index uid (user id)||local delivery
18885 If the generic \user\ option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
18886 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
18887 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
18888 \group\ option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
18889 accept the message is used.
18890
18891 .conf restrict@_to@_path boolean false
18892 When this option is set, any command name not listed in \allow@_commands\ must
18893 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
18894 in the \path\ option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
18895 command has been generated from a user's \(.forward)\ file. This is usually
18896 handled by a \%pipe%\ transport called \address@_pipe\.
18897
18898 .conf return@_fail@_output boolean false
18899 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
18900 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in \temp@_errors\ (that
18901 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
18902 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
18903 message), output from the command is discarded.
18904 .em
18905 This option and \return@_output\ are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
18906 be set.
18907 .nem
18908
18909 .conf return@_output boolean false
18910 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
18911 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
18912 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
18913 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
18914 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
18915 option.
18916 .em
18917 This option and \return@_fail@_output\ are mutually exclusive. Only one of them
18918 may be set.
18919 .nem
18920
18921 .conf temp@_errors "string list" "see below"
18922 .index \%pipe%\ transport||temporary failure
18923 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
18924 asterisk. If \ignore@_status\ is false
18925 and \return@_output\ is not set,
18926 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
18927 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
18928 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
18929 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
18930 defined by \\EX@_TEMPFAIL\\ and \\EX@_CANTCREAT\\ in \(sysexits.h)\. If Exim is
18931 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
18932 and 73, respectively.
18933
18934 .conf timeout time 1h
18935 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
18936 causes the delivery to fail. A zero time interval specifies no timeout. In
18937 order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the command are also killed,
18938 Exim makes the initial process a process group leader, and kills the whole
18939 process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated if one of the
18940 processes starts a new process group.
18941
18942 .conf umask "octal integer" 022
18943 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
18944
18945 .conf use@_bsmtp boolean false
18946 .index envelope sender
18947 If this option is set true, the \%pipe%\ transport writes messages in `batch
18948 SMTP' format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
18949 commands. If you want to include a leading \\HELO\\ command with such messages,
18950 you can do so by setting the \message@_prefix\ option. See section
18951 ~~SECTbatchSMTP for details of batch SMTP.
18952
18953 .conf use@_crlf boolean false
18954 .index carriage return
18955 .index linefeed
18956 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
18957 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
18958 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
18959 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
18960
18961 The contents of the \message@_prefix\ and \message@_suffix\ options are written
18962 verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these are
18963 needed. Since the default values for both \message@_prefix\ and
18964 \message@_suffix\ end with a single linefeed, their values
18965 must
18966 be changed to end with \"@\r@\n"\ if \use@_crlf\ is set.
18967
18968 .conf use@_shell boolean false
18969 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to \(/bin/sh)\
18970 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
18971 ~~SECThowcommandrun. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
18972 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
18973 modified. The \allow@_commands\ and \restrict@_to@_path\ options, and the
18974 `$tt{@$pipe@_addresses}' facility are incompatible with \use@_shell\. The
18975 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to \(/bin/sh)\ as data for
18976 its \-c-\ option.
18977
18978 .endconf
18979
18980 .section Using an external local delivery agent
18981 .index local delivery||using an external agent
18982 .index \*procmail*\
18983 .index external local delivery
18984 .index delivery||\*procmail*\
18985 .index delivery||by external agent
18986 The \%pipe%\ transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
18987 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as \procmail\. When doing
18988 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
18989 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
18990 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
18991 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
18992 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
18993 configuration for \procmail\:
18994 .display asis
18995 # transport
18996 procmail_pipe:
18997 driver = pipe
18998 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
18999 return_path_add
19000 delivery_date_add
19001 envelope_to_add
19002 check_string = "From "
19003 escape_string = ">From "
19004 user = $local_part
19005 group = mail
19006 .endd
19007 .display asis
19008 # router
19009 procmail:
19010 driver = accept
19011 check_local_user
19012 transport = procmail_pipe
19013 .endd
19014
19015 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
19016 \*mail*\. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as \*mail*\
19017 or \*exim*\, but in this case you must arrange for \procmail\ to trust that
19018 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a \group\
19019 or a \user\ option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The home
19020 directory is the user's home directory by default.
19021
19022 Note that the command that the pipe transport runs does $it{not} begin with
19023 .display asis
19024 IFS=" "
19025 .endd
19026 as shown in the \procmail\ documentation, because Exim does not by default use
19027 a shell to run pipe commands.
19028
19029 .index Cyrus
19030 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
19031 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
19032 .display asis
19033 # transport
19034 local_delivery_cyrus:
19035 driver = pipe
19036 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
19037 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
19038 user = cyrus
19039 group = mail
19040 return_output
19041 log_output
19042 message_prefix =
19043 message_suffix =
19044 .endd
19045 .display asis
19046 # router
19047 local_user_cyrus:
19048 driver = accept
19049 check_local_user
19050 local_part_suffix = .*
19051 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
19052 .endd
19053 Note the unsetting of \message@_prefix\ and \message@_suffix\, and the use of
19054 \return@_output\ to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
19055 sender.
19056
19057
19058 .
19059 .
19060 .
19061 .
19062 . ============================================================================
19063 .chapter The smtp transport
19064 .rset CHAPsmtptrans "~~chapter"
19065 .set runningfoot "smtp transport"
19066 .index transports||\%smtp%\
19067 .index \%smtp%\ transport
19068 The \%smtp%\ transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
19069 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
19070 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
19071 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
19072 ~~CHAPretry) is applied to each IP address independently.
19073
19074 .section Multiple messages on a single connection
19075 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
19076 two ways:
19077 .numberpars $.
19078 If a message contains more than \max@_rcpt\ (see below) addresses that are
19079 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
19080 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
19081 the \%smtp%\ transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually does
19082 when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the value
19083 of the global \remote@_max@_parallel\ option. Details are given in section
19084 ~~SECToutSMTPTCP.)
19085 .nextp
19086 .index hints database||remembering routing
19087 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
19088 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
19089 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
19090 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
19091 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
19092 process.
19093 .endp
19094
19095 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
19096 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of \connection@_max@_messages\,
19097 no further messages are sent over that connection.
19098
19099
19100 .section Use of the @$host variable
19101 .index \$host$\
19102 .index \$host@_address$\
19103 At the start of a run of the \%smtp%\ transport, the values of \$host$\ and
19104 \$host@_address$\ are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
19105 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
19106 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, \$host$\ and
19107 \$host@_address$\ are set to the values for that host. These are the values
19108 that are in force when the \helo@_data\, \hosts@_try@_auth\, \interface\,
19109 \serialize@_hosts\, and the various TLS options are expanded.
19110
19111
19112 .section Private options for smtp
19113 The private options of the \%smtp%\ transport are as follows:
19114
19115 .index options||\%smtp%\ transport
19116 .startconf smtp
19117 .conf allow@_localhost boolean false
19118 .index local host||sending to
19119 .index fallback||hosts specified on transport
19120 When a host specified in \hosts\ or \fallback@_hosts\ (see below) turns out to
19121 be the local host, or is listed in \hosts@_treat@_as@_local\, delivery is
19122 deferred by default. However, if \allow@_localhost\ is set, Exim goes on to do
19123 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
19124 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
19125 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
19126
19127 .conf authenticated@_sender string$**$ unset
19128 .index Cyrus
19129 When Exim has authenticated as a client, this option sets a value for the
19130 \\AUTH=\\ item on outgoing \\MAIL\\ commands, overriding any existing
19131 authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is forced to fail, the
19132 option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery to be deferred. If
19133 the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also ignored.
19134
19135 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
19136 \authenticated@_sender\ still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
19137 deferred if it fails), but no \\AUTH=\\ item is added to \\MAIL\\ commands.
19138
19139 This option allows you to use the \%smtp%\ transport in LMTP mode to
19140 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
19141 `authenticated sender', via a setting such as:
19142 .display asis
19143 authenticated_sender = $local_part
19144 .endd
19145 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
19146 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
19147
19148 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
19149 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
19150 value.
19151
19152 .conf command@_timeout time 5m
19153 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
19154 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
19155 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
19156
19157 .conf connect@_timeout time 5m
19158 This sets a timeout for the \*connect()*\ function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
19159 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
19160 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
19161 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
19162 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
19163 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
19164
19165 .index SMTP||passed connection
19166 .index SMTP||multiple deliveries
19167 .index multiple SMTP deliveries
19168 .conf connection@_max@_messages integer 500
19169 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
19170 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
19171 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the \-oB-\ command line
19172 option.
19173
19174 .conf data@_timeout time 5m
19175 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
19176 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
19177 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also \final@_timeout\.
19178
19179 .conf delay@_after@_cutoff boolean true
19180 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
19181 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
19182 cutoff times.
19183
19184 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
19185 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
19186 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
19187 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
19188 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
19189 unhappy at this prospect, so...
19190
19191 If \delay@_after@_cutoff\ is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
19192 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
19193 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
19194 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
19195 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
19196 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
19197 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
19198 \delay@_after@_cutoff\ means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
19199 to them.
19200
19201 .conf dns@_qualify@_single boolean true
19202 If the \hosts\ or \fallback@_hosts\ option is being used,
19203 and the \gethostbyname\ option is false,
19204 the \\RES@_DEFNAMES\\ resolver option is set. See the \qualify@_single\ option
19205 in chapter ~~CHAPdnslookup for more details.
19206
19207 .conf dns@_search@_parents boolean false
19208 .index \search@_parents\
19209 If the \hosts\ or \fallback@_hosts\ option is being used, and the
19210 \gethostbyname\ option is false, the \\RES@_DNSRCH\\ resolver option is set.
19211 See the \search@_parents\ option in chapter ~~CHAPdnslookup for more details.
19212
19213
19214 .conf fallback@_hosts "string list" unset
19215 .index fallback||hosts specified on transport
19216 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
19217 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. Fallback hosts can also be
19218 specified on routers, which associate them with the addresses they process. As
19219 for the \hosts\ option without \hosts@_override\, \fallback@_hosts\ specified
19220 on the transport is used only if the address does not have its own associated
19221 fallback host list. Unlike \hosts\, a setting of \fallback@_hosts\ on an
19222 address is not overridden by \hosts@_override\. However, \hosts@_randomize\
19223 does apply to fallback host lists.
19224
19225 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
19226 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
19227 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
19228 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
19229 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
19230
19231 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
19232 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
19233 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and \max@_rcpt\ permits it), a single
19234 copy of the message is sent.
19235
19236 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
19237 \gethostbyname\ option, as for the \hosts\ option. Fallback hosts apply
19238 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
19239 from \hosts\. This option provides a `use a smart host only if delivery fails'
19240 facility.
19241
19242 .conf final@_timeout time 10m
19243 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
19244 line containing just `.' that terminates a message. Its value must not be zero.
19245
19246 .conf gethostbyname boolean false
19247 If this option is true when the \hosts\ and/or \fallback@_hosts\ options are
19248 being used, names are looked up using \*gethostbyname()*\
19249 (or \*getipnodebyname()*\ when available)
19250 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
19251 it may also consult other sources of information such as \(/etc/hosts)\.
19252
19253 .index \\HELO\\||argument, setting
19254 .index \\EHLO\\||argument, setting
19255 .conf helo@_data string$**$ $tt{@$primary@_hostname}
19256 The value of this option is expanded, and used as the argument for the \\EHLO\\
19257 or \\HELO\\ command that starts the outgoing SMTP session.
19258
19259 .conf hosts "string list$**$" unset
19260 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as \%dnslookup%\, which
19261 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS. However, addresses
19262 can be passed to the \%smtp%\ transport by any router, and not all of them can
19263 provide an associated host list. The \hosts\ option specifies a list of hosts
19264 which are used if the address being processed does not have any hosts
19265 associated with it. The hosts specified by \hosts\ are also used, whether or
19266 not the address has its own hosts, if \hosts@_override\ is set.
19267
19268 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
19269 list of host names or IP addresses. If the expansion fails, delivery is
19270 deferred. Unless the failure was caused by the inability to complete a lookup,
19271 the error is logged to the panic log as well as the main log. Host names are
19272 looked up either by searching directly for address records in the DNS or by
19273 calling \*gethostbyname()*\
19274 (or \*getipnodebyname()*\ when available),
19275 depending on the setting of the \gethostbyname\ option. When Exim is compiled
19276 with IPv6 support, if a host that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and
19277 IPv6 addresses, both types of address are used.
19278
19279 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
19280 unless \hosts@_randomize\ is set.
19281
19282 .conf hosts@_avoid@_esmtp "host list$**$" unset
19283 .index ESMTP, avoiding use of
19284 .index \\HELO\\||forcing use of
19285 .index \\EHLO\\||avoiding use of
19286 .index \\PIPELINING\\||avoiding the use of
19287 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
19288 example, \\PIPELINING\\) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
19289 matches \hosts@_avoid@_esmtp\, Exim sends \\HELO\\ rather than \\EHLO\\ at the
19290 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
19291 facilities such as \\AUTH\\, \\PIPELINING\\, \\SIZE\\, and \\STARTTLS\\.
19292
19293 .conf hosts@_avoid@_tls "host list$**$" unset
19294 .index TLS||avoiding for certain hosts
19295 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
19296 matches this list. See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for details of TLS.
19297
19298 .conf hosts@_max@_try integer 5
19299 .index host||maximum number to try
19300 .index limit||number of hosts tried
19301 .index limit||number of MX tried
19302 .index MX record||maximum tried
19303 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
19304 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
19305 ~~SECTvalhosmax describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
19306
19307 .em
19308 .conf hosts@_max@_try@_hardlimit integer 50
19309 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
19310 tries for any one delivery. Section ~~SECTvalhosmax describes its use and why
19311 it exists.
19312 .nem
19313
19314 .conf hosts@_nopass@_tls "host list$**$" unset
19315 .index TLS||passing connection
19316 .index multiple SMTP deliveries
19317 .index TLS||multiple message deliveries
19318 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
19319 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
19320 message on the same connection. See section ~~SECTmulmessam for an explanation
19321 of when this might be needed.
19322
19323 .conf hosts@_override boolean false
19324 If this option is set and the \hosts\ option is also set, any hosts that are
19325 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
19326 \hosts\ option are always used. This option does not apply to
19327 \fallback@_hosts\.
19328
19329 .conf hosts@_randomize boolean false
19330 .index randomized host list
19331 .index host||list of, randomized
19332 .index fallback||randomized hosts
19333 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
19334 \hosts\ or the \fallback@_hosts\ option, or the hosts supplied by the router
19335 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
19336 router), and were not randomizied by the router, the order of trying the hosts
19337 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
19338 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
19339
19340 When \hosts@_randomize\ is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
19341 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
19342 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
19343 \"+"\ in the host list. For example:
19344 .display asis
19345 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19346 .endd
19347 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19348 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19349 If \hosts@_randomize\ is not set, a \"+"\ item in the list is ignored.
19350
19351 .index authentication||required by client
19352 .conf hosts@_require@_auth "host list$**$" unset
19353 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
19354 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
19355 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
19356 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
19357 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
19358 hard failure if required. See also \hosts@_try@_auth\, and chapter
19359 ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH for details of authentication.
19360
19361 .conf hosts@_require@_tls "host list$**$" unset
19362 .index TLS||requiring for certain servers
19363 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
19364 matches this list. See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for details of TLS.
19365 \**Note**\: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
19366 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
19367
19368 .index authentication||optional in client
19369 .conf hosts@_try@_auth "host list$**$" unset
19370 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
19371 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
19372 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
19373 unauthenticated. See also \hosts@_require@_auth\, and chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH
19374 for details of authentication.
19375
19376 .index bind IP address
19377 .index IP address||binding
19378 .conf interface "string list$**$" unset
19379 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
19380 call. The variables \$host$\ and \$host@_address$\ refer to the host to which a
19381 connection is about to be made during the expansion of the string. Forced
19382 expansion failure, or an empty string result causes the option to be ignored.
19383 Otherwise, after expansion,
19384 the string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
19385 separator can be changed in the usual way.
19386 For example:
19387 .display asis
19388 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
19389 .endd
19390 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
19391 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
19392 \interface\ is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
19393 interface to use if the host has more than one.
19394
19395 .conf keepalive boolean true
19396 .index keepalive||on outgoing connection
19397 This option controls the setting of \\SO@_KEEPALIVE\\ on outgoing TCP/IP socket
19398 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
19399 periodically, by sending packets with `old' sequence numbers. The other end of
19400 the connection should send a acknowledgement if the connection is still okay or
19401 a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is that
19402 it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection that can
19403 get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the TCP/IP
19404 call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
19405 unreachable hosts.
19406
19407 .conf max@_rcpt integer 100
19408 .index \\RCPT\\||maximum number of outgoing
19409 This option limits the number of \\RCPT\\ commands that are sent in a single
19410 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
19411 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if \remote@_max@_parallel\
19412 permits this.
19413
19414 .conf multi@_domain boolean true
19415 When this option is set, the \%smtp%\ transport can handle a number of addresses
19416 containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve to the same
19417 list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to handling only
19418 one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use \$domain$\ in an
19419 expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there is a single
19420 domain involved in a remote delivery.
19421
19422 .conf port string$**$ "see below"
19423 .index port||sending TCP/IP
19424 .index TCP/IP||setting outgoing port
19425 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects. If
19426 it begins with a digit it is taken as a port number; otherwise it is looked up
19427 using \*getservbyname()*\. The default value is normally `smtp', but if
19428 \protocol\ is set to `lmtp', the default is `lmtp'.
19429 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery is
19430 deferred.
19431
19432
19433 .conf protocol string "smtp"
19434 .index LMTP||over TCP/IP
19435 If this option is set to `lmtp' instead of `smtp', the default value for the
19436 \port\ option changes to `lmtp', and the transport operates the LMTP protocol
19437 (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
19438 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
19439 over a pipe to a local process -- see chapter ~~CHAPLMTP.
19440
19441 .conf retry@_include@_ip@_address boolean true
19442 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
19443 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
19444 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
19445 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
19446 addresses is not affected.
19447
19448 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
19449 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
19450 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
19451 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
19452 instance of the \%smtp%\ transport, set up specially to handle the dialup hosts.
19453
19454 .conf serialize@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
19455 .index serializing connections
19456 .index host||serializing connections
19457 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
19458 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
19459 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
19460 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
19461 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
19462 \serialize@_hosts\ to match the relevant hosts.
19463
19464 .index hints database||serializing deliveries to a host
19465 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
19466 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
19467 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
19468 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
19469 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
19470
19471 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
19472 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
19473 start with \(misc)\ and they are kept in the \(spool/db)\ directory. There
19474 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
19475 are used for ETRN serialization.
19476
19477 .conf size@_addition integer 1024
19478 .index SMTP||\\SIZE\\
19479 .index message||size issue for transport filter
19480 .index size||of message
19481 .index transport||filter
19482 .index filter||transport filter
19483 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the \\SIZE\\ option of the
19484 \\MAIL\\ command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
19485 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of \size@_addition\ to the value it
19486 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
19487 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
19488 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
19489
19490 Alternatively, if the value of \size@_addition\ is set negative, it disables
19491 the use of the \\SIZE\\ option altogether.
19492
19493 .conf tls@_certificate string$**$ unset
19494 .index TLS||client certificate, location of
19495 .index certificate||for client, location of
19496 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
19497 client's certificate, for use when sending a message over an encrypted
19498 connection. The values of \$host$\ and \$host@_address$\ are set to the name
19499 and address of the server during the expansion. See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for
19500 details of TLS.
19501
19502 \**Note**\: This option must be set if you want Exim to use TLS when sending
19503 messages as a client. The global option of the same name specifies the
19504 certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically assumed that the same
19505 certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a client.
19506
19507 .conf tls@_crl string$**$ unset
19508 .index TLS||client certificate revocation list
19509 .index certificate||revocation list for client
19510 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
19511 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
19512
19513 .conf tls@_privatekey string$**$ unset
19514 .index TLS||client private key, location of
19515 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
19516 client's private key, for use when sending a message over an encrypted
19517 connection. The values of \$host$\ and \$host@_address$\ are set to the name
19518 and address of the server during the expansion.
19519 If this option is unset, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
19520 the certificate.
19521 See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for details of TLS.
19522
19523 .conf tls@_require@_ciphers string$**$ unset
19524 .index TLS||requiring specific ciphers
19525 .index cipher||requiring specific
19526 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
19527 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
19528 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of \$host$\ and
19529 \$host@_address$\ are set to the name and address of the server during the
19530 expansion. See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for details of TLS; note that this option is
19531 used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections ~~SECTreqciphssl and
19532 ~~SECTreqciphgnu).
19533 .em
19534 For GnuTLS, the order of the ciphers is a preference order.
19535 .nem
19536
19537 .conf tls@_tempfail@_tryclear boolean true
19538 When the server host is not in \hosts@_require@_tls\, and there is a problem in
19539 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
19540 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
19541 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
19542 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4\*xx*\
19543 response to \\STARTTLS\\. Also, if \\STARTTLS\\ is accepted, but the subsequent
19544 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
19545 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
19546 in clear.
19547
19548 .conf tls@_verify@_certificates string$**$ unset
19549 .index TLS||server certificate verification
19550 .index certificate||verification of server
19551 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
19552 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
19553 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
19554 \tls@_verify@_certificates\ to the name of a directory containing certificate
19555 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
19556 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of \$host$\ and
19557 \$host@_address$\ are set to the name and address of the server during the
19558 expansion of this option. See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for details of TLS.
19559
19560 .endconf
19561
19562
19563 .section How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used
19564 .rset SECTvalhosmax "~~chapter.~~section"
19565 .index host||maximum number to try
19566 .index limit||hosts, maximum number tried
19567 .em
19568 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
19569 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are \hosts@_max@_try\ and
19570 \hosts@_max@_try@_hardlimit\.
19571 .nem
19572
19573 The \hosts@_max@_try\ option limits the number of hosts that are tried
19574 for a single delivery. However, despite the term `host' in its name, the option
19575 actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a multihomed
19576 host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for retrying.
19577
19578 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
19579 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
19580 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
19581
19582 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
19583 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
19584 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
19585 \hosts@_max@_try\ is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
19586 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
19587
19588 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
19589 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
19590 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
19591 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
19592 \hosts@_max@_retry\ may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
19593 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
19594 see below for an exception).
19595
19596 Secondly, when the \hosts@_max@_try\ limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
19597 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
19598 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
19599 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
19600 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
19601
19602 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
19603 higher MX value. If \hosts@_max@_try\ is small (the default is 5) only a few
19604 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
19605 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
19606 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
19607 reached their retry times.
19608
19609 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
19610 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
19611 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
19612 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
19613 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
19614 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried
19615 .em
19616 until all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days),
19617 because there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry
19618 times. With the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each
19619 MX value at every delivery attempt, even if the \hosts@_max@_try\ limit has
19620 already been reached.
19621
19622 The above logic means that \hosts@_max@_try\ is not a hard limit, and in
19623 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
19624 out an email address. When \hosts@_max@_try\ was implemented, this seemed a
19625 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
19626 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
19627 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
19628
19629 The \hosts@_max@_try@_hardlimit\ option was added to help with this problem.
19630 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
19631 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
19632 possible IP addresses have been tried.
19633 .nem
19634
19635
19636
19637
19638 .
19639 .
19640 .
19641 .
19642 . ============================================================================
19643 .chapter Address rewriting
19644 .set runningfoot "address rewriting"
19645 .rset CHAPrewrite ~~chapter
19646 .index rewriting||addresses
19647 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
19648 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
19649 (referred to as an `unqualified address') or when an address contains an
19650 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
19651
19652 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
19653 messages, or messages from hosts that match \sender@_unqualified@_hosts\ or
19654 \recipient@_unqualified@_hosts\, respectively. Unqualified addresses in header
19655 lines are qualified if they are in locally submitted messages, or messages from
19656 hosts that are permitted to send unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise,
19657 unqualified addresses in header lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
19658
19659 One situation in which Exim does $it{not} automatically rewrite a domain is
19660 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
19661 such a domain should be rewritten using the `canonical' name, and some MTAs do
19662 this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
19663
19664 .section Explicitly configured address rewriting
19665 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
19666 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
19667 \headers@_rewrite\ option that can be set on any transport.
19668
19669 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
19670 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
19671 facility; you do not have to use it.
19672
19673 The main rewriting rules that appear in the `rewrite' section of the
19674 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
19675 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
19676 address to which it applies.
19677
19678 Rewriting of addresses in header lines applies only to those headers that
19679 were received with the message, and, in the case of transport rewriting, those
19680 that were added by a system filter. That is, it applies only to those headers
19681 that are common to all copies of the message. Header lines that are added by
19682 individual routers or transports (and which are therefore specific to
19683 individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten.
19684
19685 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
19686 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
19687 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
19688 used sparingly, and mainly for `regularizing' addresses in your own domains.
19689 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
19690 discouraged.
19691
19692 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
19693 illustrated by these examples:
19694 .numberpars $.
19695 The company whose domain is \*hitch.fict.example*\ has a number of hosts that
19696 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
19697 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites \*@*.hitch.fict.example*\ as
19698 \*hitch.fict.example*\ when sending mail off-site.
19699 .nextp
19700 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
19701 \*fp42@@hitch.fict.example*\ becomes \*Ford.Prefect@@hitch.fict.example*\.
19702 .endp
19703
19704 .section When does rewriting happen?
19705 .index rewriting||timing of
19706 .index ~~ACL||rewriting addresses in
19707 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
19708 message's processing.
19709
19710 At the start of an ACL for \\MAIL\\, the sender address may have been rewritten
19711 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section ~~SECTrewriteS), but no
19712 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
19713 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
19714 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of \$sender@_address$\ is the
19715 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
19716 \\RCPT\\ ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
19717 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
19718
19719 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for \\RCPT\\, the current recipient's address
19720 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
19721 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
19722 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
19723 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
19724 value of \$local@_part$\ and \$domain$\ after verification are always the same
19725 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten -- except for
19726 SMTP-time rewriting -- address).
19727
19728 Once a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope recipient
19729 addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to the
19730 addresses in the header lines (if configured).
19731 .index \*local@_scan()*\ function||address rewriting, timing of
19732 Thus, all the rewriting is completed before the \\DATA\\ ACL and
19733 \*local@_scan()*\ functions are run.
19734
19735 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
19736 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
19737 redirection, unless \no@_rewrite\ is set on the router.
19738
19739 .index envelope sender, rewriting
19740 .index rewriting||at transport time
19741 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
19742 specified by setting the generic \headers@_rewrite\ option on a transport. This
19743 option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
19744 section of the configuration file. In addition, the outgoing envelope sender
19745 can be rewritten by means of the \return@_path\ transport option. However, it
19746 is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at transport time.
19747
19748
19749
19750 .section Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input
19751 .index rewriting||testing
19752 .index testing||rewriting
19753 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
19754 configuration file headed by `begin rewrite'. It can be tested by the \-brw-\
19755 command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC 2822
19756 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
19757 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
19758 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
19759 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
19760 .display asis
19761 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
19762 .endd
19763 might produce the output
19764 .display asis
19765 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
19766 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
19767 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
19768 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
19769 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
19770 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
19771 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
19772 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
19773 .endd
19774 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
19775 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
19776 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
19777 set for a particular transport.
19778
19779 .section Rewriting rules
19780 .index rewriting||rules
19781 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
19782 rules in the form
19783 .display
19784 <<source pattern>> <<replacement>> <<flags>>
19785 .endd
19786 Rewriting rules that are specified for the \headers@_rewrite\ generic transport
19787 option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list takes the
19788 same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration
19789 (except that any colons must be doubled, of course).
19790
19791 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
19792 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
19793 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
19794 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
19795 ignored.
19796
19797 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
19798 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
19799 replaced by later rules (but see the `q' and `R' flags).
19800
19801 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
19802 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
19803 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
19804 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
19805 address in ::To:: must not assume that the message's address in ::From:: has (or
19806 has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of ::From:: may assume that
19807 the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
19808
19809 The variables \$local@_part$\ and \$domain$\ can be used in the replacement
19810 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
19811 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
19812 .display asis
19813 *@* ${lookup ...
19814 .endd
19815 where the lookup key uses \$1$\ and \$2$\ or \$local@_part$\ and \$domain$\ to
19816 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
19817
19818 .section Rewriting patterns
19819 .index rewriting||patterns
19820 .index address list||in a rewriting pattern
19821 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
19822 address list (see section ~~SECTaddresslist). It is in fact processed as a
19823 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
19824 against the address.
19825
19826 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
19827 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
19828 can use a regular expression that starts with \"^(?i)"\.
19829
19830 .index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in rewriting rules
19831 After matching, the numerical variables \$1$\, \$2$\, etc. may be set,
19832 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
19833 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. \$0$\ always
19834 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
19835 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
19836 of pattern they are set as follows:
19837
19838 .numberpars $.
19839 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
19840 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with \$1$\ associated with
19841 the first asterisk, and \$2$\ with the second, if present. For example, if the
19842 pattern
19843 .display
19844 *queen@@*.fict.example
19845 .endd
19846 is matched against the address \*hearts-queen@@wonderland.fict.example*\ then
19847 .display asis
19848 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
19849 $1 = hearts-
19850 $2 = wonderland
19851 .endd
19852 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
19853 does, it is \$1$\ that contains the wild part of the domain.
19854 .nextp
19855 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
19856 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
19857 for example, that the address \*foo@@bar.baz.example*\ is processed by a
19858 rewriting rule of the form
19859 .display
19860 *@@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file <<replacement string>>
19861 .endd
19862 and the key in the file that matches the domain is \"*.baz.example"\. Then
19863 .display asis
19864 $1 = foo
19865 $2 = bar
19866 $3 = baz.example
19867 .endd
19868 If the address \*foo@@baz.example*\ is looked up, this matches the same
19869 wildcard file entry, and in this case \$2$\ is set to the empty string, but
19870 \$3$\ is still set to \*baz.example*\. If a non-wild key is matched in a
19871 partial lookup, \$2$\ is again set to the empty string and \$3$\ is set to the
19872 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
19873 .endp
19874
19875 .section Rewriting replacements
19876 .index rewriting||replacements
19877 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
19878 match the pattern and the flags are $it{not} rewritten, and no subsequent
19879 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
19880 .display asis
19881 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
19882 .endd
19883 specifies that \*hatta@@lookingglass.fict.example*\ is never to be rewritten in
19884 ::From:: headers.
19885
19886 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
19887 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
19888 \$local@_part$\ and \$domain$\ refer to the address that is being rewritten.
19889 Any letters they contain retain their original case -- they are not lower
19890 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
19891 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
19892 the presence of `fail' in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
19893 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
19894 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
19895 entry written to the panic log.
19896
19897
19898 .section Rewriting flags
19899 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
19900 .numberpars $.
19901 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
19902 c, f, h, r, s, t.
19903 .nextp
19904 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
19905 .nextp
19906 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
19907 .endp
19908 For rules that are part of the \headers@_rewrite\ generic transport option,
19909 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
19910
19911
19912 .section Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite
19913 .index rewriting||flags
19914 If none of the following flag letters, nor the `S' flag (see section
19915 ~~SECTrewriteS) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers and
19916 to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
19917 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
19918 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
19919 .display
19920 E $rm{rewrite all envelope fields}
19921 F $rm{rewrite the envelope From field}
19922 T $rm{rewrite the envelope To field}
19923 b $rm{rewrite the ::Bcc:: header}
19924 c $rm{rewrite the ::Cc:: header}
19925 f $rm{rewrite the ::From:: header}
19926 h $rm{rewrite all headers}
19927 r $rm{rewrite the ::Reply-To:: header}
19928 s $rm{rewrite the ::Sender:: header}
19929 t $rm{rewrite the ::To:: header}
19930 .endd
19931 You should be particularly careful about rewriting ::Sender:: headers, and
19932 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
19933
19934 .section The SMTP-time rewriting flag
19935 .rset SECTrewriteS "~~chapter.~~section"
19936 .index SMTP||rewriting malformed addresses
19937 .index \\RCPT\\||rewriting argument of
19938 .index \\MAIL\\||rewriting argument of
19939 The rewrite flag `S' specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at SMTP
19940 time, as soon as an address is received in a \\MAIL\\ or \\RCPT\\ command, and
19941 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
19942 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
19943 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
19944
19945 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
19946 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, `bang paths' in batched SMTP
19947 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
19948 the variables \$local@_part$\ and \$domain$\ are not available during the
19949 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
19950 original address in the \\MAIL\\ or \\RCPT\\ command.
19951
19952 .section Flags controlling the rewriting process
19953 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
19954 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
19955 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
19956 .numberpars $.
19957 If the `Q' flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
19958 unqualified local part. It is qualified with \qualify@_recipient\. In the
19959 absence of `Q' the rewritten address must always include a domain.
19960 .nextp
19961 If the `q' flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
19962 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a `fail' in the expansion.
19963 The `q' flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type (does not
19964 match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
19965 .nextp
19966 The `R' flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
19967 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the `q' flag, to stop
19968 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
19969 .nextp
19970 .index rewriting||whole addresses
19971 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
19972 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 `phrase'
19973 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
19974 .display asis
19975 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
19976 .endd
19977 into
19978 .display asis
19979 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
19980 .endd
19981 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
19982 done by adding the flag letter `w' to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
19983 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
19984 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
19985 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
19986 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
19987 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047.
19988 The character set is taken from \headers@_charset\, which defaults to
19989 ISO-8859-1.
19990
19991 When the `w' flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
19992 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
19993 .endp
19994
19995 .section Rewriting examples
19996 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
19997 .display asis
19998 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
19999 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
20000 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
20001 .endd
20002 Note the use of `fail' in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
20003 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
20004 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
20005 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the `q' flag is not
20006 present in that rule. An alternative to `fail' would be to supply \$1$\
20007 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
20008 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
20009 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
20010
20011 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
20012 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
20013 .display asis
20014 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
20015 .endd
20016 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
20017 local part \*root*\ at any domain ending in \*hitch.fict.example*\.
20018
20019 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
20020 \${if$\ in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
20021 messages that originate outside the local host:
20022 .display asis
20023 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
20024 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
20025 .endd
20026 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
20027 space.
20028
20029 .index rewriting||bang paths
20030 .index bang paths||rewriting
20031 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of `bang paths'. If it sees such an
20032 address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with the
20033 local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
20034 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
20035 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
20036 components. For example, the rule
20037 .display asis
20038 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
20039 .endd
20040 rewrites a two-component bang path \*host.name!user*\ as the domain address
20041 \*user@@host.name*\. However, there is a security implication in using this as
20042 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
20043 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
20044 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
20045 use the `S' flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
20046 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
20047
20048
20049
20050
20051
20052 .
20053 .
20054 .
20055 .
20056 . ============================================================================
20057 .chapter Retry configuration
20058 .set runningfoot "retry configuration"
20059 .rset CHAPretry ~~chapter
20060 .index retry||configuration, description of
20061 .index configuration file||retry section
20062 The `retry' section of the run time configuration file contains a list of retry
20063 rules which control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot be
20064 delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules, temporary errors
20065 are treated as permanent. The \-brt-\ command line option can be used to test
20066 which retry rule will be used for a given address or domain.
20067
20068 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
20069 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
20070 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
20071 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
20072 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
20073 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the \retry@_defer\ log
20074 selector is set, the message
20075 .index retry||time not reached
20076 `retry time not reached' is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
20077 skipped for this reason. Section ~~SECToutSMTPerr contains more details of the
20078 handling of errors during remote deliveries.
20079
20080 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
20081 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
20082 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
20083 failures to route the domain \*snark.fict.example*\ and failures to deliver to
20084 the host \*snark.fict.example*\. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
20085 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
20086 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
20087 domain are maintained independently.
20088
20089 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
20090 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
20091 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
20092 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
20093 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
20094 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
20095 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
20096 the local address is reached.
20097
20098
20099 .section Retry rules
20100 .index retry||rules
20101 .em
20102 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
20103 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
20104 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
20105 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched in
20106 order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
20107 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
20108 message's sender, respectively.
20109 .nem
20110
20111 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
20112 ~~SECTaddresslist). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list, which
20113 means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that has
20114 been delayed. Address list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were
20115 preceded by `*@@', which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with
20116 just a domain. For example,
20117 .display asis
20118 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
20119 .endd
20120 provides a rule for any address in the \*lookingglass.fict.example*\ domain,
20121 whereas
20122 .display asis
20123 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
20124 .endd
20125 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part \alice\.
20126 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
20127 part.
20128
20129 .index regular expressions||in retry rules
20130 \**Warning**\: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
20131 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
20132 expressions work in address lists.
20133 .display
20134 ^@\Nxyz@\d+@\.abc@\.example@$@\N * G,1h,10m,2 \Wrong\
20135 ^@\N[^@@]+@@xyz@\d+@\.abc@\.example@$@\N * G,1h,10m,2 \Right\
20136 .endd
20137
20138
20139 .section Choosing which retry rule to use
20140 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
20141 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
20142 against the complete address only if \retry__use@_local@_part\ is set for the
20143 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
20144 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with `*'. A
20145 domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
20146 `*@@'. By default, \retry@_use@_local@_part\ is true for routers where
20147 \check@_local@_user\ is true, and false for other routers.
20148
20149 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
20150 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
20151 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
20152 \retry@_use@_local@_part\ is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
20153 local transports).
20154
20155 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt has
20156 failed, what happens depends on the type of failure. After a 4\*xx*\ SMTP
20157 response for a recipient address, the whole address is used when searching the
20158 retry rules. The rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the
20159 failing address.
20160
20161 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address,
20162 (for example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is
20163 checked twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name
20164 (preceded by `*@@' when matching a regular expression). If this does not match
20165 the line, the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For
20166 example, suppose the MX records for \*a.b.c.example*\ are
20167 .display asis
20168 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
20169 MX 6 p.q.r.example
20170 MX 7 m.n.o.example
20171 .endd
20172 and the retry rules are
20173 .display asis
20174 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
20175 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
20176 .endd
20177 and a delivery to the host \*x.y.z.example*\ fails. The first rule matches
20178 neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second rule. This does
20179 not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used to calculate
20180 the retry time for the host \*x.y.z.example*\. Meanwhile, Exim tries to deliver
20181 to \*p.q.r.example*\. If this fails, the first retry rule is used, because it
20182 matches the host.
20183
20184 In other words, failures to deliver to host \*p.q.r.example*\ use the first
20185 rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
20186 \*a.b.c.example*\, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
20187 routing to \*a.b.c.example*\ suffers a temporary failure.
20188
20189 .section Retry rules for specific errors
20190 .index retry||specific errors, specifying
20191 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
20192 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
20193 .em
20194
20195 .push
20196 .indent 2em
20197 .tempindent 0
20198 \auth@_failed\: Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
20199 \hosts@_require@_auth\ list in an \%smtp%\ transport.
20200
20201 .tempindent 0
20202 \rcpt@_4xx\: A 4\*xx*\ error was received for an outgoing \\RCPT\\ command.
20203 Either the first or both of the x's can be given as specific digits, for
20204 example: \"rcpt@_45x"\ or \"rcpt@_436"\. For example, to recognize 452 errors
20205 given to \\RCPT\\ commands by a particular host, and have retries every ten
20206 minutes and a one-hour timeout, you could set up a retry rule of this form:
20207 .display asis
20208 the.host.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
20209 .endd
20210 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the \%smtp%\ transport) and outgoing
20211 LMTP (either the \%lmtp%\ transport, or the \%smtp%\ transport in LMTP mode).
20212 Note, however, that they apply only to responses to \\RCPT\\ commands.
20213
20214 .tempindent 0
20215 \refused@_MX\: A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
20216
20217 .tempindent 0
20218 \refused@_A\: A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was
20219 refused.
20220
20221 .tempindent 0
20222 \refused\: A connection was refused.
20223
20224 .tempindent 0
20225 \timeout@_connect@_MX\: A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX
20226 record timed out.
20227
20228 .tempindent 0
20229 \timeout@_connect@_A\: A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX
20230 record timed out.
20231
20232 .tempindent 0
20233 \timeout@_connect\: A connection attempt timed out.
20234
20235 .tempindent 0
20236 \timeout@_MX\: There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session
20237 with a host obtained from an MX record.
20238
20239 .tempindent 0
20240 \timeout@_A\: There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session
20241 with a host not obtained from an MX record.
20242
20243 .tempindent 0
20244 \timeout\: There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
20245
20246 .tempindent 0
20247 \quota\: A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the
20248 \%appendfile%\ transport.
20249
20250 .index quota||error testing in retry rule
20251 .index retry||quota error testing
20252 .tempindent 0
20253 \quota@_\<<time>>: A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by
20254 the \%appendfile%\ transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for
20255 <<time>>. For example, \*quota@_4d*\ applies to a quota error when the mailbox
20256 has not been accessed for four days.
20257
20258 .pop
20259
20260
20261 .index mailbox||time of last read
20262 The idea of \quota@_\<<time>> is to make it possible to have shorter timeouts
20263 when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally, it should
20264 be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox. However, it is
20265 not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following heuristic rules:
20266 .numberpars $.
20267 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the `atime') is used.
20268 As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over quota),
20269 Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
20270 .nextp
20271 .index maildir format||time of last read
20272 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the \(new)\
20273 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
20274 the \(new)\ subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
20275 change to the \(new)\ subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
20276 MUA moving a new message to the \(cur)\ directory when it is first read. The
20277 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
20278 .nextp
20279 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
20280 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
20281 .endp
20282 .nem
20283 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
20284 mechanism in the \%appendfile%\ transport. The \*quota*\ error also applies
20285 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the \\ENOSPC\\
20286 error).
20287
20288
20289 .em
20290 .section Retry rules for specified senders
20291 .index retry||rules, sender-specific
20292 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
20293 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
20294 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
20295 form:
20296 .display
20297 senders=<<address list>>
20298 .endd
20299 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
20300 .display asis
20301 * * senders=: F,1h,30m
20302 .endd
20303 matches all temporary errors for bounce messages sent to any host. If the
20304 address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes. For example:
20305 .display
20306 a.domain timeout senders="x@b.dom : y@c.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
20307 .endd
20308 When testing retry rules using \-brt-\, you can supply a sender using the \-f-\
20309 command line option, like this:
20310 .display asis
20311 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
20312 .endd
20313 If you do not set \-f-\ with \-brt-\, a retry rule that contains a senders list
20314 is never matched.
20315 .nem
20316
20317
20318
20319 .section Retry parameters
20320 .index retry||parameters in rules
20321 The third
20322 .em
20323 (or fourth, if a senders list is present)
20324 .nem
20325 field in a retry rule is a sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by
20326 semicolons. Each set consists of
20327 .display
20328 <<letter>>,<<cutoff time>>,<<arguments>>
20329 .endd
20330 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
20331 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
20332 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
20333 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
20334 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
20335 .index retry||algorithms
20336 The available algorithms are:
20337 .numberpars $.
20338 \*F*\: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
20339 the interval.
20340 .nextp
20341 \*G*\: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
20342 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
20343 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
20344 .endp
20345 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
20346 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
20347 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
20348 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
20349 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
20350 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
20351 interval is found. The main configuration variable
20352 .index limit||retry interval
20353 .index retry||interval, maximum
20354 .index \retry@_interval@_max\
20355 \retry@_interval@_max\ limits the maximum interval between retries.
20356
20357 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
20358 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
20359 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
20360 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
20361 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
20362 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
20363 time.
20364
20365 .index hints database||use for retrying
20366 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
20367 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
20368 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
20369 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
20370 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
20371 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
20372 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
20373 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
20374 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
20375 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
20376 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
20377
20378 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
20379 \*exim@_dumpdb*\ or \*exim@_fixdb*\ utility programs (see chapter ~~CHAPutils). The
20380 latter utility can also be used to change the data. The \*exinext*\ utility
20381 script can be used to find out what the next retry times are for the hosts
20382 associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local deliveries that
20383 have been deferred.
20384
20385 .section Retry rule examples
20386 Here are some example retry rules:
20387 .display asis
20388 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
20389 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
20390 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
20391 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
20392 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
20393 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
20394 .endd
20395 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
20396 \*alice@@wonderland.fict.example*\ when there is an over-quota error and the
20397 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
20398 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
20399 parts at \*wonderland.fict.example*\; the absence of a local part has the same
20400 effect as supplying `$*$@@'. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
20401 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
20402 days.
20403
20404 The third rule handles all other errors at \*wonderland.fict.example*\; retries
20405 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
20406 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
20407 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
20408 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
20409
20410 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain \*lookingglass.fict.example*\.
20411 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
20412 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
20413 were not obtained from an MX record.
20414
20415 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
20416 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
20417 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
20418 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
20419 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
20420
20421
20422 .section Timeout of retry data
20423 .index timeout||of retry data
20424 .index \retry@_data@_expire\
20425 .index hints database||data expiry
20426 .index retry||timeout of data
20427 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
20428 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
20429 set in \retry@_data@_expire\ (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
20430 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
20431 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
20432 failing for the first time.
20433
20434 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
20435 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
20436 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
20437 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
20438
20439 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
20440 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. It there is a
20441 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
20442
20443
20444
20445 .section Long-term failures
20446 .index delivery||failure, long-term
20447 .index retry||after long-term failure
20448 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
20449 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
20450 default retry rule:
20451 .display asis
20452 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
20453 .endd
20454 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
20455 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
20456 failure for the recipient address that counts.
20457
20458 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
20459 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
20460 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
20461 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
20462 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
20463
20464 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
20465 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
20466 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
20467
20468 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
20469 .index \delay@_after@_cutoff\
20470 \delay@_after@_cutoff\ option of the \%smtp%\ transport. The option is true by
20471 default and in that case:
20472 .numberpars " "
20473 Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is reached,
20474 the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery attempt
20475 taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to those IP
20476 addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails, the address
20477 is bounced and new retry times are computed.
20478 .endp
20479
20480 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
20481 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
20482 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
20483 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
20484 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
20485 notice.
20486
20487 If \delay@_after@_cutoff\ is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
20488 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
20489 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
20490 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
20491 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
20492 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
20493 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
20494 \delay@_after@_cutoff\ false means that there will be many more attempts to
20495 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when \delay@_after@_cutoff\ is
20496 true.
20497
20498 .section Ultimate address timeout
20499 .index retry||ultimate address timeout
20500 An additional rule is needed to cope with cases where a host is intermittently
20501 available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents its delivery when
20502 others to the same address get through. In this situation, because some
20503 messages are successfully delivered, the `retry clock' for the address keeps
20504 getting restarted, and so a message could remain on the queue for ever. To
20505 prevent this, if a message has been on the queue for longer than the cutoff
20506 time of any applicable retry rule for a given address, a delivery is attempted
20507 for that address, even if it is not yet time, and if this delivery fails, the
20508 address is timed out. A new retry time is not computed in this case, so that
20509 other messages for the same address are considered immediately.
20510
20511
20512
20513
20514
20515 .
20516 .
20517 .
20518 .
20519 . ============================================================================
20520 .chapter SMTP authentication
20521 .set runningfoot "SMTP authentication"
20522 .rset CHAPSMTPAUTH "~~chapter"
20523 .index SMTP||authentication configuration
20524 .index authentication
20525 The `authenticators' section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned with
20526 SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
20527 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
20528 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that
20529 are permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to
20530 the transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with
20531 each other.
20532
20533 .index \\AUTH\\||description of
20534 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
20535 .numberpars $.
20536 The server advertises a number of authentication \*mechanisms*\ in response to
20537 the client's \\EHLO\\ command.
20538 .nextp
20539 The client issues an \\AUTH\\ command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
20540 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
20541 .nextp
20542 The server may issue one or more \*challenges*\, to which the client must send
20543 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
20544 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
20545 any challenges -- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
20546 with the \\AUTH\\ command.
20547 .nextp
20548 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
20549 .nextp
20550 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the \\AUTH\\
20551 option on the \\MAIL\\ command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
20552 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
20553 connection.
20554 .nextp
20555 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
20556 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
20557 unauthenticated connection.
20558 .endp
20559 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
20560 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
20561 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an \\EHLO\\ command. The response to this
20562 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
20563 .display
20564 @$ $cb{telnet server.example 25}
20565 Trying 192.168.34.25...
20566 Connected to server.example.
20567 Escape character is '@^]'.
20568 220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...
20569 $cb{ehlo client.example}
20570 250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]
20571 250-SIZE 52428800
20572 250-PIPELINING
20573 250-AUTH PLAIN
20574 250 HELP
20575 .endd
20576 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
20577 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
20578 mechanisms are configured by specifying \*authenticator*\ drivers. Like the
20579 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
20580 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
20581 included by setting
20582 .display asis
20583 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
20584 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
20585 AUTH_SPA=yes
20586 .endd
20587 in \(Local/Makefile)\, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
20588 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second can be configured to
20589 support the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism,
20590 which is not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The third
20591 authenticator supports Microsoft's \*Secure Password Authentication*\
20592 mechanism.
20593
20594 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
20595 section ~~SECTfordricon). If no authenticators are required, no authentication
20596 section need be present in the configuration file. Each authenticator can in
20597 principle have both server and client functions. When Exim is receiving SMTP
20598 mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out messages over SMTP, it
20599 is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration options are provided for use
20600 in both these circumstances.
20601
20602 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
20603 \server@_\ and \client@_\ are used on option names that are specific to either
20604 the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client functions
20605 are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is to be
20606 used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using both sets
20607 of options, is required. For example:
20608 .display asis
20609 cram:
20610 driver = cram_md5
20611 public_name = CRAM-MD5
20612 server_secret = ${if eq{$1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
20613 client_name = ph10
20614 client_secret = secret2
20615 .endd
20616 The \server@_\ option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
20617 \client@_\ options when it is acting as a client.
20618
20619 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
20620 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
20621 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
20622 in Exim.
20623
20624
20625 .section Generic options for authenticators
20626 .index authentication||generic options
20627
20628 .startconf authenticators
20629 .index options||generic, for authenticators
20630
20631 .conf driver string unset
20632 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
20633 authenticators is to be used.
20634
20635 .conf public@_name string unset
20636 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
20637 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
20638 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
20639 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If \public@_name\ is not set, it
20640 defaults to the driver's instance name.
20641
20642 .conf server@_advertise@_condition string$**$ unset
20643 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
20644 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, `0', `no', or `false', the
20645 mechanism is not advertised.
20646 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
20647 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
20648 See section ~~SECTauthexiser below for further discussion.
20649
20650 .conf server@_debug@_print string$**$ unset
20651 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the \-d-\
20652 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
20653 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
20654 out the values of variables.
20655 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20656 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20657
20658 .conf server@_set@_id string$**$ unset
20659 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
20660 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
20661 messages in the variable \$authenticated@_id$\. It is also included in the log
20662 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
20663 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
20664 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
20665 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
20666
20667 .conf server@_mail@_auth@_condition string$**$ unset
20668 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
20669 as part of \\MAIL\\ commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
20670 driver on which \server__mail__auth@_condition\ is set. The option is not used
20671 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
20672 remembered for later use.
20673 How it is used is described in the following section.
20674 .endconf
20675
20676
20677
20678 .section The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands
20679 .rset SECTauthparamail "~~chapter.~~section"
20680 .index authentication||sender, authenticated
20681 .index \\AUTH\\||on \\MAIL\\ command
20682 When a client supplied an \\AUTH=\\ item on a \\MAIL\\ command, Exim applies
20683 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
20684 message:
20685 .numberpars $.
20686 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, \\HELO\\ was used rather
20687 than \\EHLO\\), the use of \\AUTH=\\ is a syntax error.
20688 .nextp
20689 If the value of the \\AUTH=\\ parameter is `@<@>', it is ignored.
20690 .nextp
20691 If \acl@_smtp@_mailauth\ is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
20692 running, the value of \$authenticated@_sender$\ is set to the value obtained
20693 from the \\AUTH=\\ parameter. If the ACL does not yield `accept', the value of
20694 \$authenticated@_sender$\ is deleted. The \acl@_smtp@_mailauth\ ACL may not
20695 return `drop' or `discard'. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is given
20696 for the \\MAIL\\ command.
20697 .nextp
20698 If \acl@_smtp@_mailauth\ is not defined, the value of the \\AUTH=\\ parameter
20699 is accepted and placed in \$authenticated@_sender$\ only if the client has
20700 authenticated.
20701 .nextp
20702 If the \\AUTH=\\ value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
20703 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
20704 \server@_mail@_auth@_condition\, the condition is checked at this point. The
20705 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
20706 fails, or yields an empty string, `0', `no', or `false', the value of
20707 \$authenticated__sender$\ is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
20708 the value of \$authenticated@_sender$\ is retained and passed on with the
20709 message.
20710 .endp
20711
20712 When \$authenticated@_sender$\ is set for a message, it is passed on to other
20713 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
20714 \$authenticated@_id$\, which is a string obtained from the authentication
20715 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
20716
20717 Whenever an \\AUTH=\\ value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
20718 \\MAIL\\, if defined, is run after \\AUTH=\\ is accepted or ignored. It can
20719 therefore make use of \$authenticated@_sender$\. The converse is not true: the
20720 value of \$sender@_address$\ is not yet set up when the \acl@_smtp@_mailauth\
20721 ACL is run.
20722
20723
20724 .section Authentication on an Exim server
20725 .rset SECTauthexiser "~~chapter.~~section"
20726 .index authentication||on an Exim server
20727 When Exim receives an \\EHLO\\ command, it advertises the public names of those
20728 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
20729 conditions:
20730 .numberpars $.
20731 The client host must match \auth@_advertise@_hosts\ (default $*$).
20732 .nextp
20733 It the \server@_advertise@_condition\ option is set, its expansion must not
20734 yield the empty string, `0', `no', or `false'.
20735 .endp
20736 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
20737 the mechanisms are advertised.
20738
20739 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
20740 provide a name and password for authentication whenever \\AUTH\\ is advertised,
20741 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
20742 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
20743 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising \\AUTH\\ to them.
20744 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
20745 that runs for \\RCPT\\) to relay without authentication, you should set
20746 .display asis
20747 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
20748 .endd
20749 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
20750
20751 The \server@_advertise@_condition\ controls the advertisement of individual
20752 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
20753 advertisement of a patricular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
20754 such as:
20755 .display asis
20756 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
20757 .endd
20758 If the session is encrypted, \$tls@_cipher$\ is not empty, and so the expansion
20759 yields `yes', which allows the advertisement to happen.
20760
20761 When an Exim server receives an \\AUTH\\ command from a client, it rejects it
20762 immediately if \\AUTH\\ was not advertised in response to an earlier \\EHLO\\
20763 command. This is the case if
20764 .numberpars $.
20765 The client host does not match \auth@_advertise@_hosts\; or
20766 .nextp
20767 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
20768 .nextp
20769 Expansion of \server@_advertise@_condition\ blocked the advertising of all the
20770 server authenticators.
20771 .endp
20772
20773 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_auth\ in order
20774 to decide whether to accept the command. If \acl@_smtp@_auth\ is not set,
20775 \\AUTH\\ is accepted from any client host.
20776
20777 If \\AUTH\\ is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
20778 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to \\EHLO\\ and
20779 that matches the one named in the \\AUTH\\ command. If it finds one, it runs
20780 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
20781 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the \\AUTH\\ command is
20782 rejected with a 504 error.
20783
20784 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
20785 \$received@_protocol$\ is set to
20786 .em
20787 `esmtpa'
20788 .nem
20789 instead of `esmtp', and \$sender@_host@_authenticated$\ contains the name (not
20790 the public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated
20791 the client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there
20792 was no successful authentication.
20793
20794
20795
20796 .section Testing server authentication
20797 .index authentication||testing a server
20798 .index \\AUTH\\||testing a server
20799 .index base64 encoding||creating authentication test data
20800 Exim's \-bh-\ option can be useful for testing server authentication
20801 configurations. The data for the \\AUTH\\ command has to be sent using base64
20802 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
20803 script:
20804 .display asis
20805 use MIME::Base64;
20806 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
20807 .endd
20808 .index binary zero||in authentication data
20809 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
20810 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
20811 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
20812 command line to run this script on such data might be
20813 .display asis
20814 encode '\0user\0password'
20815 .endd
20816 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
20817 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
20818 whose code value is zero.
20819
20820 \**Warning 1**\: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
20821 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
20822 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
20823 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
20824
20825 \**Warning 2**\: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
20826 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
20827 example, a command such as
20828 .display asis
20829 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
20830 .endd
20831 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped `@@' and `@$' characters.
20832
20833 If you have the \mimencode\ command installed, another way to do produce
20834 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
20835 .display asis
20836 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
20837 .endd
20838 The \-e-\ option of \echo\ enables the interpretation of backslash escapes in
20839 the argument, and the \-n-\ option specifies no newline at the end of its
20840 output. However, not all versions of \echo\ recognize these options, so you
20841 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
20842
20843
20844 .section Authentication by an Exim client
20845 .index authentication||on an Exim client
20846 The \%smtp%\ transport has two options called \hosts@_require@_auth\ and
20847 \hosts@_try@_auth\. When the \%smtp%\ transport connects to a server that
20848 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
20849 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
20850 .numberpars $.
20851 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, it searches the
20852 authentication mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name
20853 matches the public name of the authenticator.
20854 .nextp
20855 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code.
20856 The variables \$host$\ and \$host@_address$\ are available for any string
20857 expansions that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and
20858 IP address. If any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt
20859 is abandoned,
20860 and Exim moves on to the next authenticator.
20861 Otherwise an expansion failure causes delivery to be
20862 deferred.
20863 .nextp
20864 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
20865 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
20866 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
20867 usual way.
20868 .nextp
20869 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5xx code), Exim carries
20870 on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if possible. If
20871 all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are no attempts
20872 because no mechanisms match
20873 (or option expansions force failure),
20874 what happens depends on whether the host matches \hosts@_require@_auth\ or
20875 \hosts@_try@_auth\. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
20876 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
20877 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
20878 deliver the message unauthenticated.
20879 .endp
20880 .index \\AUTH\\||on \\MAIL\\ command
20881 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the \\AUTH\\
20882 parameter to the \\MAIL\\ commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender
20883 for the message.
20884 If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender is the one
20885 that was receiving on an incoming \\MAIL\\ command, provided that the incoming
20886 connection was authenticated and the \server@_mail@_auth\ condition allowed the
20887 authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim to send a
20888 message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
20889 \qualify@_domain\ is treated as authenticated. However, if the
20890 \authenticated@_sender\ option is set on the \%smtp%\ transport, it overrides
20891 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
20892
20893
20894
20895
20896
20897
20898 .
20899 .
20900 .
20901 .
20902 . ============================================================================
20903 .chapter The plaintext authenticator
20904 .rset CHAPplaintext "~~chapter"
20905 .set runningfoot "plaintext authenticator"
20906 .index \%plaintext%\ authenticator
20907 .index authenticators||\%plaintext%\
20908 The \%plaintext%\ authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
20909 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
20910 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
20911 security risk. If you use one of these mechanisms without also making use of
20912 SMTP encryption (see chapter ~~CHAPTLS) you should not use the same passwords
20913 for SMTP connections as you do for login accounts.
20914
20915 .section Using plaintext in a server
20916 When running as a server, \%plaintext%\ performs the authentication test by
20917 expanding a string. It has the following options:
20918
20919 .startconf plaintext
20920 .index options||\%plaintext%\ authenticator (server)
20921
20922 .conf server@_prompts string$**$ unset
20923 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
20924 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
20925 given.
20926
20927 .conf server@_condition string$**$ unset
20928 This option must be set in order to configure the driver as a server. Its use
20929 is described below.
20930
20931 .endconf
20932
20933 .index \\AUTH\\||in \%plaintext%\ authenticator
20934 .index binary zero||in \%plaintext%\ authenticator
20935 .index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in \%plaintext%\ authenticator
20936 .index base64 encoding||in \%plaintext%\ authenticator
20937 The data sent by the client with the \\AUTH\\ command, or in response to
20938 subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte values
20939 when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as a
20940 list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), which are placed in the
20941 expansion variables \$1$\, \$2$\, etc. If there are more strings in
20942 \server@_prompts\ than the number of strings supplied with the \\AUTH\\
20943 command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more data. Each response from
20944 the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
20945
20946 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
20947 \server@_condition\ is expanded.
20948 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
20949 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
20950 If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string, `0', `no', or
20951 `false', authentication fails. If the result of the expansion is `1', `yes', or
20952 `true', authentication succeeds and the generic \server@_set@_id\ option is
20953 expanded and saved in \$authenticated@_id$\. For any other result, a temporary
20954 error code is returned, with the expanded string as the error text.
20955
20956 \**Warning**\: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
20957 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
20958 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
20959
20960
20961 .section The PLAIN authentication mechanism
20962 .index PLAIN authentication mechanism
20963 .index authentication||PLAIN mechanism
20964 .index binary zero||in \%plaintext%\ authenticator
20965 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
20966 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
20967 separators). The data is sent either as part of the \\AUTH\\ command, or
20968 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
20969
20970 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
20971 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
20972 configured as follows:
20973 .display asis
20974 fixed_plain:
20975 driver = plaintext
20976 public_name = PLAIN
20977 server_prompts = :
20978 server_condition = \
20979 ${if and {{eq{$2}{username}}{eq{$3}{mysecret}}}{yes}{no}}
20980 server_set_id = $2
20981 .endd
20982 The \server@_prompts\ setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
20983 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
20984 \\AUTH\\ command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
20985 authenticator is advertised in the response to \\EHLO\\ as
20986 .display asis
20987 250-AUTH PLAIN
20988 .endd
20989 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
20990 .display asis
20991 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
20992 .endd
20993 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
20994 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
20995 .display asis
20996 AUTH PLAIN
20997 .endd
20998 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
20999 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
21000
21001 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
21002 when decoded, is \"<<NUL>>username<<NUL>>mysecret"\, where <<NUL>> represents a
21003 zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which is empty.
21004 The \server@_condition\ option in the authenticator checks that the second two
21005 are \"username"\ and \"mysecret"\ respectively.
21006
21007 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
21008 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
21009 authenticating clients it could make sense.
21010
21011 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
21012 \$2$\ to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
21013 comparison (see \crypteq\ in chapter ~~CHAPexpand). Here is a example of this
21014 approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. \**Warning**\: This
21015 is an incorrect example:
21016 .display asis
21017 server_condition = \
21018 ${if eq{$3}{${lookup{$2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}{yes}{no}}
21019 .endd
21020 The expansion uses the user name (\$2$\) as the key to look up a password,
21021 which it then compares to the supplied password (\$3$\). Why is this example
21022 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
21023 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
21024 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
21025 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
21026 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
21027 .display asis
21028 server_condition = ${lookup{$2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
21029 {${if eq{$value}{$3}{yes}{no}}}{no}}
21030 .endd
21031 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
21032 fails, authentication fails. If \crypteq\ is being used instead of \eq\, the
21033 first example is in fact safe, because \crypteq\ always fails if its second
21034 argument is empty. However, the second way of writing the test makes the logic
21035 clearer.
21036
21037
21038 .section The LOGIN authentication mechanism
21039 .index LOGIN authentication mechanism
21040 .index authentication||LOGIN mechanism
21041 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
21042 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the \\AUTH\\ command. Instead, a
21043 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
21044 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
21045 .display asis
21046 fixed_login:
21047 driver = plaintext
21048 public_name = LOGIN
21049 server_prompts = User Name : Password
21050 server_condition = \
21051 ${if and {{eq{$1}{username}}{eq{$2}{mysecret}}}{yes}{no}}
21052 server_set_id = $1
21053 .endd
21054 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
21055 with the \\AUTH\\ command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
21056 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
21057 strings are used to obtain two data items.
21058
21059 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
21060 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only `Username:' and
21061 `Password:'. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator which uses those
21062 strings, and which uses the \ldapauth\ expansion condition to check the user
21063 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
21064 .display asis
21065 login:
21066 driver = plaintext
21067 public_name = LOGIN
21068 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
21069 server_condition = ${if ldapauth \
21070 .newline
21071 {user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
21072 pass=${quote:$2} \
21073 .newline
21074 ldap://ldap.example.org/}{yes}{no}}
21075 server_set_id = uid=$1,ou=people,o=example.org
21076 .endd
21077 Note the use of the \quote@_ldap@_dn\ operator to correctly quote the DN for
21078 authentication. However, the basic \quote\ operator, rather than any of the
21079 LDAP quoting operators, is the correct one to use for the password, because
21080 quoting is needed only to make the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the
21081 LDAP level, the password is an uninterpreted string.
21082
21083
21084 .section Support for different kinds of authentication
21085 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
21086 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
21087 traditionally encrypted passwords from \(/etc/passwd)\ (or equivalent), PAM,
21088 Radius, \ldapauth\, and \*pwcheck*\. For details see section ~~SECTexpcond.
21089
21090
21091
21092 .section Using plaintext in a client
21093 The \%plaintext%\ authenticator has just one client option:
21094
21095 .startconf plaintext
21096 .index options||\%plaintext%\ authenticator (client)
21097
21098 .conf client@_send string$**$ unset
21099 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
21100 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
21101 string is sent with the \\AUTH\\ command; any more strings are sent in response
21102 to prompts from the server.
21103
21104 \**Note**\: you cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
21105 splitting takes priority and happens first.
21106
21107 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
21108 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
21109 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
21110 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
21111 the string.
21112
21113 .endconf
21114
21115 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
21116 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
21117 .display asis
21118 fixed_plain:
21119 driver = plaintext
21120 public_name = PLAIN
21121 client_send = ^username^mysecret
21122 .endd
21123 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the \\AUTH\\
21124 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
21125 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
21126 .display asis
21127 fixed_login:
21128 driver = plaintext
21129 public_name = LOGIN
21130 client_send = : username : mysecret
21131 .endd
21132 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
21133 the \\AUTH\\ command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
21134 prompts.
21135
21136
21137
21138
21139 .
21140 .
21141 .
21142 .
21143 . ============================================================================
21144 .chapter The cram@_md5 authenticator
21145 .set runningfoot "cram@_md5 authenticator"
21146 .index \%cram@_md5%\ authenticator
21147 .index authenticators||\%cram@_md5%\
21148 .index CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism
21149 .index authentication||CRAM-MD5 mechanism
21150 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
21151 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
21152 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
21153 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
21154 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
21155 secure than \%plaintext%\. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
21156 available in plain text at either end.
21157
21158 .section Using cram@_md5 as a server
21159 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
21160 authenticator as a server:
21161
21162 .startconf cram@_md5
21163 .index options||\%cram@_md5%\ authenticator (server)
21164
21165 .conf server@_secret string$**$ unset
21166 .index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in \%cram@_md5%\ authenticator
21167 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
21168 the expansion variable \$1$\, and \server@_secret\ is expanded to obtain the
21169 password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest that the
21170 client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct string. If the
21171 expansion of \server@_secret\ is forced to fail, authentication fails. If the
21172 expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is returned to
21173 the client.
21174
21175 .endconf
21176
21177 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
21178 client is `ph10', and if so, uses `secret' as the password. For any other user
21179 name, authentication fails.
21180 .display asis
21181 fixed_cram:
21182 driver = cram_md5
21183 public_name = CRAM-MD5
21184 server_secret = ${if eq{$1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
21185 server_set_id = $1
21186 .endd
21187 If authentication succeeds, the setting of \server@_set@_id\ preserves the user
21188 name in \$authenticated@_id$\.
21189 A more tyical configuration might look up the secret string in a file, using
21190 the user name as the key. For example:
21191 .display asis
21192 lookup_cram:
21193 driver = cram_md5
21194 public_name = CRAM-MD5
21195 server_secret = ${lookup{$1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}{$value}fail}
21196 server_set_id = $1
21197 .endd
21198 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
21199 because \$1$\ contains an unknown user name.
21200
21201 .section Using cram@_md5 as a client
21202 When used as a client, the \%cram@_md5%\ authenticator has two options:
21203
21204 .startconf cram@_md5
21205 .index options||\%cram@_md5%\ authenticator (client)
21206
21207 .conf client@_name string$**$ "the primary host name"
21208 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
21209 computing the response to the server's challenge.
21210
21211 .conf client@_secret string$**$ unset
21212 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
21213 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
21214
21215 .endconf
21216
21217 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
21218 to \$host$\ or \$host@_address$\ in the options.
21219
21220 Forced failure of either expansion string is treated as an indication that this
21221 authenticator is not prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next
21222 configured client authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to
21223 give up trying to send the message to the current server.
21224
21225 A simple example configuration of a \%cram@_md5%\ authenticator, using fixed
21226 strings, is:
21227 .display asis
21228 fixed_cram:
21229 driver = cram_md5
21230 public_name = CRAM-MD5
21231 client_name = ph10
21232 client_secret = secret
21233 .endd
21234
21235
21236
21237
21238 .
21239 .
21240 .
21241 .
21242 . ============================================================================
21243 .chapter The cyrus@_sasl authenticator
21244 .set runningfoot "cyrus@_sasl authenticator"
21245 .index \%cyrus@_sasl%\ authenticator
21246 .index authenticators||\%cyrus@_sasl%\
21247 .index Cyrus, SASL library
21248 .em
21249 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
21250 Digital Ltd (\?http://www.aldigital.co.uk?\).
21251
21252 The \%cyrus@_sasl%\ authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
21253 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (`Simple Authentication and Security
21254 Layer'). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms, including
21255 PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support directly.
21256 In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
21257
21258 The \%cyrus@_sasl%\ authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
21259 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
21260 then so can the \%cyrus@_sasl%\ authenticator. By default it uses the public
21261 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
21262
21263 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
21264 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the \*exim*\
21265 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
21266 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
21267 depending on the driver you are using.
21268
21269 .section Using cyrus@_sasl as a server
21270 The \%cyrus@_sasl%\ authenticator has four private options. It puts the
21271 username (on a successful authentication) into \$1$\.
21272
21273 .startconf cyrus@_sasl
21274 .conf server@_hostname string$**$ $tt{$primary@_hostname}
21275 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with
21276 the library. It is up to the underlying SASL plug-in what it does with
21277 this data.
21278
21279 .conf server@_mech string $tt{public@_name}
21280 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should
21281 use. It allows you to use a different underlying mechanism from the
21282 advertised name. For example:
21283 .display asis
21284 sasl:
21285 driver = cyrus_sasl
21286 public_name = X-ANYTHING
21287 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
21288 server_set_id = $1
21289 .endd
21290
21291 .conf server@_realm string unset
21292 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
21293
21294 .conf server@_service string $tt{smtp}
21295 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
21296
21297 .endconf
21298
21299 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
21300 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
21301 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
21302 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
21303 .display asis
21304 sasl_cram_md5:
21305 driver = cyrus_sasl
21306 public_name = CRAM-MD5
21307 server_set_id = $1
21308
21309 sasl_plain:
21310 driver = cyrus_sasl
21311 public_name = PLAIN
21312 server_set_id = $1
21313 .endd
21314
21315 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
21316 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
21317 but it is present in many binary distributions.
21318
21319 .nem
21320
21321
21322
21323 .
21324 .
21325 .
21326 .
21327 . ============================================================================
21328 .chapter The spa authenticator
21329 .set runningfoot "spa authenticator"
21330 .index \%spa%\ authenticator
21331 .index authenticators||\%spa%\
21332 .index authentication||Microsoft Secure Password
21333 .index authentication||NTLM
21334 .index Microsoft Secure Password Authentication
21335 .index NTLM authentication
21336 The \%spa%\ authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's \*Secure
21337 Password Authentication*\ mechanism,
21338 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
21339 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
21340 taken from the Samba project (\?http://www.samba.org?\). The code for the
21341 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner.
21342
21343 The mechanism works as follows:
21344 .numberpars $.
21345 After the \\AUTH\\ command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
21346 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
21347 .nextp
21348 The server sends back a challenge.
21349 .nextp
21350 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
21351 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
21352 .endp
21353 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
21354
21355
21356 .section Using spa as a server
21357 The \%spa%\ authenticator has just one server option:
21358
21359 .startconf spa
21360 .index options||\%spa%\ authenticator (server)
21361
21362 .conf server@_password string$**$ unset
21363 .index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in \%spa%\ authenticator
21364 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
21365 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in \$1$\. For example:
21366 .display asis
21367 spa:
21368 driver = spa
21369 public_name = NTLM
21370 server_password = ${lookup{$1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}}
21371 .endd
21372 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
21373 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
21374
21375 .endconf
21376
21377
21378
21379 .section Using spa as a client
21380 The \%spa%\ authenticator has the following client options:
21381
21382 .startconf spa
21383 .index options||\%spa%\ authenticator (client)
21384
21385 .conf client@_domain string$**$ unset
21386 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
21387
21388 .conf client@_password string$**$ unset
21389 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
21390
21391 .conf client@_username string$**$ unset
21392 This option specifies the user name, and must be set.
21393
21394 .endconf
21395
21396 Here is an example of a configuration of this authenticator for use with the
21397 mail servers at \*msn.com*\:
21398 .display asis
21399 msn:
21400 driver = spa
21401 public_name = MSN
21402 client_username = msn/msn_username
21403 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
21404 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
21405 .endd
21406
21407
21408
21409
21410
21411
21412 .
21413 .
21414 .
21415 .
21416 . ============================================================================
21417 .chapter Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL
21418 .set runningfoot "TLS encryption"
21419 .rset CHAPTLS "~~chapter"
21420 .index encryption||on SMTP connection
21421 .index SMTP||encryption
21422 .index TLS||on SMTP connection
21423 .index OpenSSL
21424 .index GnuTLS
21425 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
21426 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
21427 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
21428 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
21429 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
21430 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section ~~SECTinctlsssl). You
21431 also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial level,
21432 and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and certificates are
21433 used.
21434
21435 RFC 2487 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
21436 connection is established, the client issues a \\STARTTLS\\ command. If the
21437 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
21438 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
21439 between them is encrypted.
21440
21441 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
21442 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
21443 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
21444 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
21445 encryption state.
21446
21447 \**Warning**\: certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
21448 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
21449 in order to get TLS to work.
21450
21451
21452 .em
21453 .section Support for the legacy `ssmtp' (aka `smtps') protocol
21454 .index ssmtp protocol
21455 .index smtps protocol
21456 .index SMTP||ssmtp protocol
21457 .index SMTP||smtps protocol
21458 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
21459 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
21460 waiting for a \\STARTTLS\\ command from the client using the standard SMTP
21461 port. The protocol was called `ssmtp' or `smtps', and port 465 was allocated
21462 for this purpose.
21463
21464 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardised, but there are
21465 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
21466 the \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ global option. Its value must be a list of port
21467 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
21468 .display asis
21469 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
21470 .endd
21471 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
21472 via the daemon and via \*inetd*\. You still need to specify all the ports that
21473 the daemon uses (by setting \daemon@_smtp@_ports\ or \local@_interfaces\ or the
21474 \-oX-\ command line option) because \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ does not add an
21475 extra port -- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
21476 defined elsewhere.
21477
21478 There is also a \-tls-on-connect-\ command line option. This overrides
21479 \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
21480 .nem
21481
21482
21483
21484
21485 .section OpenSSL vs GnuTLS
21486 .index TLS||OpenSSL \*vs*\ GnuTLS
21487 .rset SECTopenvsgnu "~~chapter.~~section"
21488 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
21489 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
21490 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
21491 .display asis
21492 USE_GNUTLS=yes
21493 .endd
21494 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
21495 .display asis
21496 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
21497 .endd
21498 You must also set \\TLS@_LIBS\\ and \\TLS@_INCLUDE\\ appropriately, so that the
21499 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
21500
21501 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
21502 .numberpars $.
21503 The \tls@_verify@_certificates\ option must contain the name of a file, not the
21504 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
21505 .nextp
21506 The \tls@_dhparam\ option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
21507 facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
21508 changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
21509 .nextp
21510 GnuTLS uses RSA and D-H parameters that take a substantial amount of
21511 time to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS
21512 session. Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool
21513 directory, called \(gnutls-params)\. The file is owned by the Exim user and is
21514 readable only by its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the
21515 RSA and D-H parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first
21516 Exim process that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file
21517 which is renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim
21518 processes do this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a
21519 file is in place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
21520
21521 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
21522 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
21523 Arranging this is easy; just delete the file when you want new values to be
21524 computed.
21525 .nextp
21526 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
21527 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
21528 affects the value of the \$tls@_peerdn$\ variable.
21529 .nextp
21530 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
21531 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA@_ARCFOUR@_SHA. What is
21532 more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
21533 life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyhens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
21534 underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
21535 \tls@_require@_ciphers\ options (the global option and the \%smtp%\ transport
21536 option).
21537 .nextp
21538 The \tls@_require@_ciphers\ options operate differently, as described in the
21539 following sections.
21540 .endp
21541
21542 .section Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL
21543 .rset SECTreqciphssl "~~chapter.~~section"
21544 .index TLS||requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)
21545 .index \tls@_require@_ciphers\||OpenSSL
21546 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
21547 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
21548 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
21549 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of \tls@_require@_ciphers\
21550 directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
21551 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
21552 .numberpars $.
21553 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
21554 .nextp
21555 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
21556 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
21557 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
21558 SSL v3 algorithms.
21559 .nextp
21560 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
21561 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
21562 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
21563 algorithms.
21564 .nextp
21565 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by the characters \"!"\, \"-"\ or
21566 \"+"\.
21567 .numberpars " "
21568 If \"!"\ is used then the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
21569 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
21570 stated.
21571 .nextp
21572 If \"-"\ is used then the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
21573 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
21574 .nextp
21575 If \"+"\ is used then the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
21576 option doesn't add any new ciphers it just moves matching existing ones.
21577 .nextp
21578 If none of these characters is present then the string is just interpreted as a
21579 list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
21580 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
21581 not moved to the end of the list.
21582 .endp
21583 .endp
21584
21585
21586 .section Requiring specific ciphers in GnuTLS
21587 .rset SECTreqciphgnu "~~chapter.~~section"
21588 .index TLS||requiring specific ciphers (GnuTLS)
21589 .index \tls@_require@_ciphers\||GnuTLS
21590 The GnuTLS library does not have a combined function like OpenSSL. Instead,
21591 it allows the caller to specify separate lists of key-exchange methods,
21592 main cipher algorithms, and MAC algorithms. Unfortunately, these lists are
21593 numerical, and the library does not have a function for turning names into
21594 numbers. Consequently, the list of recognized names has to be built into
21595 the application.
21596
21597 At present, Exim permits only the list of main cipher algorithms to be
21598 changed. The \tls@_require@_ciphers\ option is in the same format as for
21599 OpenSSL. Exim searches each item for the name of available algorithm. For
21600 example, if the list contains RSA@_AES@_SHA then AES is recognized.
21601
21602 The cipher algorithms list starts out with a default set of algorithms. If
21603 the first item in \tls@_require@_ciphers\ does \*not*\ start with an
21604 exclamation mark, all the default items are deleted. Thus, only those specified
21605 can be used. If the first item in \tls@_require@_ciphers\ \*does*\ start with
21606 an exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
21607
21608 Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevent
21609 algorithms to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start
21610 with an exclamation mark causes the relevant algorithms to be added to the
21611 list. Thus,
21612 .display asis
21613 tls_require_ciphers = !RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA
21614 .endd
21615 allows all the defaults except those that use ARCFOUR, whereas
21616 .display asis
21617 tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
21618 .endd
21619 allows only cipher suites that use AES and 3DES. The currently recognized
21620 algorithms are:
21621 .em
21622 AES@_256, AES@_128, AES (both of the preceding), 3DES, and ARCFOUR@_128.
21623 Unrecognized algorithms are ignored. In a server, the order of the list is
21624 unimportant; the server will advertise the availability of all the relevant
21625 cipher suites. However, in a client, the order of the list specifies a
21626 preference order for the algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
21627 also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
21628 above.
21629 .nem
21630
21631
21632 .section Configuring an Exim server to use TLS
21633 .index TLS||configuring an Exim server
21634 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
21635 the \\STARTTLS\\ command to client hosts that match \tls@_advertise@_hosts\,
21636 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
21637 that \\STARTTLS\\ is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
21638 need to set some other options in order to make TLS avaliable, and also it is
21639 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
21640
21641 If a client issues a \\STARTTLS\\ command and there is some configuration
21642 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
21643 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except \\QUIT\\ are rejected
21644 with the error
21645 .display asis
21646 554 Security failure
21647 .endd
21648 If a \\STARTTLS\\ command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
21649 rejected with a 554 error code.
21650
21651 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set \tls@_advertise@_hosts\ to
21652 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to $*$ to match all hosts.
21653 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
21654 without some further configuration at the server end.
21655
21656 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
21657 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
21658 .display asis
21659 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
21660 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
21661 .endd
21662 The first file contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains
21663 the private key that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim
21664 user, and must always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if
21665 both the certificate and the key are contained within it. If \tls@_privatekey\
21666 is not set, this is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also
21667 contain intermediate certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable
21668 it to authenticate the server's certificate.
21669
21670 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
21671 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
21672 few comments below in section ~~SECTcerandall.)
21673
21674 \**Note**\: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client --
21675 they apply only in the case of a server. For a client, you must set the options
21676 of the same name in an \%smtp%\ transport.
21677
21678 With just these options, Exim will work as a server with clients such as
21679 Netscape. It does not require the client to have a certificate (but see below
21680 for how to insist on this). There is one other option that may be needed in
21681 other situations. If
21682 .display asis
21683 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
21684 .endd
21685 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
21686 with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
21687 suites that the server supports. See the command
21688 .display asis
21689 openssl dhparam
21690 .endd
21691 for a way of generating this data.
21692 At present, \tls@_dhparam\ is used only when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is
21693 ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
21694
21695 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
21696 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
21697 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
21698 in \$sender@_host@_address$\ to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
21699 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
21700
21701 .index cipher||logging
21702 .index log||TLS cipher
21703 The variable \$tls@_cipher$\ is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
21704 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the ::Received:: header of an
21705 incoming message (by default -- you can, of course, change this), and it is
21706 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by `X=',
21707 unless the \tls@_cipher\ log selector is turned off.
21708 The \encrypted\ condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in
21709 ACLs.
21710
21711 The ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can check the name of the cipher
21712 suite and vary their actions accordingly. The cipher suite names are those used
21713 by OpenSSL. These may differ from the names used elsewhere. For example,
21714 OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other contexts
21715 is known as TLS@_RSA@_WITH@_3DES@_EDE@_CBC@_SHA. Check the OpenSSL
21716 documentation for more details.
21717
21718
21719 .section Requesting and verifying client certificates
21720 .index certificate||verification of client
21721 .index TLS||client certificate verification
21722 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
21723 session with a client, you must set either \tls@_verify@_hosts\ or
21724 \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\. You can, of course, set either of them to $*$ to
21725 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
21726 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
21727 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
21728 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
21729 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
21730 \tls@_verify@_certificates\.
21731
21732 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
21733 directory is used
21734 (OpenSSL only),
21735 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
21736 of the form <<hash>>.0, where <<hash>> is a hash value constructed from the
21737 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
21738 .display asis
21739 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
21740 .endd
21741 where \(/cert/file)\ contains a single certificate.
21742
21743 The difference between \tls@_verify@_hosts\ and \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\ is
21744 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
21745 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
21746 \tls@_verify@_certificates\. If the client matches \tls@_verify@_hosts\, the
21747 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
21748 dropped. If the client matches \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\, the (encrypted) SMTP
21749 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
21750 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
21751 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
21752 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
21753
21754 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
21755 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
21756 \$tls@_peerdn$\ during subsequent processing of the message.
21757 .index log||distinguished name
21758 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
21759 ::Received:: header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
21760 `DN=', by setting the \tls@_peerdn\ log selector, and you can use
21761 \received@_header@_text\ to change the ::Received:: header. When no certificate
21762 is supplied, \$tls@_peerdn$\ is empty.
21763
21764 .section Revoked certificates
21765 .index TLS||revoked certificates
21766 .index revocation list
21767 .index certificate||revocation list
21768 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
21769 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
21770 server using the global option called \tls@_crl\ and to an Exim client using an
21771 identically named option for the \%smtp%\ transport. In each case, the value of
21772 the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a CRL
21773 in PEM format.
21774
21775 .section Configuring an Exim client to use TLS
21776 .index cipher||logging
21777 .index log||TLS cipher
21778 .index log||distinguished name
21779 .index TLS||configuring an Exim client
21780 The \tls@_cipher\ and \tls@_peerdn\ log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
21781 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
21782 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
21783 within the \%smtp%\ transport.
21784
21785 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the \%smtp%\
21786 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
21787 server, the \%smtp%\ transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
21788 this can be prevented by setting \hosts@_avoid@_tls\ (an option of the
21789 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
21790
21791 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
21792 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
21793 \hosts@_require@_tls\ to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
21794 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
21795 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
21796 usual way.
21797
21798 When the server host is not in \hosts@_require@_tls\, Exim may try to deliver
21799 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to \\STARTTLS\\ is
21800 a 5\*xx*\ code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
21801 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
21802 \tls@_tempfail@_tryclear\ option of the \%smtp%\ transport. If it is false,
21803 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
21804 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4\*xx*\ response to
21805 \\STARTTLS\\, and if \\STARTTLS\\ is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
21806 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
21807 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
21808 unencrypted.
21809
21810
21811 The \tls@_certificate\ and \tls@_privatekey\ options of the \%smtp%\ transport
21812 provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server if it
21813 requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
21814 \tls@_verify@_hosts\ or \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\ matches the client.
21815 \**Note**\: these options must be set in the \%smtp%\ transport for Exim to use
21816 TLS when it is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server
21817 certificate (set by the global options of the same name) should also be used
21818 when operating as a client.
21819
21820 If \tls@_verify@_certificates\ is set, it must name a file or,
21821 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
21822 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
21823 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
21824 in the list defined by \tls@_crl\.
21825
21826 If
21827 \tls@_require@_ciphers\ is set on the \%smtp%\ transport, it must contain a
21828 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
21829 the current host is abandoned, and the \%smtp%\ transport tries to deliver to
21830 alternative hosts, if any.
21831
21832 All the TLS options in the \%smtp%\ transport are expanded before use, with
21833 \$host$\ and \$host@_address$\ containing the name and address of the server to
21834 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
21835 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
21836
21837
21838 .section Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection
21839 .rset SECTmulmessam "~~chapter.~~section"
21840 .index multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS
21841 .index TLS||multiple message deliveries
21842 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
21843 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
21844 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
21845 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
21846 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
21847 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
21848 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
21849 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
21850 if \\AUTH\\ is in use, before sending the next message.
21851
21852 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
21853 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
21854 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
21855 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
21856 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
21857 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
21858 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
21859 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
21860 and delay other deliveries to that host.
21861
21862 To test for this case, Exim sends an \\EHLO\\ command to the server after
21863 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
21864 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
21865 information is recorded.
21866
21867 There is also a manual override; you can set \hosts@_nopass@_tls\ on the
21868 \%smtp%\ transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
21869 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
21870
21871
21872
21873 .section Certificates and all that
21874 .rset SECTcerandall "~~chapter.~~section"
21875 .index certificate||references to discussion
21876 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
21877 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
21878 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
21879 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
21880 to Apache, currently at
21881 .display rm
21882 \?http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl@_faq.html@#ToC24?\
21883 .endd
21884 Other parts of the \*modssl*\ documentation are also helpful, and have
21885 links to further files.
21886 Eric Rescorla's book, \*SSL and TLS*\, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
21887 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
21888 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
21889 .display rm
21890 \?http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/?\
21891 .endd
21892
21893 .section Certificate chains
21894 The file named by \tls@_certificate\ may contain more than one
21895 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
21896 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
21897 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
21898 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
21899 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
21900 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
21901 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
21902 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
21903 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
21904 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
21905 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
21906
21907 .section Self-signed certificates
21908 .index certificate||self-signed
21909 You can create a self-signed certificate using the \*req*\ command provided
21910 with OpenSSL, like this:
21911 .display asis
21912 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
21913 -days 9999 -nodes
21914 .endd
21915 \(file1)\ and \(file2)\ can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
21916 delimited and so can be identified independently. The \-days-\ option
21917 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The \-nodes-\ option is
21918 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
21919 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
21920 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
21921 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
21922
21923 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
21924 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
21925 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
21926
21927 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
21928 user (also called `leaf' or `site') certificate, and not a self-signed
21929 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
21930 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root \*certification
21931 authority*\ (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
21932 signed with that self-signed certificate.
21933
21934 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
21935 user certificates, see the \*General implementation overview*\ chapter of the
21936 Open-source PKI book, available online at \?http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/?\.
21937
21938
21939
21940 .
21941 .
21942 .
21943 .
21944 . ============================================================================
21945 .chapter Access control lists
21946 .set runningfoot "ACL"
21947 .rset CHAPACL "~~chapter"
21948 .index ~~ACL||description
21949 .index control of incoming mail
21950 .index message||controlling incoming
21951 .index policy control||access control lists
21952 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
21953 configuration file, headed by `begin acl'. Each ACL definition starts with a
21954 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
21955 one very small ACL:
21956 .display asis
21957 begin acl
21958
21959 small_acl:
21960 accept hosts = one.host.only
21961 .endd
21962 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
21963 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
21964
21965 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
21966 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
21967 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the \-bs-\
21968 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
21969 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
21970 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
21971 a realistic ACL for checking \\RCPT\\ commands. This is discussed in chapter
21972 ~~CHAPdefconfil.
21973
21974 .section Testing ACLs
21975 The \-bh-\ command line option provides a way of testing your ACL configuration
21976 locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact. The host
21977 \*relay-test.mail-abuse.org*\ provides a service for checking your relaying
21978 configuration (see section ~~SECTcheralcon for more details).
21979
21980
21981 .section Specifying when ACLs are used
21982 .index ~~ACL||options for specifying
21983 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
21984 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
21985 .index \\AUTH\\||ACL for
21986 .index \\DATA\\, ACLs for
21987 .index \\ETRN\\||ACL for
21988 .index \\EXPN\\||ACL for
21989 .index \\HELO\\||ACL for
21990 .index \\EHLO\\||ACL for
21991 .index \\MAIL\\||ACL for
21992 .index \\QUIT\\, ACL for
21993 .index \\RCPT\\||ACL for
21994 .index \\STARTTLS\\, ACL for
21995 .index \\VRFY\\||ACL for
21996 .index SMTP||connection, ACL for
21997 .index non-smtp message, ACL for
21998 .display
21999 .tabs 20
22000 .if !~~sys.fancy
22001 .tabs 24
22002 .fi
22003 \acl@_not@_smtp\ $t $rm{ACL for non-SMTP messages}
22004 \acl@_smtp@_auth\ $t $rm{ACL for \\AUTH\\}
22005 \acl@_smtp@_connect\ $t $rm{ACL for start of SMTP connection}
22006 \acl@_smtp@_data\ $t $rm{ACL after \\DATA\\ is complete}
22007 \acl@_smtp@_etrn\ $t $rm{ACL for \\ETRN\\}
22008 \acl@_smtp@_expn\ $t $rm{ACL for \\EXPN\\}
22009 \acl@_smtp@_helo\ $t $rm{ACL for \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\}
22010 \acl@_smtp@_mail\ $t $rm{ACL for \\MAIL\\}
22011 \acl@_smtp@_mailauth\ $t $rm{ACL for the \\AUTH\\ parameter of \\MAIL\\}
22012 .newline
22013 .em
22014 \acl@_smtp@_mime\ $t $rm{ACL for content-scanning MIME parts}
22015 \acl@_smtp@_predata\ $t $rm{ACL at start of \\DATA\\ command}
22016 \acl@_smtp@_quit\ $t $rm{ACL for \\QUIT\\}
22017 .nem
22018 .newline
22019 \acl@_smtp@_rcpt\ $t $rm{ACL for \\RCPT\\}
22020 \acl@_smtp@_starttls\ $t $rm{ACL for \\STARTTLS\\}
22021 \acl@_smtp@_vrfy\ $t $rm{ACL for \\VRFY\\}
22022 .endd
22023 For example, if you set
22024 .display asis
22025 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
22026 .endd
22027 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a \\RCPT\\ command
22028 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
22029 done when \\RCPT\\ commands arrive. A rejection of \\RCPT\\ should cause the
22030 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the \\RCPT\\
22031 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
22032 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
22033 testing as possible at \\RCPT\\ time.
22034
22035 .section The non-SMTP ACL
22036 .index non-smtp message, ACL for
22037 The non-SMTP ACL applies to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, it
22038 applies to batch SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batch SMTP is not
22039 really SMTP.) This ACL is run just before the \*local@_scan()*\ function. Any
22040 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
22041 temporary error for these kinds of message. Many of the ACL conditions (for
22042 example, host tests, and tests on the state of the SMTP connection such as
22043 encryption and authentication) are not relevant and are forbidden in this ACL.
22044
22045 .section The connect ACL
22046 .index SMTP||connection, ACL for
22047 The ACL test specified by \acl@_smtp@_connect\ happens after the test specified
22048 by \host__reject__connection\ (which is now an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers
22049 testing (if configured).
22050
22051 .em
22052 .section The DATA ACLs
22053 .index \\DATA\\, ACLs for
22054 Two ACLs are associated with the \\DATA\\ command, because it is two-stage
22055 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
22056 When the \\DATA\\ command is received, the ACL defined by \acl@_smtp@_predata\
22057 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the \\RCPT\\ commands, but before
22058 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
22059 response to the \\DATA\\ command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
22060 added by \\MAIL\\ or \\RCPT\\ ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
22061 are defined here are visible when the \acl@_smtp@_data\ ACL is run.
22062
22063 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
22064 in the headers, at \\RCPT\\ time or when the \\DATA\\ command is received. Such
22065 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
22066 received, before the final response to the \\DATA\\ command is sent. This is
22067 the ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_data\, which is the second ACL that is
22068 associated with the \\DATA\\ command.
22069
22070 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
22071 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
22072 MTAs do not treat hard (5$it{xx}) responses to the \\DATA\\ command (either
22073 before or after the data) correctly -- they keep the message on their queues
22074 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
22075 your resources.
22076
22077 .section The MIME ACL
22078 The \acl@_smtp@_mime\ option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
22079 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter ~~CHAPexiscan.
22080
22081 .section The QUIT ACL
22082 .rset SECTQUITACL "~~chapter.~~section"
22083 .index \\QUIT\\, ACL for
22084 The ACL for the SMTP \\QUIT\\ command is anomalous, in that the
22085 outcome of the ACL does not affect the response code to \\QUIT\\,
22086 which is always 221. Thus, the ACL does not in fact control any access.
22087 For this reason, the only verbs that are permitted are \accept\ and \warn\.
22088
22089 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
22090 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
22091 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at \\QUIT\\ time using one or
22092 more \logwrite\ modifiers on a \warn\ verb.
22093
22094 You do not need to have a final \accept\, but if you do, you can use a
22095 \message\ modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
22096 response to \\QUIT\\.
22097
22098 This ACL is run only for a `normal' \\QUIT\\. For certain kinds of disastrous
22099 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
22100 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
22101 client are given temporary error responses until \\QUIT\\ is received or the
22102 connection is closed. In these special cases, the \\QUIT\\ ACL does not run.
22103 .nem
22104
22105 .section Finding an ACL to use
22106 .index ~~ACL||finding which to use
22107 The value of an \acl@_smtp@_$it{xxx}\ option is expanded before use, so you can
22108 use different ACLs in different circumstances. The resulting string does not
22109 have to be the name of an ACL in the configuration file; there are other
22110 possibilities. Having expanded the string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
22111 .numberpars $.
22112 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
22113 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
22114 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
22115 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is `@#'.
22116 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
22117 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
22118 .display asis
22119 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
22120 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
22121 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
22122 .endd
22123 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
22124 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
22125 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
22126 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
22127 .nextp
22128 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
22129 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
22130 matches the string.
22131 .nextp
22132 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
22133 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
22134 want to have something like
22135 .display asis
22136 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
22137 .endd
22138 in order to allow free use of the \\VRFY\\ command. Such a string may contain
22139 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
22140 .endp
22141
22142
22143 .section ACL return codes
22144 .index ~~ACL||return codes
22145 .em
22146 Except for the \\QUIT\\ ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
22147 section ~~SECTQUITACL above), the
22148 .nem
22149 result of running an ACL is either `accept' or `deny', or, if some test
22150 cannot be completed (for example, if a database is down), `defer'. These
22151 results cause 2$it{xx}, 5$it{xx}, and 4$it{xx} return codes, respectively, to
22152 be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return, `error', occurs when there is an
22153 error such as invalid syntax in the ACL. This also causes a 4$it{xx} return
22154 code.
22155
22156 .em
22157 For the non-SMTP ACL, `defer' and `error' are treated in the same way as
22158 `deny', because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
22159 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
22160 .nem
22161
22162 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return `discard'. This
22163 has the effect of `accept', but causes either the entire message or an
22164 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
22165 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
22166
22167 If the ACL for \\MAIL\\ returns `discard', all recipients are discarded, and no
22168 ACL is run for subsequent \\RCPT\\ commands. The effect of `discard' in a
22169 \\RCPT\\ ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
22170 recipients left when the message's data is received, the \\DATA\\ ACL is not
22171 run. A `discard' return from the \\DATA\\ or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
22172 remaining recipients.
22173 .em
22174 The `discard' return is not permitted for the \acl@_smtp@_predata\ ACL.
22175 .nem
22176
22177 .index \*local@_scan()*\ function||when all recipients discarded
22178 The \*local@_scan()*\ function is always run, even if there are no remaining
22179 recipients; it may create new recipients.
22180
22181
22182 .section Unset ACL options
22183 .index ~~ACL||unset options
22184 The default actions when any of the \acl@_$it{xxx}\ options are unset are not
22185 all the same. \**Note**\: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
22186 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control reaches
22187 the end of the ACL statements is `deny'.
22188
22189 For \acl@_not@_smtp\, \acl@_smtp@_auth\, \acl@_smtp@_connect\,
22190 \acl@_smtp@_data\, \acl@_smtp@_helo\, \acl__smtp__mail\, \acl@_smtp@_mailauth\,
22191 .em
22192 \acl@_smtp@_mime\, \acl@_smtp@_predata\, \acl@_smtp@_quit\,
22193 .nem
22194 and \acl__smtp__starttls\, the action when the ACL is not defined is `accept'.
22195
22196 For the others (\acl@_smtp@_etrn\, \acl@_smtp@_expn\, \acl@_smtp@_rcpt\, and
22197 \acl@_smtp@_vrfy\), the action when the ACL is not defined is `deny'.
22198 This means that \acl@_smtp@_rcpt\ must be defined in order to receive any
22199 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
22200 configuration file.
22201
22202
22203
22204 .section Data for message ACLs
22205 .index ~~ACL||data for message ACL
22206 .em
22207 When a \\MAIL\\ or \\RCPT\\ ACL, or either of the \\DATA\\ ACLs, is running,
22208 the variables that contain information about the host and the message's sender
22209 (for example, \$sender@_host@_address$\ and \$sender@_address$\) are set, and
22210 can be used in ACL statements. In the case of \\RCPT\\ (but not \\MAIL\\ or
22211 \\DATA\\), \$domain$\ and \$local@_part$\ are set from the argument address.
22212
22213 When an ACL for the \\AUTH\\ parameter of \\MAIL\\ is running, the variables
22214 that contain information about the host are set, but \$sender@_address$\ is not
22215 yet set. Section ~~SECTauthparamail contains a discussion of this parameter and
22216 how it is used.
22217
22218 The \$message@_size$\ variable is set to the value of the \\SIZE\\ parameter on
22219 the \\MAIL\\ command at \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\ and pre-data time, or to -1 if
22220 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
22221 the time the final \\DATA\\ ACL is run (after the message data has been
22222 received).
22223
22224 The \$rcpt@_count$\ variable increases by one for each \\RCPT\\ command
22225 received. The \$recipients@_count$\ variable increases by one each time a
22226 \\RCPT\\ command is accepted, so while an ACL for \\RCPT\\ is being processed,
22227 it contains the number of previously accepted recipients. At \\DATA\\ time (for
22228 both the \\DATA\\ ACLs), \$rcpt@_count$\ contains the total number of \\RCPT\\
22229 commands, and \$recipients@_count$\ contains the total number of accepted
22230 recipients.
22231 .nem
22232
22233
22234
22235 .section Data for non-message ACLs
22236 .rset SECTdatfornon "~~chapter.~~section"
22237 .index ~~ACL||data for non-message ACL
22238 .em
22239 When an ACL is being run for \\AUTH\\, \\EHLO\\, \\ETRN\\, \\EXPN\\, \\HELO\\,
22240 .nem
22241 \\STARTTLS\\, or \\VRFY\\, the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in
22242 \$smtp@_command@_argument$\. This can be tested using a \condition\ condition.
22243 For example, here is an ACL for use with \\AUTH\\, which insists that either
22244 the session is encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In
22245 other words, it does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext
22246 passwords on unencrypted connections.
22247 .display asis
22248 acl_check_auth:
22249 accept encrypted = *
22250 .newline
22251 .em
22252 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
22253 {CRAM-MD5}}
22254 .nem
22255 .newline
22256 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
22257 .endd
22258 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
22259 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
22260 encrypted. You can use the generic \server@_advertise@_condition\ authenticator
22261 option to do this.)
22262
22263
22264 .section Format of an ACL
22265 .index ~~ACL||format of
22266 .index ~~ACL||verbs, definition of
22267 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
22268 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and `modifiers'.
22269 .em
22270 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
22271 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
22272 .nem
22273
22274 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
22275 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
22276 provides a means of specifying an `and' conjunction between conditions. For
22277 example:
22278 .display asis
22279 deny dnslists = list1.example
22280 dnslists = list2.example
22281 .endd
22282 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed.
22283 .em
22284 Exim stops evaluating the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition
22285 that fails. What happens then
22286 .nem
22287 depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not all the
22288 conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot test a
22289 sender address in the ACL that is run for a \\VRFY\\ command.
22290
22291 .section ACL verbs
22292 The ACL verbs are as follows:
22293 .numberpars $.
22294 .index \accept\, ACL verb
22295 \accept\: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns `accept'. If any of
22296 the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether \endpass\ appears
22297 among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition is before
22298 \endpass\, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is after
22299 \endpass\, the ACL returns `deny'. Consider this statement, used to check a
22300 \\RCPT\\ command:
22301 .display asis
22302 accept domains = +local_domains
22303 endpass
22304 verify = recipient
22305 .endd
22306 If the recipient domain does not match the \domains\ condition, control passes
22307 to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and the
22308 command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification fails,
22309 the ACL yields `deny', because the failing condition is after \endpass\.
22310 .nextp
22311 .index \defer\, ACL verb
22312 \defer\: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns `defer' which, in an
22313 SMTP session, causes a 4\*xx*\ response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
22314 \defer\ is the same as \deny\, because there is no way of sending a temporary
22315 error. For a \\RCPT\\ command, \defer\ is much the same as using a
22316 \%redirect%\ router and \":defer:"\ while verifying, but the \defer\ verb can
22317 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
22318 .nextp
22319 .index \deny\, ACL verb
22320 \deny\: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns `deny'. If any of the
22321 conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
22322 example,
22323 .display asis
22324 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
22325 .endd
22326 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
22327 .nextp
22328 .index \discard\, ACL verb
22329 \discard\: This verb behaves like \accept\, except that it returns `discard'
22330 from the ACL instead of `accept'. It is permitted only on ACLs that are
22331 concerned with receiving messages, and it causes recipients to be discarded.
22332 If the \log@_message\ modifier is set when \discard\ operates, its contents are
22333 added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
22334
22335 If \discard\ is used in an ACL for \\RCPT\\, just the one recipient is
22336 discarded; if used for \\MAIL\\, \\DATA\\ or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
22337 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before
22338 \\DATA\\ do not appear in the log line when the \log@_recipients\ log selector
22339 is set.
22340 .nextp
22341 .index \drop\, ACL verb
22342 \drop\: This verb behaves like \deny\, except that an SMTP connection is
22343 forcibly closed after the 5\*xx*\ error message has been sent. For example:
22344 .display asis
22345 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
22346 .newline
22347 .em
22348 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
22349 .nem
22350 .endd
22351 There is no difference between \deny\ and \drop\ for the connect-time ACL. The
22352 connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
22353 .nextp
22354 .index \require\, ACL verb
22355 \require\: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
22356 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns `deny'. For
22357 example, when checking a \\RCPT\\ command,
22358 .display asis
22359 require verify = sender
22360 .endd
22361 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
22362 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command.
22363 .nextp
22364 .index \warn\, ACL verb
22365 \warn\: If all the conditions are met, a header line is added to an incoming
22366 message and/or a line is written to Exim's main log. In all cases, control
22367 passes to the next ACL statement. The text of the added header line and the log
22368 line are specified by modifiers; if they are not present, a \warn\ verb just
22369 checks its conditions and obeys any `immediate' modifiers such as \set\ and
22370 \logwrite\.
22371 .em
22372 There is more about adding header lines in section ~~SECTaddheadwarn.
22373 .nem
22374
22375 If any condition on a \warn\ statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
22376 some sort of defer), no header lines are added and the configured log line is
22377 not written. No further conditions or modifiers in the \warn\ statement are
22378 processed. The incident is logged, but the ACL continues to be processed, from
22379 the next statement onwards.
22380
22381 If a \message\ modifier is present on a \warn\ verb in an ACL that is not
22382 testing an incoming message, it is ignored, and the incident is logged.
22383
22384 A \warn\ statement may use the \log@_message\ modifier to cause a line to be
22385 written to the main log when the statement's conditions are true.
22386 If an identical log line is requested several times in the same message, only
22387 one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force duplicates to be
22388 written, use the \logwrite\ modifier instead.
22389
22390 When one of the \warn\ conditions is an address verification that fails, the
22391 text of the verification failure message is in \$acl@_verify@_message$\. If you
22392 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
22393 .display asis
22394 warn !verify = sender
22395 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
22396 .endd
22397 .endp
22398
22399 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional \deny\.
22400
22401 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
22402 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
22403 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
22404 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
22405 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
22406
22407
22408 .section ACL variables
22409 .rset SECTaclvariables "~~chapter.~~section"
22410 .index ~~ACL||variables
22411 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
22412 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
22413 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
22414 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. There are two sets
22415 of these variables:
22416 .numberpars $.
22417 The values of \$acl@_c0$\ to \$acl@_c9$\ persist throughout an SMTP connection.
22418 They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set while receiving one message is
22419 still available when receiving the next message on the same SMTP connection.
22420 .nextp
22421 The values of \$acl@_m0$\ to \$acl@_m9$\ persist only while a message is being
22422 received. They are reset afterwards. They are also reset by \\MAIL\\, \\RSET\\,
22423 \\EHLO\\, \\HELO\\, and after starting up a TLS session.
22424 .endp
22425 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
22426 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
22427 time. The ACL variables are set by modifier called \set\. For example:
22428 .display asis
22429 accept hosts = whatever
22430 set acl_m4 = some value
22431 .endd
22432 \**Note**\: a leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
22433 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
22434 \warn\ verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
22435
22436
22437 .section Condition and modifier processing
22438 .index ~~ACL||conditions, processing
22439 .index ~~ACL||modifiers, processing
22440 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example,
22441 .display asis
22442 deny domains = *.dom.example
22443 !verify = recipient
22444 .endd
22445 causes the ACL to return `deny' if the recipient domain ends in
22446 \*dom.example*\ and the recipient address cannot be verified.
22447
22448 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
22449 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
22450 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
22451 .display asis
22452 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
22453 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
22454 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
22455 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
22456 .endd
22457 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
22458 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
22459 different in the two cases. The \fail\ in the first statement causes the
22460 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The \accept\ verb
22461 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
22462 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
22463 and therefore the \accept\ also fails.
22464
22465 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
22466 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
22467 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
22468 warning is generated.
22469 .em
22470 The \control\ modifier affects the way an incoming message is handled.
22471 .nem
22472
22473 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
22474 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
22475 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
22476 consider this use of the \message\ modifier:
22477 .display asis
22478 require message = Can't verify sender
22479 verify = sender
22480 message = Can't verify recipient
22481 verify = recipient
22482 message = This message cannot be used
22483 .endd
22484 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
22485 `deny', so it goes no further. The first \message\ modifier has been seen, so
22486 its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
22487 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
22488 verification succeeds, the third message becomes `current', but is never used
22489 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
22490
22491 For the \deny\ verb, on the other hand, it is always the last \message\
22492 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
22493 happen. Specifying more than one \message\ modifier does not make sense, and
22494 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
22495 .display asis
22496 deny hosts = ...
22497 !senders = *@my.domain.example
22498 message = Invalid sender from client host
22499 .endd
22500 The `deny' result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached, by
22501 which time Exim has set up the message.
22502
22503
22504 .section ACL modifiers
22505 .rset SECTACLmodi "~~chapter.~~section"
22506 .index ~~ACL||modifiers, list of
22507 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
22508
22509 .startitems
22510
22511 .item "control = <<text>>"
22512 .index \control\, ACL modifier
22513 .em
22514 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
22515 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
22516 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
22517 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
22518 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
22519 even if the \control\ modifier appears in a \\RCPT\\ ACL.
22520
22521 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
22522 separately in section ~~SECTcontrols.
22523 .nem
22524 The \control\ modifier can be used in several different ways. For example:
22525 .numberpars $.
22526 It can be at the end of an \accept\ statement:
22527 .display asis
22528 accept ...some conditions
22529 control = queue_only
22530 .endd
22531 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields `accept', in
22532 other words, when the conditions are all true.
22533 .nextp
22534 It can be in the middle of an \accept\ statement:
22535 .display asis
22536 accept ...some conditions...
22537 control = queue_only
22538 ...some more conditions...
22539 .endd
22540 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
22541 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
22542 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield `accept' for the control to
22543 be relevant.
22544 .nextp
22545 It can be used with \warn\ to apply the control, leaving the
22546 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
22547 example:
22548 .display asis
22549 warn ...some conditions...
22550 control = freeze
22551 accept ...
22552 .endd
22553 This example of \warn\ does not contain \message\, \log@_message\, or
22554 \logwrite\, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a log
22555 entry.
22556 .nextp
22557 .em
22558 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a \require\
22559 verb. For example:
22560 .display asis
22561 require control = no_multiline_response
22562 .nem
22563 .endd
22564 .endp
22565
22566 .item "delay = <<time>>"
22567 .index \delay\, ACL modifier
22568 .index \-bh-\ option
22569 This modifier causes Exim to wait for the time interval before proceeding. The
22570 time is given in the usual Exim notation. This modifier may appear in any ACL.
22571 The delay happens as soon as the modifier is processed. However, when testing
22572 Exim using the \-bh-\ option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate
22573 message is output instead).
22574
22575 Like \control\, \delay\ can be used with \accept\ or
22576 \deny\, for example:
22577 .display asis
22578 deny ...some conditions...
22579 delay = 30s
22580 .endd
22581 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
22582 `deny'. Compare this with:
22583 .display asis
22584 deny delay = 30s
22585 ...some conditions...
22586 .endd
22587 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The \delay\ modifier can
22588 also be used with \warn\ and together with \control\:
22589 .display
22590 warn ...some conditions...
22591 delay = 2m
22592 control = freeze
22593 accept ...
22594 .endd
22595
22596 .item endpass
22597 .index \endpass\, ACL modifier
22598 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in \accept\
22599 statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose failure causes
22600 control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose failure causes
22601 the ACL to return `deny'. See the description of \accept\ above.
22602
22603 .item "log@_message = <<text>>"
22604 .index \log@_message\, ACL modifier
22605 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
22606 ACL denies access or a \warn\ statement's conditions are true. For example:
22607 .display asis
22608 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
22609 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
22610 .endd
22611 \log@_message\ adds to any underlying error message that may exist because of
22612 the condition failure. For example, while verifying a recipient address, a
22613 :::fail:: redirection might have already set up a message. Although the message
22614 is usually defined before the conditions to which it applies, the expansion
22615 does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be denied. This means that
22616 any variables that are set by the condition are available for inclusion in the
22617 message. For example, the \$dnslist@_<<xxx>>$\ variables are set after a DNS
22618 black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of \log@_message\ fails, or if the
22619 result is an empty string, the modifier is ignored.
22620
22621 If you want to use a \warn\ statement to log the result of an address
22622 verification, you can use \$acl__verify__message$\ to include the verification
22623 error message.
22624
22625 If \log@_message\ is used with a \warn\ statement, `Warning:' is added to the
22626 start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested more
22627 than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is actually
22628 logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use \logwrite\ instead of
22629 \log@_message\. In the absence of \log@_message\ and \logwrite\, nothing is
22630 logged for a succesful \warn\ statement.
22631
22632 If \log@_message\ is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
22633 example, from the failure of address verification), but \message\ is present,
22634 the \message\ text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
22635 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
22636 both \log@_message\ and \message\, a default built-in message is used for
22637 logging rejections.
22638
22639 .item "logwrite = <<text>>"
22640 .index \logwrite\, ACL modifier
22641 .index log||in ACL, immediate
22642 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
22643 processing an ACL. (Compare \log@_message\, which, except in the case of
22644 \warn\, is used only if the ACL statement denies access.) The \logwrite\
22645 modifier can be used to log special incidents in ACLs. For example:
22646 .display
22647 accept <<some special conditions>>
22648 control = freeze
22649 logwrite = froze message because ...
22650 .endd
22651 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
22652 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
22653 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
22654 example:
22655 .display asis
22656 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
22657 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
22658 .endd
22659
22660 .item "message = <<text>>"
22661 .index \message\, ACL modifier
22662 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as an error
22663 message if the current statement causes the ACL to deny access. The expansion
22664 happens at the time Exim decides that access is to be denied, not at the time
22665 it processes \message\. If the expansion fails, or generates an empty string,
22666 the modifier is ignored. For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the
22667 message is returned as part of the SMTP error response.
22668
22669 The \message\ modifier is also used with the \warn\ verb to specify one or more
22670 header lines to be added to an incoming message when all the conditions are
22671 true. See section ~~SECTaddheadwarn for more details. If \message\ is used with
22672 \warn\ in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
22673 effect.
22674
22675 The text is literal; any quotes are taken as literals, but because the string
22676 is expanded, backslash escapes are processed anyway. If the message contains
22677 newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP response. Like \log@_message\,
22678 the contents of \message\ are not expanded until after a condition has failed.
22679
22680 If \message\ is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
22681 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
22682 However, the original message is available in the variable
22683 \$acl@_verify@_message$\, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
22684 wish. In particular, if you want the text from \:fail:\ items in \%redirect%\
22685 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
22686 use a \message\ modifier, or make use of \$acl@_verify@_message$\.
22687
22688 .item "set <<acl@_name>> = <<value>>"
22689 .index \set\, ACL modifier
22690 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
22691 ~~SECTaclvariables).
22692
22693 .enditems
22694
22695
22696 .em
22697 .section Use of the control modifier
22698 .rset SECTcontrols "~~chapter.~~section"
22699 .index \control\, ACL modifier
22700 The \control\ modifier supports the following settings:
22701
22702 .startitems
22703
22704 .item "control = caseful@_local@_part"
22705 .item "control = caselower@_local@_part"
22706 .index ~~ACL||case of local part in
22707 .index case of local parts
22708 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_rcpt\
22709 (that is, during \\RCPT\\ processing). By default, the contents of
22710 \$local@_part$\ are lower cased before ACL processing. If
22711 `caseful@_local@_part' is specified, any uppercase letters in the original
22712 local part are restored in \$local@_part$\ for the rest of the ACL, or until a
22713 control that sets `caselower@_local@_part' is encountered.
22714
22715 This control affects only the current recipient. Moreover, it applies only to
22716 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
22717 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
22718 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
22719 configuration (see the \caseful@_local@_part\ generic router option).
22720
22721 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
22722 containing upper case letters. For example, using \$acl@_m4$\ to accumulate the
22723 spam score:
22724 .display asis
22725 warn control = caseful_local_part
22726 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
22727 $acl_m4 + \
22728 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
22729 }
22730 control = caselower_local_part
22731 .endd
22732 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
22733 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
22734
22735 .item "control = enforce@_sync"
22736 .item "control = no@_enforce@_sync"
22737 .index SMTP||synchronization checking
22738 .index synchronization checking in SMTP
22739 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
22740 is enforced. The global option \smtp@_enforce@_sync\ specifies the initial
22741 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
22742 in chapter ~~CHAPmainconfig for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
22743
22744 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
22745 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
22746 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
22747 \acl@_smtp@_connect\, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
22748 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
22749 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
22750 work with.
22751
22752 .item "control = fakereject/<<message>>"
22753 .index fake rejection
22754 .index rejection, fake
22755 This control is permitted only for the \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, and \\DATA\\ ACLs,
22756 in other words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts
22757 the message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
22758 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
22759 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
22760 the same SMTP connection.
22761
22762 The text for the 550 response is taken from the \control\ modifier. If no
22763 message is supplied, the following is used:
22764 .display asis
22765 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
22766 550-kept for evaluation.
22767 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
22768 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
22769 .endd
22770 This facilty should be used with extreme caution.
22771
22772
22773 .item "control = freeze"
22774 .index frozen messages||forcing in ACL
22775 This control is permitted only for the \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, \\DATA\\, and
22776 non-SMTP ACLs, in other words, only when a message is being received. If the
22777 message is accepted, it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control
22778 applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be
22779 received in the same SMTP connection.
22780
22781
22782 .item "control = no@_mbox@_unspool"
22783 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
22784 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
22785 of it, to be written in `mbox format' to a spool file, for passing to a virus
22786 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
22787 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control
22788 applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be
22789 received in the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and
22790 is unlikely to be useful in production.
22791
22792
22793 .item "control = no@_multiline@_response"
22794 .index multiline responses, suppressing
22795 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
22796 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
22797 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
22798
22799 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
22800 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
22801 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
22802 (`use multiline responses for more' it says -- ha!), and some of the responses
22803 might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a sop to
22804 broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
22805 .numberpars
22806 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
22807 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically `sender
22808 verification failed') is sent.
22809 .nextp
22810 If a \message\ modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
22811 line is output.
22812 .endp
22813 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
22814 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
22815
22816
22817 .item "control = queue@_only"
22818 .index \queue@_only\
22819 .index queueing incoming messages
22820 This control is permitted only for the \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, \\DATA\\, and
22821 non-SMTP ACLs, in other words, only when a message is being received. If the
22822 message is accepted, it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery
22823 by a subsequent queue runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In
22824 other words, it has the effect as the \queue@_only\ global option. However, the
22825 control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
22826 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
22827
22828
22829 .item "control = submission/<<options>>"
22830 .index message||submission
22831 .index submission mode
22832 This control is permitted only for the \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, and start of data
22833 ACLs (the latter is the one defined by \acl@_smtp@_predata\). Setting it tells
22834 Exim that the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case,
22835 Exim operates in `submission mode', and applies certain fixups to the message
22836 if necessary. For example, it add a ::Date:: header line if one is not present.
22837 This control is not permitted in the \acl@_smtp@_data\ ACL, because that is too
22838 late (the message has already been created).
22839
22840 Chapter ~~CHAPmsgproc describes the processing that Exim applies to messages.
22841 Section ~~SECTsubmodnon covers the processing that happens in submission mode;
22842 the available options for this control are described there. The control applies
22843 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
22844 the same SMTP connection.
22845
22846 .enditems
22847 .nem
22848
22849
22850 .em
22851 .section Adding header lines with the warn verb
22852 .rset SECTaddheadwarn "~~chapter.~~section"
22853 .index header lines||adding in an ACL
22854 .index header lines||position of added lines
22855 .index \warn\, ACL verb
22856 .index \message\, ACL modifier
22857 The \message\ modifier can be used on a \warn\ statement to add an extra header
22858 line to an incoming message, as in this example:
22859 .display asis
22860 warn message = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
22861 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
22862 dialup.mail-abuse.org
22863 .endd
22864 If an identical header line is requested several times (provoked, for example,
22865 by multiple \\RCPT\\ commands), only one copy is actually added to the message.
22866 If the text of the \message\ modifier contains one or more newlines that are
22867 not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
22868 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; \"X-ACL-Warn:"\ is added to the
22869 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
22870
22871 By default, new lines are added at the end of the existing header lines.
22872 However, you can specify that any particular header line should be added right
22873 at the start (before all the ::Received:: lines), immediately after the first
22874 block of ::Received:: lines, or immediately before any line that is not a
22875 ::Received:: or ::Resent-something:: header.
22876
22877 This is done by specifying `:at@_start:', `:after@_received:', or
22878 `:at@_start@_rfc:' (or, for completeness, `:at@_end:') before the text of the
22879 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
22880 to be a header name first.) For example:
22881 .display asis
22882 warn message = :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
22883 .endd
22884
22885 If more than one header is supplied in a single warn statement, each one is
22886 treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If you add
22887 more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they will
22888 end up in reverse order.
22889
22890 \**Warning**\: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
22891 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
22892 system filter or in a router or transport.
22893
22894 .index header lines||added, visibility of
22895 Header lines that are added by an ACL at \\MAIL\\ or \\RCPT\\ time are not
22896 visible in string expansions in ACLs for subsequent \\RCPT\\ commands or in the
22897 \acl@_smtp@_predata\ ACL. However, they are visible in string expansions in the
22898 ACL that is run after \\DATA\\ is complete (the \acl@_smtp@_data\ ACL). This is
22899 also true for header lines that are added in the \acl@_smtp@_predata\ ACL.
22900 If a message is rejected after \\DATA\\, all added header lines are included in
22901 the entry that is written to the reject log.
22902
22903 If you want to preserve data between \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, and the
22904 \acl@_smtp@_predata\ ACLs, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
22905 ~~SECTaclvariables.
22906 .nem
22907
22908
22909
22910 .section ACL conditions
22911 .rset SECTaclconditions "~~chapter.~~section"
22912 .index ~~ACL||conditions, list of
22913 .em
22914 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
22915 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
22916 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
22917 content scanning in chapter ~~CHAPexiscan.
22918 .nem
22919
22920 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
22921 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
22922 result of the arrival of an \\ETRN\\ command, and checks on message headers can
22923 be done only in the ACLs specified by \acl@_smtp@_data\ and \acl__not__smtp\.
22924 You can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in
22925 the same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an `and' conjunction.
22926 The conditions are as follows:
22927
22928 .startitems
22929
22930 .item "acl = <<name of acl or ACL string or file name >>"
22931 .index ~~ACL||nested
22932 .index ~~ACL||indirect
22933 .index \acl\, ACL condition
22934 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
22935 \acl@_smtp@_$it{xxx}\ options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
22936 `accept' the condition is true; if it returns `deny' the condition is false. If
22937 it returns `defer', the current ACL returns `defer'
22938 .em
22939 unless the condition is on a \warn\ verb. In that case, a `defer' return makes
22940 the condition false. This means that further processing of the \warn\ verb
22941 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
22942 .nem
22943
22944 If the nested \acl\ returns `drop' and the outer condition denies access,
22945 the connection is dropped. If it returns `discard', the verb must be \accept\
22946 or \discard\, and the action is taken immediately -- no further conditions are
22947 tested.
22948
22949 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
22950 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
22951 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle \\RCPT\\
22952 commands for different local users or different local domains.
22953
22954 .item "authenticated = <<string list>>"
22955 .index \authenticated\, ACL condition
22956 .index authentication||ACL checking
22957 .index ~~ACL||testing for authentication
22958 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
22959 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
22960 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
22961 .display asis
22962 authenticated = *
22963 .endd
22964
22965 .item "condition = <<string>>"
22966 .index \condition\, ACL condition
22967 .index customizing||ACL condition
22968 .index ~~ACL||customized test
22969 .index ~~ACL||testing, customized
22970 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
22971 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
22972 `no' or `false', the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero number,
22973 or one of the strings `yes' or `true', the condition is true. For any other
22974 values, some error is assumed to have occured, and the ACL returns `defer'.
22975
22976
22977 .em
22978 .item "decode = <<location>>"
22979 .index \decode\, ACL condition
22980 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
22981 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only the the ACL defined by
22982 \acl@_smtp@_mime\. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
22983 For details, see chapter ~~CHAPexiscan.
22984 .nem
22985
22986
22987 .item "dnslists = <<list of domain names and other data>>"
22988 .index \dnslists\, ACL condition
22989 .index DNS list||in ACL
22990 .index black list (DNS)
22991 .index ~~ACL||testing a DNS list
22992 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
22993 `RBL lists', after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the use
22994 of the lists at \*mail-abuse.org*\ now carries a charge.
22995 There are too many different variants of this condition to describe briefly
22996 here. See sections ~~SECTmorednslists--~~SECTmorednslistslast for details.
22997
22998 .item "domains = <<domain list>>"
22999 .index \domains\, ACL condition
23000 .index domain||ACL checking
23001 .index ~~ACL||testing a recipient domain
23002 This condition is relevant only after a \\RCPT\\ command. It checks that the
23003 domain of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack
23004 processing is enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check
23005 succeeds with a lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in \$domain@_data$\
23006 until the next \domains\ test.
23007
23008 .item "encrypted = <<string list>>"
23009 .index \encrypted\, ACL condition
23010 .index encryption||checking in an ACL
23011 .index ~~ACL||testing for encryption
23012 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
23013 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
23014 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
23015 .display asis
23016 encrypted = *
23017 .endd
23018
23019 .item "hosts = << host list>>"
23020 .index \hosts\, ACL condition
23021 .index host||ACL checking
23022 .index ~~ACL||testing the client host
23023 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
23024 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
23025 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
23026 .display asis
23027 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
23028 .endd
23029 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
23030 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
23031 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
23032 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
23033 \accept\ statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
23034 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
23035
23036 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
23037 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
23038 .display asis
23039 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
23040 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
23041 .endd
23042 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
23043 is not in the list, so the first \accept\ statement fails. The second statement
23044 can then check the IP address.
23045
23046 If a \hosts\ condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
23047 of the lookup is made available in the \$host@_data$\ variable. This
23048 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
23049 .display asis
23050 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
23051 message = $host_data
23052 .endd
23053 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
23054
23055 .item "local@_parts = <<local part list>>"
23056 .index \local@_parts\, ACL condition
23057 .index local part||ACL checking
23058 .index ~~ACL||testing a local part
23059 This condition is relevant only after a \\RCPT\\ command. It checks that the
23060 local part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing
23061 is enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup,
23062 the result of the lookup is placed in \$local@_part@_data$\ until the next
23063 \local@_parts\ test.
23064
23065
23066 .em
23067 .item "malware = <<option>>"
23068 .index \malware\, ACL condition
23069 .index ~~ACL||virus scanning
23070 .index ~~ACL||scanning for viruses
23071 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
23072 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
23073 viruses. For details, see chapter ~~CHAPexiscan.
23074 .nem
23075
23076
23077 .em
23078 .item "mime@_regex = <<list of regular expressions>>"
23079 .index \mime@_regex\, ACL condition
23080 .index ~~ACL||testing by regex matching
23081 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
23082 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only the the ACL defined by
23083 \acl@_smtp@_mime\. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
23084 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter ~~CHAPexiscan.
23085 .nem
23086
23087
23088 .item "recipients = <<address list>>"
23089 .index \recipients\, ACL condition
23090 .index recipient||ACL checking
23091 .index ~~ACL||testing a recipient
23092 This condition is relevant only after a \\RCPT\\ command. It checks the entire
23093 recipient address against a list of recipients.
23094
23095
23096 .em
23097 .item "regex = <<list of regular expressions>>"
23098 .index \regex\, ACL condition
23099 .index ~~ACL||testing by regex matching
23100 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
23101 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned
23102 for a match with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
23103 ~~CHAPexiscan.
23104 .nem
23105
23106
23107 .item "sender@_domains = <<domain list>>"
23108 .index \sender@_domains\, ACL condition
23109 .index sender||ACL checking
23110 .index ~~ACL||testing a sender domain
23111 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
23112 domain list.
23113 \**Note**\: the domain of the sender address is in
23114 \$sender@_address@_domain$\. It is \*not*\ put in \$domain$\ during the testing
23115 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing
23116 domain lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an
23117 ACL for a \\RCPT\\ command, the recipient's domain (which is in \$domain$\) can
23118 be used to influence the sender checking.
23119
23120 .item "senders = <<address list>>"
23121 .index \senders\, ACL condition
23122 .index sender||ACL checking
23123 .index ~~ACL||testing a sender
23124 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
23125 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
23126 .display asis
23127 senders = :
23128 .endd
23129
23130
23131 .em
23132 .item "spam = <<username>>"
23133 .index \spam\, ACL condition
23134 .index ~~ACL||scanning for spam
23135 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
23136 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
23137 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter ~~CHAPexiscan.
23138 .nem
23139
23140
23141 .item "verify = certificate"
23142 .index \verify\, ACL condition
23143 .index TLS||client certificate verification
23144 .index certificate||verification of client
23145 .index ~~ACL||certificate verification
23146 .index ~~ACL||testing a TLS certificate
23147 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
23148 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
23149 server requests a certificate only if the client matches \tls@_verify@_hosts\
23150 or \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\ (see chapter ~~CHAPTLS).
23151
23152 .item "verify = header@_sender/<<options>>"
23153 .index \verify\, ACL condition
23154 .index ~~ACL||verifying sender in the header
23155 .index header lines||verifying the sender in
23156 .index sender||verifying in header
23157 .index verifying||sender in header
23158 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
23159 received, that is, in an ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_data\
23160 .em
23161 or \acl@_not@_smtp\. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least
23162 one of the ::Sender::, ::Reply-To::, or ::From:: header lines. Such an address
23163 is loosely thought of as a `sender' address (hence the name of the test).
23164 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
23165 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
23166 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
23167 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the \\MAIL\\ command.
23168 .nem
23169
23170 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
23171 section ~~SECTaddressverification (callouts are described in section
23172 ~~SECTcallver). You can combine this condition with the \senders\ condition to
23173 restrict it to bounce messages only:
23174 .display asis
23175 deny senders = :
23176 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
23177 !verify = header_sender
23178 .endd
23179
23180 .item "verify = header@_syntax"
23181 .index \verify\, ACL condition
23182 .index ~~ACL||verifying header syntax
23183 .index header lines||verifying syntax
23184 .index verifying||header syntax
23185 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
23186 received, that is, in an ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_data\
23187 or \acl@_not@_smtp\.
23188 It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain lists of addresses
23189 (::Sender::, ::From::, ::Reply-To::, ::To::, ::Cc::, and ::Bcc::).
23190 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are permitted only in
23191 locally generated messages and from hosts that match
23192 \sender@_unqualified@_hosts\ or \recipient@_unqualified@_hosts\, as
23193 appropriate.
23194
23195 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
23196 ploy is to send syntactically invalid headers such as
23197 .display asis
23198 To: @
23199 .endd
23200 and this condition can be used to reject such messages.
23201
23202 .item "verify = helo"
23203 .index \verify\, ACL condition
23204 .index ~~ACL||verifying HELO/EHLO
23205 .index \\HELO\\||verifying
23206 .index \\EHLO\\||verifying
23207 .index verifying||\\EHLO\\
23208 .index verifying||\\HELO\\
23209 This condition is true if a \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command has been received from
23210 the client host, and its contents have been verified. Verification of these
23211 commands does not happen by default. See the description of the
23212 \helo@_verify@_hosts\ and \helo@_try@_verify@_hosts\ options for details of how
23213 to request it.
23214
23215 .item "verify = recipient/<<options>>"
23216 .index \verify\, ACL condition
23217 .index ~~ACL||verifying recipient
23218 .index recipient||verifying
23219 .index verifying||recipient
23220 This condition is relevant only after a \\RCPT\\ command. It verifies the
23221 current recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at
23222 section ~~SECTaddressverification. After a recipient has been verified, the
23223 value of \$address@_data$\ is the last value that was set while routing the
23224 address. This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is
23225 being verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with
23226 the new address, and in that case, the subsequent value of \$address@_data$\ is
23227 the value for the child address.
23228
23229
23230 .item "verify = reverse@_host@_lookup"
23231 .index \verify\, ACL condition
23232 .index ~~ACL||verifying host reverse lookup
23233 .index host||verifying reverse lookup
23234 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
23235 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
23236 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched \host@_lookup\.)
23237 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
23238 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
23239 original IP address.
23240
23241 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
23242 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
23243
23244
23245 .item "verify = sender/<<options>>"
23246 .index \verify\, ACL condition
23247 .index ~~ACL||verifying sender
23248 .index sender||verifying
23249 .index verifying||sender
23250 This condition is relevant only after a \\MAIL\\ or \\RCPT\\ command, or after
23251 a message has been received (the \acl@_smtp@_data\ or \acl@_not@_smtp\ ACLs).
23252 If the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
23253 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
23254 .em
23255 If there is data in the \$address@_data$\ variable at the end of routing, its
23256 value is placed in \$sender__address__data$\ at the end of verification. This
23257 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
23258 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
23259 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
23260
23261 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
23262 ~~SECTaddressverification. Exim caches the result of sender verification, to
23263 avoid doing it more than once per message.
23264
23265 .item "verify = sender=<<address>>/<<options>>"
23266 .index \verify\, ACL condition
23267 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
23268 verified as a sender.
23269
23270 .enditems
23271
23272
23273
23274 .section Using DNS lists
23275 .rset SECTmorednslists "~~chapter.~~section"
23276 .index DNS list||in ACL
23277 .index black list (DNS)
23278 .index ~~ACL||testing a DNS list
23279 In its simplest form, the \dnslists\ condition tests whether the calling host
23280 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
23281 address in one or more DNS domains. For example, if the calling host's IP
23282 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
23283 .display asis
23284 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
23285 dialups.mail-abuse.org
23286 .endd
23287 the following records are looked up:
23288 .display asis
23289 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
23290 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
23291 .endd
23292 .em
23293 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
23294 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an `or' conjunction. If you want to
23295 test that a host is on more than one list (an `and' conjunction), you can use
23296 two separate conditions:
23297 .display asis
23298 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
23299 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
23300 .endd
23301 .nem
23302 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
23303 behaves as if the host
23304 .em
23305 does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS record does not exist. If
23306 there are further items in the DNS list, they are processed.
23307 .nem
23308 This is usually the required action when \dnslists\ is used with \deny\ (which
23309 is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from blocking
23310 mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the following
23311 special items in the list:
23312 .index \"+include@_unknown"\
23313 .index \"+exclude@_unknown"\
23314 .index \"+defer@_unknown"\
23315 .display
23316 +include@_unknown $rm{behave as if the item is on the list}
23317 +exclude@_unknown $rm{behave as if the item is not on the list (default)}
23318 +defer@_unknown $rm{give a temporary error}
23319 .endd
23320 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
23321 .display asis
23322 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
23323 .endd
23324
23325 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
23326 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
23327 .display asis
23328 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
23329 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
23330 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
23331 .endd
23332
23333 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
23334 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
23335 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
23336 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
23337
23338
23339 .em
23340 .section Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup
23341 .index DNS list||keyed by explicit IP address
23342 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
23343 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
23344 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
23345 .display asis
23346 deny dnslists = black.list.tls/192.168.1.2
23347 .endd
23348 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
23349 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
23350 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
23351 ~~SECTmulkeyfor below.
23352 .nem
23353
23354
23355 .section DNS lists keyed on domain names
23356 .index DNS list||keyed by domain name
23357 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
23358 addresses (see for example the \*domain based zones*\ link at
23359 \?http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/?\). No reversing of components is used with
23360 these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by listing
23361 it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
23362 .display asis
23363 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
23364 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
23365 .endd
23366 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
23367 \\RCPT\\ or \\DATA\\ commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
23368 example) the message's sender is \*user@@tld.example*\ the name that is looked
23369 up by this example is
23370 .display asis
23371 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
23372 .endd
23373 .em
23374 A single \dnslists\ condition can contain entries for both names and IP
23375 addresses. For example:
23376 .display asis
23377 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
23378 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
23379 .endd
23380 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
23381 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
23382 .nem
23383
23384
23385 .em
23386 .section Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list
23387 .rset SECTmulkeyfor "~~chapter.~~section"
23388 .index DNS list||multiple keys for
23389 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
23390 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
23391 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
23392 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
23393 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
23394 either to double the separators like this:
23395 .display asis
23396 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
23397 .endd
23398 or to change the separator character, like this:
23399 .display asis
23400 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
23401 .endd
23402 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
23403 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
23404 occurs. Consider this condition:
23405 .display asis
23406 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
23407 .endd
23408 The DNS lookups that occur are:
23409 .display asis
23410 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
23411 a.domain.black.list.tld
23412 .endd
23413 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
23414 address, if specified -- see section ~~SECTaddmatcon), no further lookups are
23415 done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains or
23416 IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
23417 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
23418 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
23419 error for a previous item.
23420
23421 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
23422 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
23423 .display asis
23424 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
23425 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
23426 .endd
23427 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
23428 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
23429 .display asis
23430 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
23431 $sender_address_domain \
23432 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
23433 see $dnslist_text.
23434 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
23435 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
23436 $sender_address_domain} }} }
23437 .endd
23438 Note the use of \">|"\ in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
23439 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
23440 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
23441 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
23442 .display asis
23443 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
23444 .endd
23445 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
23446 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
23447 .nem
23448
23449
23450
23451 .section Data returned by DNS lists
23452 .index DNS list||data returned from
23453 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
23454 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
23455 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
23456 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
23457 .display rm
23458 .tabs 12
23459 127.1.0.1 $t RBL
23460 127.1.0.2 $t DUL
23461 127.1.0.3 $t DUL and RBL
23462 127.1.0.4 $t RSS
23463 127.1.0.5 $t RSS and RBL
23464 127.1.0.6 $t RSS and DUL
23465 127.1.0.7 $t RSS and DUL and RBL
23466 .endd
23467 Some DNS lists may return more than one address record.
23468
23469 .section Variables set from DNS lists
23470 .index DNS list||variables set from
23471 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable \$dnslist@_domain$\
23472 contains the name of the domain that matched, \$dnslist@_value$\ contains the
23473 data from the entry, and \$dnslist@_text$\ contains the contents of any
23474 associated TXT record. If more than one address record is returned by the DNS
23475 lookup, all the IP addresses are included in \$dnslist@_value$\, separated by
23476 commas and spaces.
23477
23478 You can use these variables in \message\ or \log@_message\ modifiers --
23479 although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not expanded
23480 until after it has failed. For example:
23481 .display asis
23482 deny hosts = !+local_networks
23483 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
23484 at $dnslist_domain
23485 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
23486 .endd
23487
23488
23489 .section Additional matching conditions for DNS lists
23490 .rset SECTaddmatcon "~~chapter.~~section"
23491 .index DNS list||matching specific returned data
23492 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a \dnslists\ domain name in
23493 order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
23494 For example,
23495 .display asis
23496 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
23497 .endd
23498 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
23499 any address record is considered to be a match. If more than one address record
23500 is found on the list, they are all checked for a matching right-hand side.
23501
23502 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
23503 separator. These are alternatives -- if any one of them matches, the \dnslists\
23504 condition is true. For example:
23505 .display asis
23506 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
23507 .endd
23508
23509 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
23510 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
23511 first. For example:
23512 .display asis
23513 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
23514 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
23515 .endd
23516
23517 If the character `&' is used instead of `=', the comparison for each listed
23518 IP address is done by a bitwise `and' instead of by an equality test. In
23519 other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
23520 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
23521 tested. For example:
23522 .display asis
23523 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
23524 .endd
23525 matches if the address is \*x.x.x.*\3, \*x.x.x.*\7, \*x.x.x.*\11, etc. If you
23526 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
23527 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
23528 .display asis
23529 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
23530 .endd
23531 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
23532 an odd number.
23533
23534
23535 .section Negated DNS matching conditions
23536 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a \dnslists\
23537 condition. Whereas
23538 .display asis
23539 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
23540 .endd
23541 means `deny if the host is in the black list at the domain \*a.b.c*\ and the IP
23542 address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3',
23543 .display asis
23544 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
23545 .endd
23546 means `deny if the host is in the black list at the domain \*a.b.c*\ and the IP
23547 address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3'. In other
23548 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
23549 the `=' (or the `&') sign.
23550
23551 \**Note**\: this kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
23552 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
23553
23554 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
23555 previous example is precisely equivalent to
23556 .display asis
23557 deny dnslists = a.b.c
23558 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
23559 .endd
23560 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
23561 Consider this example:
23562 .display asis
23563 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
23564 list.dsbl.org : \
23565 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
23566 relays.ordb.org
23567 .endd
23568 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
23569 .display asis
23570 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
23571 list.dsbl.org
23572 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
23573 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
23574 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
23575 .endd
23576 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
23577
23578
23579
23580 .section DNS lists and IPv6
23581 .rset SECTmorednslistslast "~~chapter.~~section"
23582 .index IPv6||DNS black lists
23583 .index DNS list||IPv6 usage
23584 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
23585 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
23586 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
23587 .display asis
23588 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
23589 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
23590 .endd
23591 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
23592 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
23593 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
23594 .display asis
23595 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
23596 .endd
23597 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
23598 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3@:@:/4 IPv6 network.
23599
23600 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
23601 \condition\ condition, as in this example:
23602 .display asis
23603 .newline
23604 .em
23605 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
23606 .nem
23607 .newline
23608 dnslists = some.list.example
23609 .endd
23610
23611
23612 .section Address verification
23613 .rset SECTaddressverification "~~chapter.~~section"
23614 .index verifying||address, options for
23615 .index policy control||address verification
23616 Several of the \verify\ conditions described in section ~~SECTaclconditions
23617 cause addresses to be verified. These conditions can be followed by options
23618 that modify the verification process. The options are separated from the
23619 keyword and from each other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters.
23620 For example:
23621 .display asis
23622 verify = sender/callout
23623 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
23624 .endd
23625 .em
23626 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
23627 address through the routers, in `verify mode'. Routers can detect the
23628 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
23629 be varied by a number of generic options such as \verify\ and \verify@_only\
23630 (see chapter ~~CHAProutergeneric). If routing fails, verification fails.
23631 The available options are as follows:
23632 .numberpars $.
23633 If the \callout\ option is specified, successful routing to one or more remote
23634 hosts is followed by a `callout' to those hosts as an additional check.
23635 Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
23636 .nextp
23637 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
23638 normally returns `defer'. However, if you include \defer@_ok\ in the options,
23639 the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
23640 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
23641 .nextp
23642 The \no@_details\ option is covered in section ~~SECTsenaddver, which discusses
23643 the reporting of sender address verification failures.
23644 .endp
23645
23646 .index verifying||address, differentiating failures
23647 After an address verification failure, \$sender@_verify@_failure$\ or
23648 \$recipient@_verify@_failure$\ (as appropriate) contains one of the following
23649 words:
23650 .numberpars $.
23651 \qualify\: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
23652 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
23653 .nextp
23654 \route\: Routing failed.
23655 .nextp
23656 \mail\: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
23657 occurred at or before the \\MAIL\\ command (that is, on initial
23658 connection, \\HELO\\, or \\MAIL\\).
23659 .nextp
23660 \recipient\: The \\RCPT\\ command in a callout was rejected.
23661 .nextp
23662 \postmaster\: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
23663 .endp
23664
23665 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
23666 rejections of \\MAIL\\ and rejections of \\RCPT\\ in callouts.
23667
23668 .nem
23669
23670
23671 .section Callout verification
23672 .rset SECTcallver "~~chapter.~~section"
23673 .index verifying||address, by callout
23674 .index callout||verification
23675 .index SMTP||callout verification
23676 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
23677 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
23678 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
23679 \*callback*\ to the sending host (for a sender address) or a \*callforward*\ to
23680 a subsequent host (for a recipient address), to see if the host accepts the
23681 address. We use the term \*callout*\ to cover both cases. This facility should
23682 be used with care, because it can add a lot of resource usage to the cost of
23683 verifying an address. However, Exim does cache the results of callouts, which
23684 helps to reduce the cost. Details of caching are in the next section.
23685
23686 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
23687 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
23688 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver.
23689 A successful callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address
23690 would succeed; on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that
23691 a delivery would fail.
23692
23693 If the \callout\ option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
23694 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
23695 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a \%dnslookup%\ or a
23696 \%manualroute%\ router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
23697 router that does not set up hosts routes to an \%smtp%\ transport with a
23698 \hosts\ setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an \%smtp%\ transport has
23699 \hosts@_override\ set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
23700 supplies a host list.
23701
23702 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
23703 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
23704 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
23705 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
23706 specified.
23707
23708 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
23709 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
23710 following SMTP commands are sent:
23711 .display
23712 .newline
23713 .em
23714 HELO <<smtp active host name>>
23715 .nem
23716 .newline
23717 MAIL FROM:@<@>
23718 RCPT TO:<<the address to be tested>>
23719 QUIT
23720 .endd
23721 \\LHLO\\ is used instead of \\HELO\\ if the transport's \protocol\ option is
23722 set to `lmtp'.
23723
23724 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
23725 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
23726 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
23727 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
23728 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
23729 \use@_sender\ and \use@_postmaster\ options, described in the next section.
23730
23731 If the response to the \\RCPT\\ command is a 2$it{xx} code, the verification
23732 succeeds. If it is 5$it{xx}, the verification fails. For any other condition,
23733 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
23734 hosts, the ACL yields `defer', unless the \defer@_ok\ parameter of the
23735 \callout\ option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
23736
23737
23738
23739
23740 .section Additional parameters for callouts
23741 .rset CALLaddparcall "~~chapter.~~section"
23742 .index callout||additional parameters for
23743 The \callout\ option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of optional
23744 parameters, separated by commas. For example:
23745 .display asis
23746 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
23747 .endd
23748 The old syntax, which had \callout@_defer@_ok\ and \check@_postmaster\ as
23749 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
23750 deprecated. The additional parameters for \callout\ are as follows:
23751
23752 .startitems
23753
23754 .item "<<a time interval>>"
23755 .index callout||timeout, specifying
23756 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
23757 For example:
23758 .display asis
23759 verify = sender/callout=5s
23760 .endd
23761 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
23762 remote host.
23763 .em
23764 It is also used for the intial connection, unless overridden by the \connect\
23765 parameter.
23766 .nem
23767
23768 .em
23769 .item "connect = <<time interval>>"
23770 .index callout||connection timeout, specifying
23771 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually
23772 smaller) timeout for making the SMTP connection.
23773 For example:
23774 .display asis
23775 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
23776 .endd
23777 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
23778 .nem
23779
23780 .item "defer@_ok"
23781 .index callout||defer, action on
23782 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
23783 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
23784 updated in this circumstance.
23785
23786 .em
23787 .item "mailfrom = <<email address>>"
23788 .index callout||sender when verifying header
23789 When verifying addresses in header lines using the \header@_sender\
23790 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
23791 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
23792 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
23793 \\MAIL\\ command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be
23794 used as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce
23795 messages (empty senders). The \mailfrom\ callout parameter allows you to
23796 specify what address to use in the \\MAIL\\ command. For example:
23797 .display asis
23798 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
23799 .endd
23800 This parameter is available only for the \header@_sender\ verification option.
23801 .nem
23802
23803 .em
23804 .item "maxwait = <<time interval>>"
23805 .index callout||overall timeout, specifying
23806 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
23807 For example:
23808 .display asis
23809 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
23810 .endd
23811 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
23812 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
23813 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
23814 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
23815 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
23816 .nem
23817
23818 .item "no@_cache"
23819 .index callout||cache, suppressing
23820 .index caching||callout, suppressing
23821 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
23822
23823 .item "postmaster"
23824 .index callout||postmaster, checking
23825 When this parameter is set, a sucessful callout check is followed by a similar
23826 check for the local part \*postmaster*\ at the same domain. If this address is
23827 rejected, the callout fails. The result of the postmaster check is recorded in
23828 a cache record; if it is a failure, this is used to fail subsequent callouts
23829 for the domain without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
23830
23831 .em
23832 .item "postmaster@_mailfrom = <<email address>>"
23833 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the \\MAIL\\ command by default.
23834 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
23835 For example:
23836 .display asis
23837 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
23838 .endd
23839 If both \postmaster\ and \postmaster@_mailfrom\ are present, the rightmost one
23840 overrides. The \postmaster\ parameter is equivalent to this example:
23841 .display asis
23842 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
23843 .endd
23844 \**Warning**\: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
23845 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
23846 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
23847 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
23848 .nem
23849
23850 .item "random"
23851 .index callout||`random' check
23852 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
23853 check for a `random' local part at the same domain. The local part is not
23854 really random -- it is defined by the expansion of the option
23855 \callout@_random@_local@_part\, which defaults to
23856 .display asis
23857 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
23858 .endd
23859 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
23860 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
23861 specific local parts. If the `random' check succeeds, the result is saved in
23862 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
23863 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
23864
23865 .item "use@_postmaster"
23866 .index callout||sender for recipient check
23867 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
23868 .display asis
23869 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
23870 .endd
23871 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the \\MAIL\\ command
23872 when performing the callout. The local part of the address is \"postmaster"\
23873 and the domain is the contents of \$qualify@_domain$\.
23874
23875 .item "use@_sender"
23876 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
23877 .display asis
23878 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
23879 .endd
23880 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the \\MAIL\\
23881 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
23882 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
23883 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
23884 usefulness of callout caching.
23885
23886 .enditems
23887
23888 .em
23889 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the \\MAIL\\
23890 command (\mailfrom\, \postmaster@_mailfrom\, \use@_postmaster\, or
23891 \use@_sender\), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
23892 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
23893 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
23894 Therefore, it is normally safe to use \use@_postmaster\ or \use@_sender\ in
23895 these circumstances.
23896
23897 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
23898 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
23899 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
23900 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in \\MAIL\\, thus avoiding a
23901 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
23902 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
23903 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
23904
23905 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
23906 caching. When you set \mailfrom\ or \use@_sender\, the cache record is keyed by
23907 the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
23908 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
23909
23910 .nem
23911
23912
23913 .section Callout caching
23914 .rset SECTcallvercache "~~chapter.~~section"
23915 .index hints database||callout cache
23916 .index callout||caching
23917 .index caching||callout
23918 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
23919 used, unless you specify the \no@_cache\ parameter with the \callout\ option.
23920 A hints database called `callout' is used for the cache. Two different record
23921 types are used: one records the result of a callout check for a specific
23922 address, and the other records information that applies to the entire domain
23923 (for example, that it accepts the local part \*postmaster*\).
23924
23925 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
23926 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
23927 is not available.
23928
23929 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
23930 independent, and can be set by the global options \callout@_negative@_expire\
23931 (default 2h) and \callout@_positive@_expire\ (default 24h), respectively.
23932
23933 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
23934 commands up to and including
23935 .display asis
23936 MAIL FROM:<>
23937 .endd
23938 (but not including the \\MAIL\\ command with a non-empty address),
23939 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
23940 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
23941 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
23942 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
23943 \callout@_domain@_negative@_expire\ (default 3h) and
23944 \callout__domain__positive@_expire\ (default 7d).
23945
23946 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
23947 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
23948 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
23949 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting `random' local parts
23950 will eventually be noticed.
23951
23952 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
23953 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
23954 behaviour will be the same.
23955
23956
23957 .section Sender address verification reporting
23958 .rset SECTsenaddver "~~chapter.~~section"
23959 .index verifying||suppressing error details
23960 When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the failure are
23961 given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the relevant
23962 SMTP command (\\RCPT\\ or \\DATA\\). For example, if sender callout is in use,
23963 you might see:
23964 .display asis
23965 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
23966 250 OK
23967 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
23968 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
23969 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
23970 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
23971 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
23972 550 Sender verification failed
23973 .endd
23974 If more than one \\RCPT\\ command fails in the same way, the details are given
23975 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
23976 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
23977 `/no@_details' to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
23978 example:
23979 .display asis
23980 verify = sender/no_details
23981 .endd
23982
23983
23984 .section Redirection while verifying
23985 .index verifying||redirection while
23986 .index address redirection||while verifying
23987 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
23988 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
23989 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
23990 it? Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
23991 .numberpars $.
23992 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
23993 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
23994 verification also fails.
23995 .nextp
23996 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
23997 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
23998 .endp
23999 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
24000 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
24001 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
24002 .display asis
24003 A.Wol: aw123
24004 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
24005 .endd
24006 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
24007 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
24008 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
24009 verification to succeed.
24010
24011
24012 .section Using an ACL to control relaying
24013 .rset SECTrelaycontrol "~~chapter.~~section"
24014 .index ~~ACL||relay control
24015 .index relaying||control by ACL
24016 .index policy control||relay control
24017 An MTA is said to \*relay*\ a message if it receives it from some host and
24018 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
24019 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
24020 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
24021 .index `percent hack'
24022 but a redirection as a result of the `percent hack' is.
24023
24024 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed `incoming' and `outgoing'. A host
24025 which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
24026 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
24027 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
24028 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
24029 same host is fulfilling both functions, as illustrated in the diagram below,
24030 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
24031 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
24032 system to arbitrary domains.
24033 .if ~~sys.fancy
24034 .figure "Controlled relaying" rm
24035 .indent 0
24036 .call aspic -sgcal -nv
24037 centre ~~sys.linelength;
24038 magnify 0.8;
24039 boundingbox 30;
24040 textdepth 16;
24041 boxwidth 120;
24042 boxdepth 44;
24043 A: box "Arbitrary" "remote hosts";
24044 C: ibox;
24045 D: box "Arbitrary" "domains";
24046 iline down 50 from bottom of C;
24047 H: box width 180 "Local host";
24048 iline down 50;
24049 E: ibox;
24050 SH: box "Specific" "hosts";
24051 SD: box join right to E "Specific" "domains";
24052 arcarrow clockwise from top of SH to bottom of D plus (-10,-4)
24053 via right of H plus (-20,0);
24054 arcarrow clockwise from bottom of A to top of SD plus (10,4)
24055 via left of H plus (20,0);
24056
24057 ibox join left to right of H "$it{Outgoing}";
24058 goto H;
24059 ibox join right to left of H "$it{Incoming}";
24060
24061 L: line dashed from right of A to top of H plus (-15,0);
24062 arc dashed to top of H plus (15,0);
24063 arrow dashed to left of D plus (-2,0);
24064
24065 arrow dashed back up 72 right 32 from middle of L plus (8,0);
24066 text at end plus (0, 4) "$it{Not wanted}";
24067 .endcall
24068 .endfigure
24069 .elif !~~html
24070 .display asis
24071 -------------- -----------
24072 | Arbitrary | |Arbitrary|
24073 |remote hosts| | domains |
24074 -------------- -----------
24075 I v ^ O
24076 n v ^ u
24077 c ---v----------------^--- t
24078 o | v Local ^ | g
24079 m | v host ^ | o
24080 i ---v----------------^--- i
24081 n v ^ n
24082 g v ^ g
24083 Specific Specific
24084 domains hosts
24085 .endd
24086 .else
24087 [(IMG SRC="relaying.gif" alt="Controlled relaying")][(br)]
24088 .fi
24089
24090 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
24091 runs for each \\RCPT\\ command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
24092 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
24093 example, suppose you want to do the following:
24094 .numberpars $.
24095 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
24096 locally in some other way). Let's say these are \*my.dom1.example*\ and
24097 \*my.dom2.example*\.
24098 .nextp
24099 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
24100 These might be \*friend1.example*\ and \*friend2.example*\.
24101 .nextp
24102 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
24103 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
24104 .endp
24105 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
24106 .display asis
24107 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
24108 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
24109 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
24110 .endd
24111 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every \\RCPT\\
24112 command:
24113 .display asis
24114 acl_check_rcpt:
24115 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
24116 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
24117 .endd
24118 The first statement accepts any \\RCPT\\ command that contains an address in
24119 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
24120 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
24121 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
24122 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
24123 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
24124 in chapter ~~CHAPdefconfil.
24125
24126
24127 .section Checking a relay configuration
24128 .rset SECTcheralcon "~~chapter.~~section"
24129 .index relaying||checking control of
24130 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
24131 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
24132 the \-bh-\ option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
24133
24134 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
24135 \*relay-test.mail-abuse.org*\ provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
24136 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
24137 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
24138 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
24139 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
24140 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
24141
24142
24143
24144
24145 .
24146 .
24147 .
24148 .
24149 . ============================================================================
24150 .chapter Content scanning
24151 .set runningfoot "content scanning"
24152 .rset CHAPexiscan "~~chapter"
24153 .index content scanning
24154 .em
24155 The content-scanning extension of Exim, formerly known as `exiscan', was
24156 originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code was integrated into
24157 the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to maintain it. Most
24158 of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's specification.
24159
24160 If you want to include the content-scanning features when you compile Exim, you
24161 need to arrange for \\WITH@_CONTENT@_SCAN\\ to be defined in your
24162 \(Local/Makefile)\. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
24163 .numberpars $.
24164 An additional ACL (\acl@_smtp@_mime\) that is run for all MIME parts.
24165 .nextp
24166 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: \decode\, \malware\, \mime@_regex\,
24167 \regex\, and \spam\. These can be used in the ACL that is run at the end of
24168 message reception (the \acl@_smtp@_data\ ACL).
24169 .nextp
24170 An additional control feature (`no@_mbox@_unspool') that saves spooled copies
24171 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
24172 .nextp
24173 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
24174 conditions.
24175 .nextp
24176 Two new main configuration options: \av@_scanner\ and \spamd@_address\.
24177 .endp
24178 There is another content-scanning configuration option for \(Local/Makefile)\,
24179 called \\WITH@_OLD@_DEMIME\\. If this is set, the old, deprecated \demime\ ACL
24180 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
24181
24182 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
24183 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
24184 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
24185 \\EXPERIMENTAL@_\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\. Such features are not documented in
24186 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
24187 \(doc/experimental.txt)\.
24188
24189 All the content-scanning facilites work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
24190 temporarily created in a file called:
24191 .display
24192 <<spool@_directory>>/scan/<<message@_id>>/<<message@_id>>.eml
24193 .endd
24194 The \(.eml)\ extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
24195 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
24196 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
24197 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
24198 removed when the \acl@_smtp@_data\ ACL has finished running, unless
24199 .display asis
24200 control = no_mbox_unspool
24201 .endd
24202 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
24203 same directory by default.
24204
24205
24206 .section Scanning for viruses
24207 .rset SECTscanvirus "~~chapter.~~section"
24208 .index virus scanning
24209 .index content scanning||for viruses
24210 .index content scanning||the \malware\ condition
24211 The \malware\ ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim. It
24212 supports a `generic' interface to scanners called via the shell, and
24213 specialized interfaces for `daemon' type virus scanners, which are resident in
24214 memory and thus are much faster.
24215
24216 .index \av@_scanner\
24217 You can set the \av@_scanner\ option in first part of the Exim configuration
24218 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
24219 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
24220 .display
24221 av@_scanner = <<scanner-type>>:<<option1>>:<<option2>>:[...]
24222 .endd
24223 If you do not set \av@_scanner\, it defaults to
24224 .display asis
24225 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
24226 .endd
24227 If the value of \av@_scanner\ starts with dollar character, it is expanded
24228 before use.
24229
24230 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
24231 .numberpars $.
24232 .index virus scanners||Kaspersky
24233 \aveserver\: This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a
24234 trial version at \?http://www.kaspersky.com?\. This scanner type takes one
24235 option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in
24236 this example:
24237 .display asis
24238 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
24239 .endd
24240
24241 .nextp
24242 .index virus scanners||clamd
24243 \clamd\: This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
24244 \?http://www.clamav.net/?\. Clamd does not seem to unpack MIME containers, so
24245 it is recommended to unpack MIME attachments in the MIME ACL. It takes one
24246 option: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
24247 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
24248 .display asis
24249 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
24250 av_scanner = clamd:192.168.2.100 1234
24251 .endd
24252 If the option is unset, the default is \(/tmp/clamd)\. Thanks to David Saez for
24253 contributing the code for this scanner.
24254
24255 .nextp
24256 .index virus scanners||command line interface
24257 \cmdline\: This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface.
24258 It can be used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This
24259 scanner type takes 3 mandatory options:
24260 .numberpars
24261 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
24262 and a placeholder (%s) for the directory to scan.
24263 .nextp
24264 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the virus
24265 scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make absolutely
24266 sure that this expression matches on `virus found'. This is called the
24267 `trigger' expression.
24268 .nextp
24269 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
24270 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
24271 `name' expression.
24272 .endp
24273 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
24274 .display asis
24275 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
24276 .endd
24277 For the trigger expression, we can just match the word `found'. For the name
24278 expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match for
24279 the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
24280 configuration setting:
24281 .display asis
24282 av_scanner = cmdline:\
24283 /path/to/sweep -all -rec -archive %s:\
24284 found:'(.+)'
24285 .endd
24286
24287 .nextp
24288 .index virus scanners||DrWeb
24289 \drweb\: The DrWeb daemon scanner (\?http://www.sald.com/?\) interface
24290 takes one argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and
24291 port separated by whitespace, as in these examples:
24292 .display asis
24293 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
24294 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
24295 .endd
24296 If you omit the argument, the default path \(/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock)\
24297 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
24298
24299 .nextp
24300 .index virus scanners||F-Secure
24301 \fsecure\: The F-Secure daemon scanner (\?http://www.f-secure.com?\) takes one
24302 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
24303 .display asis
24304 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
24305 .endd
24306 If no argument is given, the default is \(/var/run/.fsav)\. Thanks to Johan
24307 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
24308
24309 .nextp
24310 .index virus scanners||Kaspersky
24311 \kavdaemon\: This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of
24312 the Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see \aveserver\ above). This
24313 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
24314 For example:
24315 .display asis
24316 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
24317 .endd
24318 The default path is \(/var/run/AvpCtl)\.
24319
24320 .nextp
24321 .index virus scanners||mksd
24322 \mksd\: This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
24323 though some parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it
24324 at \?http://linux.mks.com.pl/?\. The only option for this scanner type is the
24325 maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
24326 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
24327 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
24328 .display asis
24329 av_scanner = mksd:2
24330 .endd
24331 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
24332
24333 .nextp
24334 .index virus scanners||Sophos and Sophie
24335 \sophie\: Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' \libsavi\ library to scan for
24336 viruses. You can get Sophie at \?http://www.vanja.com/tools/sophie/?\. The only
24337 option for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses
24338 for client communication. For example:
24339 .display asis
24340 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
24341 .endd
24342 The default path is \(/var/run/sophie)\, so if you are using this, you can omit
24343 the option.
24344 .endp
24345
24346 When \av@_scanner\ is correctly set, you can use the \malware\ condition in the
24347 \\DATA\\ ACL. The \av@_scanner\ option is expanded each time \malware\ is
24348 called. This makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for
24349 an example. The \malware\ condition caches its results, so when you use it
24350 multiple times for the same message, the actual scanning process is only
24351 carried out once. However, using expandable items in \av@_scanner\ disables
24352 this caching, in which case each use of the \malware\ condition causes a new
24353 scan of the message.
24354
24355 The \malware\ condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
24356 use. It can then be one of
24357 .numberpars $.
24358 `true', `*', or `1', in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
24359 condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
24360 recommended usage.
24361 .nextp
24362 `false' or `0', in which case no scanning is done and the condition fails
24363 immediately.
24364 .nextp
24365 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
24366 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
24367 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
24368 .endp
24369 You can append \"/defer@_ok"\ to the \malware\ condition to accept messages even
24370 if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
24371
24372 .index \$malware@_name$\
24373 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
24374 \$malware@_name$\ that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
24375 \message\ modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
24376 logging data.
24377
24378 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
24379 use the \demime\ condition (see section ~~SECTdemimecond) before the \malware\
24380 condition.
24381
24382 Here is a very simple scanning example:
24383 .display asis
24384 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
24385 demime = *
24386 malware = *
24387 .endd
24388 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
24389 .display asis
24390 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
24391 demime = *
24392 malware = */defer_ok
24393 .endd
24394 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
24395 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
24396 .display asis
24397 av_scanner = $acl_m0
24398 .endd
24399 in the main Exim configuration.
24400 .display asis
24401 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
24402 set acl_m0 = sophie
24403 malware = *
24404
24405 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
24406 set acl_m0 = aveserver
24407 malware = *
24408 .endd
24409
24410
24411 .section Scanning with SpamAssassin
24412 .rset SECTscanspamass "~~chapter.~~section"
24413 .index content scanning||for spam
24414 .index spam scanning
24415 .index SpamAssassin, scanning with
24416 The \spam\ ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's \spamd\ daemon to get a spam
24417 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
24418 \?http://www.spamassassin.org?\, or, if you have a working Perl installation,
24419 you can use CPAN by running:
24420 .display asis
24421 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
24422 .endd
24423 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
24424 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
24425 nicely, however.
24426
24427 .index \spamd@_address\
24428 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the \spamd\ daemon.
24429 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
24430 port for \spamd\, you must set the \spamd@_address\ option in the global part
24431 of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
24432 .display asis
24433 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
24434 .endd
24435 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
24436 \spamd\ also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
24437 these, supply \spamd@_address\ with an absolute file name instead of a
24438 address/port pair:
24439 .display asis
24440 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
24441 .endd
24442
24443 You can have multiple \spamd\ servers to improve scalability. These can reside
24444 on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple \spamd\
24445 servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the \spamd@_address\ option,
24446 separated with colons:
24447 .display asis
24448 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
24449 192.168.2.11 783 : \
24450 192.168.2.12 783
24451 .endd
24452 Up to 32 \spamd\ servers are supported. The servers are
24453 queried in a random fashion. When a server fails to respond
24454 to the connection attempt, all other servers are tried
24455 until one succeeds. If no server responds, the \spam\
24456 condition defers.
24457
24458 \**Warning**\: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
24459 multiple \spamd\ servers.
24460
24461 Here is a simple example of the use of the \spam\ condition in a DATA ACL:
24462 .display asis
24463 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
24464 spam = joe
24465 .endd
24466 The right-hand side of the \spam\ condition specifies the username that
24467 SpamAssassin should scan for. If you do not want to scan for a particular user,
24468 but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide default profile, you can scan for
24469 an unknown user, or simply use `nobody'. However, you must put something on the
24470 right-hand side.
24471
24472 The username allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles. The
24473 right-hand side is expanded before being used, so you can put lookups or
24474 conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to `0' or `false', no
24475 scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
24476
24477 The \spam\ condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
24478 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
24479 \spam\ condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
24480 it always return `true' by appending \":true"\ to the username.
24481
24482 .index spam scanning||returned variables
24483 When the \spam\ condition is run, it sets up the following expansion
24484 variables:
24485
24486 .push
24487 .indent 2em
24488
24489 .tempindent 0
24490 \$spam@_score$\: The spam score of the message, for example `3.4' or `30.5'.
24491 This is useful for inclusion in log or reject messages.
24492
24493 .tempindent 0
24494 \$spam@_score@_int$\: The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an
24495 integer value. For example `34' or `305'. This is useful for numeric
24496 comparisons in conditions. This variable is special; it is saved with the
24497 message, and written to Exim's spool file. This means that it can be used
24498 during the whole life of the message on your Exim system, in particular, in
24499 routers or transports during the later delivery phase.
24500
24501 .tempindent 0
24502 \$spam@_bar$\: A string consisting of a number of `+' or `@-' characters,
24503 representing the integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4
24504 would have a \$spam@_bar$\ value of `++++'. This is useful for inclusion in
24505 warning headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
24506
24507 .tempindent 0
24508 \$spam@_report$\: A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin
24509 report for the message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
24510
24511 .pop
24512
24513 The \spam\ condition caches its results. If you call it again with the same user
24514 name, it does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
24515
24516 The \spam\ condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running the
24517 message through SpamAssassin. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to
24518 the next ACL statement block), append \"/defer@_ok"\ to the right-hand side of
24519 the spam condition, like this:
24520 .display asis
24521 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
24522 spam = joe/defer_ok
24523 .endd
24524 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a
24525 problem with \spamd\.
24526
24527 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the \spam\
24528 condition:
24529 .display asis
24530 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
24531 warn message = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
24532 spam = nobody:true
24533 warn message = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
24534 spam = nobody:true
24535
24536 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
24537 # is over threshold
24538 warn message = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
24539 spam = nobody
24540
24541 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
24542 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
24543 spam = nobody:true
24544 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
24545 .endd
24546
24547
24548
24549 .section Scanning MIME parts
24550 .rset SECTscanmimepart "~~chapter.~~section"
24551 .index content scanning||MIME parts
24552 .index MIME content scanning
24553 .index \acl@_smtp@_mime\
24554 The \acl@_smtp@_mime\ global option defines an ACL that is called once for each
24555 MIME part of a message, including multipart types, in the sequence of their
24556 position in the message.
24557
24558 This ACL is called (possibly many times) just before the \acl@_smtp@_data\ ACL,
24559 but only if the message has a ::MIME-Version:: header. When a call to the MIME
24560 ACL does not yield `accept', ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
24561 result code is sent to the remote client. The \acl@_smtp@_data\ ACL is not
24562 called in this circumstance.
24563
24564 At the start of the MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
24565 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
24566 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
24567 parts whose content-type is `message/rfc822'. If you want to decode a MIME part
24568 into a disk file, you can use the \decode\ modifier. The general syntax is:
24569 .display
24570 decode = [/<<path>>/]<<filename>>
24571 .endd
24572 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
24573 the value can be:
24574 .numberpars
24575 `0' or `false', in which case no decoding is done.
24576 .nextp
24577 The string `default'. In that case, the file is put in the temporary `default'
24578 directory \(<<spool@_directory>>/scan/<<message@_id>>/)\ with a sequential file
24579 name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The full path and name
24580 is available in \$mime@_decoded@_filename$\ after decoding.
24581 .nextp
24582 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
24583 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
24584 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
24585 the full path and file name.
24586 .nextp
24587 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
24588 filename, and the default path is then used.
24589 .endp
24590 You can easily decode a file with its original, proposed
24591 filename using
24592 .display asis
24593 decode = $mime_filename
24594 .endd
24595 However, you should keep in mind that \$mime@_filename$\ might contain
24596 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
24597 automatically unlinked.
24598
24599 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
24600 content-type of `message/rfc822'), the ACL is called again in the same manner
24601 as for the primary message, only that the \$mime@_is@_rfc822$\ expansion
24602 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
24603 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
24604
24605 The MIME ACL supports the \regex\ and \mime@_regex\ conditions. These can be
24606 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
24607 respectively. They are described in section ~~SECTscanregex.
24608
24609 .index MIME content scanning||returned variables
24610 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
24611 available in the MIME ACL:
24612
24613 .push
24614 .indent 2em
24615
24616 .tempindent 0
24617 \$mime@_boundary$\:
24618 If the current part is a multipart (see \$mime@_is@_multipart$\) below, it
24619 should have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current
24620 part has no boundary parameter in the ::Content-Type:: header, this variable
24621 contains the empty string.
24622
24623 .tempindent 0
24624 \$mime@_charset$\:
24625 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
24626 ::Content-Type:: header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
24627 .display asis
24628 us-ascii
24629 gb2312 (Chinese)
24630 iso-8859-1
24631 .endd
24632 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
24633 case-insensitively.
24634
24635 .tempindent 0
24636 \$mime@_content@_description$\:
24637 This variable contains the normalized content of the ::Content-Description::
24638 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
24639 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are
24640 usually only used for display purposes.
24641
24642 .tempindent 0
24643 \$mime@_content@_disposition$\:
24644 This variable contains the normalized content of the ::Content-Disposition::
24645 header. You can expect strings like `attachment' or `inline' here.
24646
24647 .tempindent 0
24648 \$mime@_content@_id$\:
24649 This variable contains the normalized content of the ::Content-ID:: header.
24650 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
24651
24652 .tempindent 0
24653 \$mime@_content@_size$\:
24654 This variable is set only after the \decode\ modifier (see above) has been
24655 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
24656 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
24657 has a \$mime@_content@_size$\ of zero.
24658
24659 .tempindent 0
24660 \$mime@_content@_transfer@_encoding$\:
24661 This variable contains the normalized content of the
24662 ::Content-transfer-encoding:: header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
24663 type. Typical values are `base64' and `quoted-printable'.
24664
24665 .tempindent 0
24666 \$mime@_content@_type$\: If the MIME part has a ::Content-Type:: header, this
24667 variable contains its value, lowercased, and without any options (like `name'
24668 or `charset'). Here are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear
24669 in this variable:
24670 .display asis
24671 text/plain
24672 text/html
24673 application/octet-stream
24674 image/jpeg
24675 audio/midi
24676 .endd
24677 If the MIME part has no ::Content-Type:: header, this variable contains the
24678 empty string.
24679
24680 .tempindent 0
24681 \$mime@_decoded@_filename$\:
24682 This variable is set only after the \decode\ modifier (see above) has been
24683 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
24684 containing the decoded data.
24685
24686 .tempindent 0
24687 \$mime@_filename$\: This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables.
24688 It contains a proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either
24689 the ::Content-Type:: or ::Content-Disposition:: headers. The filename will be
24690 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
24691 found, this variable contains the empty string.
24692
24693 .tempindent 0
24694 \$mime@_is@_coverletter$\:
24695 This variable attempts to differentiate the `cover letter' of an e-mail from
24696 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unneccessarily encoded
24697 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
24698
24699 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
24700 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
24701 follows:
24702 .numberpars
24703 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
24704 .nextp
24705 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter, so
24706 are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
24707 .nextp
24708 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
24709 and the rest are attachments.
24710 .nextp
24711 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
24712 .endp
24713
24714 As an example, the following will ban `HTML mail' (including that sent with
24715 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
24716 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
24717 .display asis
24718 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
24719 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
24720 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
24721 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
24722 .endd
24723
24724
24725 .tempindent 0
24726 \$mime@_is@_multipart$\:
24727 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
24728 `multipart', for example `multipart/alternative' or `multipart/mixed'. Since
24729 multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not want
24730 to carry out specific actions on them.
24731
24732 .tempindent 0
24733 \$mime@_is@_rfc822$\:
24734 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
24735 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
24736 decoding is fully recursive.
24737
24738 .tempindent 0
24739 \$mime@_part@_count$\:
24740 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
24741 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
24742 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
24743 \$mime@_is@_rfc822$\). The counter stays set after \acl@_smtp@_mime\ is
24744 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
24745 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
24746
24747 .pop
24748
24749
24750 .section Scanning with regular expressions
24751 .rset SECTscanregex "~~chapter.~~section"
24752 .index content scanning||with regular expressions
24753 .index regular expressions||content scanning with
24754 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
24755 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
24756
24757 The \regex\ condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
24758 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
24759 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The \regex\ condition matches
24760 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
24761 have multiline matches with the \regex\ condition.
24762
24763 The \mime@_regex\ condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
24764 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
24765 part has not been decoded with the \decode\ modifier earlier in the ACL, it is
24766 decoded automatically when \mime@_regex\ is executed (using default path and
24767 filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first 32K
24768 characters are checked.
24769
24770 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
24771 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
24772 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
24773 with more backslashes, or use the \"@\N"\ facility to disable expansion.
24774 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
24775 .display asis
24776 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
24777 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
24778 .endd
24779 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
24780 \$regex@_match@_string$\ expansion variable is then set up and contains the
24781 matching regular expression.
24782
24783 \**Warning**\: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
24784 CPU-intensive.
24785
24786
24787
24788 .section The demime condition
24789 .rset SECTdemimecond "~~chapter.~~section"
24790 .index content scanning||MIME checking
24791 .index MIME content scanning
24792 The \demime\ ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
24793 extension blocking. It uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
24794 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
24795 condition is deprecated and kept only for for backward compatibility. You must
24796 set the \\WITH@_OLD@_DEMIME\\ option in \(Local/Makefile)\ at build time to be
24797 able to use the \demime\ condition.
24798
24799 The \demime\ condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
24800 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
24801 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
24802 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
24803 scanning, it is recommened that you use the \demime\ condition before the
24804 antivirus (\malware\) condition.
24805
24806 On the right-hand side of the \demime\ condition you can pass a colon-separated
24807 list of file extensions that it should match against. For example:
24808 .display asis
24809 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
24810 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
24811 .endd
24812 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
24813 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, `disk
24814 full'), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
24815 the condition is on a \warn\ verb).
24816
24817 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
24818 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, `false', or
24819 zero (`0'), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
24820
24821 The \demime\ condition set the following variables:
24822
24823 .push
24824 .indent 2em
24825
24826 .tempindent 0
24827 \$demime@_errorlevel$\: When an error is detected in a MIME container, this
24828 variable contains the severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher
24829 the value, the more severe the error. If this variable is unset or zero, no
24830 error occurred.
24831
24832 .tempindent 0
24833 \$demime@_reason$\: When \$demime@_errorlevel$\ is greater than zero, this
24834 variable contains a human-readable text string describing the MIME error that
24835 occurred.
24836
24837 .tempindent 0
24838 \$found@_extension$\: When the \demime\ condition is true, this variable
24839 contains the file extension it found.
24840
24841 .pop
24842
24843 Both \$demime@_errorlevel$\ and \$demime@_reason$\ are set by the first call of
24844 the \demime\ condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
24845
24846 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the \demime\
24847 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass `*' as the
24848 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
24849 facility:
24850 .display asis
24851 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
24852 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
24853 demime = *
24854 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
24855
24856 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
24857 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
24858 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
24859 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
24860
24861 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
24862 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
24863 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
24864 demime = exe:doc
24865 control = freeze
24866 .endd
24867
24868
24869 .nem
24870
24871
24872
24873 .
24874 .
24875 .
24876 .
24877 . ============================================================================
24878 .chapter Adding a local scan function to Exim
24879 .set runningfoot "local scan function"
24880 .rset CHAPlocalscan "~~chapter"
24881 .index \*local@_scan()*\ function||description of
24882 .index customizing||input scan using C function
24883 .index policy control||by local scan function
24884
24885 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
24886 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
24887 .em
24888 The content scanning extension (chapter ~~CHAPexiscan) has facilities for
24889 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
24890 .nem
24891 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the \condition\
24892 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP \\DATA\\ command or the ACL for
24893 non-SMTP messages (see chapter ~~CHAPACL), but this has its limitations.
24894
24895 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
24896 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
24897 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
24898 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
24899
24900 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
24901 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
24902 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
24903 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
24904
24905 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
24906 option called \local@_scan@_timeout\ for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
24907 Zero means `no timeout'.
24908 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
24909 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
24910 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
24911 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
24912 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
24913 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
24914
24915
24916 .section Building Exim to use a local scan function
24917 .index \*local@_scan()*\ function||building Exim to use
24918 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
24919 function is before building Exim, by setting \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_SOURCE\\ in your
24920 \(Local/Makefile)\. A recommended place to put it is in the \(Local)\
24921 directory, so you might set
24922 .display asis
24923 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
24924 .endd
24925 for example. The function must be called \*local@_scan()*\. It is called by
24926 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
24927 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
24928 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
24929 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
24930 \(src/local@_scan.c)\.
24931
24932 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
24933 for your \*local@_scan()*\ function, you must also set
24934 .display asis
24935 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
24936 .endd
24937 in \(Local/Makefile)\ (see section ~~SECTconoptloc below).
24938
24939
24940
24941 .section API for local@_scan()
24942 .rset SECTapiforloc "~~chapter.~~section"
24943 .index \*local@_scan()*\ function||API description
24944 You must include this line near the start of your code:
24945 .display asis
24946 #include "local_scan.h"
24947 .endd
24948 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
24949 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
24950 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
24951 for \"unsigned char"\ called \"uschar"\.
24952 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
24953 strings and pointers to character strings:
24954 .display asis
24955 #define CS (char *)
24956 #define CCS (const char *)
24957 #define CSS (char **)
24958 #define US (unsigned char *)
24959 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
24960 #define USS (unsigned char **)
24961 .endd
24962
24963 The function prototype for \*local@_scan()*\ is:
24964 .display asis
24965 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
24966 .endd
24967 The arguments are as follows:
24968 .numberpars $.
24969 \fd\ is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
24970 (the -D file).
24971 The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not recommended.
24972 \**Warning**\: You must \*not*\ close this file descriptor.
24973
24974 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
24975 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
24976 id followed by \"-D"\ and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
24977 macro \\SPOOL@_DATA@_START@_OFFSET\\ to reset to the start of the data, just in
24978 case this changes in some future version.
24979
24980 .nextp
24981 \return@_text\ is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
24982 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
24983 .endp
24984 The function must return an \int\ value which is one of the following macros:
24985 .numberpars $.
24986 \"LOCAL@_SCAN@_ACCEPT"\
24987
24988 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
24989 the message, and made available in the variable \$local@_scan@_data$\. No
24990 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
24991 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
24992 .nextp
24993 \"LOCAL@_SCAN@_ACCEPT@_FREEZE"\
24994
24995 This behaves as \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_ACCEPT\\, except that the accepted message is
24996 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
24997 .nextp
24998 \"LOCAL@_SCAN@_ACCEPT@_QUEUE"\
24999
25000 This behaves as \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_ACCEPT\\, except that the accepted message is
25001 queued without immediate delivery.
25002 .nextp
25003 \"LOCAL@_SCAN@_REJECT"\
25004
25005 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
25006 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted --
25007 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
25008 \"@\n"\ in log lines.
25009 If no message is given, `Administrative prohibition' is used.
25010 .nextp
25011 \"LOCAL@_SCAN@_TEMPREJECT"\
25012
25013 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
25014 message as for \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_REJECT\\. If no message is given, `Temporary
25015 local problem' is used.
25016 .nextp
25017 \"LOCAL@_SCAN@_REJECT@_NOLOGHDR"\
25018
25019 This behaves as \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_REJECT\\, except that the header of the rejected
25020 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
25021 \rejected@_header\ log selector for just this rejection. If \rejected@_header\
25022 is already unset (see the discussion of the \log@_selection\ option in section
25023 ~~SECTlogselector), this code is the same as \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_REJECT\\.
25024
25025 .nextp
25026 \"LOCAL@_SCAN@_TEMPREJECT@_NOLOGHDR"\
25027
25028 This code is a variation of \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_TEMPREJECT\\ in the same way that
25029 \\LOCAL__SCAN__REJECT__NOLOGHDR\\ is a variation of \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_REJECT\\.
25030 .endp
25031
25032 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
25033 reported by writing to \stderr\ or by sending an email, as configured by the
25034 \-oe-\ command line options.
25035
25036
25037 .section Configuration options for local@_scan()
25038 .rset SECTconoptloc "~~chapter.~~section"
25039 .index \*local@_scan()*\ function||configuration options
25040 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
25041 that set values in static variables in the \*local@_scan()*\ module. If you
25042 want to do this, you must have the line
25043 .display asis
25044 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
25045 .endd
25046 in your \(Local/Makefile)\ when you build Exim. (This line is in
25047 \(OS/Makefile-Default)\, commented out). Then, in the \*local@_scan()*\ source
25048 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table to
25049 define them.
25050
25051 The table must be a vector called \local@_scan@_options\, of type
25052 \"optionlist"\. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
25053 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
25054 alphabetical order. Following \local@_scan@_options\ you must also define a
25055 variable called \local@_scan@_options@_count\ that contains the number of
25056 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
25057 .display asis
25058 static int my_integer_option = 42;
25059 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
25060
25061 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
25062 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
25063 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
25064 };
25065 int local_scan_options_count =
25066 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
25067 .endd
25068 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
25069 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
25070 .display asis
25071 begin local_scan
25072 my_integer = 99
25073 my_string = some string of text...
25074 .endd
25075 The available types of option data are as follows:
25076
25077 .startitems
25078
25079 .item opt@_bool
25080 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to
25081 a variable of type \"BOOL"\, which will be set to \\TRUE\\ or \\FALSE\\, which
25082 are macros that are defined as `1' and `0', respectively. If you want to detect
25083 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
25084 \\TRUE@_UNSET\\. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than
25085 two values.)
25086
25087 .item "opt@_fixed"
25088 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
25089 The address should point to a variable of type \"int"\. The value is stored
25090 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
25091
25092 .item "opt@_int"
25093 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
25094 \"int"\. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
25095 Exim.
25096
25097 .item "opt@_mkint"
25098 This is the same as \opt@_int\, except that when such a value is output in a
25099 \-bP-\ listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
25100 printed with the suffix K or M.
25101
25102 .item "opt@_octint"
25103 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpeted as an
25104 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
25105 always output in octal.
25106
25107 .item "opt@_stringptr"
25108 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
25109 variable that points to a string (for example, of type \"uschar $*$"\).
25110
25111 .item "opt@_time"
25112 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
25113 type \"int"\. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
25114
25115 .enditems
25116
25117 If the \-bP-\ command line option is followed by \"local@_scan"\, Exim prints
25118 out the values of all the \*local@_scan()*\ options.
25119
25120
25121 .section Available Exim variables
25122 .index \*local@_scan()*\ function||available Exim variables
25123 The header \(local@_scan.h)\ gives you access to a number of C variables.
25124 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
25125 release. Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim variable by
25126 calling \*expand@_string()*\. The exported variables are as follows:
25127
25128 .startitems
25129
25130 .item "unsigned int debug@_selector"
25131 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
25132 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
25133 \*local@_scan()*\; they are defined as macros:
25134 .numberpars $.
25135 The \"D@_v"\ bit is set when \-v-\ was present on the command line. This is a
25136 testing option that is not privileged -- any caller may set it. All the
25137 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
25138 .nextp
25139 The \"D@_local@_scan"\ bit is provided for use by \*local@_scan()*\; it is set
25140 by the \"+local@_scan"\ debug selector. It is not included in the default set
25141 of debugging bits.
25142 .endp
25143 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when \"+local@_scan"\ has been
25144 selected, you should use code like this:
25145 .display asis
25146 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
25147 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
25148 .endd
25149
25150 .item "uschar *expand@_string@_message"
25151 After a failing call to \*expand@_string()*\ (returned value NULL), the
25152 variable \expand__string__message\ contains the error message, zero-terminated.
25153
25154 .item "header@_line *header@_list"
25155 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The \header@_line\ structure is discussed
25156 below.
25157
25158 .item "header@_line *header@_last"
25159 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
25160
25161 .item "uschar *headers@_charset"
25162 The value of the \headers@_charset\ configuration option.
25163
25164 .item "BOOL host@_checking"
25165 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
25166 \-bh-\ command line option.
25167
25168 .item "uschar *interface@_address"
25169 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
25170 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
25171
25172 .item "int interface@_port"
25173 The port on which this message was received.
25174
25175 .item "uschar *message@_id"
25176 This variable contains the message id for the incoming message as a
25177 zero-terminated string.
25178
25179
25180 .item "uschar *received@_protocol"
25181 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
25182
25183 .item "int recipients@_count"
25184 The number of accepted recipients.
25185
25186 .item "recipient@_item *recipients@_list"
25187 .index recipient||adding in local scan
25188 .index recipient||removing in local scan
25189 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
25190 \recipients@_count\. The \recipient@_item\ structure is discussed below. You
25191 can add additional recipients by calling \*receive@_add@_recipient()*\ (see
25192 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and adusting
25193 the value in \recipients@_count\. In particular, by setting \recipients@_count\
25194 to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the value
25195 \"LOCAL@_SCAN@_ACCEPT"\, the message is accepted, but immediately blackholed.
25196 To replace the recipients, set \recipients@_count\ to zero and then call
25197 \*receive@_add@_recipient()*\ as often as needed.
25198
25199 .item "uschar *sender@_address"
25200 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
25201
25202 .item "uschar *sender@_host@_address"
25203 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
25204 locally-submitted messages.
25205
25206 .item "uschar *sender@_host@_authenticated"
25207 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
25208 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
25209
25210 .item "uschar *sender@_host@_name"
25211 The name of the sending host, if known.
25212
25213 .item "int sender@_host@_port"
25214 The port on the sending host.
25215
25216 .item "BOOL smtp@_input"
25217 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
25218
25219 .item "BOOL smtp@_batched@_input"
25220 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
25221
25222 .item "int store@_pool"
25223 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
25224 requests. See section ~~SECTmemhanloc for details.
25225
25226 .enditems
25227
25228
25229 .section Structure of header lines
25230 The \header@_line\ structure contains the members listed below.
25231 You can add additional header lines by calling the \*header@_add()*\ function
25232 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
25233 their type to $*$.
25234
25235 .startitems
25236
25237 .item "struct header@_line *next"
25238 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
25239
25240 .item "int type"
25241 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
25242 characters, and are documented in chapter ~~CHAPspool of this manual. Notice in
25243 particular that any header line whose type is $*$ is not transmitted with the
25244 message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been rewritten, or
25245 are to be removed (for example, ::Envelope-sender:: header lines.) Effectively,
25246 $*$ means `deleted'.
25247
25248 .item "int slen"
25249 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
25250 internal newlines.
25251
25252 .item "uschar *text"
25253 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
25254 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
25255
25256 .enditems
25257
25258
25259
25260 .section Structure of recipient items
25261 The \recipient@_item\ structure contains these members:
25262
25263 .startitems
25264
25265 .item "uschar *address"
25266 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
25267
25268 .item "int pno"
25269 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created
25270 by the \one@_time\ option. It is not relevant at the time \*local@_scan()*\ is
25271 run and
25272 must always contain -1 at this stage.
25273
25274 .item "uschar *errors@_to"
25275 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
25276 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
25277 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the \errors@_to\ generic
25278 router option.)
25279 If a \*local@_scan()*\ function sets an \errors@_to\ field to an unqualified
25280 address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from \qualify@_recipient\.
25281 When \*local@_scan()*\ is called, the \errors@_to\ field is NULL for all
25282 recipients.
25283 .enditems
25284
25285
25286 .section Available Exim functions
25287 .index \*local@_scan()*\ function||available Exim functions
25288 The header \(local@_scan.h)\ gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
25289 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
25290 release:
25291
25292 .startitems
25293
25294 .item "pid@_t child@_open(uschar **argv, uschar **envp, int newumask, int *infdptr, int *outfdptr, BOOL make@_leader)"
25295 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
25296 \argv\. The environment for the process is specified by \envp\, which can be
25297 NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied for
25298 the process in \newumask\.
25299
25300 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
25301 and returned to the caller via the \infdptr\ and \outfdptr\ arguments. The
25302 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
25303 descriptors `in the way' in the new process, they are closed. If the final
25304 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
25305
25306 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
25307
25308
25309 .item "int child@_close(pid@_t pid, int timeout)"
25310 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
25311 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
25312 return value is as follows:
25313 .numberpars $.
25314 >= 0
25315
25316 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process ending
25317 status.
25318 .nextp
25319 < 0 and > --256
25320
25321 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
25322 signal number.
25323 .nextp
25324 --256
25325
25326 The process timed out.
25327 .nextp
25328 --257
25329
25330 The was some other error in wait(); \errno\ is still set.
25331 .endp
25332
25333
25334 .item "pid@_t child@_open@_exim(int *fd)"
25335 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
25336 Exim. (Of course, you can also call \(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\ yourself if you
25337 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
25338 forks a subprocess that is running
25339 .display asis
25340 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
25341 .endd
25342 and returns to you (via the \"int *"\ argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
25343 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
25344 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
25345 recipients in ::To::, ::Cc::, and/or ::Bcc:: header lines.
25346
25347 When you have finished, call \*child@_close()*\ to wait for the process to
25348 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
25349 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
25350 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
25351
25352 .item "void debug@_printf(char *, ...)"
25353 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for \*(printf()*\. The
25354 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
25355 calls to \*debug@_printf()*\ have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
25356 conditional on the \"local@_scan"\ debug selector by coding like this:
25357 .display asis
25358 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
25359 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
25360 .endd
25361
25362 .item "uschar *expand@_string(uschar *string)"
25363 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
25364 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
25365 The C variable \expand@_string@_message\ contains an error message after an
25366 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
25367 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
25368 block of memory that was obtained by a call to \*store@_get()*\. See section
25369 ~~SECTmemhanloc below for a discussion of memory handling.
25370
25371 .item "void header@_add(int type, char *format, ...)"
25372 .em
25373 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
25374 existing ones.
25375 .nem
25376 The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space character. The
25377 second argument is a format string and any number of substitution arguments as
25378 for \*sprintf()*\. You may include internal newlines if you want, and you must
25379 ensure that the string ends with a newline.
25380
25381 .em
25382 .item "void header@_add@_at@_position(BOOL after, uschar *name, BOOL topnot, int type, char *$nh{format}, ...)"
25383 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
25384 chain. The header itself is specified as for \*header@_add()*\.
25385
25386 If \name\ is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if \after\
25387 is true, or at the start if \after\ is false. If \name\ is not NULL, the header
25388 lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that matches the name. If
25389 one is found, the new header is added before it if \after\ is false. If \after\
25390 is true, the new header is added after the found header and any adjacent
25391 subsequent ones with the same name (even if marked `deleted'). If no matching
25392 non-deleted header is found, the \topnot\ option controls where the header is
25393 added. If it is true, addition is at the top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to
25394 add a header after all the ::Received:: headers, or at the top if there are no
25395 ::Received:: headers, you could use
25396 .display asis
25397 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
25398 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
25399 .endd
25400 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted ::Received:: header, but
25401 there may not be if \received@_header@_text\ expands to an empty string.
25402
25403
25404 .item "void header@_remove(int occurrence, uschar *name)"
25405 This function removes header lines. If \occurrence\ is zero or negative, all
25406 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
25407 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
25408 match the specification, the function does nothing.
25409
25410
25411 .item "BOOL header@_testname(header@_line *hdr, uschar *name, int length, BOOL notdel)"
25412 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
25413 a string comparison, because whitespace is permitted between the name and the
25414 colon. If the \notdel\ argument is true, a false return is forced for all
25415 `deleted' headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
25416 .display asis
25417 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
25418 .endd
25419 .nem
25420
25421
25422 .item "uschar *lss@_b64encode(uschar *cleartext, int length)"
25423 .index base64 encoding||functions for \*local@_scan()*\ use
25424 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
25425 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
25426 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling \*store@_get()*\. It is
25427 zero-terminated.
25428
25429 .item "int lss@_b64decode(uschar *codetext, uschar **cleartext)"
25430 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
25431 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
25432 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the
25433 decoded string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64
25434 data, the yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to
25435 make it easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its
25436 own). The added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
25437
25438 .item "int lss@_match@_domain(uschar *domain, uschar *list)"
25439 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
25440 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
25441 .display
25442 OK $rm{match succeeded}
25443 FAIL $rm{match failed}
25444 DEFER $rm{match deferred}
25445 .endd
25446 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
25447 inability to contact a database.
25448
25449 .item "int lss@_match@_local@_part(uschar *localpart, uschar *list, BOOL caseless)"
25450 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
25451 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
25452 \*lss@_match@_domain()*\.
25453
25454 .item "int lss@_match@_address(uschar *address, uschar *list, BOOL caseless)"
25455 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
25456 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
25457 matched caselessly. The return values are as for \*lss@_match@_domain()*\.
25458
25459 .item "int lss@_match@_host(uschar *host@_name, uschar *host@_address, uschar *list)"
25460 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
25461 expected to be
25462 .display asis
25463 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
25464 .endd
25465 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the
25466 host name is NULL, the name corresponding to \$sender@_host@_address$\ is
25467 automatically looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the
25468 list. The return values are as for \*lss@_match@_domain()*\, but in addition,
25469 \*lss@_match@_host()*\ returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host
25470 name, but the lookup failed.
25471
25472 .item "void log@_write(unsigned int selector, int which, char *format, ...)"
25473 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
25474 is concerned with \log@_selector\). The second argument can be \"LOG@_MAIN"\ or
25475 \"LOG@_REJECT"\ or
25476 \"LOG@_PANIC"\ or the inclusive `or' of any combination of them. It specifies
25477 to which log or logs the message is written.
25478 The remaining arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The
25479 string should not contain any newlines, not even at the end.
25480
25481
25482 .item "void receive@_add@_recipient(uschar *address, int pno)"
25483 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
25484 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
25485 with the \qualify@_recipient\ domain. The second argument must always be -1.
25486
25487 This function does not allow you to specify a private \errors@_to\ address (as
25488 described with the structure of \recipient@_item\ above), because it pre-dates
25489 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
25490 value afterwards. For example:
25491 .display asis
25492 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
25493 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
25494 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
25495 .endd
25496
25497 .em
25498 .item "BOOL receive@_remove@_recipient(uschar *recipient)"
25499 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the
25500 list of recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and
25501 false if no matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a
25502 complete email address.
25503 .nem
25504
25505
25506 .item "uschar *rfc2047@_decode(uschar *string, BOOL lencheck, uschar *target, int zeroval, int *lenptr, uschar **error)"
25507 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
25508 these are the contents of header lines. First, each encoded `word' is decoded
25509 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
25510 a charset encoding, and if the \*iconv()*\ function is available, an attempt is
25511 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
25512 binary string is returned with an error message.
25513
25514 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If \lencheck\ is TRUE, the
25515 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
25516 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
25517
25518 .index binary zero||in RFC 2047 decoding
25519 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
25520 contents of the \zeroval\ argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
25521 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
25522
25523 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
25524 \lenptr\ is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to which
25525 it points. When \zeroval\ is 0, \lenptr\ should not be NULL.
25526
25527 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the \error\
25528 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by \error\ is set
25529 to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
25530 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
25531 with translation.
25532
25533
25534 .item "int smtp@_fflush(void)"
25535 This function is used in conjunction with \*smtp@_printf()*\, as described
25536 below.
25537
25538 .item "void smtp@_printf(char *, ...)"
25539 The arguments of this function are like \*printf()*\; it writes to the SMTP
25540 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
25541 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
25542 SMTP. This is the case when \smtp@_input\ is TRUE and \smtp@_batched@_input\ is
25543 FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
25544 opposed to a local process that used the \-bs-\ command line option), you can
25545 test the value of \sender@_host@_address\, which is non-NULL when a remote host
25546 is involved.
25547
25548 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, \*smtp@_printf()*\ uses the TLS
25549 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
25550
25551 Strings that are written by \*smtp@_printf()*\ from within \*local@_scan()*\
25552 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
25553 \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_REJECT\\, 451 if you are going to return
25554 \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_TEMPREJECT\\, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
25555 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
25556 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
25557 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
25558 .display asis
25559 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
25560 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
25561 .endd
25562 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
25563 the data returned via the \return@_text\ argument. The added value of using
25564 \*smtp@_printf()*\ is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
25565 multiple output lines.
25566
25567 The \*smtp@_printf()*\ function does not return any error indication, because it
25568 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
25569 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
25570 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
25571 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
25572 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call \*smtp@_fflush()*\, which has no
25573 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
25574 is an error.
25575
25576 .item "void *store@_get(int)"
25577 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
25578 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
25579 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
25580
25581 .item "void *store@_get@_perm(int)"
25582 This function is like \*store@_get()*\, but it always gets memory from the
25583 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
25584
25585 .item "uschar *string@_copy(uschar *string)"
25586 .item "uschar *string@_copyn(uschar *string, int length)" 0
25587 .item "uschar *string@_sprintf(char *format, ...)" 0
25588 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
25589 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
25590 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
25591 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
25592 pointer to a new string
25593 in the current memory pool. See the next section for more discussion.
25594
25595 .enditems
25596
25597
25598
25599 .section More about Exim's memory handling
25600 .rset SECTmemhanloc "~~chapter.~~section"
25601 .index \*local@_scan()*\ function||memory handling
25602 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
25603 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
25604 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
25605 to incoming SMTP connections -- other input methods can supply only one message
25606 at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process terminates.
25607
25608 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
25609 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
25610 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
25611 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
25612
25613 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
25614 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
25615 .display asis
25616 store_pool = POOL_PERM
25617 .endd
25618 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
25619 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
25620 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of \store@_pool\ or
25621 set it explicitly to \\POOL@_MAIN\\.
25622
25623 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
25624 \*expand@_string()*\, \*store@_get()*\, and the \*string@_xxx()*\ functions.
25625 There is also a convenience function called \*store__get__perm()*\ that gets a
25626 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
25627 \store@_pool\.
25628
25629
25630
25631
25632
25633 .
25634 .
25635 .
25636 .
25637 . ============================================================================
25638 .chapter System-wide message filtering
25639 .set runningfoot "system filtering"
25640 .rset CHAPsystemfilter "~~chapter"
25641 .index filter||system filter
25642 .index filtering all mail
25643 .index system filter
25644 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
25645 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
25646 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
25647 they are delivered. This is called the $it{system filter}.
25648
25649 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
25650 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
25651 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because \deliver\
25652 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
25653 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
25654
25655 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
25656 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
25657 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
25658 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
25659 of the \first@_delivery\ condition in an \if\ command in the filter to prevent
25660 it happening on retries.
25661
25662 \**Warning**\: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
25663 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as \$local@_part$\ and
25664 \$domain$\, are not set, and the `personal' condition is not meaningful. If you
25665 want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
25666 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable \%redirect%\ router, as
25667 described in section ~~SECTperaddfil below.
25668
25669 .section Specifying a system filter
25670 .index uid (user id)||system filter
25671 .index gid (group id)||system filter
25672 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
25673 setting \system@_filter\. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
25674 other than root, you must also set \system@_filter@_user\ and
25675 \system@_filter@_group\ as appropriate. For example:
25676 .display asis
25677 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
25678 system_filter_user = exim
25679 .endd
25680 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
25681 \save\ or \pipe\ commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
25682 specified by setting \system@_filter@_file@_transport\ and
25683 \system@_filter@_pipe@_transport\, respectively. Similarly,
25684 \system@_filter@_reply@_transport\ must be set to handle any messages generated
25685 by the \reply\ command.
25686
25687 .section Testing a system filter
25688 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
25689 filter, but you should use \-bF-\ rather than \-bf-\, so that features that
25690 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
25691 .em
25692 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
25693 you can use both \-bF-\ and \-bf-\ on the same command line.
25694 .nem
25695
25696 .section Contents of a system filter
25697 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
25698 files. It is described in the separate end-user document \*Exim's interface to
25699 mail filtering*\. However, there are some additional features that are
25700 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
25701 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with \-bf-\,
25702 they cause errors.
25703
25704 .index frozen messages||manual thaw, testing in filter
25705 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
25706 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition \first@_delivery\
25707 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
25708 \manually@_thawed\ is true only if the message has been frozen, and
25709 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
25710 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the \auto__thaw\ setting does not.
25711
25712 \**Warning**\: If a system filter uses the \first@_delivery\ condition to
25713 specify an `unseen' (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
25714 succeed, it will not be tried again.
25715 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
25716 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
25717
25718 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables \$n0$\ --
25719 \$n9$\ are copied into \$sn0$\ -- \$sn9$\ and are thereby made available to
25720 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up `scores' to
25721 which users' filter files can refer.
25722
25723
25724 .section Additional variable for system filters
25725 The expansion variable \$recipients$\, containing a list of all the recipients
25726 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
25727 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
25728
25729
25730 .section Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters
25731 .index freezing messages
25732 .index message||freezing
25733 .index message||forced failure
25734 .index \fail\||in system filter
25735 .index \freeze\ in system filter
25736 .index \defer\ in system filter
25737 There are three extra commands (\defer\, \freeze\ and \fail\) which are always
25738 available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users' filters.
25739 (See the \allow@_defer\,
25740 \allow@_freeze\ and \allow@_fail\ options for the \%redirect%\ router.) These
25741 commands can optionally be followed by the word \text\ and a string containing
25742 an error message, for example:
25743 .display asis
25744 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
25745 .endd
25746 The keyword \text\ is optional if the next character is a double quote.
25747
25748 The \defer\ command defers delivery of the original recipients of the message.
25749 The \fail\ command causes all the original recipients to be failed, and a
25750 bounce message to be created. The \freeze\ command suspends all delivery
25751 attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries that are
25752 specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has run.
25753
25754 The \freeze\ command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
25755 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
25756 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
25757 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
25758
25759 .index log||\fail\ command log line
25760 .index \fail\||log line, reducing
25761 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
25762 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
25763 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
25764 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
25765 two characters \"@<@<"\ and contains \"@>@>"\ later. The text between these two
25766 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
25767 message. For example:
25768 .display asis
25769 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
25770 because it contains attachments that we are \
25771 not prepared to receive."
25772 .endd
25773
25774 .index loop||caused by \fail\
25775 Take great care with the \fail\ command when basing the decision to fail on the
25776 contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include the
25777 contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the \fail\ command
25778 again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this. Testing the
25779 \error@_message\ condition is one way to prevent this. You could use, for
25780 example
25781 .display asis
25782 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
25783 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
25784 .endd
25785 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
25786 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
25787 generated by the filter.
25788
25789 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
25790 \defer\,
25791 \freeze\, or \fail\ command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were set up
25792 earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such as
25793 .display asis
25794 mail ...
25795 freeze
25796 .endd
25797 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
25798 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
25799 take place.
25800
25801
25802 .section Adding and removing headers in a system filter
25803 .rset SECTaddremheasys "~~chapter.~~section"
25804 .index header lines||adding, in system filter
25805 .index header lines||removing, in system filter
25806 .index filter||header lines, adding/removing
25807 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
25808 .display
25809 headers add <<string>>
25810 headers remove <<string>>
25811 .endd
25812 The argument for the \headers add\ is a string that is expanded and then added
25813 to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the filter
25814 maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white space is
25815 ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is forced to
25816 fail, the command has no effect.
25817
25818 You can use `@\n' within the string, followed by white space, to specify
25819 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
25820 including `@\n' within the string without any following white space. For
25821 example:
25822 .display asis
25823 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
25824 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
25825 X-header-2: ...."
25826 .endd
25827 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
25828 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
25829 space after input continuations is ignored.
25830
25831 The argument for \headers remove\ is a colon-separated list of header names.
25832 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
25833 those that are added at delivery time (such as ::Envelope-To:: and
25834 ::Return-Path::) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
25835 header with the same name, they are all removed.
25836
25837 .em
25838 The \headers\ command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
25839 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
25840 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
25841 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
25842 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
25843 used for all recipients of the message.
25844
25845 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
25846 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
25847 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
25848 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
25849 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
25850 until the message is actually being written (see section ~~SECTheadersaddrem).
25851
25852 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
25853 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
25854 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
25855 present, but marked `deleted' so that they are not transported with the
25856 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the \headers\ command conditional
25857 on \first@_delivery\ so that the set of header lines is not modified more than
25858 once.
25859
25860 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
25861 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
25862 For example:
25863 .display asis
25864 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
25865 headers remove "Subject"
25866 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
25867 headers remove "Old-Subject"
25868 .endd
25869 .nem
25870
25871
25872
25873 .section Setting an errors address in a system filter
25874 .index envelope sender
25875 In a system filter, if a \deliver\ command is followed by
25876 .display
25877 errors@_to <<some address>>
25878 .endd
25879 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
25880 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
25881 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
25882 might use
25883 .display asis
25884 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
25885 .endd
25886 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
25887 address if its delivery failed.
25888
25889
25890 .section Per-address filtering
25891 .rset SECTperaddfil "~~chapter.~~section"
25892 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
25893 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
25894 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
25895 such as \$local@_part$\ and \$domain$\ can be used, and indeed, the choice of
25896 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
25897 which implements such a filter:
25898 .display asis
25899 central_filter:
25900 .newline
25901 check_local_user
25902 .newline
25903 driver = redirect
25904 domains = +local_domains
25905 file = /central/filters/$local_part
25906 no_verify
25907 allow_filter
25908 allow_freeze
25909 .endd
25910 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
25911 \check@_local@_user\ must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
25912 the local user, or the \user\ option must be used to specify which user to use.
25913 If both are set, \user\ overrides.
25914
25915 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
25916 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
25917 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
25918 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
25919 normal way.
25920
25921
25922
25923
25924
25925
25926 .
25927 .
25928 .
25929 .
25930 . ============================================================================
25931 .chapter Message processing
25932 .set runningfoot "message processing"
25933 .rset CHAPmsgproc "~~chapter"
25934 .index message||general processing
25935 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
25936 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
25937 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
25938 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
25939 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
25940 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
25941
25942 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
25943 `locally-originated' messages. This adjective is used to describe messages that
25944 are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on its
25945 standard input. This includes the interactive `local SMTP' case that is set up
25946 by the \-bs-\ command line option.
25947
25948 \**Note**\: messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
25949 or @:@:1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
25950 loopback interface specially in any way.
25951 .em
25952 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
25953 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
25954 .nem
25955
25956
25957 .section Submission mode for non-local messages
25958 .rset SECTsubmodnon "~~chapter.~~section"
25959 .index message||submission
25960 .index submission mode
25961 .em
25962 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages can also
25963 be requested for other messages. The term `submission mode' is used to describe
25964 this state. Submisssion mode is set by the modifier
25965 .display asis
25966 control = submission
25967 .endd
25968 in a \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, or pre-data ACL for an incoming SMTP message (see
25969 sections ~~SECTACLmodi and ~~SECTcontrols). This makes Exim treat the message
25970 as a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
25971 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
25972 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
25973 interface, you could include the following in the \\MAIL\\ ACL:
25974 .display asis
25975 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
25976 control = submission
25977 .endd
25978 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
25979 is used to separate options. For example:
25980 .display asis
25981 control = submission/sender_retain
25982 .endd
25983 Specifying \sender@_retain\ has the effect of setting \local@_sender@_retain\
25984 true and \local@_from@_check\ false for the current incoming message. The first
25985 of these allows an existing ::Sender:: header in the message to remain, and the
25986 second suppresses the check to ensure that ::From:: matches the authenticated
25987 sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding ::Date:: and
25988 ::Message-ID:: header lines if they are missing, but makes no attempt to check
25989 sender authenticity in header lines.
25990
25991 A submission mode setting may also specify a domain to be used when generating
25992 a ::From:: or ::Sender:: header. For example:
25993 .display asis
25994 control = submission/domain=some.domain
25995 .endd
25996 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
25997 ~~SECTthefrohea and ~~SECTthesenhea.
25998 .nem
25999
26000
26001
26002 .section Line endings
26003 .rset SECTlineendings "~~chapter.~~section"
26004 .index line endings
26005 .index carriage return
26006 .index linefeed
26007 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
26008 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
26009 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
26010 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
26011 use CRLF or just CR.
26012
26013 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
26014 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
26015 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
26016 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
26017 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
26018 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
26019 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
26020 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
26021 follows:
26022 .numberpars $.
26023 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
26024 .nextp
26025 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
26026 is ignored.
26027 .nextp
26028 The sequence `CR, dot, CR' does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
26029 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
26030 terminator.
26031 .nextp
26032 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
26033 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
26034 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
26035 people trying to play silly games.
26036 .nextp
26037 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
26038 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
26039 line.
26040 .endp
26041
26042
26043
26044 .section Unqualified addresses
26045 .index unqualified addresses
26046 .index address||qualification
26047 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
26048 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
26049 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
26050 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
26051 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
26052
26053 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
26054 sender or receipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
26055 \sender__unqualified__hosts\ and \recipient__unqualified__hosts\. In both
26056 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
26057 value of \qualify__domain\ or \qualify__recipient\, as appropriate.
26058 .index \qualify@_domain\
26059 .index \qualify@_recipient\
26060
26061 .em
26062 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
26063 that are locally originated, unless the \-bnq-\ option is given on the command
26064 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
26065 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
26066 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
26067 \sender__unqualified__hosts\ and \recipient__unqualified__hosts\,
26068 .nem
26069
26070
26071 .section The UUCP From line
26072 .index `From' line
26073 .index UUCP||`From' line
26074 .index sender||address
26075 .index \uucp@_from@_pattern\
26076 .index \uucp@_from@_sender\
26077 .index envelope sender
26078 .index Sendmail compatibility||`From' line
26079 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
26080 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
26081 `From'. Examples of two common formats are:
26082 .display asis
26083 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
26084 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
26085 .endd
26086 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
26087 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
26088 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
26089 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
26090 \ignore@_fromline@_hosts\ or the \-bs-\ option was used for a local message and
26091 \ignore@_fromline@_local\ is set. The recognition is controlled by a regular
26092 expression that is defined by the \uucp@_from@_pattern\ option, whose default
26093 value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address that
26094 follows `From' into \$1$\.
26095
26096 .index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in `From ' line handling
26097 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a `From' line is a
26098 trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
26099 contents of \uucp@_sender@_address\, whose default value is `@$1'. This is then
26100 parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
26101 qualified with \qualify@_domain\ unless it is the empty string. However, if the
26102 command line \-f-\ option is used, it overrides the `From' line.
26103
26104 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the `From' line is recognized, but the
26105 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
26106 that are permitted to contain `From' lines.
26107
26108 Only one `From' line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
26109 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
26110 as a header line. This also happens if a `From' line is present in an incoming
26111 SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
26112
26113
26114 .section Resent- header lines
26115 .index \Resent@-\ header lines
26116 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
26117 \"Resent-"\ to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
26118 recipient to somebody else. These headers are ::Resent-Date::, ::Resent-From::,
26119 ::Resent-Sender::, ::Resent-To::, ::Resent-Cc::, ::Resent-Bcc:: and
26120 ::Resent-Message-ID::. The RFC says:
26121
26122 \*Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
26123 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.*\
26124
26125 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
26126 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats \Resent@-\ header lines as
26127 follows:
26128 .numberpars $.
26129 A ::Resent-From:: line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
26130 is automatically rewritten in the same way as ::From:: (see below).
26131 .nextp
26132 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
26133 \Resent@-\ header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
26134 ::From:: also rewrites ::Resent-From::.
26135 .nextp
26136 For local messages, if ::Sender:: is removed on input, ::Resent-Sender:: is also
26137 removed.
26138 .nextp
26139 For a locally-submitted message,
26140 if there are any \Resent@-\ header lines but no ::Resent-Date::,
26141 ::Resent-From::, or ::Resent-Message-Id::, they are added as necessary. It is
26142 the contents of ::Resent-Message-Id:: (rather than ::Message-Id::) which are
26143 included in log lines in this case.
26144 .nextp
26145 The logic for adding ::Sender:: is duplicated for ::Resent-Sender:: when any
26146 \Resent@-\ header lines are present.
26147 .endp
26148
26149
26150 .section The Auto-Submitted: header line
26151 Whenever Exim generates a bounce or a delay warning message, it includes the
26152 header line
26153 .display asis
26154 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
26155 .endd
26156
26157
26158 .section The Bcc: header line
26159 .index ::Bcc:: header line
26160 If Exim is called with the \-t-\ option, to take recipient addresses from a
26161 message's header, it removes any ::Bcc:: header line that may exist (after
26162 extracting its addresses). If \-t-\ is not present on the command line, any
26163 existing ::Bcc:: is not removed.
26164
26165 .section The Date: header line
26166 .index ::Date:: header line
26167 If a locally-generated
26168 or submission-mode
26169 message has no ::Date:: header line, Exim adds one, using the current date and
26170 time.
26171
26172 .section The Delivery-date: header line
26173 .index ::Delivery-date:: header line
26174 .index \delivery@_date@_remove\
26175 ::Delivery-date:: header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
26176 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
26177 the generic \delivery@_date@_add\ transport option.) They should not be present
26178 in messages in transit. If the \delivery@_date@_remove\ configuration option is
26179 set (the default), Exim removes ::Delivery-date:: header lines from incoming
26180 messages.
26181
26182 .section The Envelope-to: header line
26183 .index ::Envelope-to:: header line
26184 .index \envelope@_to@_remove\
26185 ::Envelope-to:: header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
26186 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
26187 generic \envelope@_to@_add\ transport option.) They should not be present in
26188 messages in transit. If the \envelope@_to@_remove\ configuration option is set
26189 (the default), Exim removes ::Envelope-to:: header lines from incoming
26190 messages.
26191
26192 .section The From: header line
26193 .rset SECTthefrohea "~~chapter.~~section"
26194 .index ::From:: header line
26195 .index Sendmail compatibility||`From' line
26196 .index message||submission
26197 .index submission mode
26198 If a submission-mode message does not contain a ::From:: header line, Exim adds
26199 one if either of the following conditions is true:
26200 .numberpars $.
26201 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
26202 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
26203 .nextp
26204 The SMTP session is authenticated and \$authenticated@_id$\ is not empty.
26205 .em
26206 .numberpars alpha
26207 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
26208 \$authenticated@_id$\ and the domain is \$qualify@_domain$\.
26209 .nextp
26210 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
26211 \$authenticated@_id$\, and the the domain is the specified domain.
26212 .nextp
26213 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
26214 \$authenticated@_id$\ is assumed to be the complete address.
26215 .endp
26216 .nem
26217 .endp
26218 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
26219
26220 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a ::From:: header
26221 line, Exim adds one containing the sender's address. The calling user's login
26222 name and full name are used to construct the address, as described in section
26223 ~~SECTconstr. They are obtained from the password data by calling
26224 \*getpwuid()*\ (but see the \unknown@_login\ configuration option). The address
26225 is qualified with \qualify@_domain\.
26226
26227 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
26228 ::From:: header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
26229 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
26230 name as described in section ~~SECTconstr.
26231
26232 .section The Message-ID: header line
26233 .index ::Message-ID:: header line
26234 .index message||submission
26235 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
26236 ::Message-ID:: or ::Resent-Message-ID:: header line, Exim adds one to the
26237 message. If there are any ::Resent-:: headers in the message, it creates
26238 ::Resent-Message-ID::. The id is constructed from Exim's internal message id,
26239 preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and followed by @@
26240 and the primary host name. Additional information can be included in this
26241 header line by setting the
26242 .index \message@_id@_header@_text\
26243 \message@_id@_header@_text\ and/or \message__id__header__domain\ options.
26244
26245
26246 .section The Received: header line
26247 .index ::Received:: header line
26248 A ::Received:: header line is added at the start of every message. The contents
26249 are defined by the \received@_header@_text\ configuration option, and Exim
26250 automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
26251
26252 The ::Received:: header is generated as soon as the message's header lines have
26253 been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the ::Received:: header line is
26254 the time that the message started to be received. This is the value that is
26255 seen by the \\DATA\\ ACL and by the \*local@_scan()*\ function.
26256
26257 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the ::Received:: header line is
26258 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
26259 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
26260
26261
26262 .section The Return-path: header line
26263 .index ::Return-path:: header line
26264 .index \return@_path@_remove\
26265 ::Return-path:: header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
26266 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic \return@_path@_add\
26267 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
26268 transit. If the \return@_path@_remove\ configuration option is set (the
26269 default), Exim removes ::Return-path:: header lines from incoming messages.
26270
26271
26272 .section The Sender: header line
26273 .rset SECTthesenhea "~~chapter.~~section"
26274 .index ::Sender:: header line
26275 .index message||submission
26276 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
26277 existing ::Sender:: header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify these
26278 actions by setting \local@_sender@_retain\ true or \local@_from@_check\ false.
26279
26280 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
26281 \local@_from@_check\ is true (the default), a check is made to see if the
26282 address given in the ::From:: header line is the correct (local) sender of the
26283 message. The address that is expected has the login name as the local part and
26284 the value of \qualify@_domain\ as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the
26285 local part can be permitted by setting \local@_from@_prefix\ and
26286 \local@_from@_suffix\ appropriately. If ::From:: does not contain the correct
26287 sender, a ::Sender:: line is added to the message.
26288
26289 If you set \local@_from@_check\ false, this checking does not occur. However,
26290 the removal of an existing ::Sender:: line still happens, unless you also set
26291 \local@_sender@_retain\ to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
26292 options true at the same time.
26293
26294 .em
26295 .index submission mode
26296 By default, no processing of ::Sender:: header lines is done for messages
26297 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
26298 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and \sender@_retain\ is
26299 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
26300
26301 First, any existing ::Sender:: lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
26302 authenticated, and \$authenticated@_id$\ is not empty, a sender address is
26303 created as follows:
26304 .numberpars $.
26305 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
26306 \$authenticated@_id$\ and the domain is \$qualify@_domain$\.
26307 .nextp
26308 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
26309 \$authenticated@_id$\, and the the domain is the specified domain.
26310 .nextp
26311 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
26312 \$authenticated@_id$\ is assumed to be the complete address.
26313 .endp
26314 This address is compared with the address in the ::From:: header line. If they
26315 are different, a ::Sender:: header line containing the created address is
26316 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in ::From:: can be permitted by
26317 setting \local@_from@_prefix\ and \local@_from@_suffix\ appropriately.
26318 .nem
26319
26320
26321 .section Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports
26322 .index header lines||adding, in router or transport
26323 .index header lines||removing, in router or transport
26324 .rset SECTheadersaddrem "~~chapter.~~section"
26325 .em
26326 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
26327 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
26328 process the message. Section ~~SECTaddremheasys contains details about
26329 modifying headers in a system filter.
26330
26331 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
26332 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
26333 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
26334 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
26335 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
26336 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
26337
26338 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a \headers@_add\
26339 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
26340 newlines (coded as `@\n'). For example:
26341 .display asis
26342 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
26343 X-added-second: another added header line
26344 .endd
26345 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
26346
26347 The result of expanding \headers@_remove\ must consist of a colon-separated
26348 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
26349 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
26350 not part of the names. For example:
26351 .display asis
26352 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
26353 .endd
26354
26355 When \headers@_add\ or \headers@_remove\ is specified on a router, its value is
26356 expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
26357 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
26358 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
26359 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
26360 .index \unseen\ option
26361 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
26362 the \unseen\ option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
26363 `unseen' router or its predecessors apply only to the `unseen' delivery.
26364
26365 Addresses that end up with different \headers@_add\ or \headers@_remove\
26366 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
26367 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
26368 requirements.
26369
26370 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
26371 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
26372 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
26373 recipient address(es) by \headers@_remove\ options in routers, and it also
26374 consults the transport's own \headers@_remove\ option. Header lines whose names
26375 are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
26376 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
26377
26378 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
26379 lines that were specified by routers' \headers@_add\ options are written, in
26380 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
26381 header lines specified by the transport's \headers@_add\ option.
26382
26383 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
26384 the following consequences:
26385 .numberpars $.
26386 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
26387 remains `visible', in the sense that the \$header@_$\\*xxx*\ variables refer to
26388 it, at all times.
26389 .nextp
26390 Header lines that are added by a router's
26391 \headers@_add\ option are not accessible by means of the \$header@_$\\*xxx*\
26392 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
26393 .nextp
26394 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by \headers@_remove\ in
26395 a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
26396 .nextp
26397 Headers added to an address by \headers@_add\ in a router cannot be removed by
26398 a later router or by a transport.
26399 .nextp
26400 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
26401 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
26402 .display asis
26403 headers_remove = subject
26404 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
26405 .endd
26406 .endp
26407
26408 \**Warning**\: The \headers@_add\ and \headers@_remove\ options cannot be used
26409 for a \%redirect%\ router that has the \one@_time\ option set.
26410 .nem
26411
26412
26413
26414 .section Constructed addresses
26415 .rset SECTconstr "~~chapter.~~section"
26416 .index address||constructed
26417 .index constructed address
26418 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
26419 the form
26420 .display
26421 <<user name>> <$$<<login>>@@<<qualify@_domain>>$$>
26422 .endd
26423 For example:
26424 .display asis
26425 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
26426 .endd
26427 The user name is obtained from the \-F-\ command line option if set, or
26428 otherwise by looking up the calling user by \*getpwuid()*\ and extracting the
26429 `gecos' field from the password entry. If the `gecos' field contains an
26430 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
26431 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
26432 \gecos@_name\ option for a way to tailor the handling of the `gecos' field. The
26433 \unknown@_username\ option can be used to specify user names in cases when
26434 there is no password file entry.
26435
26436 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
26437 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
26438 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
26439 including non-ASCII characters in header lines.
26440 The value of the \headers@_charset\ option specifies the name of the encoding
26441 that is used (the characters are assumed to be in this encoding).
26442 The setting of \print@_topbitchars\ controls whether characters with the top
26443 bit set (that is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or
26444 not.
26445
26446
26447 .section Case of local parts
26448 .index case of local parts
26449 .index local part||case of
26450 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
26451 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
26452 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
26453 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
26454 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
26455 original case for local parts by setting the \caseful@_local@_part\ generic
26456 router option.
26457
26458 .index mixed-case login names
26459 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
26460 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
26461 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
26462 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
26463 .display asis
26464 correct_case:
26465 driver = redirect
26466 domains = +local_domains
26467 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
26468 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
26469 @$domain
26470 .endd
26471 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
26472 (\caseful@_local@_part\ is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
26473 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set \caseful@_local@_part\
26474 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
26475 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
26476
26477
26478 .section Dots in local parts
26479 .index dot||in local part
26480 .index local part||dots in
26481 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
26482 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
26483 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
26484 empty components for compatibility.
26485
26486
26487 .section Rewriting addresses
26488 .index rewriting||addresses
26489 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
26490 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
26491 in chapter ~~CHAPrewrite. The headers that may be affected by this are ::Bcc::,
26492 ::Cc::, ::From::, ::Reply-To::, ::Sender::, and ::To::.
26493
26494 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
26495 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
26496 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
26497 example, a header such as
26498 .display asis
26499 To: hare@teaparty
26500 .endd
26501 might get rewritten as
26502 .display asis
26503 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
26504 .endd
26505 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
26506 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
26507 been routed.
26508
26509 Strictly, one should not do $it{any} deliveries of a message until all its
26510 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
26511 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
26512 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
26513 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
26514 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
26515
26516
26517 .
26518 .
26519 .
26520 .
26521 . ============================================================================
26522 .chapter SMTP processing
26523 .set runningfoot "smtp processing"
26524 .rset CHAPSMTP ~~chapter
26525 .index SMTP||processing details
26526 .index LMTP||processing details
26527 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
26528 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
26529 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
26530 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
26531 .numberpars $.
26532 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or \*inetd*\);
26533 .nextp
26534 SMTP over the standard input and output (the \-bs-\ option);
26535 .nextp
26536 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the \-bS-\ option).
26537 .endp
26538 For mail delivery, the following are available:
26539 .numberpars $.
26540 SMTP over TCP/IP (the \%smtp%\ transport);
26541 .nextp
26542 LMTP over TCP/IP (the \%smtp%\ transport with the \protocol\ option set to
26543 `lmtp');
26544 .nextp
26545 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the \%lmtp%\
26546 transport);
26547 .nextp
26548 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the \%appendfile%\ and \%pipe%\ transports with
26549 the \use@_bsmtp\ option set).
26550 .endp
26551 \*Batched SMTP*\ is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
26552 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
26553 used to contain the envelope information.
26554
26555
26556 .section Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP
26557 .rset SECToutSMTPTCP "~~chapter.~~section"
26558 .index SMTP||outgoing over TCP/IP
26559 .index outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP
26560 .index LMTP||over TCP/IP
26561 .index outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP
26562 .index \\EHLO\\
26563 .index \\HELO\\
26564 .index \\SIZE\\ option on \\MAIL\\ command
26565 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the \%smtp%\ transport.
26566 The \protocol\ option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
26567 processing is the same in both cases.
26568
26569 If, in response to its \\EHLO\\ command, Exim is told that the \\SIZE\\
26570 parameter is supported, it adds \\SIZE\\=<<n>> to each subsequent \\MAIL\\
26571 command. The value of <<n>> is the message size plus the value of the
26572 \size@_addition\ option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
26573 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
26574 .index transport||filter
26575 .index filter||transport filter
26576 transport filter. If \size@_addition\ is set negative, the use of \\SIZE\\ is
26577 suppressed.
26578
26579 If the remote server advertises support for \\PIPELINING\\, Exim uses the
26580 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
26581 required for the transaction.
26582
26583 If the remote server advertises support for the \\STARTTLS\\ command, and Exim
26584 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
26585 server matches \hosts@_avoid@_tls\. See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for more details.
26586
26587 If the remote server advertises support for the \\AUTH\\ command, Exim scans
26588 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
26589 in chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH.
26590
26591 .index carriage return
26592 .index linefeed
26593 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
26594 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
26595 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
26596 line terminator.
26597
26598 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
26599 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
26600 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
26601 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
26602 of the \max@_rcpts\ option in the \%smtp%\ transport allows, in which case they
26603 are split into groups containing no more than \max@_rcpts\ addresses each. If
26604 \remote@_max@_parallel\ is greater than one, such groups may be sent in
26605 parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
26606 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
26607
26608 When the \%smtp%\ transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
26609 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
26610 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
26611 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
26612 .index hints database||retry keys
26613 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
26614 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
26615 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
26616
26617 .index SMTP||passed connection
26618 .index SMTP||batching over TCP/IP
26619 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
26620 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
26621 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
26622 creates a new Exim process using the \-MC-\ option (which can only be used by a
26623 process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it so
26624 that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process does
26625 only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in turn
26626 pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
26627
26628 The \connection@_max@_messages\ option of the \%smtp%\ transport can be used to
26629 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
26630 .index asterisk||after IP address
26631 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
26632 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
26633 square bracket of the IP address.
26634
26635
26636
26637 .section Errors in outgoing SMTP
26638 .rset SECToutSMTPerr "~~chapter.~~section"
26639 .index error||in outgoing SMTP
26640 .index SMTP||errors in outgoing
26641 .index host||error
26642 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
26643 message errors, and recipient errors.
26644 .numberpars
26645 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
26646 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
26647 .numberpars $.
26648 Connection refused or timed out,
26649 .nextp
26650 Any error response code on connection,
26651 .nextp
26652 Any error response code to \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\,
26653 .nextp
26654 Loss of connection at any time, except after `.',
26655 .nextp
26656 I/O errors at any time,
26657 .nextp
26658 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\ or
26659 the `.' at the end of the data.
26660 .endp
26661 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
26662 \\EHLO\\, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
26663 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
26664 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
26665 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
26666 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
26667 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
26668 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
26669 .nextp
26670 .index message||error
26671 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
26672 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
26673 message errors are:
26674 .numberpars $.
26675 Any error response code to \\MAIL\\, \\DATA\\, or the `.' that terminates
26676 the data,
26677 .nextp
26678 Timeout after \\MAIL\\,
26679 .nextp
26680 Timeout
26681 or loss of connection after the `.' that terminates the data. A timeout after
26682 the \\DATA\\ command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
26683 connection at any other time.
26684 .endp
26685 For a message error, a permanent error response (5$it{xx}) causes all addresses
26686 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
26687 temporary error response (4$it{xx}), or one of the timeouts, causes all
26688 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
26689 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
26690 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
26691 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
26692 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
26693 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
26694 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
26695
26696 If the remote host specified support for the \\SIZE\\ parameter in its response
26697 to \\EHLO\\, Exim adds SIZE=$it{nnn} to the \\MAIL\\ command, so an
26698 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
26699 response to \\MAIL\\.
26700 .nextp
26701 .index recipient||error
26702 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
26703 recipient errors are:
26704 .numberpars $.
26705 Any error response to \\RCPT\\,
26706 .nextp
26707 Timeout after \\RCPT\\.
26708 .endp
26709 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5$it{xx}) causes the
26710 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
26711 sender. A temporary error response (4$it{xx}) or a timeout causes the failing
26712 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
26713 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
26714 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
26715 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
26716 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
26717 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
26718 (`message too big for this recipient' is a possible example), other messages
26719 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
26720 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
26721 the retry clock is reset.
26722
26723 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
26724 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
26725 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
26726 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
26727 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
26728 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
26729 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
26730 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
26731 recipient's retry time.
26732 .endp
26733
26734 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
26735 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
26736 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
26737 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
26738 until the next delivery attempt.
26739
26740 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
26741 \\MAIL\\ command at certain times (`insufficient space' has been seen). It
26742 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
26743 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
26744 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
26745 is created.
26746
26747 The reason that timeouts after \\MAIL\\ and \\RCPT\\ are treated specially is
26748 that these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
26749 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
26750 response had been received. A timeout after `.' is treated specially because it
26751 is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
26752 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
26753 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
26754
26755 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
26756 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\,
26757 or `.' is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
26758 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
26759 then to be treated as a host error.
26760
26761 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
26762 terminating `.' if they do not like the contents of the message for some
26763 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5$it{xx} response
26764 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
26765 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
26766
26767
26768
26769
26770 .section Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)
26771 .index VERP
26772 .index Variable Envelope Return Paths
26773 .index envelope sender
26774 Variable Envelope Return Paths -- see
26775 \?ftp://koobera.math.uic.edu/www/proto/verp.txt?\ -- can be supported in Exim
26776 by using the \return@_path\ generic transport option to rewrite the return path
26777 at transport time. For example, the following could be used on an \%smtp%\
26778 transport:
26779 .display asis
26780 return_path = \
26781 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
26782 {$1-request=$local_part%$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
26783 .endd
26784 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on all
26785 outgoing SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
26786 `-request', and the domain is \*your.dom.example*\. The rewriting inserts the
26787 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
26788 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
26789 \*somelist-request@@your.dom.example*\ is sent to
26790 \*subscriber@@other.dom.example*\. In the transport, the return path is
26791 rewritten as
26792 .display asis
26793 somelist-request=subscriber%other.dom.example@your.dom.example
26794 .endd
26795 For this to work, you must arrange for outgoing messages that have `-request'
26796 in their return paths to have just a single recipient. This can be done by
26797 setting
26798 .display asis
26799 max_rcpt = 1
26800 .endd
26801 in the \%smtp%\ transport. Otherwise a single copy of a message might be
26802 addressed to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
26803 \$local@_part$\ is not available (because it is not unique). Of course, if you
26804 do start sending out messages with this kind of return path, you must also
26805 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
26806 Typically this would be done by setting an \local@_part@_suffix\ option for a
26807 suitable router.
26808
26809 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
26810 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
26811 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
26812 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
26813 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
26814 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
26815 used).
26816
26817
26818 .section Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP
26819 .index SMTP||incoming over TCP/IP
26820 .index incoming SMTP over TCP/IP
26821 .index inetd
26822 .index daemon
26823 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
26824 listening daemon, or by using \*inetd*\. In the latter case, the entry in
26825 \(/etc/inetd.conf)\ should be like this:
26826 .display asis
26827 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
26828 .endd
26829 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
26830 agent using the \-bs-\ option by checking whether or not the standard input is
26831 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
26832 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
26833 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
26834 stream and exits with an error code.
26835
26836 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
26837 disconnects (either via the daemon or \*inetd*\), unless the disconnection is
26838 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
26839 \smtp@_connection\ log selector.
26840
26841 .index carriage return
26842 .index linefeed
26843 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
26844 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
26845 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
26846 line terminator.
26847 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
26848 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
26849 sequence `CR, dot, CR' does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
26850
26851 .index \\EHLO\\||invalid data
26852 .index \\HELO\\||invalid data
26853 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the \\EHLO\\ or
26854 \\HELO\\ commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
26855 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
26856 the data that is sent, so \helo@_verify@_hosts\ is not relevant.) You can tell
26857 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting \helo@_accept@_junk@_hosts\ to
26858 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
26859
26860 .index \\SIZE\\ option on \\MAIL\\ command
26861 .index \\MAIL\\||\\SIZE\\ option
26862 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever \\SIZE\\ is received on
26863 a \\MAIL\\ command, independently of whether \message@_size@_limit\ or
26864 \check@_spool@_space\ is configured, unless \smtp__check__spool__space\ is set
26865 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
26866 \check@_spool@_space\ is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
26867 value given with \\SIZE\\, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
26868 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
26869
26870 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
26871 its response to the final `.' that terminates the data. If the remote host logs
26872 this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
26873
26874 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
26875 prepared to handle (see the \smtp@_accept@_max\ option). It can also limit the
26876 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
26877 \smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_host\ option). Additional connection attempts are
26878 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
26879
26880 The Exim daemon does not rely on the \\SIGCHLD\\ signal to detect when a
26881 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
26882 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
26883 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
26884 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
26885 sometimes see a `defunct' Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem; it
26886 will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
26887
26888 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
26889 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
26890 high system load -- for details see the \smtp@_accept@_reserve\,
26891 \smtp@_load@_reserve\, and \smtp@_reserve@_hosts\ options. The load check
26892 applies in both the daemon and \*inetd*\ cases.
26893
26894 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
26895 can be varied by means of the \-odq-\ command line option and the
26896 \queue@_only\, \queue@_only@_file\, and \queue@_only@_load\ options. The number
26897 of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from SMTP
26898 input can be limited by the \smtp__accept__queue\ and
26899 \smtp__accept__queue__per__connection\ options. When either limit is reached,
26900 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
26901 a delivery process.
26902
26903 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (\smtp@_accept@_max\,
26904 \smtp@_accept@_queue\, \smtp__accept__reserve\) are not available when Exim is
26905 started up from the \*inetd*\ daemon, because in that case each connection is
26906 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
26907 however, available with \*inetd*\.
26908
26909 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
26910 are received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for details. It can also be configured to
26911 rewrite addresses at this time -- before any syntax checking is done. See
26912 section ~~SECTrewriteS.
26913
26914 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
26915 \\MAIL\\ and \\RCPT\\ commands in a single SMTP session. See the
26916 \smtp@_ratelimit@_hosts\ option.
26917
26918
26919 .section Unrecognized SMTP commands
26920 .index SMTP||unrecognized commands
26921 If Exim receives more than \smtp@_max@_unknown@_commands\ unrecognized SMTP
26922 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
26923 the error response to the last command. The default value for
26924 \smtp@_max@_unknown@_commands\ is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
26925 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
26926 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
26927
26928 .section Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands
26929 .index SMTP||syntax errors
26930 .index SMTP||protocol errors
26931 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
26932 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
26933 address in a \\RCPT\\ command. Protocol errors include invalid command
26934 sequencing such as \\RCPT\\ before \\MAIL\\. If Exim receives more than
26935 \smtp@_max@_synprot@_errors\ such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
26936 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
26937 default value for \smtp__max__synprot__errors\ is 3. This is a defence against
26938 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
26939
26940
26941 .section Use of non-mail SMTP commands
26942 .index SMTP||non-mail commands
26943 The `non-mail' SMTP commands are those other than \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, and
26944 \\DATA\\. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
26945 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
26946 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing \\AUTH\\s, or a mad
26947 client looping sending \\EHLO\\. The global option \smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail\
26948 defines what `too many' means. Its default value is 10.
26949
26950 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of \\RSET\\ is not counted. This
26951 allows a client to send one \\RSET\\ between messages (this is not necessary,
26952 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurence of \\HELO\\
26953 or \\EHLO\\, and one occurrence of \\STARTTLS\\ between messages. After
26954 starting up a TLS session, another \\EHLO\\ is expected, and so it too is not
26955 counted.
26956
26957 The first occurrence of \\AUTH\\ in a connection, or immediately following
26958 \\STARTTLS\\ is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than \\MAIL\\,
26959 \\RCPT\\, \\DATA\\, and \\QUIT\\ are counted.
26960
26961 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
26962 \smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail\ by setting
26963 \smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail@_hosts\. The default value is \"$*$"\, which makes
26964 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
26965 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
26966
26967
26968
26969 .section The \\VRFY\\ and \\EXPN\\ commands
26970 When Exim receives a \\VRFY\\ or \\EXPN\\ command on a TCP/IP connection, it
26971 runs the ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_vrfy\ or \acl@_smtp@_expn\ (as
26972 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
26973 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
26974
26975 .index \\VRFY\\||processing
26976 When \\VRFY\\ is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
26977 called with the \-bv-\ option.
26978 .index \\EXPN\\||processing
26979 When \\EXPN\\ is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
26980 \\EXPN\\ is treated as an `address test' (similar to the \-bt-\ option) rather
26981 than a verification (the \-bv-\ option). If an unqualified local part is given
26982 as the argument to \\EXPN\\, it is qualified with \qualify@_domain\. Rejections
26983 of \\VRFY\\ and \\EXPN\\ commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
26984 \\VRFY\\ verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
26985 \\RCPT\\ failures.
26986
26987
26988 .section The \\ETRN\\ command
26989 .rset SECTETRN "~~chapter.~~section"
26990 .index \\ETRN\\||processing
26991 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called \\ETRN\\ that is designed to
26992 overcome the security problems of the \\TURN\\ command (which has fallen into
26993 disuse). When Exim receives an \\ETRN\\ command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
26994 the ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_etrn\ in order to decide whether the command
26995 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
26996
26997 The \\ETRN\\ command is concerned with `releasing' messages that are awaiting
26998 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
26999 the only form of \\ETRN\\ that is supported by default is the one where the
27000 text starts with the `@#' prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
27001 specific to the SMTP server. A valid \\ETRN\\ command causes a run of Exim with
27002 the \-R-\ option to happen, with the remainder of the \\ETRN\\ text as its
27003 argument. For example,
27004 .display asis
27005 ETRN #brigadoon
27006 .endd
27007 runs the command
27008 .display asis
27009 exim -R brigadoon
27010 .endd
27011 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
27012 containing the text `brigadoon'. When \smtp@_etrn@_serialize\ is set (the
27013 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
27014 for the same argument string as a result of an \\ETRN\\ command. This stops
27015 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
27016
27017 .index hints database||\\ETRN\\ serialization
27018 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
27019 record is written whenever a process is started by \\ETRN\\, and deleted when
27020 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
27021 the \\ETRN\\ process to complete. Once \\ETRN\\ is accepted, the client is sent
27022 a `success' return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get left
27023 lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this, Exim
27024 ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
27025
27026 .index \smtp@_etrn@_command\
27027 For more control over what \\ETRN\\ does, the \smtp@_etrn@_command\ option can
27028 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever \\ETRN\\ is received,
27029 whatever the form of its argument. For
27030 example:
27031 .display asis
27032 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain $sender_host_address
27033 .endd
27034 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
27035 expansion variable \$domain$\ is set to the argument of the \\ETRN\\ command,
27036 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
27037 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
27038 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
27039 for it to change them before running the command.
27040
27041
27042 .section Incoming local SMTP
27043 .index SMTP||local incoming
27044 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
27045 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
27046 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
27047 \-bs-\ option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
27048 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
27049 sender given in a \\MAIL\\ command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
27050 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
27051 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
27052 runs for \\RCPT\\ commands:
27053 .display asis
27054 accept hosts = :
27055 .endd
27056 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
27057
27058
27059 .section Outgoing batched SMTP
27060 .rset SECTbatchSMTP "~~chapter.~~section"
27061 .index SMTP||batched outgoing
27062 .index batched SMTP output
27063 Both the \%appendfile%\ and \%pipe%\ transports can be used for handling batched
27064 SMTP. Each has an option called \use@_bsmtp\ which causes messages to be output
27065 in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of delivery. All
27066 it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the envelope along
27067 with the message.
27068
27069 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
27070 \\MAIL\\ and \\RCPT\\, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
27071 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
27072 \\HELO\\ is not normally used. If it is required, the \message@_prefix\ option
27073 can be used to specify it.
27074
27075 Because \%appendfile%\ and \%pipe%\ are both local transports, they accept only
27076 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
27077 to handle several addresses at once by setting the \batch@_max\ option. When
27078 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple \\RCPT\\ commands. See
27079 chapter ~~CHAPbatching for more details.
27080
27081 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
27082 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
27083 transport in the variable \$host$\. Here is an example of such a transport and
27084 router:
27085 .display asis
27086 begin routers
27087 route_append:
27088 driver = manualroute
27089 transport = smtp_appendfile
27090 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
27091
27092 begin transports
27093 smtp_appendfile:
27094 driver = appendfile
27095 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
27096 batch_max = 1000
27097 use_bsmtp
27098 user = exim
27099 .endd
27100 This causes messages addressed to \*domain.example*\ to be written in BSMTP
27101 format to \(/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example)\, with only a single copy of each
27102 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
27103
27104
27105 .section Incoming batched SMTP
27106 .rset SECTincomingbatchedSMTP "~~chapter.~~section"
27107 .index SMTP||batched incoming
27108 .index batched SMTP input
27109 The \-bS-\ command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
27110 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
27111 is trusted, the senders in the \\MAIL\\ commands are believed; otherwise the
27112 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
27113 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. \\HELO\\
27114 and \\EHLO\\ act as \\RSET\\; \\VRFY\\, \\EXPN\\, \\ETRN\\ and \\HELP\\, act
27115 as \\NOOP\\; \\QUIT\\ quits.
27116
27117 No policy checking is done for BSMTP input. That is, no ACL is run at anytime.
27118 In this respect it is like non-SMTP local input.
27119
27120 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing `.' at
27121 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
27122 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
27123 make some use of automatically, for example:
27124 .display asis
27125 554 Unexpected end of file
27126 Transaction started in line 10
27127 Error detected in line 14
27128 .endd
27129 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
27130 file, for example:
27131 .display asis
27132 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
27133 The error message was:
27134
27135 501 '>' missing at end of address
27136
27137 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
27138 The error was detected in line 12.
27139 The SMTP command at fault was:
27140
27141 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
27142
27143 1 previous message was successfully processed.
27144 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
27145 .endd
27146 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
27147 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
27148 accepted.
27149
27150
27151
27152 .
27153 .
27154 .
27155 .
27156 . ============================================================================
27157 .chapter Customizing bounce and warning messages
27158 .set runningfoot "customizing messages"
27159 .rset CHAPemsgcust "~~chapter"
27160 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
27161 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
27162 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
27163 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
27164 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
27165
27166 The ::From:: and ::To:: header lines are automatically generated; you can cause
27167 a ::Reply-To:: line to be added by setting the \errors@_reply@_to\ option. Exim
27168 also adds the line
27169 .display asis
27170 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
27171 .endd
27172 to all warning and bounce messages,
27173
27174 .section Customizing bounce messages
27175 .index customizing||bounce message
27176 .index bounce message||customizing
27177 If \bounce@_message@_text\ is set, its contents are included in the default
27178 message immediately after `This message was created automatically by mail
27179 delivery software.' The string is not expanded. It is not used if
27180 \bounce@_message@_file\ is set.
27181
27182 When \bounce@_message@_file\ is set, it must point to a template file for
27183 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
27184 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
27185 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
27186 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
27187 item.
27188
27189 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
27190 expansion variables which can be of use here: \$bounce@_recipient$\ is set to
27191 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
27192 \$return@_size@_limit$\ contains the value of the \return@_size@_limit\ option,
27193 rounded to a whole number.
27194
27195 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
27196 .numberpars $.
27197 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
27198 ::Subject:: header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
27199 .nextp
27200 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
27201 failing addresses with their error messages.
27202 .nextp
27203 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
27204 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
27205 .nextp
27206 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
27207 as part of the error report.
27208 .nextp
27209 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
27210 truncated because it is bigger than \return@_size@_limit\.
27211 .nextp
27212 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
27213 .endp
27214 The default state (\bounce@_message@_file\ unset) is equivalent to the
27215 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The ::Subject:: line has been
27216 split into two here in order to fit it on the page:
27217 .if ~~sys.fancy
27218 .display flow asis
27219 .fontgroup 0
27220 .font 54
27221 .else
27222 .rule
27223 .display flow asis
27224 .linelength 80em
27225 .indent 0
27226 .fi
27227 Subject: Mail delivery failed
27228 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}{: returning message to sender}}
27229 ****
27230 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
27231
27232 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}{that you sent }{sent by
27233
27234 <$sender_address>
27235
27236 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
27237 The following address(es) failed:
27238 ****
27239 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
27240 ****
27241 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers. ------
27242 ****
27243 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long; only the first
27244 ------ $return_size_limit or so are included here.
27245 ****
27246 .endd
27247 .if !~~sys.fancy
27248 .rule
27249 .fi
27250
27251 .section Customizing warning messages
27252 .rset SECTcustwarn "~~chapter.~~section"
27253 .index customizing||warning message
27254 .index warning of delay||customizing the message
27255 The option
27256 \warn@_message@_file\
27257 can be pointed at a template file for use when
27258 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
27259 text sections:
27260 .numberpars $.
27261 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
27262 ::Subject:: header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
27263 .nextp
27264 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
27265 the delayed addresses.
27266 .nextp
27267 The third item then ends the message.
27268 .endp
27269 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that the line
27270 starting `A message' has been split here, in order to fit it on the page:
27271 .if ~~sys.fancy
27272 .display asis
27273 .fontgroup 0
27274 .font 54
27275 .else
27276 .rule
27277 .display asis
27278 .linelength 80em
27279 .indent 0
27280 .fi
27281 .newline
27282 Subject: Warning: message $message_id delayed $warn_message_delay
27283 ****
27284 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
27285
27286 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
27287 {that you sent }{sent by
27288
27289 <$sender_address>
27290
27291 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
27292 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
27293 .newline
27294
27295 The message identifier is: $message_id
27296 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
27297 The date of the message is: $h_date
27298
27299 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
27300 ****
27301 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will continue for
27302 some time, and this warning may be repeated at intervals if the message
27303 remains undelivered. Eventually the mail delivery software will give up,
27304 and when that happens, the message will be returned to you.
27305 .endd
27306 .if !~~sys.fancy
27307 .rule
27308 .fi
27309 except that in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
27310 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
27311 \$warn@_message@_delay$\
27312 is set to the delay time in one of the forms `<<n>> minutes'
27313 or `<<n>> hours', and
27314 \$warn@_message@_recipients$\
27315 contains a list of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than
27316 one if there are multiple addresses with different \errors@_to\ settings on the
27317 routers that handled them.
27318
27319
27320
27321
27322 .
27323 .
27324 .
27325 . ============================================================================
27326 .chapter Some common configuration requirements
27327 .set runningfoot "common configuration requirements"
27328 .rset CHAPcomconreq "~~chapter"
27329 This chapter discusses some configuration requirements that seem to be fairly
27330 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
27331
27332
27333 .section Sending mail to a smart host
27334 .index smart host||example router
27335 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a `smart host', you
27336 should replace the default \%dnslookup%\ router with a router which does the
27337 routing explicitly:
27338 .display asis
27339 send_to_smart_host:
27340 driver = manualroute
27341 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
27342 transport = remote_smtp
27343 .endd
27344 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
27345 .em
27346 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
27347 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
27348 synchronously by setting the \mua@_wrapper\ option (see chapter
27349 ~~CHAPnonqueueing).
27350 .nem
27351
27352
27353 .section Using Exim to handle mailing lists
27354 .rset SECTmailinglists "~~chapter.~~section"
27355 .index mailing lists
27356 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
27357 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
27358 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
27359
27360 The \%redirect%\ router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
27361 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
27362 independent manager. The \domains\ router option can be used to run these
27363 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
27364 .display asis
27365 lists:
27366 driver = redirect
27367 domains = lists.example
27368 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
27369 forbid_pipe
27370 forbid_file
27371 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
27372 no_more
27373 .endd
27374 This router is skipped for domains other than \*lists.example*\. For addresses
27375 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
27376 such file, the router declines, but because \no@_more\ is set, no subsequent
27377 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
27378
27379 The \forbid@_pipe\ and \forbid@_file\ options prevent a local part from being
27380 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
27381 a mailing list.
27382
27383 .index \errors@_to\
27384 The \errors@_to\ option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
27385 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
27386 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
27387 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
27388
27389 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
27390 \*dicts@@lists.example*\ is passed on to those addresses contained in
27391 \(/usr/lists/dicts)\, with error reports directed to
27392 \*dicts-request@@lists.example*\, provided that this address can be verified.
27393 There could be a file called \(/usr/lists/dicts-request)\ containing
27394 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
27395 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the \local@_part@_prefix\
27396 or \local@_part@_suffix\ options) to handle addresses of the form \owner-xxx\
27397 or \xxx-request\, are also possible.
27398
27399
27400 .section Syntax errors in mailing lists
27401 .index mailing lists||syntax errors in
27402 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
27403 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
27404 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
27405 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
27406 addresses are not rigorously checked.
27407
27408 If the \skip@_syntax@_errors\ option is set, the \%redirect%\ router just skips
27409 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
27410 \syntax@_errors@_to\ is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
27411 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
27412 \syntax@_errors@_to\ to the same address as \errors@_to\.
27413
27414
27415 .section Re-expansion of mailing lists
27416 .index mailing lists||re-expansion of
27417 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
27418 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
27419 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
27420 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
27421 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
27422 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
27423 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
27424 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
27425
27426 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the \one@_time\ option can be set
27427 on the \%redirect%\ router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
27428 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
27429 `top level' addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
27430 `delivered'. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
27431 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
27432 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
27433 pre-existing messages.
27434
27435 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
27436 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
27437 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
27438 \all@_parents\ selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
27439 one level of expansion anyway.
27440
27441
27442 .section Closed mailing lists
27443 .index mailing lists||closed
27444 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
27445 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
27446 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
27447 \senders\ option to restrict the router that handles the list.
27448
27449 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
27450 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
27451 .display asis
27452 lists_request:
27453 driver = redirect
27454 domains = lists.example
27455 local_part_suffix = -request
27456 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
27457 no_more
27458
27459 lists_post:
27460 driver = redirect
27461 domains = lists.example
27462 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
27463 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
27464 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
27465 forbid_pipe
27466 forbid_file
27467 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
27468 no_more
27469
27470 lists_closed:
27471 driver = redirect
27472 domains = lists.example
27473 allow_fail
27474 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
27475 .endd
27476 All three routers have the same \domains\ setting, so for any other domains,
27477 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
27478 \@-request\. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
27479 mailing list.
27480
27481 The second router runs only if the \senders\ precondition is satisfied. It
27482 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
27483 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
27484 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
27485 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
27486 not exist, the expansion of \senders\ is $*$, which matches all senders. This
27487 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
27488 \no@_more\ ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
27489 `unrouteable address' error.
27490
27491 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
27492 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
27493 the address, giving a suitable error message.
27494
27495
27496
27497 .section Virtual domains
27498 .rset SECTvirtualdomains "~~chapter.~~section"
27499 .index virtual domains
27500 .index domain||virtual
27501 The phrase \*virtual domain*\ is unfortunately used with two rather different
27502 meanings:
27503 .numberpars $.
27504 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
27505 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
27506 top-level domains and `vanity' domains.
27507 .nextp
27508 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
27509 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
27510 have login accounts on that host.
27511 .endp
27512 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more `virtual' than the
27513 second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
27514 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
27515 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
27516 whether the domain exists. The \%dsearch%\ lookup type is useful here, leading
27517 to a router of this form:
27518 .display asis
27519 virtual:
27520 driver = redirect
27521 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
27522 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
27523 no_more
27524 .endd
27525 The \domains\ option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
27526 is a file in the \(/etc/mail/virtual)\ directory whose name is the same as the
27527 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
27528 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The \no@_more\
27529 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to \data\ being an empty
27530 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
27531
27532 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
27533 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
27534 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
27535 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
27536
27537 The other kind of `virtual' domain can also be handled in a straightforward
27538 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
27539 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
27540 .display asis
27541 my_domains:
27542 driver = accept
27543 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
27544 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
27545 transport = my_mailboxes
27546 .endd
27547 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
27548 can be found in the file. The \domains\ option is used to check for the file's
27549 existence because \domains\ is tested before the \local@_parts\ option (see
27550 section ~~SECTrouprecon). You can't use \require@_files\, because that option
27551 is tested after \local@_parts\. The transport is as follows:
27552 .display asis
27553 my_mailboxes:
27554 driver = appendfile
27555 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
27556 user = mail
27557 .endd
27558 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The \user\ setting is
27559 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
27560
27561 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
27562 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
27563 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
27564 information about the domains.
27565
27566
27567 .section Multiple user mailboxes
27568 .rset SECTmulbox "~~chapter.~~section"
27569 .index multiple mailboxes
27570 .index mailbox||multiple
27571 .index local part||prefix
27572 .index local part||suffix
27573 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
27574 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
27575 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
27576 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
27577 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
27578 \local@_part@_prefix\ and \local@_part@_suffix\ can be used for this. For
27579 example, consider this router:
27580 .display asis
27581 userforward:
27582 driver = redirect
27583 check_local_user
27584 file = $home/.forward
27585 local_part_suffix = -*
27586 local_part_suffix_optional
27587 allow_filter
27588 .endd
27589 It runs a user's \(.forward)\ file for all local parts of the form
27590 \*username-$*$*\. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
27591 cases by testing the variable \$local@_part@_suffix$\. For example:
27592 .display asis
27593 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
27594 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
27595 endif
27596 .endd
27597 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
27598 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
27599 \local@_part@_suffix\ option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
27600 control over which suffixes are valid.
27601
27602 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
27603 \(.forward)\ file -- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
27604 another MTA:
27605 .display asis
27606 userforward:
27607 driver = redirect
27608 check_local_user
27609 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
27610 local_part_suffix = -*
27611 local_part_suffix_optional
27612 allow_filter
27613 .endd
27614 If there is no suffix, \(.forward)\ is used; if the suffix is \*-special*\, for
27615 example, \(.forward-special)\ is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
27616 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
27617 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
27618 \(.forward)\ file to use as a default.
27619
27620
27621 .section Simplified vacation processing
27622 .index vacation processing
27623 The traditional way of running the \*vacation*\ program is for a user to set up
27624 a pipe command in a \(.forward)\ file
27625 (see section ~~SECTspecitredli for syntax details).
27626 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
27627 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
27628 .numberpars $.
27629 A local part prefix such as `vacation-' can be specified on a router which
27630 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the \*vacation*\ program, or
27631 alternatively can use Exim's \%autoreply%\ transport. The contents of a user's
27632 \(.forward)\ file are then much simpler. For example:
27633 .display asis
27634 spqr, vacation-spqr
27635 .endd
27636 .nextp
27637 The \require@_files\ generic router option can be used to trigger a
27638 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
27639 user's home directory. The \unseen\ generic option should also be used, to
27640 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
27641 to do is to create a file called, say, \(.vacation)\, containing a vacation
27642 message.
27643 .endp
27644 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
27645 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
27646
27647
27648 .section Taking copies of mail
27649 .index message||copying every
27650 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
27651 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
27652 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
27653 each day's messages.
27654
27655 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
27656 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
27657 delivery. This could be used, $it{inter alia}, to implement automatic
27658 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
27659
27660
27661 .section Intermittently connected hosts
27662 .index intermittently connected hosts
27663 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
27664 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
27665 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
27666 permanently connected.
27667
27668 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
27669 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
27670 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
27671
27672 .section Exim on the upstream server host
27673 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
27674 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
27675 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
27676 being mixed up in the same queue -- those that cannot be delivered because of
27677 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
27678 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
27679 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
27680
27681 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
27682 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
27683 into local files in batch SMTP, `mailstore', or other envelope-preserving
27684 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
27685 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
27686 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
27687 if required.
27688
27689 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
27690 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
27691 intermittent host. For example:
27692 .display
27693 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
27694 .endd
27695 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
27696 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
27697 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the \-M-\ or \-R-\
27698 options, or by using the \\ETRN\\ SMTP command (see section ~~SECTETRN)
27699 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
27700 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
27701 immediately.
27702
27703 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
27704 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
27705 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
27706 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
27707 avoided by unsetting \retry__include__ip__address\ on the \%smtp%\ transport.
27708 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
27709 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
27710
27711
27712 .section Exim on the intermittently connected client host
27713 The value of \smtp@_accept@_queue@_per@_connection\ should probably be
27714 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
27715 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
27716 delivered immediately.
27717
27718 .index SMTP||passed connection
27719 .index SMTP||multiple deliveries
27720 .index multiple SMTP deliveries
27721 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
27722 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
27723 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
27724 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
27725 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
27726 \-qq-\ instead of \-q-\. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the first
27727 pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a normal
27728 queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those destined
27729 for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a single
27730 SMTP connection.
27731
27732
27733
27734 .
27735 .
27736 .
27737 .
27738 . ============================================================================
27739 .chapter Using Exim as a non-queueing client
27740 .set runningfoot "non-queueing client"
27741 .rset CHAPnonqueueing "~~chapter"
27742 .index client, non-queueing
27743 .index smart host||queueing, suppressing
27744 .em
27745 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
27746 email to be sent to a `smart host'. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
27747 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
27748 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
27749 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
27750 \(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\. Furthermore, utility programs such as \*cron*\ submit
27751 messages this way.
27752
27753 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
27754 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
27755 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
27756 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
27757 email is not desirable.
27758
27759 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
27760 \(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\ interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
27761 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
27762 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
27763 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
27764 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
27765 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
27766
27767 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called \*ssmtp*\)
27768 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
27769 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
27770 before sending a message to the smart host.
27771
27772 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
27773 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
27774 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
27775
27776 .index \mua@_wrapper\
27777 There is a Boolean global option called \mua@_wrapper\, defaulting false.
27778 Setting \mua@_wrapper\ true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
27779 assumes that it is being used to `wrap' a command-line MUA in the manner
27780 just described. As well as setting \mua@_wrapper\, you also need to provide a
27781 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
27782 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
27783
27784 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
27785 following ways:
27786 .numberpars alpha
27787 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from \*inetd*\.
27788 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
27789 .nextp
27790 Each message is synchonously delivered as soon as it is received (\-odi-\ is
27791 assumed). All queueing options (\queue@_only\, \queue@_smtp@_domains\,
27792 \control\ in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process does
27793 not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
27794 successful, a zero return code is given.
27795 .nextp
27796 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
27797 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
27798 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
27799 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
27800 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
27801 are.
27802 .nextp
27803 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a failure
27804 or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
27805 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
27806 .nextp
27807 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there is
27808 no distinction between 4\*xx*\ and 5\*xx*\ SMTP response codes from the smart
27809 host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to the
27810 caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
27811 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
27812 .nextp
27813 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
27814 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
27815 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
27816 .nextp
27817 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
27818 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
27819 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
27820 are ever generated.
27821 .nextp
27822 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
27823 .nextp
27824 A number of Exim options are overridden: \deliver@_drop@_privilege\ is forced
27825 true, \max@_rcpt\ in the smtp transport is forced to `unlimited',
27826 \remote@_max@_parallel\ is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
27827 .endp
27828 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
27829 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
27830 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
27831 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to \*exim*\ instead of setuid
27832 to \*root*\. See section ~~SECTrunexiwitpri for a general discussion about the
27833 advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
27834 .nem
27835
27836
27837
27838 .
27839 .
27840 .
27841 .
27842 . ============================================================================
27843 .chapter Log files
27844 .set runningfoot "log files"
27845 .rset CHAPlog "~~chapter"
27846 .index log||types of
27847 .index log||general description
27848 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
27849 and the panic log:
27850 .numberpars $.
27851 .index main log
27852 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
27853 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
27854 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
27855 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
27856 them are optional, in which case the \log@_selector\ option controls whether
27857 they are included or not. A Perl script called \*eximstats*\, which does simple
27858 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
27859 ~~SECTmailstat).
27860 .nextp
27861 .index reject log
27862 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
27863 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
27864 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
27865 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
27866 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
27867 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
27868 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
27869 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
27870 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting \write@_rejectlog\ false.
27871 .nextp
27872 .index panic log
27873 .index system log
27874 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
27875 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
27876 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
27877 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
27878 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a \*cron*\ script check it)
27879 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
27880 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
27881 is opened with LOG@_PID+LOG@_CONS and the facility code of LOG@_MAIL. The
27882 message itself is written at priority LOG@_CRIT.
27883 .endp
27884 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in this example:
27885 .display asis
27886 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed by QUIT
27887 .endd
27888 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
27889 ways of changing this:
27890 .numberpars $.
27891 You can set the \timezone\ option to a different time zone; in particular, if
27892 you set
27893 .display asis
27894 timezone = UTC
27895 .endd
27896 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
27897 .nextp
27898 If you set \log@_timezone\ true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
27899 example:
27900 .display asis
27901 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
27902 .endd
27903 .endp
27904
27905
27906
27907 .section Where the logs are written
27908 .rset SECTwhelogwri "~~chapter.~~section"
27909 .index log||destination
27910 .index log||to file
27911 .index log||to syslog
27912 .index syslog
27913 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
27914 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
27915 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
27916 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
27917 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
27918 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write -- on Linux
27919 this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
27920
27921 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting \\LOG@_FILE@_PATH\\ in
27922 \(Local/Makefile)\ or by setting \log@_file@_path\ in the run time
27923 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
27924 references to the host name:
27925 .display asis
27926 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
27927 .endd
27928 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in \(Local/Makefile)\
27929 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
27930 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
27931 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
27932 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
27933 log at all.
27934
27935 The value of \\LOG@_FILE@_PATH\\ or \log@_file@_path\ is a colon-separated
27936 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
27937 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
27938 colon-separated. If an item in the list is `syslog' then syslog is used;
27939 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing \"%s"\ at the
27940 point where `main', `reject', or `panic' is to be inserted, or be empty,
27941 implying the use of a default path.
27942
27943 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
27944 \\LOG@_FILE@_PATH\\, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
27945 `syslog'. This means that an empty item in \log@_file@_path\ can be used to
27946 mean `use the path specified at build time'. It no such item exists, log files
27947 are written in the \(log)\ subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
27948 equivalent to the setting:
27949 .display asis
27950 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
27951 .endd
27952 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
27953 logs are written.
27954
27955 A log file path may also contain \"%D"\ if datestamped log file names are in
27956 use -- see section ~~SECTdatlogfil below.
27957
27958 Here are some examples of possible settings:
27959 .display
27960 .tabs 42
27961 LOG@_FILE@_PATH=syslog $t $rm{syslog only}
27962 LOG@_FILE@_PATH=:syslog $t $rm{syslog and default path}
27963 LOG@_FILE@_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim@_%s $t $rm{syslog and specified path}
27964 LOG@_FILE@_PATH=/usr/log/exim@_%s $t $rm{specified path only}
27965 .endd
27966 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
27967 error is logged.
27968
27969
27970 .section Logging to local files that are periodically `cycled'
27971 .index log||cycling local files
27972 .index cycling logs
27973 .index \*exicyclog*\
27974 .index log||local files, writing to
27975 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardised methods for cycling
27976 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called \*exicyclog*\ is
27977 provided (see section ~~SECTcyclogfil). This renames and compresses the main
27978 and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to keep
27979 can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily \*cron*\ job.
27980
27981 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
27982 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required -- for
27983 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
27984 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
27985 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if \*exicyclog*\ or
27986 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
27987 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
27988 \*stat()*\ on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
27989 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
27990 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
27991 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
27992 renamed.
27993
27994
27995 .section Datestamped log files
27996 .rset SECTdatlogfil "~~chapter.~~section"
27997 .index log||datestamped files
27998 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
27999 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
28000 for example, \(mainlog-20031225)\. The datestamp is in the form \(yyyymmdd)\.
28001 Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting the
28002 \log@_file@_path\ option to a path that includes \"%D"\ at the point where the
28003 datestamp is required. For example:
28004 .display asis
28005 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
28006 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
28007 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
28008 .endd
28009 As before, \"%s"\ is replaced by `main' or `reject'; the following are examples
28010 of names generated by the above examples:
28011 .display asis
28012 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
28013 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
28014 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
28015 .endd
28016 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
28017 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
28018 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
28019 run \*exicyclog*\ with this form of logging.
28020
28021 The location of the panic log is also determined by \log@_file@_path\, but it
28022 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
28023 When generating the name of the panic log, \"%D"\ is removed from the string.
28024 In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following non-alphanumeric
28025 character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric character is
28026 removed. Thus, the three examples above would give these panic log names:
28027 .display asis
28028 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
28029 /var/log/exim-panic.log
28030 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
28031 .endd
28032
28033
28034 .section Logging to syslog
28035 .index log||syslog, writing to
28036 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
28037 except in one respect. If \syslog@_timestamp\ is set false, the timestamps on
28038 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
28039 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
28040 `facility' is set to \\LOG@_MAIL\\, and the program name to `exim'
28041 by default, but you can change these by setting the \syslog@_facility\ and
28042 \syslog@_processname\ options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
28043 \\SYSLOG@_LOG@_PID\\ set in \(Local/Makefile)\ (this is the default in
28044 \(src/EDITME)\), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
28045 \\LOG@_PID\\ flag is set so that the \*syslog()*\ call adds the pid as well as
28046 the time and host name to each line.
28047 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
28048 .numberpars " "
28049 \*mainlog*\ is mapped to \\LOG@_INFO\\
28050 .nextp
28051 \*rejectlog*\ is mapped to \\LOG@_NOTICE\\
28052 .nextp
28053 \*paniclog*\ is mapped to \\LOG@_ALERT\\
28054 .endp
28055 Many log lines are written to both \*mainlog*\ and \*rejectlog*\, and some are
28056 written to both \*mainlog*\ and \*paniclog*\, so there will be duplicates if
28057 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
28058 by setting \syslog@_duplication\ false.
28059
28060 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its \*rejectlog*\
28061 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
28062 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate \*syslog()*\
28063 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
28064 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
28065 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
28066 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
28067 RFC 3164, you should set
28068 .display asis
28069 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
28070 .endd
28071 in \(Local/Makefile)\ before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
28072 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in \*reject*\ log entries.
28073
28074 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
28075 entry starts with a string of the form `[<<n>>/<<m>>]' or `[<<n>>@\<<m>>]'
28076 where <<n>> is the component number and <<m>> is the total number of components
28077 in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split because it was
28078 too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the @\ delimiter is
28079 used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 70 instead of 1000, the
28080 following would be the result of a typical rejection message to \*mainlog*\
28081 (LOG@_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host name, and
28082 pid as added by syslog:
28083 .display
28084 .indent 0
28085 $smc{[1/3] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from [127.0.0.1] (ph10):
28086 [2/3] syntax error in 'From' header when scanning for sender: missing or ma
28087 [3/3] lformed local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@@cam.example>)}
28088 .endd
28089 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to `rejectlog'
28090 (LOG@_NOTICE):
28091 .display flow
28092 .indent 0
28093 $smc{[1/14] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from [127.0.0.1] (ph10):
28094 [2/14] syntax error in 'From' header when scanning for sender: missing or ma
28095 [3@\14] lformed local part in "@<@>" (envelope sender is <ph10@@cam.example>)
28096 [4@\14] Recipients: ph10@@some.domain.cam.example
28097 [5@\14] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
28098 [6@\14] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
28099 [7@\14] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
28100 [8@\14] for ph10@@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
28101 [9@\14] F From: @<@>
28102 [10@\14] Subject: this is a test header
28103 [11@\14] X-something: this is another header
28104 [12@\14] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@@xxxxx.cam.example>
28105 [13@\14] B Bcc:
28106 [14/14] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100}
28107 .endd
28108 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
28109 without modification.
28110
28111 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
28112 display, unless syslog is routing \*mainlog*\ to a file on the local host and
28113 the environment variable \\EXIMON@_LOG@_FILE@_PATH\\ is set to tell the monitor
28114 where it is.
28115
28116
28117 .section Log line flags
28118 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
28119 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
28120 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
28121 timestamp. The flags are:
28122 .display
28123 .tabs 6
28124 <= $t $rm{message arrival}
28125 => $t $rm{normal message delivery}
28126 -> $t $rm{additional address in same delivery}
28127 *> $t $rm{delivery suppressed by \-N-\}
28128 ** $t $rm{delivery failed; address bounced}
28129 == $t $rm{delivery deferred; temporary problem}
28130 .endd
28131
28132
28133 .section Logging message reception
28134 .index log||reception line
28135 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
28136 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
28137 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
28138 .display
28139 .indent 0
28140 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@@dwarf.fict.example
28141 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
28142 P=smtp S=5678 id=<<incoming message id>>
28143 .endd
28144 The address immediately following `<=' is the envelope sender address. A bounce
28145 message is shown with the sender address `<>', and if it is locally generated,
28146 this is followed by an item of the form
28147 .display
28148 R=<<message id>>
28149 .endd
28150 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
28151
28152 .index \\HELO\\
28153 .index \\EHLO\\
28154 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
28155 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
28156 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
28157 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
28158 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
28159 \host@_lookup\ option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
28160 by the remote host in the SMTP \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command, and has not been
28161 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for \\HELO\\ or
28162 \\EHLO\\, the verified name appears first, followed by the \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\
28163 name in parentheses.
28164
28165 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
28166 without brackets, in the \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command, leading to entries in
28167 the log containing text like these examples:
28168 .display
28169 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
28170 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
28171 .endd
28172 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
28173 on.
28174
28175 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
28176 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
28177 of Exim.
28178
28179 .index authentication||logging
28180 .index \\AUTH\\||logging
28181 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
28182 message. This is set to
28183 .em
28184 `esmtpa'
28185 .nem
28186 for messages received from hosts that have authenticated themselves using the
28187 SMTP \\AUTH\\ command. In this case there is an additional item A= followed by
28188 the name of the authenticator that was used. If an authenticated identification
28189 was set up by the authenticator's \server@_set@_id\ option, this is logged too,
28190 separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
28191
28192 The id field records the existing message id, if present.
28193 .index size||of message
28194 The size of the received message is given by the S field. When the message is
28195 delivered, headers may get removed or added, so that the size of delivered
28196 copies of the message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be
28197 different to each other).
28198
28199 The \log@_selector\ option can be used to request the logging of additional
28200 data when a message is received. See section ~~SECTlogselector below.
28201
28202
28203 .section Logging deliveries
28204 .index log||delivery line
28205 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
28206 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote deliveries,
28207 respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order to fit
28208 it on the page:
28209 .display
28210 .indent 0
28211 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv <marv@@hitch.fict.example>
28212 R=localuser T=local@_delivery
28213 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => monk@@holistic.fict.example
28214 R=dnslookup T=remote@_smtp H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
28215 .endd
28216 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
28217 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
28218 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
28219 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
28220 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
28221
28222 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
28223 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
28224 .display
28225 ST=<<shadow transport name>>
28226 .endd
28227 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
28228 parentheses afterwards.
28229
28230 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
28231 SMTP \\RCPT\\ commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent
28232 addresses are flagged with `$tt{@-@>}' instead of `$tt{@=@>}'. When two or more
28233 messages are delivered down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the
28234 IP address in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
28235
28236 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a `delivery'
28237 to the addressee, preceded by `>'.
28238
28239 The \log@_selector\ option can be used to request the logging of additional
28240 data when a message is delivered. See section ~~SECTlogselector below.
28241
28242
28243 .section Discarded deliveries
28244 .index discarded messages
28245 .index message||discarded
28246 .index delivery||discarded, logging
28247 When a message is discarded as a result of the command `seen finish' being
28248 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
28249 .display
28250 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
28251 <low.club@@bridge.example> R=userforward
28252 .endd
28253 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
28254 because it is aliased to `:blackhole:' the log line is like this:
28255 .display asis
28256 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
28257 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
28258 .endd
28259
28260
28261 .section Deferred deliveries
28262 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
28263 .display
28264 .indent 0
28265 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@@endrest.example
28266 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
28267 .endd
28268 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
28269 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
28270 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
28271 .display
28272 .indent 0
28273 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
28274 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
28275 .endd
28276 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
28277 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
28278 appropriate value in \log@_selector\.
28279
28280
28281 .section Delivery failures
28282 .index delivery||failure, logging
28283 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
28284 following form is logged:
28285 .display asis
28286 .indent 0
28287 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
28288 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
28289 .endd
28290 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
28291 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
28292 .display asis
28293 .indent 0
28294 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example R=dnslookup
28295 .newline
28296 T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer after pipelined
28297 .newline
28298 RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host pbmail3.py.example
28299 [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0 <ace400@pb.example>...
28300 Addressee unknown
28301 .endd
28302 The word `pipelined' indicates that the SMTP \\PIPELINING\\ extension was being
28303 used. See \hosts@_avoid@_esmtp\ in the \%smtp%\ transport for a way of
28304 disabling \\PIPELINING\\.
28305
28306 The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are flagged with \"**"\.
28307
28308
28309 .section Fake deliveries
28310 .index delivery||fake, logging
28311 If a delivery does not actually take place because the \-N-\ option has been
28312 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
28313 `=>' is replaced by `$*$>'.
28314
28315
28316 .section Completion
28317 A line of the form
28318 .display
28319 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
28320 .endd
28321 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
28322 at the end of its processing.
28323
28324
28325
28326 .section Summary of Fields in Log Lines
28327 .index log||summary of fields
28328 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
28329 the following table:
28330 .display flow
28331 .tabs 8
28332 A $t $rm{authenticator name (and optional id)}
28333 C $t $rm{SMTP confirmation on delivery}
28334 CV $t $rm{certificate verification status}
28335 DN $t $rm{distinguished name from peer certificate}
28336 .newline
28337 .em
28338 DT $t $rm{on \"=>"\ lines: time taken for a delivery}
28339 .nem
28340 .newline
28341 F $t $rm{sender address (on delivery lines)}
28342 H $t $rm{host name and IP address}
28343 I $t $rm{local interface used}
28344 id $t $rm{message id for incoming message}
28345 P $t $rm{on \"<="\ lines: protocol used}
28346 .newline
28347 .em
28348 $t $rm{on \"=>"\ and \"**"\ lines: return path}
28349 QT $t $rm{on \"=>"\ lines: time spent on queue so far}
28350 $t $rm{on `Completed' lines: time spent on queue}
28351 .nem
28352 .newline
28353 R $t $rm{on \"<="\ lines: reference for local bounce}
28354 .newline
28355 .em
28356 $t $rm{on \"=>"\ \"**"\ and \"=="\ lines: router name}
28357 .nem
28358 .newline
28359 S $t $rm{size of message}
28360 ST $t $rm{shadow transport name}
28361 T $t $rm{on \"<="\ lines: message subject (topic)}
28362 .newline
28363 .em
28364 $t $rm{on \"=>"\ \"**"\ and \"=="\ lines: transport name}
28365 .nem
28366 .newline
28367 U $t $rm{local user or RFC 1413 identity}
28368 X $t $rm{TLS cipher suite}
28369 .endd
28370
28371
28372 .section Other log entries
28373 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
28374 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
28375 .numberpars $.
28376 .index retry||time not reached
28377 \*retry time not reached*\##An address previously suffered a temporary error
28378 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
28379 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
28380 during the first delivery attempt.
28381 .nextp
28382 \*retry time not reached for any host*\##An address previously suffered
28383 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
28384 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
28385 .nextp
28386 .index spool directory||file locked
28387 \*spool file locked*\##An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
28388 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
28389 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
28390 \*exiwhat*\ utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
28391 doing.
28392 .nextp
28393 .index error||ignored
28394 \*error ignored*\##There are several circumstances that give rise to this
28395 message:
28396 .numberpars " "
28397 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
28398 \ignore__bounce__errors__after\. The bounce was discarded.
28399 .nextp
28400 A filter file set up a delivery using the `noerror' option, and the delivery
28401 failed. The delivery was discarded.
28402 .nextp
28403 A delivery set up by a router configured with
28404 .display asis
28405 errors_to = <>
28406 .endd
28407 failed. The delivery was discarded.
28408 .endp
28409 .endp
28410
28411
28412
28413 .section Reducing or increasing what is logged
28414 .rset SECTlogselector "~~chapter.~~section"
28415 .index log||selectors
28416 By setting the \log@_selector\ global option, you can disable some of Exim's
28417 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
28418 \log@_selector\ is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
28419 example:
28420 .display asis
28421 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
28422 .endd
28423 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
28424 selection marked by asterisks:
28425 .display flow
28426 .tabs 32
28427 address@_rewrite $t $rm{address rewriting}
28428 all@_parents $t $rm{all parents in => lines}
28429 arguments $t $rm{command line arguments}
28430 *connection@_reject $t $rm{connection rejections}
28431 *delay@_delivery $t $rm{immediate delivery delayed}
28432 deliver@_time $t $rm{time taken to perform delivery}
28433 delivery@_size $t $rm{add S=nnn to => lines}
28434 *dnslist@_defer $t $rm{defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups}
28435 *etrn $t $rm{ETRN commands}
28436 *host@_lookup@_failed $t $rm{as it says}
28437 ident@_timeout $t $rm{timeout for ident connection}
28438 incoming@_interface $t $rm{incoming interface on <= lines}
28439 incoming@_port $t $rm{incoming port on <= lines}
28440 *lost@_incoming@_connection $t $rm{as it says (includes timeouts)}
28441 outgoing@_port $t $rm{add remote port to => lines}
28442 *queue@_run $t $rm{start and end queue runs}
28443 .newline
28444 .em
28445 queue@_time $t $rm{time on queue for one recipient}
28446 queue@_time@_overall $t $rm{time on queue for whole message}
28447 .nem
28448 .newline
28449 received@_recipients $t $rm{recipients on <= lines}
28450 received@_sender $t $rm{sender on <= lines}
28451 *rejected@_header $t $rm{header contents on reject log}
28452 *retry@_defer $t $rm{`retry time not reached'}
28453 return@_path@_on@_delivery $t $rm{put return path on => and ** lines}
28454 sender@_on@_delivery $t $rm{add sender to => lines}
28455 *size@_reject $t $rm{rejection because too big}
28456 *skip@_delivery $t $rm{delivery skipped in a queue run}
28457 smtp@_confirmation $t $rm{SMTP confirmation on => lines}
28458 smtp@_connection $t $rm{SMTP connections}
28459 smtp@_incomplete@_transaction $t $rm{incomplete SMTP transactions}
28460 smtp@_protocol@_error $t $rm{SMTP protocol errors}
28461 smtp@_syntax@_error $t $rm{SMTP syntax errors}
28462 subject $t $rm{contents of ::Subject:: on <= lines}
28463 tls@_certificate@_verified $t $rm{certificate verification status}
28464 *tls@_cipher $t $rm{TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines}
28465 tls@_peerdn $t $rm{TLS peer DN on <= and => lines}
28466
28467 all $t $rm{all of the above}
28468 .endd
28469 More details on each of these items follows:
28470 .numberpars $.
28471 .index log||rewriting
28472 .index rewriting||logging
28473 \address@_rewrite\: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
28474 rewrites,
28475 but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because such users
28476 cannot access the log).
28477 .nextp
28478 .index log||full parentage
28479 \all@_parents\: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
28480 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
28481 parentheses between them.
28482 .nextp
28483 .index log||Exim arguments
28484 .index Exim arguments, logging
28485 \arguments\: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
28486 to the main log,
28487 preceded by the current working directory.
28488 This is a debugging feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain
28489 MUAs call \(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\. The logging does not happen if Exim has given
28490 up root privilege because it was called with the \-C-\ or \-D-\ options.
28491 Arguments that are empty or that contain whitespace are quoted. Non-printing
28492 characters are shown as escape sequences.
28493 This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments, because the arguments are
28494 checked before the configuration file is read. The only way to log such cases
28495 is to interpose a script such as \(util/logargs.sh)\ between the caller and
28496 Exim.
28497 .nextp
28498 .index log||connection rejections
28499 \connection@_reject\: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
28500 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
28501 .nextp
28502 .index log||delayed delivery
28503 .index delayed delivery, logging
28504 \delay@_delivery\: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
28505 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
28506 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
28507 process is started because \queue@_only\ is set or \-odq-\ was used.
28508 .nextp
28509 .index log||delivery duration
28510 \deliver@_time\: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
28511 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<<time>>, for example, \"DT=1s"\.
28512 .nextp
28513 .index log||message size on delivery
28514 .index size||of message
28515 \delivery@_size\: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
28516 the `=>' line, tagged with S=.
28517 .nextp
28518 .index log||dnslist defer
28519 .index DNS list||logging defer
28520 .index black list (DNS)
28521 \dnslist@_defer\: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
28522 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
28523 .nextp
28524 .index log||ETRN commands
28525 .index \\ETRN\\||logging
28526 \etrn\: Every legal ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL is
28527 run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
28528 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
28529 selector (see \smtp@_syntax@_error\ and \smtp@_protocol@_error\).
28530 .nextp
28531 .index log||host lookup failure
28532 \host@_lookup@_failed\: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
28533 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
28534 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
28535 routing email addresses, but it does apply to `byname' lookups.
28536 .nextp
28537 .index log||ident timeout
28538 .index RFC 1413||logging timeout
28539 \ident@_timeout\: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
28540 client's ident port times out.
28541 .nextp
28542 .index log||incoming interface
28543 .index interface||logging
28544 \incoming@_interface\: The interface on which a message was received is added
28545 to the `<=' line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and followed
28546 by a colon and the port number.
28547 The local interface and port are also added to other SMTP log
28548 lines, for example `SMTP connection from', and to rejection lines.
28549 .nextp
28550 .index log||incoming remote port
28551 .index port||logging remote
28552 .index TCP/IP||logging incoming remote port
28553 \incoming@_port\: The remote port number from which a message was received is
28554 added to log entries and ::Received:: header lines, following the IP address in
28555 square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
28556 changing the value that is put in the \$sender@_fullhost$\ and
28557 \$sender@_rcvhost$\ variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
28558 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
28559 .nextp
28560 .index log||dropped connection
28561 \lost@_incoming@_connection\: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
28562 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
28563 .nextp
28564 .index log||outgoing remote port
28565 .index port||logging outgoint remote
28566 .index TCP/IP||logging ougtoing remote port
28567 \outgoing@_port\: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
28568 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
28569 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
28570 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
28571 .nextp
28572 .index log||queue run
28573 .index queue runner||logging
28574 \queue@_run\: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
28575 .nextp
28576 .index log||queue time
28577 \queue@_time\: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
28578 local host is logged as QT=<<time>>
28579 .em
28580 on delivery (\"=>"\) lines, for example, \"QT=3m45s"\. The clock starts when
28581 Exim starts to receive the message, so it includes reception time as well as
28582 the delivery time for the current address. This means that it may be longer
28583 than the difference between the arrival and delivery log line times, because
28584 the arrival log line is not written until the message has been successfully
28585 received.
28586 .nem
28587
28588 .nextp
28589 .em
28590 \queue@_time@_overall\: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
28591 the local host is logged as QT=<<time>> on `Completed' lines, for
28592 example, \"QT=3m45s"\. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
28593 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
28594 .nem
28595 .nextp
28596 .index log||recipients
28597 \received@_recipients\: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
28598 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
28599 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word `for'. The
28600 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
28601 has taken place.
28602 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for \\MAIL\\ or \\RCPT\\ do not appear
28603 in the list.
28604 .nextp
28605 .index log||sender reception
28606 \received@_sender\: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
28607 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
28608 `from' (before the recipients if \received@_recipients\ is also set).
28609 .nextp
28610 .index log||header lines for rejection
28611 \rejected@_header\: If a message's header has been received at the time a
28612 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
28613 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
28614 rejected by the \*local@_scan()*\ function (see section ~~SECTapiforloc).
28615 .nextp
28616 .index log||retry defer
28617 \retry@_defer\: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a retry
28618 time has not yet been reached. However, this `retry time not reached' message
28619 is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
28620 attempt.
28621 .nextp
28622 .index log||return path
28623 \return@_path@_on@_delivery\: The return path that is being transmitted with
28624 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
28625 .em
28626 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
28627 or if delivery is to \(/dev/null)\ or to \":blackhole:"\.
28628 .nem
28629 .nextp
28630 .index log||sender on delivery
28631 \sender@_on@_delivery\: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
28632 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for `from').
28633 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
28634 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
28635 .nextp
28636 .index log||size rejection
28637 \size@_reject\: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because it
28638 is too big.
28639 .nextp
28640 .index log||frozen messages, skipped
28641 .index frozen messages||logging skipping
28642 \skip@_delivery\: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
28643 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
28644 it.
28645 .em
28646 .index `spool file is locked'
28647 The message that is written is `spool file is locked'.
28648 .nem
28649 .nextp
28650 .index log||smtp confirmation
28651 .index SMTP||logging confirmation
28652 \smtp@_confirmation\: The response to the final `.' in the SMTP dialogue for
28653 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form `C="<<text>>"'. A
28654 number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this response.
28655 .nextp
28656 .index log||SMTP connections
28657 .index SMTP||logging connections
28658 \smtp@_connection\: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
28659 established or closed,
28660 .em
28661 unless the connection is from a host that matches \hosts@_connection@_nolog\.
28662 .nem
28663 (In contrast, \lost__incoming__connection\ applies only when the closure is
28664 unexpected.) This applies to connections from local processes that use \-bs-\
28665 as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is dropped in the middle of a
28666 message, a log line is always written, whether or not this selector is set, but
28667 otherwise nothing is written at the start and end of connections unless this
28668 selector is enabled.
28669
28670 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
28671 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
28672 reset if the daemon is restarted.
28673 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
28674 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
28675 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
28676 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
28677 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
28678 .nextp
28679 .index log||SMTP transaction, incomplete
28680 .index SMTP||logging incomplete transactions
28681 \smtp@_incomplete@_transaction\: When a mail transaction is aborted by
28682 \\RSET\\, \\QUIT\\, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
28683 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
28684 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
28685 .nextp
28686 .index log||SMTP protocol error
28687 .index SMTP||logging protocol error
28688 \smtp@_protocol@_error\: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
28689 encountered.
28690 Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors because of
28691 transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If \\PIPELINING\\ has been
28692 advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use it, and
28693 therefore it does not count `expected' errors (for example, \\RCPT\\ received
28694 after rejecting \\MAIL\\) as protocol errors.
28695 .nextp
28696 .index SMTP||logging syntax errors
28697 .index SMTP||syntax errors, logging
28698 .index SMTP||unknown command, logging
28699 .index log||unknown SMTP command
28700 .index log||SMTP syntax error
28701 \smtp@_syntax@_error\: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
28702 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
28703 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
28704 using \-bs-\ the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
28705 .nextp
28706 .index log||subject
28707 .index subject, logging
28708 \subject\: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
28709 preceded by `T=' (T for `topic', since S is already used for `size').
28710 Any MIME `words' in the subject are decoded. The \print@_topbitchars\ option
28711 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
28712 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
28713 .nextp
28714 .index log||certificate verification
28715 \tls@_certificate@_verified\: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
28716 when TLS is in use. The item is \"CV=yes"\ if the peer's certificate was
28717 verified, and \"CV=no"\ if not.
28718 .nextp
28719 .index log||TLS cipher
28720 .index TLS||logging cipher
28721 \tls@_cipher\: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted connection,
28722 the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
28723 .nextp
28724 .index log||TLS peer DN
28725 .index TLS||logging peer DN
28726 \tls@_peerdn\: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted connection,
28727 and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is added to the
28728 log line, preceded by DN=.
28729 .endp
28730
28731 .section Message log
28732 .index message||log file for
28733 .index log||message log, description of
28734 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
28735 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
28736 .index \(msglog)\ directory
28737 they are kept in the \(msglog)\ sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
28738 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
28739 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
28740 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
28741 is complete,
28742 .index \preserve@_message@_logs\
28743 unless \preserve__message__logs\ is set, but this should be used only with
28744 great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
28745
28746 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
28747 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
28748 \message@_logs\ option false.
28749
28750
28751
28752 .
28753 .
28754 .
28755 . ============================================================================
28756 .chapter Exim utilities
28757 .set runningfoot "utilities"
28758 .rset CHAPutils ~~chapter
28759 .index utilities
28760 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
28761 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
28762 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
28763
28764 . This duplication seems to be the only way to arrange that the cross-
28765 . references are omitted in the Texinfo version. They look horribly ugly.
28766
28767 .if ~~texinfo
28768 .display rm
28769 .tabs 22
28770 \*exiwhat*\ $t $rm{list what Exim processes are doing}
28771 .newline
28772 \*exiqgrep*\ $t $rm{grep the queue}
28773 .newline
28774 \*exiqsumm*\ $t $rm{summarize the queue}
28775 \*exigrep*\ $t $rm{search the main log}
28776 \*exipick*\ $t $rm{select messages on various criteria}
28777 \*exicyclog*\ $t $rm{cycle (rotate) log files}
28778 \*eximstats*\ $t $rm{extract statistics from the log}
28779 \*exim@_checkaccess*\ $t $rm{check address acceptance from given IP}
28780 \*exim@_dbmbuild*\ $t $rm{build a DBM file}
28781 \*exinext*\ $t $rm{extract retry information}
28782 \*exim@_dumpdb*\ $t $rm{dump a hints database}
28783 \*exim@_tidydb*\ $t $rm{clean up a hints database}
28784 \*exim@_fixdb*\ $t $rm{patch a hints database}
28785 \*exim@_lock*\ $t $rm{lock a mailbox file}
28786 .endd
28787 .
28788 .else
28789 .
28790 .display rm
28791 .tabs 22
28792 ~~SECTfinoutwha \*exiwhat*\ $t $rm{list what Exim processes are doing}
28793 ~~SECTgreptheque \*exiqgrep*\ $t $rm{grep the queue}
28794 ~~SECTsumtheque \*exiqsumm*\ $t $rm{summarize the queue}
28795 ~~SECTextspeinf \*exigrep*\ $t $rm{search the main log}
28796 ~~SECTexipick \*exipick*\ $t $rm{select messages on various criteria}
28797 ~~SECTcyclogfil \*exicyclog*\ $t $rm{cycle (rotate) log files}
28798 ~~SECTmailstat \*eximstats*\ $t $rm{extract statistics from the log}
28799 ~~SECTcheckaccess \*exim@_checkaccess*\ $t $rm{check address acceptance from given IP}
28800 ~~SECTdbmbuild \*exim@_dbmbuild*\ $t $rm{build a DBM file}
28801 ~~SECTfinindret \*exinext*\ $t $rm{extract retry information}
28802 ~~SECThindatmai \*exim@_dumpdb*\ $t $rm{dump a hints database}
28803 ~~SECThindatmai \*exim@_tidydb*\ $t $rm{clean up a hints database}
28804 ~~SECThindatmai \*exim@_fixdb*\ $t $rm{patch a hints database}
28805 ~~SECTmailboxmaint \*exim@_lock*\ $t $rm{lock a mailbox file}
28806 .endd
28807 .fi
28808
28809 .section Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)
28810 .rset SECTfinoutwha "~~chapter.~~section"
28811 .index \*exiwhat*\
28812 .index process, querying
28813 .index \\SIGUSR1\\
28814 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
28815 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the \\SIGUSR1\\ signal by writing
28816 a line describing what it is doing to the file \(exim-process.info)\ in the
28817 Exim spool directory. The \*exiwhat*\ script sends the signal to all Exim
28818 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
28819 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
28820 order to run \*exiwhat*\ successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
28821 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
28822
28823 .em
28824 \**Warning**\: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
28825 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
28826 script that sends \\SIGUSR1\\ signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
28827 .nem
28828
28829 Unfortunately, the \*ps*\ command that \*exiwhat*\ uses to find Exim processes
28830 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
28831 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
28832 system configuration options that configure exactly how \*exiwhat*\ works. If it
28833 doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time options:
28834 .display
28835 EXIWHAT@_PS@_CMD $rm{the command for running \*ps*\}
28836 EXIWHAT@_PS@_ARG $rm{the argument for \*ps*\}
28837 EXIWHAT@_EGREP@_ARG $rm{the argument for \*egrep*\ to select from \*ps*\ output}
28838 EXIWHAT@_KILL@_ARG $rm{the argument for the \*kill*\ command}
28839 .endd
28840 An example of typical output from \*exiwhat*\ is
28841 .display
28842 .indent 0
28843 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
28844 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
28845 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example [10.19.42.42]
28846 (editor@@ref.example)
28847 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
28848 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
28849 .endd
28850 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
28851 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
28852
28853
28854 .section Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)
28855 .rset SECTgreptheque "~~chapter.~~section"
28856 .index \*exiqgrep*\
28857 .index queue||grepping
28858 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
28859 .display asis
28860 exim -bpu
28861 .endd
28862 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
28863 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
28864 options are available:
28865
28866 .startoptions
28867
28868 .option f <<regex>>
28869 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
28870 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
28871 .display asis
28872 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
28873 .endd
28874
28875 .option r <<regex>>
28876 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
28877 brackets.
28878
28879 .option s <<regex>>
28880 Match against the size field.
28881
28882 .option y <<seconds>>
28883 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
28884
28885 .option o <<seconds>>
28886 Match messages that are older than the given time.
28887
28888 .option z
28889 Match only frozen messages.
28890
28891 .option x
28892 Match only non-frozen messages.
28893
28894 .endoptions
28895
28896 The following options control the format of the output:
28897
28898 .startoptions
28899
28900 .option c
28901 Display only the count of matching messages.
28902
28903 .option l
28904 Long format -- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
28905 the default.
28906
28907 .option i
28908 Display message ids only.
28909
28910 .option b
28911 Brief format -- one line per message.
28912
28913 .option R
28914 Display messages in reverse order.
28915
28916 .endoptions
28917
28918 There is one more option, \-h-\, which outputs a list of options.
28919
28920
28921 .section Summarising the queue (exiqsumm)
28922 .rset SECTsumtheque "~~chapter.~~section"
28923 .index \*exiqsumm*\
28924 .index queue||summary
28925 The \*exiqsumm*\ utility is a Perl script which reads the output of \*exim
28926 -bp*\ and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
28927 running a command such as
28928 .display asis
28929 exim -bp | exiqsumm
28930 .endd
28931 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
28932 it, as in the following example:
28933 .display asis
28934 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
28935 .endd
28936 Each line lists the number of
28937 pending deliveries for a domain, their total volume, and the length of time
28938 that the oldest and the newest messages have been waiting. Note that the number
28939 of pending deliveries is greater than the number of messages when messages
28940 have more than one recipient.
28941
28942 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
28943 domain name, but \*exiqsumm*\ has the options \-a-\ and \-c-\, which cause the
28944 output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages, respectively.
28945
28946 The output of \*exim -bp*\ contains the original addresses in the message, so
28947 this also applies to the output from \*exiqsumm*\. No domains from addresses
28948 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the \one@_time\ option
28949 of the \%redirect%\ router has been used to convert them into `top level'
28950 addresses).
28951
28952
28953
28954 .section Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)
28955 .rset SECTextspeinf "~~chapter.~~section"
28956 .index \*exigrep*\
28957 .index log||extracts, grepping for
28958 The \*exigrep*\ utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
28959 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
28960 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
28961 match the pattern. Thus, \*exigrep*\ can extract complete log entries for a
28962 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
28963
28964 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is always
28965 included in \*exigrep*\'s output.
28966 The usage is:
28967 .display asis
28968 exigrep [-l] [-t<n>] <pattern> [<log file>] ...
28969 .endd
28970 The \-t-\ argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
28971 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
28972 they spent more than <<n>> seconds on the queue.
28973
28974 The \-l-\ flag means `literal', that is, treat all characters in the
28975 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
28976 regular expression. The pattern match is case-insensitive. If no file names are
28977 given on the command line, the standard input is read.
28978
28979 If the location of a \*zcat*\ command is known from the definition of
28980 \\ZCAT@_COMMAND\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\, \*exigrep*\ automatically passes any
28981 file whose name ends in \\COMPRESS@_SUFFIX\\ through \*zcat*\ as it searches
28982 it.
28983
28984 .section Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)
28985 .rset SECTexipick "~~chapter.~~section"
28986 .index \*exipick*\
28987 John Jetmore's \*exipick*\ utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
28988 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details,
28989 run:
28990 .display asis
28991 exipick --help
28992 .endd
28993
28994
28995 .section Cycling log files (exicyclog)
28996 .rset SECTcyclogfil "~~chapter.~~section"
28997 .index log||cycling local files
28998 .index cycling logs
28999 .index \*exicyclog*\
29000 The \*exicyclog*\ script can be used to cycle (rotate) \*mainlog*\ and
29001 \*rejectlog*\ files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
29002 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
29003 ~~SECTdatlogfil). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms for
29004 log cycling, and these can be used instead of \*exicyclog*\ if preferred.
29005
29006 Each time \*exicyclog*\ is run the file names get `shuffled down' by one. If
29007 the main log file name is \(mainlog)\ (the default) then when \*exicyclog*\ is
29008 run \(mainlog)\ becomes \(mainlog.01)\, the previous \(mainlog.01)\ becomes
29009 \(mainlog.02)\ and so on, up to a limit which is set in the script, and which
29010 defaults to 10.
29011 .em
29012 Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded.
29013 .nem
29014 Reject logs are handled similarly.
29015
29016 .em
29017 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
29018 \(mainlog.001)\, \(mainlog.002)\, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
29019 to one that is greater, or \*vice versa*\, you will have to fix the names of
29020 any existing log files.
29021 .nem
29022
29023 If no \(mainlog)\ file exists, the script does nothing. Files that `drop off'
29024 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
29025 using a compression command which is configured by the \\COMPRESS@_COMMAND\\
29026 setting in \(Local/Makefile)\. It is usual to run \*exicyclog*\ daily from a
29027 root \crontab\ entry of the form
29028 .display
29029 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
29030 .endd
29031 assuming you have used the name `exim' for the Exim user. You can run
29032 \*exicyclog*\ as root if you wish, but there is no need.
29033
29034
29035 .section Mail statistics (eximstats)
29036 .rset SECTmailstat "~~chapter.~~section"
29037 .index statistics
29038 .index \*eximstats*\
29039 A Perl script called \*eximstats*\ is provided for extracting statistical
29040 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
29041 Exim log files are also suported by the \*Lire*\ system produced by the
29042 LogReport Foundation (\?http://www.logreport.org?\).
29043
29044 The \*eximstats*\ script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
29045 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
29046 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
29047 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
29048 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
29049 .display asis
29050 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
29051 .endd
29052 By default, \*eximstats*\ extracts information about the number and volume of
29053 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
29054 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
29055 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
29056 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
29057 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
29058 also produced per user.
29059
29060 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
29061 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
29062 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
29063 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one \\RCPT\\ command) is counted
29064 as a single delivery by \*eximstats*\.
29065
29066 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
29067 have multiple recipients), it is possible for \*eximstats*\ to report more
29068 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
29069 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
29070 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
29071 an entirely separate message.
29072
29073 \*eximstats*\ always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
29074 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
29075 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
29076 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
29077 least one address that failed.
29078
29079 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
29080 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
29081 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
29082 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
29083 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
29084 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
29085 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
29086
29087 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
29088 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
29089 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
29090
29091 The options for \*eximstats*\ are as follows:
29092
29093 .startoptions
29094 .index \*eximstats*\||options
29095 .option bydomain
29096 The `league tables' are computed on the basis of the superior domains of the
29097 sending hosts instead of the sending and receiving hosts. This option may be
29098 combined with \-byhost-\ and/or \-byemail-\.
29099
29100 .option byedomain
29101 This is a synonym for \-byemaildomain-\.
29102
29103 .option byemail
29104 The `league tables' are computed on the basis of complete email addresses,
29105 instead of sending and receiving hosts. This option may be combined with
29106 \-byhost-\ and/or \-bydomain-\.
29107
29108 .option byemaildomain
29109 The `league tables' are computed on the basis of the sender's email domain
29110 instead of the sending and receiving hosts. This option may be combined with
29111 \-byhost-\, \-bydomain-\, or \-byemail-\.
29112
29113 .option byhost
29114 The `league tables' are computed on the basis of sending and receiving hosts.
29115 This is the default option. It may be combined with \-bydomain-\ and/or
29116 \-byemail-\.
29117
29118 .option cache
29119 Cache results of \*timegm()*\ lookups. This results in a significant speedup
29120 when processing hundreds of thousands of messages, at a cost of increasing the
29121 memory utilisation.
29122
29123 .option chartdir <<dir>>
29124 When \-charts-\ is specified, create the charts in the directory <<dir>>.
29125
29126 .option chartrel <<dir>>
29127 When \-charts-\ is specified, this option specifies the relative directory for
29128 the \"img src="\ tags from where to include the charts.
29129
29130 .option charts
29131 Create graphical charts to be displayed in HTML output. This requires the
29132 \"GD"\, \"GDTextUtil"\, and \"GDGraph"\ Perl modules, which can be obtained
29133 from \?http://www.cpan.org/modules/01modules.index.html?\.
29134
29135 To install these, download and unpack them, then use the normal Perl
29136 installation procedure:
29137 .display asis
29138 perl Makefile.PL
29139 make
29140 make test
29141 make install
29142 .endd
29143
29144 .option d
29145 This is a debug flag. It causes \*eximstats*\ to output the \*eval()*\'d parser
29146 to the standard output, which makes it easier to trap errors in the eval
29147 section. Remember to add one to the line numbers to allow for the title.
29148
29149
29150 .option help
29151 Show help information about \*eximstats*\' options.
29152
29153 .option h <<n>>
29154 This option controls the histograms of messages received and deliveries per
29155 time interval. By default the time interval is one hour. If \-h0-\ is given,
29156 the histograms are suppressed; otherwise the value of <<n>> gives the number of
29157 divisions per hour. Valid values are 0, 1, 2, 3, 5, 10, 15, 20, 30 or 60, so
29158 \-h2-\ sets an interval of 30 minutes, and the default is equivalent to \-h1-\.
29159
29160 .option html
29161 Output the results in HTML instead of plain text.
29162
29163 .option merge
29164 This option causes \*eximstats*\ to merge old reports into a combined report.
29165 When this option is used, the input files must be outputs from previous calls
29166 to \*eximstats*\, not raw log files. For example, you could produce a set of
29167 daily reports and a weekly report by commands such as
29168 .display asis
29169 eximstats mainlog.sun > report.sun.txt
29170 eximstats mainlog.mon > report.mon.txt
29171 eximstats mainlog.tue > report.tue.txt
29172 eximstats mainlog.wed > report.wed.txt
29173 eximstats mainlog.thu > report.thu.txt
29174 eximstats mainlog.fri > report.fri.txt
29175 eximstats mainlog.sat > report.sat.txt
29176 eximstats -merge -html report.*.txt > weekly_report.html
29177 .endd
29178 You can merge text or html reports and output the results as text or html. You
29179 can use all the normal \*eximstats*\ output options, but only data included in
29180 the original reports can be shown. When merging reports, some loss of accuracy
29181 may occur in the `league tables', towards the ends of the lists. The order of
29182 items in the `league tables' may vary when the data volumes round to the same
29183 value.
29184
29185 .option ne
29186 Suppress the display of information about failed deliveries (errors).
29187
29188 .option nr
29189 Suppress information about messages relayed through this host.
29190
29191 .option nr /pattern/
29192 Suppress information about relayed messages that match the pattern, which is
29193 matched against a string of the following form (split over two lines here in
29194 order to fit it on the page):
29195 .display asis
29196 H=<host> [<ip address>] A=<sender address> =>
29197 H=<host> A=<recipient address>
29198 .endd
29199 for example
29200 .display asis
29201 H=in.host [1.2.3.4] A=from@some.where.example =>
29202 H=out.host A=to@else.where.example
29203 .endd
29204 The sending host name appears in parentheses if it has not been verified as
29205 matching the IP address. The mail addresses are taken from the envelope, not
29206 the headers. This option allows you to screen out hosts whom you are happy to
29207 have using your host as a relay.
29208
29209 .option nt
29210 Suppress the statistics about delivery by transport.
29211
29212 .option nt/<<pattern>>/
29213 Suppress the statistics about delivery by any transport whose name matches the
29214 pattern. If you are using one transport to send all messages to a scanning
29215 mechanism before doing the real delivery, this feature can be used to omit that
29216 transport from your normal statistics (on the grounds that it is of no
29217 interest).
29218
29219
29220 .option "pattern" "#<<description>>#/<<pattern>>/"
29221 Count lines matching specified patterns and show them in
29222 the results. For example:
29223 .display asis
29224 -pattern 'Refused connections' '/refused connection/'
29225 .endd
29226 This option can be specified multiple times.
29227
29228 .option q0
29229 Suppress information about times messages spend on the queue.
29230
29231 .option q <<n1>>...
29232 This option sets an alternative list of time intervals for the queueing
29233 information. The values are separated by commas and are in seconds, but can
29234 involve arithmetic multipliers, so for example you can set 3$*$60 to specify 3
29235 minutes. A setting such as
29236 .display asis
29237 -q60,5*60,10*60
29238 .endd
29239 causes \*eximstats*\ to give counts of messages that stayed on the queue for less
29240 than one minute, less than five minutes, less than ten minutes, and over ten
29241 minutes.
29242
29243 .option t <<n>>
29244 Sets the `top' count to <<n>>. This controls the listings of the `top <<n>>'
29245 hosts and users by count and volume. The default is 50, and setting 0
29246 suppresses the output altogether.
29247
29248 .option tnl
29249 Omit local information from the `top' listings.
29250
29251 .option t@_remote@_users
29252 Include remote users in the `top' listings.
29253
29254 .endoptions
29255
29256
29257 .section Checking access policy (exim@_checkaccess)
29258 .rset SECTcheckaccess "~~chapter.~~section"
29259 .index \*exim@_checkaccess*\
29260 .index policy control||checking access
29261 .index checking access
29262 The \-bh-\ command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
29263 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
29264 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
29265 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of \-bh-\, and
29266 sometimes you just want to answer the question \*Does this address have
29267 access?*\ without bothering with any further details.
29268
29269 The \*exim@_checkaccess*\ utility is a `packaged' version of \-bh-\. It takes
29270 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
29271 .display asis
29272 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
29273 .endd
29274 The utility runs a call to Exim with the \-bh-\ option, to test whether the
29275 given email address would be accepted in a \\RCPT\\ command in a TCP/IP
29276 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
29277 is either the word `accepted', or the SMTP error response, for example:
29278 .display asis
29279 Rejected:
29280 550 Relay not permitted
29281 .endd
29282 When running this test, the utility uses \"<>"\ as the envelope sender address
29283 for the \\MAIL\\ command, but you can change this by providing additional
29284 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
29285 that the test is to be run with the sender address \*himself@@there.example*\
29286 you can use:
29287 .display asis
29288 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
29289 -f himself@there.example
29290 .endd
29291 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
29292 mandatory arguments.
29293
29294 Because the \exim@_checkaccess\ uses \-bh-\, it does not perform callouts while
29295 running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using \-bhc-\,
29296 but this is not yet available in a `packaged' form.
29297
29298
29299 .section Making DBM files (exim@_dbmbuild)
29300 .rset SECTdbmbuild "~~chapter.~~section"
29301 .index DBM||building dbm files
29302 .index building DBM files
29303 .index \*exim@_dbmbuild*\
29304 .index lower casing
29305 .index binary zero||in lookup key
29306 The \*exim@_dbmbuild*\ program reads an input file containing keys and data in
29307 the format used by the \%lsearch%\ lookup (see section ~~SECTsinglekeylookups).
29308 It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias names as keys and the
29309 remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing can be prevented by
29310 calling the program with the \-nolc-\ option.
29311
29312 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
29313 the \%dbm%\ lookup type. However, if the option \-nozero-\ is given,
29314 \*exim@_dbmbuild*\ creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
29315 strings or the data strings. The \%dbmnz%\ lookup type can be used with such
29316 files.
29317
29318 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
29319 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
29320 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
29321 well.
29322 .index \\USE@_DB\\
29323 If the native DB interface is in use (\\USE@_DB\\ is set in a compile-time
29324 configuration file -- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
29325 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
29326 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
29327 .display asis
29328 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
29329 .endd
29330 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
29331 \(/etc/aliases.db)\.
29332
29333 In systems that use the \*ndbm*\ routines (mostly proprietary versions of Unix),
29334 two files are used, with the suffixes \(.dir)\ and \(.pag)\. In this
29335 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
29336 \*exim@_dbmbuild*\, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
29337 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
29338 recommended), because in that case it adds a \(.db)\ suffix to the file name.
29339
29340 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
29341 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the \-noduperr-\ option
29342 is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used -- this
29343 makes it compatible with \%lsearch%\ lookups. There is an option \-lastdup-\
29344 which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead. There is also
29345 an option \-nowarn-\, which stops it listing duplicate keys to \stderr\. For
29346 other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the return code is 2.
29347
29348
29349
29350 .section Finding individual retry times (exinext)
29351 .rset SECTfinindret "~~chapter.~~section"
29352 .index retry||times
29353 .index \*exinext*\
29354 A utility called \*exinext*\ (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to fish
29355 specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
29356 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
29357 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
29358 is obtained by running \*exim@_dumpdb*\ (see below) and post-processing the
29359 output. For example:
29360 .display asis
29361 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
29362 kanga.milne.fict.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
29363 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
29364 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
29365 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
29366 roo.milne.fict.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
29367 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
29368 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
29369 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
29370 past final cutoff time
29371 .endd
29372 You can also give \*exinext*\ a local part, without a domain, and it
29373 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
29374 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
29375 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
29376 suffers a message-specific error (see section ~~SECToutSMTPerr). \*exinext*\ is
29377 not particularly efficient, but then it isn't expected to be run very often.
29378
29379 The \*exinext*\ utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
29380 of the spool directory. The utility has \-C-\ and \-D-\ options, which are
29381 passed on to the \*exim*\ commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
29382 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
29383 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
29384 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
29385
29386
29387
29388 .section Hints database maintenance (exim@_dumpdb, exim@_fixdb, exim@_tidydb)
29389 .rset SECThindatmai "~~chapter.~~section"
29390 .index hints database||maintenance
29391 .index maintaining Exim's hints database
29392 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
29393 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
29394 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
29395 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as
29396 follows:
29397 .numberpars $.
29398 \*retry*\: the database of retry information
29399 .nextp
29400 \*wait-*\<<transport name>>: databases of information about messages waiting
29401 for remote hosts
29402 .nextp
29403 \*callout*\: the callout cache
29404 .nextp
29405 \*misc*\: other hints data
29406 .endp
29407 The \*misc*\ database is used for
29408 .numberpars alpha
29409 Serializing \\ETRN\\ runs (when \smtp@_etrn@_serialize\ is set)
29410 .nextp
29411 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when \serialize@_hosts\ is set in an
29412 \%smtp%\ transport)
29413 .endp
29414
29415 .section exim@_dumpdb
29416 .index \*exim@_dumpdb*\
29417 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
29418 \*exim@_dumpdb*\ program, which has no options or arguments other than the
29419 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
29420 .display asis
29421 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
29422 .endd
29423 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
29424 .display
29425 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
29426 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
29427 .endd
29428 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
29429 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
29430 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
29431 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
29432 address (unless \no@_retry@_include@_ip@_address\ is set on the \%smtp%\
29433 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
29434 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
29435 and a textual description of the error.
29436
29437 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
29438 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
29439 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
29440 exceeded.
29441
29442 Each output line from \*exim@_dumpdb*\ for the \*wait-*\$it{xxx} databases
29443 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
29444 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
29445 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
29446 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
29447 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
29448 cross-references.
29449
29450
29451 .section exim@_tidydb
29452 .index \*exim@_tidydb*\
29453 The \*exim@_tidydb*\ utility program is used to tidy up the contents of the
29454 hints databases. If run with no options, it removes all records from a database
29455 that are more than 30 days old. The cutoff date can be altered by means of the
29456 \-t-\ option, which must be followed by a time. For example, to remove all
29457 records older than a week from the retry database:
29458 .display asis
29459 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
29460 .endd
29461 Both the \*wait-*\$it{xxx} and \*retry*\ databases contain items that involve
29462 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host --
29463 they were messages that were waiting for that host -- and in the latter they
29464 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
29465 types of error. When \*exim@_tidydb*\ is run, a check is made to ensure that
29466 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
29467 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
29468 \*wait-*\$it{xxx} records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are
29469 deleted. For the \*retry*\ database, records whose keys are non-existent
29470 message ids are removed. The \*exim@_tidydb*\ utility outputs comments on the
29471 standard output whenever it removes information from the database.
29472
29473 .em
29474 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
29475 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
29476 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
29477 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
29478 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
29479
29480 It is important, therefore, to run \*exim@_tidydb*\ periodically on all the
29481 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
29482 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
29483 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
29484 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
29485 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
29486 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
29487 tidied.
29488
29489 \**Warning**\: If you never run \*exim@_tidydb*\, the space used by the hints
29490 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
29491 .nem
29492
29493
29494 .section exim@_fixdb
29495 .index \*exim@_fixdb*\
29496 The \*exim@_fixdb*\ program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
29497 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
29498 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
29499 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
29500 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
29501 displayed.
29502
29503 If `d' is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
29504 except the \*retry*\ database, that is the only operation that can be carried
29505 out. For the \*retry*\ database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
29506 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
29507 by new data, for example:
29508 .display asis
29509 > 4 951102:1000
29510 .endd
29511 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
29512 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
29513 used as optional separators.
29514
29515
29516
29517 .section Mailbox maintenance (exim@_lock)
29518 .rset SECTmailboxmaint "~~chapter.~~section"
29519 .index mailbox||maintenance
29520 .index \*exim@_lock*\
29521 .index locking mailboxes
29522 The \*exim@_lock*\ utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
29523 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section ~~SECTopappend.
29524 \*Exim@_lock*\ can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
29525 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
29526 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
29527 argument is run as a command (using C's \*system()*\ function); if there is no
29528 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
29529 is unset or empty, \(/bin/sh)\ is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
29530 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
29531
29532 .startoptions
29533
29534 .option fcntl
29535 Use \*fcntl()*\ locking on the open mailbox.
29536
29537 .option flock
29538 Use \*flock()*\ locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
29539 supports it.
29540
29541 .option interval
29542 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
29543 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
29544
29545 .option lockfile
29546 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
29547
29548 .option mbx
29549 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
29550
29551 .option q
29552 Suppress verification output.
29553
29554 .option retries
29555 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
29556 the lock (default 10).
29557
29558 .option restore@_time
29559 This option causes \exim@_lock\ to restore the modified and read times to the
29560 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
29561 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
29562 subsequently sees.
29563
29564 .option timeout
29565 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
29566 timeout to be used with a blocking \*fcntl()*\ lock. If it is not set (the
29567 default), a non-blocking call is used.
29568
29569 .option v
29570 Generate verbose output.
29571
29572 .endoptions
29573
29574 If none of \-fcntl-\,
29575 \-flock-\,
29576 \-lockfile-\ or \-mbx-\ are given, the default is to create a lock file and
29577 also to use \*fcntl()*\ locking on the mailbox, which is the same as Exim's
29578 default. The use of
29579 \-flock-\
29580 or \-fcntl-\ requires that the file be writeable; the use of
29581 \-lockfile-\ requires that the directory containing the file be writeable.
29582 Locking by lock file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is
29583 expired if it is more than 30 minutes old.
29584
29585 The \-mbx-\ option can be used with either or both of \-fcntl-\ or \-flock-\.
29586 It assumes \-fcntl-\ by default.
29587 MBX locking causes a shared lock to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an
29588 exclusive lock on the file \(/tmp/.$it{n}.$it{m})\ where $it{n} and $it{m} are
29589 the device number and inode number of the mailbox file. When the locking is
29590 released, if an exclusive lock can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in
29591 \(/tmp)\ is deleted.
29592
29593 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
29594 \-v-\ option causes some additional information to be given. The \-q-\ option
29595 suppresses all output except error messages.
29596
29597 A command such as
29598 .display asis
29599 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
29600 .endd
29601 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
29602 .display
29603 exim@_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr @<@<End
29604 <<some commands>>
29605 End
29606 .endd
29607 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
29608 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
29609 such as
29610 .display asis
29611 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
29612 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
29613 .endd
29614 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
29615 second argument -- hence the quotes.
29616
29617
29618
29619 .
29620 .
29621 .
29622 .
29623 . ============================================================================
29624 .chapter The Exim monitor
29625 .set runningfoot "monitor"
29626 .rset CHAPeximon ~~chapter
29627 .index monitor
29628 .index Exim monitor
29629 .index X-windows
29630 .index \*eximon*\
29631 .index Local/eximon.conf
29632 .index \(exim@_monitor/EDITME)\
29633 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
29634 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
29635 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
29636 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
29637 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
29638
29639
29640 .section Running the monitor
29641 The monitor is started by running the script called \*eximon*\. This is a shell
29642 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
29643 binary called \(eximon.bin)\. The default appearance of the monitor window can
29644 be changed by editing the \(Local/eximon.conf)\ file created by editing
29645 \(exim@_monitor/EDITME)\. Comments in that file describe what the various
29646 parameters are for.
29647
29648 The parameters that get built into the \*eximon*\ script can be overridden for a
29649 particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
29650 preceded by `$tt{EXIMON@_}'. For example, a shell command such as
29651 .display asis
29652 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
29653 .endd
29654 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs \*eximon*\ with an overriding setting of the
29655 \\LOG@_DEPTH\\ parameter. If \\EXIMON@_LOG@_FILE@_PATH\\ is set in the
29656 environment, it overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it
29657 possible to have \*eximon*\ tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided
29658 that MAIL.INFO syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
29659
29660 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
29661 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
29662 .display asis
29663 Eximon*background: gray94
29664 .endd
29665 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
29666 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
29667 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
29668 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
29669 `highlight' (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
29670 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
29671 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
29672 .display asis
29673 xrdb -merge <<End
29674 Eximon*highlight: gray
29675 End
29676 .endd
29677
29678 .index admin user
29679 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
29680 \*eximon*\ must either be run as root or by an admin user.
29681
29682 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
29683 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a `tail' of the
29684 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
29685 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
29686 different parts of the display.
29687
29688
29689
29690 .section The stripcharts
29691 .index stripchart
29692 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
29693 be configured by setting \\QUEUE@_STRIPCHART@_NAME\\ in the
29694 \(Local/eximon.conf)\ file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
29695 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
29696 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
29697 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
29698 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
29699 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
29700 parameter in the \(Local/eximon.conf)\ file.
29701
29702 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
29703 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
29704 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
29705 For example, `x2' means that each division represents a value of 2.
29706
29707 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
29708 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
29709 to a single partition.
29710 .index \statvfs\ function
29711 This relies on the availability of the \*statvfs()*\ function or equivalent in
29712 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
29713 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
29714 100%, and the scale is given as `x10%'. This chart is configured by setting
29715 \\SIZE@_STRIPCHART\\ and (optionally) \\SIZE@_STRIPCHART@_NAME\\ in the
29716 \(Local/eximon.conf)\ file.
29717
29718
29719
29720 .section Main action buttons
29721 .index size||of monitor window
29722 .index monitor window size
29723 .index window size
29724 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
29725 to this is another button marked `Size'. They are placed here so that shrinking
29726 the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count stripchart
29727 and these two buttons visible. Pressing the `Size' button causes the window to
29728 expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum, in which case
29729 it is reduced to its minimum.
29730
29731 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
29732 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
29733 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
29734 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
29735
29736 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
29737 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
29738 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
29739 The idea is copied from what the \*twm*\ window manager does for its
29740 \*f.fullzoom*\ action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
29741 the \\MIN@_HEIGHT\\ and \\MIN@_WIDTH\\ values in \(Local/eximon.conf)\.
29742
29743 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
29744 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
29745 \\START@_SMALL\\=yes in \(Local/eximon.conf)\.
29746
29747
29748 .section The log display
29749 .index log||tail of, in monitor
29750 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
29751 the main log is maintained.
29752 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
29753 removing the date and, if \log@_timezone\ is set, the timezone.
29754 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
29755 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
29756 to \*eximon*\ via the \\EXIMON@_LOG@_FILE@_PATH\\ environment variable.
29757
29758 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
29759 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
29760 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
29761 \\LOG@_BUFFER\\ in \(Local/eximon.conf)\, which specifies the amount of memory
29762 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded -- this is much
29763 more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has a
29764 horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
29765 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
29766 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
29767 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
29768 configuration file \(Local/eximon.conf)\.
29769
29770 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
29771 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
29772 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
29773 It cannot go further back up the log.
29774
29775 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
29776 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
29777 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
29778 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
29779 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
29780 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
29781
29782 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
29783 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
29784 the search, and for cancelling. If the `Search' button is pressed, the search
29785 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
29786 `Return' key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
29787 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
29788
29789 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
29790 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both `search' and `replace'
29791 options. In order to suppress the unwanted `replace' portion for eximon, a
29792 modified version of the \TextPop\ widget is distributed with Exim. However, the
29793 linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally provided version
29794 of \TextPop\ when the remaining parts of the text widget come from the standard
29795 libraries. The compile-time option \\EXIMON@_TEXTPOP\\ can be unset to cut out
29796 the modified \TextPop\, making it possible to build Eximon on these systems, at
29797 the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup window.
29798
29799
29800 .section The queue display
29801 .index queue||display in monitor
29802 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
29803 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
29804 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
29805 parameters in the configuration file \(Local/eximon.conf)\, and the frequency
29806 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file --
29807 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
29808 there is an `Update' action button just above the display which can be used to
29809 force an update of the queue display at any time.
29810
29811 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
29812 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
29813 with this situation there is a button next to `Update' called `Hide'. If
29814 pressed, a dialogue box called `Hide addresses ending with' is put up. If you
29815 type anything in here and press `Return', the text is added to a chain of such
29816 texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
29817 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
29818
29819 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
29820 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
29821 example, \*cam.ac.uk*\ specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
29822 \*xxx@@foo.com.example*\ specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
29823 has been set up, a button called `Unhide' is displayed. If pressed, it cancels
29824 all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten, a hide
29825 request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
29826
29827 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
29828 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
29829 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
29830 pressing the `Hide' button.
29831
29832 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
29833 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
29834 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
29835 a bounce message, the sender is shown as `<>'. If there is more than one
29836 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
29837 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
29838 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
29839 not shown.
29840 .index frozen messages||display
29841 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
29842
29843 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
29844 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
29845 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
29846 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
29847 display is updated.
29848
29849
29850 .section The queue menu
29851 .index queue||menu in monitor
29852 If the \shift\ key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
29853 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
29854 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
29855 any selected text.
29856
29857 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
29858 \\MENU@_EVENT\\ parameter in \(Local/eximon.conf)\ to change the default, or
29859 set \\EXIMON@_MENU@_EVENT\\ in the environment before starting the monitor. The
29860 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
29861 run eximon using \ctrl\ rather than \shift\ you could use
29862 .display asis
29863 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
29864 .endd
29865 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
29866 follows:
29867 .numberpars $.
29868 \*message log*\: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed in
29869 a new text window.
29870 .nextp
29871 \*headers*\: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
29872 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
29873 ~~CHAPspool for a description of the format of spool files.
29874 .nextp
29875 \*body*\: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
29876 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
29877 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the \\BODY@_MAX\\
29878 option at compile time, or the \\EXIMON@_BODY@_MAX\\ option at run time.
29879 .nextp
29880 \*deliver message*\: A call to Exim is made using the \-M-\ option to request
29881 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
29882 frozen. The \-v-\ option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
29883 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
29884 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
29885 .nextp
29886 \*freeze message*\: A call to Exim is made using the \-Mf-\ option to request
29887 that the message be frozen.
29888 .nextp
29889 .index thawing messages
29890 .index unfreezing messages
29891 .index frozen messages||thawing
29892 \*thaw message*\: A call to Exim is made using the \-Mt-\ option to request that
29893 the message be thawed.
29894 .nextp
29895 .index delivery||forcing failure
29896 \*give up on msg*\: A call to Exim is made using the \-Mg-\ option to request
29897 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
29898 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
29899 .nextp
29900 \*remove message*\: A call to Exim is made using the \-Mrm-\ option to request
29901 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
29902 message.
29903 .nextp
29904 \*add recipient*\: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
29905 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the \\QUALIFY@_DOMAIN\\ parameter
29906 is set in \(Local/eximon.conf)\, the address is qualified with that domain.
29907 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing \\RETURN\\
29908 causes a call to Exim to be made using the \-Mar-\ option to request that an
29909 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
29910 which case no action is taken.
29911 .nextp
29912 \*mark delivered*\: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
29913 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the \\QUALIFY@_DOMAIN\\ parameter
29914 is set in \(Local/eximon.conf)\, the address is qualified with that domain.
29915 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing \\RETURN\\
29916 causes a call to Exim to be made using the \-Mmd-\ option to mark the given
29917 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
29918 case no action is taken.
29919 .nextp
29920 \*mark all delivered*\: A call to Exim is made using the \-Mmad-\ option to mark
29921 all recipient addresses as already delivered.
29922 .nextp
29923 \*edit sender*\: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current sender's
29924 address. Pressing \\RETURN\\ causes a call to Exim to be made using the \-Mes-\
29925 option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty, in which
29926 case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in bounce
29927 messages), you must specify it as `<>'. Otherwise, if the address is not
29928 qualified and the \\QUALIFY@_DOMAIN\\ parameter is set in
29929 \(Local/eximon.conf)\, the address is qualified with that domain.
29930 .endp
29931 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the \-v-\ output is displayed. In
29932 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
29933 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
29934 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
29935 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set \\ACTION@_OUTPUT\\=yes in
29936 \(Local/eximon.conf)\, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
29937 if no output is generated.
29938
29939 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
29940 thawing, unless \\ACTION@_QUEUE@_UPDATE\\=no has been set in
29941 \(Local/eximon.conf)\. In this case the `Update' button has to be used to force
29942 an update of the display after one of these actions.
29943
29944 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
29945 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
29946 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
29947
29948
29949
29950
29951
29952
29953 .
29954 .
29955 .
29956 .
29957 . ============================================================================
29958 .chapter Security considerations
29959 .set runningfoot "security"
29960 .rset CHAPsecurity ~~chapter
29961 .index security
29962 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
29963 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
29964
29965 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
29966 Exim as a `particularly secure' mailer. Perhaps it is because of the existence
29967 of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the chapter is
29968 simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain security concerns,
29969 not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of its security as
29970 compared with other MTAs.
29971
29972 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
29973 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
29974 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
29975 as soon as possible.
29976
29977 .section Building a more `hardened' Exim
29978 .index security||build-time features
29979 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in \(Local/Makefile)\
29980 to create Exim binaries that are `harder' to attack, in particular by a rogue
29981 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
29982 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
29983 .numberpars $.
29984 \\ALT@_CONFIG@_PREFIX\\ can be set to a string that is required to match the
29985 start of any file names used with the \-C-\ option. When it is set, these file
29986 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence `/../'. (However, if the
29987 value of the \-C-\ option is identical to the value of \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ in
29988 \(Local/Makefile)\, Exim ignores \-C-\ and proceeds as usual.) There is no
29989 default setting for \ALT@_CONFIG@_PREFIX\.
29990
29991 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
29992 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
29993 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
29994 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
29995 .nextp
29996 If \\ALT@_CONFIG@_ROOT@_ONLY\\ is defined, root privilege is retained for \-C-\
29997 and \-D-\ only if the caller of Exim is root. Without it, the Exim user may
29998 also use \-C-\ and \-D-\ and retain privilege. Setting this option locks out
29999 the possibility of testing a configuration using \-C-\ right through message
30000 reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by
30001 that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain
30002 privilege for the delivery, the use of \-C-\ causes privilege to be lost.
30003 However, root can test reception and delivery using two separate commands.
30004 \\ALT@_CONFIG@_ROOT@_ONLY\\ is not set by default.
30005 .nextp
30006 If \\DISABLE@_D@_OPTION\\ is defined, the use of the \-D-\ command line option
30007 is disabled.
30008 .nextp
30009 \\FIXED@_NEVER@_USERS\\ can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
30010 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the \never@_users\ runtime
30011 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
30012 to the list. The default setting is `root'; this prevents a non-root user who
30013 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
30014 .endp
30015
30016
30017 .section Root privilege
30018 .index setuid
30019 .index root privilege
30020 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
30021 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
30022 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
30023 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
30024 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
30025 is required for two things:
30026 .numberpars $.
30027 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
30028 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from \*inetd*\, this privileged action is
30029 not required.
30030 .nextp
30031 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' \(.forward)\ files and
30032 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
30033 configuration.
30034 .endp
30035 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
30036 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
30037 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
30038 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
30039 \(Local/Makefile)\. These are known as `the Exim user' and `the Exim group'.
30040 Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this is not
30041 recommended. Often a user called \*exim*\ is used, but some sites use \*mail*\
30042 or another user name altogether.
30043
30044 Exim uses \*setuid()*\ whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
30045 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
30046 \*seteuid()*\ was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
30047
30048 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
30049 uid and gid in the following cases:
30050 .numberpars $.
30051 .index \-C-\ option
30052 .index \-D-\ option
30053 If the \-C-\ option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
30054 the \-D-\ option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
30055 calling process is not running as root or the Exim user, the uid and gid are
30056 changed to those of the calling process.
30057 However, if \\ALT@_CONFIG@_ROOT@_ONLY\\ is defined in \(Local/Makefile)\, only
30058 root callers may use \-C-\ and \-D-\ without losing privilege, and if
30059 \\DISABLE@_D@_OPTION\\ is set, the \-D-\ option may not be used at all.
30060 .nextp
30061 .index \-be-\ option
30062 .index \-bf-\ option
30063 .index \-bF-\ option
30064 If the expansion test option (\-be-\) or one of the filter testing options
30065 (\-bf-\ or \-bF-\) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
30066 calling process.
30067 .nextp
30068 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
30069 process or a process for testing address routing (started with \-bt-\), the uid
30070 and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
30071 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
30072 testing address verification
30073 .index \-bv-\ option
30074 .index \-bh-\ option
30075 (the \-bv-\ option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the \-bh-\
30076 option).
30077 .nextp
30078 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
30079 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
30080 .endp
30081 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
30082 .numberpars $.
30083 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim user
30084 after setting up one or more listening sockets. The \*initgroups()*\ function
30085 is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they will be
30086 used during message reception.
30087 .nextp
30088 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its job
30089 is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
30090 .nextp
30091 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
30092 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
30093 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
30094 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
30095 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
30096 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
30097 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
30098 generating bounce and warning messages.
30099
30100 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
30101 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
30102 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
30103 gid. A system filter is run as root unless \system@_filter@_user\ is set.
30104 .nextp
30105 A process that is testing addresses (the \-bt-\ option) runs as root so that
30106 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
30107 .endp
30108
30109
30110 .section Running Exim without privilege
30111 .rset SECTrunexiwitpri "~~chapter.~~section"
30112 .index privilege, running without
30113 .index unprivileged running
30114 .index root privilege||running without
30115 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
30116 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
30117 by the global option \deliver@_drop@_privilege\. When this is set, the uid and
30118 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
30119 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
30120 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
30121 to any other uid.
30122
30123 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting \deliver@_drop@_privilege\ means
30124 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
30125 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
30126
30127 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
30128 to the Exim group.
30129 If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root process. (Calling
30130 Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does when it is setuid
30131 root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a SIGHUP signal because
30132 it cannot regain privilege.
30133
30134 It is still useful to set \deliver@_drop@_privilege\ in this case, because it
30135 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
30136 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
30137 effect.
30138
30139 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if
30140 .em
30141 \mua@_wrapper\ is set, or
30142 .nem
30143 \*inetd*\ is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid to the
30144 Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
30145
30146 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
30147 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
30148 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
30149 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
30150 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
30151 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
30152 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
30153 address this problem at this time.
30154
30155 For this reason, the recommended approach for `mostly unprivileged' running is
30156 to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set \deliver@_drop@_privilege\.
30157 This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to be used in the most
30158 straightforward way.
30159
30160 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
30161 number of restrictions on what you can do:
30162 .numberpars $.
30163 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
30164 \user\ and \group\ options to override routers or local transports that
30165 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
30166 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
30167 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
30168 .nextp
30169 Use of \(.forward)\ files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
30170 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
30171 .nextp
30172 Users who wish to use \(.forward)\ would have to make their home directory and
30173 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
30174 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
30175 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
30176 .nextp
30177 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
30178 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
30179 .numberpars $*$
30180 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writable by that group. This
30181 implies you must set \mode\ in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
30182 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
30183 .nextp
30184 You must set \no@_check@_owner\, since most or all of the files will not be
30185 owned by the Exim user.
30186 .nextp
30187 You must set \file@_must@_exist\, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
30188 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
30189 mailboxes need to be created manually.
30190 .endp
30191 .endp
30192 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
30193 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
30194 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting \deliver@_drop@_privilege\
30195 gives more security at essentially no cost.
30196 .em
30197 If you are using the \mua@_wrapper\ facility (see chapter ~~CHAPnonqueueing),
30198 \deliver@_drop@_privilege\ is forced to be true.
30199 .nem
30200
30201
30202 .section Delivering to local files
30203 Full details of the checks applied by \%appendfile%\ before it writes to a file
30204 are given in chapter ~~CHAPappendfile.
30205
30206
30207 .section IPv4 source routing
30208 .index source routing||in IP packets
30209 .index IP source routing
30210 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
30211 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
30212 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
30213 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
30214
30215
30216 .section The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP
30217 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
30218 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
30219
30220
30221
30222 .section Privileged users
30223 .index trusted user
30224 .index admin user
30225 .index privileged user
30226 .index user||trusted
30227 .index user||admin
30228 Exim recognises two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
30229 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
30230 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
30231 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
30232 permit a remote host to be specified.
30233
30234 .index \-f-\ option
30235 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the \-f-\ command line option in
30236 the special form \-f @<@>-\ to indicate that a delivery failure for the message
30237 should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope, but it
30238 does not affect the ::Sender:: header. Untrusted users may also be permitted to
30239 use specific forms of address with the \-f-\ option by setting the
30240 \untrusted@_set@_sender\ option.
30241
30242 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
30243 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
30244 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
30245 as any user listed in the \trusted@_users\ configuration option, or under any
30246 group listed in the \trusted@_groups\ option.
30247
30248 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
30249 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
30250 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
30251 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
30252 includes the contents of files on the spool.
30253
30254 .index \-M-\ option
30255 .index \-q-\ option
30256 By default, the use of the \-M-\ and \-q-\ options to cause Exim to attempt
30257 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
30258 restriction can be relaxed by setting the \no@_prod@_requires@_admin\ option.
30259 Similarly, the use of \-bp-\ (and its variants) to list the contents of the
30260 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
30261 setting \no@_queue@_list@_requires@_admin\.
30262
30263 Exim recognises an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
30264 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
30265 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
30266 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
30267 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
30268 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
30269 files.
30270
30271
30272 .section Spool files
30273 .index spool directory||files
30274 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
30275 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
30276 \(Local/Makefile)\ configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
30277 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
30278
30279
30280 .section Use of argv[0]
30281 Exim examines the last component of \argv[0]\, and if it matches one of a set
30282 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
30283 with the last component of \argv[0]\ set to `rsmtp' is exactly equivalent to
30284 calling it with the option \-bS-\. There are no security implications in this.
30285
30286
30287 .section Use of %f formatting
30288 The only use made of `%f' by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
30289 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
30290 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
30291 converted output.
30292
30293
30294 .section Embedded Exim path
30295 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
30296 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
30297 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
30298 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
30299
30300
30301 .section Use of sprintf()
30302 .index \*sprintf()*\
30303 A large number of occurrences of `sprintf' in the code are actually calls to
30304 \*string@_sprintf()*\, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
30305 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
30306 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
30307 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
30308
30309 The remaining uses of \*sprintf()*\ happen in controlled circumstances where
30310 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
30311 string.
30312
30313
30314 .section Use of debug@_printf() and log@_write()
30315 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
30316 formatting by calling the function \*string@_vformat()*\, which runs through
30317 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
30318
30319
30320 .section Use of strcat() and strcpy()
30321 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
30322 enough to hold the result.
30323
30324
30325
30326
30327 .
30328 .
30329 .
30330 .
30331 . ============================================================================
30332 .chapter Format of spool files
30333 .set runningfoot "spool file format"
30334 .rset CHAPspool ~~chapter
30335 .index format||spool files
30336 .index spool directory||format of files
30337 .index spool||files, format of
30338 .index spool||files, editing
30339 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
30340 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
30341 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
30342 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
30343 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
30344 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
30345 themselves are recoverable.
30346
30347 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
30348 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
30349 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
30350 .numberpars $.
30351 You must use the \*exim@_lock*\ utility to ensure that Exim does not try to
30352 deliver the message while you are fiddling with it. The lock is implemented
30353 by opening the -D file and taking out a write lock on it. If you update the
30354 file in place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename
30355 it, the lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
30356 .nextp
30357 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
30358 \$body@_linecount$\, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect.
30359 .nextp
30360 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
30361 .nextp
30362 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
30363 signature.
30364 .endp
30365
30366 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the \(input)\ directory (or
30367 its subdirectories when \split@_spool@_directory\ is set). These are journal
30368 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
30369 the course of a delivery run. At the end of the run, the -H file is updated,
30370 and the -J file is deleted.
30371
30372 .section Format of the -H file
30373 .index uid (user id)||in spool file
30374 .index gid (group id)||in spool file
30375 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
30376 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
30377 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
30378 message. For a message received over TCP/IP, it is normally the Exim user.
30379
30380 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
30381 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
30382 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
30383 in the \\MAIL\\ command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
30384 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
30385 \qualify@_domain\. However, this can be overridden by the \-f-\ option or a
30386 leading `From' line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
30387 `@<@>' or an address that matches \untrusted@_set@_senders\.
30388
30389 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
30390 was received, in the conventional Unix form -- the number of seconds since the
30391 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
30392 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
30393
30394 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
30395 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
30396 .numberpars $.
30397 \-acl <<number>> <<length>>-\: A line of this form is present for every ACL
30398 variable that is not empty. The number identifies the variable; the
30399 \acl@_c\*x*\$$\ variables are numbered 0--9 and the \acl@_m\*x*\$$\ variables
30400 are numbered 10--19. The length is the length of the data string for the
30401 variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of the next line, and is
30402 followed by a newline character. It may contain internal newlines.
30403 .nextp
30404 .em
30405 \-active@_hostname <<hostname>>-\: This is present if, when the message was
30406 received over SMTP, the value of \$smtp@_active@_hostname$\ was different to
30407 the value of \$primary@_hostname$\.
30408 .nem
30409 .nextp
30410 \-allow@_unqualified@_recipient-\: This is present if unqualified recipient
30411 addresses are permitted in header lines (to stop such addresses from being
30412 qualified if rewriting occurs at transport time). Local messages that were
30413 input using \-bnq-\ and remote messages from hosts that match
30414 \recipient@_unqualified@_hosts\ set this flag.
30415 .nextp
30416 \-allow@_unqualified@_sender-\: This is present if unqualified sender
30417 addresses are permitted in header lines (to stop such addresses from being
30418 qualified if rewriting occurs at transport time). Local messages that were
30419 input using \-bnq-\ and remote messages from hosts that match
30420 \sender@_unqualified@_hosts\ set this flag.
30421 .nextp
30422 \-auth@_id <<text>>-\: The id information for a message received on an
30423 authenticated SMTP connection -- the value of the \$authenticated@_id$\
30424 variable.
30425 .nextp
30426 \-auth@_sender <<address>>-\: The address of an authenticated sender -- the
30427 value of the \$authenticated@_sender$\ variable.
30428 .nextp
30429 \-body@_linecount <<number>>-\: This records the number of lines in the body of
30430 the message, and is always present.
30431 .nextp
30432 .em
30433 \-body@_zerocount <<number>>-\: This records the number of binary zero bytes in
30434 the body of the message, and is present if the number is greater than zero.
30435 .nem
30436 .nextp
30437 \-deliver@_firsttime-\: This is written when a new message is first added to
30438 the spool. When the spool file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
30439 .nextp
30440 .index frozen messages||spool data
30441 \-frozen <<time>>-\: The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at
30442 <<time>>.
30443 .nextp
30444 \-helo@_name <<text>>-\: This records the host name as specified by a remote
30445 host in a \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command.
30446 .nextp
30447 \-host@_address <<address>>.<<port>>-\: This records the IP address of the host
30448 from which the message was received and the remote port number that was used.
30449 It is omitted for locally generated messages.
30450 .nextp
30451 \-host@_auth <<text>>-\: If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP
30452 connection, this records the name of the authenticator -- the value of the
30453 \$sender@_host@_authenticated$\ variable.
30454 .nextp
30455 \-host@_lookup@_failed-\: This is present if an attempt to look up the sending
30456 host's name from its IP address failed. It corresponds to the
30457 \$host@_lookup@_failed$\ variable.
30458 .nextp
30459 .index DNS||reverse lookup
30460 .index reverse DNS lookup
30461 \-host@_name <<text>>-\: This records the name of the remote host from which
30462 the message was received, if the host name was looked up from the IP address
30463 when the message was being received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was
30464 done.
30465 .nextp
30466 \-ident <<text>>-\: For locally submitted messages, this records the login of
30467 the originating user, unless it was a trusted user and the \-oMt-\ option was
30468 used to specify an ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records
30469 the ident string supplied by the remote host, if any.
30470 .nextp
30471 \-interface@_address <<address>>.<<port>>-\: This records the IP address of the
30472 local interface and the port number through which a message was received from a
30473 remote host. It is omitted for locally generated messages.
30474 .nextp
30475 \-local-\: The message is from a local sender.
30476 .nextp
30477 \-localerror-\: The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
30478 .nextp
30479 \-local@_scan <<string>>-\: This records the data string that was
30480 returned by the \*local@_scan()*\ function when the message was received -- the
30481 value of the \$local@_scan@_data$\ variable. It is omitted if no data was
30482 returned.
30483 .nextp
30484 \-manual@_thaw-\: The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is,
30485 by an explicit Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
30486 .nextp
30487 \-N-\: A testing delivery process was started using the \-N-\ option to
30488 suppress any actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further
30489 delivery attempts, \-N-\ is assumed.
30490 .nextp
30491 \-received@_protocol-\: This records the value of the \$received@_protocol$\
30492 variable, which contains the name of the protocol by which the message was
30493 received.
30494 .nextp
30495 \-sender@_set@_untrusted-\: The envelope sender of this message was set by an
30496 untrusted local caller (used to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue
30497 listings).
30498 .nextp
30499 .em
30500 \-spam@_score@_int-\: If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is
30501 present. It records the value of \$spam@_score@_int$\.
30502 .nem
30503 .nextp
30504 \-tls@_certificate@_verified-\: A TLS certificate was received from the client
30505 that sent this message, and the certificate was verified by the server.
30506 .nextp
30507 \-tls@_cipher <<cipher name>>-\: When the message was received over an
30508 encrypted connection, this records the name of the cipher suite that was used.
30509 .nextp
30510 \-tls@_peerdn <<peer DN>>-\: When the message was received over an encrypted
30511 connection, and a certificate was received from the client, this records the
30512 Distinguished Name from that certificate.
30513 .endp
30514
30515 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
30516 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
30517 line when the \-t-\ option is used and \extract__addresses__remove__arguments\
30518 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
30519 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
30520 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
30521 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
30522 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
30523 addresses are complete.
30524
30525 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
30526 the text `XX'. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either Y
30527 or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
30528 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
30529 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
30530 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
30531 .display asis
30532 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
30533 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
30534 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
30535 .endd
30536 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
30537 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
30538 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
30539 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
30540 example:
30541 .display asis
30542 4
30543 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
30544 darcy@austen.fict.example
30545 rdo@foundation
30546 alice@wonderland.fict.example
30547 .endd
30548 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
30549 result of the use of the \one@_time\ option on a \%redirect%\ router, each line
30550 is of the following form:
30551 .display
30552 <<top-level address>> <<errors@_to address>> <<length>>,<<parent number>>@#<<flag bits>>
30553 .endd
30554 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
30555 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
30556 fields. The <<parent number>> is the offset in the recipients list of the
30557 original parent of the `one time' address. The first two fields are the
30558 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
30559 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
30560 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a \%redirect%\ router
30561 that has an \errors@_to\ setting.
30562
30563
30564 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
30565 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
30566 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
30567 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
30568 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
30569 following:
30570 .display
30571 .tabs 9
30572 <<blank>> $t $rm{header in which Exim has no special interest}
30573 #B $t $rm{::Bcc:: header}
30574 #C $t $rm{::Cc:: header}
30575 #F $t $rm{::From:: header}
30576 #I $t $rm{::Message-id:: header}
30577 #P $t $rm{::Received:: header -- P for `postmark'}
30578 #R $t $rm{::Reply-To:: header}
30579 #S $t $rm{::Sender:: header}
30580 #T $t $rm{::To:: header}
30581 #* $t $rm{replaced or deleted header}
30582 .endd
30583 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
30584 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
30585 typical set of headers:
30586 .display asis
30587 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
30588 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
30589 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
30590 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
30591 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
30592 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
30593 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
30594 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
30595 109T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.fict.example,
30596 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
30597 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
30598 .endd
30599 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, ::From:: header, and
30600 ::To:: header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
30601 unqualified domain \*foundation*\.
30602
30603 .
30604 .
30605 .
30606 .
30607 . ============================================================================
30608 .chapter Adding new drivers or lookup types
30609 .set runningfoot "adding drivers"
30610 .index adding drivers
30611 .index new drivers, adding
30612 .index drivers||adding new
30613 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
30614 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
30615 .numberpars
30616 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
30617 existing name; I will use `newdriver' in what follows.
30618 .nextp
30619 Add to \(src/EDITME)\ the line
30620 .display
30621 <<type>>@_NEWDRIVER=yes
30622 .endd
30623 where <<type>> is \\ROUTER\\, \\TRANSPORT\\, \\AUTH\\, or \\LOOKUP\\. If the
30624 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
30625 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
30626 .nextp
30627 Add to \(src/config.h.defaults)\ the line
30628 .display
30629 @#define <<type>>@_NEWDRIVER
30630 .endd
30631 .nextp
30632 Edit \(src/drtables.c)\, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
30633 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
30634 .nextp
30635 Edit \(Makefile)\ in the appropriate sub-directory (\(src/routers)\,
30636 \(src/transports)\, \(src/auths)\, or \(src/lookups)\); add a line for the new
30637 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
30638 .nextp
30639 Create \(newdriver.h)\ and \(newdriver.c)\ in the appropriate sub-directory of
30640 \(src)\.
30641 .nextp
30642 Edit \(scripts/MakeLinks)\ and add commands to link the \(.h)\ and \(.c)\ files
30643 as for other drivers and lookups.
30644 .endp
30645 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
30646 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
30647 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
30648 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
30649 searched using a binary chop procedure.
30650
30651 There is a \(README)\ file in each of the sub-directories of \(src)\ describing
30652 the interface that is expected.
30653
30654 .
30655 .
30656 .
30657 .
30658 . ============================================================================
30659 . Fudge for the index page number. We want it to be on a right-hand page.
30660 .
30661 .set indexpage ~~sys.pagenumber + 1
30662 .if even ~~indexpage
30663 .set indexpage ~~indexpage + 1
30664 .fi
30665 .if ~~sgcal
30666 .%index Index$e~~indexpage--
30667 .fi
30668 .
30669 .
30670 . End of Exim specification